Caa - Cap 804
Caa - Cap 804
Caa - Cap 804
CAP 804 Flight Crew Licensing: Mandatory Requirements, Policy and Guidance
15 October 2013
CAP 804
Civil Aviation Authority 2013 All rights reserved. Copies of this publication may be reproduced for personal use, or for use within a company or organisation, but may not otherwise be reproduced for publication. To use or reference CAA publications for any other purpose, for example within training material for students, please contact the CAA at the address below for formal agreement. ISBN 978 0 11792 851 0 First published April 2012 Corrected May 2012 Amendment 2012/01 incorporated 27 July 2012 Amendment 2012/02 incorporated 17 September 2012 Amendment 2013/01 incorporated 30 January 2013 Amendment 2013/02 incorporated 15 October 2013
Enquiries regarding the content of this publication should be addressed to: Licensing and Training Standards, Safety Regulation Group, Civil Aviation Authority, Aviation House, Gatwick Airport South, West Sussex, RH6 0YR. The latest version of this document is available in electronic format at www.caa.co.uk/publications, where you may also register for e-mail notication of amendments. Published by TSO (The Stationery Ofce) on behalf of the UK Civil Aviation Authority. Printed copy available from: TSO, PO Box 29, Norwich NR3 1GN Telephone orders/General enquiries: 0844 477 7300 Fax orders: 0870 600 5533 www.tsoshop.co.uk E-mail: caa@tso.co.uk Textphone: 0870 240 3701
15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 April 2012 April 2012 15 October 2013 May 2012 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 15 October 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013
30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 15 October 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013
15 October 2013
Page iii
Section Part Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 1 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Part C, Appendix 2 Part C, Appendix 2 Part C, Appendix 2 Part C, Appendix 2 Part C, Appendix 2 Part D Part D Part D Part D Part D Part D Part D Part D Part D Part D Part D Part D Part D, Appendix 1 Part D, Appendix 1 Part E Part E Part E Part E Part E Part E Part E Part E Part E Part E Part E Part E Part E Part E Part E Part E Part F Part G Part G Part G Part G Part G Part H Part A Part A Part A Part A Part A Part A Part A
Page 56 57 58 59 60 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 1 1 2 3 4 5 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Date
Section Part Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Section 2 Part A Part A Part A Part A Part A Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part C Part C Part C Part C
Page 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3
30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 May 2012 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 May 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 30 January 2013 May 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012
30 January 2013 30 January 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 May 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 30 January 2013 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 30 January 2013 May 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012
4 17 September 2012
Section 3 Section 3 Section 3 Section 3 Section 3 Section 3 Section 3 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Part A Part A Part A Part A Part A Part A Part A Part B, Subpart 1 Part B, Subpart 1 Part B, Subpart 1 Part B, Subpart 1 Part B, Subpart 2 Part B, Subpart 2 Part B, Subpart 2 Part B, Subpart 2 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 4 Part B, Subpart 4 Part B, Subpart 4
15 October 2013
Page iv
Section Part Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Part B, Subpart 4 Part C, Subpart 1 Part C, Subpart 1 Part C, Subpart 1 Part C, Subpart 2 Part C, Subpart 2 Part C, Subpart 2 Part C, Subpart 3 Part C, Subpart 3 Part C, Subpart 3 Part C, Subpart 4 Part C, Subpart 4 Part C, Subpart 4 Part C, Subpart 4 Part C Subpart 5 Part C Subpart 5 Part C Subpart 5 Part C Subpart 5 Part D, Subpart 1 Part D, Subpart 1 Part D, Subpart 1 Part D, Subpart 2 Part D, Subpart 2 Part D, Subpart 3 Part D, Subpart 3 Part E Part E Part F, Subpart 1 Part F, Subpart 1 Part F, Subpart 1 Part F, Subpart 2 Part F, Subpart 2 Part F, Subpart 2 Part G, Subpart 1 Part G, Subpart 1 Part G, Subpart 1 Part G, Subpart 1 Part G, Subpart 2 Part G, Subpart 2 Part G, Subpart 2 Part G, Subpart 2 Part G, Subpart 3 Part G, Subpart 3 Part G, Subpart 3 Part G, Subpart 3 Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 1
Page 4 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3
Date May 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012
Section Part Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 2 Part H, Subpart 2 Part H, Subpart 2 Part H, Subpart 2 Part H, Subpart 2 Part H, Subpart 3 Part H, Subpart 3 Part H, Subpart 3 Part H, Subpart 3 Part H, Subpart 4 Part H, Subpart 4 Part H, Subpart 4 Part H, Subpart 4 Part I Part I Part I Part I Part I Part J, Subpart 0 Part J, Subpart 0 Part J, Subpart 0 Part J, Subpart 0 Part J, Subpart 1 Part J, Subpart 1 Part J, Subpart 1 Part J, Subpart 1 Part J, Subpart 1 Part J, Subpart 1 Part J, Subpart 2 Part J, Subpart 2 Part J, Subpart 2 Part J, Subpart 2 Part J, Subpart 2 Part J, Subpart 2 Part J, Subpart 3 Part J, Subpart 3
Page 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2
15 October 2013 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012
15 October 2013 15 October 2013 May 2012 27 July 2012 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 May 2012 27 July 2012 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012
15 October 2013
Page v
Section Part Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Part J, Subpart 3 Part J, Subpart 4 Part J, Subpart 4 Part J, Subpart 4 Part J, Subpart 5 Part J, Subpart 5 Part J, Subpart 5 Part J, Subpart 5 Part J, Subpart 5 Part J, Subpart 5 Part J, Appendix 1 Part J, Appendix 1 Part J, Appendix 1 Part J, Subpart 6 Part J, Subpart 6 Part J, Subpart 6 Part J, Subpart 7 Part J, Subpart 7 Part J, Subpart 7 Part J, Subpart 7 Part J, Subpart 8 Part J, Subpart 8 Part J, Subpart 9 Part J, Subpart 9 Part J, Subpart 9 Part K, Subpart 0 Part K, Subpart 0 Part K, Subpart 0 Part K, Subpart 0 Part K, Subpart 0 Part K, Subpart 0 Part K, Subpart 0 Part K, Subpart 0 Part K, Subpart 1 Part K, Subpart 1 Part K, Subpart 1 Part K, Subpart 2 Part K, Subpart 2 Part K, Subpart 2 Part K, Subpart 3 Part K, Subpart 3 Part K, Subpart 4 Part K, Subpart 4 Part K, Subpart 5 Part K, Subpart 5 Part K, Subpart 5 Part K, Subpart 5 Part K, Subpart 6
Page 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 4 1 2 1 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 1 2 1 2 3 4 1
Section Part Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Part K, Subpart 6 Part K, Subpart 6 Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L
Page 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46
Date May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012
15 October 2013 15 October 2013 27 July 2012 May 2012 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 May 2012
30 January 2013
15 October 2013
Page vi
Section Part Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part L Part M Part M Part M Part M
Page 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 1 2 3 4
Section Part Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Part N Part N Part N Part N Part N Part N Part N Part N Part N Part N Part N Part N Part N Part N Part N Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part O Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P
Page 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 1 2 3 4 5 6 8 9 10
Date 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012
30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 30 January 2013
15 October 2013 15 October 2013 27 July 2012 15 October 2013 May 2012 30 January 2013 15 October 2013 30 January 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 30 January 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 15 October 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 27 July 2012 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 May 2012 27 July 2012 15 October 2013 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012
7 17 September 2012
15 October 2013
Page vii
Section Part Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part P Part Q, Subpart 1 Part Q, Subpart 1 Part Q, Subpart 1 Part Q, Subpart 1 Part Q, Subpart 1 Part Q, Subpart 1 Part Q, Subpart 2 Part Q, Subpart 2 Part Q, Subpart 2 Part Q, Subpart 2
Page 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4
Section Part Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 4 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Part Q, Subpart 2 Part R Part R Part R Part R Part R Part R Part S Part S Part S Part S Part S Part S Part S Part S Part S Part S Part S Part A, Subpart 1 Part A, Subpart 1 Part A, Subpart 1 Part A, Subpart 1 Part A, Subpart 2 Part A, Subpart 2 Part A, Subpart 2 Part A, Subpart 2 Part A, Subpart 2 Part A, Subpart 2 Part A, Subpart 2 Part A, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 1 Part B, Subpart 2 Part B, Subpart 2 Part B, Subpart 2 Part B, Subpart 2 Part B, Subpart 2 Part B, Subpart 2 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 3 Part B, Subpart 3
Page 5 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
Date
15 October 2013 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 April 2012 April 2012 30 January 2013 April 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012
15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 15 October 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 15 October 2013
15 October 2013
Page viii
Section Part Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 6 Section 6 Section 6 Section 6 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Part B, Subpart 4 Part B, Subpart 5 Part C, Subpart 1 Part C, Subpart 2 Part C, Subpart 2 Part C, Subpart 2 Part C, Subpart 2 Part C, Subpart 3 Part C, Subpart 4 Part C, Subpart 5 Part C, Subpart 6 Part D, Subpart 1 Part D, Subpart 2 Part E Part E Part E Part E Part E Part F, Subpart 1 Part F, Subpart 2 Part F, Subpart 3 Part G Part H, Subpart 1 Part H, Subpart 2 Part H, Subpart 2 Part H, Subpart 2 Part H, Subpart 2 Part H, Subpart 2 Part H, Subpart 2 Part H, Subpart 3 Part H, Subpart 3 Part H, Subpart 3 Part H, Subpart 3 Part I Part J Part J Part J Part J Part A Part A Part A Part A Part A Part A Part A Part A Part A Part A
Page 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 1 1 2 3 4 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 5 7
Date May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012
Section Part Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Section 7 Part A Part A Part A Part A Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B Part B
Page 8 9 10 11 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 1 2 3 1 2 1
Date May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012
30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 15 October 2013 15 October 2013 27 July 2012 27 July 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012
1 17 September 2012
15 October 2013
Page ix
CAP 804
30 January 2013
Page x
CAP 804
Section Part Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Part A Subpart 2 Part A Subpart 2 Part A Subpart 2 Part A Subpart 2 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part A Appendix 1 Part B Subpart 1 Part B Subpart 2 Part B Subpart 2 Part B Subpart 2 Part B Subpart 2 Part B Subpart 2 Part B Subpart 3 Part B Subpart 4 Part B Subpart 5 Part C Subpart 1 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2
Page 32 33 34 35 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 1 1 2 3 4 5 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
Section Part Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Section 5 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 2 Part C Subpart 3 Part C Subpart 4 Part C Subpart 5 Part C Subpart 6 Part D Subpart 1 Part D Subpart 2 Part E Part E Part E Part E Part E
Page 15 16 17 18 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5
Date May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012
30 January 2013 May 2012 May 2012 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 May 2012 May 2012 30 January 2013 May 2012 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 30 January 2013 30 January 2013 May 2012 30 January 2013 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012 May 2012
30 January 2013
Page xi
CAP 804
Contents
Foreword
Part I
Section 1
Part A Part B Part C
General Information
Introduction Abbreviations and Denitions EASA and Non-EASA Applicability of European and National Rules
Appendix 1 Categorisation of EASA and non-EASA aircraft Appendix 2 Sample Part-FCL Licence
Part D
Personal Flying Logs and recording of Flight Time Skill Tests Safety Directives, Safety Notices and Information Notices and AICs Information for Air Operator Certicate holders
Section 2
Part A Part B Part C
Section 3 Section 4
Part A Part B
May 2012
Contents Page 1
CAP 804
EASA Light Aircraft Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes LAPL(A) EASA Light Aircraft Pilot Licence for Helicopters LAPL(H) EASA Light Aircraft Pilot Licence for Sailplanes LAPL(S) EASA Light Aircraft Pilot Licence for Balloons LAPL(B)
Part C
EASA Private Pilot Licence (PPL), Sailplane Pilot Licence (SPL) and Balloon Pilot Licence (BPL)
Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Subpart 4 Subpart 5 EASA Private Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes PPL(A) EASA Private Pilot Licence for Helicopters PPL(H) EASA Private Pilot Licence for Airships PPL(As) EASA Sailplane Pilot Licence SPL EASA Balloon Pilot Licence BPL
Part D
EASA Commercial Pilot Licence (CPL) for Aeroplanes, Helicopters and Airships
Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 EASA Commercial Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes CPL(A) EASA Commercial Pilot Licence for Helicopter CPL(H) EASA Commercial Pilot Licence for Airships CPL(As)
Part E Part F
EASA Multi Crew Pilot Licence MPL Airline Transport Pilot Licence ATPL
Subpart 1 Subpart 2 EASA Airline Transport Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes ATPL(A) EASA Airline Transport Pilot Licence for Helicopters ATPL(H)
Part G
Part H
May 2012
CAP 804
Part I Part J
Part K
Examiners
Subpart 0 Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Subpart 4 Subpart 5 Subpart 6 EASA Examiner Certicates EASA Flight Examiners FE EASA Type Rating Examiners TRE EASA Class Rating Examiners CRE Aeroplanes EASA Instrument Rating Examiners IRE Aeroplanes, Helicopters and Airships EASA Synthetic Flight Examiner SFE Flight Instructor Examiner FIE
Appendices to Part-FCL ICAO and EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew Medical Certicates Credits for Military Pilots Licence Conversions UK to Part-FCL Validation and Conversion of Non-EASA licences issued by States other than the UK
Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Validation of Non-EASA licences issued by States other than the UK Conversion of Non-EASA licences issued by States other than the UK
May 2012
Contents Page 3
CAP 804
Part R Part S
Approved Training Organisations (ATOs) Flight Crew Requirements for Air Operations
Section 5
Part A
UK National Licences
UK National Private Pilot Licences (NPPL) for Aeroplanes, Microlights, Self Launching Motor Gliders and Helicopters
Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 UK National Private Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes NPPL(A) (SSEA/SLMG) UK National Private Pilots Licence NPPL(A) with a Microlight Aeroplane Class Rating UK National Private Pilot Licence for Helicopters NPPL(H)
Part B
UK Private Pilot Licences (PPL) for Aeroplanes, Balloons and Airships, Gyroplanes, Helicopters and Unmanned Aircraft
Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Subpart 4 Subpart 5 UK Private Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes UK PPL(A) UK Private Pilot Licence for Balloons and Airships UK PPL(BA) UK Private Pilot Licence for Gyroplanes UK PPL(G) UK Private Pilot Licence for Helicopters UK PPL(H) UK Private Pilot Licence for Unmanned Aircraft UK PPL(UA)
Part C
UK Commercial Pilot Licence (CPL) Aeroplanes, Balloons, Gyroplanes, Helicopters, Unmanned Aircraft and Airships
Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Subpart 4 Subpart 5 Subpart 6 UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes UK CPL(A) UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Balloons UK CPL(B) UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Gyroplanes UK CPL(G) UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Helicopters UK CPL(H) UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Unmanned Aircraft UK CPL (UA) UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Airships UK CPL(As)
Part D
May 2012
Contents Page 4
CAP 804
Part E
The UK Instrument Meteorological Conditions Rating for Aeroplanes UK (IMC) (endorsed as IR(Restricted) on Part-FCL licences) UK Class and Type Ratings
Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Aeroplanes Helicopters Airships
Part F
Part G Part H
Part I Part J
Section 6
Part A
Radio Licences
Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence (FRTOL)
Section 7
Part A Part B
Section 8 Section 9
Part A Part B
May 2012
Contents Page 5
CAP 804
Part II
Section 5
Part A
UK National Licences
UK NPPL for Aeroplanes, Microlights, Self Launching Motor Gliders and Helicopters
Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Simple Single-engine Aeroplane (SSEA)/Self Launching Motor Gliders (SLMG) UK National Pilot Licence for Microlights UK NPPL(A) Microlight/Powered Parachute Allowances Against Training for an NPPL(A)
Part B
UK Private Pilot Licences (PPL) for Aeroplanes, Balloons and Airships, Gyroplanes, Helicopters and Unmanned Aircraft
Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Subpart 4 Subpart 5 UK PPL(A) Aeroplanes UK Private Pilot Licence for Balloons and Airships UK PPL(BA) UK PPL(G) Gyroplanes UK PPL(H) Helicopters UK PPL(Unmanned) Unmanned Aircraft
Part C
UK Commercial Pilot Licence (CPL) for Aeroplanes, Balloons and Airships, Gyroplanes, Helicopters and Unmanned Aircraft
Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Subpart 4 Subpart 5 Subpart 6 UK CPL(A) Aeroplanes UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Balloons UK CPL(B) UK CPL(G) Gyroplanes UK CPL(H) Helicopters UK CPL(Unmanned) Unmanned Aircraft UK CPL(As) Airships
Part D
Part E
May 2012
Contents Page 6
Foreword
1
1.1 1.1.1
Document Description
Document Purpose The purpose of this CAP 804 is to notify the requirements, policy and guidance material that applies to Flight Crew Licences issued by the United Kingdom Civil Aviation Authority and to the training for those licences. The requirements to be complied with for the grant and continued validity of Flight Crew Licences (and associated ratings and authorisations) issued under the UK Air Navigation Order are notied by means of this publication. For completeness this CAP 804 also includes the rules set out in the European Aircrew Regulation pertaining to pilot licences that are issued by the CAA under European legislation. Status CAP 804 applies with effect from 17 September 2012 with exception of Part l, Section4, Part O which applies from 27 July 2012. The text located within any section that is entitled Requirements sets out the mandatory rules that shall be complied with for the grant or continued validity of the relevant licence, rating, authorisation, approval or other certicate or qualication. Document Revisions Each page of this CAP 804 is uniquely identied by page number, section, subpart and date, so that individual pages can be replaced as required to provide updated information. The status of any page may be veried using the List of Effective Pages at the front of the publication. Individual sections of this publication are separately numbered to allow for the issue of amended and additional pages without the need to renumber and reissue the entire document. When amended or new pages are rst issued, changes to the text are indicated by the use of sideline revision marks. Document Availability from the Civil Aviation Authority website at:
1.1.2
1.1.3
1.2 1.2.1
1.3 1.3.1
1.3.2
1.3.3 1.4
Visitors to the website may view, download and reproduce this le for use by their company or organisation, or for their own personal use. 1.4.2 1.5 1.5.1 Printed copies of CAP 804 are available for purchase from the CAAs sales agency for printed publications. Contact details are provided on the inside cover of this publication. Document Comments and Queries Any comments or queries regarding the contents of this document should be sent to fclweb@caa.co.uk.
27 July 2012
Foreword Page 1
Part A
1
1.1
Introduction
Part II contains supplementary information for Section 5. 1.2 Regulations 1178/2011 and 290/2012 the EASA Aircrew Regulation came into force on 8 April 2012. The requirements contained in the regulation replace JAR-FCL 1, 2 and 3 and certain National licensing requirements. This CAP 804 is: a guide to the European ight crew licensing rules; the means by which the CAA noties its information, guidance and Alternative Means of Compliance with the European Rules; and the means by which the CAA noties requirements and guidance material for National ight crew licences. For convenience the requirements of Part-FCL have been reproduced for each kind of licence, rating etc. Some Part-FCL requirements make reference to more than one category of aircraft. For clarity, the Part-FCL text as included in this CAP 804 has been edited to remove references not relevant to the specic section, with some consequential minor wording changes. These deviations from the text of Part-FCL are indicated by underlining. In case of doubt, reference should be made to Annex I to Regulation 1178/2011 which may be found on the EASA website.
1.3
April 2012
The term United Kingdom licence as used by the CAA and in the Air Navigation Order means a licence issued by the CAA that is not an EASA Part-FCL licence and is not a National Private Pilots Licence (NPPL). When the European regulations are fully implemented, United Kingdom licences will not be valid for the piloting of EASA aircraft. The UK National Private Pilots Licence (NPPL) is a licence issued by the CAA that is valid in UK airspace for the piloting of UK registered aircraft only. (The NPPL may only be used in another country with the permission of the relevant authorities of that country.) Depending upon the class ratings included in the NPPL it may be used to y microlight aeroplanes, Self-Launching Motor Gliders (SLMGs), and/or Simple Single Engine Aeroplanes (SSEA). When the European regulations are fully implemented, NPPLs will not be valid for the piloting of EASA aircraft. National licence In European regulations and associated materials, a National licence is any licence issued under national law rather than European regulations. This means any licence that is not issued in accordance with Part-FCL is a National licence. Under the legislation, JAR-FCL licences issued by mutually recognised Member States and fully in accordance with JAR-FCL are deemed to be European Part-FCL licences.
April 2012
Part B
1 Abbreviations
Abbreviation A AAC A/C ADF AFI AIC AIP AIS AeMC AMC AME AMS ANO AOC AOPA ATC ATO ATP ATPL BBAC BCPL(A) BGA BHGA BHPA PPG BHPA SPHG BITD BMAA BMAA FLM CAA
Denition Aeroplane Army Air Corps Aircraft Automatic Direction Finding Assistant Flying Instructor Aeronautical Information Circular Aeronautical Information Publication Aeronautical Information Services Aeromedical Centre Acceptable Means of Compliance published by EASA Authorised Medical Examiner Aeromedical Section Air Navigation Order Air Operators Certicate Aircraft Owners and Pilots Association Air Trafc Control Approved Training Organisation Airline Transport Pilot Airline Transport Pilot Licence British Balloon and Airship Club Basic Commercial Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) British Gliding Association British Hang Gliding Association British Hang Gliding and Para Gliding Association Powered Paraglider British Hang Gliding and Para Gliding Association Self propelled Hang Glider Basic Instrument Training Device British Microlight Aircraft Association British Microlight Aircraft Association Foot Launched Microlight Civil Aviation Authority (United Kingdom)
15 October 2013
CAP CCQ CFI CFS CG CGI C of A C of E C of R C of T CP CPL CQB CR CRE CRI CRM C to I DEFTS DHFS DME EASA ECAC ECG EEA EFIS EFT EU FADEC FCL FE
Civil Aviation Publication Cross Crew Qualication Chief Flying Instructor Central Flying School (of the Royal Air Force) Centre of Gravity Chief Ground Instructor Certicate of Airworthiness Certicate of Experience Certicate of Revalidation Certicate of Test Co-pilot Commercial Pilot Licence Central Question Bank Class Rating Class Rating Examiner Class Rating Instructor Crew Resource Management Competent to Instruct Defence Elementary Flying Training School Defence Helicopter Flying School Distance Measuring Equipment European Aviation Safety Agency European Civil Aviation Conference Electrocardiograph European Economic Area Electronic Flight Instrument System Elementary Flying Training European Union Full Authority Digital Engine Control Flight Crew Licensing Flight Examiner authorised to conduct tests and examinations and sign Certicates of Test and Revalidation in accordance with the privileges stated on the individual authorization Flight Engineer Flight Engineer Licence
F/E F/EL
May 2012
Flight Instructor Flight Instructor (Restricted) Flight Instructor Course Flight Instructor Examiner Flight Navigator Flight and Navigation Procedures Trainer Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence Flight Simulation Training Device - a training device is which is a Full Flight Simulator (FFS), a Flight Training Device (FTD), a Flight Navigation Procedures Trainer (FNPT), or a Basic Instrument Training Device (BITD). General Skill Test (National Private Pilots Licences) Helicopter High Performance Aeroplane Head of Training International Civil Aviation Organisation Interpretative and Explanatory Material Instrument Flight Rules Instrument Landing System Instrument Meteorological Conditions Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) Instrument Rating (Helicopter) Instrument Rating Examiner Instrument Rating Instructor Instrument Rating Test (Aeroplanes) Instrument Rating Test (Helicopters) Joint Aviation Authorities Joint Aviation Requirements Joint Aviation Requirements Flight Crew Licensing Jet Orientation Course Light Aircraft Pilot Licence Licensing and Training Standards Licensing Prociency Check Line Orientated Flight Training Licensing Skill Test Multi Crew Co-operation the functioning of the ight crew as a team of cooperating members led by the pilot-in-command
GST H HPA HT ICAO IEM IFR ILS IMC IR(A) IR(H) IRE IRI IRT(A) IRT(H) JAA JAR JAR-FCL JOC LAPL L&TS LPC LOFT LST MCC
15 October 2013
MCCI MCQ ME MEP MET MGIR MPA MPH MPL MTWA NAA NDB NFT NM NOTAM NPA NPLG NPPL OML OPC OSL P1 P2 PF PIC PICUS PNF PPL P U/T QFI QMP(A) QMP(H) RF R/T RTF
Multi Crew Co-operation Instructor Multiple Choice Questions Multi-engine Multi-engine Piston Multi-engine turbo-prop Motor Glider Instructor Rating Multi-pilot aeroplane Multi-pilot helicopter Multi-Crew Pilot Licence Maximum Total Weight Authorised National Aviation Authority Non-Directional Beacon Navigation Flight Test (UK National Licences) Nautical Miles Notice to Airmen Notice of Proposed Amendment National Pilot Licensing Group (NPLG) Ltd National Private Pilots Licence Operational Multi-Pilot Limitation Operator Prociency Check Operational Safety Pilot Limitation Pilot-in-command Co-pilot Pilot Flying Pilot-in-command Pilot-in-command, under supervision Pilot not ying Private Pilot Licence Pilot Under Training Qualied Flying Instructor (Military) Qualied Military Pilot (Aeroplanes) Qualied Military Pilot (Helicopters) Registered Facility Radiotelephony Radiotelephony
15 October 2013
SE SEP SET SFE SFI SLMG SPA SPH SLPC SSEA STD
Single-engine Single-Engine Piston Single-engine turbo-prop Synthetic Flight Examiner Synthetic Flight Instructor Self Launching Motor Glider Single Pilot Aeroplane - an aeroplane certicated for operation by one pilot Single-pilot helicopter - a helicopter certicated for operation by one pilot Single Lever Power Control Simple Single Engine Aeroplane Synthetic Training Device - a training device that is either a Flight Simulator (FS), a Flight Training Device (FTD), a Flight and Navigation Procedures Trainer (FNPT), or an Other Training Device (OTD) Synthetic Training Instructor Touring Motor Glider Type Rating Type Rating Examiner Type Rating Examiner (Aeroplane) Type Rating Examiner (Flight Engineer) Type Rating Examiner (Helicopter) Type Rating Instructor Type Rating Instructor (Aeroplane) Type Rating Instructor (Flight Engineer) Type Rating Instructor (Helicopter) Type Rating Training Organisation University Air Squadron United Kingdom Aeronautical Information Publication VHF Direction Finding Visual Flight Rules Very High Frequency Visual Meteorological Conditions VHF Omni Range
STI TMG TR TRE TRE (A) TRE (E) TRE (H) TRI TRI (A) TRI (E) TRI (H) TRTO UAS UKAIP VDF VFR VHF VMC VOR
15 October 2013
2 Denitions
Term Aerobatic ight Denition Intentional manoeuvre involving an abrupt change in an aircrafts attitude, an abnormal attitude, or abnormal acceleration, not necessary for normal ight or for instruction for licences or ratings other than the aerobatic rating. Engine-driven xed-wing aircraft heavier than air which is supported in ight by the dynamic reaction of the air against its wings. Type of aeroplane which is required to be operated with a co-pilot as specied in the ight manual or by the air operator certicate. Any machine which can derive support in the atmosphere from the reactions of the air other than the reactions of the air against the earths surface. The consistent use of good judgement and well-developed knowledge, skills and attitudes to accomplish ight objectives A power-driven lighter-than-air aircraft, with the exception of hot-air airships, which are included in the denition of balloon. Lighter-than-air aircraft which is not engine-driven and sustains ight through the use of either gas or an airborne heater. A hot-air airship, although engine-driven, is also considered a balloon Ground-based training device which represents the student pilots station of a class of aeroplanes. It may use screen-based instrument panels and spring-loaded ight controls, providing a training platform for at least the procedural aspects of instrument ight Categorisation of aircraft according to specied basic characteristics, for example aeroplane, powered-lift, helicopter, airship, sailplane, free balloon. Categorisation of single-pilot aeroplanes not requiring a type rating. Categorisation of balloons taking into account the lifting means used to sustain ight. The transport of passengers, cargo or mail for remuneration or hire. Combination of skills, knowledge and attitude required to perform a task to the prescribed standard. An action which constitutes a task that has a triggering event and a terminating event that clearly denes its limits, and an observable outcome. A discrete function consisting of a number of competency elements A pilot operating other than as pilot-in-command, on an aircraft for which more than one pilot is required, but excluding a pilot who is on board the aircraft for the sole purpose of receiving ight instruction for a licence or rating.
Aeroplane
Category of aircraft
Class of aeroplane Class of balloon Commercial air transport Competency Competency element
May 2012
Cross-country
A ight between a point of departure and a point of arrival following a preplanned route, using standard navigation procedures. A pilot who relieves the co-pilot of his/her duties at the controls during the cruise phase of a ight in multi-pilot operations above FL 200. Flight time or instrument ground time during which a person is receiving ight instruction from a properly authorised instructor. An action or inaction taken by the ight crew which leads to deviations from organisational or ight intentions or expectations. The process of detecting and responding to errors with countermeasures which reduce or eliminate the consequences of errors, and mitigate the probability of errors or undesired aircraft states. Full size replica of a specic type or make, model and series aircraft ight deck, including the assemblage of all equipment and computer programmes necessary to represent the aircraft in ground and ight operations, a visual system providing an out-ofthe-ight deck view, and a force cueing motion system. For aeroplanes, touring motor gliders and powered-lift, it means the total time from the moment an aircraft rst moves for the purpose of taking off until the moment it nally comes to rest at the end of the ight; For helicopters, it means the total time from the moment a helicopters rotor blades start turning until the moment the helicopter nally comes to rest at the end of the ight, and the rotor blades are stopped; For airships, it means the total time from the moment an airship is released from the mast for the purpose of taking off until the moment the airship nally comes to rest at the end of the ight, and is secured on the mast; For sailplanes, it means the total time from the moment the sailplane commences the ground run in the process of taking off until the moment the sailplane nally comes to a rest at the end of ight; For balloons, it means the total time from the moment the basket leaves the ground for the purpose of taking off until the moment it nally comes to a rest at the end of the ight. All ight time during which the aircraft is being operated under the Instrument Flight Rules. Full size replica of a specic aircraft types instruments, equipment, panels and controls in an open ight deck area or an enclosed aircraft ight deck, including the assemblage of equipment and computer software programmes necessary to represent the aircraft in ground and ight conditions to the extent of the systems installed in the device. It does not require a force cueing motion or visual system, except in the case of helicopter FTD levels 2 and 3, where visual systems are required
Flight time
Flight time under Instrument Flight Rules (IFR) Flight Training Device (FTD)
May 2012
A training device which represents the ight deck or cockpit environment, including the assemblage of equipment and computer programmes necessary to represent an aircraft type or class in ight operations to the extent that the systems appear to function as in an aircraft. A categorisation of balloons, taking into account the size or capacity of the envelope. Group A Up to 3,400 cubic metres, (up to 120,069 cubic feet). Group B 3,401 to 6,000 cubic metres, (120,070 to 211,888 cubic feet). Group C 6,001 to 10,500 cubic metres, (211,889 to 370,804 cubic feet). Group D Above 10,500 cubic metres. (370,805 cubic feet and above).
Group of balloons
Helicopter
A heavier-than-air aircraft supported in ight chiey by the reactions of the air on one or more power-driven rotors on substantially vertical axes. The time during which a pilot is controlling an aircraft in ight solely by reference to instruments. The time during which a pilot is receiving instruction in simulated instrument ight, in ight simulation training devices (FSTD). Instrument ight time or instrument ground time. For aeroplanes, it means an operation requiring at least 2 pilots using multi-crew cooperation in either multi-pilot or single-pilot aeroplanes; For helicopters, it means an operation requiring at least 2 pilots using multi-crew cooperation on multi-pilot helicopters. The functioning of the ight crew as a team of cooperating members led by the pilot-in-command. For aeroplanes, it means aeroplanes certicated for operation with a minimum crew of at least two pilots; For helicopters, airships and powered-lift aircraft, it means the type of aircraft which is required to be operated with a co-pilot as specied in the ight manual or by the air operator certicate or equivalent document. The period between the end of evening civil twilight and the beginning of morning civil twilight or such other period between sunset and sunrise as may be prescribed by the appropriate authority, as dened by the Member State. Training aids other than ight simulators, ight training devices or ight and navigation procedures trainers which provide means for training where a complete ight deck environment is not necessary. A simple, evaluative statement on the required outcome of the competency element and a description of the criteria used to judge if the required level of performance has been achieved. The pilot designated as being in command and charged with the safe conduct of the ight.
Instrument ight time Instrument ground time Instrument time Multi-pilot operation:
Night
Performance criteria
Pilot-in-command (PIC)
May 2012
A co-pilot performing, under the supervision of the pilot-incommand, the duties and functions of a pilot-in-command. Any aircraft deriving vertical lift and in ight propulsion/lift from variable geometry rotors or engines/propulsive devices attached to or contained within the fuselage or wings. An aircraft equipped with one or more engines having, with engines inoperative, the characteristics of a sailplane. A pilot who holds a licence which prohibits the piloting of aircraft in operations for which remuneration is given, with the exclusion of instruction or examination activities, as established in this Part. The demonstration of skill to revalidate or renew ratings, and including such oral examination as may be required. The administrative action taken after a licence, rating or certicate has lapsed for the purpose of renewing the privileges of the licence, rating or certicate for a further specied period consequent upon the fullment of specied requirements. The administrative action taken within the period of validity of a licence, rating or certicate which allows the holder to continue to exercise the privileges of a rating or certicate for a further specied period consequent upon the fullment of specied requirements. A ight comprising take-off, departure, cruise of not less than 15 minutes, arrival, approach and landing phases. A heavier-than-air aircraft which is supported in ight by the dynamic reaction of the air against its xed lifting surfaces, the free ight of which does not depend on an engine. An aircraft with the characteristics of a non-power-driven glider, which is tted with one or more power units and which is designed or intended to take off under its own power. It differs from the TMG in that the propeller(s)/engine(s) may be retractable. An aircraft with the characteristics of a non-power-driven glider, which is tted with one or more power units but which is NOT designed or intended to take off under its own power. For the purposes of the National Private Pilots Licence a single engine piston aeroplane with a maximum take-off weight authorised not exceeding 2000kgs and which is not a microlight aeroplane or a self-launching motor glider. An aircraft certicated for operation by one pilot. The demonstration of skill for a licence or rating issue, including such oral examination as may be required. Flight time during which a student pilot is the sole occupant of an aircraft. Means a student pilot acting as pilot-in-command on a ight with an instructor where the latter will only observe the student pilot and shall not inuence or control the ight of the aircraft. Events or errors which occur beyond the inuence of the ight crew, increase operational complexity and which must be managed to maintain the margin of safety.
Single-pilot aircraft Skill test Solo ight time Student pilot-incommand (SPIC) Threat
27 July 2012
Threat management
The process of detecting and responding to the threats with countermeasures which reduce or eliminate the consequences of threats, and mitigate the probability of errors or undesired aircraft states. A specic class of powered sailplane having an integrally mounted, non-retractable engine and a non-retractable propeller, that is designed to be capable of taking off and climbing under its own power according to its ight manual. A categorisation of aircraft requiring a type rating as determined in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21, and which include all aircraft of the same basic design including all modications thereto except those which result in a change in handling or ight characteristics. 1. A person is the holder of a licence if a licence has been issued to them and it has not expired and has not been revoked. 2. In the case of a Flight Crew Licence, a person has held a licence if their licence has expired (calendar expiry) or it has been revoked. The person named on the licence has held a licence, but is no longer the holder of a licence. 3. A valid licence. A licence is valid if it has been issued and: (a) it has not expired (or is non-expiring); and (b) it has not been provisionally suspended, suspended or revoked; and (c) the holder has a current and valid medical certicate or medical declaration appropriate to the licence. 4. A valid rating or authorisation. A rating or authorisation is valid if it has been issued and: (a) it has not expired (or is non-expiring) and any applicable recency requirements have been complied with; and (b) it has not been provisionally suspended, suspended or revoked; and (c) the associated licence (where applicable) is valid as above. 5. In the case of a Flight Crew Licence, an Appropriate licence for a ight is dened at Article 50 (2) of the Air Navigation Order 2009 as a licence which entitles the holder to perform the functions being undertaken in relation to the aircraft concerned on the particular ight. This means that it must be a valid licence containing valid ratings and/or authorisations that provide the privileges that are required for the conduct of the ight. In the absence of a similar statement in the EASA Aircrew Regulation, the CAA takes the view that this denition applies to any ight in circumstances where a member of the ight crew must hold a Part-FCL licence.
Type of aircraft
Validity of Licences
May 2012
Part C
1
1.1
1.2
The EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulations 1178/2011 and 290/2012) denes dates after which licences issued under national rules will no longer be valid for ying aircraft that are within the scope of the EU regulations EASA aircraft. Any pilot who intends to y an EASA aircraft registered in the EU after the applicable dates will have to hold an appropriate EASA licence (or a validation if he has a licence from a country that is not an EASA Member State). In some circumstances the licensing requirements will also apply to the pilots of EASA aircraft registered outside the EU; (see Section 4, Part Q). Under EU legislation all aircraft are EASA aircraft unless: a) they are aircraft that are carrying out military, customs, police, search and rescue, reghting, coastguard or similar activities or services (i.e. State Aircraft); or b) they are within the categories set out in Annex II to European Regulation 216/2008 (Annex II aircraft). The main categories set out in Annex II to the EASA Basic Regulation are: microlight aeroplanes; light gyroplanes; amateur built aircraft; ex-military aircraft; foot-launched aircraft; vintage aircraft that meet specic criteria for date of design and manufacture; and aircraft built or modied for scientic or novel purposes. These exclusions are common to the airworthiness Implementing Rules, which have been in place for some years, thus the Annex II aircraft types registered in the UK have already been identied. For an individual aircraft registered in Europe the classication can be determined by reference to the Certicate of Airworthiness or
1.3
May 2012
Permit to Fly for that aircraft. If that document is marked in the bottom left corner as EASA Form 20a or 20b (Permit to Fly) or EASA Form 24 or 25 (Certicate of Airworthiness), then the aircraft is an EASA aircraft. The classication of aircraft by type as EASA and non-EASA aircraft is set out in Section 1, Part 2 of CAP 747 Mandatory Requirements for Airworthiness, which may be found on the CAA website (www.caa.co.uk/cap747). The classication of an individual aircraft registered in the UK may be checked by viewing the data for the aircraft on the Aircraft Register, G-INFO via the CAA website. If the aircraft has a valid airworthiness certicate, G-INFO will show whether it is an EASA certicate or a national certicate. A more succinct denition of an EASA aircraft is that it is an aircraft (other than a State Aircraft) of a type which, if registered in any EU Member State, would be required by EU regulations to have an EASA certicate of airworthiness, an EASA restricted certicate of airworthiness or an EASA permit to y.
NOTE: In the context of EU rules the term Airworthiness Certicate includes Certicate of Airworthiness, Restricted Certicate of Airworthiness, and Permit to Fly.
It is important to understand that an aircraft that is an EASA type is still an EASA aircraft when registered outside the EU and as such is subject to EU regulations when ying in Europe. 1.4 The following example illustrates the primary effect that the EU legislation has on pilots with UK non-JAR licences: The Tigermoth, Luscombe 8, Piper J3 Cub, and Rutan Varieze are examples of aircraft that are within the categories of Annex II to Regulation 216/2008 and so are non-EASA aircraft. The Cessna 172 and the Piper PA28 are EASA aircraft. When compliance with the EU rules for licensing is mandatory the holder of a Single Engine Piston (SEP) class rating on a UK PPL (Aeroplane) that was issued under national rules (before the introduction of JAR-FCL) is still able to y a Tigermoth, a Piper J3 Cub or other nonEASA SEP aeroplane, but that licence is not valid for the PA28, Cessna 172, or any other EASA aircraft. To y an EASA aircraft, an EASA licence is required; any holder of a national licence who intends to y EASA aircraft following any transition periods must obtain an EASA licence (based on credit for the national licence). It is important to understand that the EU legislation is directly applicable and overrides any existing national legislation, such that UK National licences are not valid for EASA aircraft regardless of the wording of the licence or of UK legislation such as the Air Navigation Order (ANO). Pilots who only ever want to y non-EASA aircraft (such as microlights, light gyroplanes and amateur-built aircraft) are able to continue to y those aircraft with their national licences, and are unaffected by EU regulations in that respect; (except in some cases if the aircraft is being own for commercial air transport, in which case an EASA licence may be required). See Appendix 1 to this Part for more information. 1.5 The CAA has amended the Air Navigation Order so that EASA licences with the appropriate class ratings are valid for non-EASA aircraft within those classes; thereby avoiding the need for the holder of an EASA PPL(A) with SEP rating to also hold a national licence in order to y an amateur-built aeroplane or a Tigermoth, for example. (Note that the Air Navigation Order cannot make a National licence valid for the piloting of an EASA aircraft). A Part-FCL licence with single-engine piston aeroplane privileges is not deemed to be rendered valid for a Microlight aeroplane unless the holder of the licence has undergone differences training in accordance with the Air Navigation Order, Section 2 of Part B of Schedule 7, appropriate for a Microlight aeroplane class rating. Refer to Section 5, Part A, Subpart 2, paragraph 3.11-3.13.
1.6
15 October 2013
1.7
An LAPL(A) does not have an SEP rating, but does have SEP privileges endorsed, therefore may be rendered valid for Microlight aeroplanes, subject to satisfying the above requirement.
2
2.1
2.2
Part-FCL makes provision for the granting of licences, ratings and authorisations that are equivalent to those previously issued under JAR-FCL. The requirements are similar to, but not the same as, JAR-FCL. Part-FCL also makes provision for pilot licences for sailplanes, balloons and airships and for ratings for powered-lift aircraft. These Part-FCL licences are all compliant with Annex 1 to the International Convention on Civil Aviation (the ICAO or Chicago Convention) and so are recognised for international ight worldwide. Part-FCL also provides for a Light Aircraft Pilot Licence (LAPL), which is not compliant with ICAO Annex 1. This is similar in concept to the UK NPPL(A). However, the LAPL is valid for ight throughout Europe using any aircraft registered in the EU that falls within the privileges of the licence. The LAPL is not limited to aeroplanes. It is possible to obtain LAPLs for aeroplanes, helicopters, balloons and sailplanes. It is not necessary to hold a Class 1 or Class 2 medical certicate in order to y using an LAPL; there is an LAPL Medical Certicate. The medical requirements (Class 1, Class2, and LAPL) are enacted in the Part-MED Implementing Rules.
2.3
2.4
All Part-FCL licences, including LAPLs are non-expiring lifetime licences. The use of licence privileges is dependent upon the validity of the ratings included in the licence (or compliance with recency criteria in the case of LAPLs) and the validity of the associated medical certicate. Under Part-FCL there are changes to the privileges of instructors for aeroplanes compared with JAR-FCL. Under JAR-FCL Type Rating Instructors (TRIs) and Type Rating Examiners (TREs) perform their respective roles in respect of Type ratings for helicopters and multi pilot aeroplanes. Class Rating Instructors (CRIs) and Class Rating Examiners (CREs) perform their roles for aeroplanes that are within Class Ratings, but also in respect of Type Ratings for single pilot aeroplanes. Under Part-FCL this latter aspect has changed: CRIs and CREs continue to deal with Class ratings and the Type Ratings for single pilot aeroplanes that are not classied as Single Pilot High Performance Complex Aeroplanes (SPHPCA). However, for SPHPCA Type ratings the instructing and examining is by TRIs and TREs, even though they are single pilot aeroplanes.
2.5
30 January 2013
2.6
The Organisation Requirements Aircrew (Part-ORA) set out the requirements for training organisations and Aeromedical Centres. The signicant change is that Part-FCL requires ying training, including for the PPL and LAPL private licences, to be carried out at Approved Training Organisations; the use of Registered Facilities for PPL training will cease on 8 April 2015. The Authority Requirements Aircrew (Part-ARA) set out the requirements and procedures to be complied with by the National Aviation Authorities, including the format of licences and the content and layout of application forms, approval certicates, etc. For UK National licences the Air Navigation Order and the requirements notied by the CAA apply.
2.7
2.8
3
3.1
Licence Validity
The validity of a European Licence Part-FCL and Part-MED All Part-FCL licences are non-expiring lifetime licences. Once issued the licence is held unless it is provisionally suspended, suspended or revoked by the issuing authority or is surrendered by the holder. However, for the licence to be valid for any particular ight the medical certicate and relevant aircraft ratings must be valid.
3.2
Dependency on Medical Certicates Part-MED species that for a licence to be valid the holder must also have a Medical Certicate appropriate to the licence. For each licence, Part-MED species the Medical Certicate that must be held for the licence to be valid as follows: MED.A.30 Medical certicates (a) A student pilot shall not y solo unless that student pilot holds a medical certicate, as required for the relevant licence. (b) Applicants for and holders of a light aircraft pilot licence (LAPL) shall hold at least a LAPL medical certicate. (c) Applicants for and holders of a private pilot licence (PPL), a sailplane pilot licence (SPL), or a balloon pilot licence (BPL) shall hold at least a class 2 medical certicate. (d) Applicants for and holders of an SPL or a BPL involved in commercial sailplane or balloon ights shall hold at least a class 2 medical certicate. (e) If a night rating is added to a PPL or LAPL, the licence holder shall be colour safe. (f) Applicants for and holders of a commercial pilot licence (CPL), a multi-crew pilot licence (MPL), or an airline transport pilot licence (ATPL) shall hold a class 1 medical certicate. (g) If an instrument rating is added to a PPL, the licence holder shall undertake pure tone audiometry examinations in accordance with the periodicity and the standard required for class 1 medical certicate holders. (h) A licence holder shall not at any time hold more than one medical certicate issued in accordance with this Part.
30 January 2013
3.3
Dependency on ratings Part-FCL requires that for any ight (other than under the direction of an instructor or examiner) the pilot must have a valid licence that includes the necessary privileges. This means that the medical certicate must be valid and that the licence must show a valid rating for the Class or Type of aircraft to be own. In the case of the Light Aircraft Pilots Licence the Class or Type of aircraft must be shown on the licence and the recency requirements of Part-FCL.140.A or FCL.140.H as applicable, must be complied with. In all other cases the licence must contain a current Class or Type Rating appropriate to the aircraft at the time of the ight meaning that the rating must not have expired. Whenever a new rating is to be added (or aircraft type added in the case of an LAPL), or an existing rating is to be revalidated or renewed, the licence must be valid in all other respects. i.e. the applicant for the rating must hold a licence that can contain that rating and must hold a valid Medical Certicate appropriate to the licence held and the rating to be added, renewed or revalidated; (e.g. MED.A.030(g) applies additional medical requirements (regarding hearing ability) for the instrument rating for PPL holders).
3.4
The validity of a UK Licence issued under the Air Navigation Order The requirements for a UK non-EASA licence to be valid are the same as set out above for EASA Part-FCL licences, except where a Medical Declaration is sufcient, i.e.PPL(Gyroplane), PPL(Balloons and Airships), and any licence containing only Microlight, SSEA or SLMG Ratings.
3.5
Dependency on Language prociency To comply with the EASA Aircrew Regulation, Part-FCL licences issued by the CAA that include a radio licence must show the level of language prociency. From 17September 2012 onwards, applicants for new or replacement licences, or for the conversion of national licences, must supply evidence of language prociency in English (or have previously been accepted by the CAA as being at a level that has not expired on the date the new licence is issued). Refer to Section 4, Part M for full details.
4
4.1
4.2
30 January 2013
A similar situation arises for any pilot who is, or becomes, qualied to hold a type rating for a non-EASA aircraft, or any other national rating for which there is no EASA equivalent. (Note that this problem does not arise with aeroplane class ratings, such as the SEP rating, which appear in both national and EU rules. This is because the ANO has been amended so that an EASA licence with SEP rating is valid for UK-registered non-EASA single engine piston aeroplanes; no national licence is needed in addition to an EASA licence in such a case). When JAR-FCL was implemented in the UK the ANO was changed so that new UK licences that were equivalent to JAR licences could no longer be issued. The ANO has now been amended so that UK equivalents to EASA licences can be issued where necessary to allow EASA licence holders to hold non-EASA UK national ratings. This has meant reintroducing the UK ATPL, CPL and PPL for both aeroplanes and helicopters. In addition, the NPPL(Helicopters) is introduced as an equivalent to the LAPL(H) so that if the holder of an LAPL(H) qualies for a type rating for a non-EASA helicopter (that is within the limits of the LAPL(H) mass, occupancy, etc.) the rating can be issued and the privileges exercised using a UK licence that will be valid for the holder of an LAPL Medical Certicate. NOTE: A medical declaration will not validate an NPPL (Helicopters). The justication for these new UK licences is that they are necessary because certain ratings cannot be included in an EASA licence. They will be granted following compliance with standards that are the same as those of Part-FCL. The route to obtaining a new UK ATPL, CPL, or PPL for aeroplanes or helicopters, or an NPPL(H), is either: to hold the equivalent EASA licence in accordance with Part-FCL and comply with the requirements for the rating; or to comply with the requirements of Part-FCL for the category of licence, and comply with the requirements for the national rating. 4.4 It is important to appreciate that the Aircrew regulation species that the conversion from a national licence to an EASA licence is only available for national licences issued before the 17 September 2012 or the end date of the applicable derogation, whichever is later. National licences issued as described in 4.3 above after the implementation of Part-FCL are not convertible to EASA licences. As part of the ANO amendment, all UK licences will become non-expiring lifetime licences. The use of the licence privileges remain dependent upon the validity of the ratings included in the licence and the validity of the associated medical certicate or declaration.
4.3
4.5
30 January 2013
(b) 2. (a)
Article 4 Article 4 Basic principles and applicability 1. Aircraft, including any installed product, part and appliance, which are: (a) (b) (c) ...........; or registered in a Member State, unless their regulatory safety oversight has been delegated to a third country and they are not used by a Community operator; or registered in a third country and used by an operator for which any Member State ensures oversight of operations or used into, within or out of the Community by an operator established or residing in the Community; or registered in a third country, or registered in a Member State which has delegated their regulatory safety oversight to a third country, and used by a third-country operator into, within or out of the Community shall comply with this Regulation.
(d)
2.
Personnel involved in the operations of aircraft referred to in paragraph 1(b), (c) or (d) shall comply with this Regulation. ................... ...................
4. 5.
Paragraph 1 shall not apply to aircraft referred to in Annex II. Paragraph 2 ........ shall not apply to aircraft referred to in Annex II, with the exception of aircraft referred to in points (a)(ii), (d) and (h) thereof when used for commercial air transportation.
May 2012
Interpretation of Article 4 Paragraph 2 requires pilots to be licensed according to the EASA Regulation. Paragraph 5 excludes pilots from the European licensing requirements of the EASA if they are ying Annex II non-EASA aircraft, unless: i) ii) the aircraft is a historic aircraft, an ex-military aircraft, or a replica of these; and the ight is for commercial air transport (e.g. the carriage of passengers in return for payment);
in which case an EASA licence is required. Annex II to Regulation 216/2008 The full text of Annex II to Regulation 216/2008 is reproduced below for ease of reference. Please note that: 1. the classications of aircraft registered in the UK with respect to Annex II have already been established during the transition to the European Implementing Rules for airworthiness; and the UK Air Navigation Order denition of a microlight aeroplane matches paragraph (e) of Annex II in respect of aeroplanes.
2.
ANNEX II (to the EASA Basic Regulation 216/2008) Aircraft referred to in Article 4(4) Article 4(1), (2) and (3) do not apply to aircraft falling in one or more of the categories set out below: (a) historic aircraft meeting the criteria below: (i) non-complex aircraft whose: initial design was established before 1 January 1955, and production has been stopped before 1 January 1975. or (ii) aircraft having a clear historical relevance, related to: a participation in a noteworthy historical event. or a major step in the development of aviation. or a major role played into the armed forces of a Member State; (b) (c) aircraft specically designed or modied for research, experimental or scientic purposes, and likely to be produced in very limited numbers; aircraft of which at least 51% is built by an amateur, or a non-prot making association of amateurs, for their own purposes and without any commercial objective; aircraft that have been in the service of military forces, unless the aircraft is of a type for which a design standard has been adopted by the Agency; aeroplanes, helicopters and powered parachutes having no more than two seats, a maximum take-off mass (MTOM), as recorded by the Member States, of no more than: (i) 300 kg for a land plane/helicopter, single-seater; or (ii) 450 kg for a land plane/helicopter, two-seater; or (iii) 330 kg for an amphibian or oatplane/helicopter single-seater; or
(d) (e)
May 2012
(iv) 495 kg for an amphibian or oatplane/helicopter two-seater, provided that, where operating both as a oatplane/helicopter and as a land plane/helicopter, it falls below both MTOM limits, as appropriate; (v) 472,5 kg for a land plane, two-seater equipped with an airframe mounted total recovery parachute system; 315 kg for a land plane single-seater equipped with an airframe mounted total (vi) recovery parachute system; and, for aeroplanes, having the stall speed or the minimum steady ight speed in landing conguration not exceeding 35 knots calibrated air speed (CAS); (f) (g) (h) (i) (j) single and two-seater gyroplanes with a maximum take off mass not exceeding 560 kg; gliders with a maximum empty mass, of no more than 80 kg when single seater or 100 kg when twoseater, including those which are foot launched; replicas of aircraft meeting the criteria of (a) or (d) above, for which the structural design is similar to the original aircraft; unmanned aircraft with an operating mass of no more than 150 kg; any other aircraft which has a maximum empty mass, including fuel, of no more than 70 kg.
May 2012
May 2012
Front-Side
In order to comply with EASA regulations, licences are prefixed with GBR rather than UK
Validity statements
Radiotelephony privilege details If an Examiner certificate is held, then it is indicated here and refers to separate authorisation
Front cover when the licence is folded: Includes Indication of whether licence is a Part-FCL licence
Remarks endorsed upon licence, including Language Proficiency level and validity period. NB Remarks continue on Reverse-side if necessary
Certificate of Revalidation: details current ratings and their valid-until dates, in addition to the associated test date. Also provides test date of any current Instrument Rating tests Further Certificates of Revalidation
Pilots are not permitted to cut up their licence as its format and layout is stipulated by EASA regulations
May 2012
Reverse-Side
Continuation of Remarks and Restrictions from the frontside of the licence, if applicable
Expired Ratings: Any ratings that are no longer current will be listed here
A DIFFERENT KIND OF LICENCE The requirements that apply to the Light Aircraft Pilots Licence (LAPL) are significantly different from those that apply to other pilot licences. This document provides a quick guide for LAPL holders. In case of doubt, reference should be made to Part-FCL and CAP 804. MEDICAL CERTIFICATE In all cases, to use the privileges of an LAPL, you must hold a valid Part-MED LAPL Medical Certificate; or a Class 1 or Class 2 Medical Certificate issued in accordance with Part-MED (or JAR-FCL 3). A UK NPPL Medical Declaration or other national medical is not an acceptable alternative.
FCL.105 LAPL Privileges and conditions (a) General. The privileges of the holder of an LAPL are to act without remuneration as PIC in noncommercial operations on the appropriate aircraft category. (b) Conditions. Applicants for the LAPL shall have fulfilled the requirements for the relevant aircraft category and, when applicable, for the class or type of aircraft used in the skill test. Aeroplanes (and Touring Motor Gliders) - LAPL(A) FCL.105.A LAPL(A) Privileges and conditions (a) The privileges of the holder of an LAPL for aeroplanes are to act as PIC on single-engine piston aeroplanes-land or TMG with a maximum certificated take-off mass of 2000 kg or less, carrying a maximum of 3 passengers, such that there are never more than 4 persons on board of the aircraft. (b) Holders of an LAPL(A) shall only carry passengers after they have completed, after the issuance of the licence, 10 hours of flight time as PIC on aeroplanes or TMG. Helicopters - LAPL(H) FCL.105.H LAPL(H) Privileges The privileges of the holder of an LAPL for helicopters are to act as PIC on single-engine helicopters with a maximum certificated take-off mass of 2000 kg or less, carrying a maximum of 3 passengers, such that there are never more than 4 persons on board. Sailplanes & Powered Sailplanes (and Touring Motor Gliders) - LAPL(S) FCL.105.S LAPL(S) Privileges and conditions (a) The privileges of the holder of an LAPL for sailplanes are to act as PIC on sailplanes and powered sailplanes. In order to exercise the privileges on a TMG, the holder shall comply with the requirements in FCL.135.S. (b) Holders of an LAPL(S) shall only carry passengers after they have completed, after the issuance of the licence, 10 hours of flight time or 30 launches as PIC on sailplanes or powered sailplanes.
(Note: Self-Sustaining Motor Gliders and Self Launching Motor Gliders with retractable propeller/engine are Powered Sailplanes. Self Launching Motors Gliders with non-retractable engine/propeller are TMGs.)
Balloons - LAPL(B) FCL.105.B LAPL(B) Privileges The privileges of the holder of an LAPL for balloons are to act as PIC on hot-air balloons or hot-air airships with a maximum of 3400m3 envelope capacity or gas balloons with a maximum of 1200m3 envelope capacity, carrying a maximum of 3 passengers, such that there are never more than 4 persons on board of the aircraft. Date 10/01/2013 Version No 1.4
30 January 2013
MAINTAINING THE VALIDITY OF THE PRIVILEGES - RECENCY You must not fly an aircraft unless the privileges of your licence are valid. Aeroplanes (and Touring Motor Gliders) - LAPL(A) Within the 24 months prior to your intended flight you must have completed in a single engine piston aeroplane or TMG: (a) at least 12 hours of flight time as PIC, including 12 take-offs and landings; and (b) refresher training of at least 1 hour of total flight time with an instructor. Helicopters - LAPL(H) Within the 12 months prior to your intended flight you must have completed on the specific helicopter type: (a) at least 6 hours of flight time as PIC, including 6 take-offs and landings; and (b) refresher training of at least 1 hour of total flight time with an instructor. Sailplanes & Powered Sailplanes (and Touring Motor Gliders) - LAPL(S) Sailplanes and Powered Sailplanes (excluding TMGs) Within the 24 months prior to your intended flight you must have completed in a sailplane or powered sailplane (excluding TMGs): (a) at least 5 hours of flight time as PIC, including 15 launches; and (b) 2 training flights with an instructor. Touring Motor Gliders Within the 24 months prior to your intended flight you must have completed in a TMG or an aeroplane* (excluding a sailplane or powered sailplane): (a) at least 12 hours of flight time as PIC, including12 take-offs and landings; and (b) refresher training of at least 1 hour of total flight time with an instructor.
(* Where the holder of the LAPL(S) also has a licence to fly aeroplanes, the requirements for TMG may be completed in aeroplanes.) (Note: Self-Sustaining Motor Gliders and Self Launching Motor Gliders with retractable propeller/engine are Powered Sailplanes. Self Launching Motors Gliders with non-retractable engine/propeller are TMGs.)
Balloons - LAPL(B) Within the 24 months prior to your intended flight you must have completed in one class of balloon: (a) 6 hours of flight time as PIC, including 10 take-offs and landings; and (b) 1 training flight with an instructor. MAINTAINING THE VALIDITY OF THE PRIVILEGES - RENEWAL You must not fly an aircraft unless the privileges of your licence are valid. Where the recency requirements above are no longer complied with, the privileges must be renewed in accordance with Part-FCL. Part-FCL requires the licence holder to either: (a) pass a proficiency check in the classes, groups or types of aircraft, as applicable; or (b) complete the remainder of the flights and take-offs and landings or launches that are specified for recency under the supervision of an instructor. The requirements applicable to each category are specified in the following Part-FCL paragraphs: Aircraft Category Aeroplanes (and TMGs) - LAPL(A) Helicopters - LAPL(H) Sailplanes & Powered Sailplanes (and TMGs) LAPL(S) Balloons - LAPL(B) Part-FCL privilege renewal requirements Part-FCL.140.A Part-FCL.140.H Part-FCL.140.S Part-FCL.140.B
Note: The validity of any radio licence (FRTOL) included in an LAPL depends upon the pilots language proficiency being valid. See CAP 804 Section 4 Part M for further information.
Date 10/01/2013
Version No 1.4
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
This document Thi d t provides id an example l t to th the new l look kP Part-FCL t FCL li licence, with ith particular reference to the Light Aircraft Pilot Licence (LAPL). It should be noted that this licence is not ICAO compliant, so cannot be used outside the EASA Member States without the formal permission of the National Aviation Authority of the State you wish to fly in. The new EASA Part-FCL licence document is printed on A4 security paper, with 8 pages to each side, those pages not used are marked Intentionally Blank. The licence document folds into A7, the CAA will provide a new licence cover on initial issue of a licence in the new format
30 January 2013
Page Number
Please note A Light Aircraft Pilot Licence is not ICAO compliant and only valid within the Member States of EASA
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
The licence privileges are shown here starting with the highest privilege and listing other privileges covered
Indicator code of the State of Issue (GBR being the code for the United Kingdom)
The Validity explains the validity and conditions that the holder of the licence is subject too, when exercising the privileges of the licence
The Radio Privileges are shown within the licence document (this is a National Privilege)
30 January 2013
Any restrictions will be shown here, by limiting the privileges to particular paragraphs within Part-FCL, Nil indicates that there are not limitations
30 January 2013
Validity Date of the rating, it will always be valid to the last day of the month
This is where and examiner will confirm the revalidation of a rating, they must enter their certificate number
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
This document Thi d t provides id an example l t to th the new l look kP Part-FCL t FCL li licence, with ith particular reference to the Light Aircraft Pilot Licence (LAPL). It should be noted that this licence is not ICAO compliant, so cannot be used outside the EASA Member States without the formal permission of the National Aviation Authority of the State you wish to fly in. The new EASA Part-FCL licence document is printed on A4 security paper, with 8 pages to each side, those pages not used are marked Intentionally Blank. The licence document folds into A7, the CAA will provide a new licence cover on initial issue of a licence in the new format
30 January 2013
Page Number
Please note A Light Aircraft Pilot Licence is not ICAO compliant and only valid within the Member States of EASA
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
The licence privileges are shown here starting with the highest privilege and listing other privileges covered
Indicator code of the State of Issue (GBR being the code for the United Kingdom )
The Validity explains the validity and conditions that the holder of the licence is subject too, when exercising the privileges of the licence
The Radio Privileges are shown within the licence document (this is a National Privilege)
15 October 2013
Any restrictions will be shown here, by limiting the privileges to particular paragraphs within Part-FCL, Nil indicates that there are not limitations
30 January 2013
Validity Date of the rating, it will always be valid to the last day of the month
This is where and examiner will confirm the revalidation of a rating, they must enter their certificate number
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
This document Thi d t provides id an example l t to th the new l look kP Part-FCL t FCL li licence, with ith particular reference to the Private Pilot Licence (PPL). The new EASA Part-FCL licence document is printed on A4 security paper, with 8 pages to each side, those pages not used are marked Intentionally Blank. The licence document folds into A7, the CAA will provide a new licence cover on initial issue of a licence in the new format.
30 January 2013
Page Number
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
The licence Privileges are shown here starting with the highest privilege and listing other privileges covered
Indicator code of the State of Issue (GBR being the code for the United Kingdom)
The Validity explains the validity and conditions that the holder of the licence is subject too, when exercising the privileges of the licence
The Radio Privileges are shown within the licence document (this is a National Privilege)
30 January 2013
Any restrictions will be shown here, by limiting the privileges to particular paragraphs within Part-FCL, Nil indicates that there are not limitations
30 January 2013
Validity Date of the rating, it will always be valid to the last day of the month
This is where and examiner will confirm the revalidation of a rating, they must enter their certificate number
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
This d Thi document t provides id an example l t to th the new l look kP Part-FCL t FCL li licence of f th the B Balloon ll Pilot Licence (BPL). The new EASA Part-FCL licence document is printed on A4 security paper, with 8 pages to each side, side those pages not used are marked Intentionally Intentionally Blank Blank. The licence document folds into A7, the CAA will provide a new licence cover on initial issue of a licence in the new format.
30 January 2013
Page Number
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
The licence Privileges are shown here starting with the highest privilege and listing other privileges covered
Indicator code of the State of Issue (GBR being the code for the United Kingdom)
The Validity explains the validity and conditions that the holder of the licence is subject too, when exercising the privileges of the licence The Radio Privileges are shown within the licence document (this is a National Privilege) (Radio Privileges are not required if the is not fitted with radio di equipment) i t) Language proficiency If level 4 or 5 are shown an expiry date will be shown (Language proficiency is not required if Radio Privileges are not held)
15 October 2013
Any restrictions will be shown here, by limiting the privileges to particular paragraphs within Part-FCL, Nil indicates that there are not limitations
15 October 2013
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
This d Thi document t provides id an example l t to th the new l look kP Part-FCL t FCL li licence of f th the Sailplane Pilot Licence (SPL). The new EASA Part-FCL licence document is printed on A4 security paper, with 8 pages to each side, side those pages not used are marked Intentionally Intentionally Blank Blank. The licence document folds into A7, the CAA will provide a new licence cover on initial issue of a licence in the new format.
30 January 2013
Page Number
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
The licence Privileges are shown here starting with the highest privilege and listing other privileges covered
Indicator code of the State of Issue (GBR being the code for the United Kingdom)
The Validity explains the validity and conditions that the holder of the licence is subject too, when exercising the privileges of the licence The Radio Privileges are shown within the licence document (this is a National Privilege) (Radio Privileges are not required if the is not fitted with radio di equipment i t Language proficiency If level 4 or 5 are shown an expiry date will be shown (Language proficiency is not required if Radio Privileges are not held
15 October 2013
Any restrictions will be shown here, by limiting the privileges to particular paragraphs within Part-FCL, Nil indicates that there are not limitations
15 October 2013
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
This document Thi d t provides id an example l t to th the new l look kP Part-FCL t FCL li licence, with ith particular reference to the Commercial Pilot Licence (CPL). The new EASA Part-FCL licence document is printed on A4 security paper, with 8 pages to each side, those pages not used are marked Intentionally Blank. The licence document folds into A7, the CAA will provide a new licence cover on initial issue of a licence in the new format.
30 January 2013
Page Number
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
The licence Privileges are shown here starting with the highest privilege and listing other privileges covered
Indicator code of the State of Issue (GBR being the code for the United Kingdom)
The Validity explains the validity and conditions that the holder of the licence is subject too, when exercising the privileges of the licence
The Radio Privileges are shown within the licence document (this is a National Privilege)
30 January 2013
Any restrictions will be shown here, by limiting the privileges to particular paragraphs within Part-FCL, Nil indicates that there are not limitations
30 January 2013
Validity Date of the rating, it will always be valid to the last day of the month
This is where and examiner will confirm the revalidation of a rating, they must enter their certificate number
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
This document Thi d t provides id an example l t to th the new l look kP Part-FCL t FCL li licence, with ith particular reference to the Air Transport Pilot Licence (ATPL). The format of a Commercial Pilot Licence (CPL) is similar. The new EASA Part-FCL licence document is printed on A4 security paper, with 8 pages to each side, those pages not used are marked Intentionally Blank. The licence document folds into A7, the CAA will provide a new licence cover on initial issue of a licence in the new format.
30 January 2013
Page Number
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
The licence Privileges are shown here starting with the highest privilege and listing other privileges covered
Indicator code of the State of Issue (GBR being the code for the United Kingdom)
The Validity explains the validity and conditions that the holder of the licence is subject too, when exercising the privileges of the licence
The Radio Privileges are shown within the licence document (this is a National Privilege)
30 January 2013
Any restrictions will be shown here, by limiting the privileges to particular paragraphs within Part-FCL, Nil indicates that there are not limitations
30 January 2013
Validity Date of the rating, it will always be valid to the last day of the month
This is where and examiner will confirm the revalidation of a rating, they must enter their certificate number
30 January 2013
30 January 2013
Part D
1
General Information
An applicant for a pilot licence, rating or other qualication, shall demonstrate a level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges of the licence, rating or qualication for which application is made by passing theoretical knowledge examinations in accordance with the requirements set out in Part-FCL Annex 1, Subpart A, FCL.025 for EASA licences, and as set out in this CAP 804 for UK National Licences. Applicants for the Part-FCL LAPL or PPL licences shall make application and undertake the theoretical knowledge examinations at an Approved Training organisation (ATO). Examinations for non professional licences conducted at ATOs are scheduled at the discretion of the ATO. Applicants for professional pilot licences or an instrument rating shall make application to the CAA and undertake the theoretical knowledge examination at a CAA exam centre. The examinations will be provided in English only, using abbreviations where applicable. Examinations for professional licences are compiled by computer and are presented in a multiple-choice format. A list of common abbreviations used in the examinations can be found in Part-FCL. EU regulations for licensing came into force on 8 April 2012. Credit is given for training and examinations completed to JAR-FCL requirements before 8 April 2012 for the issue of EASA Part-FCL licences, but examinations taken after that date must be to the latest standard. For this reason no examinations to the old standard are available after March 2012 (this includes re-sits). Where an applicant for a licence or rating has completed all of the examinations for that qualication to either the new or old standard by the end of March 2012, those examinations will be valid for the qualication; (subject to the usual calendar expiry). However, where an applicant who is sitting exams that are not to the latest JAR standard does not pass them all before 8 April 2012, the candidate will have to take all remaining subjects to the new standard. In this case, where the candidate has passed any of the subjects listed below to the old standard, the candidate will have to resit and pass those subjects to the new standard as the content of those subjects has changed. ATPL Examinations (A and H) Subject 21 Airframes Subject 22 Instrumentation Subject 62 Radio Navigation Subject 71 Operational Procedures (Aeroplanes only) CPL Examinations (A and H) Subject 21 Airframe Systems Subject 22 Instruments Subject 31 Mass and Balance Subject 32 Performance (Aeroplanes) Subject 33 Flight Planning Subject 34 Performance (Helicopters) Subject 62 Radio Navigation
May 2012
IR Examinations (A and H) Subject 10 Air Law Subject 22 Instruments Subject 62 Radio Navigation Helicopter Interim Arrangements for CPL(H) and ATPL(H) Subject 21 Airframes Subject 22 Instrumentation Subject 31 Mass and Balance Subject 33 Flight Planning Subject 34 Performance Subject 62 Radio Navigation Subject 71 Operational Procedures Subject 82 Principles of Flight
2
2.1
2.2
Examination Timetable The Examination Timetable can be found on the CAA website at: www.caa.co.uk/examinations.
May 2012
2.3
Venue Details Detailed venue maps can be found on the CAA (SRG) web site at www.caa.co.uk/ maps. Facilities for lunchtime meals and/or snacks will be provided at all venues wherever possible on a payment basis.
2.4
Amending Examination Bookings Examination bookings cannot be amended in the ve clear working days prior to Day One of the examination week that the examination booking is contained within. Cancellations/transfers will only be accepted if received in writing at least 5 clear working days before Day One of the examination week, for overseas venues this is 10 working days, if accompanied by the cancellation/transfer fee as specied in the current Personnel Licensing Scheme of Charges. Cancellations/transfers requested within these 5 clear working days are subject to the loss of the subject fee(s). Refund of examination fees for emergency cancellations or non-attendance will only be given if a valid medical certicate (original) is provided, together with a letter of explanation. NOTE: For CAA purposes, working days are Monday to Friday (excluding public holidays). A fee applies to any amendment (except venue changes) to an existing booking and must accompany the written amendment request. Please refer to our current Scheme of Charges on our web site at www.caa. co.uk/pldcharges. Money will only be debited from a debit/credit card or from money that is held in credit for that individual with prior authorisation from the card/account holder. Where a candidate does not attend for a booked examination(s), the fee for those subjects will be non-refundable and nontransferable. For any subjects not attempted within a sitting, when having attempted at least one subject, the fee(s) and attempt(s) are non-refundable and non-transferable.
2.5
Attendance at the Examination Candidates should be present at the examination centre with photographic proof of identity* at least 20 minutes before the scheduled time for the commencement of each examination. A candidate who fails to provide authorised identication will not be permitted to take the examination and will forfeit the fee and attempt for that subject. The sitting number may also be affected. Candidates may enter the examination room only after invitation by the Invigilator, during the 10 minutes preceding the start of the examination to prepare examination material. Candidates must not remain in the examination room after the nish of the examination period. On occasions when there is a possibility of disruption to public transport services, for whatever reason, candidates are expected to make alternative arrangements for attendance or, if appropriate, to give formal notice of their inability to attend. Personal coats, bags, briefcases, etc. may be placed at the front/rear of the examination room, under the direction of the Invigilating Ofcer. Any bags etc. could be removed if left unattended outside the examination room.
May 2012
Whilst every attempt is made to ensure reasonable comfort in examination halls, the CAA cannot be held responsible for extraneous noise or for any breakdown or uctuation in heating, lighting or ventilation facilities in examination halls which are operated on hire or lease arrangements and over which the CAA, as a result, has no direct control. Candidates are also advised that, at all examination centres, a no smoking rule must be observed. Please note you are not permitted to take any photographs at CAA examination venues. NOTE: The CAA accepts no responsibility for items of personal equipment a candidate brings into the examination hall and which he/she is not permitted to retain during the examination. *Acceptable forms of photographic ID are: valid passport, UK Forces ID, photographic Driving Licence, School passes and Company ID. All forms of ID must be photographic. 2.6 Materials for the Examination When necessary the following reference books and tables will be supplied to each candidate, but they must not be marked in any way or removed from the examination room: a) CAP 696 Mass and Balance Manual; b) CAP 697 Flight Planning Manual; c) CAP 698 Performance Manual. Candidates must bring the following materials to the following examination: General Navigation ATPL, Navigation CPL and IR 0150 E(LO) 1/2 and E(LO) 1A Jeppesen Chart. Candidates must bring the following materials to the following examination: Flight Planning candidates must provide their own Jeppesen Training Route Manual. These are subject to random checks by the CAA Invigilators. Candidates are required to provide themselves with all the necessary drawing and calculating instruments, e.g. dividers, compasses, protractors, parallel rules, sliderules and navigational computers and a scientic, non-programmable, non-alphanumeric calculator without aviation functions. Candidates may use their own pens, pencils, highlighters etc. on the rough working paper provided and on their own documents. Documents provided by the CAA must not be marked in any permanent way (if pencils are used in CAA manuals, all marks must be erased before they are collected by the Invigilator). No pencil boxes, containers or instrument cases are permitted on tables. The use of slide rules or instruments containing printed information on critical point, point of no return, distance to the horizon, convergency, conversion angle, dep/dlong, conversion factors, etc. are not permitted. 2.7 Examination Brieng Before the start of the examinations, the Invigilator will give a brieng regarding the examination, details of which can be found in Appendix 1.
17 September 2012
2.8
Regulations which will be applied to the conduct of Examinations Candidates are not allowed to use any loose paper other than that provided at the examination by the CAA. All papers issued and documents provided by the CAA are to be returned with the answer sheet to the Invigilator on completion. Failure to comply with this rule may result in disciplinary action being taken. Answer sheets must be completed using the pencil provided. Candidates may use other writing implements on the rough working paper or on their own documents. Candidates who choose to record answers on the question paper or elsewhere before copying onto the answer sheet must do so within the time allotted for the examination. No additional time will be allowed for transferring answers onto the answer sheet. Answers recorded anywhere other than the answer sheet will not be taken into account. Silence is to be observed in the examination room at all times. Alarms from wristwatches and key rings are not permitted. Mobile telephones, pagers etc. must be switched off and left in the candidates personal belongings and must not be on your person. Candidates must not attempt to communicate with other candidates or disturb other candidates or attempt to observe the answers given by any other candidate. If a candidate wishes to speak to an Invigilating Ofcer, they should remain seated and raise their hand. It should be noted that the Invigilating Ofcer will consider only those questions from candidates which relate to the general conduct of the examinations and they will not enter into discussion on the interpretation of words or questions contained in the examination papers. A candidate may leave the room only with the permission of the Invigilating Ofcer if they have nished an examination before time, except during the last 5 minutes (after the warning is given) before the end of any paper. Candidates are to stop work and put pencils down immediately when so directed and must remain seated and quiet until all answer material has been collected. Failure to comply with this rule may result in disciplinary action being taken. If a candidate chooses to ignore any of the above regulations, they may be asked to leave the examination room. Any candidate who attempts to remove unauthorised examination materials from the room will be liable to disqualication from those examinations that have been taken and may be subject to special arrangements for future examinations.
2.9
Failure to comply with Examination Regulations Any infringement of examination regulations may result in the candidate being disqualied in any subjects that have been taken on that occasion and previous occasions, the candidate will also be barred from further participation in future examinations for a minimum period of 12 months. Immediate removal from the examination room may be imposed if a candidate contravenes any of these regulations.
2.10
Examination Results Candidates should not telephone the CAA for results as we always endeavour to work to the timescales below. Enquiries received before the published despatch date only serve to delay the process. In normal circumstances results will be despatched by rst class post or air mail within ten working days after the Friday of the examination week. Results will not be despatched until any outstanding payments have been received. It is not possible to collect your results from the CAA on the day of despatch.
15 October 2013
Please note that examination results cannot be e-mailed or advised via the telephone. In the event of non-receipt of a result notication, arrangements can be made (on receipt of a written request) for repeat notications to be sent by post, however an allowance should be made for possible postal delays before requesting a repeat notication. The CAA cannot enter into discussion or correspondence with candidates on the subject of their examination results, but candidates may apply for any paper to be re-marked on payment of the fee as stated in the CAA Scheme of Charges, together with a written request. NOTE: Candidates for Professional Pilot and Flight Engineer Licences are advised to consult: a) Part-FCL and Part-OPS for aeroplane examinations. b) Part-FCL and JAR-OPS 3 for helicopter examinations. c) Part-MED for relevant medical regulations. d) JAR-FCL 4 for ight engineer examinations. e) Part-FCL Learning Objectives (LOs) at appropriate level. All candidates are reminded that Aeronautical Information Circulars (White) published by the CAA are the means of conveying early warnings of, and short notice changes to, any of the examination requirements or timetables. 2.11 Re-sits Candidates cannot apply to re-sit examinations, which they believe they may have failed, until they have received the ofcial result notication.
15 October 2013
IFR Communications 1215-1245 Daily Total 3 hours Part-FCL ATPL(A) Papers Subject 010 Air Law Subject 021 Aircraft General Knowledge Subject 022 Aircraft General Knowledge Instrumentation Subject 031 Mass & Balance Subject 032 Performance Aeroplanes Subject 033 Flight Planning and Monitoring Subject 040 Human Performance Subject 050 Meteorology Subject 061 General Navigation Subject 062 Radio Navigation Subject 070 Operational Procedures Subject 081 Principles of Flight Aeroplanes Subject 091 VFR Communications Subject 092 IFR Communications Part-FCL ATPL(H)/IR Papers Subject 010 Subject 021 Subject 022 Subject 031 Subject 033 Subject 034 Subject 040 Subject 050 Subject 061 Subject 062 Subject 071 Subject 082 Subject 091 Subject 092 Subject 010 Subject 021 Subject 022 Subject 031 Subject 033 Subject 034 Subject 040 Subject 050 Subject 061 Subject 062 Subject 071 Subject 082 Subject 091 Air Law Aircraft General Knowledge Aircraft General Knowledge Instruments Mass & Balance Flight Planning and Monitoring Performance Helicopter Human Performance Meteorology General Navigation Radio Navigation Operational Procedures Principles of Flight Helicopters VFR Communications IFR Communications Air Law Aircraft General Knowledge Aircraft General Knowledge Instruments Mass & Balance Flight Planning and Monitoring Performance Helicopter Human Performance Meteorology General Navigation Radio Navigation Operational Procedures Principles of Flight Helicopters VFR Communications
15 October 2013
May 2012
Part-FCL CPL(A) Papers Subject 010 Air Law Subject 021 Aircraft General Knowledge Subject 022 Aircraft General Knowledge Instruments Subject 031 Mass & Balance Subject 032 Performance Aeroplanes Subject 033 Flight Planning and Monitoring Subject 040 Human Performance Subject 050 Meteorology Subject 061 General Navigation Subject 062 Radio Navigation Subject 071 Operational Procedures Subject 081 Principles of Flight Aeroplanes Subject 091 VFR Communications Part-FCL CPL(H) Papers Subject 010 Subject 021 Subject 022 Subject 031 Subject 033 Subject 034 Subject 040 Subject 050 Subject 061 Subject 062 Subject 071 Subject 082 Subject 091 Air Law Aircraft General Knowledge Aircraft General Knowledge Instruments Mass & Balance Flight Planning and Monitoring Performance Helicopter Human Performance Meteorology General Navigation Radio Navigation Operational Procedures Principles of Flight Helicopters VFR Communications
15 October 2013
Pass Standards
Pass standards for theoretical knowledge examinations can be found in Part-FCL.025, refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part A, paragraph 3.
6.1
Failure to comply with Pass Standards An applicant failing to pass all of the relevant examinations within the time limits will be required to re-enter the examinations as though for an initial attempt. An applicant will be required to complete the minimum approved theoretical knowledge training specied below prior to re-entering the examinations: Integrated or modular IR theory course = minimum 20 hours theoretical knowledge instruction. Integrated or modular CPL theory course = minimum 20 hours theoretical knowledge instruction. Integrated or modular ATPL theory course = minimum 60 hours theoretical instruction. A candidate who received a reduction in the ATPL theoretical instruction hours i.e. where an IR, CPL or CPL/IR was already held, will be required to complete further theoretical knowledge instruction equivalent to a minimum 10% of the original course completed. A candidate who completed ATPL, CPL and/or IR theoretical knowledge instruction at the discretion of an approved training provider i.e. conversion from a non-EASA qualication, will be required to complete further theoretical knowledge instruction at the discretion of an approved training provider. All applications for resits must be countersigned by the authorised signatory of an approved training provider. A candidate who qualies for exemption from approved theoretical knowledge training (i.e. some non-EASA ATPL conversions) is not subject to this requirement.
6.2
Prohibition on re-sitting examinations for which valid passes are held Once a valid pass has been obtained, candidates may not re-sit an examination for any reason, including to attempt to obtain higher marks. Examinations that have been passed may only be retaken when the passes previously achieved are no longer valid.
7 Credits
Details of Part-FCL Theoretical Examination Credits can be found within the appropriate section for the licence being sought.
Validity Period
Potential candidates for the Part-FCL ATPL theoretical knowledge examinations should rst consider the implications of Part-FCL.025 (c)(2) that relates to the validity period. See CAP 804 Section 4, Part A, paragraph 3.
8.1
Failure to comply with Acceptance Period If a CPL and IR are not granted within the 36 month acceptance period then the ATPL theory credit will lapse. Candidates will be required to re-pass all ATPL theoretical knowledge examinations to regain ATPL theory credit. However, where a candidate
15 October 2013
has previously passed all ATPL theoretical knowledge examinations but was not granted a CPL/IR within the 36 month acceptance period, the amount of ATPL theoretical knowledge instruction will be at the discretion of the Approved ATO.
Navigation
10
15 October 2013
11
Examination arrangements
All examination booking application forms for the bridging examinations (including resits), must be countersigned by the authorised signatory of an approved training provider. The Composite bridging examination for ATPL(A)/(H) will be scheduled for 13.00 on Day 2 of the published examination timetable i.e. together with candidates for the Flight Planning and Monitoring examination. The Composite bridging examination for CPL(A) will be scheduled for 10.00 on Day 1 of the published examination timetable i.e. together with candidates for the Aircraft General Knowledge examination. NOTE: In circumstances where an approved bridge instruction course is not available, L&TS will permit candidates to complete theoretical knowledge instruction, at the appropriate level, at the discretion of the Head of Training of an approved training provider. However, candidates should consider carefully that in this circumstance preparation for the Composite bridge examination may be affected, as the training provider may not have the materials (such as practice papers) to prepare the candidate for the examination.
15 October 2013
15 October 2013
Be aware of the 5 minute warning which will be given before the end of the exam. Pencils must be put down immediately when time is called, otherwise disciplinary action will be taken. Answers must be transferred during the examination time. Candidates who choose to record answers on the question paper or elsewhere before copying onto the answer sheet must do so within the time allotted for the examination. No additional time will be allowed for transferring answers onto the answer sheet. Answers recorded anywhere other than the answer sheet will not be taken into account. No extra time will be given after the exam has nished for candidates to write comments or queries. This must be done during the exam. During the exam only general questions may be answered by the invigilator. You will not be given meanings or explanations of words used in the question papers. At the end of the exam please remain seated until all paperwork is collected. If you nish your exam early please raise your hand and remain silent. Remain seated until your paperwork is collected and checked, then you may leave the exam room quietly. Be considerate of others still working. Appendices can be detached and handed in with the exam paperwork. Each separated appendix must have your name on it. The exam room will be locked during lunchtimes and personal items may be left in the room. Personal items left anywhere are your own responsibility. Silence is to be observed in the examination room at all times. If you wish to speak with the Invigilator remain seated and raise your hand.
15 October 2013
Part E
This Part sets out the requirements and guidance for Log annotation. The Part-FCL and Air Navigation Order requirements are listed below so that pilots have the information needed to maintain records that meet both European and national requirements.
General information
Flight crew logs must be kept in accordance with the provisions of Article 79 of the UK ANO as amended and must also conform to Part-FCL (AMC FCL.050 refers). Part-FCL states that ight time shall be recorded in a manner specied by the Authority. 79 (1) Every member of the ight crew of an aircraft registered in the United Kingdom and every person who engages in ying for the purpose of qualifying for the grant or renewal of a ight crew licence under this Order or a ight crew licence issued by the CAA under Part-FCL must keep a personal ying log in which the following information must be recorded: (a) the name and address of the holder of the log; (b) detailed information about the holders licence (if any) to act as a member of the ight crew of an aircraft; and (c) the name and address of the holders employer (if any). (2) Detailed information about each ight during which the holder of the log acted either as a member of the ight crew of an aircraft or for the purpose of qualifying for the grant or renewal of a licence under this Order must be recorded in the log as soon as reasonably practicable after the end of each ight. (3) The information recorded in accordance with paragraph (2) must include: (a) the date, the places at which the holder of the log embarked on and disembarked from the aircraft and the time spent during the course of a ight when the holder was acting in either capacity; (b) the type and registration marks of the aircraft; (c) the capacity in which the holder acted in ight; (d) information about any special conditions under which the ight was conducted, including night ying and instrument ying; and (e) information about any test or examination undertaken by the holder of the log whilst in ight. (4) Information about any test or examination undertaken whilst in a ight simulator must be recorded in the log, including: (a) the date of the test or examination; (b) the type of simulator; (c) the capacity in which the holder acted; and (d) the nature of the test or examination. (5) For the purposes of this article, a helicopter is in ight from the moment the helicopter rst moves under its own power for the purpose of taking off until the rotors are next stopped.
May 2012
2
2.1
Required information
Part-FCL.050 and the ANO require a ight crew member to keep a personal ying log in which at least the following particulars are recorded:
Information Personal details: Name and address of the pilot For each ight: Name of Pilot-in-command; Date of ight; Place and time of departure and arrival; Type, including make, model and variant, and registration of the aircraft; Indication if the aircraft is single-engine or multi-engine; Total time of ight; Accumulated total ight hours. The capacity in which the holder acted in ight; Information about any special conditions under which the ight was conducted, including night ying and instrument ying Information about any test or examination undertaken by the holder of the log whilst in ight. For each ight simulator or FNPT session: Type and qualication number of the training device Synthetic training device instruction Date Total time of session Accumulated total time The capacity in which the holder acted The nature of any test or examination taken Part-FCL Part-FCL Part-FCL / ANO Part-FCL Part-FCL ANO ANO Part-FCL Part-FCL / ANO Part-FCL Part-FCL / ANO Part-FCL Part-FCL / ANO Part-FCL ANO ANO ANO Required By Part-FCL / ANO
2.1.1
Details on pilot function, namely pilot-in-command, including solo, student pilot-incommand and pilot-in-command under supervision time, co-pilot, dual, ight instructor or ight examiner. Operational conditions, namely if the operation takes place at night, or is conducted under instrument ight rules. Pilots applying for a licence or rating are strongly advised to use a log complying with Part-FCL.050 AMC No.1 to facilitate its issue.
2.1.2 2.2
3
3.1
Logging of time
Pilot-in-command ight time a) The holder of a licence may log as pilot-in-command time, all of the ight time during which he is the pilot-in-command.
27 July 2012
b) The applicant for or the holder of a pilot licence may log as pilot-in-command time all solo ight time, ight time as student pilot-in-command and ight time under supervision provided that such SPIC time and ight time under supervision are countersigned by the instructor. Crediting of SPIC is restricted to students of integrated training courses only. c) The holder of an instructor certicate may log as pilot-in-command all ight time during which he/she acts as an instructor in an aircraft. d) The holder of an examiners certicate may log as pilot-in-command all ight time during which he/she occupies a pilots seat and acts as an examiner in an aircraft. e) A co-pilot acting as pilot-in-command under supervision on an aircraft on which more than one pilot is required under the type certication of the aircraft or as required by Part-OPS provided such pilot-in-command time under supervision is countersigned by the pilot-in-command. f) If the holder of a licence carries out a number of ights upon the same day returning on each occasion to the same place of departure and the interval between successive ights does not exceed 30 minutes, such series of ights may be recorded as a single entry. 3.2 Co-pilot ight time The holder of a pilot licence occupying a pilot seat as co-pilot may log all ight time as co-pilot ight time on an aircraft on which more than one pilot is required under the type certication of the aircraft, or the regulations under which the ight is conducted. 3.3 3.4 Cruise relief co-pilot ight time A cruise relief co-pilot may log all ight time as co-pilot when occupying a pilots seat. Instruction time A summary of all time logged by an applicant for a licence or rating as ight instruction, instrument ight instruction, instrument ground time, etc. may be logged if certied by the appropriately rated and/or authorised instructor from whom it was received. 3.5 PICUS (Pilot-in-command under supervision) Provided that the method of supervision is acceptable to the authority, a co-pilot may log as PIC ight time own as PICUS, when all the duties and functions of PIC on that ight were carried out, in such a way that the intervention of the PIC in the interest of safety was not required. A remarks column will be provided to give details of specic functions e.g. SPIC, PICUS, instrument ight time* etc. * Instrument ight time is the time when ying by sole reference to instruments. 3.6 Logging of Flight Hours gained in the USA Some ight hour recording practices allowable in the USA do not comply with European and UK requirements. In particular: 2 pilots ying together in a single pilot aircraft both claiming P1 hours; One pilot accompanying another on newsgathering or trafc control ights and claiming P1/PIC when they have not acted as Captain or signed for the aircraft. Flying hours of this nature cannot be credited towards the requirements for Part-FCL or UK Licences.
May 2012
4
4.1
4.2
May 2012
May 2012
Holders name
May 2012
HOLDERS ADDRESS: ..................................................................... ..................................................................... [space for address change] ..................................................................... ..................................................................... ..................................................................... [space for address change] ..................................................................... ..................................................................... ..................................................................... [space for address change] .....................................................................
.....................................................................
.....................................................................
.....................................................................
.....................................................................
.....................................................................
.....................................................................
.....................................................................
.....................................................................
.....................................................................
TOTAL TIME OF
May 2012
1 AIRCRAFT MAKE, MODEL, REGISTRAVARIANT TION SE ME SINGLEMULTI PILOT PILOT TIME TIME TOTAL TIME OF FLIGHT NAME PIC
DEPARTURE
ARRIVAL
PLACE
TIME
PLACE
TOTAL TIM
May 2012
9 PILOT FUNCTION TIME COPILOT DUAL INSTRUCTOR DATE TYPE (dd/mm/yy) TOTAL TIME OF SESSION SYNTHETIC TRAINING DEVICE SESSION
10
11
NIGHT
IFR
PILOT-IN COMMAND
I certify that the entries in this log are true. ___________________ Pilots signature
TOTAL TIME
May 2012
FCL.050 requires holders of a pilot licence to record details of all ights own. This log enables pilot licence holders to record ying experience in a manner which will facilitate this process while providing a permanent record of the licence holders ying. Pilots who y regularly aeroplanes and helicopters or other aircraft categories are recommended to maintain separate logs for each aircraft category.
Flight crew log entries should be made as soon as practicable after any ight undertaken. All entries in the log should be made in ink or indelible pencil.
The particulars of every ight in the course of which the holder of a ight crew licence acts as a member of the operating crew of an aircraft are to be recorded in the appropriate columns using one line for each ight, provided that if an aircraft carries out a number of ights upon the same day returning on each occasion to the same place of departure and the interval between successive ights does not exceed 30 minutes, such series of ights may be recorded as a single entry.
(i) for aeroplanes, touring motor gliders and powered-lift, from the moment an aircraft rst moves for the purpose of taking off until the moment it nally comes to rest at the end of the ight;
(ii) for helicopters, from the moment a helicopters rotor blades start turning until the moment the helicopter nally comes to rest at the end of the ight, and the rotor blades are stopped;
(iii) for airships, from the moment an airship is released from the mast for the purpose of taking off until the moment the airship nally comes to rest at the end of the ight, and is secured on the mast;
(iv) for sailplanes, the total time from the moment the sailplane commences the ground run in the process of taking off until the moment the sailplane nally comes to a rest at the end of ight;
(v) for balloons, the total time from the moment the basket leaves the ground for the purpose of taking off until the moment it nally comes to a rest at the end of the ight.
When an aircraft carries two or more pilots as members of the operating crew, one of them shall, before the ight commences, be designated by the operator as the aircraft pilot-in-command, in accordance with Part-OPS, who may delegate the conduct of the ight to another suitably qualied pilot. All ying carried out as pilot-in-command is entered in the log as pilot-in-command. A pilot ying as pilot-in-command under supervision or student pilot-in-command enters ying times as pilot-in-command but all such are certied by the pilot-in-command or ight instructor in the Remarks column of the log.
May 2012
Notes on recording of ight time: Column 1: enter date (dd/mm/yy) on which the ight commences. Column 2/3: enter place of departure and destination either in full or the internationally recognised three or four letter designator. All times should be UTC. Column 5: indicate whether the operation was single or multi-pilot, and for single-pilot operation whether single or multi-engine.
Example:
4 AIRCRAFT MAKE, MODEL, REGISTRAVARIANT TION SE ME SINGLEMULTI PILOT PILOT TIME TIME TOTAL TIME OF FLIGHT 5 6 7 NAME PIC 8 LANDINGS DAY NIGHT
DEPARTURE
ARRIVAL
PLACE
TIME
PLACE
LFAC
1025
EGBJ
1240
PA-34-250
G-SENE
2 1
15 20
SELF SELF
1 2
15/11/11
EGBJ
1810
EGBJ
22/11/11
LGW
1645
LAX
0225
B747-400
G-ABCD
40
40
SPEAKIN
Column 6: total time of ight may be entered in hours and minutes or decimal notation as desired.
Column 9: enter ight time undertaken at night or under instrument ight rules if applicable.
Column 10: Pilot function time: enter ight time as pilot-in-command (PIC), student pilot-in-command (SPIC) and pilot-in-command under supervision (PICUS) as PIC, all time recorded as SPIC or PICUS is countersigned by the aircraft pilot-in-command/ight instructor in the Remarks (column 12), instructor time should be recorded as appropriate and also entered as PIC.
May 2012
Column 11: Flight Simulator (FS) or Flight Navigation Procedures Trainer (FNPT): for FS enter type of aircraft and qualication number of the device. For other ight training devices enter either FNPT I or FNPT II as appropriate.
Total time of session includes all exercises carried out in the device, including pre- and after-ight checks.
Enter type of exercise performed in the Remarks (column 12), e.g. operator prociency check, revalidation. Column 12: the Remarks column may be used to record details of the ight at the holders discretion. The following entries,however, should always be made: instrument ight time undertaken as part of the training for a licence or rating, details of all skill tests and prociency checks, signature of PIC if the pilot is recording ight time as SPIC or PICUS, signature of instructor if ight is part of a single-engine piston or touring motor glider class rating revalidation.
When each page is completed, accumulated ight time/hours should be entered in the appropriate columns and certied by the pilot in the Remarks column.
Example:
10 PILOT FUNCTION TIME COPILOT DUAL INSTRUCTOR DATE (dd/mm/yy) 11 SYNTHETIC TRAINING DEVICES SESSION TYPE TOTAL TIME OF SESSION 12
NIGHT
IFR
PILOT-IN COMMAND
2 1 20
15
15 Night rating training (A L Pilot) 20/11/11 B747-400 (Q1234) 4 10 Revalidation Prof Check PIC(US) C Speaking
20
20
10
40
40
5
5.1 5.2
6
6.1
7
7.1
8
8.1
8.2
STD time is creditable towards courses and licence issue but is not ight time and must not be recorded as such. STD time must be logged separately from ight time recorded in the log.
May 2012
9
Case
1 A B
2 Pilot-in-Command
5 Enter time in P1 column. Enter time in P1 column. Counted in full toward licence experience requirements subject to certication by the pilot-in-command. Enter time in Second pilot or in Co-pilot (P2) column. As for C Enter time in the F Eng,
Co-pilot performing the duties of N/A PIC under supervision of pilot-in-command (see Notes)
Co-pilot (see Notes) Co-pilot whilst holding PPL Pilot acting as: (i) Systems Panel Operator (SPO) in aircraft certicated for optional operation by three pilot crew; (ii) Flight Engineer in aircraft certicated for optional or mandatory operation by two pilots + FE crew.
N/A
P2
D E
N/A. N/A
P2 SPO
E1
Any other ying or spare column and annotate SPO or F Eng as appropriate. Enter time in the F/Nav,
Pilot on ight deck but not as P1, P2, SPO or FE: (i) Acting as required Flight F/N licence Navigator (under the Air Navigation Order); (ii) Pilot supervising Co-pilot N/A activities; N/A (iii) No duties assigned (Supernumerary); Pilot under instruction for the purpose of gaining a licence or rating, or for conversion to an aircraft type within an aircraft rating group or class. N/A
N1
P2 SNY P/UT
Any other ying or spare column and annotate N1. Enter as for case C. Enter time in Any other ying or spare column and annotate SNY. Enter time in Dual column.
Student Pilot-in-Command. N/A (Pilot acting as pilot-in-command during an approved integrated course of training, under the supervision of a ight instructor. The ight instructor shall only observe the student acting as pilot-in-command and shall not control the ight of the aircraft). (see Notes)
SPIC
Enter time in P1 column. SPIC may be recorded only by students of Integrated training courses during such a course.
May 2012
Pilot undergoing any form of N/A ight test with a EASA or CAA Authorised Examiner (other than case K.
PICUS for successful Test P/UT for unsuccessful test (including partial pass) P2 PIC or P1.
Enter time in P1 column and have it certied by aircraft commander. Enter time in Dual column As for case C. Enter time in P1 column
K L
Pilot undergoing a ight test in the capacity of co-pilot. Student pilot ying as the sole occupant of an aircraft during training for the grant of a PPL or CPL. Student pilot ying as pilot-incommand during training for a CPL Pilot acting as Safety Pilot (i) Pilot undergoing Flight Instructor Course training as pilot-in-command accompanied by: (ii) Pilot acting as student for instructional purposes.
N/A N/A
N/A
PIC or P1
As for case L.
N P
N/A N/A
SNY PIC or P1
As for case F(iii). Roles in column 2 are interchangeable between pilots. Time spent as P1 to be entered as case L. Time spent as student to be entered and count as case F(iii). See Notes on heavy crew below
N/A
SNY
N/A
NOTES: The terms Pilot-in-Command, Co-pilot, Flight Crew and Crew shall have the interpretation given them by Article 255 (1) of the Air Navigation Order and Part-FCL. 1 Whenever two members of ight crew acting in the same capacity share a particular operating duty, each performing such duty for particular periods only and neither acting under the supervision of the other, only the time during which the duty was performed is to be recorded in the appropriate column of the personal ying log. A pilot claiming time spent as co-pilot performing the duties and functions of pilot-incommand, under the supervision of the pilot-in-command, toward meeting the licence requirements as given in Case B, will be credited with that ight time only if: a) i) the ight was conducted in an aircraft dened in the Flight Manual and aircraft airworthiness certication documents that the minimum crew is two pilots; or ii) it is being own under an Air Operators Certicate or equivalent document that requires that it be operated with a co-pilot. b) he was responsible for checking the accuracy of the ight plan, load sheet and fuel calculations for the ight; c) he ensured that all crew checks were carried out in accordance with the laid down operation procedures; d) throughout the ight he carried out all the duties and functions of pilot-in-command and conducted the take-off and the landing; e) he resolved all meteorological, communication and air trafc control problems; f) the pilot-in-command did not have to overrule any course of action proposed or taken by the co-pilot;
May 2012
g) the pilot-in-command certies in the co-pilots ying log against the entry for that ight that it was carried out by the co-pilot acting as pilot-in-command under supervision. Such certication will be taken as conrming that all the foregoing conditions were met. 3 A pilot claiming ying hours as co-pilot towards meeting the overall ying experience requirements for a licence, as provided for in cases C,D, F(ii) or K, will only be credited with that ight time if holding an appropriate licence to perform co-pilot duties, and if: a) the ight was conducted in an aircraft required by its Certicate of Airworthiness, or by Article 25 (3) of the Air Navigation Order 2009, to carry a crew of not less than two pilots; or b) the ight was conducted by an AOC holder choosing to operate a particular aircraft as a two pilot operation and provided that the specic duties that the second pilot was required to perform on all ights in respect of the operation of the aircraft were contained in the Operations Manual relating to the aircraft; or c) it was conducted in a military aircraft normally own by more than one pilot; or d) exceptionally in Cases C and D, and subject to prior agreement with the CAA, it was conducted in an aircraft not required to carry two pilots but which was tted with full dual controls for that ight, and the pilot-in-command certies in the co-pilots log that the ight was conducted as a genuine two pilot operation. Flight time as PICUS, apart from as specically provided for under Case J above, will only be allowable for the holder of a PPL subject to the terms of a prior agreement with the CAA.
10
Heavy Crew
When an aircraft crew consists of more than the required number of pilots (i.e. a heavy crew) the rules for logging of ight time are as per Part-FCL.050, but for clarication the following should apply:
10.1
Pilot in Command The designated commander of the aeroplane may log as pilot in command all the ight time. This includes rest taken on board.
10.2
Co-Pilot The designated co-pilot of the aeroplane may log as co-pilot all the time he acts as co-pilot whilst sitting in a pilots seat. He may log as PICUS all the time he occupies a pilots seat and acts as pilot-incommand under the supervision of the pilot in command or a cruise relief pilot substituting for the pilot in command. He may also log as pilot in command all the time he is acting as pilot in command and substituting for the designated commander of the aircraft when he is taking rest. He may not log as ight time any periods during which he does not occupy a pilots seat.
10.3
Cruise Relief Pilot A cruise relief pilot may log as pilot in command all the time he occupies a pilots seat as relief for the designated commander. He may log as co-pilot all the time he occupies a pilots seat as relief for the co-pilot.
May 2012
He may log as PICUS all the time he occupies a pilots seat and acts as pilot in command under the supervision of the designated commander or his relief. 10.4 Student Pilot-in-Command A student on a CPL(A)/IR, CPL(H) or ATPL(A)/(H) Integrated Course of ying training may log ight time on instrument training ights as SPIC when ying with an instructor qualied to give instrument ight instruction. The instructor must be the holder of a valid professional licence, instructor rating, instrument rating and IRI privileges. SPIC time shall be credited as pilot-in-command time, unless the ight instructor had reason to control any part of the ight. A ground de-brieng by the ight instructor does not affect the crediting as pilot-in-command. 10.5 Mutual Flying on a Flight Instructor Course 10.5.1 During the course of training for an Fl rating, AMC Part-FCL.930 Part 2, (h) makes provision for two student instructors to y together to practice ight demonstrations, known as mutual ying. 10.5.2 If this cannot be scheduled the mutual ying part of the course may only be undertaken with another FI. AMC Part-FCL.930 Part 2, (h) states that During training, except when acting as a student pilot for mutual ights, the student instructor shall occupy the seat normally occupied by the FI. 10.5.3 Therefore, only the student instructor acting as the FI and occupying the instructors seat may claim the mutual ight time towards the course requirements. The student instructor acting as a student pilot and occupying the student pilots seat is not entitled to claim any ight time for this exercise.
May 2012
Part F
1
Skill Tests
Where applicants for a Part-FCL or UK National Licence or a rating to be included in a licence are required to pass a Flying Skill Test, this shall be with an appropriately qualied Flight Examiner. With the exception of skill test for Microlight privileges, examiners shall not test applicants to whom they have given ight instruction for the qualication applied for. Applicants wishing to undergo a Flight Skill Test for the purpose of issue, renewal or revalidation of a Part-FCL licence shall meet all the requirements for the appropriate licence as set out in Section 4. Details of the Skill Test requirements can be found in Section 4 for each Part-FCL licence issued by the CAA. Applicants wishing to undergo a Flight Skill Test for the purpose of issue, renewal or revalidation of a UK non EASA Licence shall meet the requirements as set out in Section 5 for the relevant National Licence issued by the CAA. An applicant for a Part-FCL licence may not take the Skill Test until all of the associated theoretical knowledge examinations have been passed. An applicant for a Part-FCL licence may not take the Skill Test until all required ying training has beencompleted. All Sections of the Skill test shall be completed within 6 months. The is no limit to the number of Skill Tests that may be attempted, however failure to pass all sections in 2 attempts will require further training.
4 5 6 7
Further details on the content of training, skill test/prociency check, conduct of test/check, specic requirements, pass marks. Flight test tolerances, cross crediting for IR and sample test form layouts can be found in Section 4, Part L, Appendices 7, 8 and 9 to Part-FCL as applicable.
27 July 2012
Part G
General information
There is always a need to update information provided to those persons involved in aviation. There are various publications provided by the CAA. Most of these provide information that will remain current until there is a change in the legislation. However, there are many occasions when the CAA has a need to provide information quickly to licence holders and other, or to notify information that is only valid for a limited period of time. The following are the main ways such information will be provided.
2
2.1 2.2
3 Scope
3.1 This Part G describes the current style of CAA communications to individuals and organisations that regularly receive communications from the CAA.
4
4.1
May 2012
4.2
Safety Directive A Safety Directive will be issued in circumstances where the action required is mandatory by means of the Directive and is legally enforceable. The Directive will specify which law or regulation makes the Directive legally enforceable, the action required, by whom and the time limit for compliance. The Safety Directive will be identied by a red circle in the top left hand corner. This symbol is in RED
4.3
Safety Notices A Safety Notice will be issued in circumstances where the information conveyed is highlighting safety concerns which are already addressed by established requirements and regulations. The Safety Notice will be identied by a yellow triangle in the top left hand corner. This symbol is in YELLOW
4.4
Information Notice An Information Notice will be issued when the information does not convey any specic safety issues and does not require any action other than to note and promulgate the content. Information Notices will be identied by a blue rectangle in the top left hand corner.
4.5
The communications listed below were discontinued from 1 January 2011, and when they are amended or replaced, the information published via those documents previously will be published in the current format of communications as described above: AIRCOMs (Airworthiness Communication) ATSINs (Air Trafc Services Information Notice) CAA EASA Information Bulletin Heli TrainingCom (Helicopter Training Communication) NOTALs (Notice to Aerodrome Licence Holders) NOTEX (Notice to Examiners)
May 2012
Flight Crew Training Notices FODCOMs (Flight Operations Communication) Info Alerts
Any existing documents will remain available on the CAA website until they are cancelled or superseded. 4.6 Airworthiness Directives and Mandatory Permit Directives retain their existing formats and numbering systems. The only change is the addition of the Safety Directive red disc, denoting that Airworthiness Directives and Mandatory Permit Directives fall within the family of safety critical information. CAA Civil Aviation Publications (CAPs) are not affected by this change and continue to be published on the CAA website (www.caa.co.uk/publications) and via the CAAs printers The Stationery Ofce (TSO). Other regular newsletters (such as GASIL) also continue to be published in their existing formats. International standard methods of communication such as Aeronautical Information Circulars (AICs) and Notice to Airmen (NOTAMs) have not been affected by this change.
4.7
4.8
5
5.1
Reference Numbers
The CAA is using a sequential numbering system for all applicable communications; for example, a Safety Notice will be pre-xed with an SN, followed by the year and a number (e.g. SN-2010/001). It should be noted that using certain search terms on the CAA publications search engine may result in a non-sequential list and therefore it may appear that some Notices are missing. Similarly, when viewing all Notices applicable to a subscription category, the document numbers may not always follow a sequential pattern. A search for all Safety Notices, Safety Directives or Information Notices will provide a complete list of all Notices. Airworthiness Directives and Mandatory Permit Directives are an exception to this numbering system. As these Directives pre-exist these changes, they will retain their existing numbering system.
5.2
6
6.1
6.2
May 2012
6.3
Subscribers wishing to receive notication of publication of Safety Directives, Safety Notices and Information Notices which are only applicable to their current subscription categories (e.g. Flight Operations, Aerodromes etc.) are not required to update their subscription as applicable communications continue to be sent. NATMAC Informatives will initially continue to be distributed by e-mail; however, during the rst half of 2011 the Directorate of Airspace Policy (DAP) will be making these notications available on the CAA website and through the Publications Subscription Notication e-mail. To unsubscribe go to www.caa.co.uk/subscription, log in as normal and at the bottom of the page there is a button to unsubscribe.
6.4
6.5
7
7.1 7.2
Accessing Documents
Each Safety Directive, Safety Notice and Information Notice can be accessed by clicking on the link in the notication e-mail, which will link directly to the document summary. Furthermore, each subscription category will contain applicable Safety Directives, Safety Notices and Information Notices listed alongside other documents such as CAPs. Complete lists of Safety Directives, Safety Notices and Information Notices can be accessed via the Safety Critical Information, Safety Notices and Information Notices publication categories respectively.
7.3
8 Queries
8.1 8.2 Further information on the introduction of the new formats can be found on the CAA website at www.caa.co.uk/publications. Any queries or further guidance required as a result of this communication should be addressed to: Telephone: +44 (0)1293 573781. E-mail: infoservices@caa.co.uk.
9
9.1
CAA Subscriptions
This is a free service designed to provide E-mail news and alerts to subscribers of our Publications www.caa.co.uk/subscriptions Publications have been divided into Categories according to subject matter. E-mail Newsletters are periodic E-mails sourcing items from our News Feeds.
9.2
Please sign up for our Publications and Newsletters that you wish to be informed about. If you would prefer more immediate alerts of new or amended content, then we recommend that you use our RSS Newsfeed Service.
May 2012
10
10.1
10.2
10.3
They can be accessed by all from the Aeronautical Information Service page of the NATS web site: www.nats-uk.ead-it.com.
27 July 2012
Part H
1
General information
Annex III to Commission Regulation (EU) No 965/2012 (Part-ORO) of the EASA Operations Regulation sets out additional requirements that must be met by Flight Crew intending to exercise the privileges of their licence when conducting commercial and non commercial operations on behalf of an Air Operator Certicate (AOC) holder. It is the responsibility of the AOC holder to ensure the additional training requirements of Part-ORO are met by any Flight Crew intending to y under the AOC approval. Further information on these additional requirements is set out in Section 4, Part S of this CAP 804. Part-FCL requires that certain elements of training required to gain or maintain an EASA licence, rating or certicate must be conducted at an Approved Training Organisation (ATO) that is approved in accordance with Part-ORA. AOC holders intending to conduct such training must be approved as an ATO. Further information on ATO requirements is set out in Section 4, Part R of this CAP 804.
30 January 2013
Categories of Aircraft: The Category of Aircraft means the categorisation of aircraft according to specied basic characteristics, i.e. Aeroplane, Helicopter, Airship, Balloon, Sailplane and Powered Sailplane.
European Licences
There are two levels of licence available: Non-commercial and Commercial. Within these two levels there are a variety of licences available with various privileges associated with each licence. Non-commercial Licences: 1 The Light Aircraft Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes (LAPL(A)), Helicopters (LAPL(H)), Sailplanes (LAPL(S)) or Balloons (LAPL(B)). 2 The Private Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes (PPL(A)), Helicopters (PPL(H)) or Airships (PPL(As)) Commercial licences: 3 The Sailplane Pilot Licence (SPL) (restricted to non-commercial use only until experience requirements have been met. Refer to Section 4, Part C) 4 The Balloon Pilot Licence (BPL) (restricted to non-commercial use only until experience requirements have been met. Refer to Section 4, Part C) 5 The Commercial Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes (CPL(A)), Helicopters (CPL(H)) or Airships (CPL(As)) 6 The Airline Transport Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes (ATPL(A)), Helicopters (ATPL(H)) 7 The Multi-Crew Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes (MPL)
May 2012
Aeroplane
Helicopter
Airship
Balloon
Sailplane
A non-ICAO licence which permits the holder to y for leisure within Europe only, restricted to single engine piston aeroplanes and touring motor gliders below 2,000kg MTOM and maximum of 3 passengers, no remuneration permitted An ICAO licence which is for noncommercial use, no remuneration permitted, (however an instructor may receive remuneration for training others)
A non-ICAO licence which permits the holder to y for leisure within Europe only, restricted to below 2,000kg MTOM and maximum of 3 passengers, no remuneration permitted
Not Available
A non-ICAO licence which permits the holder to y for leisure within Europe only, no remuneration permitted
A non-ICAO licence which permits the holder to y for leisure within Europe only, no remuneration permitted
PPL
An ICAO licence which is for noncommercial use, no remuneration permitted (however an instructor may receive remuneration for training others)
An ICAO licence which is for noncommercial use, no remuneration permitted, (however an instructor may receive remuneration for training others)
Not Available
Not Available
Commercial BPL Not Available Not Available Not Available An ICAO licence which is for commercial use, but no remuneration is permitted until the holder meets the requirements of FCL.205.B Not Available
27 July 2012
Sailplane An ICAO licence which is for commercial use, but no remuneration permitted until the holder meets the requirements of FCL.205.S Not Available
CPL
An ICAO licence which is for commercial use in aeroplanes requiring single crew only or to act in a noncommand role in multicrew aeroplanes An ICAO licence which is for commercial use to act in a noncommand role in multicrew aeroplanes An ICAO licence which is for commercial use to act in a command role in multicrew aeroplanes
An ICAO licence which is for commercial use in helicopters requiring single crew only or to act in a noncommand role in multicrew helicopters Not Available
An ICAO licence which is for commercial use in airships requiring single crew only or to act in a noncommand role in multicrew airships Not Available
Not Available
MPL
Not Available
Not Available
ATPL
An ICAO licence which is for commercial use to act in a command role in multicrew helicopters
Not Available
Not Available
Not Available
May 2012
1.1 1.1.1
Training for Part-FCL Non-commercial Licences: The Light Aircraft Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes (LAPL(A)) Helicopters (LAPL(H)) Sailplanes (LAPL(S)) or Balloons (LAPL(B)) An LAPL is obtained through completing an approved LAPL course with an Approved Training Organisation (ATO) approved by the Authority, that is a minimum of: 30 hours ying for the LAPL(A); 40 hours ying for the LAPL(H); 15 hours ying for the LAPL(S); or 16 hours ying for the LAPL(B). The privileges of this licence allow you to y privately (not for remuneration or for any commercial purpose). (Please refer to Section 4, Part B, for full LAPL details).
1.1.2
The Private Pilot Licence (Aeroplane, Helicopter or Airships) A PPL is obtained through completing an approved PPL course with an Approved Training Organisation (ATO) approved by the Authority, comprising a minimum of: 45 hours ying for a PPL(A); 45 hours ying for a PPL(H); or 35 hours of ying for a PPL(As). The privileges of this licence allow you to y privately (not for remuneration or for any commercial operation), except that a PPL holder who holds a valid ight instructor (FI) or Flight Examiner (FE) rating may be paid to give instruction in ying or conduct skill tests, as applicable. (Please refer to Section 4, Part C, for full PPL details).
1.2
Training for Part-FCL Commercial Pilot Licences: To be employed as a pilot (other than as an instructor for non-commercial licences) you will need a commercial licence, i.e. CPL, ATPL or MPL in the appropriate aircraft category, or an SPL for Sailplanes or BPL for Balloons;
1.2.1
The Sailplane Pilot Licence (SPL) An SPL is obtained through completing an approved SPL course with an Approved Training Organisation (ATO) approved by the Authority, comprising a minimum of 15 hours ying. The privileges of this licence allows you to y commercially for remuneration, except that the licence is limited to non-commercial operations until the holder has met the requirements of FCL.205.S(b)(2). (Please refer to Section 4, Part C, for full SPL Licence details).
1.2.2
The Balloon Pilot Licence (BPL) A BPL is obtained through completing an approved BPL course with an Approved Training Organisation (ATO) approved by the Authority, comprising a minimum of 16 hours ight instruction. The privileges of this licence allows you to y commercially, except that the licence is limited to non-commercial operations until the holder has met the requirements of FCL.205.B(b)(2). (Please refer to Section 4, Part C, for full BPL Licence details).
May 2012
1.2.3
Course Routes for Aeroplane, Helicopter and Airship Commercial Licences The commercial licences for aeroplanes, helicopters and airships can be obtained via two routes: the integrated course route the modular route
1.2.3.1 Integrated Courses (Aeroplane, Helicopter and Airships) The Integrated Course is a full time course of ground and ying training run by an ATO approved to conduct such courses. These fully residential courses offer the quickest means of qualifying for a Commercial Pilots Licence. You should contact the approved ATOs for details of their current charges. The Integrated Courses permitted by the regulations are: a) Aeroplane: Multi Pilot Licence (Aeroplane) Integrated course The aim of the MPL integrated course is to train pilots to the level of prociency necessary to enable them to operate as co-pilot of a multi-engine multi-pilot turbinepowered air transport aeroplane under VFR and IFR and to obtain an MPL. The course consists of a minimum of 240 hours of ying training and 750 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction. The course also includes training in multi-crew co-operation for the operation of multi-pilot aeroplanes. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 5 for full course details). Airline Transport Pilot (Aeroplane) Integrated Course The aim of the ATP(A) integrated course is to train pilots to the level of prociency necessary to enable them to operate as co-pilot on multi-pilot multi-engine aeroplanes in commercial air transport and to obtain the CPL(A)/IR. The course consists of a minimum of 195 hours of ying training and 750 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction. The course also includes training in multi-crew co-operation for the operation of multi-pilot aeroplanes. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3 for full course details). Commercial Pilot Licence (Aeroplane) with Instrument Rating Integrated Course The aim of the CPL(A) and IR(A) integrated course is to train pilots to the level of prociency necessary to operate single-pilot single-engine or multi-engine aeroplanes in commercial air transport and to obtain the CPL(A)/IR. This course consists of a minimum of 180 hours of ying training and 500 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3 for full course details). Commercial Pilot Licence (Aeroplane) Integrated Course The aim of the CPL(A) integrated course is to train pilots to the level of prociency necessary for the issue of a CPL(A), excluding instrument rating instruction. This course consists of a minimum of 150 hours of ying training and 350 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3 for full course details).
May 2012
b) Helicopter: Airline Transport Pilot (Helicopter) with Instrument Rating Integrated Course The aim of the ATP(H)/IR integrated course is to train pilots to the level of prociency necessary to enable them to operate as co-pilot on multi-pilot multi-engine helicopters in commercial air transport and to obtain the CPL(H)/IR. The course consists of a minimum of 195 hours of ying training and 750 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction. The course also includes training in multi-crew co-operation for the operation of multi-pilot helicopters. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3 for full course details). Airline Transport Pilot (Helicopter) Integrated Course The aim of the ATP(H) integrated course is to train pilots to the level of prociency necessary to enable them to operate as co-pilot on multi-pilot multi-engine helicopters limited to VFR privileges in commercial air transport and to obtain the CPL(H). The course consists of a minimum of 150 hours of ying training and 650 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction. The course also includes training in multi-crew co-operation for the operation of multi-pilot helicopters. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3 for full course details). Commercial Pilot Licence (Helicopter) with Instrument Rating Integrated Course The aim of the CPL(H)/IR integrated course is to train pilots to the level of prociency necessary to operate single-pilot multi-engine helicopters and to obtain the CPL(H)/ IR multiengine helicopter. The course consists of a minimum of 180 hours of ying training and 500 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3 for full course details). Commercial Pilot Licence (Helicopter) Integrated Course The aim of the CPL(H) integrated course is to train pilots to the level of prociency necessary for the issue of a CPL(H). The course consists of a minimum of 135 hours of ying training and 350 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction or 200 hours if the applicant is the holder of a PPL(H). (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3 for full course details). c) Airships: Commercial Pilot Licence (Airships) with Instrument Rating Integrated Course The aim of the CPL(As)/IR integrated course is to train pilots to the level of prociency necessary to operate airships and to obtain the CPL(As)/IR. The course consists of a minimum of 80 hours of ying training and 500 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3 for full course details).
May 2012
Commercial Pilot Licence (Airships) Integrated Course The aim of the CPL(As) integrated course is to train pilots to the level of prociency necessary for the issue of a CPL(As). The course consists of a minimum of 50 hours of ying training and 350 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction or 200 hours if the applicant is a PPL holder.. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3 for full course details). 1.2.3.2 Modular Courses (Aeroplane, Helicopter and Airships) The modular courses are designed for individuals who do not wish to undertake a full time course of integrated training or who wish to train in stages by completing modules of approved training over a period of time. Pilots embarking on modular training must hold a valid Private Pilot Licence for the category of aircraft. The Modular Courses available are: a) Aeroplane: Commercial Pilot Licence (Aeroplane) Modular Course The aim of the CPL(A) modular course is to train PPL(A) holders to the level of prociency necessary for the issue of a CPL(A) but not the instrument rating or any further specialisation. Before commencing a CPL(A) modular course an applicant shall be the holder of a PPL(A) issued in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention. Before commencing the ight training the applicant shall have completed 150 hours ight time and have complied with the prerequisites for the issue of a class or type rating for multi-engine aeroplanes in accordance with Section 4, Part H, if a multi-engine aeroplane is to be used on the skill test. The course consists of a minimum of 25 hours of ying training (30 hours for applicants without a night ying qualication (aeroplane)) and 250 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction. The ying training may be reduced by 10 hours for holders of valid Instrument Ratings or of a Course Completion Certicate for the Basic Instrument Flight Module. The applicant for a CPL(A) shall have completed at least 200 hours ight time. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3 for full course details). Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) Modular Course The aim of the IR(A) modular ying training course is to train pilots to the level of prociency necessary to operate aeroplanes under IFR and in IMC. Holders of a PPL(A) or CPL(A) issued in accordance with Part-FCL and with the privilege to y at night, may commence ight training on an approved Part-FCL IR modular course. The course shall comprise of at least 50 hours instrument ying for Single-Engine IR(A)or at least 55 hours instrument ying for Multi-Engine IR(A) and at least 150 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction. The holder of a CPL(A) or of a Course Completion Certicate for the Basic Instrument Flight Module may have the total amount of training required reduced by 10 hours. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 6 for full course details).
27 July 2012
b) Helicopter: Commercial Pilot Licence (Helicopter) Modular Course The aim of the CPL(H) modular course is to train PPL(H) holders to the level of prociency necessary for the issue of a CPL(H) but not the instrument rating or any further specialisation. Before commencing a CPL(H) modular course an applicant shall be the holder of a PPL(H) issued in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention. Before commencing the ight training the applicant shall have completed 155 hours ight time as a pilot in helicopters, including 50 hours as PIC of which 10 hours shall be cross-country and have complied with FCL.725 and FCL.720.H if a multi-engine helicopter is to be used on the skill test. The course consists of a minimum of 30 hours of ying training (35 hours for applicants without a night ying qualication (helicopter)) and 250 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction. The ying training may be reduced by 10 hours for holders of valid Instrument Ratings. The applicant for a CPL(H) shall have completed at least 185 hours ight time. Hours as pilot-in-command of other categories of aircraft may count towards the 185 hours ight time. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3 for full course details). Instrument Rating (Helicopter) Modular Course The aim of the IR(H) modular ying training course is to train pilots to the level of prociency necessary to operate helicopters under IFR and in IMC. Holders of a PPL(H) or CPL(H) issued in accordance with Part-FCL and with the privilege to y at night, may commence ight training on an approved Part-FCL IR modular course. The course shall comprise of at least 50 hours instrument ying for Single-Engine IR(H)or 55 hours instrument ying for Multi-Engine IR(H) and at least 150 hours of instruction. The holder of a CPL(H) or a PPL(H) with a Night Rating may have the total amount of training required reduced by 5 hours. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 6 for full course details). c) Airships: Commercial Pilot Licence (Airships) Modular Course The aim of the CPL(As) modular course is to train PPL(As) holders to the level of prociency necessary for the issue of a CPL(As). Before commencing a CPL(As) modular course an applicant shall hold a PPL(As) issued in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention and have completed 200 hours ight time as a pilot on airships, including 100 hours as PIC, of which 50 hours shall be cross-country. The course consists of a minimum of 20 hours of ying training (25 hours forapplicants without a night ying qualication (Airships)) and 250 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction. The ying training may be reduced by 10 hours for holders of valid Instrument Ratings.
May 2012
The applicant for a CPL(As) shall have completed at least 250 hours ight time in airships, including 125 hours as PIC, of which 50 hours of cross-country ight as PIC. Hours as PIC of other categories of aircraft may count towards the 185 hours ight time. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3 for full course details). Instrument Rating (Airships) Modular Course The aim of the IR(As) modular ying training course is to train pilots to the level of prociency necessary to operate airships under IFR and in IMC. Holders of a PPL(A) or CPL(A) issued in accordance with Part-FCL and with the privilege to y at night, may commence ight training on an approved Part-FCL IR modular course. The course shall comprise of at least 35 hours instrument ying instruction and at least 150 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction.. The holder of a CPL(As) or of a Course Completion Certicate for the Basic Instrument Flight Module may have the total amount of training required reduced by 10 hours. (Please refer to Section 4, Part L, Appendix 6 for full course details).
UK National Licences
There are two levels of licence available: Non-commercial and Commercial. Within these two levels there are a variety of licences available with specic privileges. A UK National Licence is for Annex II (non-EASA) aircraft only. Non-commercial Licences: 1 The UK National Private Pilot Licence (Aeroplanes) for Simple Single Engine Aeroplanes and/or Self-Launching Motor Gliders (NPPL(SSEA or SLMG)). 2 The UK National Private Pilot Licence for Microlight Aeroplanes (NPPL (Microlight)). 3 The UK National Private Pilot Licence for Helicopters (NPPL(H)) 4 The UK Private Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes UK PPL(A), Helicopters (UK PPL(H)), Gyroplanes (PPL(Gyroplane), Balloons and Airships (UK PPL(BA)). Please refer to Section 5, Parts A and B, for details of training requirements. Commercial Licences: 1 The UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes (UK CPL(A)), Helicopters (UK CPL(H)) Balloons (UK CPL(B)) Glider (CPL(G)) or Airships (UK CPL(As)). 2 The UK Airline Transport Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes (UK ATPL(A)) or Helicopters (UK ATPL(H)). Please refer to Section 5, Parts C and D, for details of training requirements.
May 2012
Aeroplane
Helicopter
Airship
Balloon
Sailplane
Gyroplane
UK PPL
A non-ICAO licence which permits the holder to y for leisure within the UK only, within the terms of the SSEA, SLMG, or Microlight rating as applicable. No remuneration permitted (however, an instructor may receive remuneration for training others) An ICAO licence which is for noncommercial use, no remuneration permitted, (however an instructor may receive remuneration for training others) An ICAO licence which is for commercial use in aeroplanes requiring single crew only or to act in a noncommand role in multi-crew aeroplanes An ICAO licence which is for commercial use to act in a command role in multi-crew aeroplanes
A non-ICAO Not licence which Available permits the holder to y for leisure within the UK only, restricted to below 2,000kg MTOM and maximum of 3 passengers, no remuneration permitted
Not Available
Not Available
Not Available
An ICAO licence which is for noncommercial use, no remuneration permitted (however an instructor may receive remuneration for training others) An ICAO licence which is for commercial use in helicopters requiring single crew only or to act in a noncommand role in multi-crew helicopters
An ICAO licence which is Not for non-commercial use, Available no remuneration permitted, (however an instructor may receive remuneration for training others)
A non-ICAO licence which is for noncommercial use, no remuneration permitted, (however an instructor may receive remuneration for training others)
Commercial UK CPL An ICAO licence which is for commercial use in single pilot airships An ICAO licence which is for commercial use in balloons An ICAO Not Available licence which is for commercial use in gliders
UK ATPL
An ICAO Not licence which Available is for commercial use to act in a command role in multi-crew helicopters
Not Available
Not Available
Not Available
27 July 2012
3
3.1
3.2
How can I nd a ight training school? Flight training schools are ofcially referred to as Approved Training Organisations (ATOs). All UK ATOs must be approved by the UK Civil Aviation Authority (CAA). ATOs based in other European Union countries are approved by the National Aviation Authority (NAA) of the country in which they are based. ATOs based outside of the European Union that provide training in accordance with the requirements of the European Aviation Safety Agency (EASA) are approved directly by EASA. A list of the ATOs approved by the CAA that provide training for commercial pilots is published by the CAA on its website in a document called Standards Document 31. Available at www.caa.co.uk/standardsdocument31. It is advisable to arrange a visit to the ATO before committing to a training course.
3.3
What does a CAA or an EASA approval mean? The approval of an Approved Training Organisation by the CAA, or other European National Aviation Authority, means it complies with all safety requirements, and is able to provide training to an agreed standard. The CAA is not required, nor is able, to carry out an assessment of the nancial health and stability of the ATO. It is important to note, therefore, that CAA approval does not mean the ATO has demonstrated its ability to operate on a sound nancial footing. For this reason the CAA advises all prospective student pilots to take precautions to protect their nancial investment.
3.4
How can I ensure that I protect my nancial investment? There are a number of ways in which student pilots can protect their investment against the failure of an ATO.
3.4.1
Payment by credit card Paying by credit card may offer some protection against the risk of an ATO failing to provide what it has promised. Your credit card provider will usually be jointly responsible with a service provider for anything you buy that costs between 100 and 30,000, including VAT. You dont need to have paid the total cost by credit card. For example, you may have paid the deposit with a credit card and the balance by a different method. However, paying for your training solely by credit card might well result in the upper limit of protection being exceeded by the total cost of training. You should think carefully before making any advance payments above the protected level of 30,000 despite the discounts that may be on offer for larger advance payments. Guidance should be sought from your credit card provider as to the level of protection offered in your credit card contract.
30 January 2013
3.4.2
Payment by credit agreement If you entered into a credit agreement to pay for training with your ATO on, or after, 1 February 2011, you may also be able to make a claim against your credit provider if the ATO fails to deliver the service. A credit agreement which has this type of protection is one where a lender loans money to a consumer to buy a specic product or service. This protection is subject to a higher upper limit than paying by credit card. Further advice about your legal rights when buying on credit is available from the UK Citizens Advice Bureau at www.adviceguide.org.uk/england/consumer_e/consumer_ different_ways_of_buying_e/consumer_buying_goods_and_services_on_credit_e/ consumer_extra_rights_when_you_buy_on_credit_e.htm.
3.4.3
Set up an escrow account. Students may elect not to pay in full for the training in advance, but to control the ow of payments to the ATO. This can be done by means of setting up an escrow account. In such arrangements, the ATO and the student agree to a schedule of payments that ensure that funds are released from the account to the ATO only at certain pre-agreed points in the training programme. Payment is made only for the training that has been provided.
3.4.4
What should I do if my training school ceases trading? In the event that your ATO ceases trading before your training is complete, it is important that your training records are secured and retained by an independent body. It is recommend that, in such circumstances; you contact the relevant National Aviation Authority (such as the CAA in the UK) directly and ask them to secure your training records for you. It is not recommended, however, that you secure your own records as it may subsequently prove difcult to demonstrate to a Licensing Authority that the records have been kept independently.
30 January 2013
Part B
1
Flow Diagrams
Aeroplanes
Helicopters
Airships
Balloons
Sailplanes
Figure 2
Figure 3
Figure 4
Figure 5
Figure 6
Aeroplanes
Helicopters
Gyroplanes
Airships CPL
Balloons CPL
Figure 7
Figure 8 For National Licences which have an equivalent EASA Licence, refer to the relevant parts of Section 5 to CAP 804 and follow the flow charts Figures 2 to 6 as appropriate
Figure 9
Figure 10
Figure 1
May 2012
No Can I meet the minimum of a LAPL medical (1) Yes LAPL(A) Course (2) Yes
Yes
End of Process
No
No
No
Yes
Yes
LAPL (A)
No
I want to fly with more than 3 pax, in an aeroplane greater than 2000kg No Yes
No
No
PPL(A)
No
Yes
CPL(A) IR (13)
MPL (17)
CPL Skills Test (10) No No Yes Instructor FI Course (14) CPL(A) (12) With ATPL Credit Do I want to fly ATPL ATPL Theory Course/Exams (4) Do I want to instruct No
No
Yes
No
SP SE IR
ATPL(A) (16)
No
Yes
SP ME IR
MCC
Yes
Do I have a ME Rating
Yes
No
End of Process
Figure 2
R = Meet the requirements of EASA Part-FCL (Refer to Section 4, Part-F, Subpart 1, FCL.510.A(b)) Ref No.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 Medical requirements LAPL(A) PPL(A) CPL(A) Theory course CPL(A) Modular Course CPL(A) Integrated Course ATP Integrated Course ATP (A) Modular Course CPL (A) IR Integrated Course CPL(A) Skill test CPL IR(A) Skill test CPL(A) CPL IR (A) Instructor Certicates FCL Type rating, LST and IR Course ATPL(A) MPL SP(A) IR Skill Test
Licence/Course
Section 4, Part N Section 4, Part B, Subpart 1 Section 4, Part C, Subpart 1 Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3, (E) Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3, (E ) Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3, (D) , Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3, A , Appendix 6 (A) Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3 (B) Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3 (A) Section 4, Part L, Appendix 4 Section 4, Part L, Appendix 4 & Appendix 7 Section 4, Part D, Subpart 1 Section 4, Part L, Appendix 6 Section 4, Part J, Subpart 0 & 1 Section 4, Part H, Part G, Part L Appendix 6 (A), Appendix 7 & 9 Section 4, Part F, Subpart 1 Section 4, Part E, Part L Appendix 5 Section 4, Part L, Part L Appendix 7
Location
May 2012
End of Process
No
Can I meet the minimum of a LAPL medical (1) Yes LAPL(H) Course (2)
No
Yes
No
No
Yes
LAPL (H)
Yes Do you want to train full time I want to fly with more than 3 pax or in a helicopter greater than 2000kg No Yes Do I want to fly IR No Do I want to fly multi crew
No PPL(H)
Yes
No
Yes No Can I meet Part Med Class 1 medical requirements (1) No Yes Do I want to fly ATPL Yes No Do I want to instruct No Yes Instructor FI Course (14)
Yes
Do I want to fly IR
No CPL IR LST (11) ATPL/IR Integrated Course/ Exams (9) ATPL Integrated Course/Exams (8)
No
CPL(H) IR (13)
No
Yes
CPL(H) (12)
No
With ATPL Credit Yes CPL(H) Frozen ATPL Credit No Yes MCC* Do I require an IR FCL Type Rating & IR Course & LST (15)
SP H IR
FI Cert
Yes
End of Process
ATPL(H) (16)
Figure 3
R = Meet the requirements of EASA Part-FCL (Refer
Location
May 2012
No
Yes
Not Possible
No
No
Yes
Yes
PPL(As) (2)
No
Yes
No
Do I want to fly IR
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Do I want to instruct
CPL(As) (3)
CPL(As) IR (7)
No Yes No
Do I want to fly IR
IR LST (11)
End of Process
Figure 4
R = Meet the requirements of EASA Part-FCL (Refer to Section 4, Appendix 3, N(2)) Ref No.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Licence/Course
Medical requirements Private Pilots Licence Airships PPL(As) Commercial Pilots Licence Airships CPL(As) CPL(As) Integrated Course CPL(As) Modular Course CPL(As) Skill Test CPL(As) IR CPL(As) IR Integrated Course CPL (As) IR Skill Test IR (As) Modular Course IR (As) Skill Test Flight Instructor (As)
Location
Section 4, Part N Section 4, Part C, Subpart 3 Section 4, Part D, Subpart 3 Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3, M Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3, N Section 4, Part L, Appendix 4 & 9 Section 4, Part D, Subpart 3, Section 4, Part G, Subpart 3, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3, L Section 4, Part L, Appendix 4, 7 & 9 Section 4, Part G, Subpart 3 & Appendix 6, C Section 4, Part L, Appendix 7 Section 4, Part J, Subpart 0 & 1
May 2012
No
Yes
No
Can I meet the minimum of a Part Med Class 2 medical (1) Yes
No
LAPL (B)
Do I want to instruct
BPL
No Yes Yes
No Yes
End of Process
Figure 5
R = Meet the requirements of EASA Part-FCL (Refer to Section 4, Part-C, Subpart 5, FCL.205.B) Ref No. 1 2 3 4 Licence/Course Medical requirements LAPL(B) Balloon Pilot Licence (BPL) Flight Instructor Certicate Location Section 4, Part N Section 4, Part B, Subpart 4 Section 4, Subpart 5 Section 4, Part J, Subpart 0 & 1
30 January 2013
No
Yes
No
No
No
End of Process
Do I want to instruct
SPL
No Yes Yes
No Yes
End of Process
Figure 6
R = Meet the requirements of EASA Part-FCL (Refer to Section 4, Part-C, Subpart 4, FCL.205.S) Ref No. 1 2 3 4 Licence/Course Medical requirements LAPL(S) Sailplane Licence (SPL) Instructor Certicate Location Section 4, Part N Section 4, Part B, Subpart 3 Section 4, Part C, Subpart 4 Section 4,Part J, Subpart 0 & 1
30 January 2013
I Want to Fly Microlights or Powered Parachutes with an (NPPL(A) Microlight or NPPL(A) Powered Parachute)
End of Process
No
Can I meet Part Med Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical requirements or national medical declaration (1)
Yes Microlights or Powered Parachutes Course/test (2) NPPL Microlights or Powered Parachutes No
Do I want to instruct
Yes
End of Process
Figure 7
Ref No. 1 2 3 Licence/Course Medical requirements Training Course & Testing Instructor experience & FI course Location Section 4, Part N & Section 5, Part A, Subpart 2 Section 5, Part A, Subpart 2 Section 5, Part H, Subpart 2
May 2012
I Want to Fly (NPPL(A) SSEA/SLMG) Simple Single Engine Aeroplanes or Self Launching Motor Gliders
End of Process
No
Can I meet Part Med Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical requirements or national medical declaration (1)
Yes
NPPL SSEA
NPPL SLMG
FI for SLMG
End of Process
Figure 8
Ref No. 1 2 3 Licence/Course Medical requirements Course requirements & Testing Instructor Experience & FI Course Location Section 4, Part N and Section 5, Part A, Subpart 1 Section 5, Part A, Subpart 1 Section 5, Part H, Subpart 2
27 July 2012
End of Process
No
Can I meet Part Med Class 1,2, LAPL medical or medical declaration requirements (1)
Yes
PPL(BA)
No
No
CPL(B) (Aerial work only) No Is my medical at least a Part-Med Class 2 (4) Yes Experience (5)
CPL(B) (Unrestricted)
End of Process
Figure 9
Ref No. 1 2 3 4 5 Licence/Course Medical requirements PPL(BA) Examinations, Experience & Flight Test CPL(B) Examinations, Experience & Flight Test CPL(B) Medical requirements CPL(B) Experience requirements Location Section 4, Part N & Section 5, Part B, Subpart 2 Section 5, Part B, Subpart 2 Section 5, Part C, Subpart 2 Section 4, Part N & Section 5, Part C, Subpart 2 Section 5, Part C, Subpart 2
May 2012
End of Process
No
Can I meet Part Med Class 1, 2, LAPL medical requirements or Medical Declaration (1)
PPL(G)
No
Do I want to instruct
Yes
AFI(G) FI(G)
End of Process
Figure 10
Ref No. 1 2 3 Licence/Course Medical requirements Training Course & Testing Instructor Experience & Course Location Section 4, Part N & Section 5, Part B, Subpart 3 Section 5, Part B, Subpart 3 Section 5, Part H, Subpart 3
May 2012
Part C
1 Transition
Regulation 1178/2011 came into force on 8 April 2012. The Regulation makes provision for various derogations that may be used by the Member States to allow time for pilots to convert from national licences to Part-FCL licences and for training organisations to be compliant with Part-ORA. The UK has notied the European Commission of how it will use these derogations and this section of CAP 804 sets out the resulting transition arrangements that will apply to the holders of UK-issued licences and organisation approvals.
2
2.1
After these dates national licences (or national licensing rules in the case of sailplanes) will no longer be valid for EASA aircraft compliance with Part-FCL will be mandatory. Pilots who will y only nationally regulated (non-EASA) aircraft may continue to do so under national licences issued in accordance with the Air Navigation Order. Pilots who wish to y EASA aircraft after the dates specied above will have to obtain Part-FCL licences. 2.2 Pilots training for JAR-FCL licences may continue on their existing courses. On completion after 17 September 2012, and on showing compliance with all applicable requirements, a Part-FCL licence will be issued. Training carried out prior to 8 April 2012 may only be credited if the licence is issued before 8 April 2016. Pilots training for national licences in accordance with national training schemes (i.e. gliders, balloons, airships, NPPL) may continue to do so and will be granted national licences on completion and on showing compliance with the requirements. These licences may then be converted to Part-FCL licences according to Section 4 Part P, but only if they were granted before the date upon which an EASA licence becomes mandatory for the category of aircraft for the licence. (i.e. A national balloon or airship licence, NPPL, or glider qualication granted after 7 April 2015 cannot be credited towards a Part-FCL licence).
2.3
27 July 2012
2.4 2.5
EASA Part-FCL licences are issued by the UK CAA from 17 September 2012 onwards. (No new, replacement or amended JAR licences are issued after 16 September 2012). JAR licences issued before 17 September 2012, that are fully compliant with JAR-FCL, automatically become Part-FCL licences. The legislation requires the physical replacement of JAR licences with their Part-FCL equivalents on calendar expiry (so that all are replaced before 8 April 2018). UK-issued non-JAR licences for aeroplanes, helicopters, balloons and airships may be converted to Part-FCL licences by complying with the requirements set out in Section4, Part P. Glider pilot qualications issued by the British Gliding Association may be credited to obtain Part-FCL sailplane licences as set out in Section 4, Part P. UK-issued JAA ATPLs and CPLs that are marked Valid for UK registered aircraft are not deemed to be Part-FCL licences. They are UK licences issued under national legislation and will not be valid to y EASA aircraft after the dates specied in 2.1 above. These licences may also be converted to Part-FCL licences in accordance with Section 4, Part P. UK Basic Commercial Pilots Licences (Aeroplanes) that are not restricted became UK CPL(A)s following amendment of the Air Navigation Order in 2012. These may be converted to Part-FCL licences in accordance with Section 4, Part P. UK Basic Commercial Pilots Licences (Aeroplanes) with restrictions became UK PPL(A) s with FI ratings following amendment of the Air Navigation Order in 2012. These may be converted to Part-FCL licences in accordance with Section 4, Part P. JAR-FCL 3 compliant medical certicates issued before 17 September 2012 are deemed to be EASA Medical Certicates; i.e. they are EASA Medical Certicates. (No new JAR Medical Certicates are issued after 16 September 2012). EASA Medical Certicates will be issued at the next revalidation or renewal of each JAR certicate after 16 September 2012. In any event all pilots with EASA licences will require PartMED Medical Certicates by 8 April 2017 at the latest. NOTE: The NPPL Medical Declaration is not an alternative to the LAPL Medical Certicate. Applicants for LAPLs must obtain the Part-MED LAPL Medical Certicate.
2.6
2.7 2.8
2.9
2.10
2.11
2.12
From 1 April 2012 the theoretical knowledge examinations for commercial licences are conducted in accordance with the latest syllabus.
3
3.1 3.1.1
3.1.2
30 January 2013
3.1.3
For an organisation that has its principal place of business within the UK, the last date for receipt of an application for approval or variation of approval of the organisation in accordance JAR-FCL was 7 April 2012. Applications for the approval and variation of an organisation approval in accordance with the new Part-ORA are accepted by the UK CAA from 8 April 2012 in anticipation of the approval being granted after 17 September 2012. Organisations holding valid JAR-FCL approvals as FTOs or TRTOs on 8 April 2012 are deemed to be Approved Training Organisations under the new Regulation on that date, and the courses that are approved under JAR-FCL are similarly deemed to be approved under the new Regulation but in both cases for 2 years only. Organisations approved under JAR-FCL, and the courses they provide, must be fully compliant with the new Regulation by 8 April 2014 at the latest. During this transition period courses that were approved under JAR-FCL before 8th April may have variations approved on demonstration of compliance with either JAR-FCL or with Parts FCL and ORA. As stated above, changes to the organisation itself after 17 September 2012 must comply with Part-ORA. The allowable period for the training organisation to become compliant with Part-ORA will not be affected by the approval or amendment of courses during the 2 year transition period (i.e. up to 8 April 2014). Applications for new courses that will obtain approval after 17 September 2012 must be compliant with Part-FCL and Part-ORA. Training Organisations whose principal place of business is outside of the EASA Member States Responsibility for the approval of organisations whose principal place of business is outside of the EU transferred to EASA from 8 April 2012. EASA will either oversee the approval itself, or will make arrangements for the Competent Authority of one of the EASA Member States or a Qualied Entity to carry out the oversight tasks under contract to the Agency. For companies whose principal place of business is located outside of an EASA Member State the date of implementation of the new requirements was 8 April 2012. Organisations holding valid JAR-FCL approvals as FTOs or TRTOs on 8 April 2012 are deemed to be Approved Training Organisations under the new Regulation on that date, and the courses that are approved under JAR-FCL are similarly deemed to be approved under the new Regulation but in both cases for 2 years only. Organisations approved under JAR-FCL, and the courses they provide, must be fully compliant with the new Regulation by 8 April 2014 at the latest. The requirements to be complied with during this 2 year transition period for amendments to courses that were approved under JAR-FCL before 8 April must be agreed with EASA. It should be expected that applications for new courses from 8 April (which must be made to EASA) will be required to show compliance with Part-FCL and Part-ORA. Any applications to the UK CAA for approval which are not issued by 8 April 2012 will be completed in co-operation and liaison with EASA. On completion the approval will be issued by the Agency, not the UK CAA. Applications for approval or variation to an approval made after 8 April 2012 must be submitted directly to EASA. The Agency will either process the application themselves or will make arrangements for the Competent Authority of one of the EASA Member States or a Qualied Entity to carry out the assessment and make a recommendation to the Agency on whether or not the approval should be granted.
3.1.4
3.1.5
3.2.2
3.2.3
3.2.4
27 July 2012
3.3 3.3.1
Registered Training Facilities The EASA Aircrew Regulation requires training organisations that provide training for any licence or attached rating or certicate be approved in accordance with Part-ORA. This includes organisations those categorised as Registered Facilities under JAR-FCL. The EASA Aircrew Regulation will be implemented from 17 September 2012 for the approval of organisations whose principal place of business is located in the UK. This means that the last date for the issue of a Registration Certicate for a Registered Facility by the UK CAA under current requirements will be 16 September 2012. Under the transition arrangements of the EASA Aircrew Regulation a Registered Facility that has a valid registration with the UK CAA on 16 September 2012 may continue to provide training for the Private Pilot Licence (within their pre-existing scope of activities) until 8 April 2015. From that date forward they must be an Approved Training Organisation in accordance with Part-ORA to continue to provide instruction for the Part-FCL PPL. Before providing training for any other Part-FCL licence such as the Light Aircraft Pilots Licence (LAPL) a Registered Facility must become an Approved Training Organisation (ATO) in compliance with Part-ORA and Part-FCL. Any organisation intending to provide training for the Part-FCL PPL that was not a Registered Facility on 16 September 2012 must rst become an Approved Training Organisation with the approval to conduct the PPL course in full compliance with Part-ORA and Part-FCL before training commences. For those UK Registered Facilities whose principal place of business is located outside of an EASA Member State the date of implementation of the new requirements is 8 April 2012. (The Bailiwicks of Jersey and Guernsey the Channel Islands and the Isle of Man are outside of the EASA Member States). Under the transition arrangements a Registered Facility that has a valid registration with the UK CAA (or any other EASA Member State) on 8 April 2012 may continue to provide training for the Private Pilot Licence (within their pre-existing scope of activities) until 8 April 2015. However, responsibility for the registration transferred to EASA from 8April 2012. EASA will either oversee the registration themselves, or will make arrangements for the Competent Authority of one of the EASA Member States or a Qualied Entity to carry out the oversight tasks under contract. For those UK Registered Facilities whose principal place of business is located within an EASA Member State other than the UK, the responsibility for the Registered Facility will transfer to that Member State. The transition of the Registered Facility to an Approved Training Organisation will be subject to agreement with the Competent Authority (National Aviation Authority) of the country where the business is located. The last date for receipt of an application for registration in the UK under JAR-FCL is 17 August 2012. Applicants should ensure that their submissions are complete and clear to facilitate registration by 16 September 2012. Any registration applied for but not completed by 16 September 2012 will not be granted. In such cases a new application for approval as an ATO under Part-ORA will be required. It is emphasised that organisations continuing as Registered Facilities (until 8 April 2015 at the latest) are accepted for the conduct of training for the Private Pilot Licence only; they may not conduct training for the Light Aeroplane Pilots Licence, or any other EASA licence. Until the organisation has become approved as an ATO, Registered facilities shall continue to advise the CAA of any changes to the organisation, such as; facilities, aerodromes, aircraft and instructors, by submitting a revised Form SRG 2188 to L&TS Approvals.
3.3.2
3.3.3
3.3.4
3.3.5
3.3.6
3.3.7
15 October 2013
2
2.1
2.2
3
3.1
3.2
May 2012
Section 3 Page 1
records. This process must be completed when any licence is re-issued and may become necessary whenever any change is made to the licence; such as the addition of a rating. 3.3 If the licence held by an individual is a JAR-FCL-compliant licence issued by a State that was recommended for mutual recognition in respect of JAR-FCL 1 (Aeroplane) and JAR-FCL 2 (Helicopter) by Central JAA (of the Joint Aviation Authorities) it should simply be a matter of applying to the new Competent Authority/NAA for a change of State of Licence issue, complying with their procedures and advising the existing State of the intent to cancel the licence because of the transfer. If the licences held were issued in accordance with national non-JAR compliant requirements and procedures, then advice must be sought from the State that issued each licence concerning what additional requirements must be met in order that a PartFCL licence may be issued. This information and evidence of compliance with the requirements must then be included with the application to the NAA of the State that is to issue the new Part-FCL licence. The EASA Aircrew Regulation stipulates that national licences may only be converted by the country that issued them. This means that the holder of a UK non-JAR-FCL licence who requires a Part-FCL licence must apply to the UK CAA and must ensure that his medical records are held in the UK.
3.4
4
4.1
May 2012
Section 3 Page 2
27 July 2012
Section 3 Page 4
Individuals who do not intend to obtain any further licence (i.e. ATPL holders) are not required to obtain a Sworn Afdavit for their past ying. However, they must start a new ying log/logbook to comply with their obligations under the law.
May 2012
Section 3 Page 5
Existing / Expiring Licence UK PPL(H) UK CPL(H and G) UK ATPL(H and G) JAR PPL(H) JAR CPL(H) JAR CPL(H) marked Valid for UK registered Aircraft JAR ATPL(H) UK PPL(BA) UK CPL(B) UK CPL(As) FRTOL (not included in pilot licence)
Replacement Licence UK PPL(H) UK CPL(H) UK ATPL(H) Part-FCL PPL(H) Part-FCL CPL(H) UK CPL(H) Part-FCL ATPL(H) UK PPL(BA) UK CPL(B) UK CPL(As) FRTOL (As a separate licence or within a pilot licence)
EASA conversion options Part-FCL PPL(H) Part-FCL CPL(H) Part-FCL ATPL(H), CPL(H) Not applicable Not applicable Part-FCL CPL(H) Not applicable LAPL(B), BPL BPL Part-FCL CPL(As)
Not applicable
27 July 2012
Section 3 Page 6
Same day services are subject to the following: Applicants must present themselves with the relevant and complete documentation before 12:00 noon. (The CAA will refuse any incomplete application). The maximum number of applications accepted from any one applicant/company for a same day service, without prior written agreement, is 4. Applications for a same day service must be collected prior to the Public Counter closing at 16:30. Applications cannot be submitted for collection the following working day. The length of time that an individual may have to wait will be dependent on the number of applications received prior to their arrival at the counter. Paperwork brought in for a same day service which has not been collected will be posted to the customer by second-class post within the published SRG Code of Practice timescale. Any multiple rating applications (four or more) for a same day service to be made by one person/ company shall be agreed beforehand with the Licensing Services Manager. Requests should be made in writing by letter or e-mail to fclweb@caa.co.uk or by fax on 01293 573996. In order to maintain the service we provide we are not able to pre-book slots. We are unable to provide a same day service for applications for initial licence issue or licence upgrade or any other service not listed above; however the applications may be handed in at the counter.
27 July 2012
Section 3 Page 7
Part A
European (EU) legislation has changed the pilot licensing rules that affect the privileges of many existing licence holders. The European Regulation 216/2008 (often referred to as the Basic EASA Regulation) and the subordinate Regulations (the Implementing Rules) that have been enacted are binding in UK law and replace and override the equivalent national aviation legislation in the Air Navigation Order. The new rules are based on JAR-FCL, but there are signicant differences. The EU rules became effective as of 8 April 2012. Part-FCL is implemented in the UK from 17 September 2012. The full text of Regulation 1178/2011 (Part-FCL is Annex 1 to that Regulation) is available through the EASA website.
1 Applicability
Part-FCL applies to Part-FCL Licences issued from the date of implementation of PartFCL and to JAR-FCL Licences that are deemed to be Part-FCL Licences by the Aircrew Regulation.
2 Privileges
The privileges of EASA pilot licences, associated ratings, certicates and the conditions of their validity and use can be found in the relevant parts of this Section 4 of CAP 804.
3 Requirements
The following requirements apply to all Part-FCL Licences, Ratings and Certicates: FCL.001 Competent authority FCL.005 Scope FCL.010 Denitions FCL.015 Application and issue of licences, ratings and certicates FCL.020 Student pilot FCL.025 Theoretical knowledge examinations for the issue of licences FCL.030 Practical skill test FCL.035 Crediting of ight time and theoretical knowledge
27 July 2012
Exercise of the privileges of licences Obligation to carry and present documents Recording of ight time Language prociency Recent experience Curtailment of privileges of licence holders aged 60 years or more in commercial air transport FCL.070 Revocation, suspension and limitation of licences, ratings and certicates For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.001 Competent authority
For the purpose of this Part, the competent authority shall be an authority designated by the Member State to whom a person applies for the issue of pilot licences or associated ratings or certicates. FCL.005 Scope Part-FCL establishes the requirements for the issue of pilot licences and associated ratings and certicates and the conditions of their validity and use. FCL.010 Denitions The denitions of FCL.010 are reproduced in CAP 804 Section 1, Part B. FCL.015 Application and issue of licences, ratings and certicates
(a) An application for the issue, revalidation or renewal of pilot licences and associated ratings and certicates shall be submitted to the competent authority in a form and manner established by this authority. The application shall be accompanied by evidence that the applicant complies with the requirements for the issue, revalidation or renewal of the licence or certicate as well as associated ratings or endorsements, established in this Part and Part-Medical. (b) Any limitation or extension of the privileges granted by a licence, rating or certicate shall be endorsed in the licence or certicate by the competent authority. (c) A person shall not hold at any time more than one licence per category of aircraft issued in accordance with Part-FCL. (d) An application for the issue of a licence for another category of aircraft, or for the issue of further ratings or certicates, as well as an amendment, revalidation or renewal of those licences, ratings or certicates shall be submitted to the competent authority which initially issued the pilot licence, except when the pilot has requested a change of competent authority and a transfer of his licensing and medical records to that authority. For the purpose of FCL.015 (a), the UK CAA is the competent authority for the UK; this is specied in the Air Navigation Order
May 2012
FCL.020
Student pilot
A student pilot shall not y solo unless authorised to do so and supervised by a ight instructor. Before his/her rst solo ight, a student pilot shall be at least: in the case of aeroplanes, helicopters and airships: 16 years of age; in the case of sailplanes and balloons: 14 years of age. FCL.025 Theoretical knowledge examinations for the issue of licences
(a) Responsibilities of the applicant (1) Applicants shall take the entire set of examinations for a specic licence or rating under the responsibility of one Member State. (2) Applicants shall only take the examination when recommended by the approved training organisation (ATO) responsible for their training, once they have completed the appropriate elements of the training course of theoretical knowledge instruction to a satisfactory standard. (3) The recommendation by an ATO shall be valid for 12 months. If the applicant has failed to attempt at least one theoretical knowledge examination paper within this period of validity, the need for further training shall be determined by the ATO, based on the needs of the applicant. (b) Pass standards (1) A pass in an examination paper will be awarded to an applicant achieving at least 75% of the marks allocated to that paper. There is no penalty marking. (2) Unless otherwise determined in this Part, an applicant has successfully completed the required theoretical knowledge examination for the appropriate pilot licence or rating when he/she has passed all the required examination papers within a period of 18 months counted from the end of the calendar month when the applicant rst attempted an examination. (3) If an applicant has failed to pass one of the examination papers within 4 attempts, or has failed to pass all papers within either 6 sittings or the period mentioned in paragraph (2), he/she shall re-take the complete set of examination papers. Before re-taking the examinations, the applicant shall undertake further training at an ATO. The extent and scope of the training needed shall be determined by the training organisation, based on the needs of the applicant. (c) Validity period (1) The successful completion of the theoretical knowledge examinations will be valid: (i) for the issue of a light aircraft pilot licence, a private pilot licence, a sailplane pilot licence or a balloon pilot licence, for a period of 24 months; (ii) for the issue of a commercial pilot licence or instrument rating (IR), for a period of 36 months; (iii) the periods in (i) and (ii) shall be counted from the day when the pilot successfully completes the theoretical knowledge examination, in accordance with (b)(2).
27 July 2012
(2) The completion of the airline transport pilot licence (ATPL) theoretical knowledge examinations will remain valid for the issue of an ATPL for a period of 7 years from the last validity date of: (i) an IR entered in the licence; or (ii) in the case of helicopters, a helicopters type rating entered in that licence. FCL.030 Practical skill test
(a) Before a skill test for the issue of a licence, rating or certicate is taken, the applicant shall have passed the required theoretical knowledge examination, except in the case of applicants undergoing a course of integrated ying training. In any case, the theoretical knowledge instruction shall always have been completed before the skill tests are taken. (b) Except for the issue of an airline transport pilot licence, the applicant for a skill test shall be recommended for the test by the organisation/person responsible for the training, once the training is completed. The training records shall be made available to the examiner. FCL.035 Crediting of ight time and theoretical knowledge
(a) Crediting of ight time (1) Unless otherwise specied in this Part, ight time to be credited for a licence, rating or certicate shall have been own in the same category of aircraft for which the licence or rating is sought. (2) Pilot-in command or under instruction (i) An applicant for a licence, rating or certicate shall be credited in full with all solo, dual instruction or PIC ight time towards the total ight time required for the licence, rating or certicate. (ii) A graduate of an ATP integrated training course is entitled to be credited with up to 50 hours of student pilot-in-command instrument time towards the PIC time required for the issue of the airline transport pilot licence, commercial pilot licence and a multi-engine type or class rating. (iii) A graduate of a CPL/IR integrated training course is entitled to be credited with up to 50 hours of the student pilot-in-command instrument time towards the PIC time required for the issue of the commercial pilot licence and a multi-engine type or class rating. (3) Flight time as co-pilot. Unless otherwise determined in this Part, the holder of a pilot licence, when acting as co-pilot or PICUS, is entitled to be credited with all of the co-pilot time towards the total ight time required for a higher grade of pilot licence. (b) Crediting of theoretical knowledge (1) An applicant having passed the theoretical knowledge examination for an airline transport pilot licence shall be credited with the theoretical knowledge requirements for the light aircraft pilot licence, the private pilot licence, the commercial pilot licence and, except in the case of helicopters, the IR in the same category of aircraft.
May 2012
(2) An applicant having passed the theoretical knowledge examination for a commercial pilot licence shall be credited with the theoretical knowledge requirement for a light aircraft pilot licence or a private pilot licence in the same category of aircraft. (3) The holder of an IR or an applicant having passed the instrument theoretical knowledge examination for a category of aircraft shall be fully credited towards the requirements for the theoretical knowledge instruction and examination for an IR in another category of aircraft. (4) The holder of a pilot licence shall be credited towards the requirements for theoretical knowledge instruction and examination for a licence in another category of aircraft in accordance with Appendix 1 to this Part. This credit also applies to applicants for a pilot licence who have already successfully completed the theoretical knowledge examinations for the issue of that licence in another category of aircraft, as long as it is within the validity period specied in FCL.025(c). FCL.040 Exercise of the privileges of licences
The exercise of the privileges granted by a licence shall be dependent upon the validity of the ratings contained therein, if applicable, and of the medical certicate. FCL.045 Obligation to carry and present documents
(a) A valid licence and a valid medical certicate shall always be carried by the pilot when exercising the privileges of the licence. (b) The pilot shall also carry a personal identication document containing his/her photo. (c) A pilot or a student pilot shall without undue delay present his/her ight time record for inspection upon request by an authorised representative of a competent authority. (d) A student pilot shall carry on all solo cross-country ights evidence of the authorisation required by FCL.020. FCL.050 Recording of ight time
The pilot shall keep a reliable record of the details of all ights own in a form and manner established by the competent authority. FCL.055 Language prociency
Refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part M for full English Language Prociency requirements. FCL.060 Recent experience
(a) Balloons. A pilot shall not operate a balloon in commercial air transport or carrying passengers unless he/she has completed in the preceding 180 days: (1) at least 3 ights as a pilot ying in a balloon, of which at least 1 shall be in a balloon of the relevant class and group; or
27 July 2012
(2) 1 ight in the relevant class and group of balloon under the supervision of an instructor qualied in accordance with Subpart J. (b) Aeroplanes, helicopters, powered-lift, airships and sailplanes. A pilot shall not operate an aircraft in commercial air transport or carrying passengers: (1) as PIC or co-pilot unless he/she has carried out, in the preceding 90 days, at least 3 take-offs, approaches and landings in an aircraft of the same type or class or an FFS representing that type or class. The 3 take-offs and landings shall be performed in either multi-pilot or single-pilot operations, depending on the privileges held by the pilot; and (2) as PIC at night unless he/she: (i) has carried out in the preceding 90 days at least 1 take-off, approach and landing at night as a pilot ying in an aircraft of the same type or class or an FFS representing that type or class; or (ii) holds an IR; (3) as cruise relief co-pilot unless he/she: (i) has complied with the requirements in (b)(1); or (ii) has carried out in the preceding 90 days at least 3 sectors as a cruise relief pilot on the same type or class of aircraft; or (iii) has carried out recency and refresher ying skill training in an FFS at intervals not exceeding 90 days. This refresher training may be combined with the operators refresher training prescribed in Part-OR.OPS. (4) When a pilot has the privilege to operate more than one type of aeroplane with similar handling and operation characteristics, the 3 take-offs, approaches and landings required in (1) may be performed as dened in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21. (5) When a pilot has the privilege to operate more than one type of non-complex helicopter with similar handling and operation characteristics, as dened in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21, the 3 take-offs, approaches and landings required in (1) may be performed in just one of the types, provided that the pilot has completed at least 2 hours of ight in each of the types of helicopter, during the preceding 6 months. (c) Specic requirements for commercial air transport (1) In the case of commercial air transport, the 90-day period prescribed in subparagraphs (b)(1) and (2) above may be extended up to a maximum of 120 days, as long as the pilot undertakes line ying under the supervision of a type rating instructor or examiner. (2) When the pilot does not comply with the requirement in (1), he/she shall complete a training ight in the aircraft or an FFS of the aircraft type to be used, which shall include at least the requirements described in (b)(1) and (2) before he/she can exercise his/her privileges. FCL.065 Curtailment of privileges of licence holders aged 60 years or more in commercial air transport
(a) Age 6064. Aeroplanes and helicopters. The holder of a pilot licence who has attained the age of 60 years shall not act as a pilot of an aircraft engaged in commercial air transport except:
May 2012
(1) as a member of a multi-pilot crew; and (2) provided that such a holder is the only pilot in the ight crew who has attained the age of 60 years. (b) Age 65. The holder of a pilot licence who has attained the age of 65 years shall not act as a pilot of an aircraft engaged in commercial air transport. FCL.070 Revocation, suspension and limitation of licences, ratings and certicates
(a) Licences, ratings and certicates issued in accordance with Part-FCL may be limited, suspended or revoked by the competent authority when the pilot does not comply with the requirements of this Part, Part-Medical or the applicable operational requirements, in accordance with the conditions and procedures laid down in Part-ARA. (b) When the pilot has his/her licence suspended or revoked, he/she shall immediately return the licence or certicate to the competent authority.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Part B
EASA Light Aircraft Pilot Licences (LAPL) for Aeroplanes, Helicopters, Sailplanes and Balloons
2 Privileges
EASA Aeroplanes The privileges and conditions of the EASA LAPL(A) are dened in FCL.105 and FCL.105.A as follows: FCL.105 LAPL Privileges and conditions
(a) General. The privileges of the holder of an LAPL(A) are to act without remuneration as PIC in non-commercial operations on aeroplanes. (b) Conditions. Applicants for the LAPL(A) shall have fullled the requirements for aeroplanes and, when applicable, for the class or type of aeroplane used in the skill test. FCL.105.A LAPL(A) Privileges and conditions (a) The privileges of the holder of an LAPL for aeroplanes are to act as PIC on singleengine piston aeroplanes-land or TMG with a maximum certicated take-off mass of 2000 kg or less, carrying a maximum of 3 passengers, such that there are never more than 4 persons on board of the aircraft. (b) Holders of an LAPL(A) shall only carry passengers after they have completed, after the issuance of the licence, 10 hours of ight time as PIC on aeroplanes or TMG. Non-EASA Aeroplanes Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA LAPL(A) to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA aeroplanes.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA LAPL(A) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.100 FCL.105 Minimum Age Privileges and Conditions
May 2012
LAPL(A) Privileges and Conditions Crediting for the same aircraft category LAPL(A) Experience requirements and crediting Training Course Theoretical Knowledge Examination Skill Test Extension of Privileges Recency Requirements
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the LAPL shall hold a valid Class1, Class 2 or LAPL medical certicate. FCL.100 LAPL(A) Minimum age
Applicants for the LAPL for aeroplanes LAPL(A) shall be at least 17 years of age; FCL.105 and 105.A See above. FCL.110 LAPL(A) Crediting for the same aircraft category LAPL(A) Privileges and conditions
(a) Applicants for an LAPL(A) who have held another licence for aeroplanes shall be fully credited towards the requirements of the LAPL(A). (b) Without prejudice to the paragraph above, if the licence has lapsed, the applicant shall have to pass a skill test in accordance with FCL.125 for the issue of an LAPL(A) in aeroplanes. FCL.110.A LAPL(A) Experience requirements and crediting (a) Applicants for an LAPL(A) shall have completed at least 30 hours of ight instruction on aeroplanes or TMGs, including at least: (1) 15 hours of dual ight instruction in the class in which the skill test will be taken; (2) 6 hours of supervised solo ight time, including at least 3 hours of solo crosscountry ight time with at least 1 cross-country ight of at least 150km (80NM), during which 1 full stop landing at an aerodrome different from the aerodrome of departure shall be made. (b) Specic requirements for applicants holding an LAPL(S) with TMG extension. Applicants for an LAPL(A) holding an LAPL(S) with TMG extension shall have completed at least 21 hours of ight time on TMGs after the endorsement of the TMG extension and complied with the requirements of FCL.135.A(a) on aeroplanes. (c) Crediting. Applicants with prior experience as PIC may be credited towards the requirements in (a). The amount of credit shall be decided by the ATO where the pilot undergoes the training course, on the basis of a pre-entry ight test, but shall in any case: (1) not exceed the total ight time as PIC;
May 2012
(2) not exceed 50% of the hours required in (a); (3) not include the requirements of (a)(2). FCL.115 LAPL(A) Training course
Applicants for an LAPL(A) shall complete a training course within an ATO. The course shall include theoretical knowledge and ight instruction appropriate to the privileges given. FCL.120 LAPL(A) Theoretical knowledge examination
Applicants for an LAPL(A) shall demonstrate a level of theoretical knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted, through examinations on the following: (a) common subjects: Air law, Human performance, Meteorology, and Communications; (b) specic subjects concerning the different aircraft categories: Principles of ight, Operational procedures, Flight performance and planning, Aircraft general knowledge, and Navigation. FCL.125 LAPL(A) Skill test
(a) Applicants for an LAPL(A) shall demonstrate through the completion of a skill test the ability to perform, as PIC aeroplanes, the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with competency appropriate to the privileges granted. (b) Applicants for the skill test shall have received ight instruction on the same class or type of aeroplane to be used for the skill test. The privileges will be restricted to the class or type used for the skill test until further extensions are endorsed on the licence, in accordance with this Subpart. (c) Pass marks (1) The skill test shall be divided into different sections, representing all the different phases of ight appropriate to the aeroplane own. (2) Failure in any item of a section will cause the applicant to fail the entire section. If the applicant fails only 1 section, he/she shall repeat only that section. Failure in more than 1 section will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. (3) When the test needs to be repeated in accordance with (2), failure in any section, including those that have been passed on a previous attempt, will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. (4) Failure to achieve a pass in all sections of the test in 2 attempts will require further practical training.
May 2012
FCL.135.A LAPL(A) Extension of privileges to another class or variant of aeroplane (a) The privileges of an LAPL(A) shall be limited to the class and variant of aeroplanes or TMG in which the skill test was taken. This limitation may be removed when the pilot has completed in another class the requirements below: (1) 3 hours of ight instruction, including: (i) 10 dual take-offs and landings, and (ii) 10 supervised solo take-offs and landings. (2) a skill test to demonstrate an adequate level of practical skill in the new class. During this skill test, the applicant shall also demonstrate to the examiner an adequate level of theoretical knowledge for the other class in the following subjects: (i) Operational procedures, (ii) Flight performance and planning, (iii) Aircraft general knowledge. (b) Before the holder of an LAPL(A) can exercise the privileges of the licence on another variant of aeroplane than the one used for the skill test, the pilot shall undertake differences or familiarisation training. The differences training shall be entered in the pilots logbook or equivalent document and signed by the instructor. FCL.140.A LAPL(A) Recency requirements (a) Holders of an LAPL (A) shall only exercise the privileges of their licence when they have completed, in the last 24 months, as pilots of aeroplanes or TMG: (1) at least 12 hours of ight time as PIC, including 12 take-offs and landings; and (2) refresher training of at least 1 hour of total ight time with an instructor. (b) Holders of an LAPL(A) who do not comply with the requirements in (a) shall: (1) undertake a prociency check with an examiner before they resume the exercise of the privileges of their licence; or (2) perform the additional ight time or take-offs and landings, ying dual or solo under the supervision of an instructor, in order to full the requirements in (a).
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1.
May 2012
2 Privileges
EASA Helicopters The privileges and conditions of the EASA LAPL(H) are dened in FCL.105 and FCL.105.H as follows: FCL.105 LAPL(H) Privileges and conditions
(a) General. The privileges of the holder of an LAPL (H) are to act without remuneration as PIC in non-commercial operations on helicopters. (b) Conditions. Applicants for the LAPL (H) shall have fullled the requirements for helicopters and, when applicable, for the type of helicopter used in the skill test. FCL.105.H LAPL(H) Privileges and conditions The privileges of the holder of an LAPL for helicopters are to act as PIC on singleengine helicopters with a maximum certicated take-off mass of 2000 kg or less, carrying a maximum of 3 passengers, such that there are never more than 4 persons on board. Non-EASA helicopters Non EASA helicopter type ratings cannot be added to an EASA licence. For the addition of a non EASA helicopter type rating, a pilot will require a UK national licence with the Non EASA type rating.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA LAPL(H) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.100 Minimum Age FCL.105 Privileges and Conditions FCL.105.H Privileges and Conditions FCL.110 Crediting for the same aircraft category FCL.110.H LAPL(H) Experience requirements and crediting FCL.115 Training Course FCL.120 Theoretical Knowledge Examination FCL.125 Skill Test FCL.135.H Extension of Privileges FCL.140.H Recency Requirements
May 2012 Section 4 Part B, Subpart 2 Page 1
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the LAPL shall hold a valid Class1, Class 2 or LAPL medical certicate. FCL.100 LAPL(H) Minimum age
Applicants for the LAPL for Helicopters LAPL(H) shall be at least 17 years of age. FCL.105 and FCL.105.H As above. FCL.110 LAPL(H) Crediting for the same aircraft category LAPL(H) Privileges and conditions
(a) Applicants for an LAPL(H) who have held another licence for helicopters shall be fully credited towards the requirements of the LAPL(H). (b) Without prejudice to the paragraph above, if the licence has lapsed, the applicant shall have to pass a skill test in accordance with FCL.125 for the issue of an LAPL(H) in the helicopter category. FCL.110.H LAPL(H) Experience requirements and crediting (a) Applicants for the LAPL(H) shall have completed 40 hours of ight instruction on helicopters. At least 35 hours of which shall be own on the type of helicopter that is to be used for the skill test. The ight instruction shall include at least: (1) 20 hours of dual ight instruction; and (2) 10 hours of supervised solo ight time, including at least 5 hours of solo cross-country ight time with at least 1 cross-country ight of at least 150km (80NM), during which one full stop landing at an aerodrome different from the aerodrome of departure shall be made. (b) Crediting. Applicants with prior experience as PIC may be credited towards the requirements in (a). The amount of credit shall be decided by the ATO where the pilot undergoes the training course, on the basis of a pre-entry ight test, but shall in any case: (1) not exceed the total ight time as PIC; (2) not exceed 50% of the hours required in (a); (3) not include the requirements in (a)(2). FCL.115 LAPL(H) Training course
Applicants for an LAPL(H) shall complete a training course within an ATO. The course shall include theoretical knowledge and ight instruction appropriate to the privileges given. FCL.120 LAPL(H) Theoretical knowledge examination
Applicants for an LAPL(H) shall demonstrate a level of theoretical knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted, through examinations on the following: (a) common subjects: Air law, Human performance, Meteorology, and Communications;
May 2012 Section 4 Part B, Subpart 2 Page 2
(b) specic subjects concerning the different aircraft categories: Principles of ight, Operational procedures, Flight performance and planning, Aircraft general knowledge, and Navigation. FCL.125 LAPL(H) Skill test
(a) Applicants for an LAPL(H) shall demonstrate through the completion of a skill test the ability to perform, as PIC on helicopters, the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with competency appropriate to the privileges granted. (b) Applicants for the skill test shall have received ight instruction on the same type of helicopter to be used for the skill test. The privileges will be restricted to the type used for the skill test until further extensions are endorsed on the licence, in accordance with this Subpart. (c) Pass marks (1) The skill test shall be divided into different sections, representing all the different phases of ight appropriate to the helicopter own. (2) Failure in any item of a section will cause the applicant to fail the entire section. If the applicant fails only 1 section, he/she shall repeat only that section. Failure in more than 1 section will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. (3) When the test needs to be repeated in accordance with (2), failure in any section, including those that have been passed on a previous attempt, will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. (4) Failure to achieve a pass in all sections of the test in 2 attempts will require further practical training. FCL.135.H LAPL(H) Extension of privileges to another type or variant of helicopter (a) The privileges of an LAPL(H) shall be limited to the specic type and variant of helicopter in which the skill test was taken. This limitation may be removed when the pilot has completed: (1) 5 hours of ight instruction, including: (i) 15 dual take-offs, approaches and landings; (ii) 15 supervised solo take-offs, approaches and landings; (iii) a skill test to demonstrate an adequate level of practical skill in the new type. During this skill test, the applicant shall also demonstrate to the examiner an adequate level of theoretical knowledge for the other type in the following subjects: Operational procedures, Flight performance and planning, Aircraft general knowledge.
30 January 2013
(b) Before the holder of an LAPL(H) can exercise the privileges of the licence in another variant of helicopter than the one used for the skill test, the pilot shall undertake differences or familiarisation training, as determined in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21. The differences training shall be entered in the pilots logbook or equivalent record and signed by the instructor. FCL.140.H LAPL(H) Recency requirements (a) Holders of an LAPL(H) shall only exercise the privileges of their licence on a specic type when they have completed on helicopters of that type in the last 12 months: (1) at least 6 hours of ight time as PIC, including 6 take-offs, approaches and landings; and (2) refresher training of at least 1 hour total ight time with an instructor. (b) Holders of an LAPL(H) who do not comply with the requirements in (a) shall: (1) pass a prociency check with an examiner on the specic type before they resume the exercise of the privileges of their licence; or (2) perform the additional ight time or take-offs and landings, ying dual or solo under the supervision of an instructor, in order to full the requirements in (a).
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1.
May 2012
2 Privileges
EASA Sailplanes The privileges and conditions of the EASA LAPL(S) are dened in FCL.105 and FCL.105.S as follows: FCL.105 LAPL(S) Privileges and conditions
(a) General. The privileges of the holder of an LAPL(S) are to act without remuneration as PIC in non-commercial operations on sailplanes or powered sailplanes. (b) Conditions. Applicants for the LAPL(S) shall have fullled the requirements for the relevant aircraft category and, when applicable, for the class of sailplane or powered sailplane used in the skill test. FCL.105.S LAPL(S) Privileges and conditions (a) The privileges of the holder of an LAPL for sailplanes are to act as PIC on sailplanes and powered sailplanes. In order to exercise the privileges on a TMG, the holder shall comply with the requirements in FCL.135.S. (b) Holders of an LAPL(S) shall only carry passengers after they have completed, after the issuance of the licence, 10 hours of ight time or 30 launches as PIC on sailplanes or powered sailplanes. NOTE: The holder of an LAPL(S) may y Sailplanes and Powered Sailplanes (i.e. Self Launching Motor Gliders excluding Touring Motor Gliders (TMG)). The licence holder is not entitled to y Touring Motor Gliders unless the TMG is included in the licence. Non-EASA sailplanes Under the ANO, no licence is required for a private ight in a non-EASA sailplane.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA LAPL(S) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.100 Minimum Age FCL.105 Privileges and Conditions FCL.105.S Privileges and Conditions FCL.110 Crediting for the same aircraft category FCL.110.S LAPL(S) Experience requirements and crediting FCL.115 Training Course FCL.120 Theoretical Knowledge Examination FCL.125 Skill Test FCL.130.S Launch Methods
27 July 2012
FCL.135.S Extension of Privileges FCL.140.S Recency Requirements For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the LAPL shall hold a valid Class1, Class 2 or LAPL medical certicate. FCL.100 LAPL(S) Minimum age
Applicants for the LAPL for Sailplanes LAPL(S) shall be at least 16 years of age; FCL.105 and FCL.105.S LAPL(S) Privileges and conditions As above. FCL.110 LAPL(S) Crediting for the same aircraft category
(a) Applicants for an LAPL(S) who have held another licence for sailplanes shall be fully credited towards the requirements of the LAPL(S). (b) Without prejudice to the paragraph above, if the licence has lapsed, the applicant shall have to pass a skill test in accordance with FCL.125 for the issue of an LAPL(S) in sailplanes. FCL.110.S LAPL(S) Experience requirements and crediting (a) Applicants for an LAPL(S) shall have completed at least 15 hours of ight instruction in sailplanes, or powered sailplanes, including at least: (1) 10 hours of dual ight instruction; (2) 2 hours of supervised solo ight time; (3) 45 launches and landings; (4) 1 solo cross-country ight of at least 50 km (27 NM) or 1 dual cross-country ight of at least 100 km (55 NM). (b) Of the 15 hours required in (a), a maximum of 7 hours may be completed in a TMG. (c) Crediting. Applicants with prior experience as PIC may be credited towards the requirements in (a). The amount of credit shall be decided by the ATO where the pilot undergoes the training course, on the basis of a pre-entry ight test, but shall in any case: (1) not exceed the total ight time as PIC; (2) not exceed 50% of the hours required in (a); (3) not include the requirements in (a)(2) to (a)(4). FCL.115 LAPL(S) Training course
Applicants for an LAPL(S) shall complete a training course within an ATO. The course shall include theoretical knowledge and ight instruction appropriate to the privileges given. FCL.120 LAPL(S) Theoretical knowledge examination
Applicants for an LAPL(S) shall demonstrate a level of theoretical knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted, through examinations on the following: (a) common subjects:
May 2012
Air law, Human performance, Meteorology, and Communications; (b) specic subjects concerning the different aircraft categories: Principles of ight, Operational procedures, Flight performance and planning, Aircraft general knowledge, and Navigation. FCL.125 LAPL(S) Skill test
(a) Applicants for an LAPL(S) shall demonstrate through the completion of a skill test the ability to perform, as PIC on sailplanes, the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with competency appropriate to the privileges granted. (b) Applicants for the skill test shall have received ight instruction on the same class or type of sailplane to be used for the skill test. The privileges will be restricted to the class or type used for the skill test until further extensions are endorsed on the licence, in accordance with this Subpart. (c) Pass marks (1) The skill test shall be divided into different sections, representing all the different phases of ight appropriate to the sailplane own. (2) Failure in any item of a section will cause the applicant to fail the entire section. If the applicant fails only 1 section, he/she shall repeat only that section. Failure in more than 1 section will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. (3) When the test needs to be repeated in accordance with (2), failure in any section, including those that have been passed on a previous attempt, will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. (4) Failure to achieve a pass in all sections of the test in 2 attempts will require further practical training. FCL.130.S LAPL(S) Launch methods (a) The privileges of the LAPL(S) shall be limited to the launch method included in the skill test. This limitation may be removed when the pilot has completed: (1) in the case of winch launch and car launch, a minimum of 10 launches in dual ight instruction, and 5 solo launches under supervision; (2) in the case of aero tow or self launch, a minimum of 5 launches in dual ight instruction, and 5 solo launches under supervision. In the case of self launch, dual ight instruction may be done in a TMG; (3) in the case of bungee launch, a minimum of 3 launches performed in dual ight instruction or solo under supervision. (b) The completion of the additional training launches shall be entered in the logbook and signed by the instructor. (c) In order to maintain their privileges in each launch method, pilots shall complete a minimum of 5 launches during the last 24 months, except for bungee launch, in which case pilots shall have completed only 2 launches.
May 2012
(d) When the pilot does not comply with the requirement in (c), he/she shall perform the additional number of launches ying dual or solo under the supervision of an instructor in order to renew the privileges. FCL.135.S LAPL(S) Extension of privileges to TMG The privileges of an LAPL(S) shall be extended to a TMG when the pilot has completed in an ATO, at least: (a) 6 hours of ight instruction on a TMG, including: (1) 4 hours of dual ight instruction; (2) 1 solo cross-country ight of at least 150 km (80 NM), during which 1 full stop landing at an aerodrome different from the aerodrome of departure shall be performed; (b) a skill test to demonstrate an adequate level of practical skill in a TMG. During this skill test, the applicant shall also demonstrate to the examiner an adequate level of theoretical knowledge for the TMG in the following subjects: Principles of ight, Operational procedures, Flight performance and planning, Aircraft general knowledge, Navigation. FCL.140.S LAPL(S) Recency requirements (a) Sailplanes and powered sailplanes. Holders of an LAPL(S) shall only exercise the privileges of their licence on sailplanes or powered sailplanes when they have completed on sailplanes or powered sailplanes, excluding TMGs, in the last 24 months, at least: (1) 5 hours of ight time as PIC, including 15 launches; (2) 2 training ights with an instructor; (b) TMG Holders of an LAPL(S) shall only exercise the privileges of their licence on a TMG when they have: (1) completed on TMGs in the last 24 months: (i) at least 12 hours of ight time as PIC, including 12 take-offs and landings; and (ii) refresher training of at least 1 hour total ight time with an instructor. (2) When the holder of the LAPL(S) also has the privileges to y aeroplanes, the requirements in (1) may be completed on aeroplanes. (c) Holders of an LAPL(S) who do not comply with the requirements in (a) or (b) shall, before they resume the exercise of their privileges: (1) pass a prociency check with an examiner on a sailplane or a TMG, as appropriate; or (2) perform the additional ight time or take-offs and landings, ying dual or solo under the supervision of an instructor, in order to full the requirements in (a) or (b).
May 2012
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1, 1.1.
May 2012
2 Privileges
EASA Balloons The privileges and conditions of the EASA LAPL(B) are dened in FCL.105 and FCL.105.B as follows: FCL.105 LAPL Privileges and conditions
(a) General. The privileges of the holder of an LAPL(B) are to act without remuneration as PIC in non-commercial operations on balloons. (b) Conditions. Applicants for the LAPL(B) shall have fullled the requirements for balloons and, when applicable, for the class or group of balloon used in the skill test. FCL.105.B LAPL(B) Privileges and conditions (a) The privileges of the holder of an LAPL for balloons are to act as PIC on hot-air balloons or hot-air airships with a maximum of 3400 m3 envelope capacity or gas balloons with a maximum of 1200 m3 envelope capacity, carrying a maximum of 3 passengers, such that there are never more than 4 persons on board of the aircraft. Non-EASA balloons Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA LAPL(B) to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA balloons.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA LAPL(B) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: Minimum Age FCL.100 FCL.105 Privileges and Conditions FCL.105.B Privileges and Conditions FCL.110 Crediting for the same aircraft category FCL.110.B LAPL(B) Experience requirements and crediting FCL.115 Training Course FCL.120 Theoretical Knowledge Examination FCL.125 Skill Test FCL.130.B Extension of Privileges to Tethered Flight FCL.135.B Extension of Privileges to Another Balloon Class
May 2012 Section 4 Part B, Subpart 4 Page 1
FCL.140.B Recency Requirements For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the LAPL shall hold a valid Class1, Class 2 or LAPL medical certicate. FCL.100 LAPL(B) Minimum age
Applicants for the LAPL for Balloons LAPL(B) shall be at least 16 years of age; FCL.105 and FCL.105.B LAPL(B) Privileges and conditions As above. FCL.110 LAPL(B) Crediting for the same aircraft category
(a) Applicants for an LAPL(B) who have held another licence for balloons shall be fully credited towards the requirements of the LAPL(B). (b) Without prejudice to the paragraph above, if the licence has lapsed, the applicant shall have to pass a skill test in accordance with FCL.125 for the issue of an LAPL(B) in balloons. FCL.110.B LAPL(B) Experience requirements and crediting (a) Applicants for an LAPL(B) shall have completed on balloons of the same class at least 16 hours of ight instruction, including at least: (1) 12 hours of dual ight instruction; (2) 10 inations and 20 take-offs and landings; and (3) 1 supervised solo ight with a minimum ight time of at least 30 minutes. (b) Crediting. Applicants with prior experience as PIC on balloons may be credited towards the requirements in (a). The amount of credit shall be decided by the ATO where the pilot undergoes the training course, on the basis of a pre-entry ight test, but shall in any case: (1) not exceed the total ight time as PIC on balloons; (2) not exceed 50% of the hours required in (a); (3) not include the requirements of (a)(2) and (a)(3). FCL.115 LAPL(B) Training course
Applicants for an LAPL(B) shall complete a training course within an ATO. The course shall include theoretical knowledge and ight instruction appropriate to the privileges given. FCL.120 LAPL(B) Theoretical knowledge examination
Applicants for an LAPL(B) shall demonstrate a level of theoretical knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted, through examinations on the following: (a) common subjects: Air law, Human performance, Meteorology, and Communications;
May 2012 Section 4 Part B, Subpart 4 Page 2
(b) specic subjects concerning the different aircraft categories: Principles of ight, Operational procedures, Flight performance and planning, Aircraft general knowledge, and Navigation. FCL.125 LAPL(B) Skill test
(a) Applicants for an LAPL(B) shall demonstrate through the completion of a skill test the ability to perform, as PIC on balloons, the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with competency appropriate to the privileges granted. (b) Applicants for the skill test shall have received ight instruction on the same class of balloon to be used for the skill test. The privileges will be restricted to the class used for the skill test until further extensions are endorsed on the licence, in accordance with this Subpart. (c) Pass marks (1) The skill test shall be divided into different sections, representing all the different phases of ight appropriate to the balloon own. (2) Failure in any item of a section will cause the applicant to fail the entire section. If the applicant fails only 1 section, he/she shall repeat only that section. Failure in more than 1 section will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. (3) When the test needs to be repeated in accordance with (2), failure in any section, including those that have been passed on a previous attempt, will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. (4) Failure to achieve a pass in all sections of the test in 2 attempts will require further practical training. FCL.130.B LAPL(B) Extension of privileges to tethered ights (a) The privileges of the LAPL(B) shall be limited to non-tethered ights. This limitation may be removed when the pilot has completed at least 3 tethered instruction ights. (b) The completion of the additional training shall be entered in the logbook and signed by the instructor. (c) In order to maintain this privilege, pilots shall complete a minimum of 2 tethered ights during the last 24 months. (d) When the pilot does not comply with the requirement in (c), he/she shall perform the additional number of tethered ights ying dual or solo under the supervision of an instructor in order to renew the privileges. FCL.135.B LAPL(B) Extension of privileges to another balloon class The privileges of the LAPL(B) shall be limited to the class of balloons in which the skill test was taken. This limitation may be removed when the pilot has completed in the other class, at an ATO, at least: (a) 5 dual instruction ights; or (b) in the case of an LAPL(B) for hot-air balloons wishing to extend their privileges to hot-air airships, 5 hours of dual ight instruction time; and
May 2012
(c) a skill test, during which they shall demonstrate to the examiner an adequate level of theoretical knowledge for the other class in the following subjects: Principles of ight, Operational procedures, Flight performance and planning, and Aircraft general knowledge. FCL.140.B LAPL(B) Recency requirements (a) Holders of an LAPL(B) shall only exercise the privileges of their licence when they have completed, in one class of balloons in the last 24 months, at least: (1) 6 hours of ight time as PIC, including 10 take-offs and landings; and (2) 1 training ight with an instructor; (3) in addition, if the pilot is qualied to y more than one class of balloons, in order to exercise their privileges in the other class, they shall have completed at least 3 hours of ight time in that class within the last 24 months, including 3 take-offs and landings. (b) Holders of an LAPL(B) who do not comply with the requirements in (a) shall, before they resume the exercise of their privileges: (1) pass a prociency check with an examiner in the appropriate class; or (2) perform the additional ight time or take-offs and landings, ying dual or solo under the supervision of an instructor, in order to full the requirements in (a).
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1, 1.1.
May 2012
Part C
EASA Private Pilot Licence (PPL), Sailplane Pilot Licence (SPL) and Balloon Pilot Licence (BPL)
2 Privileges
EASA Aeroplanes The privileges and conditions of the EASA PPL(A) are dened in FCL.205 and FCL.205.A as follows: FCL.205 Privileges and conditions
Applicants for the issue of a PPL(A) shall have fullled the requirements for the class or type rating for the aeroplane used in the skill test, as established in Subpart H of EASA Part-FCL. FCL.205.A PPL(A) Privileges and conditions (a) The privileges of the holder of a PPL(A) are to act without remuneration as PIC or co-pilot on aeroplanes or TMGs engaged in non-commercial operations. (b) Notwithstanding the paragraph above, the holder of a PPL(A) with instructor or examiner privileges may receive remuneration for: (1) the provision of ight instruction for the LAPL(A) or PPL(A); (2) the conduct of skill tests and prociency checks for these licences; (3) the ratings and certicates attached to these licences. NOTE: The PPL(A) is not valid to y EASA Sailplanes and Powered Sailplanes, except for Touring Motor Gliders (TMG). Non-EASA aeroplanes Article 62(5) of the ANO 2009 renders the EASA PPL(A) to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA aeroplanes.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA PPL(A) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.200 Minimum Age FCL.205 Privileges and Conditions FCL.205.A Privileges and Conditions FCL.210 Training Course
27 July 2012
PPL(A) Experience requirements and crediting Theoretical Knowledge Examination Skill Test
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the PPL(A) shall hold a valid Class1 or Class 2 medical certicate. FCL.200 PPL(A) Minimum age
Applicants for the PPL for aeroplanes PPL(A) shall be at least 17 years of age; FCL.205 and FCL.205.A PPL(A) Privileges and Conditions As above. FCL.210 PPL(A) Training Course
Applicants for a PPL(A) shall complete a training course at an ATO. The course shall include theoretical knowledge and ight instruction appropriate to the privileges given. FCL.210.A PPL(A) Experience requirements and crediting (a) Applicants for a PPL(A) shall have completed at least 45 hours of ight instruction in aeroplanes, 5 of which may have been completed in an FSTD, including at least: (1) 25 hours of dual ight instruction; and (2) 10 hours of supervised solo ight time, including at least 5 hours of solo cross-country ight time with at least 1 cross-country ight of at least 270km (150 NM), during which full stop landings at 2 aerodromes different from the aerodrome of departure shall be made. (b) Specic requirements for applicants holding an LAPL(A). Applicants for a PPL (A) holding an LAPL(A) shall have completed at least 15 hours of ight time on aeroplanes after the issue of the LAPL (A), of which at least 10 shall be ight instruction completed in a training course at an ATO. This training course shall include at least 4 hours of supervised solo ight time, including at least 2 hours of solo cross-country ight time with at least 1 cross-country ight of at least 270km (150 NM), during which full stop landings at 2 aerodromes different from the aerodrome of departure shall be made. (c) Specic requirements for applicants holding an LAPL(S) with a TMG extension. Applicants for a PPL (A) holding an LAPL(S) with a TMG extension shall have completed: (1) at least 24 hours of ight time on TMG after the endorsement of the TMG extension; and (2) 15 hours of ight instruction in aeroplanes in a training course at an ATO, including at least the requirements of (a)(2). (d) Crediting. Applicants holding a pilot licence for another category of aircraft, with the exception of balloons, shall be credited with 10% of their total ight time as PIC on such aircraft up to a maximum of 10 hours. The amount of credit given shall in any case not include the requirements in (a)(2).
May 2012
FCL.215
Applicants for a PPL (A) shall demonstrate a level of theoretical knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted through examinations in the following subjects: (a) Common subjects: Air law, Human performance, Meteorology, and Communications; (b) Specic subjects concerning the different aircraft categories: Principles of ight, Operational procedures, Flight performance and planning, Aircraft general knowledge, and Navigation. FCL.235 PPL(A) Skill Test
(a) Applicants for a PPL(A) shall demonstrate through the completion of a skill test the ability to perform, as PIC aeroplanes, the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with competency appropriate to the privileges granted. (b) An applicant for the skill test shall have received ight instruction on the same class or type of aeroplane to be used for the skill test. (c) Pass marks. (1) The skill test shall be divided into different sections, representing all the different phases of ight appropriate to the aeroplane own. (2) Failure in any item of a section will cause the applicant to fail the entire section. Failure in more than 1 section will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. If the applicant fails only 1 section, he/she shall repeat only that section. (3) When the test needs to be repeated in accordance with (2), failure in any section, including those that have been passed on a previous attempt, will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. (4) Failure to achieve a pass in all sections of the test in 2 attempts will require further training.
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1, 1.1.
May 2012
2 Privileges
EASA Helicopters The privileges and conditions of the EASA PPL(H) are dened in FCL.205 and FCL.205.H as follows: FCL.205 Privileges and conditions
Applicants for the issue of a PPL(H) shall have fullled the requirements for the type rating for the helicopter used in the skill test, as established in Subpart H of EASA Part-FCL. FCL.205.H PPL(H) Privileges and conditions (a) The privileges of the holder of a PPL(H) are to act without remuneration as PIC or co-pilot of helicopters engaged in non-commercial operations. (b) Notwithstanding the paragraph above, the holder of a PPL(H) with instructor or examiner privileges may receive remuneration for: (1) the provision of ight instruction for the LAPL(H) or PPL(H); (2) the conduct of skill tests and prociency checks for these licences; (3) the ratings and certicates attached to these licences. Non-EASA Helicopters Non-EASA helicopter type ratings cannot be added to an EASA licence. For the addition of a non-EASA helicopter type rating, a pilot will require a UK national licence with the Non-EASA type rating.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA PPL(H) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.200 Minimum Age FCL.205 Conditions FCL.205.H Privileges FCL.210 Training Course FCL.210.H PPL(H) Experience requirements and crediting FCL.215 Theoretical Knowledge Examination FCL.235 Skill Test
27 July 2012
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the PPL(H) shall hold a valid Class1 or Class 2 medical certicate. FCL.200 PPL(H) Minimum age
Applicants for the PPL for helicopters PPL(H) shall be at least 17 years of age; FCL.205 and FCL.205.H PPL(H) Privileges and Conditions As above. FCL.210 PPL(H) Training Course
Applicants for a PPL(H) shall complete a training course at an ATO. The course shall include theoretical knowledge and ight instruction appropriate to the privileges given. FCL.210.H PPL(H) Experience requirements and crediting (a) Applicants for a PPL(H) shall have completed at least 45 hours of ight instruction on helicopters, 5 of which may have been completed in an FNPT or FFS, including at least: (1) 25 hours of dual ight instruction; and (2) 10 hours of supervised solo ight time, including at least 5 hours of solo cross-country ight time with at least 1 cross-country ight of at least 185km (100 NM), with full stop landings at 2 aerodromes different from the aerodrome of departure. (3) 35 of the 45 hours of ight instruction have to be completed on the same type of helicopter as the one used for the skill test. (b) Specic requirements for an applicant holding an LAPL (H). Applicants for a PPL(H) holding an LAPL (H) shall complete a training course at an ATO. This training course shall include at least 5 hours of dual ight instruction time and at least 1 supervised solo cross-country ight of at least 185 km (100 NM), with full stop landings at 2aerodromes different from the aerodrome of departure. (c) Applicants holding a pilot licence for another category of aircraft, with the exception of balloons, shall be credited with 10% of their total ight time as PIC on such aircraft up to a maximum of 6 hours. The amount of credit given shall in any case not include the requirements in (a)(2). FCL.215 PPL(H) Theoretical Knowledge Examination
Applicants for a PPL(H) shall demonstrate a level of theoretical knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted through examinations in the following subjects: (a) Common subjects: Air law, Human performance, Meteorology, and Communications;
May 2012
(b) specic subjects concerning the different aircraft categories: Principles of ight, Operational procedures, Flight performance and planning, Aircraft general knowledge, and Navigation. FCL.235 PPL(H) Skill Test
(a) Applicants for a PPL(H) shall demonstrate through the completion of a skill test the ability to perform, as PIC on helicopters, the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with competency appropriate to the privileges granted. (b) An applicant for the skill test shall have received ight instruction on the same type of helicopter to be used for the skill test. (c) Pass marks (1) The skill test shall be divided into different sections, representing all the different phases of ight appropriate to the helicopter own. (2) Failure in any item of a section will cause the applicant to fail the entire section. Failure in more than 1 section will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. If the applicant fails only 1 section, he/she shall repeat only that section. (3) When the test needs to be repeated in accordance with (2), failure in any section, including those that have been passed on a previous attempt, will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. (4) Failure to achieve a pass in all sections of the test in 2 attempts will require further training.
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1, 1.1.
May 2012
2 Privileges
EASA Airships The privileges and conditions of the EASA PPL (As) are dened in FCL.205 and FCL.205.As as follows: FCL.205 Privileges and conditions
Applicants for the issue of a PPL(As) shall have fullled the requirements for the type rating for the airship used in the skill test, as established in Subpart H of EASA PartFCL. FCL.205.As PPL(As) Privileges and conditions (a) The privileges of the holder of a PPL(As) are to act without remuneration as PIC or co-pilot of airships engaged in non-commercial operations. (b) Notwithstanding the paragraph above, the holder of a PPL(As) with instructor or examiner privileges may receive remuneration for: (1) the provision of ight instruction for the PPL(As); (2) the conduct of skill tests and prociency checks for this licence; (3) the ratings or certicates attached to this licence. Non-EASA Airships Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA PPL(As) to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA airships
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA PPL(As) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.200 Minimum Age FCL.205 Privileges and Conditions FCL.205.As Privileges and Conditions FCL.210 Training Course FCL.210.As PPL(As) Experience requirements and crediting FCL.215 Theoretical Knowledge Examination FCL.235 Skill Test
May 2012
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the PPL(As) shall hold a valid Class1 or Class 2 medical certicate. FCL.200 PPL(As) Minimum age
Applicants for the PPL for airships PPL(As) shall be at least 17 years of age; FCL.205 and FCL.205.As As above. FCL.210 PPL(As) Training Course PPL(As) Privileges and Conditions
Applicants for a PPL(As) shall complete a training course at an ATO. The course shall include theoretical knowledge and ight instruction appropriate to the privileges given. FCL.210.As PPL(As) Experience requirements and crediting (a) Applicants for a PPL(As) shall have completed at least 35 hours of ight instruction in airships, 5 of which may have been completed in an FSTD, including at least: (1) 25 hours of dual ight instruction, including: (i) 3 hours of cross-country ight training, including 1 cross-country ight of at least 65 km (35 NM); (ii) 3 hours of instrument instruction; (2) 8 take-offs and landings at an aerodrome, including masting and unmasting procedures; (3) 8 hours of supervised solo ight time. (b) Applicants holding a BPL and qualied to y hot-air airships shall be credited with 10% of their total ight time as PIC on such airships up to amaximum of 5 hours. FCL.215 PPL(As) Theoretical Knowledge Examination
Applicants for a PPL(As) shall demonstrate a level of theoretical knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted through examinations in the following subjects: (a) Common subjects: Air law, Human performance, Meteorology, and Communications; (b) Specic subjects concerning the different aircraft categories: Principles of ight, Operational procedures, Flight performance and planning, Aircraft general knowledge, and Navigation.
May 2012
FCL.235
(a) Applicants for a PPL(As) shall demonstrate through the completion of a skill test the ability to perform, as PIC on airships, the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with competency appropriate to the privileges granted. (b) An applicant for the skill test shall have received ight instruction on the type of airship to be used for the skill test. (c) Pass marks (1) The skill test shall be divided into different sections, representing all the different phases of ight appropriate to the airship own. (2) Failure in any item of a section will cause the applicant to fail the entire section. Failure in more than 1 section will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. If the applicant fails only 1 section, he/she shall repeat only that section. (3) When the test needs to be repeated in accordance with (2), failure in any section, including those that have been passed on a previous attempt, will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. (4) Failure to achieve a pass in all sections of the test in 2 attempts will require further training.
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1, 1.1.
May 2012
Subpart 4
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA SPL may exercise the privileges of the licence to y EASA Sailplanes registered in the EU and non-EASA Sailplanes registered in the UK that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence.
2 Privileges
EASA Sailplanes The privileges and conditions of the EASA SPL are dened in FCL.205 and FCL.205.S as follows: FCL.205 Privileges and conditions
Applicants for the issue of an SPL shall have fullled the requirements for the class rating for the sailplane used in the skill test, as established in Subpart H of EASA Part-FCL. FCL.205.S SPL Privileges and Conditions (a) The privileges of the holder of an SPL are to act as PIC on sailplanes and powered sailplanes. In order to exercise the privileges on a TMG, the holder shall have to comply with the requirements in FCL.135.S (Section 4,Part B subpart 3, LAPL(S)). (b) Holders of an SPL shall: (1) carry passengers only when having completed, after the issuance of the licence, at least 10 hours of ight time or 30 launches as PIC on sailplanes or powered sailplanes; (2) be restricted to act without remuneration in non-commercial operations until they have: (i) attained the age of 18 years; (ii) completed, after the issuance of the licence, 75 hours of ight time or 200 launches as PIC on sailplanes or powered sailplanes; (iii) passed a prociency check with an examiner. (c) Notwithstanding (b)(2), the holder of an SPL with instructor or examiner privileges may receive remuneration for: (1) the provision of ight instruction for the LAPL(S) or the SPL; (2) the conduct of skill tests and prociency checks for these licences; (3) the ratings and certicates attached to these licences. NOTE: The holder of an SPL may y Sailplanes and Powered Sailplanes (i.e. Self Launching Motor Gliders). The licence holder is not entitled to y Touring Motor Gliders unless a TMG rating is included in the licence. Non-EASA sailplanes Under the ANO, no licence is required for a private ight in a non-EASA sailplane. Where the SPL holder has complied with the requirements of FCL.205.S (b) (2) for commercial operations, they may use the SPL to y non-EASA Gliders for the same purposes.
May 2012
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA SPL shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: Minimum Age FCL.200 FCL.205 Privileges and Conditions FCL.205.S Privileges and Conditions FCL.210 Training Course FCL.210.S SPL Experience requirements and crediting FCL.215 Theoretical Knowledge Examination FCL.220.S SPL Launch Methods FCL.230.S SPL Recency requirements FCL.235 Skill Test For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the SPL shall hold a valid Class1 or Class 2 medical certicate. FCL.200 SPL Minimum age
Applicants for the Sailplane pilots licence SPL shall be at least 16 years of age; FCL.205 and FCL.205.S SPL Privileges and Conditions As above. FCL.210 SPL Training Course
Applicants for an SPL shall complete a training course at an ATO. The course shall include theoretical knowledge and ight instruction appropriate to the privileges given. FCL.210.S SPL Experience requirements and crediting (a) Applicants for an SPL shall have completed at least 15 hours of ight instruction on sailplanes or powered sailplanes, including at least the requirements specied in FCL.110.S. (Section 4,Part B Subpart 3, LAPL(S)) (b) Applicants for an SPL holding an LAPL(S) shall be fully credited towards the requirements for the issue of an SPL. (c) Applicants for an SPL who held an LAPL(S) within the period of 2 years before the application shall be fully credited towards the requirements of theoretical knowledge and ight instruction. (d) Crediting. Applicants holding a pilot licence for another category of aircraft, with the exception of balloons, shall be credited with 10% of their total ight time as PIC on such aircraft up to a maximum of 7 hours. The amount of credit given shall in any case not include the requirements of FCL.110.S (a)(2) to (a)(4).
May 2012
FCL.215
Applicants for an SPL shall demonstrate a level of theoretical knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted through examinations in the following subjects: (a) common subjects: Air law, Human performance, Meteorology, and Communications; (b) specic subjects concerning the different aircraft categories: Principles of ight, Operational procedures, Flight performance and planning, Aircraft general knowledge, and Navigation. FCL.220.S SPL Launch Methods The privileges of the SPL shall be limited to the launch method included in the skill test. This limitation may be removed and the new privileges exercised when the pilot complies with the requirements in FCL.130.S. (Section 4,Part B Subpart 3, LAPL(S)). FCL.230.S SPL Recency requirements Holders of an SPL shall only exercise the privileges of their licence when complying with the recency requirements in FCL.140.S. (Section 4,Part B Subpart 3, LAPL(S)) (a) Sailplanes and powered sailplanes. Holders of an SPL shall only exercise the privileges of their licence on sailplanes or powered sailplanes when they have completed on sailplanes or powered sailplanes, excluding TMGs, in the last 24 months, at least: (1) 5 hours of ight time as PIC, including 15 launches; (2) 2 training ights with an instructor; (b) TMG. Holders of an SPL shall only exercise the privileges of their licence on a TMG when they have: (1) completed on TMGs in the last 24 months: (i) at least 12 hours of ight time as PIC, including 12 take-offs and landings; and (ii) refresher training of at least 1 hour total ight time with an instructor. (2) When the holder of the SPL also has the privileges to y aeroplanes, the requirements in (1) may be completed on aeroplanes. (c) Holders of an SPL who do not comply with the requirements in (a) or (b) shall, before they resume the exercise of their privileges: (1) pass a prociency check with an examiner on a sailplane or a TMG, as appropriate; or
May 2012
(2) perform the additional ight time or take-offs and landings, ying dual or solo under the supervision of an instructor, in order to full the requirements in (a) or (b). FCL.235 SPL Skill Test
(a) Applicants for an SPL shall demonstrate through the completion of a skill test the ability to perform, as PIC on sailplanes, the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with competency appropriate to the privileges granted. (b) An applicant for the skill test shall have received ight instruction on the class of sailplane to be used for the skill test. (c) Pass marks (1) The skill test shall be divided into different sections, representing all the different phases of ight appropriate to the sailplane own. (2) Failure in any item of a section will cause the applicant to fail the entire section. Failure in more than 1 section will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. If the applicant fails only 1 section, he/she shall repeat only that section. (3) When the test needs to be repeated in accordance with (2), failure in any section, including those that have been passed on a previous attempt, will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. (4) Failure to achieve a pass in all sections of the test in 2 attempts will require further training.
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1.
May 2012
Subpart 5
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA BPL may exercise the privileges of the licence to y EASA Balloons registered in the EU and non-EASA Balloons registered in the UK that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence.
2 Privileges
EASA Balloons The privileges of the EASA BPL are dened in FCL.205 and FCL.205.B as follows: FCL.205 BPL privileges and conditions
Applicants for the issue of a BPL shall have fullled the requirements for the class or group rating for the balloon used in the skill test, as established in Subpart H of EASA Part-FCL. FCL.205.B BPL privileges and conditions (a) The privileges of the holder of a BPL are to act as PIC on balloons and hot-air airships. (b) Holders of a BPL shall be restricted to act without remuneration in non-commercial operations until they have: (1) attained the age of 18 years; (2) completed 50 hours of ight time and 50 take-offs and landings as PIC on balloons; (3) passed a prociency check with an examiner on a balloon in the specic class. (c) Notwithstanding paragraph (b), the holder of a BPL with instructor or examiner privileges may receive remuneration for: (1) the provision of ight instruction for the LAPL(B) or the BPL; (2) the conduct of skill tests and prociency checks for these licences; (3) the ratings and certicates attached to these licences. Non-EASA Balloons Article 62(5) of the ANO 2009 renders the EASA BPL to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA balloons.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA BPL shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.200 Minimum Age FCL.205 Conditions FCL.205.B Privileges and Conditions
27 July 2012
Training Course BPL Experience requirements and crediting Theoretical Knowledge Examination BPL Extension of privileges to tethered ights BPL Extension of privileges to another balloon class or group BPL Recency requirements Skill Test
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the BPL shall hold a valid Class1 or Class 2 medical certicate. FCL.200 BPL Minimum age
Applicants for the balloon pilots licence BPL shall be at least 16 years of age; FCL.205 and FCL.205.B BPL Privileges and Conditions As above. FCL.210 BPL Training Course
Applicants for a BPL shall complete a training course at an ATO. The course shall include theoretical knowledge and ight instruction appropriate to the privileges given. FCL.210.B BPL Experience requirements and crediting (a) Applicants for a BPL shall have completed on balloons in the same class and group at least 16 hours of ight instruction, including at least: (1) 12 hours of dual ight instruction; (2) 10 inations and 20 take-offs and landings; and (3) 1 supervised solo ight with a minimum ight time of at least 30 minutes. (b) Applicants for a BPL holding an LAPL(B) shall be fully credited towards the requirements for the issue of a BPL. Applicants for a BPL who held an LAPL(B) within the period of 2 years before the application shall be fully credited towards the requirements of theoretical knowledge and ight instruction. FCL.215 BPL Theoretical Knowledge Examination
Applicants for a BPL shall demonstrate a level of theoretical knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted through examinations in the following subjects: (a) Common subjects: Air law, Human performance, Meteorology, and Communications;
May 2012
(b) Specic subjects concerning the different aircraft categories: Principles of ight, Operational procedures, Flight performance and planning, Aircraft general knowledge, and Navigation. FCL.220.B BPL Extension of privileges to tethered ights The privileges of the BPL shall be limited to non-tethered ights. This limitation may be removed when the pilot complies with the requirements in FCL.130.B. (Section4, Part B Subpart 4, LAPL(B)) (a) The privileges of the BPL shall be limited to non-tethered ights. This limitation may be removed when the pilot has completed at least 3 tethered instruction ights. (b) The completion of the additional training shall be entered in the logbook and signed by the instructor. (c) In order to maintain this privilege, pilots shall complete a minimum of 2 tethered ights during the last 24 months. (d) When the pilot does not comply with the requirement in (c), he/she shall perform the additional number of tethered ights ying dual or solo under the supervision of an instructor in order to renew the privileges. FCL.225.B BPL Extension of privileges to another balloon class or group The privileges of the BPL shall be limited to the class and group of balloons in which the skill test was taken. This limitation may be removed when the pilot has: (a) in the case of an extension to another class within the same group, complied with the requirements in FCL.135.B; (Section 4 Part B, Subpart 4, LAPL(B)). (b) in the case of an extension to another group within the same class of balloons, completed at least: (1) 2 instruction ights on a balloon of the relevant group; and (2) the following hours of ight time as PIC on balloons: (i) for balloons with an envelope capacity between 3401m3 and 6000m3, at least 100 hours; (ii) for balloons with an envelope capacity between 6001m3 and 10500m3, at least 200 hours; (iii) for balloons with an envelope capacity of more than 10500m3, at least 300 hours; (iv) for gas balloons with an envelope capacity of more than 1260m3, at least 50 hours. FCL.230.B BPL recency requirements (a) Holders of a BPL shall only exercise the privileges of their licence when they have completed in one class of balloons in the last 24 months at least:
May 2012
(1) 6 hours of ight time as PIC, including 10 take-offs and landings; and (2) 1 training ight with an instructor in a balloon within the appropriate class and with the maximum envelope capacity they have privileges for. (3) In addition, in the case of pilots qualied to y more than one class of balloons, in order to exercise their privileges in the other class, they shall have completed at least 3 hours of ight time on that class within the last 24months, including 3 take-offs and landings. (b) Holders of a BPL who do not comply with the requirements in (a) shall, before they resume the exercise of their privileges: (1) pass a prociency check with an examiner in a balloon within the appropriate class and with the maximum envelope capacity they have privileges for; or (2) perform the additional ight time or take-offs and landings, ying dual or solo under the supervision of an instructor, in order to full the requirements in (a). FCL.235 BPL Skill Test
(a) Applicants for a BPL shall demonstrate through the completion of a skill test the ability to perform, as PIC on balloons, the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with competency appropriate to the privileges granted. (b) An applicant for the skill test shall have received ight instruction on the class and group of balloon to be used for the skill test. (c) Pass marks. (1) The skill test shall be divided into different sections, representing all the different phases of ight appropriate to the balloon own. (2) Failure in any item of a section will cause the applicant to fail the entire section. Failure in more than 1 section will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. If the applicant fails only 1 section, he/she shall repeat only that section. (3) When the test needs to be repeated in accordance with (2), failure in any section, including those that have been passed on a previous attempt, will cause the applicant to fail the entire test. (4) Failure to achieve a pass in all sections of the test in 2 attempts will require further training.
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1, 1.1.
May 2012
Part D
EASA Commercial Pilot Licence (CPL) for Aeroplanes, Helicopters and Airships
2 Privileges
EASA Aeroplanes The privileges and conditions of the EASA CPL(A) are dened in FCL.305 as follows: FCL.305 CPL(A) Privileges and conditions
(a) Privileges. The privileges of the holder of a CPL(A) are, within aeroplanes, to: (1) exercise all the privileges of the holder of an LAPL(A) and a PPL(A); (2) act as PIC or co-pilot of any aeroplane engaged in operations other than commercial air transport; (3) act as PIC in commercial air transport of any single-pilot aeroplane subject to the restrictions specied in FCL.060 and in this Subpart; (4) act as co-pilot in commercial air transport subject to the restrictions specied in FCL.060. (b) Conditions. An applicant for the issue of a CPL(A) shall have fullled the requirements for the class or type rating of the aeroplane used in the skill test. Non-EASA aeroplanes Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA CPL(A) to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA aeroplanes.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA CPL(A) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.300 Minimum Age FCL.305 Privileges and Conditions FCL.310 Theoretical Knowledge Examination FCL.315 Training Course FCL.320 CPL(A) Skill Test FCL.325.A Specic conditions for MPL holders
May 2012
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the CPL(A) shall hold a valid Class 1 medical certicate. FCL.300 CPL(A) Minimum age
Applicants for the CPL for Aeroplanes CPL(A) shall be at least 18 years of age; FCL.305 As above. FCL.310 Theoretical Knowledge Examination CPL(A) Privileges and Conditions
An applicant for a CPL (A) shall demonstrate a level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted in the following subjects: Air Law, Aircraft General Knowledge - Airframe/Systems/Powerplant, Aircraft General Knowledge Instrumentation, Mass and Balance, Performance, Flight Planning and Monitoring, Human Performance, Meteorology, General Navigation, Radio Navigation, Operational Procedures, Principles of Flight, Visual Flight Rules (VFR) Communications. FCL.315 Training Course
An applicant for a CPL(A) shall have completed theoretical knowledge instruction and ight instruction at an ATO, in accordance with Appendix 3 to Part-FCL (refer to 5 Additional Information). FCL.320 Skill Test
An applicant for a CPL(A) shall pass a skill test in accordance with Appendix 4 to Part-FCL to demonstrate the ability to perform, as PIC of aeroplanes, the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with the competency appropriate to the privileges granted. FCL.325.A Specic conditions for MPL holders Before exercising the privileges of a CPL(A), the holder of an MPL shall have completed in aeroplanes: (a) 70 hours of ight time: (1) as PIC; or (2) made up of at least 10 hours as PIC and the additional ight time as PIC under supervision (PICUS).
May 2012
Of these 70 hours, 20 shall be of VFR cross-country ight time as PIC, or crosscountry ight time made up of at least 10 hours as PIC and 10 hours as PICUS. This shall include a VFR cross-country ight of at least 540 km (300 NM) in the course of which full-stop landings at two different aerodromes shall be own as PIC; (b) the elements of the CPL(A) modular course as specied in paragraphs 10(a) and 11 of Appendix 3, E to this Part-FCL; and (c) the CPL(A) skill test, in accordance with FCL.320.
5
5.1
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1, A. 2. For information relating to training courses for the issue of a CPL(A); refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3, C, D or E as appropriate.
5.2
May 2012
2 Privileges
EASA Helicopters The privileges and conditions of the EASA CPL(H) are dened in FCL.305 as follows: FCL.305 CPL(H) Privileges and conditions
(a) Privileges. The privileges of the holder of a CPL(H) are, within helicopters, to: (1) exercise all the privileges of the holder of an LAPL(H) and a PPL(H); (2) act as PIC or co-pilot of any helicopter engaged in operations other than commercial air transport; (3) act as PIC in commercial air transport of any single-pilot helicopter subject to the restrictions specied in FCL.060 and in this Subpart; (4) act as co-pilot in commercial air transport subject to the restrictions specied in FCL.060. (b) Conditions. An applicant for the issue of a CPL(H) shall have fullled the requirements for the type rating of the helicopter used in the skill test. Non-EASA Helicopters Non-EASA helicopter type ratings cannot be added to an EASA licence. For the addition of a non-EASA helicopter type rating, a pilot will require a UK national licence with the Non-EASA type rating.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA CPL(H) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.300 FCL.305 FCL.310 FCL.315 FCL.320 Minimum Age Privileges and Conditions Theoretical Knowledge Examination Training Course CPL(H) Skill Test
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the CPL(H) shall hold a valid Class 1 medical certicate.
May 2012
FCL.300
Applicants for the CPL for helicopters CPL(H) shall be at least 18 years of age. FCL.305 As above. FCL.310 Theoretical Knowledge Examination CPL(H) Privileges and Conditions
An applicant for a CPL(H) shall demonstrate a level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted in the following subjects: Air Law, Aircraft General Knowledge - Airframe/Systems/Powerplant, Aircraft General Knowledge Instrumentation, Mass and Balance, Performance, Flight Planning and Monitoring, Human Performance, Meteorology, General Navigation, Radio Navigation, Operational Procedures, Principles of Flight, Visual Flight Rules (VFR) Communications. FCL.315 Training Course
An applicant for a CPL(H) shall have completed theoretical knowledge instruction and ight instruction at an ATO, in accordance with Appendix 3 to Part-FCL (refer to 5 Additional Information). FCL.320 Skill Test
An applicant for a CPL(H) shall pass a skill test in accordance with Appendix 4 to PartFCL to demonstrate the ability to perform, as PIC of helicopters, the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with the competency appropriate to the privileges granted.
5
5.1
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1, 1.2. For information relating to training courses for the issue of a CPL(H); refer to CAP804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3, paragraph I, J or K as appropriate.
Section 4 Part D, Subpart 2 Page 2
5.2
May 2012
2 Privileges
EASA Airships The privileges and conditions of the EASA CPL(As) are dened in FCL.305 as follows: FCL.305 CPL(As) Privileges and conditions
(a) Privileges. The privileges of the holder of a CPL(As) are, within airships, to: (1) exercise all the privileges of the holder of a PPL(As); (2) act as PIC or co-pilot of any airship engaged in operations other than commercial air transport; (3) act as PIC in commercial air transport of any single-pilot airship subject to the restrictions specied in FCL.060 and in this Subpart; (4) act as co-pilot in commercial air transport subject to the restrictions specied in FCL.060. (b) Conditions. An applicant for the issue of a CPL(As) shall have fullled the requirements for the type rating of the airship used in the skill test. Non-EASA Airships Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA CPL(As) to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA airships.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA CPL(As) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.300 Minimum Age FCL.305 Privileges and Conditions FCL.310 Theoretical Knowledge Examination FCL.315 Training Course FCL.320 CPL(As) Skill Test For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the CPL(As) shall hold a valid Class 1 medical certicate.
May 2012
FCL.300
Applicants for the CPL for airshipsCPL(As) shall be at least 18 years of age; FCL.305 As above. FCL.310 Theoretical Knowledge Examination CPL(As) Privileges and Conditions
An applicant for a CPL(As) shall demonstrate a level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted in the following subjects: Air Law, Aircraft General Knowledge - Airframe/Systems/Powerplant, Aircraft General Knowledge Instrumentation, Mass and Balance, Performance, Flight Planning and Monitoring, Human Performance, Meteorology, General Navigation, Radio Navigation, Operational Procedures, Principles of Flight, Visual Flight Rules (VFR) Communications. FCL.315 Training Course
An applicant for a CPL(As) shall have completed theoretical knowledge instruction and ight instruction at an ATO, in accordance with Appendix 3 to Part-FCL. (refer to 5 Additional Information). FCL.320 Skill Test
An applicant for a CPL(As) shall pass a skill test in accordance with Appendix 4 to Part-FCL to demonstrate the ability to perform, as PIC of airships, the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with the competency appropriate to the privileges granted.
5
5.1
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1, 1.2. For information relating to training courses for the issue of a CPL(As); refer to CAP804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3, paragraph L, M or N as appropriate.
Section 4 Part D, Subpart 3 Page 2
5.2
May 2012
Part E
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA MPL may exercise the privileges of the licence to y EASA Aeroplanes registered in the EU.
2 Privileges
EASA MPL The privileges and conditions of the EASA MPL are dened in FCL.405.A as follows: FCL.405.A MPL Privileges (a) The privileges of the holder of an MPL are to act as co-pilot in an aeroplane required to be operated with a co-pilot. (b) The holder of an MPL may obtain the extra privileges of: (1) the holder of a PPL(A), provided that the requirements for the PPL(A) specied in Subpart C are met; (2) a CPL(A), provided that the requirements specied in FCL.325.A are met. (c) The holder of an MPL shall have the privileges of his/her IR (A) limited to aeroplanes required to be operated with a co-pilot. The privileges of the IR (A) may be extended to single-pilot operations in aeroplanes, provided that the licence holder has completed the training necessary to act as PIC in single-pilot operations exercised solely by reference to instruments and passed the skill test of the IR (A) as a single-pilot.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA MPL shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.400 MPL Minimum Age FCL.405.A MPL Privileges FCL.410.A MPL Training Course and Theoretical Knowledge Examinations FCL.415.A MPL Practical Skill For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the MPL shall hold a valid Class 1 medical certicate. FCL.400 MPL Minimum Age
Applicants for an MPL shall be at least 18 years of age. FCL.405.A MPL Privileges As above.
May 2012
FCL.410.A MPL Training Course and Theoretical Knowledge Examinations (a) Course. An applicant for an MPL shall have completed a training course of theoretical knowledge and ight instruction at an ATO in accordance with Appendix 5 to this Part. (Refer to 5 Additional Information to this Part.) (b) Examination. An applicant for an MPL shall have demonstrated a level of knowledge appropriate to the holder of an ATPL (A), in accordance with FCL.515, and of a multi-pilot type rating. (Refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part F, Subpart 1, paragraph 3) FCL.415.A MPL Practical Skill (a) An applicant for an MPL shall have demonstrated through continuous assessment the skills required for fullling all the competency units specied in Appendix 5 to Part-FCL, as pilot ying and pilot not ying, in a multi-engine turbine-powered multi-pilot aeroplane, under VFR and IFR. (b) On completion of the training course, the applicant shall pass a skill test in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL, to demonstrate the ability to perform the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with the competency appropriate to the privileges granted. The skill test shall be taken in the type of aeroplane used on the advanced phase of the MPL integrated training course or in an FFS representing the same type.
Additional Information
For information relating to training courses for the issue of an MPL; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 5.
May 2012
Part F
2 Privileges
EASA ATPL Aeroplanes The privileges and conditions of the EASA ATPL(A) are dened in FCL.505 as follows: FCL.505 ATPL Privileges
(a) The privileges of the holder of an ATPL(A) are, within the aeroplane category, to: (1) exercise all the privileges of the holder of an LAPL(A), a PPL(A) and a CPL(A); (2) act as PIC of aeroplanes engaged in commercial air transport. (b) Applicants for the issue of an ATPL(A) shall have fullled the requirements for the type rating of the aeroplane used in the skill test. Non-EASA aeroplanes Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA ATPL(A) to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA aeroplanes.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA ATPL(A) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.500 FCL.505 FCL.505.A FCL.510.A FCL.515 FCL.520.A Minimum Age Privileges and Conditions ATPL(A) Restriction of privileges for pilots previously holding an MPL ATPL(A) Prerequisites, experience and crediting Training Course and Theoretical Knowledge Examinations ATPL(A) Skill Test
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the ATPL(A) shall hold a valid Class 1 medical certicate.
May 2012
FCL.500
Minimum Age
Applicants for an ATPL(A) shall be at least 21 years of age. FCL.505 As above. FCL.505.A ATPL(A) Restriction of privileges for pilots previously holding an MPL When the holder of an ATPL(A) has previously held only an MPL, the privileges of the licence shall be restricted to multi-pilot operations, unless the holder has complied with FCL.405.A (b)(2) and (c) for single-pilot operations. (Refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part E) FCL.510.A ATPL(A) Prerequisites, experience and crediting (a) Prerequisites. Applicants for an ATPL(A) shall hold: (1) an MPL; or (2) a CPL(A) and a multi-engine IR for aeroplanes. In this case, the applicant shall also have received instruction in MCC. (b) Experience. Applicants for an ATPL(A) shall have completed a minimum of 1500 hours of ight time in aeroplanes, including at least: (1) 500 hours in multi-pilot operations on aeroplanes; (2) (i) 500 hours as PIC under supervision; or (ii) 250 hours as PIC; or (iii) 250 hours, including at least 70 hours as PIC, and the remaining as PIC under supervision; (3) 200 hours of cross-country ight time of which at least 100 hours shall be as PIC or as PIC under supervision; (4) 75 hours of instrument time of which not more than 30 hours may be instrument ground time; and (5) 100 hours of night ight as PIC or co-pilot. Of the 1500 hours of ight time, up to 100 hours of ight time may have been completed in an FFS and FNPT. Of these 100 hours, only a maximum of 25 hours may be completed in an FNPT. (c) Crediting. (1) Holders of a pilot licence for other categories of aircraft shall be credited with ight time up to a maximum of: (i) for TMG or sailplanes, 30 hours own as PIC; (ii) for helicopters, 50% of all the ight time requirements of paragraph (b) (2) Holders of a ight engineer licence issued in accordance with applicable national rules shall be credited with 50% of the ight engineer time up to a maximum credit of 250 hours. These 250 hours may be credited against the 1500 hours requirement of paragraph (a), and the 500 hours requirement of paragraph (b)(1), provided that the total credit given against any of these paragraphs does not exceed 250 hours. (d) The experience required in (b) shall be completed before the skill test for the ATPL(A) is taken. Privileges and Conditions
May 2012
FCL.515
(a) Course. Applicants for an ATPL(A) shall have completed a training course at an ATO. The course shall be either an integrated training course or a modular course, in accordance with Appendix 3 to this Part. (Refer to 1.5 Additional Information) (b) Examination. Applicants for an ATPL(A) shall demonstrate a level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted in the following subjects: Air Law, Aircraft General Knowledge Airframe/Systems/Power plant, Aircraft General Knowledge Instrumentation, Mass and Balance, Flight Planning and Monitoring, Human Performance, General Navigation, Radio Navigation, Operational Procedures, Principles of Flight, VFR Communications, IFR Communications.
Performance,
Meteorology,
FCL.520.A ATPL(A) Skill Test Applicants for an ATPL(A) shall pass a skill test in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL to demonstrate the ability to perform, as PIC of a multi-pilot aeroplane under IFR, the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with the competency appropriate to the privileges granted. The skill test shall be taken in the aeroplane or an adequately qualied FFS representing the same type.
5
5.1
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1, 1.3. For information relating to training courses for the issue of a ATPL(A); refer to CAP804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3, paragraph A or B as appropriate.
5.2
May 2012
2 Privileges
EASA Helicopters The privileges and conditions of the EASA ATPL(H) are dened in FCL.505 as follows: FCL.505 ATPL Privileges
(a) The privileges of the holder of an ATPL(H) are, within the helicopter category, to: (1) exercise all the privileges of the holder of a LAPL(H), a PPL(H) and a CPL(H); (2) act as PIC of helicopters engaged in commercial air transport. (b) Applicants for the issue of an ATPL(H) shall have fullled the requirements for the type rating of the helicopter used in the skill test. Non-EASA Helicopters Non-EASA helicopter type ratings cannot be added to an EASA licence. For the addition of a non-EASA helicopter type rating, a pilot will require a UK national licence with the Non-EASA type rating.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA ATPL(H) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.500 FCL.505 FCL.510.H FCL.515 FCL.520.H Minimum Age Privileges and Conditions ATPL(H) Prerequisites, experience and crediting Training Course and Theoretical Knowledge Examinations ATPL(H) Skill Test
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). Part-MED stipulates that applicants for and holders of the ATPL(H) shall hold a valid Class 1 medical certicate.
May 2012
FCL.500
Minimum Age
Applicants for an ATPL(H) shall be at least 21 years of age. FCL.505 As above. FCL.510.H ATPL(H) Prerequisites, experience and crediting Applicants for an ATPL(H) shall: (a) hold a CPL(H) and a multi-pilot helicopter type rating and have received instruction in MCC; (b) have completed as a pilot of helicopters a minimum of 1000 hours of ight time including at least: (1) 350 hours in multi-pilot helicopters; (2) (i) 250 hours as PIC; or (ii) 100 hours as PIC and 150 hours as PIC under supervision; or (iii) 250 hours as PIC under supervision in multi-pilot helicopters. In this case, the ATPL(H) privileges shall be limited to multi-pilot operations only, until 100 hours as PIC have been completed; (3) 200 hours of cross-country ight time of which at least 100 hours shall be as PIC or as PIC under supervision; (4) 30 hours of instrument time of which not more than 10 hours may be instrument ground time; and (5) 100 hours of night ight as PIC or as co-pilot. Of the 1000 hours, a maximum of 100 hours may have been completed in an FSTD, of which not more than 25 hours may be completed in an FNPT. (c) Flight time in aeroplanes shall be credited up to 50% against the ight time requirements of paragraph (b). (d) The experience required in (b) shall be completed before the skill test for the ATPL(H) is taken. FCL.515 Training Course and Theoretical Knowledge Examinations Privileges and Conditions
(a) Course. Applicants for an ATPL(H) shall have completed a training course at an ATO. The course shall be either an integrated training course or a modular course, in accordance with Appendix 3 to this Part. (Refer to 1.5 Additional Information.) (b) Examination. Applicants for an ATPL(H) shall demonstrate a level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted in the following subjects: Air Law, Aircraft General Knowledge Airframe/Systems/Power plant, Aircraft General Knowledge Instrumentation, Mass and Balance, Performance, Flight Planning and Monitoring, Human Performance,
May 2012
Meteorology, General Navigation, Radio Navigation, Operational Procedures, Principles of Flight, VFR Communications, IFR Communications. FCL.520.H ATPL(H) Skill Test Applicants for an ATPL(H) shall pass a skill test in accordance with Appendix 9 to PartFCL to demonstrate the ability to perform as PIC of a multi-pilot helicopter the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with the competency appropriate to the privileges granted. The skill test shall be taken in the helicopter or an adequately qualied FFS representing the same type.
5
5.1
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1, 1.3. For information relating to training courses for the issue of a ATPL(H); refer to CAP804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3, paragraph F, G or H as appropriate.
5.2
May 2012
Part G Subpart 1
EASA Instrument Rating (IR) EASA Instrument Rating for Aeroplanes IR(A)
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA IR(A) may exercise the privileges of the rating to y EASA aeroplanes registered in the EU and non-EASA aeroplanes registered in the UK that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence.
2 Privileges
EASA Instrument Rating Aeroplanes The privileges and conditions of the EASA IR(A) are dened in FCL.605 as follows: FCL.605 IR Privileges
(a) The privileges of a holder of an IR are to y aeroplanes under IFR with a minimum decision height of 200 feet (60 m). (b) In the case of a multi-engine IR, these privileges may be extended to decision heights lower than 200 feet (60 m) when the applicant has undergone specic training at an ATO and has passed section 6 of the skill test prescribed in Appendix 9 to this Part in multi-pilot aeroplanes. (c) Holders of an IR shall exercise their privileges in accordance with the conditions established in Appendix 8 to Part-FCL. Non-EASA aeroplanes Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA IR(A) to be valid with the same privileges for non-EASA aeroplanes.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA IR (A) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.600 General FCL.605 FCL.610 FCL.615 FCL.620 FCL.625 FCL.625.A IR(A) Privileges IR(A) Prerequisites, experience and crediting IR(A) Theoretical Knowledge Examinations and Flight Instruction IR(A) Skill Test IR(A) Validity, revalidation and renewal IR(A) Revalidation
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011).
May 2012
FCL.600 General Operations under IFR on an aeroplane shall only be conducted by holders of a PPL, CPL, MPL and ATPL with an IR on aeroplanes or when undergoing skill testing or dual instruction. FCL.605 As above. FCL.610 IR(A) Prerequisites, experience and crediting IR(A) Privileges
Applicants for an IR shall: (a) hold: (1) at least a PPL(A), and: (i) the privileges to y at night in accordance with FCL.810 i; or (ii) an ATPL in another category of aircraft; or (2) a CPL(A). (b) have completed at least 50 hours of cross-country ight time as PIC in aeroplanes, helicopters or airships of which at least 10 hours shall be in aeroplanes. FCL.615 IR(A) Theoretical Knowledge Examinations and Flight Instruction
(a) Course. Applicants for an IR shall have received a course of theoretical knowledge and ight instruction at an ATO. The course shall be: (1) an integrated training course which includes training for the IR, in accordance with Appendix 3 to Part-FCL (refer to CAP 804, Section4, PartL, Appendix 3); or (2) a modular course in accordance with Appendix 6 to Part-FCL,(refer to CAP804, Section 4, PartL, Appendix 6). (b) Examination. Applicants shall demonstrate a level of theoretical knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted in the following subjects: Air Law, Aircraft General Knowledge Instrumentation, Flight Performance and Monitoring, Human Performance, Radio Navigation, IFR Communications. IR(A) Skill Test
Meteorology,
FCL.620
(a) Applicants for an IR(A) shall pass a skill test in accordance with Appendix 7 to PartFCL to demonstrate the ability to perform the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with a degree of competency appropriate to the privileges granted.
27 July 2012
(b) For a multi-engine IR(A), the skill test shall be taken in a multi-engine aeroplane. For a single-engine IR, the test shall be taken in a single-engine aeroplane. A multiengine centerline thrust aeroplane shall be considered a single-engine aeroplane for the purposes of this paragraph. FCL.625 IR(A) Validity, revalidation and renewal
(a) Validity. An IR(A) shall be valid for 1 year. (b) Revalidation (1) An IR(A) shall be revalidated within the 3 months immediately preceding the expiry date of the rating. (2) Applicants who fail to pass the relevant section of an IR(A) prociency check before the expiry date of the IR(A) shall not exercise the IR(A) privileges until they have passed the prociency check. (c) Renewal. If an IR(A) has expired, in order to renew their privileges applicants shall: (1) go through refresher training at an ATO to reach the level of prociency needed to pass the instrument element of the skill test in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL; and (2) complete a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL, in an aeroplane. (d) If the IR(A) has not been revalidated or renewed within the preceding 7 years, the holder will be required to pass again the IR theoretical knowledge examination and skill test. *The UK CAA has issued an exemption against FCL.625(d) (see paragraph 5.3) FCL.625.A IR (A) Revalidation (a) Revalidation. Applicants for the revalidation of an IR(A): (1) when combined with the revalidation of a class or type rating, shall pass a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL; (2) when not combined with the revalidation of a class or type rating, shall: (i) for single-pilot aeroplanes, complete section 3b and those parts of section 1 relevant to the intended ight, of the prociency check prescribed in Appendix 9 to Part-FCL; and (ii) for multi-engine aeroplanes, complete section 6 of the prociency check for single-pilot aeroplanes in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL by sole reference to instruments. (3) An FNPT II or an FFS representing the relevant class or type of aeroplane may be used in the case of paragraph (2), but at least each alternate prociency check for the revalidation of an IR(A) in these circumstances shall be performed in an aeroplane. (b) Cross-credit shall be given in accordance with Appendix 8 to Part-FCL.
15 October 2013
5
5.1
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1, A 4. For information relating to training courses for the issue of an IR(A); refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 6, A. FCL.625(d): IR Renewal requirement for pilots who hold or have held an IR on another licence or a UK Military Green Rating The UK CAA has issued an exemption such that where a pilot holds or has held an Instrument Rating issued by a third country and that rating is compliant with Annex I to the Convention on International Civil Aviation, the applicability of FCL.625 IR(c) and (d) may be based on the validity dates of the Instrument Rating of that other country. The effect of this exemption is that to renew the IR on a UK issued licence: (i) a pilot with a current and valid 3rd country IR shall complete the revalidation requirements of FCL.625(b) and the aircraft category specic requirements for revalidation of the Part-FCL IR; meaning that he must pass the prociency check, but is not required to undergo training or to re-take the theoretical knowledge examinations; or (ii) a pilot who held a 3rd country IR that is no longer valid but had been revalidated or renewed within the preceding 7 years shall comply with the renewal requirements of FCL.625 IR(c), but is not required to re-take the theoretical knowledge examinations.
5.2 5.3
The UK CAA has published equivalent terms for holders of a United Kingdom Unrestricted Military Green Rating, Refer to Section 4, Part O for full information.
15 October 2013
Subpart 2
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA IR(H) may exercise the privileges of the rating to y EASA Helicopters registered in the EU.
2 Privileges
EASA Instrument Rating Helicopter The privileges and conditions of the EASA IR(H) are dened in FCL.605 as follows: FCL.605 IR Privileges
(a) The privileges of a holder of an IR(H) are to y helicopters under IFR with a minimum decision height of 200 feet (60 m). (b) In the case of a multi-engine IR, these privileges may be extended to decision heights lower than 200 feet (60 m) when the applicant has undergone specic training at an ATO and has passed section 6 of the skill test prescribed in Appendix 9 to Part-FCL in multi-pilot helicopters. (c) Holders of an IR(H) shall exercise their privileges in accordance with the conditions established in Appendix 8 to Part-FCL. (d) To exercise privileges as PIC under IFR in multi-pilot helicopters, the holder of an IR(H) shall have at least 70 hours of instrument time of which up to 30 hours may be instrument ground time. Non-EASA Helicopters Non-EASA helicopter type ratings and associated instrument ratings cannot be added to an EASA licence. For the addition of a non-EASA helicopter rating, a pilot will require a UK national licence with the Non-EASA rating.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA IR(A) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.600 General FCL.605 FCL.610 FCL.615 FCL.620 FCL.625 FCL.625.H FCL.630.H IR(H) Privileges IR(H) Prerequisites, experience and crediting IR(H) Theoretical Knowledge Examinations and Flight Instruction IR(H) Skill Test IR(H) Validity, revalidation and renewal IR(H) Revalidation IR(H) Extension of privileges from single-engine to multi-engine helicopters
May 2012
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.600 General Operations under IFR on a helicopter shall only be conducted by holders of a PPL(H), CPL(H), or ATPL(H) with an IR on helicopters or when undergoing skill testing or dual instruction. FCL.605 As above. FCL.610 IR(H) Prerequisites, experience and crediting IR(H) Privileges
Applicants for an IR shall: (a) hold: (1) at least a PPL(H), and: (i) the privileges to y at night in accordance with FCL.810 i; or (ii) an ATPL in another category of aircraft; or (2) a CPL(H). (b) have completed at least 50 hours of cross-country ight time as PIC in aeroplanes, helicopters or airships of which at least 10 hours shall be in helicopters. (c) Applicants who have completed an ATP(H)/IR, ATP(H), CPL(H)/IR or CPL(H) integrated training course shall be exempted from the requirement in (b). FCL.615 IR(H) Theoretical Knowledge Examinations and Flight Instruction
(a) Course. Applicants for an IR shall have received a course of theoretical knowledge and ight instruction at an ATO. The course shall be: (1) an integrated training course which includes training for the IR, in accordance with Appendix 3 to Part-FCL (refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 3); or (2) a modular course in accordance with Appendix 6 to Part-FCL,(refer to CAP804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 6). (b) Examination. Applicants shall demonstrate a level of theoretical knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted in the following subjects: Air Law, Aircraft General Knowledge Instrumentation, Flight Performance and Monitoring, Human Performance, Radio Navigation, IFR Communications.
Meteorology,
27 July 2012
FCL.620
(a) Applicants for an IR(H) shall pass a skill test in accordance with Appendix 7 to PartFCL to demonstrate the ability to perform the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with a degree of competency appropriate to the privileges granted. (b) For a multi-engine IR(H), the skill test shall be taken in a multi-engine helicopter. For a single-engine IR(H), the test shall be taken in a single-engine helicopter. FCL.625 IR(H) Validity, revalidation and renewal
(a) Validity. An IR(H) shall be valid for 1 year. (b) Revalidation (1) An IR(H) shall be revalidated within the 3 months immediately preceding the expiry date of the rating. (2) Applicants who fail to pass the relevant section of an IR(H) prociency check before the expiry date of the IR(H) shall not exercise the IR (H) privileges until they have passed the prociency check. (c) Renewal. If an IR(H) has expired, in order to renew their privileges applicants shall: (1) go through refresher training at an ATO to reach the level of prociency needed to pass the instrument element of the skill test in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL; and (2) complete a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL, in a helicopter. (d) If the IR(H) has not been revalidated or renewed within the preceding 7 years, the holder will be required to pass again the IR theoretical knowledge examination and skill test. The UK CAA has issued an exemption against FCL.625(d), see paragraph 5.3. FCL.625.H IR(H) Revalidation (a) Applicants for the revalidation of an IR(H): (1) when combined with the revalidation of a type rating, shall complete a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to this Part, for the relevant type of helicopter. (2) when not combined with the revalidation of a type rating, shall complete only section 5 and the relevant parts of section 1 of the prociency check established in Appendix 9 to Part-FCL for the relevant type of helicopter. In this case, an FTD II/III or an FFS representing the relevant type of helicopter may be used, but at least each alternate prociency check for the revalidation of an IR(H) in these circumstances shall be performed in a helicopter. (b) Cross-credit shall be given in accordance with Appendix 8 to Part-FCL. FCL.630.H IR(H) Extension of privileges from single-engine to multi-engine helicopters Holders of an IR(H) valid for single-engine helicopters wishing to extend for the rst time the IR(H) to multi-engine helicopters shall complete: (a) a training course at an ATO comprising at least 5 hours dual instrument instruction time, of which 3 hours may be in an FFS or FTD 2/3 or FNPT II/III; and (b) section 5 of the skill test in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL on multiengine helicopters.
15 October 2013
5
5.1
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1, A 4. For information relating to training courses for the issue of an IR(H); refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 6, B. FCL.625(d): IR Renewal requirement for pilots who hold or have held an IR on another licence or a UK Military Green Rating The UK CAA has issued an exemption such that where a pilot holds or has held an Instrument Rating issued by a third country and that rating is compliant with Annex I to the Convention on International Civil Aviation, the applicability of FCL.625 IR(c) and (d) may be based on the validity dates of the Instrument Rating of that other country. The effect of this exemption is that to renew the IR on a UK issued licence: (i) a pilot with a current and valid 3rd country IR shall complete the revalidation requirements of FCL.625(b) and the aircraft category specic requirements for revalidation of the Part-FCL IR; meaning that he must pass the prociency check, but is not required to undergo training or to re-take the theoretical knowledge examinations; or (ii) a pilot who held a 3rd country IR that is no longer valid but had been revalidated or renewed within the preceding 7 years shall comply with the renewal requirements of FCL.625 IR(c), but is not required to re-take the theoretical knowledge examinations.
5.2 5.3
The UK CAA has published equivalent terms for holders of a United Kingdom Unrestricted Military Green Rating, Refer to Section 4, Part O for full information.
15 October 2013
Subpart 3
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA IR(As) may exercise the privileges of the rating to y EASA Airships registered in the EU and non-EASA Airships registered in the UK that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence.
2 Privileges
EASA Instrument Rating Airship The privileges and conditions of the EASA IR(As) are dened in FCL.605 as follows: FCL.605 IR Privileges
(a) The privileges of a holder of an IR(As) are to y airships under IFR with a minimum decision height of 200 feet (60 m). (b) In the case of a multi-engine IR, these privileges may be extended to decision heights lower than 200 feet (60 m) when the applicant has undergone specic training at an ATO and has passed section 6 of the skill test prescribed in Appendix 9 to Part-FCL in multi-pilot airship. (c) Holders of an IR(As) shall exercise their privileges in accordance with the conditions established in Appendix 8 to Part-FCL. Non-EASA Airships Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA IR(As) to be a valid rating with the same privileges for non-EASA Airships.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA IR(As) shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.600 General FCL.605 FCL.610 FCL.615 FCL.620 FCL.625 FCL.625.As IR (As) Privileges IR (As) Prerequisites, experience and crediting IR (As) Theoretical Knowledge Examinations and Flight Instruction IR (As) Skill Test IR (As) Validity, revalidation and renewal IR (As) Revalidation
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011).
May 2012
FCL.600 General Operations under IFR on an airship shall only be conducted by holders of a PPL(As) or a CPL(As) with an IR on airships or when undergoing skill testing or dual instruction. FCL.605 As above. FCL.610 IR(As) Prerequisites, experience and crediting IR(As) Privileges
Applicants for an IR shall: (a) hold: (1) at least a PPL(As), and: (i) the privileges to y at night in accordance with FCL.810 i (Refer to CAP 804,Section 4,Part I) ; or (ii) an ATPL in another category of aircraft; or (2) a CPL(As). (b) have completed at least 50 hours of cross-country ight time as PIC in aeroplanes, helicopters or airships of which at least 20 hours shall be in airships. FCL.615 IR(As) Theoretical Knowledge Examinations and Flight Instruction
(a) Course. Applicants for an IR(As) shall have received a course of theoretical knowledge and ight instruction at an ATO. The course shall be: (1) an integrated training course which includes training for the IR(As), in accordance with Appendix 3 to Part-FCL (refer to CAP 804, Section 4, PartL, Appendix 3); or (2) a modular course in accordance with Appendix 6 to Part-FCL,(refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 6). (b) Examination. Applicants shall demonstrate a level of theoretical knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted in the following subjects: Air Law, Aircraft General Knowledge Instrumentation, Flight Performance and Monitoring, Human Performance, Meteorology, Radio Navigation, IFR Communications. FCL.620 IR(As) Skill Test
(a) Applicants for an IR(As) shall pass a skill test in accordance with Appendix 7 to Part-FCL to demonstrate the ability to perform the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with a degree of competency appropriate to the privileges granted. (b) For a multi-engine IR(As), the skill test shall be taken in a multi-engine airship. For a single-engine IR(As), the test shall be taken in a single-engine airship.
27 July 2012
FCL.625
(a) Validity. An IR(As) shall be valid for 1 year. (b) Revalidation (1) An IR(As) shall be revalidated within the 3 months immediately preceding the expiry date of the rating. (2) Applicants who fail to pass the relevant section of an IR(As) prociency check before the expiry date of the IR (As) shall not exercise the IR (As) privileges until they have passed the prociency check. (c) Renewal. If an IR(As) has expired, in order to renew their privileges applicants shall: (1) go through refresher training at an ATO to reach the level of prociency needed to pass the instrument element of the skill test in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL; and (2) complete a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL, in an airship. (d) If the IR(As) has not been revalidated or renewed within the preceding 7 years, the holder will be required to pass again the IR theoretical knowledge examination and skill test. The UK CAA has issued an exemption against FCL.625(d), see paragraph 5.3. FCL.625.As IR(As) Revalidation Applicants for the revalidation of an IR(As): (a) when combined with the revalidation of a type rating, shall complete a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL, for the relevant type of airship; (b) when not combined with the revalidation of a type rating, shall complete section 5 and those parts of section 1 relevant to the intended ight of the prociency check for airships in accordance with Appendix 9 of part-FCL. In this case, an FTD 2/3 or FFS representing the relevant type may be used, but at least each alternate prociency check for the revalidation of an IR(As) in these circumstances shall be performed in an airship.
5
5.1
Additional Information
For information relating to crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilots licence in another category of aircraft, bridge instruction and examination requirements; refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 1, 1.4. For information relating to training courses for the issue of an IR(As); refer to CAP 804, Section 4, Part L, Appendix 6, paragraph 3.
5.2
15 October 2013
5.3
FCL.625(d): IR Renewal requirement for pilots who hold or have held an IR on another licence or a UK Military Green Rating The UK CAA has issued an exemption such that where a pilot holds or has held an Instrument Rating issued by a third country and that rating is compliant with Annex I to the Convention on International Civil Aviation, the applicability of FCL.625 IR(c) and (d) may be based on the validity dates of the Instrument Rating of that other country. The effect of this exemption is that to renew the IR on a UK issued licence: (i) a pilot with a current and valid 3rd country IR shall complete the revalidation requirements of FCL.625(b) and the aircraft category specic requirements for revalidation of the Part-FCL IR; meaning that he must pass the prociency check, but is not required to undergo training or to re-take the theoretical knowledge examinations; or (ii) a pilot who held a 3rd country IR that is no longer valid but had been revalidated or renewed within the preceding 7 years shall comply with the renewal requirements of FCL.625 IR(c), but is not required to re-take the theoretical knowledge examinations.
The UK CAA has published equivalent terms for holders of a United Kingdom Unrestricted Military Green Rating, Refer to Section 4, Part O for full information.
15 October 2013
Part H Subpart 1
Class and Type Ratings EASA Class and Type Ratings for Aeroplanes
1 Applicability
This section sets out the requirements for Class and Type ratings included in EASA licences for Aeroplanes.
2 Privileges
EASA Class and Type Rating Aeroplanes The privileges and conditions of the EASA Class or Type Rating are dened in FCL.705 as follows: FCL.705 Privileges of the holder of a class or type rating
The privileges of the holder of a class or type rating are to act as pilot on the class or type of aeroplane specied in the rating. In the case of a Class rating, Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA licence and Class ratings valid with the same privileges for non-EASA Aeroplanes.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA Class or Type rating shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.700 FCL.705 FCL.710 FCL.720.A FCL.725 FCL.725.A FCL.730.A FCL.735.A FCL.740 FCL.740.A Circumstances in which class or type ratings are required Privileges of the holder of a class or type rating Class and type ratings variants Experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of class or type ratings aeroplanes Requirements for the issue of class and type ratings Theoretical knowledge and ight instruction for the issue of class and type ratings aeroplanes Specic requirements for pilots undertaking a zero ight time type rating (ZFTT) course aeroplanes Multi-crew cooperation training course aeroplanes Validity and renewal of class and type ratings Revalidation of class and type ratings - aeroplanes
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011).
May 2012 Section 4 Part H, Subpart 1 Page 1
FCL.700
(a) Holders of a pilot licence for aeroplanes shall not act in any capacity as pilot of an aeroplane unless they have a valid and appropriate class or type rating, except when undergoing skill tests, or prociency checks for renewal of class or type ratings, or receiving ight instruction. (b) Notwithstanding (a), in the case of ights related to the introduction or modication of aircraft types, pilots may hold a special certicate given by the competent authority, authorising them to perform the ights. This authorisation shall have its validity limited to the specic ights. (c) Without prejudice to (a) and (b), in the case of ights related to the introduction or modication of aircraft types conducted by design or production organisations within the scope of their privileges, as well as instruction ights for the issue of a ight test rating, when the requirements of this Subpart may not be complied with, pilots may hold a ight test rating issued in accordance with FCL.820. FCL.705 As above. FCL.710 Class and type ratings variants Privileges of the holder of a class or type rating
(a) In order to extend his/her privileges to another variant of aeroplane within one class or type rating, the pilot shall undertake differences or familiarisation training. In the case of variants within a type rating, the differences or familiarisation training shall include the relevant elements dened in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21. (b) If the variant has not been own within a period of 2 years following the differences training, further differences training or a prociency check in that variant shall be required to maintain the privileges, except for types or variants within the singleengine piston and TMG class ratings. (c) The differences training shall be entered in the pilots logbook or equivalent record and signed by the instructor as appropriate. FCL.720.A Experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of class or type ratings aeroplanes Unless otherwise determined in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21, an applicant for a class or type rating shall comply with the following experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of the relevant rating: (a) Single-pilot multi-engine aeroplanes. An applicant for a rst class or type rating on a single-pilot multi-engine aeroplane shall have completed at least 70 hours as PIC on aeroplanes. (b) Single-pilot high performance non-complex aeroplanes. Before starting ight training, an applicant for a rst class or type rating for a single-pilot aeroplane classied as a high performance aeroplane shall: (1) have at least 200 hours of total ying experience, of which 70 hours as PIC on aeroplanes; and
May 2012
(2) (i) hold a certicate of satisfactory completion of a course for additional theoretical knowledge undertaken at an ATO; or (ii) have passed the ATPL(A) theoretical knowledge examinations in accordance with Part-FCL; or (iii) hold, in addition to a licence issued in accordance with Part-FCL, an ATPL(A) or CPL(A)/IR with theoretical knowledge credit for ATPL(A), issued in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention; (3) in addition, pilots seeking the privilege to operate the aeroplane in multi-pilot operations shall meet the requirements of (d)(3). (c) Single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes. Applicants for the issue of a rst type rating for a complex single-pilot aeroplane classied as a high performance aeroplane shall, in addition to meeting the requirements of (b), have fullled the requirements for a multi-engine IR(A), as established in SubpartG. (d) Multi-pilot aeroplanes. An applicant for the rst type rating course for a multi-pilot aeroplane shall be a student pilot currently undergoing training on an MPL training course or comply with the following requirements: (1) have at least 70 hours of ight experience as PIC on aeroplanes; (2) hold a multi-engine IR(A); (3) have passed the ATPL(A) theoretical knowledge examinations in accordance with this Part; and (4) except when the type rating course is combined with an MCC course: (i) hold a certicate of satisfactory completion of an MCC course in aeroplanes; or (ii) hold a certicate of satisfactory completion of MCC in helicopters and have more than 100 hours of ight experience as a pilot on multi-pilot helicopters; or (iii) have at least 500 hours as a pilot on multi-pilot helicopters; or (iv) have at least 500 hours as a pilot in multi-pilot operations on single-pilot multi-engine aeroplanes, in commercial air transport in accordance with the applicable air operations requirements. (e) Notwithstanding paragraph (d), a Member State may issue a type rating with restricted privileges for multi pilot aeroplane that allows the holder of such rating to act as a cruise relief co-pilot above Flight Level 200, provided that two other members of the crew have a type rating in accordance with paragraph (d) . (f) Additional multi-pilot and single-pilot high performance complex aeroplane type ratings. An applicant for the issue of additional multi-pilot type ratings and singlepilot high performance complex aeroplanes type ratings shall hold a multi-engine IR(A). (g) When so determined in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21, the exercise of the privileges of a type rating may be initially limited to ight under the supervision of an instructor. The ight hours under supervision shall be entered in the pilots logbook or equivalent record and signed by the instructor. The limitation shall be removed when the pilot demonstrates that the hours of ight under supervision required by the operational suitability data have been completed.
May 2012
FCL.725
(a) Training course. An applicant for a class or type rating shall complete a training course at an ATO. The type rating training course shall include the mandatory training elements for the relevant type as dened in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21. (b) Theoretical knowledge examination. The applicant for a class or type rating shall pass a theoretical knowledge examination organised by the ATO to demonstrate the level of theoretical knowledge required for the safe operation of the applicable aircraft class or type. (1) For multi-pilot aeroplanes, the theoretical knowledge examination shall be written and comprise at least 100 multiple-choice questions distributed appropriately across the main subjects of the syllabus. (2) For single-pilot multi-engine aeroplanes, the theoretical knowledge examination shall be written and the number of multiple-choice questions shall depend on the complexity of the aircraft. (3) For single-engine aeroplanes, the theoretical knowledge examination shall be conducted verbally by the examiner during the skill test to determine whether or not a satisfactory level of knowledge has been achieved. (4) For single-pilot aeroplanes that are classied as high performance aeroplanes, the examination shall be written and comprise at least 60 multiple-choice questions distributed appropriately across the main subjects of the syllabus. (c) Skill test. An applicant for a class or type rating shall pass a skill test in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL to demonstrate the skill required for the safe operation of the applicable class or type of aeroplane. The applicant shall pass the skill test within a period of 6 months after commencement of the class or type rating training course and within a period of 6 months preceding the application for the issue of the class or type rating. (d) An applicant who already holds a type rating for an aeroplane type, with the privilege for either single-pilot or multi-pilot operations, shall be considered to have already fullled the theoretical requirements when applying to add the privilege for the other form of operation on the same aeroplane type. (e) Notwithstanding the paragraphs above, pilots holding a ight test rating issued in accordance with FCL.820 who were involved in development, certication or production ight tests for an aeroplane type, and have completed either 50 hours of total ight time or 10 hours of ight time as PIC on test ights in that type, shall be entitled to apply for the issue of the relevant type rating, provided that they comply with the experience requirements and the prerequisites for the issue of that type rating, as established in this Subpart for aeroplanes. FCL.725.A Theoretical knowledge and ight instruction for the issue of class and type ratings aeroplanes Unless otherwise determined in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21: (a) Single-pilot multi-engine aeroplanes. (1) The theoretical knowledge course for a single-pilot multi-engine class rating shall include at least 7 hours of instruction in multi-engine aeroplane operations.
May 2012
(2) The ight training course for a single-pilot multi-engine class or type rating shall include at least 2 hours and 30 minutes of dual ight instruction under normal conditions of multi-engine aeroplane operations, and not less than 3hours 30 minutes of dual ight instruction in engine failure procedures and asymmetric ight techniques. (b) Single-pilot aeroplanessea. The training course for single-pilot aeroplanesea ratings shall include theoretical knowledge and ight instruction. The ight training for a class or type rating-sea for single-pilot aeroplanes-sea shall include at least 8 hours of dual ight instruction if the applicant holds the land version of the relevant class or type rating, or 10 hours if the applicant does not hold such a rating. FCL.730.A Specic requirements for pilots undertaking a zero ight time type rating (ZFTT) course aeroplanes (a) A pilot undertaking instruction at a ZFTT course shall have completed, on a multipilot turbo-jet aeroplane certicated to the standards of CS-25 or equivalent airworthiness code or on a multi-pilot turbo-prop aeroplane having a maximum certicated take-off mass of not less than 10 tonnes or a certicated passenger seating conguration of more than 19 passengers, at least: (1) if an FFS qualied to level CG, C or interim C is used during the course, 1500 hours ight time or 250 route sectors; (2) if an FFS qualied to level DG or D is used during the course, 500 hours ight time or 100 route sectors. (b) When a pilot is changing from a turbo-prop to a turbo-jet aeroplane or from a turbojet to a turbo-prop aeroplane, additional simulator training shall be required. FCL.735.A Multi-crew cooperation training course aeroplanes (a) The MCC training course shall comprise at least: (1) 25 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction and exercises; and (2) 20 hours of practical MCC training, or 15 hours in the case of student pilots attending an ATP integrated course. An FNPT II MCC or an FFS shall be used. When the MCC training is combined with initial type rating training, the practical MCC training may be reduced to no less than 10 hours if the same FFS is used for both the MCC and type rating training. (b) The MCC training course shall be completed within 6 months at an ATO. (c) Unless the MCC course has been combined with a type rating course, on completion of the MCC training course the applicant shall be given a certicate of completion. (d) An applicant having completed MCC training for any other category of aircraft shall be exempted from the requirement in (a)(1). FCL.740 Validity and renewal of class and type ratings
(a) The period of validity of class and type ratings shall be 1 year, except for singlepilot single-engine class ratings, for which the period of validity shall be 2 years, unless otherwise determined by the operational suitability data, established in accordance with Part-21.
May 2012
(b) Renewal. If a class or type rating has expired, the applicant shall: (1) take refresher training at an ATO, when necessary to reach the level of prociency necessary to safely operate the relevant class or type of aeroplane; and (2) pass a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL. FCL.740.A Revalidation of class and type ratings aeroplanes (a) Revalidation of multi-engine class ratings and type ratings. For revalidation of multi-engine class ratings and type ratings, the applicant shall: (1) pass a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL in the relevant class or type of aeroplane or an FSTD representing that class or type, within the 3 months immediately preceding the expiry date of the rating; and (2) complete during the period of validity of the rating, at least: (i) 10 route sectors as pilot of the relevant class or type of aeroplane; or (ii) 1 route sector as pilot of the relevant class or type of aeroplane or FFS, own with an examiner. This route sector may be own during the prociency check. (3) A pilot working for a commercial air transport operator approved in accordance with the applicable air operations requirements who has passed the operators prociency check combined with the prociency check for the revalidation of the class or type rating shall be exempted from complying with the requirement in (2). (4) The revalidation of an IR(A), if held, may be combined with a prociency check for the revalidation of a class or type rating. (b) Revalidation of single-pilot single-engine class ratings. (1) Single-engine piston aeroplane class ratings and TMG ratings. For revalidation of single-pilot single-engine piston aeroplane class ratings or TMG class ratings the applicant shall: (i) within the 3 months preceding the expiry date of the rating, pass a prociency check in the relevant class in accordance with Appendix 9 to this Part with an examiner; or (ii) within the 12 months preceding the expiry date of the rating, complete 12 hours of ight time in the relevant class, including: 6 hours as PIC; 12 take-offs and 12 landings; and a training ight of at least 1 hour with a ight instructor (FI) or a class rating instructor (CRI). Applicants shall be exempted from this ight if they have passed a class or type rating prociency check or skill test in any other class or type of aeroplane.* (2) When applicants hold both a single-engine piston aeroplane-land class rating and a TMG rating, they may complete the requirements of (1) in either class, and achieve revalidation of both ratings. (3) Single-pilot single-engine turbo-prop aeroplanes. For revalidation of singleengine turbo-prop class ratings applicants shall pass a prociency check on the relevant class in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL with an examiner, within the 3 months preceding the expiry date of the rating. * Refer to AMC 4.1 for UK Alternative Means of Compliance.
27 July 2012
(c) Applicants who fail to achieve a pass in all sections of a prociency check before the expiry date of a class or type rating shall not exercise the privileges of that rating until a pass in the prociency check has been achieved.
4.1
UK Alternative Means of Compliance with FCL.740.A(b)(1)(ii) Revalidation of single-engine class ratings. The requirements for a training ight with an FI or CRI, referred to in FCL.740.A(b)(1)(ii), may be satised by receiving instruction totalling at least 1 hour from the same instructor in the course of a maximum of three ights.
4.2
Multi-Pilot Type Rating conducted in an FSTD With the exception of courses approved for Zero Flight Time Training, certain training exercises normally involving take-off and landing in various congurations will need to be completed in the aeroplane rather than an approved Flight Simulator. This requirement is set out in AMC2-ORA.ATO.125 (k), and must be complied with prior to the rating to be included on a Part-FCL licence. AMC2-ORA.ATO.125 (k) Aeroplane Training with Full Flight Simulator With the exception of courses approved for ZFTT, certain training exercises normally involving take-off and landing in various congurations should be completed in the aeroplane rather than the FFS. For multi-pilot aeroplanes where the student pilot has more than 500 hours of MPA experience in aeroplanes of similar size and performance, these should include at least four landings of which at least one should be a full stop landing, unless otherwise specied in the OSD established in accordance with Part-21, when available. In all other cases the student should complete at least six landings. This aeroplane training may be completed after the student pilot has completed the FSTD training and has successfully undertaken the type rating skill test, provided it does not exceed two hours of the ight training course. Upon completion of simulator training and the simulator based Licence Skill Test (LST) at an approved ATO, ying in the relevant aircraft is required. This must be accomplished with an appropriately qualied TRI, within or not afliated to the ATO, before an application is submitted for rating endorsement to L&TS, in accordance with Part-FCL.725(c).
4.3 4.3.1
Guidance on Differences Training Variable Pitch (VP) Propellers (all propeller aeroplanes) These systems make a signicant difference to performance in all phases of ight. Mostly, the instruction in this section will be given to pilots converting from SEP aeroplanes with xed pitch propellers to SEP or MEP aeroplanes with VP propellers and constant speed units (CSU). The system on some older types may not include a CSU and instructors must ensure that all of the system differences and handling techniques, introduced by the new type, are properly covered in the training given. Differences Training completed, for this section, on an SEP aeroplane, does not provide equivalent qualication on MEP aeroplanes.
15 October 2013
All Aeroplanes Principle of operation and effect on performance; System construction and function; Propeller system limitations; Engine limitations and instrumentation. Operation of throttle, mixture and propeller controls, including pre-ight checks and normal handling during: Start up and taxying; Take-off and climb; Cruise at various power settings and speeds; Low speed handling and stall/spin recovery; Approach and go-around; Landing and shut down. In-ight failures, within the propeller system, including: Loss of oil pressure; Loss of governor control; Overspeed; Underspeed. Emergency handling, during: Engine failure after take-off/go-around; Engine failure during other phases of ight, including approach and landing; Effect of engine failure on glide performance. Emergency Handling Considerations for Multi-Engine Aeroplanes Engine failures after take-off including propeller feathering and effect of wind-mill drag; Circuit and approach with one or more engines inoperative; Go-around with one or more engines inoperative; Landing with one or more engines inoperative. 4.3.2 Retractable Undercarriage Differences Training completed, for this section, on an SEP aeroplane, does not provide equivalent qualication on MEP aeroplanes: Principle and effect on performance; System construction and function; Limitations raising, lowering and extended. Operation including pre-ight checks and normal handling: After take-off; On approach/go-around and landing. In-ight system failures and emergency lowering. Operation of undercarriage during: Engine failure after take-off/go-around (Emergency raising as applicable to type); Engine failure during other phases of ight, including approach and landing. Effect on glide performance.
27 July 2012
Considerations for MEP Aeroplanes: Effect on performance one or more engines inoperative. Handling during approach and landing/go-around with one or more engines inoperative. Effect on engine out allowance and landing committal height. 4.3.3 Turbo/Supercharged Engine(s) Differences Training completed, for this section, on a SEP aeroplane, does not provide equivalent qualication on MEP Aeroplanes: Principle and effect on performance, including cruise altitude; System construction and function; Engine limitations and instrumentation. Engine handling including pre-ight checks and normal operation during: Start up and taxying; Take-off and climb; Cruise at various power settings and speeds; Low speed handling and stall/spin recovery; Approach and go-around; Landing and shut down. In-ight failures and emergency handling; Single-Engine Stabilising Altitude (ME only). 4.3.4 Cabin Pressurisation and Oxygen Systems Differences Training completed, for this section, on an SEP aeroplane, does not provide equivalent qualication on MEP aeroplanes: Principle and effect on performance; Construction; System function including associated environmental heating and air conditioning systems; Oxygen system - storage capacity, pre-ight checks, system function (passengers and crew); Systems Limitations; Human Limitations including hypoxia and period of useful consciousness. Operations at high altitude including: Airspace classication; Licence and rating privileges; Rules of the Air; Weather; Air Navigation (BR Nav). Normal operation including pre-ight checks, setting and monitoring during: Take-off and climb; Cruise; Descent; Approach and Landing. In-ight failures and emergency handling including:
27 July 2012
Use of oxygen; Emergency descent including terrain and ATC considerations; Single Engine Stabilising Altitude (ME only). 4.3.5 Tail Wheel Differences Training completed, for this section, on an SEP aeroplane, does not provide equivalent qualication on MEP aeroplanes: Physical differences; Loading and Effect of CG Position. Dynamic differences and handling during: Ground handling; Starting and taxying; Taking-off; Engine failure during take-off; Landings including 2-point Wheelers and 3-point landings (as applicable to type); Crosswind operations; Parking and mooring. Landing and ground handling with one or more engines inoperative (ME only). Variants within a Type Rating Weight and loading normal, utility and aerobatic load categories; Take-off and climb performance; Cruise performance; Landing performance; Speeds for normal operation; Speeds for emergency operation; Airframe limitations; Manoeuvre imitations and aerobatics; Spinning; Stall/Spin warning for protection systems; Fuel system; Engine systems and instrumentation; Undercarriage system; Electrical system (DC and AC); Cabin and environmental system (including pressurisation); Cockpit and cabin oxygen systems; Caution and warning annunciator system; Flight instrumentation; EFIS and navigation systems; Autopilot and trim system including pre-ight checks; Other systems including pneumatic, vacuum and hydraulic; Aerodynamic controls and handling characteristics; Engine handling; Flaps and lift/drag augmentation;
27 July 2012
Other systems particular to type; Emergency procedures. 4.3.6 Single Lever Power Control (SLPC) Aeroplanes Differences training, for this section, on a single-engine aeroplane does not provide equivalent qualication on multi-engine aeroplanes. Engine and Ancillaries Fuel type Principles, construction and function Gearbox Turbo/super chargers FADEC / Engine Control Unit (ECU) Lubrication, oil type, checking and topping up Cooling coolant type, checking and topping up Propeller Propeller principles Constant Speed Unit (CSU) and governor Care of prop. and ground handling System monitoring and control Power control lever, FADEC and ECU integration Standby/manual over-ride power control (if applicable) Engine information displays Auxiliary system displays Annunciator panels, caution and warning systems Electrical System Electrical system layout, voltage and limitations Alternator system Battery capacity Circuit breakers Distribution, bus bars and switching Use of ground power units Fuel System Fuel quantity distribution and selections Fuel consumption Fuel Labelling Re-fuelling supervision Loading and Performance Engine Mass and aircraft loading differences Take off and Climb Performance Cruise performance Fuel consumption and endurance Landing performance
27 July 2012
Handling Starting and shutting down Engine master switch Pre-ight checks and ECU testing Normal operations Fire and Emergency handling Use of main power control lever Use of standby / manual over-ride power controls (if applicable) Power settings and speeds for normal and emergency operations Take-off / landing conguration differences and review of Pilots Operating Handbook Converting from SLPC Aeroplanes; Engine and System Components, Construction, Layout and Function: Power control indications Fuel system Ignition system where applicable Carburettor heat/alternate air control where applicable Theory of carburettor icing Mixture control Theory and need for manual mixture control Ignition system Theory of magneto ignition where applicable Fixed pitch propeller theory Engine cooling Operation and Engine Handling Performance and loading considerations Range and endurance Pre-ight inspection Starting taxying Power and function checks Take-off and climb Cruise, including fuel system handling and fuel consumption Use of carburettor heat control Mixture leaning using mixture control Engine handling during descent, approach and landing Shutdown Limitations System limitations for despatch Operating limitations during ight Considerations for shutdown In-Flight Failures and Emergency Handling Engine failures including memory and checklist items
27 July 2012
Engine overspeed in descent Engine re on the ground / in the air Other emergency checklist procedures 4.3.7 Electronic Flight Instruments System (EFIS) Airborne training in the use of Integrated EFIS demands considerable attention of both instructor and pilot, often at the expense of lookout and ight safety. It is recommended, therefore, that this training be carried out with an appropriate Part Task Trainer, FNPT or other STD. In any event, maximum use should be made of any available videos, manufacturers or agents computer based training aids and programmes. System overview System components and sub-systems Sub-systems arrangement and inputs including (but not limited to; Pitot/Static and Air Data Computer (ADC) Compass and magnetometer Attitude and Heading Reference System (AHRS) Avionics computer(s) Power supply Sub-system principles, construction and limitations System Function Instruments Main and alternative power supplies System electrical demands Communication radios and audio panel Transponder VHF navigation Radios GPS and RNAV functionality and approval status ADF and DME installations Autopilot and ight director Trafc information systems Terrain data systems Weather radar and data-link systems Normal Operations Switching on, system initialisation and alignment Test modes and function Cautions and warnings system and display Display brightness and control Display modes, layout and available information Flight instruments display Engine Instruments Use of communications radios, Use of transponder system, altitude encoding and trafc information system, aircraft identication (Mode S) and mode of use. Use of VHF navigation systems, Use of ADF and DME,
27 July 2012
Use of GPS and RNAV functions Navigation displays Instrument approach operations (for RNAV instrument approach operations see CAP 773) Autopilot and Flight Director selection and control functions, Abnormal Operations Sub system / system input malfunction Screen failure Composite, backup or reversionary display function Radio failure and emergency operation Electrical failures, re and shut-down Flight by reference to standby instruments Aircraft system cautions and warnings EFIS message advisories 4.3.8 Differences training in Single Pilot aeroplanes with Electronic ight instrumentation systems (EFIS) Increasingly, single-pilot aircraft are being tted with digital Electronic Flight Instrumentation Systems (EFIS) consisting of electronic glass instruments and integrated digital avionics displays of widely varying complexity and capability. These systems present a signicant change from conventional, mechanical ight instruments in the way the information is presented and the interpretation of these systems requires a thorough understanding by the pilot. For the purposes of this requirement, an EFIS display requiring differences training is an electronic presentation of the primary ight instruments that presents gyroscopic instrument, pressure instrument and navigation information that is used by the pilot as a primary reference for control of the aircraft in ight. Differences training requires both theoretical knowledge and training on an appropriate training device or an aeroplane. The instructors and training providers who may give the training are detailed in subsequent paragraphs. Pilots converting to an EFIS equipped aeroplane for the rst time, within the Single Engine Piston Class Rating, are required to complete differences training to the satisfaction of an appropriately qualied Class or Instrument Rating Instructor or Flight Instructor. Those pilots with logbook evidence to show that they have been operating these aircraft as pilot in command, prior to September 9th 2010, the issue date of an AIC on the topic, are exempt from this requirement. Pilots converting to another EFIS equipped aeroplane within the privileges of other type or class ratings are strongly advised to complete similar differences training. When converting either to or from EFIS within a single-pilot type rating, pilots should attend a Training Organisation approved to conduct type-rating training courses on the particular aircraft type and variant. 4.3.9 Converting between different EFIS installations Pilots converting to another Integrated EFIS display should obtain further differences training, whether or not the same manufacturer produces the new system. Familiarisation training should be sufcient for FIs or CRI/TRIs who are fully qualied to teach all applied instrument ying and who are already trained on another Integrated EFIS system.
30 January 2013
4.3.10 Converting from EFIS to Mechanical Instruments Pilots trained in using Integrated EFIS displays but not trained on mechanical ight instruments, are likely to have established a scan pattern quite different from the techniques required by a conventional, mechanical instrument layout. These pilots are strongly advised to obtain differences training on conventional instruments, including selective radial scan techniques, before ying an aircraft with conventional mechanical instrumentation. EFIS can provide very precise information, which requires little interpretation, as opposed to conventional instrument displays, which require considerable interpretation and different scan techniques. A key element in this type of training, on whatever system, is ensuring the pilot fully understands what information is available, what is being displayed and how to interpret the display correctly.
Additional Information
None.
30 January 2013
Subpart 2
1 Applicability
This section sets out the requirements for Type ratings included in EASA licences for Helicopters.
2 Privileges
EASA Type Rating Helicopters The privileges and conditions of the EASA Type Rating are dened in FCL.705 as follows: FCL.705 Privileges of the holder of type rating
The privileges of the holder of a type rating are to act as pilot on the type of helicopter specied in the rating.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA Helicopter Type rating shall comply with the following PartFCL requirements: Circumstances in which type ratings are required FCL.700 FCL.705 Privileges of the holder of a type rating FCL.710 Type ratings variants FCL.720.H Experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of type ratings helicopters FCL.725 Requirements for the issue of type ratings FCL.735.H Multi-crew cooperation training course helicopters FCL.740 Validity and renewal of class and type ratings FCL.740.H Revalidation of class and type ratings helicopters For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.700 Circumstances in which class or type ratings are required (a) Holders of a pilot licence for helicopters shall not act in any capacity as pilots of an helicopter unless they have a valid and appropriate type rating, except when undergoing skill tests, or prociency checks for renewal of type ratings, or receiving ight instruction. (b) Notwithstanding (a), in the case of ights related to the introduction or modication of aircraft types, pilots may hold a special certicate given by the competent authority, authorising them to perform the ights. This authorisation shall have its validity limited to the specic ights. (c) Without prejudice to (a) and (b), in the case of ights related to the introduction or modication of helicopter types conducted by design or production organisations within the scope of their privileges, as well as instruction ights for the issue of a ight test rating, when the requirements of this Subpart may not be complied with, pilots may hold a ight test rating issued in accordance with FCL.820.
May 2012 Section 4 Part H, Subpart 2 Page 1
(a) In order to extend his/her privileges to another variant of helicopter within type rating, the pilot shall undertake differences or familiarisation training. In the case of variants within a type rating, the differences or familiarisation training shall include the relevant elements dened in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21. (b) If the variant has not been own within a period of 2 years following the differences training, further differences training or a prociency check in that variant shall be required to maintain the privileges. (c) The differences training shall be entered in the pilots logbook or equivalent record and signed by the instructor as appropriate. FCL.720.H Experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of type ratings helicopter Unless otherwise determined in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21, an applicant for the issue of the rst helicopter type rating shall comply with the following experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of the relevant rating: (a) Multi-pilot helicopters. An applicant for the rst type rating course for a multi-pilot helicopter type shall: (1) have at least 70 hours as PIC on helicopters; (2) except when the type rating course is combined with an MCC course: (i) hold a certicate of satisfactory completion of an MCC course in helicopters; or (ii) have at least 500 hours as a pilot on multi-pilot aeroplanes; or (iii) have at least 500 hours as a pilot in multi-pilot operations on multi-engine helicopters; (3) have passed the ATPL(H) theoretical knowledge examinations. (b) An applicant for the rst type rating course for a multi-pilot helicopter type who is a graduate from an ATP(H)/IR, ATP(H), CPL(H)/IR or CPL(H) integrated course and who does not comply with the requirement of (a)(1), shall have the type rating issued with the privileges limited to exercising functions as co-pilot only. The limitation shall be removed once the pilot has: (1) completed 70 hours as PIC or pilot-in-command under supervision of helicopters; (2) passed the multi-pilot skill test on the applicable helicopter type as PIC. (c) Single-pilot multi-engine helicopters. An applicant for the issue of a rst type rating for a single-pilot multi-engine helicopter shall: (1) before starting ight training: (i) have passed the ATPL(H) theoretical knowledge examinations; or (ii) hold a certicate of completion of a pre-entry course conducted by an ATO. The course shall cover the following subjects of the ATPL(H) theoretical knowledge course:
May 2012
Aircraft General Knowledge: airframe/systems/power plant, and instrument/electronics, Flight Performance and Planning: mass and balance, performance; (2) in the case of applicants who have not completed an ATP(H)/IR, ATP(H), or CPL(H)/IR integrated training course, have completed at least 70 hours as PIC on helicopters. FCL.725 Requirements for the issue of type ratings
(a) Training course. An applicant for a helicopter type rating shall complete a training course at an ATO. The type rating training course shall include the mandatory training elements for the relevant type as dened in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21. (b) Theoretical knowledge examination. The applicant for a helicopter type rating shall pass a theoretical knowledge examination organised by the ATO to demonstrate the level of theoretical knowledge required for the safe operation of the applicable helicopter type. (1) For multi-pilot helicopters, the theoretical knowledge examination shall be written and comprise at least 100 multiple-choice questions distributed appropriately across the main subjects of the syllabus. (2) For single-pilot multi-engine helicopters, the theoretical knowledge examination shall be written and the number of multiple-choice questions shall depend on the complexity of the aircraft. (3) For single-engine helicopters, the theoretical knowledge examination shall be conducted verbally by the examiner during the skill test to determine whether or not a satisfactory level of knowledge has been achieved. (c) Skill test. An applicant for a helicopter type rating shall pass a skill test in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL to demonstrate the skill required for the safe operation of the applicable type of helicopter. The applicant shall pass the skill test within a period of 6 months after commencement of the type rating training course and within a period of 6 months preceding the application for the issue of the type rating. (d) An applicant who already holds a type rating for a helicopter type, with the privilege for either single-pilot or multi-pilot operations, shall be considered to have already fullled the theoretical requirements when applying to add the privilege for the other form of operation on the same helicopter type. (e) Notwithstanding the paragraphs above, pilots holding a ight test rating issued in accordance with FCL.820 who were involved in development, certication or production ight tests for an helicopter type, and have completed either 50 hours of total ight time or 10 hours of ight time as PIC on test ights in that type, shall be entitled to apply for the issue of the relevant type rating, provided that they comply with the experience requirements and the prerequisites for the issue of that type rating, as established in this Subpart for helicopters.
May 2012
FCL.735.H Multi-crew cooperation training course helicopters (a) The MCC training course shall comprise at least: (1) for MCC/IR: (i) 25 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction and exercises; and (ii) 20 hours of practical MCC training or 15 hours, in the case of student pilots attending an ATP(H)/IR integrated course. When the MCC training is combined with the initial type rating training for a multi-pilot helicopter, the practical MCC training may be reduced to not less than 10 hours if the same FSTD is used for both MCC and type rating; (2) for MCC/VFR: (i) 25 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction and exercises; and (ii) 15 hours of practical MCC training or 10 hours, in the case of student pilots attending an ATP(H)/IR integrated course. When the MCC training is combined with the initial type rating training for a multi-pilot helicopter, the practical MCC training may be reduced to not less than 7 hours if the same FSTD is used for both MCC and type rating. (b) The MCC training course shall be completed within 6 months at an ATO. An FNPT II or III qualied for MCC, an FTD 2/3 or an FFS shall be used. (c) Unless the MCC course has been combined with a multi-pilot type rating course, on completion of the MCC training course the applicant shall be given a certicate of completion. (d) An applicant having completed MCC training for any other category of aircraft shall be exempted from the requirement in (a)(1)(i) or (a)(2)(i), as applicable. (e) An applicant for MCC/IR training who has completed MCC/VFR training shall be exempted from the requirement in (a)(1)(i), and shall complete 5 hours of practical MCC/IR training. FCL.740 Validity and renewal of type ratings
(a) The period of validity of type ratings shall be 1 year, unless otherwise determined by the operational suitability data, established in accordance with Part-21. (b) Renewal. If a type rating has expired, the applicant shall: (1) take refresher training at an ATO, when necessary to reach the level of prociency necessary to safely operate the relevant type of helicopter; and (2) pass a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL. FCL.740.H Revalidation of type ratings helicopter (a) Revalidation. For revalidation of type ratings for helicopters, the applicant shall: (1) pass a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL in the relevant type of helicopter or an FSTD representing that type within the 3 months immediately preceding the expiry date of the rating; and (2) complete at least 2 hours as a pilot of the relevant helicopter type within the validity period of the rating. The duration of the prociency check may be counted towards the 2 hours.
May 2012
(3) When applicants hold more than 1 type rating for single-engine piston helicopters, they may achieve revalidation of all the relevant type ratings by completing the prociency check in only 1 of the relevant types held, provided that they have completed at least 2 hours of ight time as PIC on the other types during the validity period. The prociency check shall be performed each time on a different type. (4) When applicants hold more than 1 type rating for single-engine turbine helicopters with a maximum certicated take-off mass up to 3175 kg, they may achieve revalidation of all the relevant type ratings by completing the prociency check in only 1 of the relevant types held, provided that they have completed: (i) 300 hours as PIC on helicopters; (ii) 15 hours on each of the types held; and (iii) at least 2 hours of PIC ight time on each of the other types during the validity period. The prociency check shall be performed each time on a different type. (5) A pilot who successfully completes a skill test for the issue of an additional type rating shall achieve revalidation for the relevant type ratings in the common groups, in accordance with (3) and (4). (6) The revalidation of an IR(H), if held, may be combined with a prociency check for a type rating. (b) An applicant who fails to achieve a pass in all sections of a prociency check before the expiry date of a type rating shall not exercise the privileges of that rating until a pass in the prociency check has been achieved. In the case of (a)(3) and (4), the applicant shall not exercise his/her privileges in any of the types.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 3
1 Applicability
This section sets out the requirements for Type ratings included in EASA licences for Powered-Lift aircraft.
2 Privileges
EASA Powered-Lift Type Rating The privileges and conditions of the EASA PoweredLift Type Rating are dened in FCL.705 as follows: FCL.705 Privileges of the holder of type rating
The privileges of the holder of a type rating are to act as pilot on the type of poweredlift aircraft specied in the rating.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA Powered-Lift Type rating shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.700 FCL.705 FCL.710 FCL.720.PL FCL.725 FCL.725.PL FCL.740 FCL.740.PL Circumstances in which type ratings are required Privileges of the holder of a type rating Type ratings variants Experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of type ratings powered-lift aircraft Requirements for the issue of type ratings Flight instruction for issue of type ratings powered-lift aircraft Validity and renewal of type ratings Revalidation of type ratings powered-lift aircraft
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.700 Circumstances in which class or type ratings are required
(a) Holders of a pilot licence for powered-lift aircraft shall not act in any capacity as a pilot of a powered-lift aircraft unless they have a valid and appropriate type rating, except when undergoing skill tests, or prociency checks for renewal of type ratings, or receiving ight instruction. (b) Notwithstanding (a), in the case of ights related to the introduction or modication of aircraft types, pilots may hold a special certicate given by the competent authority, authorising them to perform the ights. This authorisation shall have its validity limited to the specic ights.
May 2012
(c) Without prejudice to (a) and (b), in the case of ights related to the introduction or modication of powered-lift aircraft types conducted by design or production organisations within the scope of their privileges, as well as instruction ights for the issue of a ight test rating, when the requirements of this Subpart may not be complied with, pilots may hold a ight test rating issued in accordance with FCL.820. FCL.705 As above. FCL.710 Type ratings variants Privileges of the holder of a class or type rating
(a) In order to extend his/her privileges to another variant of powered-lift aircraft within type rating, the pilot shall undertake differences or familiarisation training. In the case of variants within a type rating, the differences or familiarisation training shall include the relevant elements dened in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21. (b) If the variant has not been own within a period of 2 years following the differences training, further differences training or a prociency check in that variant shall be required to maintain the privileges. (c) The differences training shall be entered in the pilots logbook or equivalent record and signed by the instructor as appropriate. FCL.720.PL Experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of type ratings powered-lift aircraft
Unless otherwise determined in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21, an applicant for the rst issue of a powered-lift type rating shall comply with the following experience requirements and prerequisites: (a) for pilots of aeroplanes: (1) hold a CPL/IR(A) with ATPL theoretical knowledge or an ATPL(A); (2) hold a certicate of completion of an MCC course; (3) have completed more than 100 hours as pilot on multi-pilot aeroplanes; (4) have completed 40 hours of ight instruction in helicopters; (b) for pilots of helicopters: (1) hold a CPL/IR(H) with ATPL theoretical knowledge or an ATPL/IR(H); (2) hold a certicate of completion of an MCC course; (3) have completed more than 100 hours as a pilot on multi-pilot helicopters; (4) have completed 40 hours of ight instruction in aeroplanes; (c) for pilots qualied to y both aeroplanes and helicopters: (1) hold at least a CPL(H); (2) hold an IR and ATPL theoretical knowledge or an ATPL in either aeroplanes or helicopters; (3) hold a certicate of completion of an MCC course in either helicopters or aeroplanes; (4) have completed at least 100 hours as a pilot on multi-pilot helicopters or aeroplanes; (5) have completed 40 hours of ight instruction in aeroplanes or helicopters, as applicable, if the pilot has no experience as ATPL or on multi-pilot aircraft.
May 2012
FCL.725
(a) Training course. An applicant for a type rating shall complete a training course at an ATO. The type rating training course shall include the mandatory training elements for the relevant type as dened in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21. (b) Theoretical knowledge examination. The applicant for a type rating shall pass a theoretical knowledge examination organised by the ATO to demonstrate the level of theoretical knowledge required for the safe operation of the applicable powered-lift aircraft type. (1) For multi-pilot powered-lift aircraft, the theoretical knowledge examination shall be written and comprise at least 100 multiple-choice questions distributed appropriately across the main subjects of the syllabus. (2) For single-pilot multi-engine powered-lift aircraft, the theoretical knowledge examination shall be written and the number of multiple-choice questions shall depend on the complexity of the aircraft. (c) Skill test. An applicant for a type rating shall pass a skill test in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL to demonstrate the skill required for the safe operation of the applicable type of powered-lift aircraft. The applicant shall pass the skill test within a period of 6 months after commencement of the type rating training course and within a period of 6 months preceding the application for the issue of the type rating. (d) An applicant who already holds a type rating for an powered-lift aircraft type, with the privilege for either single-pilot or multi-pilot operations, shall be considered to have already fullled the theoretical requirements when applying to add the privilege for the other form of operation on the same powered-lift aircraft type. (e) Notwithstanding the paragraphs above, pilots holding a ight test rating issued in accordance with FCL.820 who were involved in development, certication or production ight tests for an powered-lift aircraft type, and have completed either 50 hours of total ight time or 10 hours of ight time as PIC on test ights in that type, shall be entitled to apply for the issue of the relevant type rating, provided that they comply with the experience requirements and the prerequisites for the issue of that type rating, as established in this Subpart for powered-lift aircraft. FCL.725.PL Flight instruction for issue of type ratings powered-lift aircraft
The ight instruction part of the training course for a powered-lift type rating shall be completed in both the aircraft and an FSTD representing the aircraft and adequately qualied for this purpose. FCL.740 Validity and renewal of type ratings
(a) The period of validity of type ratings shall be 1 year, unless otherwise determined by the operational suitability data, established in accordance with Part-21. (b) Renewal. If a type rating has expired, the applicant shall: (1) take refresher training at an ATO, when necessary to reach the level of prociency necessary to safely operate the relevant type of powered-lift aircraft; and (2) pass a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL.
May 2012
FCL.740.PL Revalidation of type ratings powered-lift aircraft (a) Revalidation. For revalidation of powered-lift type ratings, the applicant shall: (1) pass a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL in the relevant type of powered-lift within the 3 months immediately preceding the expiry date of the rating; (2) complete during the period of validity of the rating, at least: (i) 10 route sectors as pilot of the relevant type of powered-lift aircraft; or (ii) 1 route sector as pilot of the relevant type of powered-lift aircraft or FFS, own with an examiner. This route sector may be own during the prociency check. (3) A pilot working for a commercial air transport operator approved in accordance with the applicable air operations requirements who has passed the operators prociency check combined with the prociency check for the revalidation of the type rating shall be exempted from complying with the requirement in (2). (b) An applicant who fails to achieve a pass in all sections of a prociency check before the expiry date of a type rating shall not exercise the privileges of that rating until the a pass in the prociency check has been achieved.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 4
1 Applicability
This section sets out the requirements for Type Ratings included in EASA licences for Airships.
2 Privileges
EASA Airship Type Rating The privileges and conditions of the EASA Airship Type Rating are dened in FCL.705 as follows: FCL.705 Privileges of the holder of a Type Rating
The privileges of the holder of a type rating are to act as pilot on the type of aircraft specied in the rating.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA Airship Type rating shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.700 Circumstances in which Type Ratings are required FCL.705 Privileges of the holder of a Type Rating FCL.710 Type Ratings variants FCL.720.As Prerequisites for the issue of Type Ratings Airships FCL.725 Requirements for the issue of Type Ratings FCL.735.As Multi-crew cooperation training course Airships FCL.740 Validity and renewal of Type Ratings FCL.740.As Revalidation of Type Ratings Airships For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.700 Circumstances in which Class or Type Ratings are required
(a) Holders of a pilot licence for powered-lift aircraft shall not act in any capacity as pilots of an Airship unless they have a valid and appropriate Type Rating, except when undergoing skill tests, or prociency checks for renewal of Type Ratings, or receiving ight instruction. (b) Notwithstanding (a), in the case of ights related to the introduction or modication of aircraft types, pilots may hold a special certicate given by the competent authority, authorising them to perform the ights. This authorisation shall have its validity limited to the specic ights. (c) Without prejudice to (a) and (b), in the case of ights related to the introduction or modication of Airship types conducted by design or production organisations within the scope of their privileges, as well as instruction ights for the issue of a ight test rating, when the requirements of this Subpart may not be complied with, pilots may hold a ight test rating issued in accordance with FCL.820.
27 July 2012 Section 4 Part H, Subpart 4 Page 1
(a) In order to extend his/her privileges to another variant of Airship within Type Rating, the pilot shall undertake differences or familiarisation training. In the case of variants within a type rating, the differences or familiarisation training shall include the relevant elements dened in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21. (b) If the variant has not been own within a period of 2 years following the differences training, further differences training or a prociency check in that variant shall be required to maintain the privileges. (c) The differences training shall be entered in the pilots logbook or equivalent record and signed by the instructor as appropriate. FCL.720.As Prerequisites for the issue of Type Ratings Airships Unless otherwise determined in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21, an applicant for the rst issue of an airship Type Rating shall comply with the following experience requirements and prerequisites: (a) for multi-pilot Airships: (1) have completed 70 hours of ight time as PIC on Airships; (2) hold a certicate of satisfactory completion of MCC on Airships. (3) An applicant who does not comply with the requirement in (2) shall have the Type Rating issued with the privileges limited to exercising functions as copilot only. The limitation shall be removed once the pilot has completed 100 hours of ight time as PIC or pilot-in-command under supervision of Airships. FCL.725 Requirements for the issue of Type Ratings
(a) Training course. An applicant for an Airship Type Rating shall complete a training course at an ATO. The Type Rating training course shall include the mandatory training elements for the relevant type as dened in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21. (b) Theoretical knowledge examination. The applicant for an Airship Type Rating shall pass a theoretical knowledge examination organised by the ATO to demonstrate the level of theoretical knowledge required for the safe operation of the applicable Airship type. (1) For multi-pilot Airships, the theoretical knowledge examination shall be written and comprise at least 100 multiple-choice questions distributed appropriately across the main subjects of the syllabus. (2) For single-pilot multi-engine Airships, the theoretical knowledge examination shall be written and the number of multiple-choice questions shall depend on the complexity of the aircraft. (3) For single-engine Airships, the theoretical knowledge examination shall be conducted verbally by the examiner during the skill test to determine whether or not a satisfactory level of knowledge has been achieved.
27 July 2012
(c) Skill test. An applicant for a an Airship Type Rating shall pass a skill test in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL to demonstrate the skill required for the safe operation of the applicable type of airship. The applicant shall pass the skill test within a period of 6 months after commencement of the Airship Type Rating training course and within a period of 6 months preceding the application for the issue of the Type Rating. (d) An applicant who already holds a type rating for an Airship, with the privilege for either single-pilot or multi-pilot operations, shall be considered to have already fullled the theoretical requirements when applying to add the privilege for the other form of operation on the same Airship type. (e) Notwithstanding the paragraphs above, pilots holding a ight test rating issued in accordance with FCL.820 who were involved in development, certication or production ight tests for an Airship type, and have completed either 50 hours of total ight time or 10 hours of ight time as PIC on test ights in that type, shall be entitled to apply for the issue of the relevant type rating, provided that they comply with the experience requirements and the prerequisites for the issue of that Type Rating, as established in this Subpart for Airships. FCL.735.As Multi-crew cooperation training course Airships (a) The MCC training course shall comprise at least: (1) 12 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction and exercises; and (2) 5 hours of practical MCC training; (3) An FNPT II, or III qualied for MCC, an FTD 2/3 or an FFS shall be used. (b) The MCC training course shall be completed within 6 months at an ATO. (c) Unless the MCC course has been combined with a multi-pilot type rating course, on completion of the MCC training course the applicant shall be given a certicate of completion. (d) An applicant having completed MCC training for any other category of aircraft shall be exempted from the requirements in (a). FCL.740 Validity and renewal of Type Ratings
(a) The period of validity of Type Ratings shall be 1 year, unless otherwise determined by the operational suitability data, established in accordance with Part-21. (b) Renewal. If a Type Rating has expired, the applicant shall: (1) take refresher training at an ATO, when necessary to reach the level of prociency necessary to safely operate the relevant type of Airship; and (2) pass a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL. FCL.740.As Revalidation of Type Ratings Airships (a) Revalidation. For revalidation of Type Ratings for Airships, the applicant shall: (1) pass a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to this Part in the relevant type of Airship within the 3 months immediately preceding the expiry date of the rating; and (2) complete at least 2 hours as a pilot of the relevant Airship type within the validity period of the rating. The duration of the prociency check may be counted towards the 2 hours.
27 July 2012
(3) The revalidation of an IR(As), if held, may be combined with a prociency check for the revalidation of a Class or Type Rating. (b) An applicant who fails to achieve a pass in all sections of a prociency check before the expiry date of a Type Rating shall not exercise the privileges of that rating until a pass in the prociency check has been achieved.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Part I
Additional Ratings
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA pilots licence may extend the privileges of their licence with additional ratings as listed below.
2 Privileges
EASA Additional Ratings The privileges of an EASA licence with additional ratings endorsed are detailed under the requirements as below. Article 62(5) of the ANO renders these ratings to be valid with the same privileges on non-EASA aircraft where necessary for the conduct of the particular ight.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for an additional rating to be added to an EASA licence shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.800 Aerobatic rating FCL.805 Sailplane towing and banner towing ratings FCL.810 Night rating FCL.815 Mountain rating FCL.820 Flight test rating For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.800 Aerobatic rating
(a) Holders of a pilot licence for aeroplanes, TMG or sailplanes shall only undertake aerobatic ights when they hold the appropriate rating. (b) Applicants for an aerobatic rating shall have completed: (1) at least 40 hours of ight time or, in the case of sailplanes, 120 launches as PIC in the appropriate aircraft category, completed after the issue of the licence; (2) a training course at an ATO, including: (i) theoretical knowledge instruction appropriate for the rating; (ii) at least 5 hours or 20 ights of aerobatic instruction in the appropriate aircraft category. (c) The privileges of the aerobatic rating shall be limited to the aircraft category in which the ight instruction was completed. The privileges will be extended to another category of aircraft if the pilot holds a licence for that aircraft category and has successfully completed at least 3 dual training ights covering the full aerobatic training syllabus in that category of aircraft.
May 2012
FCL.805
(a) Holders of a pilot licence with privileges to y aeroplanes or TMGs shall only tow sailplanes or banners when they hold the appropriate sailplane towing or banner towing rating. (b) Applicants for a sailplane towing rating shall have completed: (1) at least 30 hours of ight time as PIC and 60 take-offs and landings in aeroplanes, if the activity is to be carried out in aeroplanes, or in TMGs, if the activity is to be carried out in TMGs, completed after the issue of the licence; (2) a training course at an ATO including: (i) theoretical knowledge instruction on towing operations and procedures; (ii) at least 10 instruction ights towing a sailplane, including at least 5 dual instruction ights, and (iii) except for holders of an LAPL(S) or an SPL, 5 familiarisation ights in a sailplane which is launched by an aircraft. (c) Applicants for a banner towing rating shall have completed: (1) at least 100 hours of ight time and 200 take-offs and landings as PIC on aeroplanes or TMG, after the issue of the licence. At least 30 of these hours shall be in aeroplanes, if the activity is to be carried out in aeroplanes, or in TMG, if the activity is to be carried out in TMGs; (2) a training course at an ATO including: (i) theoretical knowledge instruction on towing operations and procedures; (ii) at least 10 instruction ights towing a banner, including at least 5dual ights. The privileges of the sailplane and banner towing ratings shall be limited to (d) aeroplanes or TMG, depending on which aircraft the ight instruction was completed. The privileges will be extended if the pilot holds a licence for aeroplanes or TMG and has successfully completed at least 3 dual training ights covering the full towing training syllabus in either aircraft, as relevant. (e) In order to exercise the privileges of the sailplane or banner towing ratings, the holder of the rating shall have completed a minimum of 5 tows during the last 24months. (f) When the pilot does not comply with the requirement in (e), before resuming the exercise of his/her privileges, the pilot shall complete the missing tows with or under the supervision of an instructor. FCL.810 Night rating
(a) Aeroplanes, TMGs, airships. (1) If the privileges of an LAPL or a PPL for aeroplanes, TMGs or airships are to be exercised in VFR conditions at night, applicants shall have completed a training course at an ATO. The course shall comprise: (i) theoretical knowledge instruction; (ii) at least 5 hours of ight time in the appropriate aircraft category at night, including at least 3 hours of dual instruction, including at least 1hour of cross-country navigation with at least one dual cross-country ight of at least 50 km and 5 solo take-offs and 5 solo full-stop landings.
May 2012
(2) Before completing the training at night, LAPL holders shall have completed the basic instrument ight training required for the issue of the PPL. (3) When applicants hold both a single-engine piston aeroplane (land) and a TMG class rating, they may complete the requirements in (1) above in either class or both classes. (b) Helicopters. If the privileges of a PPL for helicopters are to be exercised in VFR conditions at night, the applicant shall have: (1) completed at least 100 hours of ight time as pilot in helicopters after the issue of the licence, including at least 60 hours as PIC on helicopters and 20 hours of cross-country ight; (2) completed a training course at an ATO. The course shall be completed within a period of 6 months and comprise: (i) 5 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction; (ii) 10 hours of helicopter dual instrument instruction time; and (iii) 5 hours of ight time at night, including at least 3 hours of dual instruction, including at least 1 hour of cross-country navigation and 5solo night circuits. Each circuit shall include a take-off and a landing. (3) An applicant who holds or has held an IR in an aeroplane or TMG, shall be credited with 5 hours towards the requirement in (2)(ii) above. (c) Balloons. If the privileges of an LAPL for balloons or a BPL are to be exercised in VFR conditions at night, applicants shall complete at least 2 instruction ights at night of at least 1 hour each. FCL.815 Mountain rating
(a) Privileges. The privileges of the holder of a mountain rating are to conduct ights with aeroplanes or TMG to and from surfaces designated as requiring such a rating by the appropriate authorities designated by the Member States. The initial mountain rating may be obtained either on: (1) wheels, to grant the privilege to y to and from such surfaces when they are not covered by snow; or (2) skis, to grant the privilege to y to and from such surfaces when they are covered by snow. (3) The privileges of the initial rating may be extended to either wheel or ski privileges when the pilot has undertaken an appropriate additional familiarisation course, including theoretical knowledge instruction and ight training, with a mountain ight instructor. (b) Training course. Applicants for a mountain rating shall have completed, within a period of 24 months, a course of theoretical knowledge instruction and ight training at an ATO. The content of the course shall be appropriate to the privileges sought. (c) Skill test. After the completion of the training, the applicant shall pass a skill test with an FE qualied for this purpose. The skill test shall contain: (1) a verbal examination of theoretical knowledge; (2) 6 landings on at least 2 different surfaces designated as requiring a mountain rating other than the surface of departure. (d) Validity. A mountain rating shall be valid for a period of 24 months.
May 2012
(e) Revalidation. For revalidation of a mountain rating, the applicant shall: (1) have completed at least 6 mountain landings in the past 24 months; or (2) pass a prociency check. The prociency check shall comply with the requirements in (c). (f) Renewal. If the rating has lapsed, the applicant shall comply with the requirement in (e)(2). FCL.820 Flight test rating
(a) Holders of a pilot licence for aeroplanes or helicopters shall only act as PIC in category 1 or 2 ight tests, as dened in Part-21, when they hold a ight test rating. (b) The obligation to hold a ight test rating established in (a) shall only apply to ight tests conducted on: (1) helicopters certicated or to be certicated in accordance with the standards of CS-27 or CS-29 or equivalent airworthiness codes; or (2) aeroplanes certicated or to be certicated in accordance with: (i) the standards of CS-25 or equivalent airworthiness codes; or (ii) the standards of CS-23 or equivalent airworthiness codes, except for aeroplanes with an maximum take-off mass of less than 2 000 kg. (c) The privileges of the holder of a ight test rating are to, within the relevant aircraft category: (1) in the case of a category 1 ight test rating, conduct all categories of ight tests, as dened in Part-21, either as PIC or co-pilot; (2) in the case of a category 2 ight test rating: (i) conduct category 1 ight tests, as dened in Part-21: as a co-pilot; or as PIC, in the case of aeroplanes referred to in (b)(2)(ii), except for those within the commuter category or having a design diving speed above 0.6 mach or a maximum ceiling above 25 000 feet; (ii) conduct all other categories of ight tests, as dened in Part-21, either as PIC or co-pilot; (3) in addition, for both category 1 or 2 ight test ratings, to conduct ights specically related to the activity of design and production organisations, within the scope of their privileges, when the requirements of Subpart H may not be complied with. (d) Applicants for the rst issue of a ight test rating shall: (1) hold at least a CPL and an IR in the appropriate aircraft category; (2) have completed at least 1000 hours of ight time in the appropriate aircraft category, of which at least 400 hours as PIC; (3) have completed a training course at an ATO appropriate to the intended aircraft and category of ights. The training shall cover at least the following subjects: Performance; Stability and control/Handling qualities; Systems; Test management; Risk/Safety management.
May 2012
(e) The privileges of holders of a ight test rating may be extended to another category of ight test and another category of aircraft when they have completed an additional course of training at an ATO.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Part J Subpart 0
1 Applicability
This section sets out the requirements for Instructor Certicates included in EASA licences and are applicable to all EASA licence holders adding an Instructor Certicate to a licence.
2 Privileges
EASA Instructor Certicates The privileges of the EASA Instructor certicate are to carry out instruction for EASA licences and ratings as dened in the Specic Instructor Certicate privileges in the subsequent Subparts of this section: Article 62(5) of the ANO renders these certicates valid with the same privileges on non-EASA aircraft.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA Instructor certicate shall comply with the following PartFCL requirements: FCL.900 Instructor certicates General prerequisites and requirements for instructors FCL.915 FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL FCL.930 Training course FCL.935 Assessment of competence Validity of instructor certicates FCL.940 For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.900 Instructor certicates
(a) General. A person shall only carry out: (1) ight instruction in aircraft when he/she holds: (i) a pilot licence issued or accepted in accordance with this Regulation; (ii) an instructor certicate appropriate to the instruction given, issued in accordance with this Subpart; (2) synthetic ight instruction or MCC instruction when he/she holds an instructor certicate appropriate to the instruction given, issued in accordance with this Subpart. (b) Special conditions (1) In the case of introduction of new aircraft in the Member States or in an operators eet, when compliance with the requirements established in this Subpart is not possible, the competent authority may issue a specic certicate giving privileges for ight instruction. Such a certicate shall be limited to the instruction ights necessary for the introduction of the new type of aircraft and its validity shall not, in any case, exceed 1 year.
May 2012 Section 4 Part J, Subpart 0 Page 1
(2) Holders of a certicate issued in accordance with (b)(1) who wish to apply for the issue of an instructor certicate shall comply with the prerequisites and revalidation requirements established for that category of instructor. Notwithstanding FCL.905.TRI (b), a TRI certicate issued in accordance with this (sub)paragraph will include the privilege to instruct for the issue of a TRI or SFI certicate for the relevant type. (c) Instruction outside the territory of the Member States (1) Notwithstanding paragraph (a), in the case of ight instruction provided in an ATO located outside the territory of the Member States, the competent authority may issue an instructor certicate to an applicant holding a pilot licence issued by a third country in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention, provided that the applicant: (i) holds at least an equivalent licence, rating, or certicate to the one for which they are authorised to instruct and in any case at least a CPL. (ii) complies with the requirements established in this Subpart for the issue of the relevant instructor certicate; (iii) demonstrates to the competent authority an adequate level of knowledge of European aviation safety rules to be able to exercise instructional privileges in accordance with this Part. (2) The certicate shall be limited to providing ight instruction: (i) in ATOs located outside the territory of the Member States; (ii) to student pilots who have sufcient knowledge of the language in which ight instruction is given. FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors
(a) General. An applicant for an instructor certicate shall be at least 18 years of age. (b) Additional requirements for instructors providing ight instruction in aircraft. An applicant for or the holder of an instructor certicate with privileges to conduct ight instruction in an aircraft shall: (1) hold at least the licence and, where relevant, the rating for which ight instruction is to be given; (2) except in the case of the ight test instructor, have: (i) completed at least 15 hours of ight as a pilot on the class or type of aircraft on which ight instruction is to be given, of which a maximum of 7 hours may be in an FSTD representing the class or type of aircraft, if applicable; or (ii) passed an assessment of competence for the relevant category of instructor on that class or type of aircraft; (3) be entitled to act as PIC on the aircraft during such ight instruction. (c) Credit towards further ratings and for the purpose of revalidation (1) Applicants for further instructor certicates may be credited with the teaching and learning skills already demonstrated for the instructor certicate held. (2) Hours own as an examiner during skill tests or prociency checks shall be credited in full towards revalidation requirements for all instructor certicates held.
May 2012
FCL.920
All instructors shall be trained to achieve the following competences: Prepare resources, Create a climate conducive to learning, Present knowledge, Integrate Threat and Error Management (TEM) and crew resource management, Manage time to achieve training objectives, Facilitate learning, Assess trainee performance, Monitor and review progress, Evaluate training sessions, Report outcome. FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL
(a) Instructors conducting training for the MPL shall: (1) have successfully completed an MPL instructor training course at an ATO; and (2) additionally, for the basic, intermediate and advanced phases of the MPL integrated training course: (i) be experienced in multi-pilot operations; and (ii) have completed initial crew resource management training with a commercial air transport operator approved in accordance with the applicable air operations requirements. (b) MPL instructors training course (1) The MPL instructor training course shall comprise at least 14 hours of training. Upon completion of the training course, the applicant shall undertake an assessment of instructor competencies and of knowledge of the competency-based approach to training. (2) The assessment shall consist of a practical demonstration of ight instruction in the appropriate phase of the MPL training course. This assessment shall be conducted by an examiner qualied in accordance with Subpart K to partFCL. (3) Upon successful completion of the MPL training course, the ATO shall issue an MPL instructor qualication certicate to the applicant. (c) In order to maintain the privileges, the instructor shall have, within the preceding 12 months, conducted within an MPL training course: (1) 1 simulator session of at least 3 hours; or (2) 1 air exercise of at least 1 hour comprising at least 2 take-offs and landings. (d) If the instructor has not fullled the requirements of (c), before exercising the privileges to conduct ight instruction for the MPL he/she shall: (1) receive refresher training at an ATO to reach the level of competence necessary to pass the assessment of instructor competencies; and (2) pass the assessment of instructor competencies as set out in (b)(2).
May 2012
FCL.930
Training course
Applicants for an instructor certicate shall have completed a course of theoretical knowledge and ight instruction at an ATO. In addition to the specic elements prescribed in this Part for each category of instructor, the course shall contain the elements required in FCL.920. FCL.935 Assessment of competence
(a) Except for the multi-crew co-operation instructor (MCCI), the synthetic training instructor (STI), the mountain rating instructor (MI) and the ight test instructor (FTI), an applicant for an instructor certicate shall pass an assessment of competence in the appropriate aircraft category to demonstrate to an examiner qualied in accordance with Subpart K the ability to instruct a student pilot to the level required for the issue of the relevant licence, rating or certicate. (b) This assessment shall include: (1) the demonstration of the competencies described in FCL.920, during preight, post-ight and theoretical knowledge instruction; (2) oral theoretical examinations on the ground, pre-ight and post-ight briengs and in-ight demonstrations in the appropriate aircraft class, type or FSTD; (3) exercises adequate to evaluate the instructors competencies. (c) The assessment shall be performed on the same class or type of aircraft or FSTD used for the ight instruction. (d) When an assessment of competence is required for revalidation of an instructor certicate, an applicant who fails to achieve a pass in the assessment before the expiry date of an instructor certicate shall not exercise the privileges of that certicate until the assessment has successfully been completed. FCL.940 Validity of instructor certicates
With the exception of the MI, and without prejudice to FCL.900(b)(1), instructor certicates shall be valid for a period of 3 years.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 1 EASA Flight Instructor Certicate FI for Aeroplanes, Helicopters, Airships, Balloons and Sailplanes
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA FI certicate may exercise the privileges of the certicate to carry out instruction for EASA licences and ratings as dened in the privileges, and for UK national licences and ratings within the same privileges.
2 Privileges
EASA Flight Instructor The privileges and conditions of the EASA FI certicate are dened in FCL.905.FI as follows: FCL.905.FI FI Privileges and conditions The privileges of an FI are to conduct ight instruction for the issue, revalidation or renewal of: (a) a PPL, SPL, BPL and LAPL in the appropriate aircraft category; (b) class and type ratings for single-pilot, single-engine aircraft, except for single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes; class and group extensions for balloons and class extensions for sailplanes; (c) type ratings for single or multi-pilot airship; (d) a CPL in the appropriate aircraft category, provided that the FI has completed at least 500 hours of ight time as a pilot on that aircraft category, including at least 200 hours of ight instruction; (e) the night rating, provided that the FI: (1) is qualied to y at night in the appropriate aircraft category; (2) has demonstrated the ability to instruct at night to an FI qualied in accordance with (i) below; and (3) complies with the night experience requirement of FCL.060(b)(2). (f) a towing or aerobatic rating, provided that such privileges are held and the FI has demonstrated the ability to instruct for that rating to an FI qualied in accordance with (i) below; (g) an IR in the appropriate aircraft category, provided that the FI has: (1) at least 200 hours of ight time under IFR, of which up to 50 hours may be instrument ground time in an FFS, an FTD 2/3 or FNPT II; (2) completed as a student pilot the IRI training course and has passed the skill test for the IRI certicate; and (3) in addition: (i) for multi-engine aeroplanes, met the requirements for the issue of a CRI certicate; (ii) for multi-engine helicopters, met the requirements for the issue of a TRI certicate.
May 2012
(h) single-pilot multi-engine class or type ratings, except for single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes, provided that the FI meets: (1) in the case of aeroplanes, the prerequisites for the CRI training course established in FCL.915.CRI (a) and the requirements of FCL.930.CRI and FCL.935; (2) in the case of helicopters, the requirements established in FCL.910.TRI (c)(1) and the prerequisites for the TRI(H) training course established in FCL.915. TRI (b)(2); (i) an FI, IRI, CRI, STI or MI certicate provided that the FI has: (1) completed at least: (i) in the case of an FI(S), at least 50 hours or 150 launches of ight instruction on sailplanes; (ii) in the case of an FI(B), at least 50 hours or 50 take-offs of ight instruction on balloons; (iii) in all other cases, 500 hours of ight instruction in the appropriate aircraft category; (2) passed an assessment of competence in accordance with FCL.935 in the appropriate aircraft category to demonstrate to a Flight Instructor Examiner (FIE) the ability to instruct for the FI certicate; (j) an MPL, provided that the FI: (1) for the core ying phase of the training, has completed at least 500 hours of ight time as a pilot on aeroplanes, including at least 200 hours of ight instruction; (2) for the basic phase of the training: (i) holds a multi-engine aeroplane IR and the privilege to instruct for an IR; and (ii) has at least 1500 hours of ight time in multi-crew operations; (3) in the case of an FI already qualied to instruct on ATP(A) or CPL(A)/IR integrated courses, the requirement of (2)(ii) may be replaced by the completion of a structured course of training consisting of: (i) MCC qualication; (ii) observing 5 sessions of ight instruction in Phase 3 of an MPL course; (iii) observing 5 sessions of ight instruction in Phase 4 of an MPL course; (iv) observing 5 operator recurrent line oriented ight training sessions; (v) the content of the MCCI instructor course. In this case, the FI shall conduct its rst 5 instructor sessions under the supervision of a TRI(A), MCCI(A) or SFI(A) qualied for MPL ight instruction. Article 65(5) of the ANO renders the FI valid with the same privileges for giving instruction for UK national licences and ratings e.g. for the UK NPPL, UK PPL, UK CPL, UK ATPL etc.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A.
May 2012
An applicant for the EASA FI rating shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.900 Instructor certicates FCL.905.FI FI Privileges and conditions FCL.910.FI FI Restricted privileges FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors FCL.915.FI FI Prerequisites FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL FCL.930 Training course FCL.930.FI FI Training course FCL.935 Assessment of competence FCL.940 Validity of instructor certicates FCL.940.FI FI Revalidation and renewal For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below and in Subpart0, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.900 Instructor certicates
See Subpart 0. FCL.905.FI FI Privileges and conditions As above. FCL.910.FI FI Restricted privileges (a) An FI shall have his/her privileges limited to conducting ight instruction under the supervision of an FI for the same category of aircraft nominated by the ATO for this purpose, in the following cases: (1) for the issue of the PPL, SPL, BPL and LAPL; (2) in all integrated courses at PPL level, in case of aeroplanes and helicopters; (3) for class and type ratings for single-pilot, single-engine aircraft, class and group extensions in the case of balloons and class extensions in the case of sailplanes; (4) for the night, towing or aerobatic ratings. (b) While conducting training under supervision, in accordance with (a), the FI shall not have the privilege to authorise student pilots to conduct rst solo ights and rst solo cross-country ights. (c) The limitations in (a) and (b) shall be removed from the FI certicate when the FI has completed at least:* (1) for the FI(A), 100 hours ight instruction in aeroplanes or TMGs and, in addition has supervised at least 25 student solo ights; (2) for the FI(H) 100 hours ight instruction in helicopters and, in addition has supervised at least 25 student solo ight air exercises; (3) for the FI(As), FI(S) and FI(B), 15 hours or 50 take-offs ight instruction covering the full training syllabus for the issue of a PPL(As), SPL or BPL in the appropriate aircraft category.
* An applicant who provides evidence that the experience requirements of FCL.910.FI(c) have been met previously using the instructor rating included on a licence that is compliant with ICAO Annex I may have the Part-FCL instructor certicate issued without the privileges restricted.
15 October 2013 Section 4 Part J, Subpart 1 Page 3
FCL.915
See Subpart 0. FCL.915.FI FI Prerequisites An applicant for an FI certicate shall: (a) in the case of the FI(A) and FI(H): (1) have received at least 10 hours of instrument ight instruction on the appropriate aircraft category, of which not more than 5 hours may be instrument ground time in an FSTD; (2) have completed 20 hours of VFR cross-country ight on the appropriate aircraft category as PIC; and (b) additionally, for the FI(A): (1) hold at least a CPL(A); or (2) hold at least a PPL(A) and have: (i) met the requirements for CPL theoretical knowledge, except for an FI(A) providing training for the LAPL(A) only, and* (ii) completed at least 200 hours of ight time on aeroplanes or TMGs, of which 150 hours as PIC; (3) have completed at least 30 hours on single-engine piston powered aeroplanes of which at least 5 hours shall have been completed during the 6 months preceding the pre-entry ight test set out in FCL.930.FI(a); (4) have completed a VFR cross-country ight as PIC, including a ight of at least 540 km (300NM) in the course of which full stop landings at 2 different aerodromes shall be made; (c) additionally, for the FI(H), have completed 250 hours total ight time as pilot on helicopters of which: (1) at least 100 hours shall be as PIC, if the applicant holds at least a CPL(H); or (2) at least 200 hours as PIC, if the applicant holds at least a PPL(H) and has met the requirements for CPL theoretical knowledge; (d) for an FI(As), have completed 500 hours of ight time on airships as PIC, of which 400 hours shall be as PIC holding a CPL(As); (e) for an FI(S), have completed 100 hours of ight time and 200 launches as PIC on sailplanes. Additionally, where the applicant wishes to give ight instruction on TMGs, he/she shall have completed 30 hours of ight time as PIC on TMGs and an additional assessment of competence on a TMG in accordance with FCL.935 with an FI qualied in accordance with FCL.905.FI(j); (f) for an FI(B), have completed 75 hours of balloon ight time as PIC, of which at least 15 hours have to be in the class for which ight instruction will be given. FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment
See Subpart 0. FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL
See Subpart 0.
* Examinations successfully completed for ATPL or CPL shall be accepted and the validity period of FCL.025(c)(1)(ii) shall not apply.
15 October 2013 Section 4 Part J, Subpart 1 Page 4
FCL.930
Training course
See Subpart 0. FCL.930.FI FI Training course (a) Applicants for the FI certicate shall have passed a specic pre-entry ight test with an FI qualied in accordance with FCL.905.FI (i) within the 6 months preceding the start of the course, to assess their ability to undertake the course. This preentry ight test shall be based on the prociency check for class and type ratings as set out in Appendix 9 to Part-FCL. (b) The FI training course shall include: (1) 25 hours of teaching and learning; (2) (i) in the case of an FI(A), (H) and (As), at least 100 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction, including progress tests; (ii) in the case of an FI(B) or FI(S), at least 30 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction, including progress tests; (3) (i) in the case of an FI(A) and (H), at least 30 hours of ight instruction, of which 25 hours shall be dual ight instruction, of which 5 hours may be conducted in an FFS, an FNPT I or II or an FTD 2/3; (ii) in the case of an FI(As), at least 20 hours of ight instruction, of which 15 hours shall be dual ight instruction; (iii) in the case of an FI(S), at least 6 hours or 20 take-offs of ight instruction; (iv) in the case of an FI(S) providing training on TMGs, at least 6 hours of dual ight instruction on TMGs; (v) in the case of an FI(B), at least 3 hours including 3 take-offs of ight instruction. When applying for an FI certicate in another category of aircraft, pilots holding or having held: (1) an FI(A), (H) or (As) shall be credited with 55 hours towards the requirement in (b)(2)(i) or with 18 hours towards the requirements in (b)(2)(ii). FCL.935 Assessment of competence
See Subpart 0. FCL.940.FI FI Revalidation and renewal (a) For revalidation of an FI certicate, the holder shall full 2 of the following 3 requirements: (1) complete: (i) in the case of an FI(A) and (H), at least 50 hours of ight instruction in the appropriate aircraft category during the period of validity of the certicate as, FI, TRI, CRI, IRI, MI or examiner. If the privileges to instruct for the IR are to be revalidated, 10 of these hours shall be ight instruction for an IR and shall have been completed within the last 12 months preceding the expiry date of the FI certicate;
May 2012
(ii) in the case of an FI(As), at least 20 hours of ight instruction in airships as FI, IRI or as examiner during the period of validity of the certicate. If the privileges to instruct for the IR are to be revalidated, 10 of these hours shall be ight instruction for an IR and shall have been completed within the last 12 months preceding the expiry date of the FI certicate; (iii) in the case of an FI(S), at least 30 hours or 60 take-offs of ight instruction in sailplanes, powered sailplanes or TMG as, FI or as examiner during the period of validity of the certicate; (iv) in the case of an FI(B), at least 6 hours of ight instruction in balloons as, FI or as examiner during the period of validity of the certicate; (2) attend an instructor refresher seminar, within the validity period of the FI certicate; (3) pass an assessment of competence in accordance with FCL.935, within the 12 months preceding the expiry date of the FI certicate. (b) For at least each alternate subsequent revalidation in the case of FI(A) or FI(H), or each third revalidation, in the case of FI(As), (S) and (B), the holder shall have to pass an assessment of competence in accordance with FCL.935. (c) Renewal. If the FI certicate has lapsed, the applicant shall, within a period of 12 months before renewal: (1) attend an instructor refresher seminar; (2) pass an assessment of competence in accordance with FCL.935.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 2 EASA Type Rating Instructor Certicate TRI for Aeroplanes, Helicopters and Powered-Lift Aircraft
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA TRI certicate may exercise the privileges of the certicate to carry out instruction for Type ratings for EASA aircraft.
2 Privileges
EASA Type Rating Instructor The privileges and conditions of the EASA TRI certicate are dened in FCL.905.TRI as follows: FCL.905.TRI TRI Privileges and conditions The privileges of a TRI are to instruct for: (a) the revalidation and renewal of IRs, provided the TRI holds a valid IR; (b) the issue of a TRI or SFI certicate, provided that the holder has 3 years of experience as a TRI; and (c) in the case of the TRI for single-pilot aeroplanes: (1) the issue, revalidation and renewal of type ratings for single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes when the applicant seeks privileges to operate in single-pilot operations. The privileges of the TRI(SPA) may be extended to ight instruction for singlepilot high performance complex aeroplanes type ratings in multi-pilot operations, provided that the TRI: (i) holds an MCCI certicate; or (ii) holds or has held a TRI certicate for multi-pilot aeroplanes. (2) the MPL course on the basic phase, provided that he/she has the privileges extended to multi-pilot operations and holds or has held an FI(A) or an IRI(A) certicate. (d) in the case of the TRI for multi-pilot aeroplanes: (1) the issue, revalidation and renewal of type ratings for: (i) multi-pilot aeroplanes; (ii) single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes when the applicant seeks privileges to operate in multi-pilot operations; (2) MCC training; (3) the MPL course on the basic, intermediate and advanced phases, provided that, for the basic phase, they hold or have held an FI(A) or IRI(A) certicate; (e) in the case of the TRI for helicopters: (1) the issue, revalidation and renewal of helicopter type ratings; (2) MCC training, provided he/she holds a multi-pilot helicopter type rating; (3) the extension of the single-engine IR(H) to multi-engine IR(H). (f) in the case of the TRI for powered-lift aircraft: (1) the issue, revalidation and renewal of powered-lift type ratings; (2) MCC training.
May 2012
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA TRI certicate shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: Instructor certicates FCL.900 FCL.905.TRI TRI Privileges and conditions FCL.910.TRI TRI Restricted privileges FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors FCL.915.TRI TRI Prerequisites FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL FCL.930 Training course FCL.930.TRI TRI Training course FCL.935 Assessment of competence FCL.935TRI TRI Assessment of competence FCL.940 Validity of instructor certicates FCL.940.TRI TRI Revalidation and renewal For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below and in Subpart0, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.900 Instructor certicates
See Subpart 0. FCL.905.TRI TRI Privileges and conditions As above. FCL.910.TRI TRI Restricted privileges (a) General. If the TRI training is carried out in an FFS only, the privileges of the TRI shall be restricted to training in the FFS. In this case, the TRI may conduct line ying under supervision, provided that the TRI training course has included additional training for this purpose. (b) TRI for aeroplanes and for powered-lift aircraft - TRI(A) and TRI(PL). The privileges of a TRI are restricted to the type of aeroplane or powered-lift aircraft in which the training and the assessment of competence was taken. The privileges of the TRI shall be extended to further types when the TRI has: (1) completed within the 12 months preceding the application, at least 15 route sectors, including take-offs and landings on the applicable aircraft type, of which 7 sectors may be completed in an FFS; (2) completed the technical training and ight instruction parts of the relevant TRI course; (3) passed the relevant sections of the assessment of competence in accordance with FCL.935 in order to demonstrate to an FIE or a TRE qualied in accordance with Subpart K his/her ability to instruct a pilot to the level required for the issue of a type rating, including pre-ight, post-ight and theoretical knowledge instruction.
May 2012
(c) TRI for helicopters TRI(H) (1) The privileges of a TRI(H) are restricted to the type of helicopter in which the skill test for the issue of the TRI certicate was taken. The privileges of the TRI shall be extended to further types when the TRI has: (i) completed the appropriate type technical part of the TRI course on the applicable type of helicopter or an FSTD representing that type; (ii) conducted at least 2 hours of ight instruction on the applicable type, under the supervision of an adequately qualied TRI(H); and (iii) passed the relevant sections of the assessment of competence in accordance with FCL.935 in order to demonstrate to an FIE or TRE qualied in accordance with Subpart K his/her ability to instruct a pilot to the level required for the issue of a type rating, including pre-ight, postight and theoretical knowledge instruction. (2) Before the privileges of a TRI(H) are extended from single-pilot to multi-pilot privileges on the same type of helicopters, the holder shall have at least 100 hours in multi-pilot operations on this type. (d) Notwithstanding the paragraphs above, holders of a TRI certicate who have been issued with a type rating in accordance with FCL.725 (e) shall be entitled to have their TRI privileges extended to that new type of aircraft. FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors
See Subpart 0. FCL.915.TRI TRI Prerequisites An applicant for a TRI certicate shall: (a) hold a CPL, MPL or ATPL pilot licence on the applicable aircraft category; (b) for a TRI(MPA) certicate: (1) have completed 1500 hours ight time as a pilot on multi-pilot aeroplanes; and (2) have completed, within the 12 months preceding the date of application, 30 route sectors, including take-offs and landings, as PIC or co-pilot on the applicable aeroplane type, of which 15 sectors may be completed in an FFS representing that type; (c) for a TRI(SPA) certicate: (1) have completed, within the 12 months preceding the date of application, 30 route sectors, including take-offs and landings, as PIC on the applicable aeroplane type, of which 15 sectors may be completed in an FFS representing that type; and (2) (i) have competed at least 500 hours ight time as pilot on aeroplanes, including 30 hours as PIC on the applicable type of aeroplane; or (ii) hold or have held an FI certicate for multi-engine aeroplanes with IR(A) privileges; (d) for TRI(H): (1) for a TRI(H) certicate for single-pilot single-engine helicopters, completed 250 hours as a pilot on helicopters;
May 2012
(2) for a TRI(H) certicate for single-pilot multi-engine helicopters, completed 500 hours as pilot of helicopters, including 100 hours as PIC on single-pilot multi-engine helicopters; (3) for a TRI(H) certicate for multi-pilot helicopters, completed 1000 hours ight time as a pilot on helicopters, including: (i) 350 hours as a pilot on multi-pilot helicopters; or (ii) for applicants already holding a TRI(H) certicate for single-pilot multiengine helicopters, 100 hours as pilot of that type in multi-pilot operations. (4) Holders of an FI(H) certicate shall be fully credited towards the requirements of (1) and (2) in the relevant single-pilot helicopter; (e) for TRI(PL): (1) completed 1500 hours ight time as a pilot on multi-pilot aeroplanes, powered-lift, or multi-pilot helicopters; and (2) completed, within the 12 months preceding the application, 30 route sectors, including take-offs and landings, as PIC or co-pilot on the applicable powered-lift type, of which 15 sectors may be completed in an FFS representing that type. FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment
See Subpart 0. FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL
See Subpart 0. FCL.930.TRI TRI Training course (a) The TRI training course shall include, at least: (1) 25 hours of teaching and learning; (2) 10 hours of technical training, including revision of technical knowledge, the preparation of lesson plans and the development of classroom/simulator instructional skills; (3) 5 hours of ight instruction on the appropriate aircraft or a simulator representing that aircraft for single-pilot aircraft and 10 hours for multi-pilot aircraft or a simulator representing that aircraft. (b) Applicants holding or having held an instructor certicate shall be fully credited towards the requirement of (a)(1). (c) An applicant for a TRI certicate who holds an SFI certicate for the relevant type shall be fully credited towards the requirements of this paragraph for the issue of a TRI certicate restricted to ight instruction in simulators. FCL.935 Assessment of competence
See Subpart 0.
May 2012
FCL.935.TRI TRI Assessment of competence If the TRI assessment of competence is conducted in an FFS, the TRI certicate shall be restricted to ight instruction in FFSs. The restriction shall be lifted when the TRI has passed the assessment of competence on an aircraft. FCL.940 Validity of instructor certicates
See Subpart 0. FCL.940.TRI TRI Revalidation and renewal (a) Revalidation (1) Aeroplanes. For revalidation of a TRI(A) certicate, the applicant shall, within the last 12 months preceding the expiry date of the certicate, full 1 of the following 3 requirements: (i) conduct one of the following parts of a complete type rating training course: simulator session of at least 3 hours or one air exercise of at least 1 hour comprising a minimum of 2 take-offs and landings; (ii) receive instructor refresher training as a TRI at an ATO; (iii) pass the assessment of competence in accordance with FCL.935. (2) Helicopters and powered lift. For revalidation of a TRI (H) or TRI(PL) certicate, the applicant shall, within the validity period of the TRI certicate, full 2 of the following 3 requirements: (i) complete 50 hours of ight instruction on each of the types of aircraft for which instructional privileges are held or in an FSTD representing those types, of which at least 15 hours shall be within the 12 months preceding the expiry date of the TRI certicate. In the case of TRI(PL), these hours of ight instruction shall be own as a TRI or type rating examiner (TRE), or SFI or synthetic ight examiner (SFE). In the case of TRI(H), time own as FI, instrument rating instructor (IRI), synthetic training instructor (STI) or as any kind of examiner shall also be relevant for this purpose; (ii) receive instructor refresher training as a TRI at an ATO; (iii) pass the assessment of competence in accordance with FCL.935. (3) For at least each alternate revalidation of a TRI certicate, the holder shall have to pass the assessment of competence in accordance with FCL.935. (4) If a person holds a TRI certicate on more than one type of aircraft within the same category, the assessment of competence taken on one of those types shall revalidate the TRI certicate for the other types held within the same category of aircraft. (5) Specic requirements for revalidation of a TRI(H). A TRI(H) holding an FI(H) certicate on the relevant type shall have full credit towards the requirements in (a) above. In this case, the TRI(H) certicate will be valid until the expiry date of the FI(H) certicate.
May 2012
(b) Renewal (1) Aeroplanes. If the TRI(A) certicate has lapsed the applicant shall have: (i) completed within the last 12 months preceding the application at least 30 route sectors, to include take-offs and landings on the applicable aeroplane type, of which not more than 15 sectors may be completed in a ight simulator; (ii) completed the relevant parts of a TRI course at an approved ATO; (iii) conducted on a complete type rating course at least 3 hours of ight instruction on the applicable type of aeroplane under the supervision of a TRI(A). (2) Helicopters and powered lift. If the TRI(H) or TRI(PL) certicate has lapsed, the applicant shall, within a period of 12 months before renewal: (i) receive instructor refresher training as a TRI at an ATO, which should cover the relevant elements of the TRI training course; and (ii) pass the assessment of competence in accordance with FCL.935 in each of the types of aircraft in which renewal of the instructional privileges is sought.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
2 Privileges
EASA Class Rating Instructor The privileges and conditions of the EASA CRI certicate are dened in FCL.905.CRI as follows: FCL.905.CRI CRI Privileges and conditions (a) The privileges of a CRI are to instruct for: (1) the issue, revalidation or renewal of a class or type rating for non-complex non-high performance single-pilot aeroplanes, when the privileges sought by the applicant are to y in single-pilot operations; (2) a towing or aerobatic rating for the aeroplane category, provided the CRI holds the relevant rating and has demonstrated the ability to instruct for that rating to an FI qualied in accordance with FCL.905.FI(i). (b) The privileges of a CRI are restricted to the class or type of aeroplane in which the instructor assessment of competence was taken. The privileges of the CRI shall be extended to further classes or types when the CRI has completed, within the last 12 months: (1) 15 hours ight time as PIC on aeroplanes of the applicable class or type of aeroplane; (2) one training ight from the right hand seat under the supervision of another CRI or FI qualied for that class or type occupying the other pilots seat Article 65(5) of the ANO renders the EASA CRI valid for giving instruction for UK class ratings for non-EASA aircraft subject to the conditions of FCL.905.CRI.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA CRI certicate shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.900 Instructor certicates FCL.905.CRI CRI Privileges and conditions FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors FCL.915.CRI CRI Prerequisites FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL FCL.930 Training course FCL.930.CRI CRI Training course
May 2012
FCL.935 Assessment of competence FCL.940 Validity of instructor certicates FCL.940.CRI CRI Revalidation and renewal For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below and in Subpart0, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.900 Instructor certicates
See Subpart 0. FCL.905.CRI CRI Privileges and conditions As above. FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors
See Subpart 0. FCL.915.CRI CRI Prerequisites An applicant for a CRI certicate shall have completed at least: (a) for multi-engine aeroplanes: (1) 500 hours ight time as a pilot on aeroplanes; (2) 30 hours as PIC on the applicable class or type of aeroplane; (b) for single-engine aeroplanes: (1) 300 hours ight time as a pilot on aeroplanes; (2) 30 hours as PIC on the applicable class or type of aeroplane. FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment
See Subpart 0. FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL
See Subpart 0. FCL.930.CRI CRI Training course (a) The training course for the CRI shall include, at least: (1) 25 hours of teaching and learning instruction; (2) 10 hours of technical training, including revision of technical knowledge, the preparation of lesson plans and the development of classroom/simulator instructional skills; (3) 5 hours of ight instruction on multi-engine aeroplanes, or 3 hours of ight instruction on single-engine aeroplanes, given by an FI(A) qualied in accordance with FCL.905.FI (i). (b) Applicants holding or having held an instructor certicate shall be fully credited towards the requirement of (a)(1).
May 2012 Section 4 Part J, Subpart 3 Page 2
FCL.935
Assessment of competence
See Subpart 0. FCL.940.CRI CRI Revalidation and renewal (a) For revalidation of a CRI certicate the applicant shall, within the 12 months preceding the expiry date of the CRI certicate: (1) conduct at least 10 hours of ight instruction in the role of a CRI. If the applicant has CRI privileges on both single-engine and multi-engine aeroplanes, the 10 hours of ight instruction shall be equally divided between single-engine and multi-engine aeroplanes; or (2) receive refresher training as a CRI at an ATO; or (3) pass the assessment of competence in accordance with FCL.935 for multiengine or single-engine aeroplanes, as relevant. (b) For at least each alternate revalidation of a CRI certicate, the holder shall have to comply with the requirement of (a)(3). (c) Renewal. If the CRI certicate has lapsed, the applicant shall, within a period of 12 months before renewal: (1) receive refresher training as a CRI at an ATO; (2) pass the assessment of competence established in FCL.935.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
2 Privileges
EASA Instrument Rating Instructor The privileges and conditions of the EASA IRI certicate are dened in FCL.905.IRI as follows: FCL.905.IRI IRI Privileges and conditions (a) The privileges of an IRI are to instruct for the issue, revalidation and renewal of an IR on the appropriate aircraft category. Specic requirements for the MPL course. To instruct for the basic phase of (b) training on an MPL course, the IRI(A) shall: (1) hold an IR for multi-engine aeroplanes; and (2) have completed at least 1500 hours of ight time in multi-crew operations. (3) In the case of IRI already qualied to instruct on ATP(A) or CPL(A)/IR integrated courses, the requirement of (b)(2) may be replaced by the completion of the course provided for in paragraph FCL.905.FI(j)(3). Article 65(5) of the ANO renders the EASA IRI valid for giving instruction for UK Instrument ratings for non-EASA aircraft subject to the conditions of FCL.905.IRI.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA IRI certicate shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.900 Instructor certicates FCL.905.IRI IRI Privileges and conditions FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors FCL.915.IRI IRI Prerequisites Instructor competencies and assessment FCL.920 FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL Training course FCL.930 FCL.930.IRI IRI Training course Assessment of competence FCL.935 FCL.940 Validity of instructor certicates FCL.940.IRI IRI Revalidation and renewal
May 2012
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below and in Subpart0, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.900 Instructor certicates
See Subpart 0. FCL.905.IRI IRI Privileges and conditions As above. FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors
See Subpart 0. FCL.915.IRI IRI Prerequisites An applicant for an IRI certicate shall: (a) for an IRI(A): (1) have completed at least 800 hours of ight time under IFR, of which at least 400 hours shall be in aeroplanes; and (2) in the case of applicants of an IRI(A) for multi-engine aeroplanes, meet the requirements of paragraph FCL.915.CRI (a); (b) for an IRI(H): (1) have completed at least 500 hours of ight time under IFR, of which at least 250 hours shall be instrument ight time in helicopters; and (2) in the case of applicants for an IRI(H) for multi-pilot helicopters, meet the requirements of FCL.905.FI (g)(3)(ii); (c) for an IRI(As), have completed at least 300 hours of ight time under IFR, of which at least 100 hours shall be instrument ight time in airships. FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment
See Subpart 0. FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL
See Subpart 0. FCL.930.IRI IRI Training course (a) The training course for the IRI shall include, at least: (1) 25 hours of teaching and learning instruction; (2) 10 hours of technical training, including revision of instrument theoretical knowledge, the preparation of lesson plans and the development of classroom instructional skills;
May 2012
(3) (i)
for the IRI(A), at least 10 hours of ight instruction on an aeroplane, FFS, FTD 2/3 or FNPT II. In the case of applicants holding an FI(A) certicate, these hours are reduced to 5; (ii) for the IRI(H), at least 10 hours of ight instruction on a helicopter, FFS, FTD 2/3 or FNPT II/III; (iii) for the IRI(As), at least 10 hours of ight instruction on an airship, FFS, FTD 2/3 or FNPT II.
(b) Flight instruction shall be given by an FI qualied in accordance with FCL.905.FI(i). (c) Applicants holding or having held an instructor certicate shall be fully credited towards the requirement of (a)(1). FCL.935 Assessment of competence
See Subpart 0. FCL.940.IRI IRI Revalidation and renewal For revalidation and renewal of an IRI certicate, the holder shall meet the requirements for revalidation and renewal of an FI certicate, in accordance with FCL.940.FI.
Additional Information
None.
15 October 2013
2 Privileges
EASA Synthetic Flight Instructor The privileges and conditions of the EASA SFI certicate are dened in FCL.905.SFI as follows: FCL.905.SFI SFI Privileges and conditions The privileges of an SFI are to carry out synthetic ight instruction, within the relevant aircraft category, for: (a) the issue, revalidation and renewal of an IR, provided that he/she holds or has held an IR in the relevant aircraft category and has completed an IRI training course; and (b) in the case of SFI for single-pilot aeroplanes: (1) the issue, revalidation and renewal of type ratings for single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes, when the applicant seeks privileges to operate in single-pilot operations. The privileges of the SFI(SPA) may be extended to ight instruction for singlepilot high performance complex aeroplanes type ratings in multi-pilot operations, provided that he/she: (i) holds an MCCI certicate; or (ii) holds or has held a TRI certicate for multi-pilot aeroplanes; and (2) provided that the privileges of the SFI(SPA) have been extended to multi-pilot operations in accordance with (1): (i) MCC; (ii) the MPL course on the basic phase; (c) in the case of SFI for multi-pilot aeroplanes: (1) the issue, revalidation and renewal of type ratings for: (i) multi-pilot aeroplanes; (ii) single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes when the applicant seeks privileges to operate in multi-pilot operations; (2) MCC; (3) the MPL course on the basic, intermediate and advanced phases, provided that, for the basic phase, he/she holds or has held an FI(A) or an IRI(A) certicate. (d) in the case of SFI for helicopters: (1) the issue, revalidation and renewal of helicopter type ratings; (2) MCC training, when the TRI has privileges to instruct for multi-pilot helicopters;
* See additional information at paragraph 5.1 and 5.2.
15 October 2013 Section 4 Part J, Subpart 5 Page 1
Article 65(5) of the ANO renders the EASA SFI valid for giving instruction for UK licences, ratings and certicates for non-EASA aircraft subject to the conditions of FCL.905.SFI.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA SFI certicate shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.900 Instructor certicates FCL.905.SFI SFI Privileges and conditions FCL.910.SFI SFI Restricted Privileges FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors FCL.915.SFI SFI Prerequisites FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL FCL.930 Training course FCL.930.SFI SFI Training course FCL.935 Assessment of competence FCL.940 Validity of instructor certicates FCL.940.SFI SFI Revalidation and renewal For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below and in Subpart0, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.900 Instructor certicates
See Subpart 0, FCL.900 excluding 900(a)(1). FCL.905.SFI SFI Privileges and conditions As above. FCL.910.SFI SFI Restricted Privileges The privileges of the SFI shall be restricted to the FTD 2/3 or FFS of the aircraft type in which the SFI training course was taken. The privileges may be extended to other FSTDs representing further types of the same category of aircraft when the holder has:* (a) satisfactorily completed the simulator content of the relevant type rating course; and (b) conducted on a complete type rating course at least 3 hours of ight instruction related to the duties of an SFI on the applicable type under the supervision and to the satisfaction of a TRE qualied for this purpose. * See additional information, Paragraph 5.3.
15 October 2013
FCL.915
See Subpart 0, FCL.915 excluding 915(b). FCL.915.SFI SFI Prerequisites An applicant for an SFI certicate shall: (a) hold or have held a CPL, MPL or ATPL in the appropriate aircraft category; (b) have completed the prociency check for the issue of the specic aircraft type rating in an FFS representing the applicable type, within the 12 months preceding the application; and (c) additionally, for an SFI(A) for multi-pilot aeroplanes or SFI(PL), have: (1) at least 1500 hours ight time as a pilot on multi-pilot aeroplanes or poweredlift, as applicable; (2) completed, as a pilot or as an observer, within the 12 months preceding the application, at least: (i) 3 route sectors on the ight deck of the applicable aircraft type; or (ii) 2 line-orientated ight training-based simulator sessions conducted by qualied ight crew on the ight deck of the applicable type. These simulator sessions shall include 2 ights of at least 2 hours each between 2 different aerodromes, and the associated pre-ight planning and debrieng; (d) additionally, for an SFI(A) for single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes: (1) have completed at least 500 hours of ight time as PIC on single-pilot aeroplanes; (2) hold or have held a multi-engine IR(A) rating; and (3) have met the requirements in (c)(2); (e) additionally, for an SFI(H), have: (1) completed, as a pilot or as an observer, at least 1 hour of ight time on the ight deck of the applicable type, within the 12 months preceding the application; and (2) in the case of multi-pilot helicopters, at least 1000 hours ying experience as a pilot on helicopters, including at least 350 hours as a pilot on multi-pilot helicopters; (3) in the case of single-pilot multi-engine helicopters, completed 500 hours as pilot of helicopters, including 100 hours as PIC on single-pilot multi-engine helicopters; (4) in the case of single-pilot single-engine helicopters, completed 250 hours as a pilot on helicopters. FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment
See Subpart 0. FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL
See Subpart 0.
15 October 2013
FCL.930.SFI SFI Training course (a) The training course for the SFI shall include: (1) the FFS content of the applicable type rating course; (2) the content of the TRI training course. (b) An applicant for an SFI certicate who holds a TRI certicate for the relevant type shall be fully credited towards the requirements of this paragraph. FCL.935 Assessment of competence
See Subpart 0. FCL.940.SFI SFI Revalidation and renewal (a) Revalidation. For revalidation of an SFI certicate the applicant shall, within the validity period of the SFI certicate, full 2 of the following 3 requirements: (1) complete 50 hours as an instructor or an examiner in FSTDs, of which at least 15 hours shall be within the 12 months preceding the expiry date of the SFI certicate; (2) receive instructor refresher training as an SFI at an ATO; (3) pass the relevant sections of the assessment of competence in accordance with FCL.935. (b) Additionally, the applicant shall have completed, on an FFS, the prociency checks for the issue of the specic aircraft type ratings representing the types for which privileges are held. (c) For at least each alternate revalidation of an SFI certicate, the holder shall have to comply with the requirement of (a)(3). (d) Renewal. If the SFI certicate has lapsed, the applicant shall, within the 12 months preceding the application: (1) complete the simulator content of the SFI training course; (2) full the requirements specied in (a)(2) and (3).
5
5.1
Additional Information
UK Part-FCL 905.SFI and training of SFIs 1. In JAR-FCL the qualications required to be able to teach the various kinds of instructor were not as dened as Part-FCL and have historically allowed SFIs to act as tutors on SFI courses - and so to teach other SFIs. Part-FCL says that the privilege to teach SFIs is granted only to Type Rating Instructors (TRIs) with 3 years of experience as TRIs.
15 October 2013
2. The UK CAA has issued an exemption to permit SFIs and TRIs with less than 3 years experience to instruct for the SFI certicate, subject to: 2.1 Any person acting as a tutor for an SFI course, shall: (a) hold a TRI or SFI certicate for the applicable type of aircraft and provide evidence to the Competent Authority that they have acted as tutor on an SFI course within the 3 years prior to the implementation of the Annexes to Regulation 1178/2011 by the country of the Competent Authority; or (b) (i) hold a TRI or SFI certicate for the applicable type of aircraft; and (ii) have completed a 2-day SFI tutor course as dened in Schedule 1, that is presented by an SFI or TRI tutor; and (iii) after completing the 2-day tutor course, pass an assessment of competence during the rst SFI course for which they act as tutor.
2.2 The assessment of competence specied in (b)(iii) shall be conducted by either: a Competent Authority Inspector/examiner; or an SFE or TRE with Tutor privileges; or a senior examiner who has tutor privileges. The Schedule 1 referred to above is given at Appendix 1 to Section 4, Part J, Subpart 5
5.2
Part-FCL 905.SFI SFIs providing instruction for the renewal or revalidation of the instrument ying privileges that are associated with type ratings.
1. Under JAR-FCL, the UK CAA allowed Synthetic Flight Instructors (SFIs) to give instruction for the renewal or revalidation of the instrument ying privileges that are associated with type ratings; i.e. the renewal or revalidation of a Type Rating combined with the type-specic Instrument Rating (IR). SFIs were not permitted to provide training for the general non-type-specic Instrument Ratings or for the initial grant of the type-specic IR privileges. The UK CAA has issued an exemption to permit SFIs to instruct for the renewal or revalidation of a combined Type Rating and Instrument Rating without having completed an Instrument rating Instructor course, subject to: (i) that person having passed a prociency check for the aircraft Type including the Instrument Rating within the last 12 months; and (ii) that the person shall not give instruction for the initial issue of any instrument rating, or for the renewal or revalidation of an instrument rating that is not associated with a Type rating that is to be renewed or revalidated.
5.3
Part-FCL 910.SFI - SFIs to extend to other FSTDs representing further types of the same category of aircraft
1. In the development of Part-FCL from JAR-FCL, new distinctions have been made between aeroplanes that are classied as high performance and those of lower performance; and also between complex and non-complex aeroplanes. This has led to some changes to the privileges of instructors and examiners compared with JAR-FCL. 2. Part FCL.910.SFI(b) species that for the SFIs privileges to be extended to simulators representing additional aircraft types, the type rating training delivered by the SFI must be to the satisfaction of a Type Rating Examiner (TRE). However, for the initial issue of
15 October 2013
the SFI certicate, including the rst aircraft type, the SFI may be tested by an SFE. There is no provision in the rule for a test to add an additional type to be performed by an SFE who is qualied on the type. 3. The UK CAA has issued an exemption to permit SFIs to extend to other FSTDs representing further types of the same category of aircraft, subject to: (a) satisfactorily completed the simulator content of the relevant type rating course; and (b) conducted on a complete type rating course at least 3 hours of ight instruction related to the duties of an SFI on the applicable type under the supervision and to the satisfaction of a TRE or SFE qualied for this purpose.
15 October 2013
SFI/TRI PART 1 linked to the SFI/TRI PART 2 & 3 (TYPE SPECIFIC) COURSE Much of the material in this Course is common to both Part 1 and Part 2 & 3 Courses. Previously, there was frequently little or no relationship between the two, when clearly there should be. The Tutor Course is intended for Tutors of Part 1, 2 & 3 TRI/SFI Courses to pursue the ideal that what is taught at the fundamental level is aligned with what is practised later on. SFI Tutor Course The course is to be presented by a Senior Examiner/Trainer to New Tutors. DAY ONE Introduction Phase: 1. Health & Safety, Fire Exits, Fire Alarm tests etc; Domestics (lunch etc), 2. A review of Participants Background (emphasis on previous Instructor experience). Give own credentials for running the Tutor Course. 3. The Terminology to be used. 4. The Scope (explain the 3 different levels of Instruction being considered). The 4 Aims of the Course. 5. 6. Overview of the Content/Timetable. Development Phase: Introduce the theme of the importance of well trained Instructors 1.Training lm. Make the comparison between Military & Civil Instructor Training. 2. 3. ERGO: The need for a very well structured Civil Instructor Course. Establish the 7 Tutor Skills (elicit from the group). Revise Instructor Skills (interactive module also checks participants knowledge) 1. Give a typical brief from a SFI/TRI course (scripted to bring out various aspects). 2. Group critique to establish Good and Bad points. 3. Analysis of Flight Instruction Part 1 (to produce 5 of the 8 Instructor Characteristics). 4. Give an example of a model pre-ight brief, incorporating appropriate skills derived from the analysis. 5. Group exercise ask Participants to produce TPs for an initial teach of an exercise in their A/C Type (e.g. SE ILS). 6. Analysis of Instruction - Part 2 (the 3 remaining Instructor Characteristics). Dene the 8 Characteristics of Good Instruction (mention the Subsidiary Skills that complement these). Build the Instructional Model the framework for any lesson (derived from instruction at basic (PPL) level but modied for pilot training at advanced levels. Explain The SFI/TRI test format, and the expectations a SFIE/TRIE should have of a new Instructor. Also: Selection of Test Exercises Initial training exercises, (not recurrent). Include Asymmetric, but start with a simple exercise. First Ofcer role preferred to Direct Entry Captain. Look at a single TRTO exercise sequentially, or vignettes from across the whole syllabus.
15 October 2013
The TRI Part 2 & 3 Course (Type Specic) discuss: 1. Course Content explain which exercises can be observed. Discuss the additional items that should be included on as course. 2. Course Progression & the Changing Emphasis the use of Building blocks, different options for added training value etc; the Inclusion of ITPs and the methods of introducing these. 3. Documentation Course Manuals & Tutor Notes, Doc 43 and Part FCL rules/AMCs. Methods used for Tutor Demonstrations (the Give and Give Backs) 1. To show how to instruct from the IOS. 2. Instruction from a Pilot seat (Flying Demo). The SFI/TRI Part 1 Course (cover this in a similar way to Part 2 & 3). Scene Setting when it should be done + what to include. Explain Role Play. 1. Part 1 simplistic. 2. Part 2 & 3 First Ofcer versus Direct Entry Captain. 3. Different Characters Single Pilot CRM in MP aircraft/Argumentative type etc. SFI/TRI Assessment of Competence no character. 4. Discuss the differences between Initial, Remedial, and Recurrent Training. Summary: Review of Skills identied so far (The Instructors Skills Set). Preparation for Day 2 (Homework). Pre ight Brieng Practice give topics. 1. 2. Design a SFI/TRI and/or Core Course supply Part FCL material. DAY TWO Introduction: Any questions/observations from Day One? Development: Participants deliver 15 minute briefs, (to include a Lesson Plan). Critiques by the group. SFI/TRI Course Design elicit group opinions on various options for content, progression and changing emphasis from the homework. Summary: Review the aims of the course ( x 4). 1. Review Tutor Skills ( x 7). 2.Promote Standardisation. 3. Review The instructor Skills Set (x 8 + Subsidiary Skills). 4. Re-afrm the Link between Part 1, 2 & 3 of the TRI/SFI Course. Wash-up and Course Critique.
15 October 2013
2 Privileges
EASA Multi-Crew Co-operation Instructor The privileges and conditions of the EASA MCCI certicate are dened in FCL.905.MCCI as follows: FCL.905.MCCI MCCI Privileges and conditions (a) The privileges of an MCCI are to carry out ight instruction during: (1) the practical part of MCC courses when not combined with type rating training; and (2) in the case of MCCI(A), the basic phase of the MPL integrated training course, provided he/she holds or has held an FI(A) or an IRI(A) certicate. Article 65(5) of the ANO renders the EASA MCCI valid for giving instruction for UK MCCI for non-EASA aircraft subject to the conditions of FCL.905.MCCI.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA MCCI certicate shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: Instructor certicates FCL.900 FCL.905.MCCI MCCI Privileges and conditions FCL.910.MCCI MCCI Restricted Privileges FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors FCL.915.MCCI MCCI Prerequisites FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL FCL.930 Training course FCL.930.MCCI MCCI Training course FCL.935 Assessment of competence FCL.940 Validity of instructor certicates FCL.940.MCCI MCCI Revalidation and renewal
May 2012
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below and in Subpart0, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.900 Instructor certicates
See Subpart 0. FCL.905.MCCI MCCI Privileges and conditions As above. FCL.910.MCCI MCCI Restricted Privileges The privileges of the holder of an MCCI certicate shall be restricted to the FNPT II/ III MCC, FTD 2/3 or FFS in which the MCCI training course was taken. The privileges may be extended to other FSTDs representing further types of aircraft when the holder has completed the practical training of the MCCI course on that type of FNPT II/III MCC, FTD 2/3 or FFS. FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors
See Subpart 0. FCL.915.MCCI MCCI Prerequisites An applicant for an MCCI certicate shall: (a) hold or have held a CPL, MPL or ATPL in the appropriate aircraft category; (b) have at least: (1) in the case of aeroplanes, airships and powered-lift aircraft, 1500 hours of ying experience as a pilot on multi-pilot operations; (2) in the case of helicopters, 1000 hours of ying experience as a pilot in multicrew operations, of which at least 350 hours in multi-pilot helicopters. FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment
See Subpart 0. FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL
Applicants for an instructor certicate shall have completed a course of theoretical knowledge and ight instruction at an ATO. In addition to the specic elements prescribed in this Part for each category of instructor, the course shall contain the elements required in FCL.920. FCL.930.MCCI MCCI Training course (a) The training course for the MCCI shall include, at least: (1) 25 hours of teaching and learning instruction; (2) technical training related to the type of FSTD where the applicant wishes to instruct;
May 2012 Section 4 Part J, Subpart 6 Page 2
(3) 3 hours of practical instruction, which may be ight instruction or MCC instruction on the relevant FNPT II/III MCC, FTD 2/3 or FFS, under the supervision of a TRI, SFI or MCCI nominated by the ATO for that purpose. These hours of ight instruction under supervision shall include the assessment of the applicants competence as described in FCL.920. (b) Applicants holding or having held an FI, TRI, CRI, IRI or SFI certicate shall be fully credited towards the requirement of (a)(1). FCL.935 Assessment of competence
See Subpart 0. FCL.940.MCCI MCCI Revalidation and renewal (a) For revalidation of an MCCI certicate the applicant shall have completed the requirements of FCL.930.MCCI (a)(3) on the relevant type of FNPT II/III, FTD 2/3 or FFS, within the last 12 months of the validity period of the MCCI certicate. (b) Renewal. If the MCCI certicate has lapsed, the applicant shall complete the requirements of FCL.930.MCCI (a)(2) and (3) on the relevant type of FNPT II/III MCC, FTD 2/3 or FFS.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 7
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA STI certicate may exercise the privileges of the certicate to carry out synthetic ight instruction, within the appropriate aircraft category that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence or instructor certicate.
2 Privileges
EASA Synthetic Training Instructor The privileges and conditions of the EASA STI certicate are dened in FCL.905.STI as follows: FCL.905.STI STI Privileges and conditions (a) The privileges of an STI are to carry out synthetic ight instruction in the appropriate aircraft category for: (1) the issue of a licence; (2) the issue, revalidation or renewal of an IR and a class or type rating for singlepilot aircraft, except for single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes. (b) Additional privileges for the STI(A). The privileges of an STI(A) shall include synthetic ight instruction during the core ying skills training of the MPL integrated training course. Article 65(5) of the ANO renders the EASA STI valid for giving instruction for UK licences for non-EASA aircraft subject to the conditions of FCL.905.STI.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA STI certicate shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.900 Instructor certicates FCL.905.STI STI Privileges and conditions FCL.910.STI STI Restricted Privileges FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors FCL.915.STI STI Prerequisites FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL FCL.930 Training course FCL.930.STI STI Training course FCL.935 Assessment of competence FCL.940 Validity of instructor certicates FCL.940.STI STI Revalidation and renewal
May 2012
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below and in Subpart0, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.900 Instructor certicates
See Subpart 0. FCL.905.STI As above. FCL.910.STI STI Restricted Privileges STI Privileges and conditions
The privileges of an STI shall be restricted to the FNPT II/III, FTD 2/3 or FFS in which the STI training course was taken. The privileges may be extended to other FSTDs representing further types of aircraft when the holder has: (a) completed the FFS content of the TRI course on the applicable type; (b) passed the prociency check for the specic aircraft type rating on an FFS of the applicable type, within the 12 months preceding the application; (c) conducted, on a type rating course, at least one FSTD session related to the duties of an STI with a minimum duration of 3 hours on the applicable type of aircraft, under the supervision of a ight instructor examiner (FIE). FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors
An applicant for an STI certicate shall: (a) hold, or have held within the 3 years prior to the application, a pilot licence and instructional privileges appropriate to the courses on which instruction is intended; (b) have completed in an FNPT the relevant prociency check for the class or type rating, within a period of 12 months preceding the application. An applicant for an STI(A) wishing to instruct on BITDs only, shall complete only the exercises appropriate for a skill test for the issue of a PPL(A); (c) additionally, for an STI(H), have completed at least 1 hour of ight time as an observer on the ight deck of the applicable type of helicopter, within the 12 months preceding the application. FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment
See Subpart 0. FCL.925 Additional requirements for instructors for the MPL
See Subpart 0.
May 2012
FCL.930
Training course
(a) The training course for the STI shall comprise at least 3 hours of ight instruction related to the duties of an STI in an FFS, FTD 2/3 or FNPT II/III, under the supervision of an FIE. These hours of ight instruction under supervision shall include the assessment of the applicants competence as described in FCL.920. Applicants for an STI(A) wishing to instruct on a BITD only, shall complete the ight instruction on a BITD. (b) For applicants for an STI(H), the course shall also include the FFS content of the applicable TRI course. FCL.935 Assessment of competence
(a) Revalidation. For revalidation of an STI certicate the applicant shall have, within the last 12 months of the validity period of the STI certicate: (1) conducted at least 3 hours of ight instruction in an FFS or FNPT II/III or BITD, as part of a complete CPL, IR, PPL or class or type rating course; and (2) passed in the FFS, FTD 2/3 or FNPT II/III on which ight instruction is routinely conducted, the applicable sections of the prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to this Part for the appropriate class or type of aircraft. For an STI(A) instructing on BITDs only, the prociency check shall include only the exercises appropriate for a skill test for the issue of a PPL(A). (b) Renewal. If the STI certicate has lapsed, the applicant shall: (1) receive refresher training as an STI at an ATO; (2) pass in the FFS, FTD 2/3 or FNPT II/III on which ight instruction is routinely conducted, the applicable sections of the prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to this Part for the appropriate class or type of aircraft. For an STI(A) instructing on BITDs only, the prociency check shall include only the exercises appropriate for a skill test for the issue of a PPL(A). (3) conduct on a complete CPL, IR, PPL or class or type rating course, at least 3 hours of ight instruction under the supervision of an FI, CRI(A), IRI or TRI(H) nominated by the ATO for this purpose. At least 1 hour of ight instruction shall be supervised by an FIE(A).
May 2012
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
2 Privileges
EASA Mountain Rating Instructor The privileges and conditions of the EASA MI certicate are dened in FCL.905.MI as follows: FCL.905.MI MI Privileges and conditions The privileges of an MI are to carry out ight instruction for the issue of a mountain rating.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA MI certicate shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.900 Instructor certicates FCL.905.MI MI Privileges and conditions FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors FCL.915.MI MI Prerequisites FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment FCL.930 Training course FCL.930.MI MI Training course FCL.935 Assessment of competence FCL.940 Validity of instructor certicates FCL.940.MI MI Revalidation and renewal For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below and in Subpart0, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.900 Instructor certicates
See Subpart 0, FCL.900 excluding (a)(2) and (b). FCL.905.MI As above. MI Privileges and conditions
May 2012
FCL.915
An applicant for an MI certicate shall: (a) hold an FI, CRI, or TRI certicate, with privileges for single-pilot aeroplanes; (b) hold a mountain rating. FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment
(a) The training course for the MI shall include the assessment of the applicants competence as described in FCL.920. (b) Before attending the course, applicants shall have passed a pre-entry ight test with an MI holding an FI certicate to assess their experience and ability to undertake the training course. FCL.935 Assessment of competence
The MI certicate is valid as long as the, FI, TRI or CRI certicate is valid.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 9
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA FTI certicate may exercise the privileges of the certicate to carry out ight instruction, within the appropriate aircraft category that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence or instructor certicate.
2 Privileges
EASA Flight Test Instructor The privileges and conditions of the EASA FTI certicate are dened in FCL.905.FTI as follows: FCL.905.FTI FTI Privileges and conditions (a) The privileges of a ight test instructor (FTI) are to instruct, within the appropriate aircraft category, for: (1) the issue of category 1 or 2 ight test ratings, provided he/she holds the relevant category of ight test rating; (2) the issue of an FTI certicate, within the relevant category of ight test rating, provided that the instructor has at least 2 years of experience instructing for the issue of ight test ratings. (b) The privileges of an FTI holding a category 1 ight test rating include the provision of ight instruction also in relation to category 2 ight test ratings.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA FTI certicate shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.900 Instructor certicates FCL.905.FTI FTI Privileges and conditions FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors FCL.915.FTI FTI Prerequisites FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment FCL.930 Training course FCL.930.FTI FTI Training course FCL.935 Assessment of competence FCL.940 Validity of instructor certicates FCL.940.FTI FTI Revalidation and renewal
May 2012
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below and in Subpart0, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.900 Instructor certicates
See Subpart 0. FCL.905.FTI As above. FCL.915 General prerequisites and requirements for instructors FTI Privileges and conditions
An applicant for an FTI certicate shall: (a) hold a ight test rating issued in accordance with FCL.820; (b) have completed at least 200 hours of category 1 or 2 ight tests. FCL.920 Instructor competencies and assessment
(a) The training course for the FTI shall include at least: (1) 25 hours of teaching and learning; (2) 10 hours of technical training, including revision of technical knowledge, the preparation of lesson plans and the development of classroom/simulator instructional skills; (3) 5 hours of practical ight instruction under the supervision of an FTI qualied in accordance with FCL.905.FTI (b). These hours of ight instruction shall include the assessment of the applicants competence as described in FCL.920. (b) Crediting (1) Applicants holding or having held an instructor certicate shall be fully credited towards the requirement of (a)(1). (2) In addition, applicants holding or having held an FI or TRI certicate in the relevant aircraft category shall be fully credited towards the requirements of (a)(2). FCL.935 Assessment of competence
See Subpart 0.
May 2012 Section 4 Part J, Subpart 9 Page 2
FCL.940.FTI FTI Revalidation and renewal (a) Revalidation. For revalidation of an FTI certicate, the applicant shall, within the validity period of the FTI certicate, full 1 of the following requirements: (1) complete at least: (i) 50 hours of ight tests, of which at least 15 hours shall be within the 12 months preceding the expiry date of the FTI certicate; and (ii) 5 hours of ight test ight instruction within the 12 months preceding the expiry date of the FTI certicate; Or (2) receive refresher training as an FTI at an ATO. The refresher training shall be based on the practical ight instruction element of the FTI training course, in accordance with FCL.930.FTI (a)(3), and include at least 1 instruction ight under the supervision of an FTI qualied in accordance with FCL.905.FTI (b). (b) Renewal. If the FTI certicate has lapsed, the applicant shall receive refresher training as an FTI at an ATO. The refresher training shall comply at least with the requirements of FCL.930.FTI (a)(3).
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Part K Subpart 0
1 Applicability
This section sets out the requirements for Examiner Certicates included in EASA licences and is applicable to all EASA licence holders adding an Examiner Certicate to a licence. Examiner Certicates are valid for the same privileges for UK licences and ratings issued under the Air Navigation Order.
2 Privileges
EASA Examiner Certicates The privileges of the EASA Examiner Certicate are to carry out Skill tests and prociency checks for EASA licences and ratings as dened in the Specic Examiner Certicate privileges in the subsequent subparts of this section.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA Examiner Certicate shall comply with the following PartFCL requirements: Examiner Certicates Limitation of privileges in case of vested interests Prerequisites for examiners Examiner standardisation Examiners assessment of competence Validity, revalidation and renewal of Examiner Certicates Conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.1000 FCL.1005 FCL.1010 FCL.1015 FCL.1020 FCL.1025 FCL.1030 FCL.1000 Examiner Certicates (a) General. Holders of an Examiner Certicate shall: (1) hold an equivalent licence, rating or certicate to the ones for which they are authorised to conduct skill tests, prociency checks or assessments of competence and the privilege to instruct for them; (2) be qualied to act as PIC on the aircraft during a skill test, prociency check or assessment of competence when conducted on the aircraft.
May 2012
(b) Special conditions (1) In the case of introduction of new aircraft in the Member States or in an operators eet, when compliance with the requirements in this Subpart is not possible, the competent authority may issue a specic certicate giving privileges for the conduct of skill tests and prociency checks. Such a certicate shall be limited to the skill tests and prociency checks necessary for the introduction of the new type of aircraft and its validity shall not, in any case, exceed 1 year. (2) Holders of a certicate issued in accordance with (b) (1) who wish to apply for an examiner certicate shall comply with the prerequisites and revalidation requirements for that category of examiner. (c) Examination outside the territory of the Member States (1) Notwithstanding paragraph (a), in the case of skill tests and prociency checks provided in an ATO located outside the territory of the Member States, the competent authority of the Member State may issue an Examiner Certicate to an applicant holding a pilot licence issued by a third country in accordance with ICAO Annex 1, provided that the applicant: (i) holds at least an equivalent licence, rating, or certicate to the one for which they are authorised to conduct skill tests, prociency checks or assessments of competence, and in any case at least a CPL . (ii) complies with the requirements established in this Subpart for the issue of the relevant Examiner Certicate; and (iii) demonstrates to the competent authority an adequate level of knowledge of European aviation safety rules to be able to exercise examiner privileges in accordance with this Part. (2) The certicate referred to in paragraph (1) shall be limited to providing prociency tests/checks: (i) outside the territory of the Member States; and (ii) to pilots who have sufcient knowledge of the language in which the test/check is given. FCL.1005 Limitation of privileges in case of vested interests Examiners shall not conduct: (a) skill tests or assessments of competence of applicants for the issue of a licence, rating or certicate: (1) to whom they have provided ight instruction for the licence, rating or certicate for which the skill test or assessment of competence is being taken; or (2) when they have been responsible for the recommendation for the skill test, in accordance with FCL.030 (b); (b) skill tests, prociency checks or assessments of competence whenever they feel that their objectivity may be affected. NOTE: For clarication on FCL.1005 refer to 5 Additional Information
May 2012
FCL.1010 Prerequisites for examiners Applicants for an Examiner Certicate shall demonstrate: (a) relevant knowledge, background and appropriate experience related to the privileges of an examiner; (b) that they have not been subject to any sanctions, including the suspension, limitation or revocation of any of their licences, ratings or certicates issued in accordance with this Part, for non-compliance with the Basic Regulation and its Implementing Rules during the last 3 years. FCL.1015 Examiner standardisation (a) Applicants for an Examiner Certicate shall undertake a standardisation course provided by the competent authority or by an ATO and approved by the competent authority. (b) The standardisation course shall consist of theoretical and practical instruction and shall include, at least: (1) the conduct of 2 skill tests, prociency checks or assessments of competences for the licences, ratings or certicates for which the applicant seeks the privilege to conduct tests and checks; (2) instruction on the applicable requirements in this part and the applicable air operations requirements, the conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence, and their documentation and reporting; (3) a brieng on the national administrative procedures, requirements for protection of personal data, liability, accident insurance and fees. (c) Holders of an Examiner Certicate shall not conduct skill tests, prociency checks or assessments of competence of an applicant for which the competent authority is not the same that issued the Examiners Certicate, unless: (1) they have informed the competent authority of the applicant of their intention to conduct the skill test, prociency check or assessment of competence and of the scope of their privileges as examiners; (2) they have received a brieng from the competent authority of the applicant on the elements mentioned in (b)(3). FCL.1020 Examiners assessment of competence Applicants for an Examiner Certicate shall demonstrate their competence to an inspector from the competent authority or a senior examiner specically authorised to do so by the competent authority responsible for the Examiners Certicate through the conduct of a skill test, prociency check or assessment of competence in the examiner role for which privileges are sought, including brieng, conduct of the skill test, prociency check or assessment of competence, and assessment of the person to whom the test, check or assessment is given, debrieng and recording documentation. FCL.1025 Validity, revalidation and renewal of examiner certicates (a) Validity. An Examiner Certicate shall be valid for 3 years. (b) Revalidation. An Examiner Certicate shall be revalidated when the holder has, during the validity period of the certicate:
May 2012
(1) conducted at least 2 skill tests, prociency checks or assessments of competence every year; (2) attended an examiner refresher seminar provided by the competent authority or by an ATO and approved by the competent authority, during the last year of the validity period. (3) One of the skill tests or prociency checks completed during the last year of the validity period in accordance with (1) shall have been assessed by an inspector from the competent authority or by a senior examiner specically authorised to do so by the competent authority responsible for the Examiners Certicate. (4) When the applicant for the revalidation holds privileges for more than one category of examiner, combined revalidation of all examiner privileges may be achieved when the applicant complies with the requirements in (b)(1) and (2) and FCL.1020 for one of the categories of Examiner Certicate held, in agreement with the competent authority. (c) Renewal. If the certicate has expired, applicants shall comply with the requirements of (b)(2) and FCL.1020 before they can resume the exercise of the privileges. (d) An Examiner Certicate shall only be revalidated or renewed if the applicant demonstrates continued compliance with the requirements in FCL.1010 and FCL.1030. FCL.1030 Conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence (a) When conducting skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence, examiners shall: (1) ensure that communication with the applicant can be established without language barriers; (2) verify that the applicant complies with all the qualication, training and experience requirements in this Part for the issue, revalidation or renewal of the licence, rating or certicate for which the skill test, prociency check or assessment of competence is taken; (3) make the applicant aware of the consequences of providing incomplete, inaccurate or false information related to their training and ight experience. (b) After completion of the skill test or prociency check, the examiner shall: (1) inform the applicant of the result of the test. In the event of a partial pass or fail, the examiner shall inform the applicant that he/she may not exercise the privileges of the rating until a full pass has been obtained. The examiner shall detail any further training requirement and explain the applicants right of appeal; (2) in the event of a pass in a prociency check or assessment of competence for revalidation or renewal, endorse the applicants licence or certicate with the new expiry date of the rating or certicate, if specically authorised for that purpose by the competent authority responsible for the applicants licence; (3) provide the applicant with a signed report of the skill test or prociency check and submit without delay copies of the report to the competent authority responsible for the applicants licence, and to the competent authority that issued the examiner certicate. The report shall include:
May 2012
(i) a declaration that the examiner has received information from the applicant regarding his/her experience and instruction, and found that experience and instruction complying with the applicable requirements in this Part; (ii) conrmation that all the required manoeuvres and exercises have been completed, as well as information on the verbal theoretical knowledge examination, when applicable. If an item has been failed, the examiner shall record the reasons for this assessment; (iii) the result of the test, check or assessment of competence. (c) Examiners shall maintain records for 5 years with details of all skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence performed and their results. (d) Upon request by the competent authority responsible for the Examiner Certicate, or the competent authority responsible for the applicants licence, examiners shall submit all records and reports, and any other information, as required for oversight activities.
Additional Information
FCL.1000: (a)(1) TRE(A) and SFE(A) Licence Status An examiner who holds only a UK national licence, but not a JAR/EASA compliant licence, may continue to exercise examiner privileges on candidates who hold a UKissued EASA licence or a UK-issued JAR licence until 8th April 2014, or when their examiner privileges are revalidated or renewed, whichever is the earlier. Advice must be sought from other member states competent authorities before conducting tests, checks or assessments of competence on holders of non-UK issued JAR/EASA licences. The UK CAA is not permitted to issue an EASA examiner certicate to an existing National or JAR licence. Examiners applying for initial issue (including addition/change of type), revalidation or renewal of their examiner certicate will therefore also need to apply for an EASA licence, using Form SRG1104. Both applications must be accompanied by the appropriate fees. The Certicate of Revalidation for existing examiner privileges must not be signed by any Senior Examiner or CAA Inspector. FCL.1005 Under Part-FCL the expression skills test or assessment of competence is used. A skill test is required for the issue of a licence, rating or certicate. A skill test is also required if the IR has not been renewed or revalidated after 7 years. The assessment of competence is used for initial, renewal and revalidation of instructor and examiner certicates. The prociency check is required for revalidation or renewal of ratings and IRs.
30 January 2013
FCL.1005 (a) states that for skill tests and assessment of competence for the issue of the licence, rating or certicate, the examiner must not have provided ight instruction. Therefore this paragraph applies for the issue of ratings, IRs or for the instructor and examiner certicates but not for revalidation or renewal. FCL.1005 (b) introduces the prociency check and obliges the examiner not to conduct any test, check or assessment of competence if their objectivity may be affected. Therefore: (a) Examiners may not provide instruction on any applicant who requires a skill test or assessment of competence for the issue of a licence, rating or certicate; (b) Examiners who may have their objectivity affected may also not conduct any skill test, prociency check or assessment of competence for issue, renewal or revalidation; (c) An examiner may provide instruction on any applicant who requires a prociency check for the revalidation or renewal of a rating or IR; (d) An examiner conducting an LPC/OPC or IR revalidations or renewals may provide refresher or remedial training to the applicant prior, during or post a prociency check. FCL.1015(c)(2) Brieng of non UK Examiners (a) Obtaining the brieng (i) The examiner brieng required by FCL.1015(c)(2) is web based and requires the examiner to register at: http://www.caa.co.uk/default.aspx?catid=2026&pagetype=90&pageid=13935 to view the brieng, and complete the questionnaire. A certicate of completion will be sent by email. There is currently no charge for the brieng. (ii) Non-UK examiners are to complete the examiner brieng every three years. Acceptability of an examiner to test UK-licensed pilots is dependent upon the examiners certicate issued by the examiners State of Licence Issue remaining valid in compliance with the requirements of Part-FCL and Part-ARA under the oversight of the examiners competent authority. (iii) All examiners are required to have a full understanding of the UK CAAs Standards Documents as applicable to their examiner category. (This is required for compliance with Part ARA, ARA.FCL.210) (b) Before each skill test, prociency check or assessment of competence (i) Non-UK examiners authorised by other EASA States must inform the UK CAA on each occasion of their intention to conduct a skill test, prociency check or assessment of competence for the holder of a UK-issued Part-FCL or JAR-FCL licence. (ii) Non-UK examiners conducting skill tests under the management system of a UK ATO may apply the ATOs approved process for designating an examiner. In all cases the CAA must be informed by the non-UK examiner of his intent to conduct a skill test and of any occasion when he intends to conduct a prociency check or assessment of competence. (iii) For prociency checks, assessments of competence and skill tests, the examiner shall inform the UK CAA by sending an email to: testnotication@caa.co.uk. The subject/title text in the email MUST begin with ST, PC or AC followed by the examiners name and licence number (example ST Biggles XXX.FCL.123456A.A). The pre-x ST is to be used for requesting a Skill Test, PC for a Prociency Check and AC for an Assessment of Competence.
30 January 2013
The email must contain the following information: Details of pilot who is to be tested First Name: UK-issued Licence No: Date of Birth: Examiner Details First Name: Licence No: State of Licence Issue: Date of Birth: Examiner Privileges: (List the examiner privileges of the examiner certicate as issued by their State of Licence Issue. Enclose a scanned copy of the examiner certicate) Date of completion of UK CAA examiner brieng: Test Details Type of Test being conducted: ST/PC/AC Class or Type of Aircraft: Simulator No or Aircraft Registration: Date of Test: Venue for Test: Time of Test: Non-UK examiners may conduct a prociency check or an assessment of (iv) competence once they have received the examiner brieng and received automated acknowledgement of their email. (v) In all other circumstances (unless designated by an ATO) a non-UK examiner shall not conduct a skill test until they have received an email from the UK CAA conrming that they have been designated as the examiner for the test. (c) Additional information (i) The UK CAA will sample skill tests, prociency checks or assessments of competence according to a published national oversight programme. (ARA. FCL.205(a)). (ii) The UK CAA publishes a list of all examiners certied by the UK CAA and all nonUK examiners who have received the examiner brieng in accordance with FCL.1015. ARA.FCL.205(c). (iii) This process is not to be used for licence validations. (iv) An examiner may only endorse the certicate of revalidation in a pilots licence to revalidate a rating, or to renew a rating which has expired for not more than 3 years and is still included in the licence. If the rating has expired by more than 3 years, or has been removed from Section XII on page 4 of the licence, the application must be submitted to Licensing & Training Standards for the rating to be entered into the certicate of revalidation and a fee will apply. Other Initials: Surname: Other Initials: Surname:
30 January 2013
FCL.1010 and FCL.1025: Senior Examiners for Multi-Pilot Aeroplanes and Single Pilot High Performance Complex Aeroplanes Aircrew Regulation Part-FCL.1000(a) states that all examiner categories are required to... hold an equivalent licence, rating or certicate to the ones for which they are authorised to conduct skill tests, prociency checks or assessments of competence and the privilege to instruct for them... A Senior Examiner may only conduct assessments of competence on types for which they hold an examiner certicate in the appropriate category. Therefore the previous practice under JAR-FCL of permitting a Senior Examiner within a TRTO to conduct assessments of competence on all types within the TRTO will cease when the Senior Examiner authorisation is amended, revalidated or renewed. When an amendment, revalidation or renewal occurs, Part-FCL requirements apply and the privileges will be adjusted to reect EASA requirements. Under JAR-FCL a Senior Examiner within a TRTO was allowed to examine TREs/SFEs on ALL types within that TRTO. Under Part-FCL the privileges are restricted to only those types on which the SE holds a valid examiner certicate. When the SE certicate is amended, revalidated or renewed the current ALL AEROPLANES privileges will be withdrawn and will be re-issued with an EASA certicate for those types on which they hold an examiner certicate in accordance with Part-FCL. The recency requirement for a Senior Examiner to conduct a minimum of 2 assessments of competence per year must be maintained. Each SE must demonstrate to UK CAA that arrangements are in place to ensure the minimum recency requirement can be achieved. The SE may act on behalf of more than one organisation. Any such arrangement must be conrmed in writing to Flight Crew Standards. The TRTO/ATO or AOC Operations Manuals need to reect this arrangement. An SE may revalidate or renew an SFE/TRE outside the above agreements, providing they are within the scope of their privileges, and subject to prior written agreement of Flight Crew Standards. All SFE/TREs will require an observation by a CAA Inspector at least every third revalidation as per current policy. Flight Crew Standards reserve the right to observe more frequently. FCL.1030(b)(2) Type and Class Rating Renewal Arrangements Where the type rating has expired by more than 3 years, or has been removed from Section XII on page 4 of the licence, the application must be submitted to Licensing & Training Standards for the certicate of revalidation entry by the UK CAA, and a fee will apply. Where the type rating has expired by less than 3 years, and is included in Section XII on page 4 of the pilots licence, the examiner may sign the certicate of revalidation included in the licence. Following a renewal the examiner is responsible for ensuring that all relevant documentation (ATO certicate or other documental evidence conrming successful completion of training, and application form) is submitted to the UK CAA without delay.
30 January 2013
2 Privileges
EASA Flight Examiner The privileges and conditions of the EASA FE certicate are dened in FCL.1005.FE as follows: FCL.1005.FE FE Privileges and conditions (a) FE(A). The privileges of an FE for aeroplanes are to conduct: (1) skill tests for the issue of the PPL(A) and skill tests and prociency checks for associated single-pilot class and type ratings, except for single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes, provided that the examiner has completed at least 1 000 hours of ight time as a pilot on aeroplanes or TMGs, including at least 250 hours of ight instruction; (2) skill tests for the issue of the CPL(A) and skill tests and prociency checks for the associated single-pilot class and type ratings, except for single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes, provided that the examiner has completed at least 2 000 hours of ight time as a pilot on aeroplanes or TMGs, including at least 250 hours of ight instruction; (3) skill tests and prociency checks for the LAPL(A), provided that the examiner has completed at least 500 hours of ight time as a pilot on aeroplanes or TMGs, including at least 100 hours of ight instruction; (4) skill tests for the issue of a mountain rating, provided that the examiner has completed at least 500 hours of ight time as a pilot on aeroplanes or TMGs, including at least 500 take-offs and landings of ight instruction for the mountain rating. (b) FE(H). The privileges of an FE for helicopters are to conduct: (1) skill tests for the issue of the PPL(H) and skill tests and prociency checks for single-pilot single-engine helicopter type ratings entered in a PPL(H), provided that the examiner has completed 1 000 hours of ight time as a pilot on helicopters, including at least 250 hours of ight instruction; (2) skill tests for the issue of the CPL(H) and skill tests and prociency checks for single-pilot single-engine helicopter type ratings entered in a CPL(H), provided the examiner has completed 2 000 hours of ight time as pilot on helicopters, including at least 250 hours of ight instruction; (3) skill tests and prociency checks for single-pilot multi-engine helicopter type ratings entered in a PPL(H) or a CPL(H), provided the examiner has completed the requirements in (1) or (2), as applicable, and holds a CPL(H) or ATPL(H) and, when applicable, an IR(H);
May 2012
(4) skill tests and prociency checks for the LAPL(H), provided that the examiner has completed at least 500 hours of ight time as a pilot on helicopters, including at least 150 hours of ight instruction. (c) FE(As). The privileges of an FE for airships are to conduct skill tests for the issue of the PPL(As) and CPL(As) and skill tests and prociency checks for the associated airship type ratings, provided that the examiner has completed 500 hours of ight time as a pilot on airships, including 100 hours of ight instruction. (d) FE(S). The privileges of an FE for sailplanes are to conduct: (1) skill tests and prociency checks for the SPL and the LAPL(S), provided that the examiner has completed 300 hours of ight time as a pilot on sailplanes or powered sailplanes, including 150 hours or 300 launches of ight instruction; (2) prociency checks for the extension of the SPL privileges to commercial operations, provided that the examiner has completed 300 hours of ight time as a pilot on sailplanes or powered sailplanes, including 90 hours of ight instruction; (3) skill tests for the extension of the SPL or LAPL(S) privileges to TMG, provided that the examiner has completed 300 hours of ight time as a pilot on sailplanes or powered sailplanes, including 50 hours of ight instruction on TMG. (e) FE(B). The privileges of an FE for balloons are to conduct: (1) skill tests for the issue of the BPL and the LAPL(B) and skill tests and prociency checks for the extension of the privileges to another balloon class or group, provided that the examiner has completed 250 hours of ight time as a pilot on balloons, including 50 hours of ight instruction; (2) prociency checks for the extension of the BPL privileges to commercial operations, provided that the examiner has completed 300 hours of ight time as a pilot on balloons, of which 50 hours in the same group of balloons for which the extension is sought. The 300 hours of ight time shall include 50hours of ight instruction. Article 65(5) of the ANO renders the EASA FE valid for conducting ight examinations or prociency checks for UK national licences, Ratings, Authorisations and Certicates for non-EASA aircraft subject to the conditions of FCL.1005.FE
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA FE certicate shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.1000 FCL.1005 FCL.1005.FE FCL.1010 FCL.1010.FE FCL.1015 FCL.1020 FCL.1025
May 2012
Examiner certicates Limitation of privileges in case of vested interests FE Privileges and conditions Prerequisites for examiners FE Prerequisites Examiner standardisation Examiners assessment of competence Validity, revalidation and renewal of examiner certicates
Section 4 Part K, Subpart 1 Page 2
FCL.1030
Conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.1000 Examiner certicates See Subpart 0. FCL.1005 Limitation of privileges in case of vested interests See Subpart 0. FCL.1005.FE FE Privileges and conditions As above. FCL.1010 Prerequisites for examiners See Subpart 0. FCL.1010.FE FE Prerequisites An applicant for an FE certicate shall hold an FI certicate in the appropriate aircraft category. FCL.1015 Examiner standardisation See Subpart 0. FCL.1020 Examiners assessment of competence See Subpart 0. FCL.1025 Validity, revalidation and renewal of examiner certicates See Subpart 0. FCL.1030 Conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence See Subpart 0.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 2
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA TRE certicate may exercise the privileges of the certicate to conduct initial issue type ratings or prociency checks for Part-FCL and UK national Licences or Ratings that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence for the purpose of issue, revalidation or renewal of a type rating.
2 Privileges
EASA Type Rating Examiners The privileges and conditions of the EASA TRE certicate are dened in FCL.1005.TRE as follows: FCL.1005.TRE TRE Privileges and conditions
(a) TRE(A) and TRE(PL). The privileges of a TRE for aeroplanes or powered-lift aircraft are to conduct: (1) skill tests for the initial issue of type ratings for aeroplanes or powered-lift aircraft, as applicable; (2) prociency checks for revalidation or renewal of type and IRs; (3) skill tests for ATPL(A) issue; (4) skill tests for MPL issue, provided that the examiner has complied with the requirements in FCL.925; (5) assessments of competence for the issue, revalidation or renewal of a TRI or SFI certicate in the applicable aircraft category, provided that the examiner has completed at least 3 years as a TRE. (b) TRE(H). The privileges of a TRE(H) are to conduct : (1) skill tests and prociency checks for the issue, revalidation or renewal of helicopter type ratings; (2) prociency checks for the revalidation or renewal of IRs, or for the extension of the IR(H) from single-engine helicopters to multi-engine helicopters, provided the TRE(H) holds a valid IR(H); (3) skill tests for ATPL(H) issue; (4) assessments of competence for the issue, revalidation or renewal of a TRI(H) or SFI(H) certicate, provided that the examiner has completed at least 3years as a TRE. Article 65(5) of the ANO renders the EASA TRE valid for conducting ight examinations or prociency checks for UK national licences or Ratings for non-EASA aircraft subject to the conditions of FCL.1005.TRE
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A.
May 2012
An applicant for the EASA TRE certicate shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.1000 FCL.1005 FCL.1005.TRE FCL.1010 FCL.1010.TRE FCL.1015 FCL.1020 FCL.1025 FCL.1030 Examiner certicates Limitation of privileges in case of vested interests TRE Privileges and conditions Prerequisites for examiners TRE Prerequisites Examiner standardisation Examiners assessment of competence Validity, revalidation and renewal of examiner certicates Conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.1000 Examiner certicates See Subpart 0. FCL.1005 Limitation of privileges in case of vested interests See Subpart 0. FCL.1005.TRE As above. FCL.1010 Prerequisites for examiners See Subpart 0. FCL.1010.TRE TRE Prerequisites TRE Privileges and conditions
(a) TRE(A) and TRE(PL). Applicants for a TRE certicate for aeroplanes and poweredlift aircraft shall: (1) in the case of multi-pilot aeroplanes or powered-lift aircraft, have completed 1500 hours of ight time as a pilot of multi-pilot aeroplanes or powered-lift aircraft, as applicable, of which at least 500 hours shall be as PIC; (2) in the case of single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes, have completed 500 hours of ight time as a pilot of single-pilot aeroplanes, of which at least 200 hours shall be as PIC; (3) hold a CPL or ATPL and a TRI certicate for the applicable type; (4) for the initial issue of an TRE certicate, have completed at least 50 hours of ight instruction as a TRI, FI or SFI in the applicable type or an FSTD representing that type. (b) TRE(H). Applicants for a TRE(H) certicate for helicopters shall: (1) hold a TRI(H) certicate or, in the case of single-pilot single-engine helicopters, a valid FI(H) certicate, for the applicable type; (2) for the initial issue of a TRE certicate, have completed 50 hours of ight instruction as a TRI, FI or SFI in the applicable type or an FSTD representing that type;
May 2012
(3) in the case of multi-pilot helicopters, hold a CPL(H) or ATPL(H) and have completed 1500 hours of ight as a pilot on multi-pilot helicopters, of which at least 500 hours shall be as PIC; (4) in the case of single-pilot multi-engine helicopters: (i) have completed 1000 hours of ight as pilot on helicopters, of which at least 500 hours shall be as PIC; (ii) hold a CPL(H) or ATPL(H) and, when applicable, a valid IR(H); (5) in the case of single-pilot single-engine helicopters: (i) have completed 750 hours of ight as a pilot on helicopters, of which at least 500 hours shall be as PIC; (ii) hold a professional helicopter pilot licence. (6) Before the privileges of a TRE(H) are extended from single-pilot multi-engine to multi-pilot multi-engine privileges on the same type of helicopter, the holder shall have at least 100 hours in multi-pilot operations on this type. (7) In the case of applicants for the rst multi-pilot multi-engine TRE certicate, the 1500 hours of ight experience on multi-pilot helicopters required in (b) (3) may be considered to have been met if they have completed the 500 hours of ight time as PIC on a multi-pilot helicopter of the same type. FCL.1015 Examiner standardisation See Subpart 0. FCL.1020 Examiners assessment of competence See Subpart 0. FCL.1025 Validity, revalidation and renewal of examiner certicates See Subpart 0. FCL.1030 Conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence See Subpart 0.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
2 Privileges
EASA Class Rating Examiners The privileges and conditions of the EASA CRE certicate are dened in FCL.1005.CRE as follows: FCL.1005.CRE CRE Privileges
The privileges of a CRE are to conduct, for single-pilot aeroplanes, except for singlepilot high performance complex aeroplanes: (a) skill tests for the issue of class and type ratings; (b) prociency checks for: (1) revalidation or renewal of class and type ratings; (2) revalidation and renewal of IRs, provided that the CRE complies with the requirements in FCL.1010.IRE (a). Article 65(5) of the ANO renders the EASA CRE valid for conducting ight examinations or prociency checks for UK national licences or Ratings for non-EASA aircraft subject to the conditions of FCL.1005.CRE
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA CRE certicate shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.1000 FCL.1005 FCL.1005.CRE FCL.1010 FCL.1010.CRE FCL.1015 FCL.1020 FCL.1025 FCL.1030 Examiner certicates Limitation of privileges in case of vested interests CRE Privileges and conditions Prerequisites for examiners CRE Prerequisites Examiner standardisation Examiners assessment of competence Validity, revalidation and renewal of examiner certicates Conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence
May 2012
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.1000 Examiner certicates See Subpart 0. FCL.1005 Limitation of privileges in case of vested interests See Subpart 0. FCL.1005.CRE As above. FCL.1010 Prerequisites for examiners See Subpart 0. FCL.1010.CRE CRE Prerequisites CRE Privileges and conditions
Applicants for a CRE certicate shall: (a) hold a CPL(A), MPL(A) or ATPL(A) with single-pilot privileges or have held it and hold a PPL(A); (b) hold a CRI certicate for the applicable class or type; (c) have completed 500 hours of ight time as a pilot on aeroplanes. FCL.1015 Examiner standardisation See Subpart 0. FCL.1020 Examiners assessment of competence See Subpart 0. FCL.1025 Validity, revalidation and renewal of examiner certicates See Subpart 0. FCL.1030 Conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence See Subpart 0.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 4 EASA Instrument Rating Examiners IRE Aeroplanes, Helicopters and Airships
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA IRE certicate may exercise the privileges of the certicate to conduct skill tests or prociency checks for IR rating in Part-FCL licences, IR and IMC ratings in UK national licences for the purpose of issue, revalidation or renewal of instrument rating.
2 Privileges
EASA Instrument Rating Examiners The privileges and conditions of the EASA IRE certicate are dened in FCL.1005.IRE as follows: FCL.1005.IRE IRE Privileges
The privileges of a holder of an IRE are to conduct skill tests for the issue, and prociency checks for the revalidation or renewal of IRs. Article 65(5) of the ANO renders the EASA IRE valid for conducting ight examinations or prociency checks for UK national licences or Ratings for non-EASA aircraft subject to the conditions of FCL.1005.IRE
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA IRE certicate shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: Examiner certicates Limitation of privileges in case of vested interests IRE Privileges and conditions Prerequisites for examiners IRE Prerequisites Examiner standardisation Examiners assessment of competence Validity, revalidation and renewal of examiner certicates Conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.1000 FCL.1005 FCL.1005.IRE FCL.1010 FCL.1010.IRE FCL.1015 FCL.1020 FCL.1025 FCL.1030 FCL.1000 Examiner certicates See Subpart 0. FCL.1005 Limitation of privileges in case of vested interests See Subpart 0.
May 2012 Section 4 Part K, Subpart 4 Page 1
FCL.1005.IRE As above.
(a) IRE(A). Applicants for an IRE certicate for aeroplanes shall hold an IRI(A) and have completed: (1) 2000 hours of ight time as a pilot of aeroplanes; and (2) 450 hours of ight time under IFR, of which 250 hours shall be as an instructor. (b) IRE(H). Applicants for an IRE certicate for helicopters shall hold an IRI(H) and have completed: (1) 2000 hours of ight time as a pilot on helicopters; and (2) 300 hours of instrument ight time on helicopters, of which 200 hours shall be as an instructor. (c) IRE(As). Applicants for an IRE certicate for airships shall hold an IRI(As) and have completed: (1) 500 hours of ight time as a pilot on airships; and (2) 100 hours of instrument ight time on airships, of which 50 hours shall be as an instructor. FCL.1015 Examiner standardisation See Subpart 0. FCL.1020 Examiners assessment of competence See Subpart 0. FCL.1025 Validity, revalidation and renewal of examiner certicates See Subpart 0. FCL.1030 Conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence See Subpart 0.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 5
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA SFE certicate may exercise the privileges of the certicate to conduct skill tests or prociency checks in a Full Flight Simulator for Part-FCL or UK national Licences and ratings within the privileges of the SFE Certicate.
2 Privileges
EASA Synthetic Flight Examiners The privileges and conditions of the EASA SFE certicate are dened in FCL.1005.SFE as follows: FCL.1005.SFE SFE Privileges and conditions
(a) SFE(A) and SFE(PL). The privileges of an SFE on aeroplanes or powered-lift aircraft are to conduct in an FFS: (1) skill tests and prociency checks for the issue, revalidation or renewal of type ratings for multi-pilot aeroplanes or powered-lift aircraft, as applicable; (2) prociency checks for revalidation or renewal of IRs, provided that the SFE complies with the requirements in FCL.1010.IRE for the applicable aircraft category; (3) skill tests for ATPL(A) issue; (4) skill tests for MPL issue, provided that the examiner has complied with the requirements in FCL.925; (5) assessments of competence for the issue, revalidation or renewal of an SFI certicate in the relevant aircraft category, provided that the examiner has completed at least 3 years as an SFE. *Refer to Additional Information paragraph 5.1 & 5.2. (b) SFE(H). The privileges of an SFE for helicopters are to conduct in an FFS: (1) skill tests and prociency checks for the issue, revalidation and renewal of type ratings; and (2) prociency checks for the revalidation and renewal of IRs, provided that the SFE complies with the requirements in FCL.1010.IRE (b); (3) skill tests for ATPL(H) issue; (4) skill tests and prociency checks for the issue, revalidation or renewal of an SFI(H) certicate, provided that the examiner has completed at least 3 years as an SFE. Article 65(5) of the ANO renders the EASA SFE valid for conducting ight examinations or prociency checks for UK national licences or Ratings for non-EASA aircraft subject to the conditions of FCL.1005.SFE
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A.
15 October 2013
An applicant for the EASA SFE certicate shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: Examiner certicates Limitation of privileges in case of vested interests SFE Privileges and conditions Prerequisites for examiners SFE Prerequisites Examiner standardisation Examiners assessment of competence Validity, revalidation and renewal of examiner certicates Conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below and in Subpart0, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.1000 Examiner certicates See Subpart 0, excluding FCL.1000 (a)(2). FCL.1005 Limitation of privileges in case of vested interests See Subpart 0. FCL.1005.SFE As above. FCL.1010 Prerequisites for examiners See Subpart 0. FCL.1010.SFE SFE Prerequisites SFE Privileges and conditions FCL.1000 FCL.1005 FCL.1005.SFE FCL.1010 FCL.1010.SFE FCL.1015 FCL.1020 FCL.1025 FCL.1030
(a) SFE(A). Applicants for an SFE certicate for aeroplanes shall: (1) hold or have held an ATPL(A), a class or type rating and an SFI(A) certicate for the applicable type of aeroplane; (2) have at least 1 500 hours of ight time as a pilot on multi-pilot aeroplanes; (3) for the initial issue of an SFE certicate, have completed at least 50 hours of synthetic ight instruction as an SFI(A) on the applicable type. (b) SFE(H). Applicants for an SFE certicate for helicopters shall: (1) hold or have held an ATPL(H), a type rating and an SFI(H) certicate for the applicable type of helicopter; (2) have at least 1 000 hours of ight time as a pilot on multi-pilot helicopters; (3) for the initial issue of an SFE certicate, have completed at least 50 hours of synthetic ight instruction as an SFI(H) on the applicable type.
15 October 2013
FCL.1015 Examiner standardisation See Subpart 0. FCL.1020 Examiners assessment of competence See Subpart 0. FCL.1025 Validity, revalidation and renewal of examiner certicates See Subpart 0. FCL.1030 Conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence See Subpart 0.
Additional Information
The CAA has issued exemptions to allow the following:
5.1
art-FCL 1005 (a) (1) & (2) - SFEs examining for the renewal or revalidation of the P instrument ying privileges that are associated with type ratings The holder of a Synthetic Flight Examiner Certicate may examine for the renewal or revalidation of a combined Type Rating and Instrument Rating without having complied with the requirements of FCL.1010.IRE, subject to the following conditions: (i) t he SFE having passed a prociency check for the aircraft type including the Instrument Rating within the last 12 months; and (ii) t he SFE shall not examine for the initial issue of any instrument rating or for the renewal or revalidation of an instrument rating that is not associated with a Type rating that is to be renewed or revalidated.
5.2
art-FCL 1010.SFE Prerequisites SFEs examining for skill tests and prociency P checks for single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes. 1. The holder of a Synthetic Flight Examiner Certicate may conduct skill tests and prociency checks for single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes subject to the conditions of paragraph 2. Applicants for an SFE certicate that includes the privileges to conduct skill tests 2. and prociency checks for single-pilot multi-engine high performance complex aeroplanes shall: 2.1 h old a CPL(A), MPL(A) or ATPL(A), a class or type rating and an SFI(A) certicate for the applicable type of aeroplane; and
15 October 2013
2.2 h ave at least 500 hours of ight time as a pilot on single-pilot aeroplanes of which 200 hours must be as Pilot In Command; and 2.3 f or the initial issue of an SFE certicate, have completed at least 50 hours of synthetic ight instruction as an SFI(A) on the applicable type.
15 October 2013
Subpart 6
1 Applicability
The holder of an EASA FIE certicate may exercise the privileges of the certicate to conduct assessments of competence for Part-FCL or UK National Instructor Certicates.
2 Privileges
EASA Flight Instructor Examiners The privileges and conditions of the EASA FIE certicate are dened in FCL.1005.FIE as follows: FCL.1005.FIE FIE Privileges and conditions
(a) FIE(A). The privileges of an FIE on aeroplanes are to conduct assessments of competence for the issue, revalidation or renewal of certicates for FI(A), CRI(A), IRI(A) and TRI(A) on single-pilot aeroplanes, provided that the relevant instructor certicate is held. (b) FIE(H). The privileges of an FIE on helicopters are to conduct assessments of competence for the issue, revalidation or renewal of certicates for FI(H), IRI(H) and TRI(H) on single-pilot helicopters, provided that the relevant instructor certicate is held. (c) FIE(As), (S), (B). The privileges of an FIE on sailplanes, powered sailplanes, balloons and airships are to conduct assessments of competence for the issue, revalidation or renewal of instructor certicates on the applicable aircraft category, provided that the relevant instructor certicate is held. Article 65(5) of the ANO renders the EASA FIE valid for conducting assessments of competence for UK national licences Instructor Certicates subject to the conditions of FCL.1005.FIE.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a Part-FCL Licence, Rating or Certicate must satisfy the General Requirements applicable to all Part-FCL licences as set out in Section 4, Part A. An applicant for the EASA FIE certicate shall comply with the following Part-FCL requirements: FCL.1000 FCL.1005 FCL.1005.FIE FCL.1010 FCL.1010.FIE FCL.1015 FCL.1020 FCL.1025 FCL.1030 Examiner certicates Limitation of privileges in case of vested interests FIE Privileges and conditions Prerequisites for examiners FIE Prerequisites Examiner standardisation Examiners assessment of competence Validity, revalidation and renewal of examiner certicates Conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence
May 2012
For convenience the text of these requirements is reproduced below and in Subpart0, edited for clarity as described in the Foreword. In case of doubt, reference should be made to the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Regulation 1178/2011). FCL.1000 Examiner certicates See Subpart 0. FCL.1005 Limitation of privileges in case of vested interests See Subpart 0. FCL.1005.FIE As above. FCL.1010 Prerequisites for examiners See Subpart 0. FCL.1010.FIE FIE Prerequisites FIE Privileges and conditions
(a) FIE(A). Applicants for an FIE certicate for aeroplanes shall in case of applicants wishing to conduct assessments of competence: (1) hold the relevant instructor certicate, as applicable; (2) have completed 2 000 hours of ight time as a pilot on aeroplanes or TMGs; and (3) have at least 100 hours of ight time instructing applicants for an instructor certicate. (b) FIE(H). Applicants for an FIE certicate for helicopters shall: (1) hold the relevant instructor certicate, as applicable; (2) have completed 2 000 hours of ight time as pilot on helicopters; (3) have at least 100 hours of ight time instructing applicants for an instructor certicate. (c) FIE(As). Applicants for an FIE certicate for airships shall: (1) have completed 500 hours of ight time as a pilot on airships; (2) have at least 20 hours of ight time instructing applicants for an FI(As) certicate; (3) hold the relevant instructor certicate. (d) FIE(S). Applicants for an FIE certicate for sailplanes shall: (1) hold the relevant instructor certicate; (2) have completed 500 hours of ight time as a pilot on sailplanes or powered sailplanes; (3) have completed: (i) for applicants wishing to conduct assessments of competence on TMGs, 10hours or 30 take-offs instructing applicants for an instructor certicate in TMGs; (ii) in all other cases, 10 hours or 30 launches instructing applicants for an instructor certicate.
May 2012
(e) FIE(B). Applicants for an FIE certicate for balloons shall: (1) hold the relevant instructor certicate; (2) have completed 350 hours of ight time as a pilot on balloons; (3) have completed 10 hours instructing applicants for an instructor certicate. FCL.1015 Examiner standardisation See Subpart 0. FCL.1020 Examiners assessment of competence See Subpart 0. FCL.1025 Validity, revalidation and renewal of examiner certicates See Subpart 0. FCL.1030 Conduct of skill tests, prociency checks and assessments of competence See Subpart 0.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Part L
Appendices to Part-FCL
Appendix 1 to Part-FCL Crediting of theoretical knowledge A. 1 1.1 Crediting of theoretical knowledge for the issue of a pilot licence in another category of aircraft Bridge instruction and examination requirements LAPL, PPL, BPL and SPL For the issue of an LAPL, the holder of an LAPL in another category of aircraft shall be fully credited with theoretical knowledge on the common subjects established in FCL.120(a). Without prejudice to the paragraph above, for the issue of an LAPL, PPL, BPL or SPL, the holder of a licence in another category of aircraft shall receive theoretical knowledge instruction and pass theoretical knowledge examinations to the appropriate level in the following subjects: Principles of Flight Operational Procedures Flight Performance and Planning Aircraft General Knowledge, Navigation 1.3 For the issue of a PPL, BPL or SPL, the holder of an LAPL in the same category of aircraft shall be credited in full towards the theoretical knowledge instruction and examination requirements. CPL An applicant for a CPL holding a CPL in another category of aircraft shall have received theoretical knowledge bridge instruction on an approved course according to the differences identied between the CPL syllabi for different aircraft categories. The applicant shall pass theoretical knowledge examinations as dened in this Part for the following subjects in the appropriate aircraft category: 021 Aircraft General Knowledge: Airframe and Systems, Electrics, Powerplant, Emergency Equipment 022 Aircraft General Knowledge: Instrumentation 032/034 Performance Aeroplanes or Helicopters, as applicable 070 Operational Procedures, and 080 Principles of Flight An applicant for a CPL having passed the relevant theoretical examinations for an IR in the same category of aircraft is credited towards the theoretical knowledge requirements in the following subjects: Human Performance Meteorology 3 3.1 ATPL An applicant for an ATPL holding an ATPL in another category of aircraft shall have received theoretical knowledge bridge instruction at an ATO according to the differences identied between the ATPL syllabi for different aircraft categories.
1.2
2 2.1
2.2
2.3
May 2012
3.2
The applicant shall pass theoretical knowledge examinations as dened in this Part for the following subjects in the appropriate aircraft category: 021 Aircraft General Knowledge: Airframe and Systems, Electrics, Powerplant, Emergency Equipment 022 Aircraft General Knowledge: Instrumentation 032Performance 070 Operational Procedures, and 080 Principles of Flight An applicant for an ATPL(A) having passed the relevant theoretical examination for a CPL(A) is credited towards the theoretical knowledge requirements in subject VFR Communications. An applicant for an ATPL(H), having passed the relevant theoretical examinations for a CPL(H) is credited towards the theoretical knowledge requirements in the following subjects: Air Law Principles of Flight (Helicopter) VFR Communications
3.3
3.4
3.5
An applicant for an ATPL(A) having passed the relevant theoretical examination for an IR(A) is credited towards the theoretical knowledge requirements in subject IFR Communications. An applicant for an ATPL(H) with an IR(H), having passed the relevant theoretical examinations for a CPL(H) is credited towards the theoretical knowledge requirements in the following subjects: Principles of Flight (Helicopter) VFR Communications
3.6
4 4.1
IR An applicant for an IR having passed the relevant theoretical examinations for a CPL in the same aircraft category is credited towards the theoretical knowledge requirements in the following subjects: Human Performance Meteorology
4.2
An applicant for an IR(H) having passed the relevant theoretical examinations for an ATPL(H) VFR is required to pass the following examination subjects: Air Law Flight Planning and Flight Monitoring Radio Navigation IFR Communications
May 2012
Appendix 2 to Part-FCL Language Prociency Rating Scale Expert, extended and operational level
VOCABULARY FLUENCY COMPREHENSION INTERACTIONS
May 2012
LEVEL
PRONUNCIATION
STRUCTURE
Expert
(Level 6)
Pronunciation, stress, rhythm, and intonation, though possibly inuenced by the rst language or regional variation, almost never interfere with ease of understanding. Vocabulary range and accuracy are sufcient to communicate effectively on a wide variety of familiar and unfamiliar topics. Vocabulary is idiomatic, nuanced and sensitive to register. Able to speak at length with a natural, effortless ow. Varies speech ow for stylistic effect, e.g. to emphasize a point. Uses appropriate discourse markers and connectors spontaneously. Comprehension is consistently accurate in nearly all contexts and includes comprehension of linguistic and cultural subtleties. Vocabulary range and accuracy are sufcient to communicate effectively on common, concrete, and work-related topics. Paraphrases consistently and successfully. Vocabulary is sometimes idiomatic. Able to speak at length with relative ease on familiar topics, but may not vary speech ow as a stylistic device. Can make use of appropriate discourse markers or connectors. Comprehension is accurate on common, concrete, and workrelated topics and mostly accurate when the speaker is confronted with a linguistic or situational complication or an unexpected turn of events. Is able to comprehend a range of speech varieties (dialect and/ or accent) or registers.
Both basic and complex grammatical structures and sentence patterns are consistently well controlled.
Interacts with ease in nearly all situations. Is sensitive to verbal and nonverbal cues, and responds to them appropriately.
Extended
(Level 5)
Pronunciation, stress, rhythm, and intonation, though inuenced by the rst language or regional variation, rarely interfere with ease of understanding.
Basic grammatical structures and sentence patterns are consistently well controlled. Complex structures are attempted but with errors which sometimes interfere with meaning.
Responses are immediate, appropriate, and informative. Manages the speaker/listener relationship effectively.
May 2012
LEVEL
PRONUNCIATION
STRUCTURE
VOCABULARY
FLUENCY
COMPREHENSION
INTERACTIONS
Operational (Level 4)
Pronunciation, stress, rhythm, and intonation are inuenced by the rst language or regional variation but only sometimes interfere with ease of understanding.
Responses are usually immediate, appropriate, and informative. Initiates and maintains exchanges even when dealing with an unexpected turn of events. Deals adequately with apparent misunderstandings by checking, conrming, or clarifying.
Basic grammatical structures and sentence patterns are used creatively and are usually well controlled. Errors may occur, particularly in unusual or unexpected circumstances, but rarely interfere with meaning. Vocabulary range and accuracy are usually sufcient to communicate effectively on common, concrete, and work-related topics. Can often paraphrase successfully when lacking vocabulary particularly in unusual or unexpected circumstances. Produces stretches of language at an appropriate tempo. There may be occasional loss of uency on transition from rehearsed or formulaic speech to spontaneous interaction, but this does not prevent effective communication. Can make limited use of discourse markers and connectors. Fillers are not distracting. Comprehension is mostly accurate on common, concrete, and work-related topics when the accent or variety used is sufciently intelligible for an international community of users. When the speaker is confronted with a linguistic or situational complication or an unexpected turn of events, comprehension may be slower or require clarication strategies.
Note: The initial text of Appendix 2 has been transferred to AMC to FCL.055,
NOTE: The Operational Level (Level 4) is the minimum required prociency level for radiotelephony communication. Levels 1 through 3 describe Pre-elementary, Elementary and Pre-operational levels of language prociency respectively, all of which describe a level below the language prociency requirement. Levels 5 and 6 describe Extended and Expert levels at levels of prociency more advanced than the minimum required standard.
Appendix 3 to Part-FCL Training Courses for the Issue of a CPL and an ATPL
1 2 This appendix describes the requirements for the different types of training courses for the issue of a CPL and an ATPL, with and without an IR. An applicant wishing to transfer to another ATO during a training course shall apply to the competent authority for a formal assessment of the further hours of training required.
NOTE: The CAA will accept an applicant transferring from one ATO to another when part-way through a course in accordance with the following: The new ATO must have all relevant training records or other acceptable information certifying the training and experience completed so far. Credit shall be given in full for all adequately documented solo, dual instruction or Pilot in Command (PIC) ight time completed as part of an approved course for the licence, rating or certicate. The Head of Training (HT) of the new ATO shall assess the student and determine the balance of training and experience required to complete the course and any additional training necessary to cover the transition from the previous partly completed course. The HT will then make a recommendation to CAA Licensing & Training Standards and obtain conrmation of agreement. The applicant shall complete the balance of all training, examinations, dual and solo ight and shall complete any additional training necessary as specied in the determination by the Head of Training (HT) of the new ATO that has been agreed with the CAA.
A
1
2 3
An applicant failing or unable to complete the entire ATP(A) course may apply to the competent authority for the theoretical knowledge examination and skill test for a licence with lower privileges and an IR if the applicable requirements are met.
May 2012
Theoretical Knowledge 6 7 An ATP(A) theoretical knowledge course shall comprise at least 750 hours of instruction. The MCC course shall comprise at least 25 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction and exercises. Theoretical Knowledge Examination 8 An applicant shall demonstrate the level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted to the holder of an ATPL(A). Flying Training 9 The ying training, not including type rating training, shall comprise a total of at least 195 hours, to include all progress tests, of which up to 55 hours for the entire course may be instrument ground time. Within the total of 195 hours, applicants shall complete at least: (a) 95 hours of dual instruction, of which up to 55 hours may be instrument ground time; (b) 70 hours as PIC, including VFR ight and instrument ight time as student pilotin-command (SPIC). The instrument ight time as SPIC shall only be counted as PIC ight time up to a maximum of 20 hours; (c) 50 hours of cross-country ight as PIC, including a VFR cross-country ight of at least 540km (300NM), in the course of which full stop landings at two aerodromes different from the aerodrome of departure shall be made; (d) 5 hours ight time shall be completed at night, comprising 3 hours of dual instruction, which will include at least 1 hour of cross-country navigation and 5 solo take-offs and 5 solo full stop landings; and (e) 115 hours of instrument time comprising, at least: (1) 20 hours as SPIC; (2) 15 hours MCC, for which an FFS or FNPT II may be used; (3) 50 hours of instrument ight instruction, of which up to: (i) 25 hours may be instrument ground time in a FNPT I, or (ii) 40 hours may be instrument ground time in a FNPT II, FTD 2 or FFS, of which up to 10 hours may be conducted in an FNPT I. An applicant holding a course completion certicate for the Basic Instrument Flight Module shall be credited with up to 10 hours towards the required instrument instruction time. Hours done in a BITD shall not be credited. (f) 5 hours to be carried out in an aeroplane certicated for the carriage of at least 4 persons that has a variable pitch propeller and retractable landing gear. Skill Test 10 Upon completion of the related ying training, the applicant shall take the CPL(A) skill test on either a single-engine or a multi-engine aeroplane and the IR skill test on a multi-engine aeroplane.
May 2012
B
1
C
1
2 3
May 2012
(b) 70 hours as PIC, including VFR ight and instrument ight time which may be own as SPIC. The instrument ight time as SPIC shall only be counted as PIC ight time up to a maximum of 20 hours; (c) 50 hours of cross-country ight as PIC, including a VFR cross-country ight of at least 540 km (300 NM), in the course of which full stop landings at two aerodromes different from the aerodrome of departure shall be made; (d) 5 hours ight time shall be completed at night, comprising 3 hours of dual instruction, which shall include at least 1 hour of cross-country navigation and 5 solo take-offs and 5 solo full stop landings; and (e) 100 hours of instrument time comprising, at least: (1) 20 hours as SPIC; and (2) 50 hours of instrument ight instruction, of which up to: (i) 25 hours may be instrument ground time in an FNPT I, or (ii) 40 hours may be instrument ground time in an FNPT II, FTD 2 or FFS, of which up to 10 hours may be conducted in an FNPTI. An applicant holding a course completion certicate for the Basic Instrument Flight Module shall be credited with up to 10 hours towards the required instrument instruction time. Hours done in a BITD shall not be credited. (f) 5 hours to be carried out in an aeroplane certicated for the carriage of at least 4 persons that has a variable pitch propeller and retractable landing gear. 9. Skill Test Upon completion of the related ying training the applicant shall take the CPL(A) skill test and the IR skill test on either a multi-engine aeroplane or a single-engine aeroplane.
D
1 2 3
An applicant failing or unable to complete the entire CPL(A) course may apply to the competent authority for the theoretical knowledge examination and skill test for a licence with lower privileges, if the applicable requirements are met.
May 2012
Theoretical Knowledge 6 A CPL(A) theoretical knowledge course shall comprise at least 350 hours of instruction. Theoretical Knowledge Examination 7 An applicant shall demonstrate a level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted to the holder of a CPL(A). Flying Training 8 The ying training, not including type rating training, shall comprise a total of at least 150 hours, to include all progress tests, of which up to 5 hours for the entire course may be instrument ground time. Within the total of 150 hours, applicants shall complete at least: (a) 80 hours of dual instruction, of which up to 5 hours may be instrument ground time; (b) 70 hours as PIC; (c) 20 hours of cross-country ight as PIC, including a VFR cross-country ight of at least 540 km (300 NM), in the course of which full stop landings at two aerodromes different from the aerodrome of departure shall be made; (d) 5 hours ight time shall be completed at night, comprising 3 hours of dual instruction, which shall include at least 1 hour of cross-country navigation and 5 solo take-offs and 5 solo full stop landings; (e) 10 hours of instrument ight instruction, of which up to 5 hours may be instrument ground time in an FNPT I, FTD 2, FNPT II or FFS. An applicant holding a course completion certicate for the Basic Instrument Flight Module shall be credited with up to 10 hours towards the required instrument instruction time. Hours done in a BITD shall not be credited; (f) 5 hours to be carried out in an aeroplane certicated for the carriage of at least four persons that has a variable pitch propeller and retractable landing gear. Skill Test 9 Upon completion of the ying training the applicant shall take the CPL(A) skill test on a single-engine or a multi-engine aeroplane.
E
1 2 3
May 2012
The course shall comprise: (a) theoretical knowledge instruction to CPL(A) knowledge level; and (b) visual and instrument ying training. Theoretical Knowledge An approved CPL(A) theoretical knowledge course shall comprise at least 250 hours of instruction. Theoretical Knowledge Examination An applicant shall demonstrate a level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted to the holder of a CPL(A). Flying Training Applicants without an IR shall be given at least 25 hours dual ight instruction, including 10 hours of instrument instruction of which up to 5 hours may be instrument ground time in a BITD, an FNPT I or II, an FTD 2 or an FFS. Applicants holding a valid IR(A) shall be fully credited towards the dual instrument instruction time. Applicants holding a valid IR(H) shall be credited up to 5 hours of the dual instrument instruction time, in which case at least 5 hours dual instrument instruction time shall be given in an aeroplane. An applicant holding a Course Completion Certicate for the Basic Instrument Flight Module shall be credited with up to 10 hours towards the required instrument instruction time. (a) Applicants with a valid IR shall be given at least 15 hours dual visual ight instruction. (b) Applicants without a night rating aeroplane shall be given additionally at least 5 hours night ight instruction, comprising 3 hours of dual instruction, which shall include at least 1 hour of cross-country navigation and 5 solo take-offs and 5 solo full stop landings.
10
11
At least 5 hours of the ight instruction shall be carried out in an aeroplane certicated for the carriage of at least 4 persons and have a variable pitch propeller and retractable landing gear. Experience The applicant for a CPL(A) shall have completed at least 200 hours ight time, including at least: (a) 100 hours as PIC, of which 20 hours of cross-country ight as PIC, which shall include a VFR cross-country ight of at least 540 km (300 NM), in the course of which full stop landings at two aerodromes different from the aerodrome of departure shall be made; (b) 5 hours of ight time shall be completed at night, comprising 3 hours of dual instruction, which shall include at least 1 hour of cross-country navigation and 5 solo take-offs and 5 solo full stop landings; and (c) 10 hours of instrument ight instruction, of which up to 5 hours may be instrument ground time in an FNPT I, or FNPT II or FFS. An applicant holding a course completion certicate for the Basic Instrument Flight Module shall be credited with up to 10 hours towards the required instrument instruction time. Hours done in a BITD shall not be credited; (d) 6 hours of ight time shall be completed in a multi-engine aeroplane.1
12
1.The reference contained in (d) only applies to pilots seeking to conduct a Skill Test in Multi-engine aeroplane. The UK CAA issued a derogation under Article 14(6) of the Basic Regulation to reect this.
May 2012
(e) Hours as PIC of other categories of aircraft may count towards the 200 hours ight time, in the following cases: (i) 30 hours in helicopter, if the applicant holds a PPL(H); or (ii) 100 hours in helicopters, if the applicant holds a CPL(H); or (iii) 30 hours in TMGs or sailplanes; or (iv) 30 hours in airships, if the applicant holds a PPL(As); or (v) 60 hours in airships, if the applicant holds a CPL(As). Skill Test 13 Upon completion of the ying training and relevant experience requirements the applicant shall take the CPL(A) skill test on either a single-engine or a multi-engine aeroplane.
F
1
2 3
The course shall comprise: (a) theoretical knowledge instruction to the ATPL(H) and IR knowledge level; (b) visual and instrument ying training; and (c) training in MCC for the operation of multi-pilot helicopters.
An applicant failing or unable to complete the entire ATP(H) /IR course may apply to the competent authority for the theoretical knowledge examination and skill test for a licence with lower privileges and an IR, if the applicable requirements are met. Theoretical Knowledge An ATP(H)/IR theoretical knowledge course shall comprise at least 750 hours of instruction. The MCC course shall comprise at least 25 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction exercises. Theoretical Knowledge Examination An applicant shall demonstrate the level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted to the holder of an ATPL(H) and an IR.
6 7
May 2012
Flying Training 9 The ying training shall comprise a total of at least 195 hours, to include all progress tests. Within the total of 195 hours, applicants shall complete at least: (a) 140 hours of dual instruction, of which: (1) 75 hours visual instruction may include: (i) 30 hours in a helicopter FFS, level C/D, or (ii) 25 hours in a FTD 2,3, or (iii) 20 hours in a helicopter FNPT II/III, or (iv) 20 hours in an aeroplane or TMG; (2) 50 hours instrument instruction may include: (i) up to 20 hours in a helicopter FFS or FTD 2,3 or FNPT II/III, or (ii) 10 hours in at least a helicopter FNPT 1 or an aeroplane; (3) 15 hours MCC, for which a helicopter FFS or helicopter FTD 2,3(MCC) or FNPT II/III(MCC) may be used. If the helicopter used for the ying training is of a different type from the helicopter FFS used for the visual training, the maximum credit shall be limited to that allocated for the helicopter FNPT II/III. (b) 55 hours as PIC, of which 40 hours may be as SPIC. At least 14 hours solo day and 1 hour solo night shall be made. (c) 50 hours of cross-country ight, including at least 10 hours of cross-country ight as SPIC including a VFR cross-country ight of at least 185 km (100 NM) in the course of which landings at two different aerodromes from the aerodrome of departure shall be made; (d) 5 hours ight time in helicopters shall be completed at night comprising 3 hours of dual instruction including at least 1 hour of cross-country navigation and 5 solo night circuits. Each circuit shall include a take-off and a landing; (e) 50 hours of dual instrument time comprising: (i) 10 hours basic instrument instruction time, and (ii) 40 hours IR Training, which shall include at least 10 hours in a multi-engine IFRcerticated helicopter. SKILL TEST 10 Upon completion of the related ying training, the applicant shall take the CPL(H) skill test on a multi-engine helicopter and the IR skill test on an IFR certicated multiengine helicopter and shall comply with the requirements for MCC training.
G
1
27 July 2012
An applicant may be admitted to training either as an ab-initio entrant, or as a holder of a PPL(H) issued in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention. In the case of a PPL(H) entrant, 50% of the relevant experience shall be credited, up to a maximum of: (a) 40 hours, of which up to 20 hours may be dual instruction; or (b) 50 hours, of which up to 25 hours may be dual instruction, if a helicopter night rating has been obtained.
The course shall comprise: (a) theoretical knowledge instruction to the ATPL(H) knowledge level; (b) visual and basic instrument ying training; and (c) training in MCC for the operation of multi-pilot helicopters.
An applicant failing or unable to complete the entire ATP(H) course may apply to the competent authority for the theoretical knowledge examination and skill test for a licence with lower privileges, if the applicable requirements are met. Theoretical Knowledge An ATP(H) theoretical knowledge course shall comprise at least 650 hours of instruction. The MCC course shall comprise at least 20 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction exercises. Theoretical Knowledge Examination An applicant shall demonstrate the level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted to the holder of an ATPL(H). Flying Training The ying training shall comprise a total of at least 150 hours, to include all progress tests. Within the total of 150 hours, applicants shall complete at least: (a) 95 hours of dual instruction, of which: (i) 75 hours visual instruction may include: (1) 30 hours in a helicopter FFS level C/D, or (2) 25 hours in a helicopter FTD 2,3, or (3) 20 hours in a helicopter FNPT II/III, or (4) 20 hours in an aeroplane or TMG; (ii) 10 hours basic instrument instruction may include 5 hours in at least a helicopter FNPT I or an aeroplane; (iii) 10 hours MCC, for which a helicopter: helicopter FFS or FTD 2,3(MCC) or FNPT II/III(MCC) may be used. If the helicopter used for the ying training is of a different type from the helicopter FFS used for the visual training, the maximum credit shall be limited to that allocated for the helicopter FNPT II/III. (b) 55 hours as PIC, of which 40 hours may be as SPIC. At least 14 hours solo day and 1 hour solo night shall be made; (c) 50 hours of cross-country ight, including at least 10 hours of cross-country ight as SPIC, Including a VFR cross-country ight of at least 185 km (100 NM) in the course of which landings at two different aerodromes from the aerodrome of departure shall be made;
6 7
27 July 2012
(d) 5 hours ight time in helicopters shall be completed at night comprising 3 hours of dual instruction including at least 1 hour of cross-country navigation and 5 solo night circuits. Each circuit shall include a take-off and a landing. Skill Test 10 Upon completion of the related ying training the applicant shall take the CPL(H) skill test on a multi-engine helicopter and comply with MCC requirements.
H
1
Applicants for an ATPL(H)/IR who complete their theoretical knowledge instruction at a modular course shall hold at least a PPL(H) and complete at least the following hours of instruction: (a) for applicants holding a PPL(H): 650 hours; (b) for applicants holding a CPL(H): 400 hours; (c) for applicants holding an IR(H): 500 hours; (d) for applicants holding a CPL(H) and an IR(H): 250 hours.
I
1
2 3
May 2012
Theoretical Knowledge 6 A CPL(H)/IR theoretical knowledge course shall comprise at least 500 hours of instruction. Theoretical Knowledge Examination 7 An applicant shall demonstrate a level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted to the holder of a CPL(H) and an IR. Flying Training 8 The ying training shall comprise a total of at least 180 hours including all progress tests. Within the 180 hours, applicants shall complete at least: (a) 125 hours of dual instruction, of which: (i) 75 hours visual instruction, which may include: (1) 30 hours in a helicopter FFS level C/D, or (2) 25 hours in a helicopter FTD 2,3, or (3) 20 hours in a helicopter FNPT II/III, or (4) 20 hours in an aeroplane or TMG (ii) 50 hours instrument instruction which may include: (1) up to 20 hours in a helicopter FFS or FTD 2,3, or FNPT II,III, or (2) 10 hours in at least a helicopter FNPT I or an aeroplane. If the helicopter used for the ying training is of a different type from the FFS used for the visual training, the maximum credit shall be limited to that allocated for the FNPT II/III. (b) 55 hours as PIC, of which 40 hours may be as SPIC. At least 14 hours solo day and 1 hour solo night shall be made; (c) 10 hours dual cross-country ying; (d) 10 hours of cross-country ight as PIC, including a VFR cross-country ight of at least 185 km (100 NM) in the course of which full stop landings at two different aerodromes from the aerodrome of departure shall be made; (e) 5 hours of ight time in helicopters shall be completed at night comprising 3 hours of dual instruction including at least 1 hour of cross-country navigation and 5 solo night circuits. Each circuit shall include a take-off and a landing; (f) 50 hours of dual instrument time comprising: (i) 10 hours basic instrument instruction time; and (ii) 40 hours IR Training, which shall include at least 10 hours in a multi-engine IFRcerticated helicopter. Skill Test 9 Upon completion of the related ying training, the applicant shall take the CPL(H) skill test on either a multi-engine or a single-engine helicopter and the IR skill test on an IFR-certicated multi-engine helicopter.
27 July 2012
J
1 2 3
The course shall comprise: (a) theoretical knowledge instruction to CPL(H) knowledge level; and (b) visual and instrument ying training.
An applicant failing or unable to complete the entire CPL(H) course may apply to the competent authority for the theoretical knowledge examination and skill test for a licence with lower privileges, if the applicable requirements are met. Theoretical Knowledge An approved CPL(H) theoretical knowledge course shall comprise at least 350 hours of instruction or200 hours if the applicant is the holder of a PPL. Theoretical Knowledge Examination An applicant shall demonstrate a level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted to the holder of a CPL(H). Flying Training The ying training shall comprise a total of at least 135 hours, to include all progress tests, of which up to 5 hours may be instrument ground time. Within the 135 hours total, applicants shall complete at least: (a) 85 hours of dual instruction, of which: (i) up to 75 hours may be visual instruction, and may include: (1) 30 hours in a helicopter FFS level C/D, or (2) 25 hours in a helicopter FTD 2,3, or (3) 20 hours in a helicopter FNPT II/III, or (4) 20 hours in an aeroplane or TMG. (ii) up to 10 hours may be instrument instruction, and may include 5 hours in at least a helicopter FNPT I or an aeroplane. If the helicopter used for the ying training is of a different type from the FFS used for the visual training, the maximum credit shall be limited to that allocated for the FNPT II/III. (b) 50 hours as PIC, of which 35 hours may be as SPIC. At least 14 hours solo day and 1 hour solo night shall be made; (c) 10 hours dual cross-country ying;
May 2012
(d) 10 hours of cross-country ight as PIC, including a VFR cross-country ight of at least 185 km (100 NM) in the course of which full stop landings at two different aerodromes from the aerodrome of departure shall be made; (e) 5 hours ight time in helicopters shall be completed at night comprising 3 hours of dual instruction including at least 1 hour of cross-country navigation and 5 solo night circuits. Each circuit shall include a take-off and a landing; (f) 10 hours of instrument dual instruction time, including at least 5 hours in a helicopter. Skill Test 9 Upon completion of the related ying training, the applicant shall take the CPL(H) skill test.
K
1 2 3
NOTE 1: Experience as set out in paragraph 11 may be credited towards this pre-entry requirement of 155 hours in helicopters. The UK CAA has elected to derogate under Article 14(6) to the Basic Regulation to facilitate this credit. 4 An applicant wishing to undertake a modular CPL(H) course shall complete all the ight instructional stages in one continuous course of training as arranged by an ATO. The theoretical knowledge instruction may be given at an ATO that conducts theoretical knowledge instruction only. The course shall comprise: (a) theoretical knowledge instruction to CPL(H) knowledge level; and (b) visual and instrument ying training. THEORETICAL KNOWLEDGE 6 An approved CPL(H) theoretical knowledge course shall comprise at least 250 hours of instruction. Theoretical Knowledge Examination 7 An applicant shall demonstrate a level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted to the holder of a CPL(H).
May 2012
Flying Training 8 Applicants without an IR shall be given at least 30 hours dual ight instruction, of which: (a) 20 hours visual instruction, which may include 5 hours in a helicopter FFS or FTD 2,3 or FNPT II,III; and (b) 10 hours instrument instruction, which may include 5 hours in at least a helicopter FTD 1 or FNPT I or aeroplane. 9 Applicants holding a valid IR(H) shall be fully credited towards the dual instrument instruction time. Applicants holding a valid IR(A) shall complete at least 5 hours of the dual instrument instruction time in a helicopter. Applicants without a night rating helicopter shall be given additionally at least 5 hours night ight instruction comprising 3 hours of dual instruction including at least 1 hour of cross-country navigation and 5 solo night circuits. Each circuit shall include a takeoff and a landing. Experience 11 The applicant for a CPL(H) shall have completed at least 185 hours ight time, including 50 hours as PIC, of which 10 hours of cross-country ight as PIC, including a VFR cross-country ight of at least 185 km (100 NM), in the course of which full stop landings at two aerodromes different from the aerodrome of departure shall be made. Hours as pilot-in-command of other categories of aircraft may count towards the 185 hours ight time, in the following cases: (a) 20 hours in aeroplanes, if the applicant holds a PPL(A); or (b) 50 hours in aeroplanes, if the applicant holds a CPL(A); or (c) 10 hours in TMGs or sailplanes; or (d) 20 hours in airships, if the applicant holds a PPL(As); or (e) 50 hours in airships, if the applicant holds a CPL(As). Skill Test 12 Upon completion of the related ying training and relevant experience, the applicant shall take the CPL(H) skill test.
10
L
1 2 3
May 2012
The course shall comprise: (a) theoretical knowledge instruction to CPL(As) and IR knowledge level, and the initial airship type rating; and (b) visual and instrument ying training.
An applicant failing or unable to complete the entire CPL/IR(As) course may apply to the competent authority for the theoretical knowledge examination and skill test for a licence with lower privileges and an IR, if the applicable requirements are met. Theoretical Knowledge A CPL(As)/IR theoretical knowledge course shall comprise at least 500 hours of instruction. Theoretical Knowledge Examination An applicant shall demonstrate a level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted to the holder of a CPL(As) and an IR. Flying Training The ying training shall comprise a total of at least 80 hours including all progress tests. Within the 80 hours, applicants shall complete at least: (a) 60 hours of dual instruction, of which: (i) 30 hours visual instruction, which may include: (1) 12 hours in an airship FFS, or (2) 10 hours in an airship FTD, or (3) 8 hours in an airship FNPT II/III, or (4) 8 hours in an aeroplane, helicopter or TMG (ii) 30 hours instrument instruction which may include: (1) up to 12 hours in an airship FFS or FTD or FNPT II,III, or (2) 6 hours in at least a airship FTD 1 or FNPT I or aeroplane. If the airship used for the ying training is of a different type from the FFS used for the visual training, the maximum credit shall be limited to 8 hours. (b) 20 hours as PIC, of which 5 hours may be as SPIC. At least 14 hours solo day and 1 hour solo night shall be made; (c) 5 hours of cross-country ight as PIC, including a VFR cross-country ight of atleast 90km (50NM) in the course of which two full stop landings at the destination aerodrome shall be made; (d) 5 hours ight time in airships shall be completed at night comprising 3 hours of dual instruction including at least 1 hour of cross-country navigation and 5 solo night circuits. Each circuit shall include take-off and landing; (e) 30 hours of dual instrument time comprising: (i) 10 hours basic instrument instruction time; and (ii) 20 hours IR Training, which shall include at least 10 hours in a multi-engine IFRcerticated airship. Skill Test
Upon completion of the related ying training, the applicant shall take the CPL(As) skill test on either a multi-engine or a single-engine airship and the IR skill test on an IFR-certicated multi-engine airship.
27 July 2012
M
1 2 3
The course shall comprise: (a) theoretical knowledge instruction to CPL(As) knowledge level; and (b) visual and instrument ying training.
An applicant failing or unable to complete the entire CPL(As) course may apply to the competent authority for the theoretical knowledge examination and skill test for a licence with lower privileges, if the applicable requirements are met. Theoretical Knowledge An approved CPL(As) theoretical knowledge course shall comprise at least 350 hours of instruction or200 hours if the applicant is a PPL holder. Theoretical Knowledge Examination An applicant shall demonstrate a level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted to the holder of a CPL(As). Flying Training The ying training shall comprise a total of at least 50 hours, to include all progress tests, of which up to 5 hours may be instrument ground time. Within the 50 hours total, applicants shall complete at least: (a) 30 hours of dual instruction, of which up to 5 hours may be instrument ground time; (b) 20 hours as PIC; (c) 5 hours dual cross-country ying; (d) 5 hours of cross-country ight as PIC, including a VFR cross-country ight of at least 90 km (50 NM) in the course of which two full stop landings at the destination aerodrome shall be made; (e) 5 hours ight time in airships shall be completed at night comprising 3 hours of dual instruction including at least 1 hour of cross-country navigation and 5 solo night circuits. Each circuit shall include take-off and landing; (f) 10 hours of instrument dual instruction time, including at least 5 hours in an airship. Skill Test
Upon completion of the related ying training, the applicant shall take the CPL(As) skill test.
May 2012
N
1 2
An applicant wishing to undertake a modular CPL(As) course shall complete all the ight instructional stages in one continuous course of training as arranged by an ATO. The theoretical knowledge instruction may be given at an ATO that conducts theoretical knowledge instruction only. The course shall comprise: (a) theoretical knowledge instruction to CPL(As) knowledge level; and (b) visual and instrument ying training. Theoretical Knowledge
An approved CPL(As) theoretical knowledge course shall comprise at least 250 hours of instruction. Theoretical Knowledge Examination An applicant shall demonstrate a level of knowledge appropriate to the privileges granted to the holder of a CPL(As). Flying Training Applicants without an IR shall be given at least 20 hours dual ight instruction, of which: 10 hours visual instruction, which may include 5 hours in an airship FFS or FTD 2,3 or FNPT II,III; and 10 hours instrument instruction, which may include 5 hours in at least an airship FTD 1 or FNPT I or aeroplane.
Applicants holding a valid IR(As) shall be fully credited towards the dual instrument instruction time. Applicants holding a valid IR in another category of aircraft shall complete at least 5 hours of the dual instrument instruction time in an airship. Applicants without a night rating airship shall be given additionally at least 5 hours night ight instruction comprising 3 hours of dual instruction including at least 1 hour of cross-country navigation and 5 solo night circuits. Each circuit shall include a takeoff and a landing. Experience The applicant for a CPL(As) shall have completed at least 250 hours ight time in airships, including 125 hours as PIC, of which 50 hours of cross-country ight as PIC, including a VFR cross-country ight of at least 90 km (50 NM), in the course of which a full stop landing at destination aerodrome. Hours as PIC of other categories of aircraft may count towards the 185 hours ight time, in the following cases:
10
May 2012
(a) 30 hours in aeroplanes or helicopters, if the applicant holds a PPL(A) or PPL(H) respectively; or (b) 60 hours in aeroplanes or helicopters, if the applicant holds a CPL(A) or CPL(H) respectively; or (c) 10 hours in TMGs or sailplanes; or (d) 10 hours in balloons. Skill Test 11 Upon completion of the related ying training and relevant experience, the applicant shall take the CPL(As) skill test.
May 2012
B
1
May 2012
The applicant shall demonstrate the ability to: (a) operate the aeroplane within its limitations, (b) complete all manoeuvres with smoothness and accuracy, (c) exercise good judgement and airmanship; (d) apply aeronautical knowledge; and (e) maintain control of the aeroplane at all times in such a manner that the successful outcome of a procedure or manoeuvre is never seriously in doubt. FLIGHT TEST TOLERANCES
The following limits shall apply, corrected to make allowance for turbulent conditions and the handling qualities and performance of the aeroplane used. Height normal ight with simulated engine failure Tracking on radio aids Heading normal ight with simulated engine failure Speed take-off and approach all other ight regimes CONTENT OF THE TEST 100 feet 150 feet 5 10 15 5 knots 10 knots
Items in section 2 (c) and (e)(iv), and the whole of sections 5 and 6 may be performed in an FNPT II or an FFS. Use of the aeroplane checklists, airmanship, control of the aeroplane by external visual reference, anti-icing/de-icing procedures and principles of threat and error management apply in all sections.
SECTION 1 PRE-FLIGHT OPERATIONS AND DEPARTURE a b c d e f g a b c d Pre-ight, including: Flight planning, Documentation, Mass and balance determination, Weather brief, NOTAMS Aeroplane inspection and servicing Taxiing and take-off Performance considerations and trim Aerodrome and trafc pattern operations Departure procedure, altimeter setting, collision avoidance (lookout) ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures Control of the aeroplane by external visual reference, including straight and level, climb, descent, lookout Flight at critically low airspeeds including recognition of and recovery from incipient and full stalls Turns, including turns in landing conguration. Steep turns 45 Flight at critically high airspeeds, including recognition of and recovery from spiral dives
May 2012
Flight by reference solely to instruments, including: (i) level ight, cruise conguration, control of heading, altitude and airspeed (ii) climbing and descending turns with 1030 bank (iii) recoveries from unusual attitudes (iv) limited panel instruments ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures Control of aeroplane by external visual reference, including cruise conguration Range/ Endurance considerations Orientation, map reading Altitude, speed, heading control, lookout Altimeter setting. ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures Monitoring of ight progress, ight log, fuel usage, assessment of track error and reestablishment of correct tracking Observation of weather conditions, assessment of trends, diversion planning Tracking, positioning (NDB or VOR), identication of facilities (instrument ight). Implementation of diversion plan to alternate aerodrome (visual ight)
f a b c d e f g
SECTION 4 APPROACH AND LANDING PROCEDURES a b c d e f g h Arrival procedures, altimeter setting, checks, lookout ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures Go-around action from low height Normal landing, crosswind landing (if suitable conditions) Short eld landing Approach and landing with idle power (single-engine only) Landing without use of aps Post ight actions
SECTION 5 ABNORMAL AND EMERGENCY PROCEDURES This section may be combined with sections 1 through 4 a Simulated engine failure after take-off (at a safe altitude), re drill b Equipment malfunctions including alternative landing gear extension, electrical and brake failure c Forced landing (simulated) d ATC liaison - compliance, R/T procedures e Oral questions SECTION 6 SIMULATED ASYMMETRIC FLIGHT AND RELEVANT CLASS OR TYPE ITEMS This section may be combined with sections 1 through 5 a Simulated engine failure during take-off (at a safe altitude unless carried out in an FFS) b Asymmetric approach and go-around c Asymmetric approach and full stop landing d Engine shutdown and restart e ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures, Airmanship f As determined by the FE any relevant items of the class or type rating skill test to include, if applicable: (i) aeroplane systems including handling of autopilot (ii) operation of pressurisation system (iii) use of de-icing and anti-icing system g Oral questions
May 2012
C
1 2
Content of the skill test for the issue of the CPL Helicopters
The helicopter used for the skill test shall meet the requirements for training helicopters. The area and route to be own shall be chosen by the FE and all low level and hover work shall be at an approved aerodrome/site. Routes used for section 3 may end at the aerodrome of departure or at another aerodrome and one destination shall be a controlled aerodrome. The skill test may be conducted in 2 ights. The total duration of the ight(s) shall be at least 90 minutes. The applicant shall demonstrate the ability to: (a) operate the helicopter within its limitations; (b) complete all manoeuvres with smoothness and accuracy; (c) exercise good judgement and airmanship; (d) apply aeronautical knowledge; and (e) maintain control of the helicopter at all times in such a manner that the successful outcome of a procedure or manoeuvre is never seriously in doubt. FLIGHT TEST TOLERANCES The following limits shall apply, corrected to make allowance for turbulent conditions and the handling qualities and performance of the helicopter used. Height 100 feet normal ight simulated major emergency 150 feet Tracking on radio aids Heading normal ight simulated major emergency 10 10 15
Speed take-off and approach multi-engine 5 knots all other ight regimes 10 knots Ground drift 3 feet T.O. hover I.G.E. landing no sideways or backwards movement 5 CONTENT OF THE TEST Items in section 4 may be performed in a helicopter FNPT or a helicopter FFS. Use of helicopter checklists, airmanship, control of helicopter by external visual reference, anti-icing procedures, and principles of threat and error management apply in all sections.
SECTION 1 PRE-FLIGHT/POST-FLIGHT CHECKS AND PROCEDURES a Helicopter knowledge (e.g. technical log, fuel, mass and balance, performance), ight planning, documentation, NOTAMS, weather b Pre-ight inspection/action, location of parts and purpose c Cockpit inspection, starting procedure d Communication and navigation equipment checks, selecting and setting frequencies e Pre-take-off procedure, R/T procedure, ATC liaison-compliance f Parking, shutdown and post-ight procedure SECTION 2 HOVER MANOEUVRES, ADVANCED HANDLING AND CONFINED AREAS a Take-off and landing (lift-off and touchdown)
May 2012
b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q
Taxi, hover taxi Stationary hover with head/cross/tail wind Stationary hover turns, 360 left and right (spot turns) Forward, sideways and backwards hover manoeuvring Simulated engine failure from the hover Quick stops into and downwind Sloping ground/unprepared sites landings and take-offs Take-offs (various proles) Crosswind, downwind take-off (if practicable) Take-off at maximum take-off mass (actual or simulated) Approaches (various proles) Limited power take-off and landing Autorotations (FE to select two items from Basic, range, low speed, and 360 turns) Autorotative landing Practice forced landing with power recovery Power checks, reconnaissance technique, approach and departure technique
SECTION 3 NAVIGATION EN-ROUTE PROCEDURES a Navigation and orientation at various altitudes/heights, map reading b Altitude/height, speed, heading control, observation of airspace, altimeter setting c Monitoring of ight progress, ight log, fuel usage, endurance, ETA, assessment of track error and re-establishment of correct track, instrument monitoring d Observation of weather conditions, diversion planning e Tracking, positioning (NDB and/or VOR), identication of facilities f ATC liaison and observance of regulations, etc. SECTION 4 FLIGHT PROCEDURES AND MANOEUVRES BY SOLE REFERENCE TO INSTRUMENTS a Level ight, control of heading, altitude/height and speed b Rate 1 level turns onto specied headings, 180 to 360 left and right c Climbing and descending, including turns at rate 1 onto specied headings d Recovery from unusual attitudes e Turns with 30 bank, turning up to 90 left and right SECTION 5 ABNORMAL AND EMERGENCY PROCEDURES (simulated where appropriate) Note (1): Where the test is conducted on a multi-engine helicopter a simulated engine failure drill, including a single-engine approach and landing, shall be included in the test. Note (2): The FE shall select 4 items from the following: a Engine malfunctions, including governor failure, carburettor/engine icing, oil system, as appropriate b Fuel system malfunction c Electrical system malfunction d Hydraulic system malfunction, including approach and landing without hydraulics, as applicable e Main rotor and/or anti-torque system malfunction (FFS or discussion only) f Fire drills, including smoke control and removal, as applicable g Other abnormal and emergency procedures as outlined in appropriate ight manual, including for multi-engine helicopters: (i) Simulated engine failure at take-off: (ii) Rejected take-off at or before TDP or safe forced landing at or before DPATO, shortly after TDP or DPATO. (iii) Landing with simulated engine failure: (iv) Landing or go-around following engine failure before LDP or DPBL, (v) Landing or go-around following engine failure after LDP or safe forced landing after DPBL.
May 2012
D
1 2
The following limits shall apply, corrected to make allowance for turbulent conditions and the handling qualities and performance of the airship used. Height normal ight simulated major emergency Tracking on radio aids Heading normal ight simulated major emergency CONTENT OF THE TEST 100 feet 150 feet 10 10 15
Items in sections 5 and 6 may be performed in an Airship FNPT or an airship FFS. Use of airship checklists, airmanship, control of airship by external visual reference, antiicing procedures, and principles of threat and error management apply in all sections.
SECTION 1 PRE-FLIGHT OPERATIONS AND DEPARTURE a Pre-ight, including: Flight planning, Documentation, Mass and Balance determination, Weather brief, NOTAMS Airship inspection and servicing Off-mast procedure, ground manoeuvring and take-off Performance considerations and trim Aerodrome and trafc pattern operations Departure procedure, altimeter setting, collision avoidance (lookout) ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures
b c d e f g
SECTION 2 GENERAL AIRWORK a Control of the airship by external visual reference, including straight and level, climb, descent, lookout b Flight at pressure height
May 2012
c d e
Turns Steep descents and climbs Flight by reference solely to instruments, including: (i) level ight, control of heading, altitude and airspeed (ii) climbing and descending turns (iii) recoveries from unusual attitudes (iv) limited panel instruments ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures
SECTION 3 EN-ROUTE PROCEDURES a Control of airship by external visual reference, Range/Endurance considerations b Orientation, map reading c Altitude, speed, heading control, lookout d Altimeter setting, ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures e Monitoring of ight progress, ight log, fuel usage, assessment of track error and reestablishment of correct tracking f Observation of weather conditions, assessment of trends, diversion planning g Tracking, positioning (NDB or VOR), identication of facilities (instrument ight). Implementation of diversion plan to alternate aerodrome (visual ight) SECTION 4 APPROACH AND LANDING PROCEDURES a Arrival procedures, altimeter setting, checks, lookout b ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures c Go-around action from low height d Normal landing e Short eld landing f Approach and landing with idle power (single-engine only) g Landing without use of aps h Post-ight actions SECTION 5 ABNORMAL AND EMERGENCY PROCEDURES This section may be combined with sections 1 through 4 a Simulated engine failure after take-off (at a safe altitude), re drill b Equipment malfunctions c Forced landing (simulated) d ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures e Oral questions SECTION 6 RELEVANT CLASS OR TYPE ITEMS This section may be combined with sections 1 through 5 a Simulated engine failure during take-off (at a safe altitude unless carried out in an FFS) b Approach and go-around with failed engine(s) c Approach and full stop landing with failed engine(s) d Malfunctions in the envelope pressure system e ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures, Airmanship f As determined by the FE any relevant items of the class or type rating skill test to include, if applicable: (i) airship systems (ii) operation of envelope pressure system g Oral questions
May 2012
4 5
May 2012
(d) Phase 4 Advanced Type rating training within an airline oriented environment. Flight experience in actual ight shall include all the experience requirements of Subpart H, upset recovery training, night ying, ight solely by reference to instruments and the experience required to achieve the relevant airmanship. MCC requirements shall be incorporated into the relevant phases above. Training in asymmetric ight shall be given either in an aeroplane or an FFS. 9 10 Each phase of training in the ight instruction syllabus shall be composed of both instruction in the underpinning knowledge and in practical training segments. The training course shall include a continuous evaluation process of the training syllabus and a continuous assessment of the students following the syllabus. Evaluation shall ensure that: (a) the competencies and related assessment are relevant to the task of a co-pilot of a multi-pilot aeroplane; and (b) the students acquire the necessary competencies in a progressive and satisfactory manner. 11 The training course shall include at least 12 take-offs and landings to ensure competency. These take-offs and landings shall be performed under the supervision of an instructor in an aeroplane for which the type rating shall be issued. ASSESSMENT LEVEL 12 The applicant for the MPL shall have demonstrated performance in all 9 competency units specied in paragraph 13 below, at the advanced level of competency required to operate and interact as a co-pilot in a turbine-powered multi-pilot aeroplane, under visual and instrument conditions. Assessment shall conrm that control of the aeroplane or situation is maintained at all times, to ensure the successful outcome of a procedure or manoeuvre. The applicant shall consistently demonstrate the knowledge, skills and attitudes required for the safe operation of the applicable aeroplane type, in accordance with the MPL performance criteria. COMPETENCY UNITS 13 The applicant shall demonstrate competency in the following 9 competency units: (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) apply human performance principles, including principles of threat and error management; perform aeroplane ground operations; perform take-off; perform climb; perform cruise; perform descent; perform approach; perform landing; and perform after landing and aeroplane post-ight operations.
May 2012
SIMULATED FLIGHT 14 Minimum requirements for FSTDs: (a) Phase 1 Core ying skills E-training and part tasking devices approved by the competent authority that have the following characteristics: involve accessories beyond those normally associated with desktop computers, such as functional replicas of a throttle quadrant, a side-stick controller, or an FMS keypad; and involve psychomotor activity with appropriate application of force and timing of responses.
(b) Phase 2 Basic An FNPT II MCC that represents a generic multi-engine turbine-powered aeroplane. (c) Phase 3 Intermediate An FSTD that represents a multi-engine turbine-powered aeroplane required to be operated with a co-pilot and qualied to an equivalent standard to level B, additionally including: a daylight/twilight/night visual system continuous cross-cockpit minimum collimated visual eld of view providing each pilot with 180 horizontal and 40 vertical eld of view, and ATC environment simulation. (d) Phase 4 Advanced An FFS which is fully equivalent to level D or level C with an enhanced daylight visual system, including ATC environment simulation. NOTE: For additional information relating to Flight Simulation Training Devices to support Multi-Crew Pilot Licence (MPL) Phases 3 and 4 requirements for ATC Environment Simulation, refer to AIC W 064/2010.
May 2012
An applicant for a modular IR(A) course shall be the holder of a PPL(A) or a CPL(A), including the privileges to y at night. An applicant for the Procedural Instrument Flight Module, who does not hold a CPL(A), shall be holder of a Course Completion Certicate for the Basic Instrument Flight Module. The ATO shall ensure that the applicant for a multi-engine IR(A) course who has not held a multi-engine aeroplane class or type rating has received the multi-engine training specied in Subpart H prior to commencing the ight training for the IR(A) course.
An applicant wishing to undertake the Procedural Instrument Flight Module of a modular IR(A) course shall be required to complete all the instructional stages in one continuous approved course of training. Prior to commencing the Procedural Instrument Flight Module, the ATO shall ensure the competence of the applicant in basic instrument ying skills. Refresher training shall be given as required. The course of theoretical instruction shall be completed within 18 months. The Procedural Instrument Flight Module and the skill test shall be completed within the period of validity of the pass in theoretical examinations. The course shall comprise: (a) theoretical knowledge instruction to the IR knowledge level; (b) instrument ight instruction. THEORETICAL KNOWLEDGE
An approved modular IR(A) course shall comprise at least 150 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction. FLYING TRAINING A single-engine IR(A) course shall comprise at least 50 hours instrument time under instruction of which up to 20 hours may be instrument ground time in an FNPT I, or up to 35 hours in an FFS or FNPT II. A maximum of 10 hours of FNPT II or an FFS instrument ground time may be conducted in an FNPT I.
May 2012
A multi-engine IR(A) course shall comprise at least 55 hours instrument time under instruction, of which up to 25 hours may be instrument ground time in an FNPT I, or up to 40 hours in an FFS or FNPT II. A maximum of 10 hours of FNPT II or an FFS instrument ground time may be conducted in an FNPT I. The remaining instrument ight instruction shall include at least 15 hours in multi-engine aeroplanes. The holder of a single-engine IR(A) who also holds a multi-engine class or type rating wishing to obtain a multi-engine IR(A) for the rst time shall complete a course at an ATO comprising at least 5 hours instruction in instrument ying in multi-engine aeroplanes, of which 3 hours may be in an FFS or FNPT II. The holder of a CPL(A) or of a Course Completion Certicate for the Basic Instrument Flight Module may have the total amount of training required in paragraphs 7 or 8 above reduced by 10 hours. The holder of an IR(H) may have the total amount of training required in paragraphs 7 or 8 above reduced to 10 hours.1 The total instrument ight instruction in aeroplane shall comply with paragraph 7 or 8, as appropriate. The ying exercises up to the IR(A) skill test shall comprise: (a) Basic Instrument Flight Module: Procedure and manoeuvre for basic instrument ight covering at least: basic instrument ight without external visual cues: horizontal ight, climbing, descent, turns in level ight, climbing, descent; instrument pattern; steep turn; radio navigation; recovery from unusual attitudes; limited panel; recognition and recovery from incipient and full stalls; (b) Procedural Instrument Flight Module: (i) pre-ight procedures for IFR ights, including the use of the ight manual and appropriate air trafc services documents in the preparation of an IFR ight plan; (ii) procedure and manoeuvres for IFR operation under normal, abnormal and emergency conditions covering at least: transition from visual to instrument ight on take-off, standard instrument departures and arrivals, en-route IFR procedures, holding procedures, instrument approaches to specied minima, missed approach procedures, landings from instrument approaches, including circling;
10.1
10.2 10.3 11
1. The UK CAA issued a derogation under Article 14 of the Basic Regulation to reect that the holder of an IR(H) may have the total training required in paragraphs 7 or 8 reduced to 10 hours.
27 July 2012
(iii) in-ight manoeuvres and particular ight characteristics; (iv) if required, operation of a multi-engine aeroplane in the above exercises, including operation of the aeroplane solely by reference to instruments with one engine simulated inoperative and engine shutdown and restart (the latter exercise to be carried out at a safe altitude unless carried out in an FFS or FNPTII).
B
1 2
3 4
6 7
An approved modular IR(H) course shall comprise at least 150 hours of instruction. FLYING TRAINING A single-engine IR(H) course shall comprise at least 50 hours instrument time under instruction, of which: (a) up to 20 hours may be instrument ground time in an FNPT I(H) or (A). These 20 hours instruction time in FNPT I (H) or (A) may be substituted by 20 hours instruction time for IR(H) in an aeroplane, approved for this course; or (b) up to 35 hours may be instrument ground time in a helicopter FTD 2/3, FNPT II/III or FFS. The instrument ight instruction shall include at least 10 hours in an IFR-certicated helicopter. A multi-engine IR(H) course shall comprise at least 55 hours instrument time under instruction of which; (a) up to 20 hours may be instrument ground time in an FNPT I (H) or (A). These 20 hours instruction time in FNPT I (H) or (A) may be substituted by 20 hours instruction time for IR(H) in an aeroplane, approved for this course; or (b) up to 40 hours may be instrument ground time in a helicopter FTD 2/3, FNPT II/III or FFS. The instrument ight instruction shall include at least 10 hours in an IFR-certicated multi-engine helicopter.
27 July 2012
NOTE: The UK CAA issued a derogation under Article 14 of the Basic Regulation to reect that the holder of a PPL(H) with a night rating or a CPL(H) shall have the total amount of training required in paragraphs 7 or 8 above reduced by 5 hours. 9.1 9.2 10 Holders of an ATPL(H) shall have the theoretical knowledge instruction hours reduced by 50 hours. The holder of an IR(A) may have the amount of training required reduced to 10 hours.1 The ying exercises up to the IR(H) skill test shall comprise: (a) pre-ight procedures for IFR ights, including the use of the ight manual and appropriate air trafc services documents in the preparation of an IFR ight plan; (b) procedure and manoeuvres for IFR operation under normal, abnormal and emergency conditions covering at least: transition from visual to instrument ight on takeoff, standard instrument departures and arrivals, en-route IFR procedures, holding procedures, instrument approaches to specied minima, missed approach procedures, landings from instrument approaches, including circling; (c) in-ight manoeuvres and particular ight characteristics; (d) if required, operation of a multi-engine helicopter in the above exercises, including operation of the helicopter solely by reference to instruments with one engine simulated inoperative and engine shutdown and restart (the latter exercise to be carried out in an FFS or FNPT II or FTD 2/3).
The aim of the IR(As) modular ying training course is to train pilots to the level of prociency necessary to operate airships under IFR and in IMC. The course consists of two modules, which may be taken separately or combined: (a) Basic Instrument Flight Module This comprises 10 hours of instrument time under instruction, of which up to 5 hours can be instrument ground time in a BITD, FNPT I or II, or an FFS. Upon completion of the Basic Instrument Flight Module, the candidate shall be issued a Course Completion Certicate. (b) Procedural Instrument Flight Module This comprises the remainder of the training syllabus for the IR(As), 25 hours instrument time under instruction, and the theoretical knowledge course for the IR(As).
1. The UK CAA issued a derogation under Article 14 of the Basic Regulation to reect that the holder of an IR(A) may have the total training required in paragraphs 7 or 8 reduced to 10 hours.
May 2012
An applicant for a modular IR(As) course shall be the holder of a PPL(As) including the privileges to y at night or a CPL(As). An applicant for the Procedural Instrument Flight Module, who does not hold a CPL(As), shall be holder of a Course Completion Certicate for the Basic Instrument Flight Module. An applicant wishing to undertake the Procedural Instrument Flight Module of a modular IR(As) course shall be required to complete all the instructional stages in one continuous approved course of training. Prior to commencing the Procedural Instrument Flight Module, the ATO shall ensure the competence of the applicant in basic instrument ying skills. Refresher training shall be given as required. The course of theoretical instruction shall be completed within 18 months. The Procedural Instrument Flight Module and the skill test shall be completed within the period of validity of the pass in theoretical examinations. The course shall comprise: (a) theoretical knowledge instruction to the IR knowledge level; (b) instrument ight instruction. THEORETICAL KNOWLEDGE
An approved modular IR(As) course shall comprise at least 150 hours of theoretical knowledge instruction. FLYING TRAINING An IR(As) course shall comprise at least 35 hours instrument time under instruction of which up to 15 hours may be instrument ground time in an FNPT I, or up to 20 hours in an FFS or FNPT II. A maximum of 5 hours of FNPT II or FFS instrument ground time may be conducted in an FNPT I. The holder of a CPL(As) or of a Course Completion Certicate for the Basic Instrument Flight Module may have the total amount of training required in paragraph 7 reduced by 10 hours. The total instrument ight instruction in airship shall comply with paragraph 7. If the applicant is the holder of an IR in another category of aircraft the total amount of ight instruction required may be reduced to 10 hours on airships. The ying exercises up to the IR(As) skill test shall comprise: (a) Basic Instrument Flight Module: Procedure and manoeuvre for basic instrument ight covering at least: basic instrument ight without external visual cues: horizontal ight, climbing, descent, turns in level ight, climbing, descent; instrument pattern; radio navigation; recovery from unusual attitudes; limited panel;
9 10
May 2012
(b) Procedural Instrument Flight Module: (i) pre-ight procedures for IFR ights, including the use of the ight manual and appropriate air trafc services documents in the preparation of an IFR ight plan; (ii) procedure and manoeuvres for IFR operation under normal, abnormal and emergency conditions covering at least: transition from visual to instrument ight on take-off, standard instrument departures and arrivals, en-route IFR procedures, holding procedures, instrument approaches to specied minima, missed approach procedures, landings from instrument approaches, including circling; (iii) inight manoeuvres and particular ight characteristics; (iv) operation of airship in the above exercises, including operation of the airship solely by reference to instruments with one engine simulated inoperative and engine shut-down and restart (the latter exercise to be carried out at a safe altitude unless carried out in an FFS or FNPT II).
May 2012
8 9
May 2012
exercise good judgment and airmanship; apply aeronautical knowledge; and maintain control of the aircraft at all times in such a manner that the successful outcome of a procedure or manoeuvre is never seriously in doubt. 11 The following limits shall apply, corrected to make allowance for turbulent conditions and the handling qualities and performance of the aircraft used. Height Generally 100 feet Starting a go-around at decision height/altitude +50 feet/0 feet Minimum descent height/MAP/altitude +50 feet/0 feet Tracking on radio aids 5 Precision approach half scale deection, azimuth and glide path Heading all engines operating 5 with simulated engine failure 10 Speed all engines operating 5 knots With Simulated Engine Failure +10 Knots/5 Knots CONTENT OF THE TEST Aeroplanes
SECTION 1 PRE-FLIGHT OPERATIONS AND DEPARTURE a b c d e f g h() i() j() a b c d(*) e
May 2012
SECTION 3 EN-ROUTE IFR PROCEDURES a b c d e f g h a b c d(+) e f g h(+) i(+) j Tracking, including interception, e.g. NDB, VOR, RNAV Use of radio aids Level ight, control of heading, altitude and airspeed, power setting, trim technique Altimeter settings Timing and revision of ETAs (en-route hold, if required) Monitoring of ight progress, ight log, fuel usage, systems management Ice protection procedures, simulated if necessary ATC liaison - compliance, R/T procedures Setting and checking of navigational aids, identication of facilities Arrival procedures, altimeter checks Approach and landing brieng, including descent/approach/landing checks Holding procedure Compliance with published approach procedure Approach timing Altitude, speed heading control (stabilised approach) Go-around action Missed approach procedure/landing ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures
SECTION 5 NON-PRECISION APPROACH PROCEDURES a b c d(+) e f g h(+) i(+) j Setting and checking of navigational aids, identication of facilities Arrival procedures, altimeter settings Approach and landing brieng, including descent/approach/landing checks Holding procedure Compliance with published approach procedure Approach timing Altitude, speed, heading control (stabilised approach) Go-around action Missed approach procedure/landing ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures
SECTION 6 FLIGHT WITH ONE ENGINE INOPERATIVE (multi-engine aeroplanes only) a b c d Simulated engine failure after take-off or on go-around Approach, go-around and procedural missed approach with one engine inoperative Approach and landing with one engine inoperative ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures
(*) May be performed in an FFS, FTD 2/3 or FNPT II. (+) May be performed in either section 4 or section 5. () Must be performed by sole reference to instruments.
May 2012
Helicopters
SECTION 1 DEPARTURE a b c d e f g h i a b c
* To be performed in section 4 or section 5. SECTION 5 NON-PRECISION APPROACH a b c Setting and checking of navigational aids, identication of facilities Arrival procedures, altimeter checks Approach and landing brieng, including descent/approach/landing checks
Section 4 Part L Page 42
May 2012
d* e f g h* i* j
Holding procedure Compliance with published approach procedure Approach timing Altitude, speed, heading control (stabilised aproach) Go-around action Missed approach procedure*/landing ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures
This section may be combined with sections 1 through 5. The test shall have regard to control of the helicopter, identication of the failed engine, immediate actions (touch drills), follow-up actions and checks and ying accuracy, in the following situations:
a Simulated engine failure after take-off and on/during approach* (at a safe altitude unless carried out in an FFS or FNPT II/III, FTD 2,3) *Multi-engine helicopter only. Failure of stability augmentation devices/hydraulic system (if applicable) Limited panel Autorotation and recovery to a pre-set altitude Precision approach manually without ight director* Precision approach manually with ight director* *Only one item to be tested.
b c d e
Airships
SECTION 1 PRE-FLIGHT OPERATIONS AND DEPARTURE a b c d e f g h i j
Use of checklist, airmanship, ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures, apply in all sections
Use of ight manual (or equivalent) especially a/c performance calculation, mass and balance Use of Air Trafc Services document, weather document Preparation of ATC ight plan, IFR ight plan/log Pre-ight inspection Weather minima Pre-take-off brieng, off mast procedure, manoeuvring on ground Take-off Transition to instrument ight Instrument departure procedures, altimeter setting ATC liaison - compliance, R/T procedures
SECTION 2 GENERAL HANDLING a b c d Control of the airship by reference solely to instruments Climbing and descending turns with sustained rate of turn Recoveries from unusual attitudes Limited panel
May 2012
SECTION 3 EN-ROUTE IFR PROCEDURES a b c d e f g Tracking, including interception, e.g. NDB, VOR, RNAV Use of radio aids Level ight, control of heading, altitude and airspeed, power setting, trim technique Altimeter settings Timing and revision of ETAs Monitoring of ight progress, ight log, fuel usage, systems management ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures
SECTION 4 PRECISION APPROACH PROCEDURES a b c d+ e f g h+ i+ j Setting and checking of navigational aids, identication of facilities Arrival procedures, altimeter checks Approach and landing brieng, including descent/approach/landing checks Holding procedure Compliance with published approach procedure Approach timing Stabilised approach (altitude, speed and heading control) Go-around action Missed approach procedure/landing ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures
SECTION 5 NON-PRECISION APPROACH PROCEDURES a b c d+ e f g h+ i+ j Setting and checking of navigational aids, identication of facilities Arrival procedures, altimeter settings Approach and landing brieng, including descent/approach/landing checks Holding procedure Compliance with published approach procedure Approach timing Stabilised approach (altitude, speed and heading control) Go-around action Missed approach procedure/landing ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures
This section may be combined with sections 1 through 5. The test shall have regard to control of the airship, identication of the failed engine, immediate actions, follow-up actions, checks and ying accuracy in the following situations:
a b c d Simulated engine failure after take-off or on go-around Approach and procedural go-around with one engine inoperative Approach and landing, missed approach procedure, with one engine inoperative ATC liaison compliance, R/T procedures
May 2012
Appendix 8 to Part-FCL Cross-crediting of the IR Part of a Class or Type Rating Prociency Check
A Aeroplanes Credits shall be granted only when the holder is revalidating IR privileges for single-engine and single-pilot multi-engine aeroplanes, as appropriate. When a prociency check including IR is performed, and the holder has a valid: MP type rating; High performance complex aeroplane type rating Credit is valid towards the IR part in a prociency check for: SE class * and SE type rating *, and SP ME class, and SP ME non-high performance complex aeroplane type rating, only credits for section 3B of the skill test for single pilot non-high performance complex aeroplane of Appendix 9 * SP ME class *, and SP ME non-high performance complex aeroplane type rating, and SE class and type rating * a. SP ME class*, and b. SP ME non-high performance complex aeroplane type rating *, and c. SE class and type rating * SE class and type rating, and SP ME class, and SP ME non-high performance complex aeroplane type rating SE class and type rating *, and SP ME class*, and SP ME non-high performance complex aeroplane type rating * SE class and type rating SE class and type rating
* Provided that within the preceding 12 months the applicant has own at least three IFR departures and approaches on an SP class or type of aeroplane in single pilot operations, or, for multi-engine non-high performance non-complex aeroplanes, the applicant has passed section 6 of the skill test for single-pilot non-high performance non-complex aeroplanes own solely by reference to instruments in single-pilot operation. B Helicopters Credits shall be granted only when the holder is revalidating IR privileges for single-engine and singlepilot multi-engine helicopters as appropriate. When a prociency check, including IR, is performed and the holder has a valid: MPH type rating SP ME type rating, operated as single-pilot SP ME type rating, restricted to multi-pilot operation Credit is valid towards the IR part in a prociency check for: SE type rating*, and SP ME type rating. * SE type rating, SP ME type rating. SE type rating, * SP ME type rating. *
* Provided that within the preceding 12 months at least 3 IFR departures and approaches have been performed on an SP type of helicopter in an SP operation.
May 2012
A General
1 2 3 4 An applicant for a skill test shall have received instruction on the same class or type of aircraft to be used in the test. Failure to achieve a pass in all sections of the test in two attempts will require further training. There is no limit to the number of skill tests that may be attempted. CONTENT OF THE TRAINING, SKILL TEST/PROFICIENCY CHECK Unless otherwise determined in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21, the syllabus of ight instruction shall comply with this Appendix. The syllabus may be reduced to give credit for previous experience on similar aircraft types, as determined in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21. Except in the case of skill tests for the issue of an ATPL, when so dened in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Part-21 for the specic type, credit may be given for skill test items common to other types or variants where the pilot is qualied. CONDUCT OF THE TEST/CHECK 6 The examiner may choose between different skill test or prociency check scenarios containing simulated relevant operations developed and approved by the competent authority. Full ight simulators and other training devices, when available, shall be used, as established in this Part. During the prociency check, the examiner shall verify that the holder of the class or type rating maintains an adequate level of theoretical knowledge. Should the applicant choose to terminate a skill test for reasons considered inadequate by the examiner, the applicant shall retake the entire skill test. If the test is terminated for reasons considered adequate by the examiner, only those sections not completed shall be tested in a further ight. At the discretion of the examiner, any manoeuvre or procedure of the test may be repeated once by the applicant. The examiner may stop the test at any stage if it is considered that the applicants demonstration of ying skill requires a complete retest. An applicant shall be required to y the aircraft from a position where the PIC or copilot functions, as relevant, can be performed and to carry out the test as if there is no other crew member if taking the test/check under single-pilot conditions. Responsibility for the ight shall be allocated in accordance with national regulations. During pre-ight preparation for the test the applicant is required to determine power settings and speeds. The applicant shall indicate to the examiner the checks and duties carried out, including the identication of radio facilities. Checks shall be completed in accordance with the check-list for the aircraft on which the test is being taken and, if applicable, with the MCC concept. Performance data for take-off, approach and landing shall be calculated by the applicant in compliance with the operations manual or ight manual for the aircraft used. Decision heights/altitude, minimum descent heights/altitudes and missed approach point shall be agreed upon with the examiner.
7 8
10
11
30 January 2013
12
The examiner shall take no part in the operation of the aircraft except where intervention is necessary in the interests of safety or to avoid unacceptable delay to other trafc. Specic Requirements for the Skill Test/Prociency Check for Multi-pilot Aircraft Type Ratings, for Single-Pilot Aeroplane Type Ratings, when Operated in Multi-Pilot Operations, for MPL and ATPL
13
The skill test for a multi-pilot aircraft or a single-pilot aeroplane when operated in multi-pilot operations shall be performed in a multi-crew environment. Another applicant or another type rated qualied pilot may function as second pilot. If an aircraft is used, the second pilot shall be the examiner or an instructor. The applicant shall operate as PF during all sections of the skill test, except for abnormal and emergency procedures, which may be conducted as PF or PNF in accordance with MCC. The applicant for the initial issue of a multi-pilot aircraft type rating or ATPL shall also demonstrate the ability to act as PNF. The applicant may choose either the left hand or the right hand seat for the skill test if all items can be executed from the selected seat. The following matters shall be specically checked by the examiner for applicants for the ATPL or a type rating for multi-pilot aircraft or for multi-pilot operations in a singlepilot aeroplane extending to the duties of a PIC, irrespective of whether the applicant acts as PF or PNF: (a) management of crew cooperation; (b) maintaining a general survey of the aircraft operation by appropriate supervision; and (c) setting priorities and making decisions in accordance with safety aspects and relevant rules and regulations appropriate to the operational situation, including emergencies.
14
15
16
The test/check should be accomplished under IFR, if the IR rating is included, and as far as possible be accomplished in a simulated commercial air transport environment. An essential element to be checked is the ability to plan and conduct the ight from routine brieng material. When the type rating course has included less than 2 hours ight training on the aircraft, the skill test may be conducted in an FFS and may be completed before the ight training on the aircraft. In that case, a certicate of completion of the type rating course including the ight training on the aircraft shall be forwarded to the competent authority before the new type rating is entered in the applicants licence.
17
B
1
May 2012
In the case of multi-pilot and single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes, the applicant shall pass all sections of the skill test or prociency check. Failure of more than 5 items will require the applicant to take the entire test or check again. Any applicant failing 5 or less items shall take the failed items again. Failure in any item on the re-test or re-check including those items that have been passed at a previous attempt will require the applicant to take the entire check or test again. Section 6 is not part of the ATPL or MPL skill test. If the applicant only fails or does not take section6, the type rating will be issued without CAT II or CAT III privileges. To extend the type rating privileges to CAT II or CAT III, the applicant shall pass the section 6 on the appropriate type of aircraft. FLIGHT TEST TOLERANCE The applicant shall demonstrate the ability to: (a) operate the aeroplane within its limitations; (b) complete all manoeuvres with smoothness and accuracy; (c) exercise good judgement and airmanship; (d) apply aeronautical knowledge; (e) maintain control of the aeroplane at all times in such a manner that the successful outcome of a procedure or manoeuvre is always assured; (f) understand and apply crew coordination and incapacitation procedures, if applicable; and (g) communicate effectively with the other crew members, if applicable.
The following limits shall apply, corrected to make allowance for turbulent conditions and the handling qualities and performance of the aeroplane used: Height Generally 100 feet Starting a go-around at decision height + 50 feet/-0 feet Minimum descent height/altitude + 50 feet/-0 feet Tracking on radio aids 5 Precision approach half scale deection, azimuth and glide path Heading all engines operating 5 with simulated engine failure 10 Speed all engines operating 5 knots with simulated engine failure +10 knots/-5 knots CONTENT OF THE TRAINING/SKILL TEST/PROFICIENCY CHECK
Single-pilot aeroplanes, except for high performance complex aeroplanes (a) The following symbols mean: P= X= Trained as PIC or Co-pilot and as Pilot Flying (PF) and Pilot Not Flying (PNF) Flight simulators shall be used for this exercise, if available, otherwise an aeroplane shall be used if appropriate for the manoeuvre or procedure
May 2012
(b) The practical training shall be conducted at least at the training equipment level shown as (P), or may be conducted on any higher level of equipment shown by the arrow (---->) The following abbreviations are used to indicate the training equipment used: A = Aeroplane FFS = Full Flight Simulator FTD = Flight Training Device (including FNPT II for ME class rating) (c) The starred (*) items of section 3B and, for multi-engine, section 6, shall be own solely by reference to instruments if revalidation/renewal of an IR is included in the skill test or prociency check. If the starred (*) items are not own solely by reference to instruments during the skill test or prociency check, and when there is no crediting of IR privileges, the class or type rating will be restricted to VFR only. (d) Section 3A shall be completed to revalidate a type or multi-engine class rating, VFR only, where the required experience of 10 route sectors within the previous 12 months has not been completed. Section 3A is not required if section 3B is completed. (e) Where the letter M appears in the skill test or prociency check column this will indicate the mandatory exercise or a choice where more than one exercise appears. (f) An FFS or an FNPT II shall be used for practical training for type or multi-engine class ratings if they form part of an approved class or type rating course. The following considerations will apply to the approval of the course: (i) the qualication of the FFS or FNPT II as set out in Part-OR; (ii) the qualications of the instructors; (iii) the amount of FFS or FNPT II training provided on the course; and (iv) the qualications and previous experience on similar types of the pilot under training. (g) When a skill test or prociency check is performed in multi-pilot operations, the type rating shall be restricted to multi-pilot operations. NOTE: The meaning of available in the context of the use of Full Flight Simulators and other training devices for pilot licensing purposes (a) The following interpretation by the UK CAA is applicable to holders of UK-issued EASA (or JAR-FCL) licences only. Holders of licences issued by other Member States should seek advice from their own National Aviation Authority on its policy on this issue. All non-UK EASA Member State examiners wishing to conduct tests/ checks on the holders of UK-issued licences must be briefed on UK policy in accordance with FCL.1015. (b) It is important to recognise that if the full ight simulator or other training device is dened as available in this context it SHALL be used. In the event that the full ight simulator or other training device is considered not available in this context then an aircraft may be used. (c) A full ight simulator or other training devices is considered available when all of the following are satised:
30 January 2013
the full ight simulator or other training devices is approved for use within the scope of the EASA regulations; and the full ight simulator or other training devices is representative of the candidates/operators aircraft class or type and is serviceable; and the full ight simulator or other training devices is sufciently representative of the particular conguration of the candidates/operators aircraft; and the full ight simulator or other training devices is accessible for use by instructors and examiners acceptable to the candidate/operator, who are appropriately trained and authorised; and the full ight simulator or other training devices is accessible for use within the scale and scope of the candidates/operators training and checking program; and the full ight simulator or other training devices is sufciently accessible to allow normal programming within the candidates/operators crew roster patterns without excessive scheduling disruptions. NOTE 1: An examiner intending to use a full ight simulator /other training devices must ensure a valid user approval has been issued in accordance with the applicable parts of the EASA Aircrew Regulation if applicable. An examiner conducting tests/checks or assessments of competence, outside of an AOC operation, who intends to use an aircraft for the purposes of Part FCL should advise Flight Crew Standards of their intent and why a simulator is not available against the criteria above. All UK AOC holders must advise their assigned Flight Operations Inspector of their intent to use an aircraft rather than a simulator that they consider to be not available for training, testing or checking in accordance with the interpretation above. Clearly, an operators SMS would play a key part in how the decision to use an aircraft is assessed.
NOTE 2:
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING
CLASS OR TYPE RATING SKILL TEST/ PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in initials when FFS training A completed Examiner initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures
FTD
FFS
SECTION 1 1 1.1 Departure Pre-ight including: Documentation Mass and Balance Weather brieng NOTAM Pre-start checks External Internal Engine starting: Normal Malfunctions Taxiing Pre-departure checks: Engine run-up (if applicable) Take-off procedure: Normal with Flight Manual ap settings Crosswind (if conditions available) Climbing: Vx/Vy Turns onto headings Level off ATC liaison Compliance, R/T procedure P----> P----> ----> P----> ----> P# P P ----> ----> M M M M
1.4 1.5
1.6
P---->
---->
1.7
P---->
---->
1.8
SECTION 2 2 2.1 Airwork (VMC) Straight and level ight at various airspeeds including ight at critically low airspeed with and without aps (including approach to VMCA when applicable) Steep turns (360 left and right at 45 bank)
P---->
---->
2.2
P---->
---->
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING
CLASS OR TYPE RATING SKILL TEST/ PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in initials when FFS training A completed Examiner initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures
FTD
FFS
2.3
Stalls and recovery: (i) Clean stall (ii) Approach to stall in descending turn with bank with approach conguration and power (iii) Approach to stall in landing conguration and power (iv) Approach to stall, climbing turn with take-off ap and climb power (single engine aeroplane only) Handling using autopilot and ight director (may be conducted in section 3) if applicable ATC liaison Compliance, R/T procedure
P---->
---->
2.4
P---->
---->
2.5
SECTION 3A 3A 3A.1 En-route procedures VFR (see B.5 (c) and (d)) Flight plan, dead reckoning and map reading Maintenance of altitude, heading and speed Orientation, timing and revision of ETAs Use of radio navigation aids (if applicable) Flight management (ight log, routine checks including fuel, systems and icing) ATC liaison Compliance, R/T procedure
3A.6
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING
CLASS OR TYPE RATING SKILL TEST/ PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in initials when FFS training A completed Examiner initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures
FTD
FFS
SECTION 3B 3B Instrument ight P----> P----> P----> ----> ----> ----> M M M 3B.1* Departure IFR 3B.2* En-route IFR 3B.3* Holding procedures 3B.4* ILS to DH/A of 200ft (60m) or to procedure minima (autopilot may be used to glideslope intercept) 3B.5* Non-precision approach to MDH/A and MAP 3B.6* Flight exercises including simulated failure of the compass and attitude indicator: rate 1 turns, recoveries from unusual attitudes 3B.7* Failure of localiser or glideslope 3B.8* ATC liaison Compliance, R/T procedure Intentionally left blank SECTION 4 4 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 Arrival and landings Aerodrome arrival procedure Normal landing Flapless landing Crosswind landing (if suitable conditions) Approach and landing with idle power from up to 2000ft above the runway (single-engine aeroplane only) M M M
P---->
---->
P---->
---->
P---->
---->
---->
P---->
---->
---->
P---->
---->
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING
CLASS OR TYPE RATING SKILL TEST/ PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in initials when FFS training A completed M Examiner initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures
FTD
FFS P---->
A ----> ---->
Go-around from minimum height Night go-around and landing (if applicable) ATC liaison Compliance, R/T procedure P---->
---->
SECTION 5 5 Abnormal and emergency procedures (This section may be combined with sections 1 through 4) Rejected take-off at a reasonable speed Simulated engine failure after take-off (singleengine aeroplanes only) Simulated forced landing without power (singleengine aeroplanes only) P----> ----> M
5.1
5.2
5.3
5.4
Simulated emergencies: (i) re or smoke in ight, (ii) systems malfunctions as appropriate P----> ----> ---->
5.5
Engine shutdown and restart (ME skill test only) (at a safe altitude if performed in the aircraft) P---->
---->
---->
5.6
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING
CLASS OR TYPE RATING SKILL TEST/ PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in initials when FFS training A completed Examiner initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures
FTD
FFS
SECTION 6 6 6.1* Simulated asymmetric ight (This section may be combined with sections 1 through 5) Simulated engine failure during take-off (at a safe altitude unless carried out in FFS or FNPT II) Asymmetric approach and go-around Asymmetric approach and full stop landing ATC liaison Compliance, R/T procedure P----> ----> --->X M
P----> P---->
----> ---->
--->X --->X
M M
Multi-pilot aeroplanes and single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes (a) The following symbols mean: P X = = Trained as PIC or Co-pilot and as PF and PNF for the issue of a type rating as applicable. Simulators shall be used for this exercise, if available; otherwise an aircraft shall be used if appropriate for the manoeuvre or procedure. The training shall be complemented by supervised aeroplane inspection.
P# =
(b) The practical training shall be conducted at least at the training equipment level shown as (P), or may be conducted up to any higher equipment level shown by the arrow (----->). The following abbreviations are used to indicate the training equipment used: A = Aeroplane FFS = Full Flight Simulator FTD = Flight Training Device OTD = Other Training Devices (c) The starred items (*) shall be own solely by reference to instruments. If this condition is not met during the skill test or prociency check, the type rating will be restricted to VFR only.
30 January 2013
(d) Where the letter M appears in the skill test or prociency check column this will indicate the mandatory exercise. (e) An FFS shall be used for practical training and testing if the FFS forms part of an approved type rating course. The following considerations will apply to the approval of the course: (i) the qualication of the FFS or FNPT II; (ii) the qualications of the instructors; (iii) the amount of FFS or FNPT II training provided on the course; and (iv) the qualications and previous experience on similar types of the pilot under training. (f) Manoeuvres and procedures shall include MCC for multi-pilot aeroplane and for single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes in multi-pilot operations. (g) Manoeuvres and procedures shall be conducted in single-pilot role for single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes in single-pilot operations. (h) In the case of single-pilot high performance complex aeroplanes, when a skill test or prociency check is performed in multi-pilot operations, the type rating shall be restricted to multi-pilot operations. If privileges of single-pilot are sought, the manoeuvres/procedures in 2.5, 3.9.3.4, 4.3, 5.5 and at least one manoeuvre/ procedure from section 3.4 have to be completed in addition as single-pilot. (i) In case of a restricted type rating issued in accordance with FCL.720.A(e), the applicants shall full the same requirements as other applicants for the type rating except for the practical exercises relating to the takeoff and landing phases.
MULTI-PILOT AEROPLANES AND SINGLE-PILOT HIGHPERFORMANCE COMPLEX AEROPLANES ATPL/MPL/TYPE RATING SKILL TEST OR PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in Examiner initials initials when FFS when test training A completed completed
PRACTICAL TRAINING
Manoeuvres/Procedures
OTD
FTD
FFS
SECTION 1 1 Flight preparation 1.1 Performance calculation 1.2 Aeroplane external visual inspection; location of each item and purpose of inspection 1.3 Cockpit inspection P
P# P-----> ----->
P ----->
1.4 Use of checklist prior to starting engines, starting procedures, radio and navigation equipment P-----> check, selection and setting of navigation and communication frequencies
----->
----->
----->
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING
ATPL/MPL/TYPE RATING SKILL TEST OR PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in Examiner initials initials when FFS when test training A completed completed -----> -----> M
Manoeuvres/Procedures
OTD
FTD
FFS
1.5 Taxiing in compliance with air trafc control or instructions of instructor 1.6 Before take-off checks SECTION 2 2 Take-offs 2.1 Normal take-offs with different ap settings, including expedited take-off 2.2* Instrument take-off; transition to instrument ight is required during rotation or immediately after becoming airborne 2.3 Crosswind take-off 2.4 Take-off at maximum take-off mass (actual or simulated maximum take-off mass) 2.5 Take-offs with simulated engine failure: 2.5.1* shortly after reaching V2 (In aeroplanes which are not certicated as transport category or commuter category aeroplanes, the engine failure shall not be simulated until reaching a minimum height of 500 ft above runway end. In aeroplanes having the same performance as a transport category aeroplane regarding take-off mass and density altitude, the instructor may simulate the engine failure shortly after reaching V2) 2.5.2* between V1 and V2 P----->
P-----> ----->
P----->
----->
P----->
----->
P-----> P----->
-----> ----->
P----->
----->
M FFS Only
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING
ATPL/MPL/TYPE RATING SKILL TEST OR PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in Examiner initials initials when FFS when test training A completed completed M
Manoeuvres/Procedures
OTD
FTD
FFS
2.6 Rejected take-off at a reasonable speed before reaching V1 SECTION 3 3 Flight Manoeuvres and Procedures 3.1 Turns with and without spoilers 3.2 Tuck under and Mach buffets after reaching the critical Mach number, and other specic ight characteristics of the aeroplane (e.g. Dutch Roll) 3.3 Normal operation of systems and controls engineers panel Normal and abnormal operations of following systems:
P----->
---->X
P----->
----> ---->X An aircraft may not be used for this exercise -----> A mandatory minimum of 3 abnormal shall be selected from 3.4.0 to 3.4.14 inclusive
P----->
P----->
----->
----->
3.4.0 Engine (if necessary propeller) 3.4.1 Pressurisation and air-conditioning 3.4.2 Pitot/static system 3.4.3 Fuel system 3.4.4 Electrical system 3.4.5 Hydraulic system 3.4.6 Flight control and Trim-system 3.4.7 Anti-icing/de-icing system, Glare shield heating
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING
ATPL/MPL/TYPE RATING SKILL TEST OR PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in Examiner initials initials when FFS when test training A completed completed -----> M (single pilot only)
Manoeuvres/Procedures
OTD
FTD
FFS
P----->
----->
----->
3.4.9 Stall warning devices or stall avoidance devices, and stability augmentation devices 3.4.10 Ground proximitywarning system, weather radar, radio altimeter,transponder 3.4.11 Radios, navigation equipment, instruments, ight management system 3.4.12 Landing gear and brake 3.4.13 Slat and ap system 3.4.14 Auxiliary power unit Intentionally left blank 3.6 Abnormal and emergency procedures:
P----->
----->
----->
----->
P----->
----->
----->
-----> -----> -----> -----> A mandatory minimum of 3 items shall be selected from 3.6.1 to 3.6.9 inclusive
3.6.1 Fire drills e.g. engine, APU, cabin, cargo compartment, ight deck, wing and electrical res including evacuation 3.6.2 Smoke control and removal 3.6.3 Engine failures, shutdown and restart at a safe height 3.6.4 Fuel dumping (simulated) 3.6.5 Wind shear at take-off/ landing
P----->
----->
----->
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING
ATPL/MPL/TYPE RATING SKILL TEST OR PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in Examiner initials initials when FFS when test training A completed completed -----> ----->
Manoeuvres/Procedures
OTD
FTD
FFS
3.6.6 Simulated cabin pressure failure/emergency descent 3.6.7 Incapacitation of ight crew member 3.6.8 Other emergency procedures as outlined in the appropriate Aeroplane Flight Manual 3.6.9 ACAS event P-----> 3.7 Steep turns with 45 bank, 180 to 360 left and right 3.8 Early recognition and counter measures on approaching stall (up to activation of stall warning device) in take-off conguration (aps in take-off position), in cruising ight conguration and in landing conguration (aps in landing position, gear extended) 3.8.1 Recovery from full stall or after activation of stall warning device in climb, cruise and approach conguration 3.9 Instrument ight procedures 3.9.1* Adherence to departure and arrival routes and ATC instructions 3.9.2* Holding procedures 3.9.3* Precision approaches down to a decision height (DH) not less than 60m (200 ft) -----> P----->
P-----> ----->
P----->
----->
----->
FFS only
P----->
----->
P----->
----->
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING
ATPL/MPL/TYPE RATING SKILL TEST OR PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in Examiner initials initials when FFS when test training A completed completed -----> -----> -----> M (skill test only)
Manoeuvres/Procedures
OTD
FTD
FFS
3.9.3.1* manually, without ight director 3.9.3.2* manually, with ight director 3.9.3.3* with autopilot 3.9.3.4* manually, with one engine simulated inoperative; engine failure has to be simulated during nal approach before passing the outer marker (OM) until touchdown or through the complete missed approach procedure In aeroplanes which are not certicated as transport category aeroplanes (JAR/ FAR 25) or as commuter category aeroplanes (SFAR 23), the approach with simulated engine failure and the ensuing go-around shall be initiated in conjunction with the non-precision approach as described in 3.9.4. The go-around shall be initiated when reaching the published obstacle clearance height (OCH/A), however not later than reaching a minimum descent height/altitude (MDH/A) of 500 ft above runway threshold elevation. In aeroplanes having the same performance as a transport category aeroplane regarding take-off mass and density altitude, the instructor may simulate the engine failure in accordance with 3.9.3.4. 3.9.4* Non-precision approach down to the MDH/A
P----->
----->
P*--->
----->
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING
ATPL/MPL/TYPE RATING SKILL TEST OR PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in Examiner initials initials when FFS when test training A completed completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures
OTD
FTD
FFS
3.9.5 Circling approach under following conditions: (a)* approach to the authorised minimum circling approach altitude at the aerodrome in question in accordance with the local instrument approach facilities in simulated instrument ight conditions; followed by: (b) circling approach to another runway at least 90 off centreline from nal approach used in item (a), at the authorised minimum circling approach altitude. Remark: if (a) and (b) are not possible due to ATC reasons, a simulated low visibility pattern may be performed. SECTION 4 4 Missed Approach Procedures 4.1 Go-around with all engines operating* after an ILS approach on reaching decision height 4.2 Other missed approach procedures 4.3* Manual go-around with the critical engine simulated inoperative after an instrument approach on reaching DH, MDH or MAPt 4.4 Rejected landing at 15 m (50 ft) above runway threshold and go-around P*---> -----> P*---> ----->
P*--->
----->
P*--->
----->
P---->
----->
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING
ATPL/MPL/TYPE RATING SKILL TEST OR PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in Examiner initials initials when FFS when test training A completed completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures
OTD
FTD
FFS
SECTION 5 5 Landings 5.1 Normal landings* also after an ILS approach with transition to visual ight on reaching DH 5.2 Landing with simulated jammed horizontal stabiliser in any out-of-trim position P
P----->
5.3 Crosswind landings (a/c, if practicable) 5.4 Trafc pattern and landing without extended or with partly extended aps and slats 5.5 Landing with critical engine simulated inoperative 5.6 Landing with two engines inoperative: - aeroplanes with 3 engines: the centre engine and 1 outboard engine as far as practicable according to data of the AFM; - aeroplanes with 4 engines: 2 engines at one side General remarks:
P----->
P----->
----->
P-----> P
-----> X
Special requirements for extension of a type rating for instrument approaches down to a decision height of less than 200 feet (60 m), i.e. Cat II/III operations.
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING
ATPL/MPL/TYPE RATING SKILL TEST OR PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in Examiner initials initials when FFS when test training A completed completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures
OTD
FTD
FFS
SECTION 6 Additional authorisation on a type rating for instrument approaches down to a decision height of less than 60 m (200 ft) (CAT II/III) The following manoeuvres and procedures are the minimum training requirements to permit instrument approaches down to a DH of less than 60 m (200 ft). During the following instrument approaches and missed approach procedures all aeroplane equipment required for type certication of instrument approaches down to a DH of less than 60m (200ft) shall be used. 6.1* Rejected take-off at minimum authorised RVR ---->X An aircraft P*-----> may not be used for this exercise
M*
6.2* ILS approaches: in simulated instrument ight conditions down to the applicable DH, using ight guidance system. Standard procedures of crew coordination (task sharing, call out procedures, mutual surveillance, information exchange and support) shall be observed
P----->
----->
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING
ATPL/MPL/TYPE RATING SKILL TEST OR PROF. CHECK Instructor Chkd in Examiner initials initials when FFS when test training A completed completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures
OTD
FTD
FFS
6.3* Go-around: after approaches as indicated in 6.2 on reaching DH. The training shall also include a go-around due to (simulated) insufcient RVR, wind shear, aeroplane deviation in excess of approach limits for a successful approach, and ground/airborne equipment failure prior to reaching DH and, go-around with simulated airborne equipment failure 6.4* Landing(s): with visual reference established at DH following an instrument approach. Depending on the specic ight guidance system, an automatic landing shall be performed
P----->
----->
M*
P----->
----->
NOTE: CAT II/III operations shall be accomplished in accordance with the applicable air operations requirements.
Class ratings sea Section 6 shall be completed to revalidate a multi-engine class rating sea, VFR only, where the required experience of 10 route sectors within the previous 12 months has not been completed. CLASS RATING SEA PRACTICAL TRAINING Instructors initials when training completed Examiners initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures SECTION 1 1 Departure 1.1 Pre-ight including: Documentation Mass and Balance Weather brieng NOTAM
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING Instructors initials when training completed Examiners initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures 1.2 Pre-start checks External/internal 1.3 Engine start-up and shutdown Normal malfunctions 1.4 Taxiing 1.5 Step taxiing 1.6 Mooring: Beach Jetty pier Buoy 1.7 Engine-off sailing 1.8 Pre-departure checks: Engine run-up (if applicable) 1.9 Take-off procedure: Normal with Flight Manual ap settings Crosswind (if conditions available) 1.10 Climbing Turns onto headings Level off 1.11ATC liaison Compliance, R/T procedure SECTION 2 2 Airwork (VFR) 2.1 Straight and level ight at various airspeeds including ight at critically low airspeed with and without aps (including approach to VMCA when applicable) 2.2 Steep turns (360 left and right at 45 bank) 2.3 Stalls and recovery: (i) clean stall; (ii) approach to stall in descending turn with bank with approach conguration and power; (iii) approach to stall in landing conguration and power; (iv) approach to stall, climbing turn with take-off ap and climb power (single-engine aeroplane only) 2.4 ATC liaison Compliance, R/T procedure SECTION 3 3 En-route procedures VFR 3.1 Flight plan, dead reckoning and map reading 3.2 Maintenance of altitude, heading and speed 3.3 Orientation, timing and revision of ETAs
30 January 2013
PRACTICAL TRAINING Instructors initials when training completed Examiners initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures 3.4 Use of radio navigation aids (if applicable) 3.5 Flight management (ight log, routine checks including fuel, systems and icing) 3.6 ATC liaison Compliance, R/T procedure SECTION 4 4 Arrivals and landings 4.1 Aerodrome arrival procedure (amphibians only) 4.2 Normal landing 4.3 Flapless landing 4.4 Crosswind landing (if suitable conditions) 4.5 Approach and landing with idle power from up to 2000 above the water (single-engine aeroplane only) 4.6 Go-around from minimum height 4.7 Glassy water landing Rough water landing 4.8 ATC liaison Compliance, R/T procedure SECTION 5 5 Abnormal and emergency procedures (This section may be combined with sections 1 through 4) 5.1 Rejected take-off at a reasonable speed 5.2 Simulated engine failure after take-off (singleengine aeroplane only) 5.3 Simulated forced landing without power (singleengine aeroplane only) 5.4 Simulated emergencies: (i) re or smoke in ight (ii) systems malfunctions as appropriate 5.5 ATC liaison Compliance, R/T procedure SECTION 6 6 Simulated asymmetric ight (This section may be combined with sections 1 through 5) 6.1 Simulated engine failure during take-off (at a safe altitude unless carried out in FFS and FNPT II) 6.2 Engine shutdown and restart (ME skill test only) 6.3 Asymmetric approach and go-around 6.4 Asymmetric approach and full stop landing 6.5 ATC liaison Compliance, R/T procedure
30 January 2013
C
1
The following limits shall apply, corrected to make allowance for turbulent conditions and the handling qualities and performance of the aeroplane used. (a) IFR ight limits Height: Generally 100 feet Starting a go-around at decision height/altitude +50 feet/-0 feet Minimum descent height/altitude +50 feet/-0 feet Tracking: On radio aids 5 Precision approach half scale deection, azimuth and glide path Heading: Normal operations Abnormal operations/emergencies Speed: Generally With simulated engine failure 5 10 10 knots +10 knots/-5 knots
30 January 2013
(b) VFR ight limits Height: Generally Heading: Normal operations Abnormal operations/emergencies Speed: Generally With simulated engine failure Ground drift: T.O. hover I.G.E. Landing General 5 The following symbols mean: P= Trained as PIC for the issue of a type rating for SPH or trained as PIC or Co-pilot and as PF and PNF for the issue of a type rating for MPH. 6 The practical training shall be conducted at least at the training equipment level shownas (P), or may be conducted up to any higher equipment level shown by the arrow (---->). The following abbreviations are used to indicate the training equipment used: FFS = FTD = 7 Full Flight Simulator Flight Training Device 100 feet 5 10 10 knots +10 knots/-5 knots 3 feet 2 feet (with 0 feet rearward or lateral ight)
H = Helicopter The starred items (*) shall be own in actual or simulated IMC, only by applicants wishing to renew or revalidate an IR(H), or extend the privileges of that rating to another type. Instrument ight procedures (section 5) shall be performed only by applicants wishing to renew or revalidate an IR(H) or extend the privileges of that rating to another type. An FFS or FTD 2/3 may be used for this purpose. Where the letter M appears in the skill test or prociency check column this will indicate the mandatory exercise. An FSTD shall be used for practical training and testing if the FSTD forms part of a type rating course. The following considerations will apply to the course: (i) the qualication of the FSTD as set out in Part-OR; (ii) the qualications of the instructor and examiner; (iii) the amount of FSTD training provided on the course; (iv) the qualications and previous experience in similar types of the pilot under training; and (v) the amount of supervised ying experience provided after the issue of the new type rating.
9 10
30 January 2013
MULTI-PILOT HELICOPTERS 11 12 Applicants for the skill test for the issue of the multi-pilot helicopter type rating and ATPL(H) shall take only sections 1 to 4 and, if applicable, section 6. Applicants for the revalidation or renewal of the multi-pilot helicopter type rating prociency check shall take only sections 1 to 4 and, if applicable, section 6.
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Instructor Chkd in initials when FFS training H completed Examiner initials when test completed
SINGLE/MULTI-PILOT HELICOPTERS
PRACTICAL TRAINING
Manoeuvres/Procedures
FTD
FFS
SECTION 1 Pre-ight preparations and checks 1.1 Helicopter exterior visual inspection; location of each item and purpose of inspection Cockpit inspection Starting procedures, radio and navigation equipment check, selection and setting of navigation and communication frequencies Taxiing/air taxiing in compliance with air trafc control instructions or with instructions of an instructor Pre-take-off procedures and checks P P P ----> M (if performed in the helicopter) M
1.2 1.3
---->
---->
1.4
---->
1.5
---->
---->
SECTION 2 Flight manoeuvres and procedures 2.1 2.2 Take-offs (various proles) Sloping ground or crosswind take-offs & landings Take-off at maximum takeoff mass (actual or simulated maximum take-off mass) Take-off with simulated engine failure shortly before reaching TDP or DPATO Take-off with simulated engine failure shortly after reaching TDP or DPATO P P P ----> ----> M
2.3
---->
---->
2.4
---->
2.4.1
---->
30 January 2013
SINGLE/MULTI-PILOT HELICOPTERS
PRACTICAL TRAINING
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Instructor Chkd in initials when FFS training H completed Examiner initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures
FTD
FFS
2.5
Climbing and descending turns to specied headings Turns with 30 bank, 180 to 360 left and right, by sole reference to instruments Autorotative descent Autorotative landing (SEH only) or power recovery Landings, various proles Go-around or landing following simulated engine failure before LDP or DPBL Landing following simulated engine failure after LDP or DPBL
---->
---->
2.5.1
P P
----> ----> P P P
M M M M M
2.7.2
---->
SECTION 3 Normal and abnormal operations of the following systems and procedures 3 Normal and abnormal operations of the following systems and procedures: A mandatory minimum of 3 items shall be selected from this section
3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 3.8 3.9 3.10 3.11 3.12
Engine Air conditioning (heating, ventilation) Pitot/static system Fuel System Electrical system Hydraulic system Flight control and Trim system Anti-icing and de-icing system Autopilot/Flight director Stability augmentation devices Weather radar, radio altimeter, transponder Area Navigation System
P P P P P P P P P P P P
----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ---> ----> ----> ---->
----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ---> ----> ----> ---->
30 January 2013
SINGLE/MULTI-PILOT HELICOPTERS
PRACTICAL TRAINING
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Instructor Chkd in initials when FFS training H completed Examiner initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures
FTD P P P
Landing gear system Auxiliary power unit Radio, navigation equipment, instruments ight management system
SECTION 4 Abnormal and emergency procedures 4 Abnormal and emergency procedures M A mandatory minimum of 3 items shall be selected from this section
Fire drills (including evacuation if applicable) Smoke control and removal Engine failures, shutdown and restart at a safe height Fuel dumping (simulated) Tail rotor control failure (if applicable) Tail rotor loss (if applicable)
P P P P P
----> ----> ----> ----> ----> Helicopter may not be used for this exercise ----> ---->
---->
Incapacitation of crew member MPH only Transmission malfunctions Other emergency procedures as outlined in the appropriate Flight Manual
P P
----> ---->
---->
---->
30 January 2013
SINGLE/MULTI-PILOT HELICOPTERS
PRACTICAL TRAINING
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Instructor Chkd in initials when FFS training H completed Examiner initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures
FTD
FFS
SECTION 5 Instrument Flight Procedures (to be performed in IMC or simulated IMC) 5.1 Instrument take-off: transition to instrument ight is required as soon as possible after becoming airborne Simulated engine failure during departure Adherence to departure and arrival routes and ATC instructions Holding procedures ILS approaches down to CAT I decision height Manually, without ight director Precision approach manually, with or without ight director With coupled autopilot Manually, with one engine simulated inoperative. (Engine failure has to be simulated during nal approach before passing the outer marker (OM) until touchdown or until completion of the missed approach procedure) Non-precision approach down to the minimum descent altitude MDA/H Go-around with all engines operating on reaching DA/DH or MDA/ MDH Other missed approach procedures Go-around with one engine simulated inoperative on reaching DA/DH or MDA/MDH IMC autorotation with power recovery
P*
---->*
---->*
5.1.1 5.2
P* P* P* P* P* P* P*
M* M*
M* M*
5.4.3 5.4.4
P*
---->*
---->*
M*
5.5
P*
---->*
---->*
M*
5.6
P*
---->*
---->*
5.6.1 5.6.2
P*
---->*
---->*
P*
M*
5.7
P*
---->*
---->*
M*
30 January 2013
SINGLE/MULTI-PILOT HELICOPTERS
PRACTICAL TRAINING
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Instructor Chkd in initials when FFS training H completed M* Examiner initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures
FTD P*
FFS ---->*
H ---->*
5.8
D
1
The following limits shall apply, corrected to make allowance for turbulent conditions and the handling qualities and performance of the powered-lift aircraft used. (a) IFR ight limits: Height: Generally 100 feet Starting a go-around at decision height/altitude +50 feet/-0 feet Minimum descent height/altitude +50 feet/-0 feet
30 January 2013
5 half scale deection, azimuth and glide path 5 10 10 knots +10 knots/-5 knots
Heading: Normal operations Abnormal operations/emergencies Speed: Generally With simulated engine failure (b) VFR ight limits:
Height: Generally 100 feet Heading: Normal operations 5 Abnormal operations/emergencies 10 Speed: 10 knots Generally With simulated engine failure +10 knots/-5 knots Ground drift: T.O. hover I.G.E. 3 feet Landing 2 feet (with 0 feet rearward or lateral ight) CONTENT OF THE TRAINING/SKILL TEST/PROFICIENCY CHECK 4 The following symbols mean: P = Trained as PIC or Co-pilot and as PF and PNF for the issue of a type rating as applicable. 5 The practical training shall be conducted at least at the training equipment level shown as (P), or may be conducted up to any higher equipment level shown by the arrow (---->). The following abbreviations are used to indicate the training equipment used: FFS = FTD = OTD = PL = Full Flight Simulator Flight Training Device Other Training Device Powered-lift aircraft
(a) Applicants for the skill test for the issue of the powered-lift aircraft type rating shall take sections 1 to 5 and, if applicable, section 6. (b) Applicants for the revalidation or renewal of the powered-lift aircraft type rating prociency check shall take sections 1 to 5 and, if applicable section 6 and/or 7. (c) The starred items (*) shall be own solely by reference to instruments. If this condition is not met during the skill test or prociency check, the type rating will be restricted to VFR only.
30 January 2013
7 8
Where the letter M appears in the skill test or prociency check column this will indicate the mandatory exercise. Flight Simulation Training Devices shall be used for practical training and testing if they form part of an approved type rating course. The following considerations will apply to the approval of the course: (a) the qualication of the ight simulation training devices as set out in Part-OR; (b) the qualications of the instructor.
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Chkd in FFS PL Examiners initials when test completed
SECTION 1 Pre-ight preparations and checks 1.1 Powered-lift aircraft exterior visual inspection; location of each item and purpose of inspection Cockpit inspection Starting procedures, radio and navigation equipment check, selection and setting of navigation and communication frequencies Taxiing in compliance with air trafc control instructions or with instructions of an instructor Pre-take-off procedures and checks including Power Check P ----> ---->
1.2 1.3
---->
---->
---->
---->
1.4
---->
---->
1.5
---->
---->
---->
SECTION 2 Flight manoeuvres and procedures 2.1 Normal VFR take-off proles; Runway operations (STOL and VTOL) including crosswind Elevated heliports Ground level heliports P ----> ----> M
30 January 2013
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Chkd in FFS PL Examiners initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures OTD 2.2 Take-off at maximum take-off mass (actual or simulated maximum take-off mass) Rejected take-off: during runway operations during elevated heliport operations during ground level operations 2.3.2 Take-off with simulated engine failure after passing decision point: during runway operations during elevated heliport operations during ground level operations 2.4 Autorotative descent in helicopter mode to ground (an aircraft shall not be used for this exercise) Windmill descent in aeroplane mode (an aircraft shall not be used for this exercise) Normal VFR landing proles; runway operations (STOL and VTOL) elevated heliports ground level heliports P ----> ----> P ----> P ----> FTD FFS PL
---->
2.3.1
---->
---->
2.4.1
---->
2.5
30 January 2013
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Chkd in FFS PL Examiners initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures OTD 2.5.1 Landing with simulated engine failure after reaching decision point: during runway operations during elevated heliport operations during ground level operations Go-around or landing following simulated engine failure before decision point FTD FFS PL
2.6
---->
SECTION 3 Normal and abnormal operations of the following systems and procedures: 3 Normal and abnormal operations of the following systems and procedures (may be completed in an FSTD if qualied for the exercise): Engine Pressurisation and air conditioning (heating, ventilation) Pitot/static system Fuel System Electrical system Hydraulic system Flight control and Trim-system Anti-icing and de-icing system, glare shield heating (if tted) Autopilot/Flight director Stall warning devices or stall avoidance devices and stability augmentation devices P P P P P P P P P ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> A mandatory minimum of 3 items shall be selected from this section
3.1 3.2
3.9 3.10
---->
---->
30 January 2013
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Chkd in FFS PL Examiners initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures OTD 3.11 Weather radar, radio altimeter, transponder, ground proximity warning system (if tted) Landing gear system Auxiliary power unit Radio, navigation equipment, instruments and ight management system Flap system FTD FFS PL
---->
---->
P P P P
3.15
SECTION 4 Abnormal and emergency procedures 4 Abnormal and emergency procedures (may be completed in an FSTD if qualied for the exercise) 4.1 Fire drills, engine, APU, cargo compartment, ight deck and electrical res including evacuation if applicable Smoke control and removal Engine failures, shutdown and restart (an aircraft shall not be used for this exercise) including OEI conversion from helicopter to aeroplane modes and vice versa 4.4 Fuel dumping (simulated, if tted) FFS only A mandatory minimum of 3 items shall be selected from this section
---->
---->
4.2 4.3
---->
---->
---->
---->
---->
---->
30 January 2013
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Chkd in FFS PL FFS only Examiners initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures OTD 4.5 Wind shear at take-off and landing (an aircraft shall not be used for this exercise) Simulated cabin pressure failure/ emergency descent (an aircraft shall not be used for this exercise) ACAS event (an aircraft shall not be used for this exercise) 4.8 4.9 4.10 Incapacitation of crew member Transmission malfunctions Recovery from a full stall (power on and off) or after activation of stall warning devices in climb, cruise and approach congurations (an aircraft shall not be used for this exercise) Other emergency procedures as detailed in the appropriate Flight Manual P ----> ----> FTD FFS PL
4.6
---->
---->
FFS only
4.7
FFS only
P P
----> ---->
---->
---->
FFS only
4.11
---->
---->
SECTION 5 Instrument Flight Procedures (to be performed in IMC or simulated IMC) 5.1 Instrument take-off: transition to instrument ight is required as soon as possible after becoming airborne Simulated engine failure during departure after decision point
P*
---->*
---->*
5.1.1
P*
---->*
---->*
M*
30 January 2013
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Chkd in FFS PL Examiners initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures OTD 5.2 Adherence to departure and arrival routes and ATC instructions Holding procedures Precision approach down to a decision height not less than 60 m (200 ft) Manually, without ight director FTD FFS PL
P* P* P*
M*
5.3 5.4
5.4.1
P*
---->*
---->*
Manually, with ight director With use of autopilot Manually, with one engine simulated inoperative; engine failure has to be simulated during nal approach before passing the outer marker (OM) and continued either to touchdown, or through to the completion of the missed approach procedure) Non-precision approach down to the minimum descent altitude MDA/H Go-around with all engines operating on reaching DA/DH or MDA/MDH Other missed approach procedures
P* P*
---->* ---->*
---->* ---->*
P*
---->*
---->*
M*
5.5
P*
---->*
---->*
M*
5.6
P*
---->*
---->*
5.6.1
P*
---->*
---->*
30 January 2013
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Chkd in FFS PL Examiners initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures OTD 5.6.2 Go-around with one engine simulated inoperative on reaching DA/DH or MDA/MDH IMC autorotation with power recovery to land on runway in helicopter mode only (an aircraft shall not be used for this exercise) Recovery from unusual attitudes (this one depends on the quality of the FFS) FTD FFS PL
P*
M*
5.7
P*
---->*
---->*
M* FFS only
5.8
P*
---->*
---->*
M*
SECTION 6 Additional authorisation on a type rating for instrument approaches down to a decision height of less than 60 m (CAT II/III) 6 Additional authorisation on a type rating for instrument approaches down to a decision height of less than 60 m (CAT II/III). The following manoeuvres and procedures are the minimum training requirements to permit instrument approaches down to a DH of less than 60m (200 ft). During the following instrument approaches and missed approach procedures all powered-lift aircraft equipment required for the type certication of instrument approaches down to a DH of less than 60m (200 ft) shall be used
30 January 2013
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Chkd in FFS PL M* Examiners initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures OTD 6.1 Rejected take-off at minimum authorised RVR ILS approaches in simulated instrument ight conditions down to the applicable DH, using ight guidance system. Standard procedures of crew coordination (SOPs) shall be observed 6.3 Go-around after approaches as indicated in 6.2 on reaching DH. The training shall also include a go-around due to (simulated) insufcient RVR, wind shear, aircraft deviation in excess of approach limits for a successful approach, ground/airborne equipment failure prior to reaching DH, and go-around with simulated airborne equipment failure 6.4 Landing(s) with visual reference established at DH following an instrument approach. Depending on the specic ight guidance system, an automatic landing shall be performed SECTION 7 Optional equipment 7 Use of optional equipment P ----> ----> FTD FFS PL
---->
6.2
---->
---->
M*
---->
---->
M*
---->
M*
30 January 2013
E
1
The following limits shall apply, corrected to make allowance for turbulent conditions and the handling qualities and performance of the airship used. (a) IFR ight limits: Height: 100 feet Generally Starting a go-around at decision height/altitude +50 feet/-0 feet Minimum descent height/altitude +50 feet/-0 feet Tracking: On radio aids 5 Precision approach half scale deection, azimuth and glide path Heading: Normal operations 5 Abnormal operations/emergencies 10 (b) VFR ight limits: Height: Generally 100 feet Heading: Normal operations 5 Abnormal operations/emergencies 10 CONTENT OF THE TRAINING/SKILL TEST/PROFICIENCY CHECK
The following symbols mean: P= Trained as PIC or Co-pilot and as PF and PNF for the issue of a type rating as applicable.
30 January 2013
The practical training shall be conducted at least at the training equipment level shown as (P), or may be conducted up to any higher equipment level shown by the arrow (---->). The following abbreviations are used to indicate the training equipment used: FFS = Full Flight Simulator FTD = Flight Training Device OTD = Other Training Device As = Airship (a) Applicants for the skill test for the issue of the airship shall take sections 1 to 5 and, if applicable, section 6. (b) Applicants for the revalidation or renewal of the airship type rating prociency check shall take sections 1 to 5 and, if applicable section 6. (c) The starred items (*) shall be own solely by reference to instruments. If this condition is not met during the skill test or prociency check, the type rating will be restricted to VFR only.
7 8
Where the letter M appears in the skill test or prociency check column this will indicate the mandatory exercise. Flight Simulation Training Devices shall be used for practical training and testing if they form part of a type rating course. The following considerations will apply to the a course: (a) the qualication of the ight simulation training devices as set out in Part-OR; (b) the qualications of the instructor.
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Instructors initials when training completed Chkd in FFS As Examiners initials when test completed
AIRSHIP CATEGORY
PRACTICAL TRAINING
SECTION 1 Pre-ight preparations and checks 1.1 1.2 1.3 Pre-ight inspection Cockpit inspection Starting procedures, radio and navigation equipment check, selection and setting of navigation and communication frequencies Off Mast procedure and Ground Manoeuvring Pre-take-off procedures and checks P ----> P ----> ----> P ---->
---->
---->
1.4 1.5
P ---->
----> ---->
M M
30 January 2013
AIRSHIP CATEGORY
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Chkd in FFS As Examiners initials when test completed
SECTION 2 Flight manoeuvres and procedures 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8 2.9 2.10 2.11 2.12 Normal VFR take-off prole Take-off with simulated engine failure Take-off with heaviness > 0 (Heavy T/O) Take-off with heaviness < 0 (Light/TO) Normal climb procedure Climb to Pressure Height Recognising of Pressure Height Flight at or close to Pressure Height Normal descent and approach Normal VFR landing prole Landing with heaviness > 0 (Heavy Ldg.) Landing with heaviness < 0 (Light Ldg.) Intentionally left blank SECTION 3 Normal and abnormal operations of the following systems and procedures 3 Normal and abnormal operations of the following systems and procedures (may be completed in an FSTD if qualied for the exercise): Engine Envelope Pressurisation Pitot/static system Fuel system Electrical system P P P P P ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> A mandatory minimum of 3 items shall be selected from this section P P P P P P P P P P P P ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> M M M M M M
30 January 2013
AIRSHIP CATEGORY
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Chkd in FFS As Examiners initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures OTD 3.6 3.7 3.8 3.9 3.10 3.11 Hydraulic system Flight control and Trim-system Ballonet system Autopilot/Flight director Stability augmentation devices Weather radar, radio altimeter, transponder, ground proximity warning system (if tted) Landing gear system Auxiliary power unit Radio, navigation equipment, instruments and ight management system Intentionally left blank SECTION 4 Abnormal and emergency procedures 4 Abnormal and emergency procedures (may be completed in an FSTD if qualied for the exercise) 4.1 Fire drills, engine, APU, cargo compartment, ight deck and electrical res including evacuation if applicable Smoke control and removal Engine failures, shutdown and restart In particular phases of ight, inclusive multiple engine failure 4.4 4.5 Incapacitation of crew member Transmission/Gearbox malfunctions P ----> ----> ----> P P P P P FTD ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> FFS ----> ----> ----> ----> ----> As ----> ----> ----> ----> ---->
---->
---->
---->
P P P
---->
---->
---->
4.2 4.3
---->
---->
---->
P P
----> ---->
----> ---->
30 January 2013
AIRSHIP CATEGORY
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Chkd in FFS As Examiners initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures OTD 4.6 Other emergency procedures as outlined in the appropriate Flight Manual FTD FFS As
---->
---->
---->
SECTION 5 Instrument Flight Procedures (to be performed in IMC or simulated IMC) 5.1 Instrument take-off: transition to instrument ight is required as soon as possible after becoming airborne
P*
---->*
---->*
---->*
5.1.1 Simulated engine failure during departure 5.2 Adherence to departure and arrival routes and ATC instructions Holding procedures Precision approach down to a decision height not less than 60 m (200 ft)
P* P* P* P*
M* M*
5.3 5.4
P*
---->*
---->*
---->*
5.4.2 Manually, with ight director 5.4.3 With use of autopilot 5.4.4 Manually, with one engine simulated inoperative; engine failure has to be simulated during nal approach before passing the outer marker (OM) and continued to touchdown, or until completion of the missed approach procedure 5.5 Non-precision approach down to the minimum descent altitude MDA/H
P* P*
---->* ---->*
---->* ---->*
---->* ---->*
P*
---->*
---->*
---->*
M*
P*
---->*
---->*
---->*
M*
30 January 2013
AIRSHIP CATEGORY
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Chkd in FFS As Examiners initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures OTD 5.6 Go-around with all engines operating on reaching DA/DH or MDA/MDH FTD FFS As
P*
---->*
---->*
---->*
5.6.1 Other missed approach procedures 5.6.2 Go-around with one engine simulated inoperative on reaching DA/DH or MDA/MDH 5.7 Recovery from unusual attitudes (this one depends on the quality of the FFS)
P*
---->*
---->*
---->*
P*
M*
P*
---->*
---->*
---->*
M*
SECTION 6 Additional authorisation on a type rating for instrument approaches down to a decision height of less than 60 m (CAT II/III) 6 Additional authorisation on a type rating for instrument approaches down to a decision height of less than 60 m (CAT II/III). The following manoeuvres and procedures are the minimum training requirements to permit instrument approaches down to a DH of less than 60 m (200 ft). During the following instrument approaches and missed approach procedures all airship equipment required for the type certication of instrument approaches down to a DH of less than 60 m (200 ft) shall be used. 6.1 Rejected take-off at minimum authorised RVR P ----> M*
30 January 2013
AIRSHIP CATEGORY
SKILL TEST OR PROFICIENCY CHECK Chkd in FFS As Examiners initials when test completed
Manoeuvres/Procedures OTD 6.2 ILS approaches In simulated instrument ight conditions down to the applicable DH, using ight guidance system. Standard procedures of crew coordination (SOPs) shall be observed 6.3 Go-around After approaches as indicated in 6.2 on reaching DH. The training shall also include a go-around due to (simulated) insufcient RVR, wind shear, aircraft deviation in excess of approach limits for a successful approach, and ground/ airborne equipment failure prior to reaching DH and, go-around with simulated airborne equipment failure Landing(s) With visual reference established at DH following an instrument approach. Depending on the specic ight guidance system, an automatic landing shall be performed SECTION 7 Optional equipment 7 Use of optional equipment P ----> FTD FFS As
---->
M*
---->
M*
6.4
---->
M*
30 January 2013
Part M
1 Applicability
In March 2003, ICAO amended Annex I to the International Convention on Civil Aviation to include a requirement for all aeroplane and helicopter pilots, ight navigators and air trafc controllers to be procient in their command of the languages that they use for radio communication. A prociency scale of 1 to 6 is specied, with Level 6 being the standard of a native speaker of the language. The requirement was later extended to include the pilots of airships and powered lift aircraft. ICAO Annex 1 species the minimum standard for the holder of a licence to be Level 4. It also species that licence holders assessed as Level 4 or 5 shall be re-tested periodically but that a person assessed as Level 6 need not be re-tested. The maximum periods between tests stated in the ICAO documents for Levels 4 and 5 are recommendations only. If the language prociency of an individual is assessed as being below Level 4 (i.e. 1, 2 or 3) that individual may not hold a licence that includes radiotelephony privileges. The ICAO standards apply to the language used for radio communication; ICAO permits languages other than English in circumstances where ight crew and air trafc controllers share another common language. Under European legislation the European Commission, assisted by EASA, must ensure that the requirements set out in the EASA Aircrew Regulation for Part-FCL licences meet or exceed ICAO standards. Similarly, the CAA is required under UK legislation to ensure that national licences comply with ICAO standards where applicable. The ICAO standards for language prociency are already in use in the UK and the other EASA Member States, but the EASA Aircrew Regulation makes their application mandatory and imposes a common format for showing language prociency on Part-FCL licences. For Part-FCL licences, the language prociency standards are set out in Part-FCL. These are equivalent to the standards already in use in the UK. Part-FCL states that holders of an Instrument Rating shall demonstrate language prociency in English. The CAA applies the EASA standards and procedures to both Part-FCL licences and national licences issued by the CAA. Whilst the EU regulations include language prociency standards (as they are included in ICAO Annex 1), they do not include the requirements to be complied with to be granted a licence to operate radio communication equipment installed in an aircraft; such licences remain under national legislation. In the UK this is a Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence (FRTOL) See Section 6 of this CAP 804. Part-FCL species that pilots who are to use radiotelephony shall demonstrate language prociency. Such prociency is required, in ENGLISH, for the issue of a UK FRTOL. Where a pilot accepts the limitation of ying non-radio only, or the pilot is the holder of a sailplane or balloon licence, Part-FCL does not require language prociency to be demonstrated; but it is always required for a UK FRTOL to be valid.
2 Privileges
The demonstration of language prociency does not provide any privileges, but the privileges of a FRTOL may not be exercised unless the language prociency demonstration of the holder of that licence is valid. (i.e. To use a FRTOL the holder must have English language prociency Level 6, or non-expired English language prociency at Level 4 or 5).
May 2012
3 Requirements
The requirements for language prociency are specied in Part-FCL FCL.055. Compliance with these requirements is mandatory for the holders of Part-FCL licences in the circumstances set out in FCL.055, and compliance is mandatory for the holder of a United Kingdom FRTOL. In FCL.055: Operational Level means ICAO Level 4 Extended Level means ICAO Level 5 Expert Level means ICAO Level 6 Information relating to the Levels is set out in Appendix 2 to Part-FCL.
May 2012
Part-ARA species that the language prociency level and validity shall be stated on a Part-FCL licence.
4.1
Methods of Testing a) At the Radiotelephony Test During the practical test for the UK FRTOL an Examiner who has Level 6 prociency in English and is authorised by the CAA as an English Language Assessor, will assess the applicants prociency in English. If the examiner assesses the candidate as being Expert Level 6 (the standard of a native speaker of English) he may certify to that effect by submitting a Form SRG1199 to the CAA. If the Examiner considers that the applicant is not at Level 6 the Examiner must not give a prociency endorsement. The applicant should then seek an expert assessment, such as through a CAA approved language school as under (c) below. A FRTOL will not be issued unless and until the applicant has a valid endorsement of language prociency at Level 4, 5 or 6. b) At a Flight Test Type Rating Examiners (TREs), Flight Examiners (FEs) and Class Rating Examiners (CREs), who have themselves been assessed as procient at Level 6 in English and are authorised by the CAA as English Language Assessors, may include assessment of the language prociency of existing holders of licences issued by the UK CAA (Part-FCL or national) as part of the licence prociency check that is conducted for the revalidation or renewal of a rating or certicate. If the examiner assesses the candidate as being Expert Level 6 (the standard of a native speaker of English) he may certify to that effect by submitting a Form SRG1199 to the CAA. If the Examiner considers that the applicant is not at Level 6 the Examiner must not give a prociency endorsement. The applicant should then seek an expert assessment, such as through a CAA approved language school as under (c) below. A UK FRTOL held by a licence holder will not be valid unless and until the applicant has a valid endorsement of language prociency at Level 4, 5 or 6. c) Through a Language School Applicants choosing to be tested by a language school should verify that the school is approved by or is acceptable to the CAA for the purpose of language assessment. A list of language schools acceptable to the CAA may be found on the CAA website (www.caa.co.uk) under Language Prociency. d) At a Training Organisation Many CAA approved ATOs offer language training modules that meet the requirements of Part-FCL.055 as part of an individuals overall training package. Language prociency may be determined by this means where the school is approved by the CAA for the purpose. A list of training organisation acceptable to the CAA for the determination of language prociency may be found on the CAA website (www.caa.co.uk) under Language Prociency. e) Other Acceptable Means Language prociency may also be assessed by other means acceptable to the CAA. Such means of assessment may be determined by an operator or
May 2012
organisation to make efcient use of their own resources, but in any case must be approved by the CAA and meet the requirements of Part-FCL.055 before being put into effect.
5
5.1
Additional Information
Transitional arrangements for existing UK licence holders In order to comply with the ICAO obligations the UK CAA has, since 2008, issued licences that include the statement Language Prociency: English. To facilitate this it was accepted by the CAA at that time that any holder of a UK FRTOL would be procient to at least Level 4. The Level of prociency is not stated on licences issued by the CAA prior to 17 September 2012, but CAA records for individual pilots will show Level 4 for FRTOL holders (expiring 4 years after the licence was issued), or Level 5 or 6 if acceptable evidence of prociency to those levels has been submitted to the CAA. To comply with the EASA Aircrew Regulation, Part-FCL licences issued by the CAA that include a radio licence must show the level of language prociency. From 17September 2012 onwards, applicants for new or replacement licences, or for the conversion of national licences, must supply evidence of language prociency in English (or have previously been accepted by the CAA as being at a level that has not expired on the date the new licence is issued). UK licence holders who need to revalidate/renew a language prociency endorsement previously granted by the UK CAA may do so by: a) i) Assessment by any of the methods set out in Paragraph 4.1. (i.e. Level 6 assessment by an examiner during a radio test, skill test, prociency check, or assessment of competence; assessment to Level 4, 5 or 6 at a language school or at an ATO approved by the CAA for the purpose); or ii) Assessment at Level 6 only with the holder of UK CAA-issued Examiner Certicate in accordance with Appendix 2 to Part-FCL and the guidance published in the Guidance to Examiners conducting Language Assessments (i.e. a face-to-face aviation discussion not associated with a Skill test or prociency check). A UK Examiner Certicate is any holder of a valid RTF Examiner, FE, TRE, CRE, IRE, SFE or FIE certicate issued by the UK CAA. Examiners can only assess candidates as being Expert Level 6 in English. Where the assessment was conducted in association with a Skill Test, Prociency Check, Assessment of Competence or Flight Radio Practical Test then the Examiner will complete the appropriate Examiners Report conrming that the candidate has demonstrated prociency at Level 6. Examiners conducting an assessment of Language Prociency not in association with a Skill Test, Prociency Check, Assessment of Competence or Flight Radio Practical Test, in accordance with 5.1 a) ii) above, will complete Form SRG 1199, to conrm that the candidate has demonstrated prociency at Level 6. Where the examiner cannot be satised that the applicant is at Level 6 the examiner must not give a prociency endorsement. In such cases the alternative means of assessment of paragraph 4.1 c), d), or e) must be used.
30 January 2013
Part N
Medical Certicates
1 Applicability
1.1 Prior to 17 September 2012, in the UK a pilot could obtain: a JAR-FCL 3 Class 1 Medical Certicate; a JAR-FCL 3 Class 2 Medical Certicate; or a Medical Declaration (through his/her GP). For ATPLs and CPLs a Class 1 Medical Certicate was required. For a PPL(A) or PPL(H) a Class 2 (or Class 1) Medical Certicate was required. For the NPPL(Aeroplanes/SLMG/Microlight), PPL(Gyroplanes) and PPL(Balloons and Airships) a Medical Declaration (or Class 1 or Class 2 Medical Certicate) was required. 1.2 Under the Aircrew Regulation (effective from 17 September 2012) Part-MED applies for EASA (and JAR) licences. Part-MED makes provision for: a Part-MED Class 1 Medical Certicate; a Part-MED Class 2 Medical Certicate; and a Part-MED LAPL Medical Certicate. 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 For UK national aeroplane licences the NPPL Medical Declaration remains available. For ATPLs and CPLs a Class 1 Medical Certicate is required. For a PPL(A), PPL(H), SPL and BPL a Class 2 (or Class 1) Medical Certicate is required. For any LAPL, an LAPL Medical Certicate (or Class 1 or Class 2 Medical Certicate) is required. For the UK NPPL(Aeroplanes/SLMG/Microlight), PPL(Gyroplanes) PPL(Balloons and Airships) and a restricted CPL(Balloons) a UK Medical Declaration is required; a PartMED LAPL, Class 1 or Class 2 Medical Certicate is acceptable. The UK Medical Declaration is not acceptable to support an EASA LAPL in place of an LAPL Medical Certicate. The UK Medical Declaration is not acceptable to support a UK NPPL(H) A mutually recognised JAR-FCL 3 compliant Medical Certicate issued before 17 September 2012 is deemed to be an EASA Medical Certicate with effect from 8April 2012 or on its date of issue, whichever is later. On revalidation/renewal a PartMED certicate will be issued.
2 Privileges
In order to exercise the privileges of any licence, a pilot must hold a valid medical certicate for the licence held.
27 July 2012
3 Requirements
3.1 UK Medical Declaration The minimum medical requirement for a National Private Pilot Licence (NPPL), except the NPPL(H), is a declaration of medical tness by the pilot, countersigned by their general practitioner (GP). The GP must be licensed to practise in the United Kingdom. The UK Medical Declaration is an acceptable level of medical tness for the holder ofa: UK NPPL(Aeroplanes) (SSEA, SLMG or Microlight) but not the NPPL(H); UK PPL(Gyroplanes); UK PPL(Microlight Aeroplanes); UK PPL(Balloons and Airships); or a UK CPL(Balloons) that is restricted to Aerial Work. NOTE: The UK Medical Declaration may be used with PPL(A) issued by the CAA in specic circumstances under the terms of a general exemption. See Information Notice IN 2012/100. The GP must have reviewed the applicants medical records in order to countersign the Medical Declaration. If you have no GP or your GP will not provide a countersignature (there is no NHS contractual obligation to do so), a Part-MED Medical Certicate is required. 3.1.1 The Process A pilot seeking to obtain an NPPL Medical Declaration should download and print off the Medical Declaration form and associated documents (Notes for the Pilot, Notes for the GP and Guidance on Medical Conditions for a Medical Declaration1) and take them to his/her GP. The GP will be able to seek further advice from an Aviation Organisation Medical Adviser if required. Details of how a GP may contact a Medical Adviser are given in the Notes for the GP. The validity period of the Medical Declaration is dependent on age. The periods of validity are stated in the Notes for the GP and the Medical Declaration Form. The minimum age for GP countersignature is 6 months prior to your 16th birthday. A pilot may not y as pilot in command without a valid Medical Declaration or Certicate. A student pilot may not y solo until they have obtained a valid Medical Declaration or Certicate. The Medical Declaration (or a copy) must be sent to the relevant Aviation Organisation for your type of ying (see below) when requested e.g. for licence issue. The GP should retain a copy in the pilots medical record. The pilot must retain the original. 3.1.2 The Standards The medical standards are based on the DVLA driving medical standards. If there is nothing in a pilots medical history which would stop him reaching a DVLA Group 2 standard for professional driving, he can obtain a National PPL without any medical limitations. If the pilot has a past history of a signicant medical condition but meets the Group 1 standard for private driving, he will only be permitted to y either solo or with another safety pilot qualied on the aircraft type. A pilot acting as a safety pilot must be appropriately briefed. Other limitations may be imposed on individual pilots depending on the advice received from a Medical Adviser. The GPs countersignature is to conrm the lack of any medical history which would preclude the pilot from meeting the appropriate DVLA standard. The GP is entitled to charge for this service.
27 July 2012
3.1.3
Decrease in Medical Fitness There is a requirement to revalidate a Medical Declaration at periodic intervals as stated on the medical declaration form. However, if a pilot ever has any doubt about his tness to y, it is his responsibility to refrain from ying and discuss the situation with his GP. Pilots should advise any doctor they consult that they are a pilot and discuss their tness to y with their GPs whenever: their medical condition changes; additional investigations are required; or if they start, stop or change any medication or treatment.
3.1.4
Medical Enquiries General medical enquiries should be directed to the most appropriate organisation for your particular ying (not the CAA or the DVLA). Contact details are as follows: Simple Single Engine Aircraft (SSEA), Self-Launching Motor Gliders and CAA Exemption ORS4 865 (or latest version) National Pilot Licensing Group (NPLG) Ltd Turweston Aerodrome Nr. Brackley Northamptonshire NN13 5YD Telephone: 01280 846786 Website: www.nationalprivatepilotslicence.co.uk or www.nppl.uk.com Microlight Aircraft British Microlight Aircraft Association (BMAA) The Bullring Deddington Banbury Oxfordshire OX15 0TT Telephone: 01869 338888 Website: www.bmaa.org Balloons and Airships British Balloon and Airship Club BBAC Information Ofcer c/o Cameron Balloons Ltd St John Street BEDMINSTER Bristol BS3 4NH Telephone: 0117 9637216 Email: information@bbac.org Website: www.bbac.org Gyroplanes British Rotorcraft Association Email: gyro@ex.co.uk Website: www.gyroight.co.uk
3.1.5
Further information about the NPPL For further information about the NPPL please see the NPPL website: www.nppl.uk.com or www.nationalprivatepilotslicence.co.uk
27 July 2012
3.2
EASA Part-MED Medical Certicates An applicant for an EASA Medical certicate shall comply with the following Part-MED requirements (where the text has been edited for clarity; refer to Part-MED for full text version): The following requirements are the most relevant text relating to Aircrew set out in Part-MED. For the full text refer to Part-MED. In case of doubt, the text of Part-MED published as Annex IV to the EASA Aircrew Regulation applies. An AeMC is an Aeromedical Centre. MED.A.020 Decrease in medical tness
(a) Licence holders shall not exercise the privileges of their licence and related ratings or certicates at any time when they: (1) are aware of any decrease in their medical tness which might render them unable to safely exercise those privileges; (2) take or use any prescribed or non-prescribed medication which is likely to interfere with the safe exercise of the privileges of the applicable licence; (3) receive any medical, surgical or other treatment that is likely to interfere with ight safety. (b) In addition, licence holders shall, without undue delay, seek aero-medical advice when they: (1) have undergone a surgical operation or invasive procedure; (2) have commenced the regular use of any medication; (3) have suffered any signicant personal injury involving incapacity to function as a member of the ight crew; (4) have been suffering from any signicant illness involving incapacity to function as a member of the ight crew; (5) are pregnant; (6) have been admitted to hospital or medical clinic; (7) rst require correcting lenses. (c) In these cases: (1) holders of class 1 and class 2 medical certicates shall seek the advice of an AeMC or AME. The AeMC or AME shall assess the medical tness of the licence holder and decide whether they are t to resume the exercise of their privileges; (2) holders of LAPL medical certicates shall seek the advice of an AeMC or AME, or the GMP who signed the medical certicate. The AeMC, AME or GMP shall assess the medical tness of the licence holders and decide whether they are t to resume the exercise of their privileges. MED.A.030 Medical certicates (a) A student pilot shall not y solo unless that student pilot holds a medical certicate, as required for the relevant licence. (b) Applicants for and holders of a light aircraft pilot licence (LAPL) shall hold at least an LAPL medical certicate. (c) Applicants for and holders of a private pilot licence (PPL), a sailplane pilot licence (SPL), or a balloon pilot licence (BPL) shall hold at least a class 2 medical certicate.
27 July 2012
(d) Applicants for and holders of an SPL or a BPL involved in commercial sailplane or balloon ights shall hold at least a class 2 medical certicate. (e) If a night rating is added to a PPL or LAPL, the licence holder shall be colour safe. (f) Applicants for and holders of a commercial pilot licence (CPL), a multi-crew pilot licence (MPL), or an airline transport pilot licence (ATPL) shall hold a class 1 medical certicate. (g) If an instrument rating is added to a PPL, the licence holder shall undertake pure tone audiometry examinations in accordance with the periodicity and the standard required for class 1 medical certicate holders. (h) A licence holder shall not at any time hold more than one medical certicate issued in accordance with this Part. MED.A.035 Application for a medical certicate (a) Applications for a medical certicate shall be made in a format established by the competent authority. (b) Applicants for a medical certicate shall provide the AeMC, AME or GMP as applicable, with: (1) proof of their identity; (2) a signed declaration: (i) of medical facts concerning their medical history; (ii) as to whether they have previously undergone an examination for a medical certicate and, if so, by whom and with what result; (iii) as to whether they have ever been assessed as unt or had a medical certicate suspended or revoked. (c) When applying for a revalidation or renewal of the medical certicate, applicants shall present it to the AeMC, AME or GMP prior to the relevant examinations. MED.A.040 Issue, revalidation and renewal of medical certicates (a) A medical certicate shall only be issued, revalidated or renewed once the required medical examinations have been completed and a t assessment is made. (b) Initial issue (1) Class 1 medical certicates shall be issued by an AeMC. (2) Class 2 medical certicates shall be issued by an AeMC or an AME. (3) LAPL medical certicates shall be issued by an AeMC, an AME or, if permitted under the national law of the licensing authority, by a GMP. (c) Revalidation and renewal (1) Class 1 and class 2 medical certicates shall be revalidated or renewed by an AeMC or an AME. (2) LAPL medical certicates shall be revalidated or renewed by an AeMC, an AME or, if permitted under the national law of the licensing authority, by a GMP. (d) The AeMC, AME or GMP shall only issue, revalidate or renew a medical certicate if: (1) the applicant has provided them with a complete medical history and, if required by the AeMC, AME or GMP, results of medical examinations and tests conducted by the applicants doctor or any medical specialists;
27 July 2012
(2) they have conducted the aero-medical assessment based on the medical examinations and tests as required for the relevant medical certicate to verify that the applicant complies with all the relevant requirements of this Part. (3) The AME, AeMC or, in the case of referral, the licensing authority may require the applicant to undergo additional medical examinations and investigations when clinically indicated. (e) The licensing authority may issue or re-issue a medical certicate, as applicable, if: (1) a case is referred; (2) it has identied that corrections to the information on the certicate are necessary. MED.A.045 Validity, revalidation and renewal of medical certicates (a) Validity (1) Class 1 medical certicates shall be valid for a period of 12 months. (2) The period of validity of class 1 medical certicates shall be reduced to 6 months for licence holders who: (i) are engaged in single-pilot commercial air transport operations carrying passengers and have reached the age of 40; (ii) have reached the age of 60. (3) Class 2 medical certicates shall be valid for a period of: (i) 60 months until the licence holder reaches the age of 40. A medical certicate issued prior to reaching the age of 40 shall cease to be valid after the licence holder reaches the age of 42; (ii) 24 months between the age of 40 and 50. A medical certicate issued prior to reaching the age of 50 shall cease to be valid after the licence holder reaches the age of 51; and (iii) 12 months after the age of 50. (4) LAPL medical certicates shall be valid for a period of: (i) 60 months until the licence holder reaches the age of 40. A medical certicate issued prior to reaching the age of 40 shall cease to be valid after the licence holder reaches the age of 42; (ii) 24 months after the age of 40. (5) The validity period of a medical certicate, including any associated examination or special investigation, shall be: (i) determined by the age of the applicant at the date when the medical examination takes place; and (ii) calculated from the date of the medical examination in the case of initial issue and renewal, and from the expiry date of the previous medical certicate in the case of revalidation. (b) Revalidation Examinations for the revalidation of a medical certicate may be undertaken up to 45 days prior to the expiry date of the medical certicate. (c) Renewal (1) If the holder of a medical certicate does not comply with (b), a renewal examination shall be required.
27 July 2012
(2) In the case of class 1 and class 2 medical certicates: (i) if the medical certicate has expired for more than 2 years, the AeMC or AME shall only conduct the renewal examination after assessment of the aero-medical records of the applicant; (ii) if the medical certicate has expired for more than 5 years, the examination requirements for initial issue shall apply and the assessment shall be based on the revalidation requirements. (3) In the case of LAPL medical certicates, the AeMC, AME or GMP shall assess the medical history of the applicant and perform the aero-medical examination in accordance with MED.B.095. MED.A.050 Referral (a) If an applicant for a class 1 or class 2 medical certicate is referred to the licensing authority in accordance with MED.B.001, the AeMC or AME shall transfer the relevant medical documentation to the licensing authority. (b) If an applicant for an LAPL medical certicate is referred to an AME or AeMC in accordance with MED.B.001, the GMP shall transfer the relevant medical documentation to the AeMC or AME. MED.B.001 Limitations to medical certicates (a) Limitations to class 1 and class 2 medical certicates (1) If the applicant does not fully comply with the requirements for the relevant class of medical certicate but is considered to be not likely to jeopardise ight safety, the AeMC or AME shall: (i) in the case of applicants for a class 1 medical certicate, refer the decision on tness of the applicant to the licensing authority as indicated in SubpartB; (ii) in cases where a referral to the licensing authority is not indicated in Subpart B, evaluate whether the applicant is able to perform his/her duties safely when complying with one or more limitations endorsed on the medical certicate, and issue the medical certicate with limitation(s) as necessary; (iii) in the case of applicants for a class 2 medical certicate, evaluate whether the applicant is able to perform his/her duties safely when complying with one or more limitations endorsed on the medical certicate, and issue the medical certicate with limitation(s) as necessary in consultation with the licensing authority; (iv) The AeMC or AME may revalidate or renew a medical certicate with the same limitation without referring the applicant to the licensing authority. (b) Limitations to LAPL medical certicates: (1) If a GMP, after due consideration of the applicants medical history, concludes that the applicant does not fully meet the requirements for medical tness, the GMP shall refer the applicant to an AeMC or AME, except those requiring a limitation related only to the use of corrective lenses.
27 July 2012
(2) If an applicant for an LAPL medical certicate has been referred, the AeMC or AME shall give due consideration to MED.B.095, evaluate whether the applicant is able to perform their duties safely when complying with one or more limitations endorsed on the medical certicate and issue the medical certicate with limitation(s) as necessary. The AeMC or AME shall always consider the need to restrict the pilot from carrying passengers (OPL). (3) The GMP may revalidate or renew an LAPL medical certicate with the same limitation without referring the applicant to an AeMC or AME. (c) When assessing whether a limitation is necessary, particular consideration shall be given to: (1) whether accredited medical conclusion indicates that in special circumstances the applicants failure to meet any requirement, whether numerical or otherwise, is such that exercise of the privileges of the licence applied for is not likely to jeopardise ight safety; (2) the applicants ability, skill and experience relevant to the operation to be performed. (d) Operational limitation codes (1) Operational multi-pilot limitation (OML Class 1 only) (i) When the holder of a CPL, ATPL or MPL does not fully meet the requirements for a class 1 medical certicate and has been referred to the licensing authority, it shall assess whether the medical certicate may be issued with an OML valid only as or with qualied co-pilot. (ii) The holder of a medical certicate with an OML shall only operate an aircraft in multi-pilot operations when the other pilot is fully qualied on the relevant type of aircraft, is not subject to an OML and has not attained the age of 60 years. (iii) The OML for class 1 medical certicates shall only be imposed and removed by the licensing authority. (2) Operational Safety Pilot Limitation (OSL Class 2, LAPL only) (i) The holder of a medical certicate with an OSL limitation shall only operate an aircraft if another pilot fully qualied to act as pilot-in-command on the relevant class or type of aircraft is carried on board, the aircraft is tted with dual controls and the other pilot occupies a seat at the controls. (ii) The OSL for class 2 medical certicates may be imposed or removed by an AeMC or AME in consultation with the licensing authority only. (3) Operational Passenger Limitation (OPL Class 2 and LAPL only) (i) The holder of a medical certicate with an OPL limitation shall only operate an aircraft without passengers on board. Any other limitation may be imposed on the holder of a medical certicate if (e) required to ensure ight safety. (f) Any limitation imposed on the holder of a medical certicate shall be specied therein.
27 July 2012
MED.B.005 General (a) Applicants for a medical certicate shall be free from any: (1) abnormality, congenital or acquired; (2) active, latent, acute or chronic disease or disability; (3) wound, injury or sequelae from operation; (4) effect or side effect of any prescribed or non-prescribed therapeutic, diagnostic or preventive medication taken; that would entail a degree of functional incapacity which is likely to interfere with the safe exercise of the privileges of the applicable licence or could render the applicant likely to become suddenly unable to exercise the privileges of the licence safely. MED.B.095 Medical examination of applicants for LAPL medical certicates (a) An applicant for an LAPL medical certicate shall be assessed based on aeromedical best practice. (b) Special attention shall be given to the applicants complete medical history. (c) The aero-medical examination shall include at least the following: (1) clinical examination; (2) blood pressure; (3) urine test; (4) vision; (5) hearing ability. (d) After the rst issue of an LAPL medical certicate, the aero-medical examinations until the age of 50 can be reduced with due regard to the evaluation of the applicants medical history.
4.1
Guidance Material for MED.B.001(d)(2) OSL Circumstances may arise where an ab-initio student has a medical condition that may require applying the OSL to their medical certicate, but the assessment cannot be denitive until they have received sufcient ying training to demonstrate their ying ability to an examiner. In such cases the CAA may decide to apply the OSL so that the student cannot y solo pending further assessment. The student will be advised that when they are rst ready to go solo they must arrange with the CAA to have a medical ight test with a nominated Flight Instructor Examiner or CAA Staff Examiner. If the student passes the test the OSL may be removed or amended so that they may continue with their training, including solo ight. However, if the determination is that the OSL must remain in place, the student will not be able to y solo and so will not be able to obtain a licence.
27 July 2012
Additional Information
FLIGHT INSTRUCTION AND SKILL TESTING IN AEROPLANES/HELICOPTERS LIMITATIONS FOR HOLDERS OF CLASS 1 MEDICAL CERTIFICATE WITH OPERATIONAL MULTI-CREW LIMITATION (OML)
5.1 5.1.1
Aeroplanes Instructing/Examining A xed-wing instructor or examiner who is subject to an OML and, for the purposes of instructing or examining is using a licence with the relevant privileges that requires a Class 1 Medical Certicate, may only give instruction or conduct skill tests in aircraft tted with dual controls and under circumstances where the student is competent to act as pilot-in-command should the instructor or examiner suffer incapacitation, taking full account of the conditions under which the instruction or skill test is being carriedout. Generally, a student will be considered to be competent to act as pilot-in-command if he: a) holds a current licence (UK or non-UK) which would entitle him to act as pilot-incommand of the aircraft if the ight were a private ight; or b) was, within the period of six months immediately preceding the ight, serving as a qualied pilot of an aeroplane in any of the naval, military or air forces of Her Majesty or of a foreign state, and holds a current medical certicate appropriate to the intended licence or rating; or c) was, within the period of six months immediately preceding the ight, employed as a pilot by an airline operating aeroplanes registered in a Contracting State other than the United Kingdom, and holds a current medical certicate appropriate to the intended licence or rating; or d) is undergoing an integrated course for the CPL(A) or CPL(A)/IR, approved by the CAA and has: i) completed Phase 2 of the integrated course for single-engine piston ying, or ii) completed the training and class/type rating skill test for multi-engine aeroplanes. Tables 1 and 2 show a matrix of the activities permissible.
27 July 2012
Table 1
Flight instruction allowable by Aeroplane Instructors with a Class 1 medical certicate with OML
Flight Instructor (FI) Class Rating Instructor (CRI) Type Rating Instructor (TRI) Instrument Rating Instructor (IRI)
Ab-initio PPL instruction before rst solo cross-country Ab-initio PPL instruction post rst solo cross-country CPL instruction (Integrated course) single-engine (before completion of Phase 2); multi-engine (before LST pass) CPL instruction (Integrated course single-engine (post completion of Phase 2); multi-engine (post LST pass) CPL instruction (Modular course non-current ICAO PPL holders) CPL instruction (Modular course current ICAO PPL holders) Instruction for issue of additional single-pilot type/class ratings Instruction for renewal of singlepilot type/class ratings Instruction for revalidation of SEP or TMG class ratings Differences training Instruction for issue of a Night Qualication Instruction to regain night ying currency for carriage of passengers Instruction for issue and renewal of an IMC rating
Yes Yes
No
Yes
No Yes (in VMC only) No No Yes Yes No Yes Yes (in VMC only) Yes (in VMC only) Yes (in VMC only)* No No Yes Yes No No
Instruction for issue and renewal of Yes an IR (in VMC only)* Instruction for issue of a multi-pilot type rating (including ZFTT) Instruction for renewal of multipilot type rating
*Except where the student holds a current and valid IMC rating or a valid non-JAA UK CPL(A), when instruction may be given in airspace and meteorological conditions appropriate to the privileges of an IMC rating.
15 October 2013
Table 2
Flight instruction allowable by Aeroplane Examiners with a Class 1 medical certicate with OML Flight Examiner (PPL) Flight Examiner (CPL) Class Rating Examiner (CRE) Type Rating Examiner (TRE) Flight Instructor Examiner (FIE) Yes (in VMC only)
Yes Yes (in VMC only) (in VMC only) Yes (in VMC only) Yes Yes (in VMC only) (in VMC only) Yes Yes Yes (in VMC only) (CRE(IRR) only) Yes (in VMC only) (CRE(IRR) only) Yes (in VMC only) (CRE(IRR) only) Yes (in VMC only) (CRE(IRR) only) No No No
IR Renewal (SPA (under 5 years) Skill Test (LST) for issue of an additional single-pilot type or class rating Prociency Check (LPC) for revalidation of a single-pilot type or class rating Skill Test (LST) or Prociency Check (LPC) (as appropriate) for renewal of a single-pilot type or class rating Skill Test (LST) for issue of a multi-pilot type rating Prociency Check (LPC) for revalidation of a multi-pilot type rating Prociency Check (LPC for renewal of a multi-pilot type rating
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
No
No Yes
No
15 October 2013
5.2 5.2.1
Helicopters Instructing/Examining A helicopter instructor or examiner who is subject to an OML and, for the purposes of instructing or examining is using a licence with the relevant privileges that requires a Class 1 Medical Certicate, may only give instruction or conduct skill tests in aircraft tted with dual controls and under circumstances where the student is competent to act as pilot-in-command should the instructor or examiner suffer incapacitation, taking full account of the conditions under which the instruction or skill test is being carried out. Generally, a student will be considered to be competent to act as pilot-in-command if he: a) holds a current licence (UK or non-UK) which would entitle him to act as pilot-incommand of the aircraft if the ight were a private ight; or b) was, within the period of six months immediately preceding the ight, serving as a qualied pilot of a helicopter in any of the naval, military or air forces of Her Majesty or of a foreign state, and holds a current medical certicate appropriate to the intended licence or rating; or c) was, within the period of six months immediately preceding the ight, employed as a pilot by an airline operating helicopters registered in a Contracting State other than the United Kingdom, and holds a current medical certicate appropriate to the intended licence or rating; or d) is undergoing an integrated course for the CPL(H) or CPL(H)IR, approved by the CAA and has completed Phase 1 of the integrated course. Tables 3 and 4 show a matrix of the activities permissible.
27 July 2012
Table 3
Flight instruction allowable by Helicopter Instructors with a Class 1 medical certicate with OML
Flight Instructor (FI) Type Rating Instructor (TRI) Instrument Rating Instructor (IRI)
Ab-initio PPL instruction before rst solo cross-country Ab-initio PPL instruction post rst solo cross-country CPL instruction (Integrated course) (before completion of Phase 1) CPL instruction (Integrated course) (post completion of Phase 1) CPL instruction (Modular course) - noncurrent or non-type rated ICAO PPL holders CPL instruction (Modular course) current, type rated ICAO PPL holders Instruction for issue of additional singlepilot type ratings Instruction for renewal of single-pilot type ratings Differences training Instruction for issue of a Night Qualication Instruction to regain night ying currency for carriage of passengers Instruction for issue & renewal of an IR rating Instruction for issue of a multi-pilot type rating Instruction for renewal of multi-pilot type rating
Yes Yes No Yes No Yes (in VMC only) No No Yes No Yes Yes (in VMC only) No No Yes (in VMC only) No No Yes
15 October 2013
Table 4
Flight instruction allowable by Helicopter Examiners with a Class 1 medical certicate with OML
Flight Examiner (PPL) Flight Examiner (CPL) Yes (in VMC only) Yes (in VMC only) Yes (TRE(IRR) only) Yes (in VMC only) (TRE(IRR) only) No No No No Type Rating Examiner (TRE) Flight Instructor Examiner (FIE) Yes (in VMC only)
PPL(H) Skill Test CPL(H) Skill Test IR Revalidation (SPH) IR Renewal (SPH) (under 5 years)
Skill Test (LST) for issue of an additional single-pilot type rating Prociency Check (LPC) for revalidation of a single-pilot type rating Skill Test (LST) or Prociency Check (LPC) (as appropriate) for renewal of a single-pilot type rating Skill Test (LST) for issue of a multi-pilot type rating Prociency Check (LPC) for revalidation of a multi-pilot type rating Prociency Check (LPC) for renewal of a multi-pilot type rating Skill Test or Prociency Check for issue, revalidation or renewal of a FI rating non current or non-type rated candidates Skill Test or Prociency Check for issue, revalidation or renewal of a FI rating current, type rated candidates
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
No
No
Yes
No
No
Yes
May 2012
Part O
This Part sets out the credits for Part-FCL licences available to UK military pilots. These are established in a Credit Report prepared by 22 (Training) Group, RAF, in consultation with the CAA, and submitted to the European Aviation Safety Agency in accordance with the requirements of Article 10 of Commission Regulation (EU) No 1178/2011 as amended. Article 10 states: Article 10 Credit for pilot licences obtained during military service In order for holders of military ight crew licences to obtain Part-FCL licences, they shall apply to the Member State where they served. The knowledge, experience and skill gained in military service shall be given credit for the purposes of the relevant requirements of Annex I in accordance with the elements of a credit report established by the Member State in consultation with the Agency. The credit report shall: (a) describe the national requirements on the basis of which the military licences, ratings, certicates, authorisations and/or qualications were issued; (b) describe the scope of the privileges that were given to the pilots; (c) indicate for which requirements of Annex I credit is to be given; (d) indicate any limitations that need to be included on the Part-FCL licences and indicate any requirements pilots have to comply with to remove those limitations; (e) include copies of all documents necessary to demonstrate the elements above, accompanied by copies of the relevant national requirements and procedures.
1 Applicability
The Military Accreditation Scheme (MAS) sets out the credits for UK Military Flight Crews for the purpose of obtaining Part-FCL licences and ratings. The MAS does not make provision for maintaining a Part-FCL licence/rating on the basis of military service or military testing. Part-FCL licences/ratings or certicates may only be maintained by satisfying the Part-FCL revalidation/renewal requirements set out in Section 4 for the licence/rating or certicate, as applicable. Applicants seeking to take advantage of these arrangements must comply with the requirements as they are specied in this part. Applications based upon combining partial compliance with the requirements for alternative routes will not be accepted. Credits have been established for United Kingdom Armed Forces (UKAF) military qualications explicitly referenced in this Part only. No other credits are available. The CAA will not assess the eligibility of individual military applicants or grant credits outside the scope of those set out in this Part. Individual service personnel requiring advice on the civil requirements to be met taking account of military credit should seek the advice of the ATO where they intend to do their training/testing.
30 January 2013
Questions regarding the derivation of the accreditation scheme or suggestions for generic enhancements should be directed in writing to: FT FJ SO1, Directorate of Flying Training, Building 1300, MoD Abbey Wood, BRISTOL, BS34 8JH or by e-mail to 22TrgGp-FTFJSO1@mod.uk. Terminology a) The scheme for military credits is termed the Military Accreditation Scheme (MAS). b) Service and ex-Service personnel of the UK Armed Forces (UKAF) who have graduated from the Elementary Flying Training (EFT) Course element of UKAF aeroplane training are termed EFT Graduates (EFTGs). c) Service and ex-Service personnel of the UKAF who have successfully passed the Single Engine Rotary Training Course element of UKAF helicopter training are termed Single Engine Rotary Pilots (SERPs). d) Service and ex-Service personnel of the UKAF who have been awarded a UKAF pilots ying badge (wings) on aeroplanes are termed Qualied Military Pilots (Aeroplanes) (QMP(A)s). e) Service and ex-Service personnel in the UKAF who have been awarded a UKAF pilots ying badge (wings) on helicopters are termed Qualied Military Pilots (Helicopters) (QMP(H)s). f) QMP(A)s who have been awarded an instructor category (or who have been assessed as Competent to Instruct) as a QFI or QPI on aeroplanes are termed QFIs. g) QMP(H)s who have been awarded an instructor category (or who have been assessed as Competent to Instruct) as a QHI on helicopters are termed QHIs. h) BFJT Basic Fast Jet Training (pilot training course) i) MEPT Multi Engine Pilot Training (pilot training course) j) SERP Single Engine Rotary Pilot (pilot training course) k) SERW Single Engine Rotary Wing (pilot training course) l) SLIC 60 Sqn Lead In Course (pilot training course) m) MERW Multi Engine Rotary Wing (pilot training course)
2 Privileges
N/A
3 Requirements
Applicants who qualify for credits under the terms of the MAS may apply for the theoretical knowledge examination and skill test for a licence as specied in this Part; or for a licence with lower privileges if the applicable requirements are met. Flight hours in military aircraft as logged in UKAF military logbooks are recognised and accepted toward meeting the licence, class and type rating experience prerequisites of Part-FCL licences, ratings or certicates as appropriate. Military Pilots qualied as an EFTG, SERP or QMP in this Part shall be credited the RTF Practical Test. Credit for theoretical knowledge examinations is included in Section 6.
15 October 2013
3.1
Credits available for EFTGs and QMP(A)s for an LAPL(A) or PPL(A) EFTGs or QMP(A)s shall meet all of the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL LAPL(A) or PPL(A) for aeroplanes, as applicable. Refer to: Section 4, Part B, Subpart 1 for the full LAPL (A) requirements, or Section 4, Part C, Subpart 1 for the full PPL (A) requirements. EFTG or QMP(A)s applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the PartFCL requirements. Theoretical Knowledge Credits EFTGs or QMP(A)s are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.115 or FCL.210, as applicable, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examinations for the LAPL(A) (FCL.120) or PPL(A) (FCL.215), as applicable. Flying Experience Credits EFTGs or QMP(A)s with a minimum of 10 hours logged as PIC/P1 Capt or PICUS/1st Pilot Non-Capt are given full credit as regards the requirement to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the skill test for the issue of an LAPL(A) or a PPL(A), as appropriate. Applicants for the issue of a Part-FCL licence shall have fullled the experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of a class rating as set out in Part FCL Subpart H (or experience for endorsement on an LAPL(A)) for the aeroplane used for the test. The skill test will be conducted by the holder of a Flight Examiner Certicate issued in accordance with Part-FCL, in: an appropriate single pilot single-engine class military aeroplane, suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent class, or an appropriate single pilot single-engine class civilian aeroplane following training to the satisfaction of the Head of Training at an ATO.
3.2
Credits available for QMP(A)s for a CPL(A) QMP(A)s shall meet all of the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL CPL(A) for aeroplanes. Refer to: Section 4, Part D, Subpart 1 for the full CPL(A) requirements. QMP(A) applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements for a CPL(A). Theoretical Knowledge Credits QMP(A)s are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.315 and Appendix 3, paragraphs A-E, as applicable, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examinations for the ATPL(A) or CPL(A) , as applicable. An applicant who passes the examinations at ATPL(A) level is reminded that the calendar validity periods for examinations set out in Part-FCL apply. Unless an IR(A) or ATPL(A) is gained within the calendar validity of the pass result, the theoretical knowledge examinations must be passed again to qualify for the IR(A) or ATPL(A).
30 January 2013
Flying Experience Credits QMP(A)s with a minimum of 70 hours logged as PIC/P1 Capt or PICUS/1st Pilot NonCapt are given full credit as regards the requirement to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the skill test for the issue of a CPL(A). BFJT (or legacy course) graduates shall take that skill test in a single pilot singleengine aeroplane. FJ OCU graduates may take that skill test in a single pilot single engine aeroplane, or alternatively on a multi-engine aeroplane provided that they complete an MEP training course at an ATO prior to the CPL Skill test. MEPT (or legacy course) graduates may take that skill test in a single engine or single pilot multi-engine aeroplane. Applicants for the issue of a Part-FCL licence shall have fullled the experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of a class or type rating as set out in PartFCL Subpart H for the aeroplane to be used for the test. The aeroplane used for the skill test shall meet the requirements for training aeroplanes and shall be certicated for the carriage of at least four persons, have a variable pitch propeller and retractable landing gear. The skill test will be conducted by the holder of a Flight Examiner Certicate issued in accordance with Part-FCL, in: an appropriate class or type of military aeroplane on which the applicant is or has been qualied to operate as a QMP(A), suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent class or type, or an appropriate class of civilian aeroplane following training to the satisfaction of the Head of Training at an ATO, or an appropriate type of civilian aeroplane provided that the applicant has completed the Part-FCL requirements for inclusion of the rating for that type in a Part-FCL licence except the type rating skill test. 3.3 Credits available for QMP(A)s who hold or have held a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) for a CPL(A) with IR(A) QMP(A)s who hold or have held a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) shall meet all the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL CPL(A) and IR rating for aeroplanes. Refer to: Section 4, Part D, Subpart 1 for the full CPL(A) requirements, and Section 4, Part G, Subpart 1 for the full IR(A) requirements. QMP(A) applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements for aeroplanes. Theoretical Knowledge Credits QMP(A)s who hold or have held a military Unrestricted Green IR(aeroplane) are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.315 and Appendix 3, paragraphs A-C and FCL 615, as applicable, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examinations for the ATPL(A)or CPL(A) and IR(A), as applicable. An applicant who passes the examinations at IR(A) or ATPL(A) level is reminded that the calendar validity periods for examination passes set out in Part-FCL apply. Unless an IR(A) or ATPL(A) are gained within the calendar validity of the pass results, the theoretical knowledge examinations must be passed again to qualify for the IR(A) or ATPL(A).
15 October 2013 Section 4 Part O Page 4
Flying Experience Credits QMP(A)s with a minimum of 70 hours logged as PIC/P1 Capt or PICUS/1st Pilot NonCapt who hold or have held a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) are given full credit as regards the requirement to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the skill test for the issue of a CPL(A) and skill test for the IR(A). BFJT (or legacy course) graduates shall take the skill tests in a single pilot singleengine aeroplane. FJ OCU graduates may take that skill test in a single pilot single engine aeroplane, or alternatively on a multi-engine aeroplane provided that they complete an MEP training course at an ATO prior to the CPL Skill test and approved multi-engine IR(A) training at an ATO comprising at least 5 hours instruction in instrument ying in multi-engine aeroplanes, of which 3 hours may be in an FFS or FNPT II. MEPT (or legacy course) graduates may take the skill tests in a single engine or single pilot multi-engine aeroplane. Applicants for the issue of a Part-FCL licence or aircraft rating shall have fullled the experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of a class or type rating as set out in Part FCL Subpart H for the aeroplane used for the test. The aeroplane used for the CPL(A) skill test shall meet the requirements for training aeroplanes and shall be certicated for the carriage of at least four persons, have a variable pitch propeller and retractable landing gear. The skill test(s) will be conducted by the holder of a Flight Examiner Certicate issued in accordance with Part-FCL, in: an appropriate class or type of military aeroplane on which the applicant is or has been qualied to operate as a QMP, suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent class or type, or a civilian aeroplane of the appropriate class following training to the satisfaction of the Head of Training at an ATO, or an appropriate type of civilian aeroplane provided that the applicant has completed the Part-FCL requirements for inclusion of the rating for that type in a Part-FCL licence except the type rating skill test. 3.4 Credits available for a Qualied Military Pilot (Aeroplanes) (QMP(A)s) who holds or has held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) Qualied Military Pilots (Aeroplanes) (QMP(A)s) who hold or have held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) shall meet all the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL CPL(A) and/or IR rating for aeroplanes. QMP(A) applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements. Refer to; Section 4, Part D, Subpart 1 for the full CPL (A) requirements, and Section 4, Part G, Subpart 1 for the full IR (A) requirements Credits are available for Qualied Military Pilots (Aeroplanes) (QMP(A)s) who holds or has held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) towards the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL CPL(A) and/or IR rating for aeroplanes.
15 October 2013
Theoretical knowledge Credits: QMP(A)s are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL. 315 and Appendix 3, paragraphs A-C or Appendix6, paragraph A, as applicable, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examination for the ATPL(A), CPL(A)IR or IR(A) rating, as applicable. Flying Experience Credits: QMP(A)s with a minimum of 70 hours logged as PIC/P1 Capt or PICUS/1st Pilot NonCapt who hold or have held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) are given full credit as regards the requirement to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the skill tests for the issue of a CPL(A). A QMP who holds or has held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) shall complete additional training to the satisfaction of the Head of Training of an ATO prior to taking an IR(A) skill test for the addition of an IR(A) rating to a Part-FCL CPL(A). This additional training shall comprise the procedural instrument ying elements of the approved IR course. BFJT (or legacy course) graduates shall take the skill tests in a single pilot singleengine aeroplane, FJ OCU graduates may take that skill test in a single pilot single engine aeroplane, or alternatively on a multi-engine aeroplane provided that they complete an MEP training course at an ATO prior to the CPL Skill test, and for the addition of an IR, approved multi-engine IR(A) training at an ATO comprising at least 5 hours instruction in instrument ying in multi-engine aeroplanes, of which 3 hours may be in an FFS or FNPT II. MEPT (or legacy course) graduates may take the skill tests in a single engine or single pilot multi-engine aeroplane. The aeroplane used for the skill tests shall meet the requirements for training aeroplanes, and shall be certicated for the carriage of at least four persons, have a variable pitch propeller and retractable landing gear. Applicants for the issue of a Part-FCL licence or Rating shall have fullled the experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of a Class or Type rating as set out in Part FCL Subpart H for the aeroplane used for the test. The skill test(s) will be conducted by the holder of a Flight Examiner Certicate issued in accordance with Part-FCL, in, an appropriate class or type of military aeroplane, suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent class or type, or a civilian aeroplane of the appropriate class following training to the satisfaction of the Head of Training of an ATO, Or an appropriate type of civilian aeroplane provided the applicant has completed the Part-FCL requirements for inclusion of that type in a Part-FCL licence except the type rating skill test. 3.5 Credits available for QMP(A)s who hold or have held an Operational Category to operate military multi-pilot aircraft for an ATPL(A) QMP(A)s who hold or have held an Operational Category with a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) to operate military multi-pilot aeroplanes shall meet all the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL ATPL(A) for aeroplanes. Refer to: Section 4, Part F, Subpart 1 for the full ATPL(A) requirements.
15 October 2013 Section 4 Part O Page 6
QMP(A) applicants who hold or have held an operational category with a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating to operate military multi-pilot aeroplanes may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements. The following types are considered to be multi-pilot aeroplanes for this purpose: Andover BAe 125 C17 Jetstream T3 Tristar Voyager Theoretical Knowledge Credits QMP(A)s who hold or have held an Operational Category and Unrestricted Military Green IR (Aeroplanes) are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.515 and Appendix 3, paragraph B prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examinations for the ATPL(A). Flying Experience Credits QMP(A)s who hold or have held an Operational Category and Unrestricted Military Green IR (Aeroplanes) to operate military multi-pilot aeroplanes, and who have satised the experience requirements for the issue of an ATPL(A) in aeroplanes as set out in Subpart F of Annex 1 to the Regulation, are given full credit as regards the MCC and the requirement to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the skill test for the issue of an ATPL(A). Applicants for the issue of a Part-FCL licence shall have fullled the experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of an aeroplane type rating as set out in Part-FCL Subpart H for the aeroplane to be used for the test. The skill test will be conducted by the holder of a Type Rating Examiner (TRE) Certicate for the aeroplane type, issued under Part-FCL, in: an appropriate multi-pilot type of military aeroplane on which the applicant is or has been qualied to operate as a QMP, suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent; or an appropriate multi-pilot type of civilian aeroplane provided the applicant has completed the Part-FCL requirements for inclusion of that type with IR in a Part-FCL licence except the type rating skill test. 3.6 Credits available for QMP(A)s who hold or have held a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) for the inclusion of an IR(A) in a Part-FCL aeroplane licence; (the IR cannot be included in an LAPL(A)) QMP(A)s who hold or have held a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) shall meet all the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL IR(A) for aeroplanes. Refer to: Section 4, Part G, Subpart 1 for the full IR(A) requirements. QMP(A) applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements. BAC 1-11 BAe 146 Hercules (C1/C3 and C4/C5 variants) Nimrod VC10
Sentinel Sentry
30 January 2013
Theoretical Knowledge Credits QMP(A)s who hold or have held a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.615 and Appendix 6, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examination for the IR(A). Flying Experience Credits QMP(A)s with a minimum of 70 hours logged as PIC/P1 Capt or PICUS/1st Pilot NonCapt who hold or have held a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) are given full credit as regards the requirement to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the skill test for the issue the IR(A). BFJT (or legacy course) graduates shall take that skill test in a single pilot singleengine aeroplane. FJ OCU graduates may take that skill test in a single pilot single engine aeroplane, or alternatively on a multi-engine aeroplane provided that they complete an MEP training course at an ATO prior to the CPL Skill test and approved multi-engine IR(A) training at an ATO comprising at least 5 hours instruction in instrument ying in multi-engine aeroplanes, of which 3 hours may be in an FFS or FNPT II. MEPT (or legacy course) graduates may take that skill test in a single engine or single pilot multi-engine aeroplane. Applicants for the issue of the IR(A) shall have qualied for the inclusion in their PartFCL licence of the class or type of aeroplane used for the IR(A) skill test. The skill test will be conducted by the holder of an Instrument Rating Examiner Certicate issued under Part-FCL, in: an appropriate class or type of military aeroplane on which the applicant is or has been qualied to operate as a QMP, suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent class or type, or a civilian aeroplane of an appropriate class or type held on the Part-FCL licence following IR training to the satisfaction of the Head of Training at an ATO. 3.7 Credits available for QMP(A)s who hold or have held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) for the inclusion an IR(A) in a Part-FCL aeroplane licence; (the IR(A) cannot be included in an LAPL(A)) QMP(A)s who hold or have held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) shall meet all the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL IR(A) for aeroplanes. Refer to: Section 4, Part G, Subpart 1 for the full IR(A) requirements. QMP(A) applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements. Theoretical Knowledge Credits QMP(A)s who hold or have held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.615 and Appendix 6, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examination for the IR(A).
15 October 2013
Flying Training Credits A QMP who holds or has held only a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) shall complete additional training to the satisfaction of the Head of Training of an ATO prior to taking an IR(A) skill test for the addition of an IR(A) rating to a Part-FCL licence. This additional training shall comprise the procedural instrument ying elements of the approved IR course. BFJT (or legacy course) graduates shall take that skill test in a single pilot singleengine aeroplane. FJ OCU graduates may take that skill test in a single pilot single engine aeroplane, or alternatively on a multi-engine aeroplane provided that they complete an MEP training course at an ATO prior to the CPL Skill test and approved multi-engine IR(A) training at an ATO comprising at least 5 hours instruction in instrument ying in multi-engine aeroplanes, of which 3 hours may be in an FFS or FNPT II. MEPT (or legacy course) graduates may take that skill test in a single engine or single pilot multi-engine aeroplane. Applicants for the issue of the IR(A) shall have qualied for the inclusion in their PartFCL licence of the class or type of aeroplane used for the IR(A) test. The skill test(s) will be conducted by the holder of a Flight Examiner Certicate issued under Part-FCL, in: an appropriate class or type of military aeroplane on which the applicant is or has been qualied to operate as a QMP, suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent class or type, or a civilian aeroplane of an appropriate class or type held on the Part-FCL licence following IR training to the satisfaction of the Head of Training at an ATO. 3.8 Revalidation of Part-FCL Instrument Rating Credit QMP(A)s, once holding a Part-FCL IR(A), may use the revalidation/renewal of a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Aeroplane) to revalidate the Part-FCL IR(A) in the following circumstances. This applies where; the Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating has been revalidated in a class or type for which they hold a valid aeroplane rating in the Part-FCL licence, the prociency check was conducted by the holder of a Flight Examiner Certicate issued under Part-FCL, and the prociency check is conducted following the civilian IR test schedule set out in Appendix 9 to Part-FCL. 3.9 Credits available for QFIs for a Restricted FI(A) QFIs shall meet all the requirements for the addition of a Part-FCL FI certicate to a Part-FCL licence for aeroplanes. Refer to: Section 4, Part J, Subpart 1 for the full ight instructor certicate (FI(A)) requirements. QFI applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements if they: hold a Part-FCL licence (except an LAPL(A)) have been awarded an instructor category (or have been assessed as Competent to Instruct) as a QFI on single pilot aeroplanes,
15 October 2013
CPL Theoretical Knowledge Credits QFIs are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.315 and Appendix 3, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examinations for the CPL(A). Teaching and Learning Credits QFIs are credited with the 25 hour teaching and learning training course requirement, as set out in FCL.930 of the relevant instructor certicate, toward the issue of any PartFCL instructor certicate. FI Course Credits QFIs who are compliant with the prerequisite requirements for the application for a restricted FI(A) certicate are required to complete training at the discretion of the Head of Training at an ATO approved to conduct FI(A) courses. QFI applicants must pass an assessment of competence for the issue of a restricted FI(A) certicate on a class of single pilot single-engine aeroplane for which the QFI holds a valid class rating in their Part-FCL licence. QFI applicants for an FI(A) certicate who hold a night or aerobatic rating on their PartFCL licence may have the instruction privilege added to their ight instructor rating by: demonstrating the ability to instruct for that rating during the assessment of competence, or if unable to satisfy the above requirement at issue of the FI rating, meet the relevant requirements of Part-FCL. 3.10 Credits available for SERPs or QMP(H)s for an LAPL(H) or PPL(H). SERPs or QMP(H)s shall meet all the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL LAPL(H) or PPL(H) for helicopters, as applicable. Refer to: Section 4, Part B, Subpart 2 for the full LAPL (H) requirements, or Section 4, Part C, Subpart 2 for the full PPL (H) requirements. SERP or QMP(H) applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the PartFCL requirements. Theoretical Knowledge Credits SERPs or QMP(H)s are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.115 or FCL.210, as applicable, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examination for the LAPL(H) (FCL.120) or PPL(H) (FCL.215), as applicable. Flying Experience Credits SERPs or QMP(H)s with a minimum of 10 hours logged as PIC/P1 Capt or PICUS/1st Pilot Non-Capt are given full credit as regards the requirement to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the skill test for the issue of an LAPL(H) or a PPL(H), as appropriate. Applicants for the issue of a Part-FCL licence shall have fullled the experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of a type rating as set out in Part FCL Subpart H (or experience for endorsement on an LAPL(H)) for the helicopter used for the test. The skill test will be conducted by the holder of a Flight Examiner Certicate issued under Part-FCL, in:
30 January 2013
a single pilot single-engine type of military helicopter on which the graduate completed the Single Engine Rotary Training Course, suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent type; or an appropriate single pilot single-engine type of civilian helicopter for which the applicant has completed the Part-FCL requirements for inclusion of that type in a Part-FCL licence, except the type rating skill test. 3.11 Credits available for QMP(H)s for a CPL(H) QMP(H)s shall meet all the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL CPL(H) for helicopters. Refer to: Section 4, Part D, Subpart 2 for the full CPL (H) requirements. QMP(H) applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements. Theoretical Knowledge Credits QMP(H)s are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.315 and Appendix 3, paragraphs F-K, as applicable, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examination for the ATPL(H) with IR, ATPL(H) without IR, or CPL(H), as applicable. An applicant who passes the examination at or ATPL(H) without or with IR level is reminded that the calendar validity periods set out in Part-FCL apply. Unless an ATPL(H) is gained within the validity of the pass result, theoretical knowledge examinations must be passed again to qualify for the ATPL(H). An applicant who passes the examination at ATPL(H) with IR level is reminded that the calendar validity periods set out in Part-FCL apply. Unless an IR(H) is gained within the validity of the pass result, theoretical knowledge examinations must be passed again to qualify for the IR(H). Flying Experience Credits QMP(H)s with a minimum of 70 hours logged as PIC/P1 Capt or PICUS/1st Pilot NonCapt are given full credit as regards the requirement to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the skill test for the issue of a CPL(H). Applicants for the issue of a Part-FCL licence shall have fullled the experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of a type rating as set out in Part FCL Subpart H for the helicopter used for the skill test. The helicopter used for the skill test shall meet the requirements for training helicopters. A QMP(H) who has not graduated from all SERW, SLIC and MERW (or legacy) courses, or who does not hold (or has not held) an operational category to operate military multi-engine helicopters, shall take that skill test in a single pilot singleengine helicopter. A QMP(H) who has graduated from all SERW, SLIC and MERW (or legacy) courses, or holds (or has held) an operational category to operate military multi-engine helicopters, may take that skill test in a single pilot multi-engine helicopter. The skill test will be conducted by the holder of a Flight Examiner Certicate issued under Part-FCL, in:
30 January 2013
an appropriate type of military helicopter on which the applicant is or has been qualied to operate as a QMP, suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent type, or an appropriate type of civilian helicopter provided the applicant has completed the Part-FCL requirements for inclusion of that type in a Part-FCL licence except the type rating skill test. 3.12 Credits available for QMP(H)s who hold or have held a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) for a CPL(H) with IR(H) QMP(H)s who hold or have held a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) shall meet all the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL CPL(H) and/or IR rating for helicopters. Refer to: Section 4, Part D, Subpart 3 for the full CPL (H) requirements, and Section 4, Part G, Subpart 2 for the full IR (H) requirements. QMP(H) applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements. Theoretical Knowledge Credits QMP(H)s are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.315 and Appendix 3, paragraphs F-K and FCL 615, as applicable, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examination for the ATPL(H) with IR or ATPL(H) (VFR) and IR(H) or CPL(H)and IR(H), as applicable. An applicant who passes the examination at ATPL(H) with IR or ATPL(H) (VFR) level is reminded that the calendar validity periods set out in Part-FCL apply. Unless an ATPL(H) is gained within the validity of the pass result, the theoretical knowledge examinations must be passed again to qualify for the ATPL(H). An applicant who passes the examination at ATPL(H) with IR level or at IR(H) level is reminded that the calendar validity periods set out in Part-FCL apply. Unless an IR(H) is gained within the validity of the pass result, the theoretical knowledge examinations must be passed again to qualify for the IR(H). Flying Experience Credits QMP(H)s with a minimum of 70 hours logged as PIC/P1 Capt or PICUS/1st Pilot NonCapt who hold or have held a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) are given full credit as regards the requirement to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the skill test(s) for the issue of a CPL(H) and IR(H). Applicants for the issue of a Part-FCL licence shall have fullled the experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of a type rating as set out in Part FCL Subpart H for the helicopter used for the test. The helicopter used for the skill test shall meet the requirements for training helicopters. A QMP(H) who has not graduated from all SERW, SLIC and MERW (or legacy) courses, or who does not hold (or has not held) an operational category to operate military multi-engine helicopters, shall take the skill test(s) in a single pilot singleengine helicopter. A QMP(H) who has graduated from all SERW, SLIC and MERW (or legacy) courses, or holds (or has held) an operational category to operate military multi-engine helicopters, may take the skill test(s) in a single pilot multi-engine helicopter.
30 January 2013
The skill test(s) will be assessed by the holder of a Flight Examiner Certicate issued under Part-FCL, in: an appropriate type of military helicopter on which the applicant is or has been qualied to operate as a QMP, suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent type, or an appropriate type of civilian helicopter provided that the applicant has completed the Part-FCL requirements for inclusion of that type in a Part-FCL licence except the type rating skill test. 3.13 Credits available for Qualied Military Pilots (Helicopters) (QMP(H)s) who hold or have held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) Qualied Military Pilots (Helicopter) (QMP(H)s) who hold or have held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) shall meet all the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL CPL(H) and/or IR rating for helicopters. QMP(H) applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements. Refer to; Section 4, Part D, Subpart 2 for the full CPL (H) requirements, and Section 4, Part G, Subpart 2 for the full IR (H) requirements. Credits are available for Qualied Military Pilots (Helicopters) (QMP(H)s) who holds or have held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) towards the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL CPL(H) and/or IR rating for helicopters. Theoretical Knowledge Credits: QMP(H)s are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.315 and Appendix 3, paragraphs F-K or Appendix 6, paragraph B, as applicable, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examination for the ATPL(H)IR, CPL(H)IR or IR(H) rating, as applicable. Flying Experience Credits: That QMP(H)s with a minimum of 70 hours logged as PIC/P1 Capt or PICUS/1st Pilot Non-Capt who holds or have held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) are given full credit as regards the requirement to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the skill tests for the issue of an CPL(H). A QMP who holds or has held only a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) shall complete additional training to the satisfaction of the Head of Training of an ATO prior to taking an IR(H) skill test for the addition of an IR(H) rating to a Part-FCL CPL(H). This additional training shall comprise the procedural instrument ying elements of the approved IR course. A QMP(H) who has not graduated from all SERW, SLIC and MERW (or legacy) courses, or who does not hold (or has not held) an operational category to operate military multi-engine helicopters, shall take the skill test in a single pilot single-engine helicopter. A QMP(H) who has graduated from all SERW, SLIC and MERW (or legacy) courses, or holds (or has held) an operational category to operate military multi-engine helicopters, may take the skill test in a single pilot multi-engine helicopter.; Applicants for the issue of a Part-FCL licence shall have fullled the experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of a type rating as set out in Part FCL Subpart H for the helicopter used for the test.
30 January 2013
The skill test(s) will be conducted by the holder of an Instrument Rating Examiner Certicate issued under Part-FCL, in: an appropriate type of military helicopter, suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent type; or an appropriate type of civilian helicopter provided the applicant has completed the Part-FCL requirements for inclusion of that type in a Part-FCL licence except the type rating skill test following training to the satisfaction of the Head of Training at an ATO. 3.14 a) Credits available for QMP(H)s who hold or have held an Operational Category to operate military multi-pilot helicopters for an ATPL(H) and IR(H) QMP(H)s who hold or have held an Operational Category with a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) to operate military multi-pilot helicopters shall meet all the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL ATPL(H) and IR(H) for helicopters. Refer to: Section 4, Part F, Subpart 2 for the full ATPL(H) requirements. QMP(H) applicants who hold or have held an Operational Category with a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) to operate military multi-pilot helicopter may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements. The following types are considered to be multi-pilot helicopters for this purpose: Bell 212 Chinook Grifn Lynx Mk 7/9A Merlin Mk 3/3A Puma (SA330) Sea King Mk 3/3A/4/5/6 Theoretical Knowledge Credits QMP(H)s are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.515 and Appendix 3, paragraph F, and FCL.615, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examinations for the ATPL(H) with IR. Flying Experience Credits QMP(H)s who hold or have held an Operational Category with a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) to operate military multi-pilot helicopters, and who have satised the experience requirements for the issue of an ATPL for helicopters as set out in Subpart F and for an IR as set out in Subpart G of Annex 1 to the Regulation, are given full credit as regards the MCC and as regards the requirement to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the skill test(s) for the issue of an ATPL(H) with IR(H). Applicants for the issue of a Part-FCL licence shall have fullled the experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of a type rating as set out in Part-FCL Subpart H for the helicopter used for the test. The skill test will be conducted by the holder of a Type Rating Examiner (TRE) certicate issued under Part-FCL, in:
30 January 2013
an appropriate multi-pilot type of military helicopter on which the applicant is or has been qualied to operate as a QMP, suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent multi-pilot helicopter type, or an appropriate multi-pilot type of civilian helicopter provided the applicant has completed the Part-FCL requirements for inclusion of that type with IR in a Part-FCL licence except the type rating skill test. b) Credits available for QMP(H)s who hold or have held an Operational Category to operate military multi-pilot helicopters for an ATPL(H) VFR QMP(H)s who hold or have held an Operational Category with a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) to operate military multi-pilot helicopters shall meet all the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL ATPL(H) VFR for helicopters. Refer to: Section 4, Part F, Subpart 2 for the full ATPL(H) requirements. QMP(H) applicants who hold or have held an Operational Category with a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) to operate military multi-pilot helicopter may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements. The following types are considered to be multi-pilot helicopters for this purpose: Bell 212 Chinook Grifn Lynx Mk 7/9A Merlin Mk 3/3A Puma (SA330) Sea King Mk 3/3A/4/5/6 AH-64D Apache Theoretical Knowledge Credits QMP(H)s are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.515 and Appendix 3, paragraph F, and FCL.615, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examinations for the ATPL(H). Flying Experience Credits QMP(H)s who hold or have held an Operational Category with a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) to operate military multi-pilot helicopters, and who have satised the experience requirements for the issue of an ATPL for helicopters as set out in Subpart F of Annex 1 to the Regulation, are given full credit as regards the MCC and as regards the requirement to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the skill test(s) for the issue of an ATPL(H) VFR. Applicants for the issue of a Part-FCL licence shall have fullled the experience requirements and prerequisites for the issue of a type rating as set out in Part-FCL Subpart H for the helicopter used for the test. The skill test will be conducted by the holder of a Type Rating Examiner (TRE) certicate issued under Part-FCL, in: an appropriate multi-pilot type of military helicopter on which the applicant is or has been qualied to operate as a QMP, suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent multi-pilot helicopter type, or
15 October 2013
an appropriate multi-pilot type of civilian helicopter provided the applicant has completed the Part-FCL requirements for inclusion of that type in a Part- FCL licence except the type rating skill test. QMP(H)s who hold or have held an Operational Category with a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) to operate military multi-pilot helicopters seeking to add an IR to a Part-FCL ATPL(H) VFR may do so by satisfying the credits set out in Paragraph 3.17 for the inclusion of an IR rating on the Part-FCL licence. The IR skill test must be taken on the multi pilot helicopter type held on the Part-FCL ATPL (H) VFR. 3.15 Credits available for QMP(H)s who hold or have held a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) for the inclusion an IR(H) in a Part-FCL helicopter licence; (an IR cannot be included in an LAPL(H)) QMP(H)s who hold or have held a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) shall meet all the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL IR(H) for helicopters. Refer to: Section 4, Part G, Subpart 2 for the full IR(H) requirements. QMP(H) applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements. Theoretical Knowledge Credits QMP(H)s who hold or have held a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.615 and Appendix 6, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examination for the IR(H). Flying Experience Credits QMP(H)s with a minimum of 70 hours logged as PIC/P1 Capt or PICUS/1st Pilot NonCapt who hold or have held a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) are given full credit as regards the requirement to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the skill test for the issue the IR(H). A QMP(H) who has not graduated from all SERW, SLIC and MERW (or legacy) courses, or who does not hold (or has not held) an operational category to operate military multi-engine helicopters, shall take that skill test in a single pilot singleengine helicopter. A QMP(H) who has graduated from all SERW, SLIC and MERW (or legacy) courses, or holds (or has held) an operational category to operate military multi-engine helicopters, may take that skill test in a single pilot multi-engine helicopter. Applicants for the issue of the IR(H) shall have qualied for the inclusion in their PartFCL licence of the type of Helicopter used for the IR(H) test. The skill test(s) will be conducted by the holder of an Examiner Certicate issued under Part-FCL, in: an appropriate type of military helicopter on which the applicant is or has been qualied to operate as a QMP, suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent class or type, or an appropriate type held on the Part-FCL licence following IR training to the satisfaction of the Head of Training at an ATO.
30 January 2013
3.16
Revalidation of Part-FCL Instrument Rating Credit QMP(H)s, once holding a Part-FCL IR(H), may use the revalidation/renewal of a Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) to revalidate the Part-FCL IR(H) in the following circumstances. This applies where; the Military Unrestricted Green Instrument Rating has been revalidated in a type for which they hold a valid helicopter rating in the Part-FCL licence, the prociency check was conducted by the holder of a Flight Examiner Certicate issued under Part-FCL, and the prociency check is conducted following the civilian IR test schedule set out in Appendix 9 to Part-FCL.
3.17
Credits available for QMP(H)s who hold or have held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) for inclusion of an IR(H) in a Part-FCL helicopter licence; (an IR cannot be included in an LAPL(H)) QMP(H)s who hold or have held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) shall meet all the requirements for the issue of a Part-FCL IR(H) for helicopters. Refer to: Section 4, Part G, Subpart 2 for the full IR(H) requirements. QMP(H) applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements. Theoretical Knowledge Credits QMP(H)s who hold or have held a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.615 and Appendix 6, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examination for the IR(H). Flying Experience Credits A QMP who holds or has held only a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) shall complete additional training to the satisfaction of the Head of Training of an ATO prior to taking an IR(H) skill test for the addition of an IR(H) rating to a Part-FCL licence. This additional training shall comprise the procedural instrument ying elements of the approved IR course. A QMP(H) who has not graduated from all SERW, SLIC and MERW (or legacy) courses, or who does not hold (or has not held) an operational category to operate military multi-engine helicopters, shall take that skill test in a single pilot singleengine helicopter. A QMP(H) who has graduated from all SERW, SLIC and MERW (or legacy) courses, or holds (or has held) an operational category to operate military multi-engine helicopters, may take that skill test in a single pilot multi-engine helicopter Applicants for the issue of the IR(H) shall have qualied for the inclusion in their PartFCL licence of the type of Helicopter used for the IR(H) test. The skill test(s) will be conducted by the holder of an Examiner Certicate issued under Part-FCL, in: an appropriate type of military helicopter on which the applicant is or has been qualied to operate as a QMP, suitably equipped for the purpose, which has an EASA civilian equivalent type; or an appropriate type held on the Part-FCL licence following IR training to the satisfaction of the Head of Training at an ATO.
30 January 2013
3.18
Revalidation of Part-FCL Instrument Rating Credit QMP(H)s, once holding a Part-FCL IR(H), may use the revalidation/renewal of a Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating (Helicopter) to revalidate the Part-FCL IR(H) in the following circumstances. This applies where: the Military Restricted Green Instrument Rating has been revalidated in a type for which they hold a valid helicopter rating in the Part-FCL licence; the prociency check was conducted by the holder of a Flight Examiner Certicate issued under Part-FCL; and the prociency check is conducted following the civilian IR test schedule set out in Appendix 9 to Part-FCL.
3.19
Credits available for QHIs for a Restricted FI(H) QHIs shall meet all the requirements for the addition of a Part-FCL FI certicate to a Part-FCL licence for helicopters. Refer to: Section 4, Part J, Subpart 1 for the full ight instructor certicate (FI (H)) requirements. QHI applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements if: they hold a Part-FCL licence (except an LAPL(H)); and they have been awarded an instructor category (or have been assessed as Competent to Instruct) as a QHI on single pilot helicopters. CPL Theoretical Knowledge Credits QHIs are credited the requirement to complete a theoretical knowledge instruction course as set out in FCL.315 and Appendix 3, prior to attempting the theoretical knowledge examinations for the CPL(H). Teaching and Learning Credits QHIs are credited with the 25 hour teaching and learning training course requirement, as set out in FCL.930 of the relevant instructor certicate, toward the issue of any PartFCL instructor certicate. FI Course Credits QHIs who are compliant with the pre-requisite requirements for the application for a restricted FI(H) certicate, are required to complete training at the discretion of the Head of Training at an ATO approved to conduct FI(H) Courses. QHI applicants must pass an assessment of competence for the issue of a restricted FI(H) certicate on a type of single pilot single-engine helicopter for which the QHI holds a valid type rating in their Part-FCL licence. QHI applicants for an FI(H) certicate who hold a night rating on their Part-FCL licence may have the instruction privilege added to their ight instructor rating by: demonstrating the ability to instruct for that rating during the assessment of competence; or if not able to satisfy the above requirement at issue of the FI rating, meet the relevant requirements of Part-FCL.
30 January 2013
3.20
Transfer of a Military Aeroplane Class/Type rating to a Part-FCL Licence A QMP(A) who is qualied on one of the Military Class/Types listed below, who is seeking to obtain the Class/Type rating for a Part-FCL licence shall meet all the requirements for the issue of the Part-FCL Class/Type rating for Aeroplanes, except for the credits stated. Refer to: Section 4, Part H, Subpart 1 for the full Class/Type Rating for Aeroplanes. QMP(A) applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements. Class/Type rating Course Credits QMP(A)s who are compliant with the prerequisite requirements for the application for the Class/Type rating are required to complete additional training to comply with the standard required for the skill test, as determined by the Head of Training at an ATO approved to conduct the applicable Class/Type rating course. QMP(A) applicants must pass the Class/Type Rating theoretical knowledge examination and Skill Test for the issue of the applicable Class/Type rating. The skill test will be conducted by the holder of the appropriate Flight Examiner Certicate issued under Part-FCL. The following Military Aeroplanes acceptable for this purpose are: Avenger T1 (Beech 300 Series(BE300/1900)) BAC 1-11, BAe 125/HS 125 BAe 146/Avro RJ Beagle Bassett (MEP) Beech 200 (BE 90/99/100/200) Hercules C1/C3 (not 130J) (Lockheed L382G) Islander (BN2T) Jetstream T1/T2 (Jetstream 200) Jetstream T3 (Jetstream 31/32) L1011 Tristar Piper PA31 (MEP) Voyager Tanker (Airbus A330-200)
3.21
Transfer of a Military Helicopter Type rating to a Part-FCL Licence A QMP(H) who is qualied on one of the Military Types listed below, who is seeking to obtain the Type rating for a Part-FCL licence shall meet all the requirements for the issue of the Part-FCL Type rating for Helicopters, except for the credits stated. Refer to: Section 4, Part H, Subpart 2 for the full Type Rating for Helicopters. QMP(H) applicants may apply the credits below, towards satisfying the Part-FCL requirements. Class/Type rating Course Credits QMP(H)s who are compliant with the prerequisite requirements for the application for the Type rating are required to complete additional training to comply with the standard required for the skill test, as determined by the Head of Training at an ATO approved to conduct the applicable Type rating course.
15 October 2013
QMP(H) applicants must pass the Type Rating theoretical knowledge examination and Skill Test for the issue of the applicable Type rating. The skill test will be conducted by the holder of the appropriate Flight Examiner Certicate issued under Part-FCL. The following Military Helicopters acceptable for this purpose are: Agusta A109A (A109) Agusta A109 Power (AW109) AW139 Dauphin (SA365/365N) Gazelle (SA341/342) Grifn (Bell 212/412) Merlin Mk 3/3A (EH101) Puma II (AS332/EC225) Squirrel (AS350/350B3) Twin Squirrel (AS355/355N)
15 October 2013
Sample Form SRG 2133 for applicants claiming Military Credits available at www.caa.co.uk/srg2133
Confirmation of Military Experience for Military Accreditation Scheme (MAS) Credits in Accordance with Article 10 of Commission Regulation (EU) 1178/2011
Please complete this form online (preferred method) then print, sign and submit as instructed. Alternatively, print, then complete in BLOCK CAPITALS using black or dark blue ink. Unique No. (to be completed by CAA) Please read attached Guidance Notes before completing this form. FALSE REPRESENTATION STATEMENT It is an offence under Article 231 of the Air Navigation Order 2009 to make, with intent to deceive, any false representation for the purpose of procuring the grant, issue, renewal or variation of any certificate, licence, approval, permission or other document. This offence is punishable on summary conviction by a fine up to 5000, and on conviction on indictment with an unlimited fine or up to two years imprisonment or both. 1. APPLICANT DETAILS CAA Personal reference number (if known): Title: ............. To be completed by the Applicant
Forename(s): ...................................................
Nationality: ..........................................................
A certified copy of your valid Passport, EEA/EU National Identity Identity Card or Full EU Photographic Driving Licence (see ccompany your application as proof of identification. Guidance Note 1) must accompany 2. ADDRESS FOR CORRESPONDENCE (if (if different from above) To be completed by the Applicant
X
Army RAF No
.........................................................................................................................
E-mail: ............................................................................
Service No.: .............................................................................................. .......................................................................... (for serving and former serving members of HM Armed Forces) ................................................. if no, date of leaving UK Armed Forces: ...........................................................
E
Currently serving Yes
LE
Page 1 of 2
30 January 2013
4. CURRENT TRAINING LEVEL(S) I have completed training to the following level: Elementary Flying Training Graduate (EFTG) Single Engine Rotary Training Graduate (SERP) QMP - Basic Fast Jet Training Graduate QMP - Multi Engine Pilot Training Graduate QMP - Single Engine Rotary Training Graduate QMP - Multi Engine Rotary Training Graduate Operational Category to Operate Military Multi-Pilot Aircraft
To be completed by the Applicant Date of Confirmation Sortie: .............................. Date of Confirmation Sortie: .............................. Date of Confirmation Sortie: .............................. Date of Confirmation Sortie: .............................. Date of Confirmation Sortie: .............................. Date of Confirmation Sortie: .............................. Date of Confirmation Sortie: ..............................
egulation No 1178/2011) (Multi-pilot aircraft utilised must conform to the definition in Commission Regulation Qualified Flying Instructor (single-engine piston Qualified Helicopter Instructor (single-engine I currently hold Military Restricted have held Unrestricted other other ) ) Date of Confirmation Sortie: .............................. Date of Confirmation Sortie: ..............................
PL E
Green Instrument Rating for fixed wing helicopter Aeroplanes Single Engine Day Night Day Night Total
Single Engine Piston Flight Time as Pilot (do not add taxi time to military logbook times) Multi Engine Piston Multi Pilot Aircraft Turbine/Turbo Prop.
6. DECLARATION OF APPLICANT (see Guidance Notes) I declare that the information provided on this form is correct.
M
To be completed by the Applicant Date: .................................. Date: ................................
EX
7. DECLARATION OF COMMANDING OFFICER / FLIGHT COMMANDER / ATO HEAD OF TRAINING I hereby confirm that the information provided by th the applicant regarding Military experience is correct. Unit/Regt/Sqn/Flt/ATO details:................................................................................................. details:............................................................................................................................................ ATO approval number (If an ATO): ...................................................................................................................................... Name of Commanding Officer / Flight Commander (Lt Cdr/Maj/Sqn Ldr or above) / ATO Head of Training (Block capitals):.......................................................................................... Rank/Position:............................................................................................ Signature: .......................................................................................................................... PLEASE REFER TO FALSE REPRESENTATION STATEMENT ON PAGE 1
Page 2 of 2
30 January 2013
Confirmation of Military Experience for Military Accreditation Scheme (MAS) Credits in Accordance with Article 10 of Commission Regulation (EU) 1178/2011 GUIDANCE NOTES
The qualifying criteria and credits available under the Military Accreditation Scheme (MAS) are set out in CAP 804, Section 4, Part O. This form must be completed to confirm the applicant's entitlement for Credits accepted under the terms of the MAS for persons who are or have been serving members of the UK Armed Forces. Credits are granted under the terms of the EASA Credit Report, in accordance with Article 10 of the EASA Aircrew Regulation (Commission Regulation (EU) 1178/2011), as submitted by 22 (Trg) Group RAF, and as agreed with the CAA in consultation with the Agency. The credits derived from this report are published in CAP 804. An applicant claiming credits under the MAS must include this form in support of their application to the CAA for the grant of any licence, rating, certificate or when applying to take theoretical knowledge examinations based on their military training. Where the application for the licence, rating or certificate will include training carried out at an Approved Training Organisation, a copy of this form must also be retained as part of the Training Records for that individual at the ATO making the recommendation for licence/rating/certificate issue.
The declaration at Section 7 must be completed by the applicant's Commanding Officer or the Head of Training of the ATO where the additional training was completed. Where an applicant for the licence, rating or certificate is not t required under the terms of the MAS to complete training at an ATO prior to undertaking the Skill Test, the Declaration n of Commanding Officer (Section (Section 7) is acceptable as a Recommendation for test as required by FCL.030. Guidance for the completion of this application form 1) Section 1 - Applicant Details.
All applicants are to complete the section. Ensure that the applicant's full name is given.
The CAA Personal Reference number, if applicable, will be found on any licence or medical certificate that has been issued to the applicant.
Applicants are to give details of their military service and service number. Applicants shall give details of the training training completed in military service. The credits applicable according to the military level achieved are set out in CAP 804, Section 4, Part O. For QMP credits, applicants must mu provide documentary evidence that they obtained the appropriate level of training (and were issued with their wings, if applicable), for the MAS credits requested.
EX
5) Section 6, Applicant's Declaration.
This section is to be completed by the applicant. Please refer to CAP 804, Section Secti 4, Part O for the multi pilot aircraft types eligible for which credit may be given. This section is to be completed completed by the applicant. This Section shall be completed by an offi officer at the level of Staff Officer 2 (Lt Cdr/Maj/Sqn Ldr) or above, who must be at least one confirm rank senior to the individual whose eligibility is being confirmed. Alternatively, the CAA will accept the signature of the Head of Training of an ATO who has reviewed the applicant's military records and confirms their compliance with the eligibility criteria published in CAP 804.
PL
The applicant must submit certified copies of their Personal Flying flight ying Log pages and clearly identify their qualifications and fli experience that is relevant to their application for military credits.
Page i of i
30 January 2013
Part P
This Part provides the requirements and other information for converting existing UK Licences into EASA Licences.
1 Applicability
European (EU) legislation has changed the pilot licensing rules. Once the transition periods are over national licences are no longer valid for the aircraft within the scope of these rules, regardless of what may be written on the national licence or in national legislation.
2 Privileges
Unless marked to the contrary, a Part-FCL licence issued on the basis of conversion of a previous UK issued licence has the privileges set out in Part-FCL.
3 Requirements
3.1 Conversion of existing UK licences a) All UK issued licences that are fully compliant with JAR-FCL automatically became EASA licences with effect from 8 April 2012 but need to be physically replaced on or before their calendar expiry date. All UK issued licences that are not fully compliant with JAR-FCL are UK national licences. b) Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation provides criteria for commonly used national licences to be converted to EASA licences. A copy of this Annex is shown below. Holders of UK ATPLs should note that to be issued with an EASA Part-FCL ATPL they must have a current and valid Type Rating for a multi-pilot EASA aircraft type that can be entered on the EASA licence. c) In the UK we have a variety of legacy licences that were issued on the basis of UKspecic standards. These include a number of versions of the Basic CPL, various forms of PPL, and JAA ATPL and CPLs that are marked Valid for UK registered aircraft because their holders did not comply in full with JAR-FCL. For helicopter and aeroplane licences (other than NPPL) the complexity of the issue has been reduced by using an amendment to the ANO to convert each kind of legacy licence into one of the categories of licence in Annex II to the Part-FCL Regulation. They are therefore convertible to EASA licences under the terms of that Annex. d) Where a national licence does not appear in Annex II to the Part-FCL Regulation (e.g. balloon licences are not present) the regulation allows the alternative of the National Aviation Authority (CAA) compiling a Conversion Report. This Conversion Report compares the national rules, that were the basis upon which the national licences were issued, with the Part-FCL requirements and so proposes the additional requirements (if any) to be complied with before an EASA licence may be issued. Conversion reports have been prepared for the NPPL, balloons, airships and gliders, and for some UK national ratings. e) The ANO has been amended so that: i) Any JAA ATPL(A) marked as valid for United Kingdom registered aircraft is deemed to be a UK ATPL(A). ii) Any JAA CPL(A) marked as valid for United Kingdom registered aircraft is deemed to be a UK CPL(A).
27 July 2012
iii) Any JAA CPL(H) marked as valid for United Kingdom registered aircraft is deemed to be a UK CPL(H). iv) Any Basic CPL(A) that is marked that the holder is restricted not to undertake Public Transport or Aerial Work, except Aerial Work that is limited to: ying instruction and ying tests; or the towing of gliders; or ying displays; or parachute dropping; is deemed to be a UK PPL(A) - see Note 1. v) Any Basic CPL(A) that is not restricted as under (iv) above is deemed to be a UK CPL(A). NOTE 1: A national PPL(A) with FI(A) rating is convertible to an EASA PPL(A) with FI(A) on the basis of experience as set out in Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation. The EASA PPL(A) with FI(A) includes the privilege to be paid for ying instruction. f) Paragraph 3.3 sets out the requirements for the conversion of licences that are not included in Annex II to Regulation 1178/2011. g) The holder of a UK national licence may choose to convert their national licence to an equivalent level Part-FCL licence or to a lower level Part-FCL licence by satisfying the conversion requirements of the level of licence sought: e.g. A UK ATPL(A) seeking to convert to a Part-FCL PPL(A) may do so by meeting the PPL(A) conversion requirements as set out in row (k) of the table below. 3.2 Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation ANNEX II to Part-FCL Regulation CONDITIONS FOR THE CONVERSION OF EXISTING NATIONAL LICENCES AND RATINGS FOR AEROPLANES AND HELICOPTERS A. AEROPLANES 1 Pilot licences A pilot licence issued by a Member State in accordance with the national requirements shall be converted into a Part-FCL licence provided that the applicant complies with the following requirements: for ATPL(A) and CPL(A), complete as a prociency check the revalidation (a) requirements of Part- FCL for type/class and instrument rating, relevant to the privileges of the licence held; (b) demonstrate knowledge of the relevant parts of Part-OPS and Part-FCL; (c) demonstrate language prociency in accordance with FCL.055; (d) comply with the requirements set out in the table below:
30 January 2013
In Tables: > means more than; < means less than; > _ means at least.
.
ATPL(A) or JAR >1500 as PIC on ATPL(A) marked multi-pilot Valid for UK aeroplanes registered aircraft
(b)
ATPL(A) or a JAR >1500 on multi-pilot None ATPL(A) marked aeroplanes Valid for UK registered aircraft ATPL(A) or a JAR >500 on multi-pilot ATPL(A) marked aeroplanes Valid for UK registered aircraft Demonstrate knowledge of ight planning and performance as required by FCL.515 (see note 1) (i) Demonstrate knowledge of ight planning and performance as required by FCL.310 and FCL.615(b) (see note 1) (ii) Meet remaining requirements of FCL.720.A (c)
As in (c)(4)
As in (c)(5)
(c)
(d)
CPL/IR(A) and passed an ICAO ATPL theory test in the Member State of licence issue
(e)
CPL/IR(A) or a JAR CPL/IR(A) marked Valid for UK registered aircraft or a Basic CPL/ IR(A) without restrictions
>500 on multi-pilot aeroplanes, or in multi-pilot operations on single-pilot aeroplanes CS-23 commuter category or equivalent in accordance with the requirements of Part-OPS for commercial air transport
(i) Pass an examination for ATPL(A) knowledge in the Member State of licence issue (see note 3) (ii) Meet remaining requirements of FCL.720.A (c)
30 January 2013
Replacement Part-FCL licence and conditions (where applicable) (4) CPL/IR(A) with type/class ratings restricted to single-pilot aeroplanes
CPL/IR(A), a JAR >500 as PIC on CPL/IR(A) marked single-pilot Valid for UK aeroplanes registered aircraft or a Basic CPL/ IR(A) without restrictions CPL/IR(A), a JAR <500 as PIC on CPL/IR(A) marked single-pilot Valid for UK aeroplanes registered aircraft or a Basic CPL/ IR(A) without restrictions CPL(A), JAR >500 as PIC on single-pilot CPL(A) marked aeroplanes Valid for UK registered aircraft or a Basic CPL(A) without restrictions CPL(A), a JAR <500 as PIC on single-pilot CPL(A) marked aeroplanes Valid for UK registered aircraft or a Basic CPL(A) without restrictions
(g)
Demonstrate knowledge of ight planning and ight performance for CPL/IR level (See note 4) Night rating, if applicable
As (4)(f)
(h)
(i)
(i) Night rating, if applicable; (ii) Demonstrate knowledge of ight performance and planning as required by FCL.310 (see note 4) Night rating if night ying privileges are not included in the instrument rating
As (4)(h)
(j)
(k)
> _ 70 on aeroplanes
PPL(A)
NOTES: 1 UK CPL(A) or ATPL(A) holders who have passed, or were credited, the UK Flight Planning examination at ATPL level and Performance A will be deemed to have satised this requirement.
2 All aircraft ratings permitted by Part-FCL included in a UK ATPL(A) will be transferred to the Part-FCL licence as Pilot-in-Command (PIC) ratings (unless specically restricted to Co-
May 2012
pilot only in the UK licence), as applicants will have already demonstrated the ability to act as PIC on each type/class. 3 UK CPL (A) holders already holding a type rating for a multi-pilot aeroplane are not required to have passed the ATPL theoretical knowledge examinations whilst they continue to operate that same aeroplane type, but will not be given ATPL theory credit for a Part-FCL licence. If a type rating for a different multi-pilot aeroplane is required, applicants must pass the PartFCL ATPL theoretical knowledge examinations. 4 UK CPL(A) holders who have passed, or were credited the UK Flight Planning examination at CPL level and have passed Performance C, D, E or U will be deemed to have satised this requirement. 5 Demonstration of the use of radio navigation aids should be to the satisfaction of a Chief Flying Instructor or Examiner. Successful demonstration should be certied by the CFI in the applicants personal ying logbook.
Instructor certicates
An instructor certicate issued by a Member State in accordance with the national requirements shall be converted into a Part-FCL certicate provided that the applicant complies with the following requirements:
National certicate or privileges held (1) Experience (2) N/A Any further requirements (3) Replacement Part-FCL certicate (4) FI(A)/IRI(A)/TRI(A)/CRI(A)
FI(A)/IRI(A)/TRI(A)/CRI(A) As required under For CRI HPSPCA see Part-FCL for the below relevant certicate
SFI certicate
An SFI certicate issued by a Member State in accordance with the national requirements shall be converted into a Part-FCL certicate provided that the holder complies with the following requirements:
National certicate held (1) SFI(A) Experience (2) >1500 hours as pilot of MPA Any further requirements (3) (i) Hold or have held a CPL, SFI(A) MPL or ATPL for aeroplanes issued by a Member State; (ii) Have completed the ight simulator content of the applicable type rating course including MCC. SFI(A) 3 years recent have completed the ight experience as an simulator content of the SFI applicable type rating course including MCC SFI(A) Replacement PartFCL certicate (4)
The conversion shall be valid for a maximum period of 3 years. Revalidation shall be subject to the completion of the revalidation requirements set out in Part-FCL. The expiry date of the existing Instructor Certicate will be copied to the new Certicate.
27 July 2012
STI certicate
An STI certicate issued by a Member State in accordance with the national requirements of that State may be converted into a Part-FCL certicate provided that the holder complies with the requirements set out in the table below:
National certicate Experience held (1) STI(A) (2) Replacement certicate (4) STI(A)
> 500 hours as pilot (i) Hold or have held a pilot on SPA licence issued by a Member State; (ii) Have completed a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL in an FSTD appropriate to the instruction intended
STI(A)
Have completed a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL in an FSTD appropriate to the instruction intended
STI(A)
CRI for HPSPCA to Part-FCL TRI(SPA): In accordance with Article 4(3) of regulation 1178/2011 a CRI with existing privileges to instruct in specic types of HPSPCA may be converted to a Part-FCL TRI (SPA) for the relevant aircraft type. Where the multi-pilot instructor/examiner privileges have been exercised on specic types on the JAR-FCL CRI rating these privileges may be retained. For extension to include other multi pilot types not previously held, the applicant must meet the requirements of FCL.905.TRI(c)(1) for multi-pilot aeroplanes. Revalidation of instructor certicates shall be subject to the completion of the revalidation requirements set out in Part-FCL. B. HELICOPTERS 1 Pilot licences
A pilot licence issued by a Member State in accordance with the national requirements shall be converted into a Part-FCL licence provided that the applicant complies with the following requirements: (a) complete as a prociency check the revalidation requirements of Part-FCL for type and instrument rating, relevant to the privileges of the licence held; (b) demonstrate knowledge of the relevant parts of Part-OPS and Part-FCL; See Acceptable Means of Compliance & Guidance Material (c) demonstrate language prociency in accordance with FCL.055; (d) comply with the requirements set out in the table below:
15 October 2013
Removal of conditions
(2) None
(3)
ATPL(H) with >1000 as PIC on valid IR(H) or a multi-pilot JAR ATPL(H) with helicopters valid IR, marked Valid for UK registered aircraft ATPL(H) no IR(H) privileges or a JAR ATPL(H) no IR, marked Valid for UK registered aircraft >1000 as PIC on multi-pilot helicopters
(b)
None
ATPL(H)
(c)
ATPL(H) with >1000 on multipilot helicopters valid IR(H) or a JAR ATPL(H) with valid IR, marked Valid for UK registered aircraft ATPL(H) no IR(H) privileges or a JAR ATPL(H) no IR, marked Valid for UK registered aircraft ATPL(H) with valid IR(H) or JAR ATPL(H) with valid IR, marked Valid for UK registered aircraft >1000 on multipilot helicopters
None
(d)
None
(e)
>500 on multi-pilot Demonstrate helicopters knowledge of ight planning and ight performance as required by FCL.515 and FCL.615(b) (see note 1)
As (4)(c)
17 September 2012
National licence Row held Ref. (1) (f) ATPL(H) no IR(H) privileges or JAR ATPL(H) no IR, marked Valid for UK registered aircraft CPL/IR(H) and passed an ICAO ATPL(H) theory test in the Member State of licence issue or a JAR CPL(H) with valid IR, marked Valid for UK registered aircraft
Removal of conditions
(2)
(3)
(5) As (5)(d)
(g)
(i) Demonstrate knowledge of ight planning and ight performance as required by FCL.310 and FCL.615(b); (see note 2)
CPL/IR(H) with ATPL(H) theory credit, provided that the ICAO ATPL(H) theory test is assessed as being at (ii) Meet remaining Part-FCL ATPL requirements of level FCL.720.H(b) >500 hrs on multi-pilot helicopters (i) To pass an examination for Part-FCL ATPL(H) theoretical knowledge in the Member State of licence issue (see note 3) (ii) To meet remaining requirements of FCL.720.H (b) CPL/IR(H) with Part-FCL ATPL(H) theory credit
Not applicable
(h)
CPL/IR(H) or a JAR CPL(H) with valid IR, marked Valid for UK registered aircraft
Not applicable
(i)
CPL/IR(H) or a JAR CPL(H) with valid IR, marked Valid for UK registered aircraft CPL/IR(H) or a JAR CPL(H) with valid IR, marked Valid for UK registered aircraft
None
CPL/IR(H) with type ratings restricted to single-pilot helicopters As (4)(i) Obtain multipilot type rating as required by Part-FCL
(j)
Demonstrate knowledge of ight planning and ight performance as required by FCL.310 and FCL.615(b) (see note 2)
27 July 2012
National licence Row held Ref. (1) (k) CPL(H) or a JAR CPL(H), marked Valid for UK registered aircraft CPL(H) or a JAR CPL(H), marked Valid for UK registered aircraft
Replacement Part-FCL licence and conditions (where applicable) (4) CPL(H), with type ratings restricted to single-pilot helicopters As (4) (k)
Removal of conditions
(5)
(l)
Night rating demonstrate knowledge of ight performance and planning as required by FCL.310 (see note 2)
(m)
>500 as PIC on single-pilot helicopters <500 as PIC on single-pilot helicopters Demonstrate knowledge of ight planning and ight performance as required by FCL.310 (see note 2) night ying privileges are not included in the instrument rating
As (4)(k) and restricted to day VFR operations As (4)(k) and restricted to day VFR operations
(n)
(o)
PPL/IR(H)
(p)
PPL(H)
PPL (H)
NOTES: 1 UK CPL(H) or ATPL(H) holders who have passed, or were credited, the UK examinations at ATPL level will be deemed to have satised this requirement. 2 UK CPL(H) holders who have passed, or were credited, the UK examinations at CPL level will be deemed to have satised this requirement. 3 CPL holders already holding a type rating for a multi-pilot helicopter are not required to have passed an examination for ATPL(H) theoretical knowledge whilst they continue to operate that same helicopter type, but will not be given ATPL(H) theory credit for a Part-FCL licence. If they require another type rating for a different multi-pilot helicopter, they must pass the Part-FCL theoretical knowledge examination. 4 Demonstration of the use of radio navigation aids should be to the satisfaction of a Chief Flying Instructor or Examiner. Successful demonstration should be certied by the CFI or examiner in the applicants personal ying logbook.
27 July 2012
Instructor certicates
An instructor certicate issued by a Member State in accordance with the national requirements shall be converted into a Part-FCL certicate provided that the applicant complies with the following requirements
National certicate or privileges held (1) FI(H)/IRI(H)/TRI(H) Experience (2) As required under Part-FCL for the relevant certicate Any further requirements (3) Replacement certicate (4) FI(H)/IRI(H)/TRI(H)*
Revalidation of the certicate shall be subject to the completion of the revalidation requirements set out in Part-FCL. 3 SFI certicate
An SFI certicate issued by a Member State in accordance with the national requirements shall be converted into a Part-FCL certicate provided that the holder complies with the following requirements:
National certicate held (1) SFI(H) Experience (2) Any further requirements (3) SFI(H) Replacement certicate (4)
>1000 hours as pilot of (i) Hold or have held a CPL, MPH MPL or ATPL issued by a Member State; (ii) Have completed the ight simulator content of the applicable type rating course including MCC
SFI(H)
Have completed the simulator content of the applicable type rating course including MCC
SFI(H)
Revalidation of the certicate shall be subject to the completion of the revalidation requirements set out in Part-FCL. 4 STI certicate
An STI certicate issued by a Member State in accordance with the national requirements of that State may be converted into a Part-FCL certicate provided that the holder complies with the requirements set out in the table below:
27 July 2012
Any further requirements (3) (i) Hold or have held a pilot licence issued by a Member State; (ii) Have completed a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL in an FSTD appropriate to the instruction intended
STI(H)
Have completed a prociency check in accordance with Appendix 9 to Part-FCL in an FSTD appropriate to the instruction intended
STI(H)
Revalidation of the certicate shall be subject to the completion of the relevant requirements set out in Part-FCL. 3.3 Conversion of UK National Licences and ratings not included under 3.1 or 3.2 In accordance with Article 4 of the EASA Aircrew Regulation, Conversion Reports have been compiled for the conversion of UK licences that are not covered by Annex II to the Regulation. The conversion requirements dened in those Reports are set out below. a) Demonstrate knowledge of the relevant parts of Part-OPS and Part-FCL; b) Demonstrate language prociency in accordance with FCL.055 or hold a FRTOL; Language prociency requirements as set out in FCL.055 do not apply to the LAPL(S), SPL, LAPL(B) or BPL, unless an FRTOL is required so that a radio can be operated. c) Comply with the requirements set out in the table below: NOTE: The following tables set out the requirements for conversion of the applicable national licences to Part-FCL licences based on conversion reports submitted by the UK CAA to EASA. The conversion requirements shall be applicable from 17 September 2012, subject to no objection from the Agency.
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence LAPL(A) with Single Engine Piston aeroplane endorsement 1. 2. Hold an NPPL(A) with SSEA rating; Hold an LAPL medical certicate (or Class 1 or Class 2 medical certicate) issued in accordance with Part MED (MED.A.030). Any limitation arising from the holders medical status will appear on the medical certicate; To be issued with a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence an individual must full the EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew at Level 4, 5, or 6. Whilst the pilot licence can be obtained without meeting EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew, a person without a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence is not authorised to use a radio in an aircraft. The holder of an existing valid UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence will be accepted as qualifying for a Level 4 (expiring) language prociency endorsement;
3.
27 July 2012
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence LAPL(A) with Single Engine Piston aeroplane endorsement 4. Have knowledge of the sections of Part-OPS and Part-FCL relevant to the LAPL(A) in accordance with A.1(b) of Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation; If the applicant has not completed 6 hours pilot in command of SSEAs since being granted the NPPL(A) with SSEA rating, comply with FCL.105.A(b) LAPL(A) Privileges and Conditions on issue of the Part-FCL LAPL(A) in order to be entitled to carry passengers. i.e: FCL.105.A LAPL(A) Privileges and conditions (b) Holders of an LAPL(A) shall only carry passengers after they have completed, after the issuance of the licence, 10 hours of ight time as PIC on aeroplanes or TMG. Flight as PIC completed since the issue of the NPPL(A) shall be credited towards fullling this requirement. If the SSEA rating is current, comply with FCL.140.A(a) LAPL(A) - Recency requirements; or, if the SSEA Certicate of Revalidation has lapsed, comply with FCL.140.A(b)(1) in a single engine pistonlandplane with a maximum take off mass of 2000 kilograms or less. i.e: FCL.140.A LAPL(A) Recency requirements (b) Holders of an LAPL(A) who do not comply with the requirements in (a) shall: (1) undertake a prociency check with an examiner before they resume the exercise of the privileges of their licence;
5.
6.
NPPL(A)(SSEA)
The holder of NPPL(A)(SSEA) seeking to convert directly to a PPL(A)(SEP)may do so by: Satisfying the NPPL(A)(SSEA) to LAPL(A) 1) (SEP) conversion requirements set out in this Part, and 2) Satisfying the LAPL(A)(SEP) to PPL(A)(SEP) training and testing requirements set out in FCL.210.A(b) & FCL.235, and 3) hold a valid Part-MED Class 1 or 2 Medical Certicate.
NPPL(A)(SLMG)
1. 2.
Hold an NPPL(A) with SLMG rating; Hold an LAPL medical certicate (or a Class 1 or Class 2 medical certicate) issued in accordance with Part MED (MED.A.030). Any limitation arising from the holders medical status will appear on the medical certicate;
15 October 2013
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence LAPL(A) with privileges restricted to TMGs 3. To be issued with a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence an individual must full the EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew at Level 4, 5, or 6. Whilst the pilot licence can be obtained without meeting EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew, a person without a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence is not authorised to use a radio in an aircraft. The holder of an existing valid UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence will be accepted as qualifying for a Level 4 (expiring) language prociency endorsement; Have knowledge of the sections of Part OPS and Part-FCL relevant to the LAPL(A) with TMG privileges in accordance with A.1(b) of Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation; If the applicant has not completed 6 hours pilot in command of TMGs since being granted the NPPL(A) with SLMG rating, comply with FCL.105.A(b) LAPL(A) Privileges and Conditions on issue of the Part-FCL LAPL(A) in order to be entitled to carry passengers, i.e.: FCL.105.A LAPL(A) Privileges and conditions (b) Holders of an LAPL(A) shall only carry passengers after they have completed, after the issuance of the licence, 10 hours of ight time as PIC on aeroplanes or TMG. Flight as PIC completed since the issue of the NPPL(A) shall be credited towards fullling this requirement. Experience in SLMGs that are powered sailplanes other than TMGs cannot be counted towards meeting the requirements. Flight as PIC in SLMGs completed since the issue of the NPPL(A) shall be credited towards fullling this requirement. At initial issue of the Part-FCL LAPL(A) provide evidence of compliance with FCL.140.A(a) in TMGs, i.e.: FCL.140.A LAPL(A) Recency Requirements (a) Holders of an LAPL(A) shall only exercise the privileges of their licence when they have completed, in the last 24 months, as pilot of aeroplanes or TMG: (1) at least 12 hours of ight time as PIC, including 12 take offs and landings: and
4.
5.
6.
15 October 2013
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence (2) refresher training of at least 1 hour of total ight time with an instructor. Or, if the SLMG Certicate of Revalidation has lapsed provide evidence of compliance with FCL.140.A(b)(1), i.e.: FCL.140.A LAPL(A) Recency Requirements (b) Holders of an LAPL(A) who do not comply with the requirements of (a) shall: (1) undertake a prociency check with an examiner before they resume the exercise of the privileges of their licence. Comply with the requirements of FCL.135.A
Extension of privilege to include single engine piston aeroplanes NPPL(A)(SLMG) PPL(A) with privileges restricted to TMGs
The holder of NPPL(A)(SSEA) seeking to convert directly to a PPL(A)(SEP) may do so by: 1) Satisfying the NPPL(A)(SLMG) to LAPL(A) (restricted to TMGs) conversion requirements set out in this Part, and 2) Satisfying the LAPL(A)(TMG) to PPL(A) (TMG) training and testing requirements set out in FCL.210.A(b) & FCL.235, and 3) hold a valid Part-MED Class 1 or 2 Medical Certicate. 1. 2. Hold an NPPL(A) with SLMG rating; Hold an LAPL medical certicate (or a Class 1 or Class 2 medical certicate) issued in accordance with Part MED (MED.A.030). Any limitation arising from the holders medical status will appear on the medical certicate; Have knowledge of the sections of Part OPS and Part-FCL relevant to the LAPL(S) with TMG privileges in accordance with A.1(b) of Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation; If the applicant has not completed 2 hours pilot in command of SLMGs since being granted the NPPL(A) with SLMG rating, comply with FCL.105.S(b) LAPL(S) Privileges and Conditions on issue of the Part-FCL LAPL(S) in order to be entitled to carry passengers, i.e.: FCL.105.S LAPL(S) Privileges and conditions (b) Holders of an LAPL(S) shall only carry passengers after they have completed, after the issuance of the licence, 10 hours of ight time or thirty launches as PIC of sailplanes or powered sailplanes.
NPPL(A)(SLMG) (A UK issued PPL(A), CPL(A) or ATPL(A) with an SLMG rating is acceptable in place of an NPPL(A) SLMG for this conversion)
LAPL(S)
3.
4.
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO NPPL(A)(SLMG) continued (A UK issued PPL(A), CPL(A) or ATPL(A) with an SLMG rating is acceptable in place of an NPPL(A) SLMG for this conversion)
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence LAPL(S) Flight as PIC in SLMGs completed since the issue of the NPPL(A) shall be credited towards fullling this requirement. Limitations and their removal Where the NPPL(A) was obtained by ying Touring Motor Gliders only, or the holder has not fullled requirements equivalent to FCL.110.S(a) in SLMGs other than TMGs (except that the 15 hours is reduced to 8 hours) nor passed a General Skill Test in an SLMG that is not a TMG, the LAPL(S) will be limited to TMGs only - (i.e. no privileges to act as pilot in command of sailplanes or powered sailplanes). This limitation shall remain in place unless and until: (i) the requirements of FCL.110.S(a) are fullled in sailplanes and/or powered sailplanes other than TMGs (except that the 15 hours may be reduced to 8 hours); and (ii) the ight test required by FCL.125 has been passed in a sailplane or powered sailplane other than a TMG. The requirements of FCL.110.S are: FCL.110.S LAPL(S) Experience requirements and crediting (a) Applicants for an LAPL(S) shall have completed at least 15 hours of ight instruction in sailplanes, or powered sailplanes, including at least: (1) 10 hours of dual ight instruction; (2) 2 hours of supervised solo ight time; (3) 45 launches and landings; (4) 1 solo cross-country ight of at least 50 km (27 NM) or 1 dual cross-country ight of at least 100 km (55 NM). (b) Of the 15 hours required in (a), a maximum of 7 hours may be completed in a TMG.
5. 5.1
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO NPPL(A)(SLMG) continued (A UK issued PPL(A), CPL(A) or ATPL(A) with an SLMG rating is acceptable in place of an NPPL(A) SLMG for this conversion)
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence LAPL(S) 5.2 Where the NPPL(A) SLMG was gained by ying only in SLMGs that are not TMGs, or the holder has not fullled requirements equivalent to FCL.135.S(a) in TMGs nor passed a General Skill Test in a TMG, the LAPL(S) will be limited to sailplanes and powered sailplanes only - (i.e. no privileges to act as pilot in command of Touring Motor Gliders). This limitation shall remain in place unless and until the requirements of FCL.135.S are complied with. Previous experience in SLMGs which are TMGs shall be credited towards fullling the requirements of FCL.135.S(a). The requirements of FCL.135.S are: FCL.135.S LAPL(S) Extension of privileges to TMG The privileges of an LAPL(S) shall be extended to a TMG when the pilot has completed in an ATO, at least: (a) 6 hours of ight instruction on a TMG, including: (1) 4 hours of dual ight instruction; (2) 1 solo cross-country ight of at least 150 km (80 NM), during which 1 full stop landing at an aerodrome different from the aerodrome of departure shall be performed; (b) a skill test to demonstrate an adequate level of practical skill in a TMG. During this skill test, the applicant shall also demonstrate to the examiner an adequate level of theoretical knowledge for the TMG in the following subjects: Principles of ight, Operational procedures, Flight performance and planning, Aircraft general knowledge, Navigation. An NPPL(A) holder who has ying experience equivalent to FCL.110.S in SLMGs and FCL.135.S in SLMGs that are TMGs and has passed a General Skill Test in both an SLMG other than a TMG and in a TMG shall be entitled to a Part-FCL LAPL(S) entitling the holder y sailplanes, powered sailplanes and TMGs.
5.3
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO NPPL(A)(SLMG) continued (A UK issued PPL(A), CPL(A) or ATPL(A) with an SLMG rating is acceptable in place of an NPPL(A) SLMG for this conversion)
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence LAPL(S) 6. At the initial issue of the LAPL(S), provide evidence of compliance with FCL.140.S as follows: If the LAPL(S) entitles the holder to y sailplanes and powered sailplanes only (i.e. it does not give the privilege to y TMGs) the holder shall comply with the requirements of FCL.140.S(a) which are: FCL.140.S LAPL(S) Recency requirements (a) Sailplanes and powered sailplanes. Holders of an LAPL(S) shall only exercise the privileges of their licence on sailplanes or powered sailplanes when they have completed on sailplanes or powered sailplanes, excluding TMGs, in the last 24 months, at least: (1) 5 hours of ight time as PIC, including 15 launches; (2) 2 training ights with an instructor; If the LAPL(S) entitles the holder to y Touring Motor Gliders only (i.e. it does not give the privilege to act as pilot in command of sailplanes and powered sailplanes), the holder shall comply with the requirements of FCL.140.S(b) which are: FCL.140.S LAPL(S) Recency Requirements (b) TMG. Holders of an LAPL(S) shall only exercise the privileges of their licence on a TMG when they have: (1) completed in a TMG in the last 24 months: (i) at least 12 hours of ight time as PIC, including 12 take-offs and landings: and (ii) refresher training of at least 1 hour total ight time with an instructor. (2) when the holder of the LAPL(S) has the privilege to y aeroplanes, the requirements in (1) may be completed in aeroplanes. If the NPPL(A) holder has insufcient experience to comply with 6(a) or 6(b), as appropriate to the LAPL(S) privileges sought, the holder shall comply with FCL.140.S(c)(1) by passing a prociency check with an examiner in a powered sailplane that is not a TMG or a TMG as required. Comply with FCL.130.S as required to add additional launch methods for sailplanes.
6.1
6.2
6.3
7.
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO NPPL(A)(SLMG) (A UK issued PPL(A), CPL(A) or ATPL(A) with an SLMG rating is acceptable in place of an NPPL(A) SLMG for this conversion)
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence SPL 1. 2. Hold an NPPL(A) with SLMG rating; Hold a Class 2 (or Class 1) medical certicate issued in accordance with Part MED (MED.A.030). Any limitation arising from the holders medical status will appear on the medical certicate; Have knowledge of the sections of Part OPS and Part-FCL relevant to the SPL - in accordance with A.1(b) of Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation; If the applicant has not completed 2 hours pilot in command of SLMGs since being granted the NPPL(A) with SLMG rating, comply with FCL.205.S(b)(1) SPL - Privileges and Conditions on issue of the Part-FCL SPL in order to be entitled to carry passengers, i.e.: FCL.205.S SPL Privileges and conditions (b) Holders of an LAPL(S) shall: (1) carry passengers only when having completed, after the issuance of the licence, 10 hours of ight time or thirty launches as PIC of sailplanes or powered sailplanes. Flight as PIC in SLMGs completed since the issue of the NPPL(A) shall be credited towards fullling this requirement. 5. 5.1 Limitations and their removal Where the NPPL(A) SLMG rating was obtained by ying Touring Motor Gliders only, or the holder has not fullled requirements equivalent to FCL.110.S(a) in SLMGs other than TMGs (except that the 15 hours is reduced to 8 hours) nor passed a General Skill Test in an SLMG that is not a TMG, the SPL will be limited to TMGs only (i.e. no privileges to act as pilot in command of sailplanes or powered sailplanes). This limitation shall remain in place unless and until: (i) the requirements of FCL.110.S(a) are fullled in sailplanes and/or powered sailplanes other than TMGs (except that the 15 hours may be reduced to 8 hours); and
3.
4.
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO NPPL(A)(SLMG) continued (A UK issued PPL(A), CPL(A) or ATPL(A) with an SLMG rating is acceptable in place of an NPPL(A) SLMG for this conversion)
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence SPL (ii) the ight test required by FCL.125 has been passed in a sailplane or powered sailplane other than a TMG. Flights in SLMGs other than TMGs that have been completed since the issue of a NPPL(A) shall be credited towards compliance with FCL.110.S(a), which are: FCL.110.S LAPL(S) Experience requirements and crediting (a) Applicants for an LAPL(S) shall have completed at least 15 hours of ight instruction in sailplanes, or powered sailplanes, including at least: (1) 10 hours of dual ight instruction; (2) 2 hours of supervised solo ight time; (3) 45 launches and landings; (4) 1 solo cross-country ight of at least 50 km (27 NM) or 1 dual cross-country ight of at least 100 km (55 NM). (b) Of the 15 hours required in (a), a maximum of 7 hours may be completed in a TMG. Where the NPPL(A) SLMG was gained by ying only in SLMGs that are not TMGs, or the holder has not fullled requirements equivalent to FCL.135.S(a) in TMGs nor passed a General Skill Test in a TMG, the SPL will be limited to sailplanes and powered sailplanes only - (i.e. no privileges to act as pilot in command of Touring Motor Gliders). This limitation shall remain in place unless and until the requirements of FCL.135.S are complied with. Previous experience in SLMGs which are TMGs shall be credited towards fullling the requirements of FCL.135.S(a). The requirements of FCL.135.S are: FCL.135.S LAPL(S) Extension of privileges to TMG The privileges of an LAPL(S) shall be extended to a TMG when the pilot has completed in an ATO, at least: (a) 6 hours of ight instruction on a TMG, including: (1) 4 hours of dual ight instruction; (2) 1 solo cross-country ight of at least 150 km (80 NM), during which 1 full stop landing at an aerodrome different from the aerodrome of departure shall be performed;
5.2
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO NPPL(A)(SLMG) continued (A UK issued PPL(A), CPL(A) or ATPL(A) with an SLMG rating is acceptable in place of an NPPL(A) SLMG for this conversion)
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence SPL (b) a skill test to demonstrate an adequate level of practical skill in a TMG. During this skill test, the applicant shall also demonstrate to the examiner an adequate level of theoretical knowledge for the TMG in the following subjects: Principles of ight, Operational procedures, Flight performance and planning, Aircraft general knowledge, Navigation. An NPPL(A) holder who has ying experience equivalent to FCL.110.S in SLMGs and FCL.135.S in SLMGs that are TMGs and has passed a General Skill Test in both an SLMG other than a TMG and in a TMG shall be entitled to a Part-FCL LAPL(S) entitling the holder y sailplanes, powered sailplanes and TMGs. At the initial issue of the SPL, provide evidence of compliance with FCL.230.S, which requires compliance with FCL.140.S. as follows: If the SPL entitles the holder to y sailplanes and powered sailplanes only (i.e. it does not give the privilege to y TMGs) the holder shall comply with the requirements of FCL.140.S(a) which are: FCL.140.S LAPL(S) Recency requirements (a) Sailplanes and powered sailplanes. Holders of an LAPL(S) shall only exercise the privileges of their licence on sailplanes or powered sailplanes when they have completed on sailplanes or powered sailplanes, excluding TMGs, in the last 24 months, at least: (1) 5 hours of ight time as PIC, including 15 launches; (2) 2 training ights with an instructor; If the SPL entitles the holder to y Touring Motor Gliders only (i.e. it does not give the privilege to act as pilot in command of sailplanes and powered sailplanes), the holder shall comply with the requirements of FCL.140.S(b) which are: FCL.140.S LAPL(S) Recency Requirements (b) TMG. Holders of an LAPL(S)shall only exercise the privileges of their licence on a TMG when they have: (1) completed in a TMG in the last 24 months:
5.3
6.
6.1
6.2
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO NPPL(A)(SLMG) continued (A UK issued PPL(A), CPL(A) or ATPL(A) with an SLMG rating is acceptable in place of an NPPL(A) SLMG for this conversion)
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence SPL (i) at least 12 hours of ight time as PIC, including 12 take-offs and landings: and (ii) refresher training of at least 1 hour total ight time with an instructor. (2) when the holder of the LAPL(S) has the privilege to y aeroplanes, the requirements in (1) may be completed in aeroplanes. If the NPPL(A) holder has insufcient experience to comply with 6(a) or 6(b), as appropriate to the LAPL(S) privileges sought, the holder shall comply with FCL.140.S(c)(1) by passing a prociency check with an examiner in a powered sailplane that is not a TMG or a TMG as required. Launch methods In order to comply with FCL.220.S, comply with FCL.130.S as required to add additional launch methods for sailplanes. To be remunerated for commercial operations other than as provided for in FCL.205.S(c), a pilot must remove the TMG only limitation and full the requirements of FCL.205.S(b)(2). Flying experience gained in powered sailplanes other than TMGs since the issue of the NPPL(A) shall be counted towards meeting this requirement. Hold an NPPL(A) with SLMG rating; Hold a Class 2 (or Class 1) medical certicate issued in accordance with Part MED (MED.A.030). Any limitation arising from the holders medical status will appear on the medical certicate; To be issued with a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence an individual must full the EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew at Level 4, 5, or 6. Whilst the pilot licence can be obtained without meeting EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew, a person without a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence is not authorised to use a radio in an aircraft. The holder of an existing valid UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence will be accepted as qualifying for a Level 4 (expiring) language prociency endorsement; Have knowledge of the sections of Part OPS and Part-FCL relevant to the PPL(A) with TMG rating - in accordance with A.1(b) of Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation;
6.3
7.
8.
NPPL(A)(SLMG)
1. 2.
3.
4.
15 October 2013
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence PPL(A) TMG only 5. Provide documentary evidence of having 45 hours ying experience in SLMGs that are TMGs including, (to comply with FCL.210.A(a) (1) and (2)), the following: (i) at least 25 hours dual ight instruction; and (ii) 10 hours of supervised solo ight time, including at least 5 hours of solo crosscountry ight time with at least 1 crosscountry ight of at least 270 km (150 NM), during which full stop landings at 2 aerodromes different from the aerodrome of departure were made; Experience in SLMGs that are powered sailplanes other than TMGs cannot be counted towards meeting the requirements. At initial issue of the Part-FCL PPL(A), provide evidence of compliance with FCL.740(b) to obtain the initial rating validity, i.e.: FCL.740(b) Revalidation of single-pilot single-engine class ratings (1) Single-engine piston aeroplane class ratings and TMG ratings. For revalidation of singlepilot single-engine piston aeroplane class ratings or TMG class ratings the applicant shall: (i) within the 3 months preceding the expiry date of the rating, pass a prociency check in the relevant class in accordance with Appendix 9 to this Part with an examiner; or (ii) within the 12 months preceding the expiry date of the rating, complete 12 hours of ight time in the relevant class, including: 6 hours as PIC; 12 take-offs and 12 landings; and a training ight of at least 1 hour with a ight instructor (FI) or a class rating instructor (CRI). Applicants shall be exempted from this ight if they have passed a class or type rating prociency check or skill test in any other class or type of aeroplane. Subsequently, compliance with Part-FCL FCL.740 and FCL.740.A(b) is required to maintain the TMG rating.
6.
7.
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO UK ATPL(A), CPL(A), BCPL(A) or PPL(A)
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence LAPL(A) 1. 2. Hold a PPL(A), BCPL(A), CPL(A) or ATPL(A) with a valid SEP rating; Hold an LAPL medical certicate or Class 1 or Class 2 medical certicate issued in accordance with Part MED (MED.A.030). Any limitation arising from the holders medical status will appear on the medical certicate; Hold or obtain (if required) a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence; and if held full the EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew at Level 4, 5, or 6. (Whilst the pilot licence can be obtained without meeting EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew, a person without a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence is not authorised to use a radio in an aircraft. The holder of an existing valid UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence will be accepted as qualifying for a Level 4 (expiring) language prociency endorsement); Have knowledge of the sections of Part OPS and Part-FCL relevant to the LAPL(A) in accordance with A.1(b) of Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation; Show evidence of the ability to use radio navigation aids. Hold a PPL(H), CPL(H), CPL(H&G), ATPL(H) or ATPL(H&G) with a valid rating for a helicopter that may be included in the LAPL(H); Hold an LAPL medical certicate or Class 1 or Class 2 medical certicate issued in accordance with Part MED (MED.A.030). Any limitation arising from the holders medical status will appear on the medical certicate; Hold or obtain (if required) a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence; and if held full the EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew at Level 4, 5, or 6. (Whilst the pilot licence can be obtained without meeting EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew, a person without a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence is not authorised to use a radio in an aircraft. The holder of an existing valid UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence will be accepted as qualifying for a Level 4 (expiring) language prociency endorsement);
3.
4.
2.
3.
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO UK ATPL(H)/(H&G), CPL(H)/(H&G) or PPL(H) continued
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence LAPL(H) 4. Have knowledge of the sections of Part OPS and Part-FCL relevant to the LAPL(H) - in accordance with A.1(b) of Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation; Show evidence of the ability to use radio navigation aids. Hold a UK issued private balloon and airship licence or a commercial balloon licence (PPL(BA) or CPL(B)) with valid balloon and/or hot air airship rating(s); Hold at least a LAPL medical certicate issued in accordance with Part-MED (MED.A.030). Any limitation arising from the holders medical status will appear on the medical certicate; Have knowledge of the sections of Part-OPS and Part-FCL relevant to the LAPL(B) - in accordance with A.1(b) of Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation; Comply with FCL.140.B LAPL(B) Recency requirements. The holder of a lapsed UK issued balloon licence must comply with FCL.140.B(b). The requirements are as follows: FCL.140.B LAPL(B) Recency requirements (a) Holders of an LAPL(B) shall only exercise the privileges of their licences when they have completed, in one class of balloons in the last 24 months, at least: (1) 6 hours of ight time as PIC, including 10 take offs and landings; and (2) 1 training ight with an instructor; (3) in addition, if the pilot is qualied to y more than one class of balloons, in order to exercise their privileges in the other class, they shall have completed at least 3 hours of ight time in that class within the last 24 months, including 3 take offs and landings. (b) Holders of a LAPL(B) who do not comply with the requirements in (a) shall, before they resume the exercise of their privileges: (1) pass a prociency check with an examiner in the appropriate class; or (2) perform the additional ight time or take offs and landings, ying dual and solo under the supervision of an instructor, in order to full the requirements in (a).
2.
3.
4.
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO PPL(Balloons and Airships), or CPL (Balloons) continued
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence LAPL(B) 5. Classes of balloons and hot air airships will be included in the LAPL(B) based upon the privileges to y balloons and airships for which the applicant qualied as the holder of a UK licence. The classes granted will not exceed the scope of the LAPL(B) and will be consistent with FCL.105.B LAPL(B) Privileges and FCL.135.B LAPL(B) Extension of privileges to another balloon class. Thus the LAPL(B) when issued will include privileges for one or more of the following: (a) hot air balloons up to 3,400 cubic metres envelope capacity; (b) hot air airships up to 3,400 cubic metres capacity; and/or (c) gas balloons up to 1,200 cubic metres envelope capacity. 6. 6.1 Extension of privileges to tethered ights The privileges of an LAPL(B) issued on conversion from a UK PPL(BA) or CPL(B) will include tethered ight privileges. Tethered ight training is included in the training required for the issue of a UK PPL(BA) and CPL(B). UK CPL(B) requirements are consistent with Part FCL. UK PPL(BA) are not. However, LAPL(B) holders must comply with FCL.130.B(c) and (d) and therefore the requirements of Part-FCL are fullled when the LAPL(B) is held. Extension of privileges to night ying UK balloon licences do not include specic limitations or ratings for night ying. On conversion to a Part FCL LAPL(B), a Night Rating will be included if the licence holder: (a) provides evidence of having received instruction at night on 2 ights of at least 1 hour each, or of at least 2 ights totalling at least 4 hours as pilot in command of a balloon at night; and (b) is colour safe MED.A.030(e). 8. 8.1 in accordance with
7. 7.1
Extension of privileges to instructing Prior to the mandatory introduction of Part-FCL for balloon licences the CAA accepts the BBAC Instructor Training Programme. Instructors who qualify as BBAC Instructors oversee the training of balloon and hot air airship pilots in the UK. The programme is set out in the BBAC Instructor Rating Application Procedure and is supported by the BBAC Instructor Syllabus FI/S/02
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO PPL(Balloons and Airships), or CPL (Balloons) continued
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence LAPL(B) 8.2 Requirements to be complied with to convert a BBAC Instructor Rating to a Part-FCL FI(B) and limitations to be applied.
8.2.1 Requirements 1 Hold a Part-FCL LAPL(B); 2 Be aged 18 or over (to comply with FCL.915(a)); 3. Hold a BBAC Balloon Instructor Rating 4 The validity of the FI(B) at initial issue will be based on either: i. the initial ight test taken as part of the BBAC Instructor Training Programme for BBAC Instructor Rating issue if within the 3 years preceeding issue of the FI(B); or ii. presentation of evidence of completion of any two of the following three requirements: a. 6 hours ight instruction or examining in balloons within the 3 years preceding issue of the FI(B) (while holding the appropriate instructor rating/examiner authorisation); b. completion of a BBAC Instructor training day within the preceding the 12 months preceding issue of the FI(B); c. passing a ight test for a BBAC Instructor Rating within the preceding 12 months; or iii. compliance with FCL.940.FI(c), i.e.: (c) Renewal. If the FI certicate has lapsed, the applicant shall, within a period of 12 months before renewal: (1) attend an instructor refresher seminar; (2) pass an assessment of competence in accordance with FCL.935. 5. BBAC Instructors who provide evidence of having qualied to give night ying instruction shall have these privileges included in the Part-FCL licence; 6. BBAC Instructors who provide evidence of having qualied to train other instructors shall have these privileges identied in the Part-FCL licence provided that they have fullled the ying experience requirements of FCL.905.FI(i)(1)(ii). 8.2.2 Limitations 1 A Part-FCL FI(B) issued on conversion of UK qualications shall have restricted privileges until the holder has complied with FCL.910. FI(c)(3);
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO PPL(Balloons and Airships), or CPL (Balloons)
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence BPL 1. Hold a UK issued private balloon and airship licence or a commercial balloon licence (PPL(BA) or CPL(B)) with valid balloon and/or hot air airship rating(s); Hold a Class 2 or Class 1 medical certicate issued in accordance with Part-MED (MED.A.030). Any limitation arising from the holders medical status will appear on the medical certicate; Have knowledge of the sections of Part-OPS and Part FCL relevant to the BPL in accordance with A.1(b) of Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation; Comply with FCL.230.B BPL Recency requirements. The holder of a lapsed UK-issued balloon licence must comply with FCL.230.B(b). The requirements are as follows: FCL.230.B BPL Recency requirements (a) Holders of a BPL shall only exercise the privileges of their licences when they have completed, in one class of balloons in the last 24 months, at least: (1) 6 hours of ight time as PIC, including 10 take offs and landings; and (2) 1 training ight with an instructor in a balloon within the appropriate class and with the maximum envelope capacity they have privileges for; (3) in addition, if the pilot is qualied to y more than one class of balloons, in order to exercise their privileges in the other class, they shall have completed at least 3 hours of ight time in that class within the last 24 months, including 3 take offs and landings. (b) Holders of a BPL who do not comply with the requirements in (a) shall, before they resume the exercise of their privileges:
2.
3.
4.
examiner in a balloon within the appropriate class and with the maximum envelope capacity they have privileges for; or (2) perform the additional ight time or take offs and landings, ying dual and solo under the supervision of an instructor, in order to full the requirements in (a).
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO PPL(Balloons and Airships), or CPL (Balloons) continued
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence BPL 5. Classes of balloons and hot air airships will be included in the BPL based upon the privileges to y balloons and airships for which the applicant qualied as the holder of a UK licence. The classes granted will not exceed the scope of the BPL and will be consistent with FCL.225.B If the UK licence held is a PPL(BA), the privileges of the BPL are restricted to act without remuneration in non-commercial operations (except as provided for in FCL.205.B(c)) until the ying experience requirements of FCL.205.B(b)(2) have been complied with. If the UK licence held is a CPL(B) that is restricted to ights for aerial work and private ying only, the privileges of the BPL are restricted to act with remuneration on other than commercial air transport operations until the ying experience requirements of FCL.205.B(b)(2) have been complied with. Extension of privileges to tethered ights The privileges of a BPL issued on conversion from a UK PPL(BA) or CPL(B) will include tethered ight privileges. Tethered ight training is included in the training required for the issue of a UK PPL(BA) and CPL(B). UK CPL(B) requirements are consistent with Part FCL. UK PPL(BA) are not. Extension of privileges to night ying UK balloon licences do not include specic limitations or ratings for night ying. On conversion to a Part FCL BPL, a Night Rating will be included if the licence holder: (a) provides evidence of having received instruction at night on 2 ights of at least 1 hour each, or of at least 2 ights totalling at least 4 hours as pilot in command of a balloon at night; and (b) is colour safe in accordance with MED.A.030(e).
6.
7.
8. 8.1
9. 9.1
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO PPL(Balloons and Airships), or CPL (Balloons) continued
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence BPL 10. 10.1 Extension of privileges to instructing Prior to the mandatory introduction of Part-FCL for balloon licences the CAA accepts the BBAC Instructor Training Programme. Instructors who qualify as BBAC Instructors oversee the training of balloon and hot air airship pilots in the UK. The programme is set out in the BBAC Instructor Rating Application Procedure and is supported by the BBAC Instructor Syllabus FI/S/02 Requirements to be complied with to convert a BBAC Instructor Rating to a Part-FCL FI(B) and limitations to be applied. 1 Hold a Part-FCL BPL; 2 Be aged 18 or over (to comply with FCL.915(a)); 3 Hold a BBAC Balloon Instructor Rating 4 The validity of the FI(B) at initial issue will be based on either: (a) the initial ight test taken as part of the BBAC Instructor Training Programme for BBAC Instructor Rating issue if within the 3 years preceeding issue of the FI(B); or (b) presentation of evidence of completion of any two of the following three requirements: (i) 6 hours ight instruction or examining in balloons within the 3 years preceding issue of the FI(B) (while holding the appropriate instructor rating/examiner authorisation); completion of a BBAC Instructor training day within the preceding the 12 months preceding issue of the FI(B);
10.2
10.2.1 Requirements
(ii)
(iii) passing a ight test for a BBAC Instructor Rating within the preceding 12 months; or (c) compliance with FCL.940.FI(c), i.e: (c) Renewal. If the FI certicate has lapsed, the applicant shall, within a period of 12 months before renewal:
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO PPL(Balloons and Airships), or CPL (Balloons) continued
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence BPL 5 BBAC Instructors who provide evidence of having qualied to give night ying instruction shall have these privileges included in the Part-FCL licence; 6 BBAC Instructors who provide evidence of having qualied to train other instructors shall have these privileges identied in the Part-FCL licence provided that they have fullled the ying experience requirements of FCL.905.FI(i)(1)(ii). 10.2.2 Limitations 1 A Part-FCL FI(B) issued on conversion of UK qualications shall have restricted privileges until the holder has complied with FCL.910. FI(c)(3).
UK CPL(As)
PPL(As)
1. 2.
Hold a UK CPL(As); Hold at least a Class 2 medical certicate issued in accordance with Part Med (MED.A.030). Any limitation arising from the holders medical status will appear on the medical certicate; To be issued with a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence an individual must full the EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew at Level 4, 5, or 6. A person without a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence is not authorised to use a radio in an aircraft. The holder of an existing valid UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence will be accepted as qualifying for a Level 4 (expiring) language prociency endorsement; Comply with FCL.060(b) Recent Experience on conversion to a Part-FCL licence; Have knowledge of the parts of Part-OPS and Part FCL relevant to the PPL(As) in accordance with A.1(b) of Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation; Have valid type ratings included in the Part-FCL licence based upon valid airship ratings in the UK licence or if the pilot does not have a valid airship rating in the UK licence comply with FCL.740(b) in an airship for which an aircraft rating is included in the UK licence. Extension of privileges to night ying Holders of UK CPL(As) are qualied to y at night. On conversion to a Part FCL PPL(As) or CPL(As), a Night Rating will be included provided the pilot has been assessed as colour safe in accordance with MED.A.030(e).
3.
4. 5.
6.
7.
15 October 2013
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence PPL(As) 8. Extension of privileges to instructing There are no holders of UK instructor ratings for airships and so no conversion criteria are needed. 9. Conversion of UK issued examiner authorisations to Part-FCL examiner certicates There is only one UK licence holder in the UK who has an airship examiner authorisation. If a conversion is required terms specic to the individual will be established and notied to the Agency.
UK CPL(As)
CPL(As)
1. 2.
Hold a UK CPL(As). Hold a class 2 or class 1 medical certicate issued in accordance with Part Med (MED.A.030. Any limitation arising from the holders medical status will appear on the medical certicate); To be issued with a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence an individual must full the EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew at Level 4, 5, or 6. A person without a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence is not authorised to use a radio in an aircraft. The holder of an existing valid UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence will be accepted as qualifying for a Level 4 (expiring) language prociency endorsement; Have knowledge of the parts of Part-Ops and Part FCL relevant to the CPL(As) in accordance with A.1(b) of Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation; Full the ying experience requirements for licence issue stipulated in Appendix 3 to Part-FCL, Section N, CPL Modular Course, Paragraph 10 Have valid type ratings included in the Part-FCL licence based upon valid airship ratings in the UK licence or if the pilot does not have a valid airship rating in the UK licence comply with FCL.740(b) in an airship for which an aircraft rating is included in the UK licence. Extension of privileges to night ying Holders of UK CPL(As) are qualied to y at night. On conversion to a Part FCL PPL(As) or CPL(As), a Night Rating will be included provided the pilot has been assessed as colour safe in accordance with MED.A.030(e).
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
15 October 2013
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence CPL(As) 8. Extension of privileges to instructing There are no holders of UK instructor ratings for airships and so no conversion criteria are needed. Conversion of UK issued examiner authorisations to Part-FCL examiner certicates There is only one UK licence holder in the UK who has an airship examiner authorisation. If a conversion is required terms specic to the individual will be established and notied to the Agency.
9.
Any microlight licence (that has contained no privilege other than to y microlight aeroplanes)
No EASA equivalent
The holder of a UK issue Microlight licence may convert their licence to a Part-FCL LAPL(A) or PPL(A), by rst satisfying the requirement to convert from a UK Microlight licence to a UK NPPL(A) with an SSEA or SLMG rating, and additionally meeting the requirements for the conversion of a NPPL(A) SSEA or SLMG to a Part-FCL LAPL(A) or PPL(A), by satisfying the conversion requirements as set out in this Part. As currently. 1. Hold a BGA Bronze Endorsement and BGA Cross Country endorsement or in lieu of the latter have achieved the Fdration Aronautique Internationale (FAI) Silver (Badge) Distance; Hold a LAPL medical certicate (or Class 1 or Class 2 medical certicate) issued in accordance with Part MED (MED.A.030). Any limitation arising from the holders medical status will appear on the medical certicate; The holder of a UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators privileges will have those privileges included in the LAPL(S). The holder must full the EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew at Level 4, 5, or 6 for the radiotelephony privileges to be usable. Have knowledge of the sections of Part OPS and Part-FCL relevant to the LAPL(S) with in accordance with A.1(b) of Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation; Comply with FCL.105.S(b) LAPL(S) Privileges and Conditions on issue of the Part-FCL LAPL(S) in order to be entitled to carry passengers. i.e.:
2.
3.
4.
5.
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO BGA Gliding Certicates continued
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence Part-FCL LAPL(S) FCL.105.S LAPL(S) Privileges and conditions (b) Holders of a LAPL(S) shall only carry passengers after they have completed, after the issuance of the licence, 10 hours of ight time or 30 launches as PIC on sailplanes or powered sailplanes. Flight time or launches as PIC completed since the issue of BGA Bronze Endorsement shall be credited towards fullling this requirement. And comply with FCL.060(b), i.e.: FCL.060 Recent experience (b) Aeroplanes, helicopters, powered-lift, airships and sailplanes. A pilot shall not operate an aircraft in commercial air transport or carrying passengers: (1) as PIC or co-pilot unless he/she has carried out, in the preceding 90 days, at least 3 take-offs, approaches and landings in an aircraft of the same type or class or an FFS representing that type or class. The 3 take-offs and landings shall be performed in either multi-pilot or single-pilot operations, depending on the privileges held by the pilot; and (2) as PIC at night unless he/she: (i) has carried out in the preceding 90 days at least 1 take-off, approach and landing at night as a pilot ying in an aircraft of the same type or class or an FFS representing that type or class; or (ii) holds an IR; 6. In order to obtain Launch Method endorsement(s), have achieved in accordance with BGA arrangements, the following: Winch and car launch: 20 launches as PIC; Aero tow launch: 12 launches as PIC; Bungee launch: 3 launches as PIC; Self Launch: Hold an NPPL(A) with SLMG rating If not qualifying for a particular launch method at the time of licence conversion, the additional launch method may be added later when the applicant complies with FCL.130.S(a). Because the United Kingdom has applied a derogation not to apply the provisions of Part-FCL in respect of sailplanes until 8 April 2015, the requirement at FCL.130.S(a) may be complied with by ying with a BGA instructor. This arrangement is necessary to permit an orderly transition from a position where no sailplane pilot or instructor holds a Part-FCL licence to one where all who wish to y EASA sailplanes from 8 April 2015 will hold such licences.
Section 4 Part P Page 33
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO BGA Gliding Certicates continued
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence Part-FCL LAPL(S) 7. In order to maintain privileges in each launch method on conversion, comply with FCL.130.S(c) and (d), i.e.: FCL.130.S LAPL(S) Launch methods (c) In order to maintain their privileges in each launch method, pilots shall complete a minimum of 5 launches during the last 24 months, except for bungee launch, in which case pilots shall have completed only 2 launches. (d) When the pilot does not comply with the requirement in (c), he/she shall perform the additional number of launches ying dual or solo under the supervision of an instructor in order to renew the privileges. Because the United Kingdom has applied a derogation not to apply the provisions of Part-FCL in respect of sailplanes until 8 April 2015, the requirement at FCL.130.S(d) may be complied with by ying with a BGA instructor. This arrangement is necessary to permit an orderly transition from a position where no sailplane pilot or instructor holds a Part-FCL licence to one where all who wish to y EASA sailplanes from 8 April 2015 will hold such licences. In order to extend the privileges of the LAPL(S) to TMG: (a) Hold an NPPL(A) with valid SLMG rating and provide evidence of having own SLMGs that are TMGs; (b) If the privileges of the LAPL(S) are extended to TMGs, the applicant is entitled to the Self Launch Method endorsement without supplying further evidence. On conversion at issue, comply with FCL.140.S, i.e: FCL.140.S LAPL(S) Recency requirements (a) Sailplanes and powered sailplanes. Holders of an LAPL(S) shall only exercise the privileges of their licence on sailplanes or powered sailplanes when they have completed on sailplanes or powered sailplanes, excluding TMGs, in the last 24 months, at least: (1) 5 hours of ight time as PIC, including 15 launches; (2) 2 training ights with an instructor.
8.
9.
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO BGA Gliding Certicates continued
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence Part-FCL LAPL(S) (b) TMG. Holders of a LAPL(S) shall only exercise the privileges of their licence on a TMG when they have: (1) completed in a TMG in the last 24 months: (i) at least 12 hours of ight time as PIC, including 12 take offs and landings; and (ii) refresher training of at least 1 hour total ight time with an instructor. (2) When the holder of a LAPL(S) also has the privileges to y aeroplanes, the requirements in (1) may be completed in aeroplanes. (c) Holders of an LAPL(S) who do not comply with the requirements in (a) or (b) shall, before they resume the exercise of their privileges: (1) pass a prociency check with an examiner on a sailplane or a TMG , as appropriate; or (2) perform the additional ight time or take-offs and landings, ying dual or solo under the supervision of an instructor, in order to full the requirements in (a) or (b). Because the United Kingdom has applied a derogation not to apply the provisions of Part-FCL in respect of sailplanes until 8 April 2015, requirements at FCL.140.S(a)(2), (b)(1)(ii) and (c) may be completed with UK nationally qualied instructors or examiners. This arrangement is necessary to permit an orderly transition from a position where no sailplane pilot or instructor holds a Part-FCL licence to one where all who wish to y EASA sailplanes from 8 April 2015 will hold such licences. 1. Hold a BGA Bronze Endorsement and BGA Cross Country endorsement or in lieu of the latter have achieved the Fdration Aronautique Internationale (FAI) Silver (Badge) Distance; Hold a Class 2 (or Class 1) medical certicate issued in accordance with Part MED (MED.A.030). Any limitation arising from the holders medical status will appear on the medical certicate; The holder of UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators privileges will have those privileges included in the SPL. The holder must full the EASA Language Prociency Requirements for Flight Crew at Level 4, 5, or 6 for the radiotelephony privileges to be usable.
Part-FCL SPL
2.
3.
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO BGA Gliding Certicates continued
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence Part-FCL SPL 4. Have knowledge of the sections of Part OPS and Part-FCL relevant to the SPL in accordance with A.1(b) of Annex II to the EASA Aircrew Regulation; Comply with FCL.205.S(b)(1) SPL Privileges and Conditions on issue of the Part-FCL SPL in order to be entitled to carry passengers. i.e.: FCL.205.S SPL Privileges and conditions (b) Holders of an SPL shall: (1) carry passengers only after they have completed, after the issuance of the licence, 10 hours of ight time or 30 launches as PIC on sailplanes or powered sailplanes. Flight time or launches as PIC completed since the issue of BGA Bronze Endorsement shall be credited towards fullling this requirement. And comply with FCL.060(b), i.e.: FCL.060 Recent experience (b) Aeroplanes, helicopters, powered-lift, airships and sailplanes. A pilot shall not operate an aircraft in commercial air transport or carrying passengers: (1) as PIC or co-pilot unless he/she has carried out, in the preceding 90 days, at least 3 take-offs, approaches and landings in an aircraft of the same type or class or an FFS representing that type or class. The 3 take-offs and landings shall be performed in either multi-pilot or single-pilot operations, depending on the privileges held by the pilot; and (2) as PIC at night unless he/she: (i) has carried out in the preceding 90 days at least 1 take-off, approach and landing at night as a pilot ying in an aircraft of the same type or class or an FFS representing that type or class; or (ii) holds an IR; In order to obtain Launch Method endorsement(s), have achieved in accordance with BGA arrangements, the following: Winch and car launch: 20 launches as PIC; Aero tow launch: 12 launches as PIC; Bungee launch: 3 launches as PIC; Self Launch: Hold an NPPL(A) with SLMG rating.
5.
6.
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO BGA Gliding Certicates continued
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence Part-FCL SPL If not qualifying for particular a launch method at the time of licence conversion, the additional launch method may be added later when the applicant shall complies with FCL.130.S(a). Because the United Kingdom has applied a derogation not to apply the provisions of Part-FCL in respect of sailplanes until 8 April 2015, the requirement at FCL.130.S(a) may be complied with by ying with a BGA instructor. This arrangement is necessary to permit an orderly transition from a position where no sailplane pilot or instructor holds a Part-FCL licence to one where all who wish to y EASA sailplanes from 8 April 2015 will hold such licences. In order to maintain privileges in each launch method on conversion, comply with FCL.130.S(c) and (d), i.e.: FCL.130.S LAPL(S) Launch methods (c) In order to maintain their privileges in each launch method, pilots shall complete a minimum of 5 launches during the last 24 months, except for bungee launch, in which case pilots shall have completed only 2 launches. (d) When the pilot does not comply with the requirement in (c), he/she shall perform the additional number of launches ying dual or solo under the supervision of an instructor in order to renew the privileges Because the United Kingdom has applied a derogation not to apply the provisions of Part-FCL in respect of sailplanes until 8 April 2015, the requirement at FCL.130.S(d) may be complied with by ying with a BGA instructor. This arrangement is necessary to permit an orderly transition from a position where no sailplane pilot or instructor holds a Part-FCL licence to one where all who wish to y EASA sailplanes from 8 April 2015 will hold such licences. In order to extend the privileges of the SPL to TMG: (a) Hold an NPPL(A) with valid SLMG rating and provide evidence of having own SLMGs that are TMGs; (b) If the privileges of the SPL are extended to TMGs, the applicant is entitled to the Self Launch Method endorsement without supplying further evidence.
7.
8.
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO BGA Gliding Certicates continued
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence Part-FCL SPL 9. On conversion at issue, comply with FCL.140.S, i.e: FCL.140.S LAPL(S) Recency requirements (a) Sailplanes and powered sailplanes. Holders of an LAPL(S) shall only exercise the privileges of their licence on sailplanes or powered sailplanes when they have completed on sailplanes or powered sailplanes, excluding TMGs, in the last 24 months, at least: (1) 5 hours of ight time as PIC, including 15 launches; (2) 2 training ights with an instructor. (b) TMG. Holders of a LAPL(S) shall only exercise the privileges of their licence on a TMG when they have: (1) completed in a TMG in the last 24 months: (i) at least 12 hours of ight time as PIC, including 12 take offs and landings; and (ii) refresher training of at least 1 hour total ight time with an instructor. (2) When the holder of a LAPL(S) also has the privileges to y aeroplanes, the requirements in (1) may be completed in aeroplanes. (c) Holders of an LAPL(S) who do not comply with the requirements in (a) or (b) shall, before they resume the exercise of their privileges: (1) pass a prociency check with an examiner on a sailplane or a TMG, as appropriate; or (2) perform the additional ight time or take-offs and landings, ying dual or solo under the supervision of an instructor, in order to full the requirements in (a) or (b). Because the United Kingdom has applied a derogation not to apply the provisions of Part-FCL in respect of sailplanes until 8 April 2015, requirements at FCL.140.S(a)(2), (b)(1)(ii) and (c) may be completed with UK nationally qualied instructors or examiners. This arrangement is necessary to permit an orderly transition from a position where no sailplane pilot or instructor holds a Part-FCL licence to one where all who wish to y EASA sailplanes from 8 April 2015 will hold such licences.
15 October 2013
Licence previously issued under the ANO BGA Gliding Certicates continued
Conversion to Requirements Part-FCL Licence Part-FCL SPL 10. On conversion, the SPL shall be endorsed with the restriction at FCL.205.S(b)(2) such that FCL.205.S(b)(2) and (c) shall apply. This restriction shall be removed on fullling the requirements for its removal as set out in FCL.205.S(b)(2).
Conversion Requirements Hold a valid IMC rating prior to 8April 2014; or a UK CPL(A)/ ATPL(A) issued prior to 1 July 2000. The requirement of Part-MED, MED.A.030(g) shall not apply to the IR(R). Hold a valid FI(A) No Applied IF Hold a valid FI(A), IR(A) Hold a valid FI(A) and a valid IMC rating prior to 8 April 2014; or a UK CPL(A)/ATPL(A) issued prior to 1 July 2000. The requirement of Part-MED, MED.A.030(g) shall not apply to the IR(R). Hold a valid FI(H) No Applied IF Hold a valid FI(H), IR(H) Hold a valid AFI(A)/(H) 1. Have qualied for a LAPL(S) or SPL in accordance with the conversion terms set out in this Part. 2. Be at least 18 years of age. 3. Have at least 100 hours ight time and 200 launches as PIC in sailplanes.
FI(A) without instrument instruction privileges FI(A) with the privilege to instruct for the IR(A) FI(A) with the privilege to instruct for the IR(Restricted) UK only
FI(H) without instrument instruction privileges FI(H) with the privilege to instruct for the IR(H) FI (A)/(H) Restricted - no instrument ight instruction privileges FI(S)
15 October 2013
Rating Previously issued under the ANO BGA Gliding Certicates continued
Conversion Requirements 4. Hold a BGA Flight Instructor Rating at Assistant or Full level. The privileges granted will be those at FCL.905.FI(a) and (b) as applicable to the FI(S). If the holder of a BGA Assistant Flight Instructor Rating has NOT completed the BGA Approved Assistant Instructor Rating Completion Course, the FI(S) will be issued with Restricted Privileges per FCL.910.FI. The privileges granted will be those at FCL.910.FI(a)(1) and (3) as applicable to the FI(S) with restricted privileges. 5. The privileges of an FI(S) without Restricted Privileges may be extended to conduct ight instruction for the FI(S), per FCL.905.FI(i), if the applicant has completed at least 50 hours or 150 launches as a ight instructor with evidence from logbook entries and is conrmed by the BGA as competent with reference to FCL.935 to instruct for instructor qualications. 6. The privileges of an FI(S) with or without Restricted Privileges may be extended to giving instruction in only gliding exercises in TMGs where the applicant qualies for a TMG class endorsement and: (a) Has at least 30 hours as PIC in TMGs (b) Is the holder of a BGA MGIR (Motor Glider Instructor Rating). The limitation to giving instruction in only gliding exercises shall be removed on completion of an assessment of competence in accordance with FCL.935 with an FI qualied in accordance with FCL.905.FI.
15 October 2013
Rating Previously issued under the ANO BGA Gliding Certicates continued
Conversion Requirements 7. The privileges of the FI(S) may be extended to instruct on TMGs without the limitation to giving instruction in only gliding exercises (i.e. to give the instructing privileges on TMGs at FCL.915.FI(e)) if the applicant holds a valid FI(SLMG) in a valid NPPL(A) with valid medical certicate and valid SLMG rating. 8. The privileges of the FI(S) with or without Restricted Privileges may be extended to instruct for the Aerobatic Rating if the applicant holds a BGA Aerobatic Instructor Endorsement. 9. On conversion, the initial validity shall be determined from the last revalidation by the BGA of the BGA Instructor Certicate being converted or if also qualifying for the extension of the FI(S) to TMGs, from the last revalidation of the FI(SLMG) by the BGA (last competency ight test), whichever is the later. 1. Have qualied for a LAPL(S) or SPL and an FI(S) in accordance with the conversion terms set out in this Part. To become an FIE(S), have in addition qualied to give instruction for the FI(S). 2. Hold a valid BGA FE and/or FIE authorisation as required for the Part-FCL examiner certicate sought. 3. Complete a UK CAA Part-FCL Examiner Standardisation Course if not already done so. 4. The privileges of the Part-FCL examiner certicate shall reect the BGA examining privileges held.
15 October 2013
Rating Previously issued under the ANO BGA Gliding Certicates continued
Conversion Requirements 5. In the case of the FE(S): (a) The privileges at FCL.1005.FE(d)(1) will be granted on initial conversion. (b) The privileges at FCL.1005.FE(d)(2) may be added when the examiner is the holder of an SPL; the restriction to act without remuneration on non commercial operations has been removed in accordance with FCL.205.S(b)(2) and the examiner meets the experience requirements set out in FCL.1005.FE(d) (2). (c) The privileges at FCL.1005.FE(d)(3) may be added when the examiners LAPL(S) or SPL and FI(S) include the TMG class extension and the examiner either meets the experience requirements set out in FCL.1005.FE(d)(3) or is the holder of a valid UK FE(SLMG) authorisation. 6. In the case of the FIE(S): (a) The privilege to conduct assessment of competence for an FI(S) without TMG extension will be granted on initial conversion. (b) The privilege to conduct assessments of competence in TMGs may be granted when the examiners LAPL(S) or SPL and FI(S) includes the TMG extension and the examiner either meets the experience requirements of FCL.1010.FIE(d)(3)(1) or is the holder of a valid UK FIE(SLMG) authorisation.
15 October 2013
Rating Previously issued under the ANO BGA Gliding Certicates continued
Conversion Requirements 7. On conversion, the initial validity shall be determined from either: (a) the most recent revalidation of the BGA examiner authorisation being converted; or (b) if also qualifying for the extension of the FE(S) or FIE(S) to TMGs, on the basis of holding a UK SLMG examiner authorisation, the validity shall be determined from the last revalidation of the FE(SLMG) or the FIE(SLMG) authorisation (last competency ight test), whichever is the later. 8. Examiners who do not have valid UK national examiner privileges shall full the requirements of FCL.1025. Where an examiner has partially fullled UK national requirements, these may be credited to comply with the requirements of FCL.1025 (b) (1), (b)(2) and (b)(3) or (c) respectively for the rst issue of a Part FCL examiner certicate. The sailplane towing standards in the UK, established by the BGA, are competency based. They have been found to be equivalent to those of Part-FCL, particularly in respect of the ying experience and theoretical knowledge requirements. These are detailed in the Comparison Tables in Section 4. The differences identied in the Comparison Table have been collated into the requirements for conversion for each case. In accordance with FCL.805(d) the ratings shall be granted for aeroplanes or TMGs depending upon the evidence submitted.
15 October 2013
Rating Previously issued under the ANO BGA Gliding Certicates continued
Conversion Requirements A Part-FCL Sailplane Towing Rating will be granted to pilots who: a) Prior to the 8th April 2015, convert their UK issued licence to a Part-FCL licence. b) Have qualied to tow through a BGA gliding club, and c) Show logbook evidence of at least 30 hours of ight time as PIC and 60 take-offs and landings in aeroplanes, if the activity is to be carried out in aeroplane, or in TMG, if the activity is to be carried out in TMGs, completed after the issue of the UK licence, and d) Show logbook evidence of at least 10 ights as PIC towing a sailplane in an Aeroplane at a BGA Club. The Sailplane Towing Rating will be restricted to Aeroplanes only. e) Show logbook evidence of at least 10 ights as PIC towing a sailplane in a TMG at a BGA Club. The Sailplane Towing Rating will be restricted to TMGs only. Once the Sailplane Towing rating has been endorsed on to a Part-FCL licence and prior to exercising the privileges the tug pilot will ensure they comply with FCL.805(e) as detailed in Section 4. Where the tug pilot does not comply with the requirements in FCL.805(e), before resuming the exercise of their privileges they shall complete the missing tows with or under the supervision of an instructor. Prior to the 8th April 2015, the instructor who conducts the supervision in paragraph 3.3 above, can be the nominated Chief Tug Pilot at the Gliding Club.
15 October 2013
Rating Previously issued under the ANO BGA Gliding Certicates continued
Conversion Requirements There is a need to ensure that those pilots who have coached other pilots to tow sailplanes can continue under Part-FCL. As such an extension of any existing Flight Instructor (FI) or Class Rating Instructor Certicate (CRI) to include privileges to instruct for the Sailplane Towing Rating will be granted to pilots who: a) Are subject to a recommendation from their BGA club CFI indicating that pilot had taught other pilots to tow sailplanes, b) Hold or have held a FI or CRI in the appropriate category to which the Towing Rating applies, c) Hold a Sailplane Towing Rating. The CRI will be issued with the following restriction, FCL.905. CRI(a)(2). Pilots issued with this certicate will not be able to exercise the full privileges of the CRI unless they extend the privileges. To extend the CRI to the full privileges they will be required to complete the full CRI course, in accordance with FCL.930.CRI and pass an Assessment of Competence in accordance with FCL.935. They will be required to apply to the CAA for issue of the full CRI. Instructor Certicates are issued for 3 years, unless the pilot holds an existing FI or CRI, the restricted CRI will be issued for 3 years from the date of conversion. Prior to the rst revalidation or renewal of the restricted CRI, the requirements of paragraph 3.9 shall be met to allow the CRI to continue to instruct.
15 October 2013
Rating Previously issued under the ANO Aerobatic Privileges exercised on UK National/JAR-FCL licence
Conversion Requirements 1. Have received the theoretical knowledge specied in AMC No 1 to FCL.800, and sign to that effect on their application; and 2. comply with any one of the following: (a) Pilots who have completed the AOPA/BAeA aerobatic course shall submit evidence of satisfactory completion of the course; (b) Pilots who hold or have held a UK Display Authorisation, which includes/included authorisation to perform aerobatics at a display shall submit a copy of the Display Authorisation; (c) Pilots who have completed aerobatic training with the United Kingdom military forces (other than the British Army) shall submit evidence of having completed satisfactorily, either: (i) the UK RAF Elementary Flying Training course; or (ii) the UK RN Elementary Flying Training course; or (iii) a UK military Basic Fast Jet Flying Training course; (d) Pilots who have own aerobatic manoeuvres at a BAeA sanctioned event (including glider events) shall provide evidence (other than log book records) of having own aerobatic manoeuvres at such an event;
15 October 2013
Rating Previously issued under the ANO Aerobatic Privileges exercised on UK National/JAR-FCL licence continued
Conversion Requirements (e) Pilots with FI or AFI ratings who have had the no aerobatic restriction removed following compliance with UK requirements to instruct aerobatics; (f) Glider pilots who have completed any of the BGAs aerobatic courses shall submit evidence of satisfactory completion of the course. 3. Aerobatic ratings may also be granted to pilots who apply on the basis of experience of ying aerobatics alone if they: (a) provide certied log book evidence of at least 5 hours of aerobatic ying in aeroplanes or gliders that have airworthiness certication for at least the manoeuvres specied in FCL.800; and (b) demonstrate to an instructor with the privilege to instruct in aerobatics (see Note 1): (i) the aerobatic manoeuvres listed in AMC 1 to FCL 800; and (ii) evidence of having the theoretical knowledge specied in AMC 1 to FCL 800; and provide with their application a statement from that instructor that they completed those manoeuvres competently and safely and have the requisite knowledge. Note 1: the instructor shall be an FI or AFI who holds aerobatic instructional privileges, or a CRI who complies with the requirements of FCL.905. CRI(a)(2)
15 October 2013
Additional Information
None.
15 October 2013
Part Q
Validation and Conversion of Non-EASA licences issued by States other than the UK
1 Applicability
The Basic EASA Regulation and the EASA Aircrew Regulation requires all pilots: a) ying an EASA aircraft registered in the EU; or b) ying an EASA aircraft registered in a State outside the EU but whose operator is resident or established in the EU; to hold either an EASA licence, or a non-EU licence that is validated by an EU Member State in accordance with the EASA Aircrew Regulation. The EASA Aircrew Regulation provides for Member States not to require the validation of non-EU licences for non-commercial ights in accordance with EU regulations until 8 April 2014. National regulations may continue to apply until that date. The United Kingdom will apply the provisions of the Aircrew Regulation for the validation of licences for commercial ights by non-EU licence holders with effect from 17 September 2012. UK legislation has always required the validation of foreign licences to y UK registered aircraft for commercial purposes. The EU regulations differ in that the validation of foreign licences is required to y foreign registered aircraft if the operator is based in the EU. For example, if a UK AOC holder is to use pilots with FAA licences to y a US registered aircraft for commercial purposes, those pilots must have their licences validated by the CAA in accordance with the Part-FCL Regulation. Another signicant difference between the Part-FCL Regulation and current UK rules is that under EU rules an individual licence holder may only obtain a validation once, and it is time limited.
2 Privileges
When a validation of a licence is issued by any EASA state, the validated licence has the same privileges as the equivalent Part-FCL licence.
27 July 2012
3 Requirements
Article 62 of the Air Navigation Order grants a permanent general validation to all nonUK licence holders to allow them to y UK-registered aircraft, provided that the ight is for non-commercial purposes and the licence holder does not receive remuneration for the ight. The EASA Aircrew Regulation will override Article 62 in respect of EASA aircraft being own for non-commercial purposes from 8 April 2014. 3.1 3.2 For any non-private ight the European requirements apply in the UK from 17 September 2012. The validation requirements are set out in Annex III to the EASA Aircrew Regulation. The general requirements that apply are: a) the licence to be validated must be compliant with ICAO Annex 1; b) application may only be made to the NAA of the country where the pilot is resident, or where the operator they will y for has its principal place of business; c) third country pilots intending to y a UK registered aircraft that is leased to an Operator located outside of the EU must obtain a licence validation from the UK CAA. This derogation has been notied to the Commission as follows: In accordance with Article 14(6) of Regulation (EC) 216/2008 of the European Parliament and of the Council any holder of a pilot licence issued in compliance with the requirements of Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention who intends to y an aircraft registered in the United Kingdom for an operator whose principal place of business is located outside the territories of the Member States is exempt from the requirement of paragraph A(1) of Annex III Commission Regulation (EU) No 1178/2011 to apply to the Competent Authority dened in that requirement, provided that a validation of the licence is obtained from the United Kingdom Civil Aviation Authority; d) the period of validation will not exceed one year; e) no repeat validations are allowed; f) a validation can be extended once only, by the competent authority (NAA) that issued it, in order to allow a reasonable time for the pilot to obtain an EASA licence. The extension will only be given if the pilot concerned has commenced training for an EASA licence. The period of the extension will not be excessive, taking into account the requirements to be complied with to be granted an EASA licence.
27 July 2012
In Tables: > means more than; < means less than; > _ means at least. 3.3 ANNEX III to Part-FCL
CONDITIONS FOR THE ACCEPTANCE OF LICENCES ISSUED BY OR ON BEHALF OF THIRD COUNTRIES A. General 1 A pilot licence issued in compliance with the requirements of Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention by a third country may be validated by the competent authority of a Member State. Pilots shall apply to the competent authority of the Member State where they reside or are established, or, if they are not residing in the territory of the Member States, where the operator for which they are ying or intend to y has its principal place of business. 2 The period of validation of a licence shall not exceed 1 year; the Annex I licence must remain valid. This period may only be extended once by the competent authority that issued the validation when, during the validation period, the pilot has applied, or is undergoing training, for the issuance of a licence in accordance with Part-FCL. This extension shall cover the period of time necessary for the licence to be issued in accordance with Part-FCL. The holders of a licence accepted by a Member State shall exercise their privileges in accordance with the requirements stated in Part-FCL. Pilot licences for commercial air transport and other commercial activities 3 In the case of pilot licences for commercial air transport and other commercial activities, the holder shall comply with the following requirements: (a) complete, as a skill test, the type or class rating revalidation requirements of Part-FCL relevant to the privileges of the licence held; (b) demonstrate that he/she has acquired knowledge of the relevant parts of Part-OPS and Part-FCL; (c) demonstrate that he/she has acquired knowledge of English in accordance with FCL.055; (d) hold a valid Class 1 medical certicate, issued in accordance with Part-Medical; (e) in the case of aeroplanes, comply with the experience requirements set out in the following table: VALIDATION OF LICENCES
Ref.
Total ying hours experience (2) >1500 hours as PIC on multi-pilot aeroplanes >1500 hours as PIC or co-pilot on multi-pilot aeroplanes according to operational requirements >1000 hours as PIC in commercial air transport since gaining an IR >1000 hours as PIC or as co-pilot in single-pilot aeroplanes according to operational requirements
Privileges (3) Commercial air transport in multi-pilot aeroplanes as PIC Commercial air transport in multi-pilot aeroplanes as co-pilot Commercial air transport in single-pilot aeroplanes as PIC Commercial air transport in single-pilot aeroplanes as co-pilot according to PartOPS
(a) (b)
(c) (d)
CPL(A)/IR CPL(A)/IR
15 October 2013
Ref. (e)
Total ying hours experience >700 hours in aeroplanes other than TMGs, including 200 hours in the activity role for which acceptance is sought, and 50 hours in that role in the last 12 months >1500 hours as PIC in commercial air transport including 500 hours on seaplane operations
Privileges Exercise of privileges in aeroplanes in operations other than commercial air transport Commercial air transport in single-pilot aeroplanes as PIC
(f)
CPL(A)
* CPL(A)/IR holders on multi-pilot aeroplanes shall have demonstrated ICAO ATPL(A) level knowledge before acceptance. (f) in the case of helicopters, comply with the experience requirements set out in the following table:
Ref. Licence held (1) (a) ATPL(H) valid IR Total ying hours experience (2) >1000 hours as PIC on multi-pilot helicopters >1000 hours as PIC on multi-pilot helicopters >1000 hours as pilot on multi-pilot helicopters Privileges (3) Commercial air transport in multi-pilot helicopters as PIC in VFR and IFR operations Commercial air transport in multi-pilot helicopters as PIC in VFR operations Commercial air transport in multi-pilot helicopters as co-pilot in VFR and IFR operations Commercial air transport in multi-pilot helicopters as co-pilot in VFR operations Commercial air transport in multi-pilot helicopters as co-pilot Commercial air transport in single-pilot helicopters as PIC Exercise of privileges in helicopters in operations other than commercial air transport
(b)
(c)
(d)
>1000 hours as pilot on multi-pilot helicopters >1000 hours as pilot on multi-pilot helicopters >1000 hours as PIC in commercial air transport since gaining an IR >700 hours in helicopters other than those certicated under CS-27/29 or equivalent, including 200 hours in the activity role for which acceptance is sought, and 50 hours in that role in the last 12 months
(e)
(f) (g)
* CPL(H)/IR holders on multi-pilot helicopters shall have demonstrated ICAO ATPL level theoretical knowledge before acceptance.
May 2012
Pilot licences for non-commercial activities with an instrument rating 4 In the case of private pilot licences with an instrument rating, or CPL and ATPL licences with an instrument rating where the pilot intends only to exercise private pilot privileges, the holder shall comply with the following requirements: (a) complete the skill test for instrument rating and the type or class ratings relevant to the privileges of the licence held, in accordance with Appendix 7 and Appendix 9 to PartFCL; (b) demonstrate that he/she has acquired knowledge of Air Law, Aeronautical Weather Codes, Flight Planning and Performance (IR), and Human Performance; (c) demonstrate that he/she has acquired knowledge of English in accordance with FCL.055; (d) hold at least a valid Class 2 medical certicate issued in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention; (e) have a minimum experience of at least 100 hours of instrument ight time as pilot-incommand in the relevant category of aircraft. Pilot licences for non-commercial activities without an instrument rating 5 In the case of private pilot licences, or CPL and ATPL licences without an instrument rating where the pilot intends only to exercise private pilot privileges, the holder shall comply with the following requirements: (a) demonstrate that he/she has acquired knowledge of Air Law and Human Performance; (b) pass the PPL skill test as set out in Part-FCL; (c) full the relevant requirements of Part-FCL for the issuance of a type or class rating as relevant to the privileges of the licence held; (d) hold at least a Class 2 medical certicate issued in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention; (e) demonstrate that he/she has acquired language prociency in accordance with FCL.055; (f) have a minimum experience of at least 100 hours as pilot in the relevant category of aircraft. Validation of pilot licences for specic tasks of limited duration 6 Notwithstanding the provisions of the paragraphs above, in the case of manufacturer ights, Member States may accept a licence issued in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention by a third country for a maximum of 12 months for specic tasks of limited duration, such as instruction ights for initial entry into service, demonstration, ferry or test ights, provided the applicant complies with the following requirements: (a) holds an appropriate licence and medical certicate and associated ratings or qualications issued in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention; (b) is employed, directly or indirectly, by an aeroplane manufacturer. In this case, the privileges of the holder shall be limited to performing ight instruction and testing for initial issue of type ratings, the supervision of initial line ying by the operators pilots, delivery or ferry ights, initial line ying, ight demonstrations or test ights.
May 2012
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Article 8 of the Aircrew regulation Conditions for the acceptance of licences from third countries
(1) Without prejudice to Article 12 of Regulation (EC) No 216/2008 and where there are no agreements concluded between the Union and a third country covering pilot licensing, Member States may accept third country licences, and associated medical certicates issued by or on behalf of third countries, in accordance with the provisions of Annex III to this Regulation. Applicants for PartFCL licences already holding at least an equivalent licence, rating or certicate issued in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention by a third country shall comply with all the requirements of Annex I to this Regulation, except that the requirements of course duration, number of lessons and specic training hours may be reduced. The credit given to the applicant shall be determined by the Member State to which the pilot applies on the basis of a recommendation from an approved training organisation.
(2)
(3)
Explanatory note: A holder of a valid ICAO licence seeking to convert to an equivalent Part-FCL licence must comply with all the requirements of Part-FCL. They may have their training course requirements reduced as per 1(2&3); but they must pass the Part-FCL applicable theoretical knowledge exams and pass the Part-FCL Skill test as set out in Appendix9. 1.1 1.1.1 Alternative Means of Compliance Conversion of ICAO Licences and Ratings to Part-FCL Licences and Ratings In accordance with the provisions of Article 8 (2 & 3) of EU Regulation 1178/2011 applicants for Part-FCL licences already holding an equivalent licence, rating or certicate issued in accordance with Annex I of the Chicago Convention may be given credit towards meeting the requirements of Part-FCL. The credit given to the applicant shall be determined by the Member State on the basis of a recommendation from an Approved Training Organisation. The UK CAA is applying the following policy which may be utilised by an ATO conducting conversion training on ICAO licence holders for a Part-FCL CPL (A) or (H), IR(A) or (H) and/or Flight Instructor Certicates (A) or (H), to be issued by the UK CAA without seeking prior approval from the Authority for each individual applicant. These arrangements provide a route to a UK CAA-issued Part-FCL CPL (A) or (H) , IR(A) or (H) and/or Flight Instructor Certicates (A) or (H), qualication for the holders of a
15 October 2013
current and valid ICAO CPL (A) or (H), IR(A) or (H) and/or ICAO Flight Instructor Rating (A) or (H), as applicable, issued in accordance with ICAO Annex 1. The Aircrew Regulation requires that the holder of an ICAO licence shall attend an Approved Training Organisation and complete an approved modular course of CPL (A) or (H), IR(A) or (H) and/or Flight Instructor (A) or (H) ying training, as applicable. If on the basis of assessment by the ATO the course is to be reduced, but not to less than the minima set out below, the determination of acceptability by the CAA as required by Article 8 may be assumed. If during the training course the Head of Training of the ATO determines that completion of the reduced course requirements set out in this part is unwarranted, the Head of Training may make a written recommendation for a further reduction, and L&TS will give the recommendation consideration. Minimum course content without submission of a recommendation to the CAA. ICAO CPL (A) holder to Part-FCL CPL(A) Undertake Part-FCL CPL (A) or ATPL (A) theoretical knowledge instruction as determined by the Head of Training of an approved training provider and pass all Part-FCL theoretical knowledge examinations at CPL level. Applicants who wish to attempt the ATPL(A) examinations must undertake an approved ATPL(A) Modular theoretical knowledge course as set out in Part-FCL Appendix 3(B) and pass all Part-FCL ATPL(A) examinations. Complete at an Approved Training Organisation approved to conduct CPL modular courses the minimum ight time under instruction in an Aeroplane as outlined at 1.2.4 below. Pass the Part-FCL CPL (A) Skill Test. Minimum instruction depending upon total hours as pilot of aeroplanes: Level 1: Experience > 1000 hrs: Level 2: Experience 500 999 hrs: Level 3: Experience 250 499 hrs: Level 4: Experience 185 249 hrs: Level 5: Experience 155 184 hrs: Min 7 hrs Min 10 hrs Min 15 hrs Min 20 hrs Min 25 hrs (18 hrs credit) (15 hrs credit) (10 hrs credit) (5 hrs credit) (no credit)
1.2 1.2.1
1.2.2
ICAO CPL(H) holder to Part-FCL CPL(H) Undertake Part-FCL CPL (H) theoretical knowledge instruction as determined by t h e Head of Training of an approved training provider and pass all Part-FCL theoretical knowledge examinations at CPL level. Applicants who wish to attempt the ATPL(H) (VFR) examinations must undertake an approved ATPL(H) Modular theoretical knowledge course as set out in Part-FCL Appendix 3(H) and pass all Part-FCL ATPL(H) (VFR) examinations. Applicants who wish to attempt the ATPL(H) with IR examinations must undertake an approved ATPL(H)/IR Modular theoretical knowledge course as set out in Part-FCL Appendix 3(H) and pass all Part-FCL ATPL(H) with IR examinations. Complete at an Approved Training Organisation approved to conduct CPL modular courses the minimum ight time under instruction in a Helicopter as outlined at 1.3.4 below. Pass the Part-FCL CPL (H) skill test.
1.3.2
1.3.3
15 October 2013
Minimum instruction depending upon total hours as pilot of helicopters: Level 1: Experience > 1000 hrs: Level 2: Experience 500 999 hrs: Level 3: Experience 250 499 hrs: Level 4: Experience 185 249 hrs: Level 5: Experience 155 184 hrs: Min 7 hrs Min 10 hrs Min 15 hrs Min 20 hrs Min 25 hrs (23 hrs credit) (20 hrs credit) (15 hrs credit) (10 hrs credit) (5 hours credit)
ICAO IR(A) holder to Part-FCL IR(A) Undertake Part-FCL IR(A) theoretical knowledge instruction as determined by the Head of Training of an approved training provider and pass all Part-FCL theoretical knowledge examinations at IR level. Applicants who wish to attempt the ATPL(A) examinations must undertake an approved ATPL(A) Modular theoretical knowledge course as set out in Part-FCL Appendix 3(B) and pass all Part-FCL ATPL(A) examinations.
1.4.2 Complete a minimum of 15 hours instrument time under instruction including recommendation for test in accordance with the approved procedures of the ATO, of which 5 hours may be in a FNPT I or 10 hours in a FNPT II or Full Flight Simulator. 1.4.3 Holder of an ICAO IR obtained in a SE aeroplane seeking a Part-FCL ME IR(A) will be required to attend an approved IR(A) training provider. In addition to the training stated in 1.4.2, an applicant must comply with the Part-FCL requirements for an ME Class Rating and the Part-FCL SE(IR) to ME(IR) training course requirements of Part-FCL Appendix 6, (A)(9). Pass the Part-FCL IR(A) Skill Test in a SE or ME aeroplane, as applicable. ICAO IR(H) holder to Part-FCL IR(H)
1.4.7 1.5
1.5.1 Undertake Part-FCL-IR(H) theoretical knowledge instruction as determined by the Head of Training of an approved training provider and pass all Part-FCL theoretical knowledge examinations at IR level. Applicants who wish to attempt the ATPL(H) with IR examinations must undertake an approved ATPL(H)/IR Modular theoretical knowledge course set out in Part-FCL Appendix 3(H) and pass all Part-FCL ATPL(H) with IR examinations. 1.5.2 Complete a minimum of 15 hours instrument time under instruction including recommendation for test in accordance with the approved procedures of the ATO, of which 5 hours may be in a FNPT I or 10 hours in a FNPT II or Full Flight Simulator. 1.5.3 Holders of an IR(H) issued in accordance with ICAO Annex 1, but with privileges obtained on single-engine helicopters only, seeking a Part-FCL-FCL ME IR(H) will be required to attend an approved IR(H) training provider. In addition to the training stated in 1.5.2, an applicant must comply with the Part-FCL requirements for an ME Type Rating and the Part-FCL SE(IR) to ME(IR) training course requirements of Part-FCL FCL.630.H. Pass the Part-FCL IR(H) Skill Test a SE or ME Helicopter, as applicable. ICAO Flight Instructor Rating (A) or (H) holder to Part-FCL FI (A) or (H) Certicate Complete a course of at least 30 hours of ground instruction at an ATO holding an approval for the ight instructor course. The course shall be based on the requirements of FCL.930.FI (b)(1) and (2) and the associated AMC. Complete a minimum of 15 hours Flight Instruction including a recommendation for test at an ATO holding an approval for the ight instructor course. The ight instruction shall be based on the requirements of FCL.930.FI (3)(i) and the associated AMC and be conducted as dual instruction in an aircraft.
1.6.2
15 October 2013
1.6.3 1.6.4
Pass the Part-FCL FI(A) or (H) Assessment of Competence appropriate to the aircraft category. Applicants who can demonstrate they have met the experience requirements for the removal of restriction of FCL.910.FI on the basis of their ICAO Instructor rating may have the Part-FCL Instructor certicate issued without this restriction at initial issue. ICAO Flight Instructor Rating (A) or (H) holder to Part-FCL Instructor Certicate restricted to Instruction outside the territory of the Member States Complete a course of at least 30 hours of ground instruction at an ATO holding an approval for the ight instructor course. The course shall be based on the requirements of FCL.930.FI (b)(1) and (2) and the associated AMC. Complete a minimum of 15 hours Flight Instruction including recommendation for test at an ATO holding an approval for the ight instructor course. The ight instruction shall be based on the requirements of FCL.930.FI (3)(i) and the associated AMC and be conducted as dual instruction in an aircraft. Pass the Part-FCL FI(A) or (H) Assessment of Competence appropriate to the aircraft category. Applicants who can demonstrate they have met the experience requirements for the removal of restriction of FCL.910.FI on the basis of their ICAO Instructor rating may have the Part-FCL Instructor certicate issued without this restriction at initial issue. ICAO Instructor Ratings (A) or (H) holder to Part-FCL Instructor Certicates other than FI Certicates (TRI, CRI, IRI, SFI, MCCI, STI, MI, FTI) No Alternative Means of Compliance available. These must be subject to individual agreement. (4) Holders of an ATPL issued by or on behalf of a third country in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention who have completed the experience requirements for the issue of an ATPL in the relevant aircraft category as set out in Subpart F of Annex I to this Regulation may be given full credit as regards the requirements to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the theoretical knowledge examinations and the skill test, provided that the third country licence contains a valid type rating for the aircraft to be used for the ATPL skill test.
1.7 1.7.1
1.7.2
1.7.3 1.7.4
1.8. 1.8.1
Explanatory note: A holder of an ICAO ATPL seeking to convert to an equivalent PartFCL licence must comply with all the requirements of Part-FCL. They may have full credit towards the training course requirements as per 1(4); but they must pass the Part-FCL ATPL theoretical knowledge exams and pass the Part-FCL Skill test on a type that is valid in the ICAO ATPL as set out in Appendix 9. (5) Aeroplane or helicopter type ratings may be issued to holders of Part-FCL licences that comply with the requirements for the issue of those ratings established by a third country. Such ratings will be restricted to aircraft registered in that third country. This restriction may be removed when the pilot complies with the requirements in paragraph C.1 of Annex III to Part-FCL.
15 October 2013
Additional Information
None.
15 October 2013
Part R
1 General
Unless stated otherwise, Part-FCL requires that training specied to gain or maintain as valid an EASA licence, rating or certicate must be received from an Approved Training Organisation (ATO), that is approved in accordance with Part-ORA. Organisations providing training for the issue of UK national licences or ratings, shall either: hold an organisation approval under Part-ORA; or shall be approved by or acceptable to the CAA for the purpose.
Transitional arrangements
From the 8 April 2012, Flight Training Organisations (FTOs) and Type Rating Training Organisations (TRTOs) that on that date held an approval under JAR-FCL, were deemed to be Approved Training Organisations (ATOs) for the scope of their approval at that time. These organisations must become fully compliant with Parts ORA and FCL by 8 April 2014, and any new courses for licences (such as the LAPL), ratings or other qualications must be approved as compliant with Part-FCL. Registered Training Facilities (RTFs) that were recorded as registered with an EU National Aviation Authority on 8 April 2012 (17 September 2012 for RTFs located in the UK) can continue to provide PPL training until 7 April 2015. To continue after that date or to offer other courses, such as for the LAPL, a Registered Facility must become an Approved Training Organisations (ATO) in accordance with Part ORA. This Part sets out the requirements for ATOs taken from Annex VII of the EASA Aircrew Regulation.
3 Requirements
The following sets out the requirements for Approved Training Organisations providing training for Licences, Ratings and Certicates. SECTION I Requirements for ATOs providing training for the LAPL and PPL and the associated ratings and certicates ORA.ATO.100 Scope This Subpart establishes the requirements to be met by organisations providing training for pilot licences and associated ratings and certicates. ORA.ATO.105 Application (a) Applicants for the issue of a certicate as an approved training organisation (ATO) shall provide the competent authority with: (1) the following information: (i) name and address of the training organisation; (ii) date of intended commencement of activity; (iii) personal details and qualications of the head of training (HT), the ight instructor(s), ight simulation training instructors and the theoretical knowledge instructor(s);
27 July 2012
(iv) name(s) and address(es) of the aerodromes(s) and/or operating site(s) at which the training is to be conducted; (v) list of aircraft to be operated for training, including their group, class or type, registration, owners and category of the certicate of airworthiness, if applicable; (vi) list of ight simulation training devices (FSTDs) that the training organisation intends to use, if applicable; (vii) the type of training that the training organisation wishes to provide and the corresponding training programme; and (2) the operations and training manuals. (b) Flight test training organisations. Notwithstanding (a)(1)(iv) and (v), training organisations providing ight test training shall only need to provide: (1) the name(s) and address(es) of the main aerodromes and/or operating site(s) at which the training is to be conducted; and (2) a list of the types or categories of aircraft to be used for ight test training. (c) In the case of a change to the certicate, applicants shall provide the competent authority with the relevant parts of the information and documentation referred to in (a). ORA.ATO.110 Personnel requirements (a) An HT shall be nominated. The HT shall have extensive experience as an instructor in the areas relevant for the training provided by the ATO and shall possess sound managerial capability. (b) The HTs responsibilities shall include: (1) ensuring that the training provided is in compliance with Part-FCL and, in the case of ight test training, that the relevant requirements of Part-21 and the training programme have been established; (2) ensuring the satisfactory integration of ight training in an aircraft or a ight simulation training device (FSTD) and theoretical knowledge instruction; and (3) supervising the progress of individual students. (c) Theoretical knowledge instructors shall have: (1) practical background in aviation in the areas relevant for the training provided and have undergone a course of training in instructional techniques; or (2) previous experience in giving theoretical knowledge instruction and an appropriate theoretical background in the subject on which they will provide theoretical knowledge instruction. Flight instructors and ight simulation training instructors shall hold the (d) qualications required by Part-FCL for the type of training that they are providing. ORA.ATO.120 Record-keeping The following records shall be kept for a period of at least 3 years after the completion of the training: (a) details of ground, ight, and simulated ight training given to individual students;
May 2012
(b) detailed and regular progress reports from instructors including assessments, and regular progress ight tests and ground examinations; and (c) information on the licences and associated ratings and certicates of the students, including the expiry dates of medical certicates and ratings. ORA.ATO.125 Training programme (a) A training programme shall be developed for each type of course offered. (b) The training programme shall comply with the requirements of Part-FCL and, in the case of ight test training, the relevant requirements of Part-21. ORA.ATO.130 Training manual and operations manual (a) The ATO shall establish and maintain a training manual and operations manual containing information and instructions to enable personnel to perform their duties and to give guidance to students on how to comply with course requirements. (b) The ATO shall make available to staff and, where appropriate, to students the information contained in the training manual, the operations manual and the ATOs approval documentation. (c) In the case of ATOs providing ight test training, the operations manual shall comply with the requirements for the ight test operations manual, as established in Part-21. The operations manual shall establish ight time limitation schemes for ight (d) instructors, including the maximum ying hours, maximum ying duty hours and minimum rest time between instructional duties in accordance with Part-OR Subpart OPS. ORA.ATO.135 Training aircraft and FSTDs (a) The ATO shall use an adequate eet of training aircraft or FSTDs appropriate to the courses of training provided. (b) The ATO shall only provide training in FSTDs when it demonstrates to the competent authority: (1) the adequacy between the FSTD specications and the related training programme; (2) that the FSTDs used comply with the relevant requirements of Part-FCL; (3) in the case of full ight simulators (FFSs), that the FFS adequately represents the relevant type of aircraft; and (4) that it has put in place a system to adequately monitor changes to the FSTD and to ensure that those changes do not affect the adequacy of the training programme. (c) If the aircraft used for the skill test is of a different type to the FFS used for the visual ight training, the maximum credit shall be limited to that allocated for ight and navigation procedures trainer II (FNPT II) for aeroplanes and FNPT II/III for helicopters in the relevant ight training programme. (d) Flight test training organisations. Aircraft used for ight test training shall be appropriately equipped with ight testing instrumentation, according to the purpose of the training.
May 2012
ORA.ATO.140 Aerodromes and operating sites When providing ight training on an aircraft, the ATO shall use aerodromes or operating sites that have the appropriate facilities and characteristics to allow training of the manoeuvres relevant, taking into account the training provided and the category and type of aircraft used. ORA.ATO.145 Pre-requisites for training (a) The ATO shall ensure that the students meet all the pre-requisites for training established in Part-Medical, Part-FCL, and, if applicable, as dened in the data established in accordance with Part-21. (b) In the case of ATOs providing ight test training, the students shall meet all the pre-requisites for training established in Part-21. ORA.ATO.150 Training in third countries When the ATO is approved to provide training for the instrument rating (IR) in third countries: (a) the training programme shall include acclimatisation ying in one of the Member States before the IR skill test is taken; and (b) the IR skill test shall be taken in one of the Member States.
SECTION II Additional requirements for ATOs providing training for CPL, MPL and ATPL and the associated Ratings and Certicates
ORA.ATO.210 Personnel requirements (a) Head of training (HT). Except in the case of ATOs providing ight test training, the nominated HT shall have extensive experience in training as an instructor for and associated ratings or certicates. (b) Chief ight instructor (CFI). The ATO providing ight instruction shall nominate a CFI who shall be responsible for the supervision of ight and ight simulation training instructors and for the standardisation of all ight instruction and ight simulation instruction. The CFI shall hold the highest professional pilot licence and associated ratings related to the ight training courses conducted and hold an instructor certicate with the privilege to instruct for at least one of the training courses provided. (c) Chief theoretical knowledge instructor (CTKI). The ATO providing theoretical knowledge instruction shall nominate a CTKI who shall be responsible for the supervision of all theoretical knowledge instructors and for the standardisation of all theoretical knowledge instruction. The CTKI shall have extensive experience as a theoretical knowledge instructor in the areas relevant for the training provided by the ATO. ORA.ATO.225 Training programme (a) The training programme shall include a breakdown of ight and theoretical knowledge instruction, presented in a week-by-week or phase layout, a list of standard exercises and a syllabus summary. (b) The content and sequence of the training programme shall be specied in the training manual.
May 2012
ORA.ATO.230 Training manual and operations manual (a) The training manual shall state the standards, objectives and training goals for each phase of training that the students are required to comply with and shall address the following subjects: training plan, brieng and air exercises, ight training in an FSTD, if applicable, theoretical knowledge instruction. (b) The operations manual shall provide relevant information to particular groups of personnel, as ight instructors, ight simulation training instructors, theoretical knowledge instructors, operations and maintenance personnel, and shall include general, technical, route and staff training information.
SECTION III Additional Requirements for ATOs Providing Specic Types of Training Chapter 1 Distance Learning Course
ORA.ATO.300 General The ATO may be approved to conduct modular course programmes using distance learning in the following cases: (a) modular courses of theoretical knowledge instruction; (b) courses of additional theoretical knowledge for a class or type rating; or (c) courses of approved pre-entry theoretical knowledge instruction for a rst type rating for a multi-engined helicopter. ORA.ATO.305 Classroom instruction (a) An element of classroom instruction shall be included in all subjects of modular distance learning courses. (b) The amount of time spent in actual classroom instruction shall not be less than 10% of the total duration of the course. (c) To this effect, classroom accommodation shall be available either at the principal place of business of the ATO or within a suitable facility elsewhere. ORA.ATO.310 Instructors All instructors shall be fully familiar with the requirements of the distance learning course programme.
May 2012
(b) Approval for ZFTT shall only be given if the operator has at least 90 days of operational experience on the aeroplane type. (c) In the case of ZFTT provided by an ATO having a specic arrangement with an operator, the 90 days of operational experience requirements will not apply if the type rating instructor (TRI(A)) involved in the additional take-offs and landings, as required in Part-OR Subpart OPS, has operational experience on the aeroplane type. ORA.ATO.335 Full ight simulator (a) The FFS approved for ZFTT shall be serviceable according to the management system criteria of the ATO. The motion and the visual system of the FFS shall be fully serviceable, in (b) accordance with the applicable certication specications for FSTD as mentioned in ORA.FSTD.205.
May 2012
Part S
1 Applicability
This Part establishes requirements for Flight Crew to be followed by an Air Operator conducting: a) Non-commercial operations with complex motor-powered aircraft; or b) Commercial operations. These requirements are applicable to pilots ying for a UK AOC holder with effect from 8 April 2014.
2 Privileges
Not applicable.
3 Requirements
3.1 Flight crew training ORO.FC.005 ORO.FC.100 ORO.FC.105 ORO.FC.110 ORO.FC.115 ORO.FC.120 ORO.FC.125 ORO.FC.130 ORO.FC.135 ORO.FC.140 ORO.FC.145 ORO.FC.200 ORO.FC.A.201 ORO.FC.202 ORO.FC.205 ORO.FC.215 ORO.FC.220 ORO.FC.230 ORO.FC.235 ORO.FC.240 ORO.FC.A.245 ORO.FC.A.250 ORO.FC.H.250 Scope Composition of ight crew Designation as pilot-in-command/commander Flight engineer Crew resource management (CRM) training Operator conversion training Differences training and familiarisation training Recurrent training and checking Pilot qualication to operate in either pilots seat Operation on more than one type or variant Provision of training Composition of ight crew In-ight relief of ight crew members Single-pilot operations under IFR or at night Command course Initial operators crew resource management (CRM) training Operator conversion training and checking Recurrent training and checking Pilot qualication to operate in either pilots seat Operation on more than one type or variant Alternative training and qualication programme Commanders holding a CPL(A) Commanders holding a CPL(H)
30 January 2013
3.2
Flight training The introduction of EASA requirements is changing the content of type and operational training. Under European rules pilot training must take account of the operational suitability data for the aircraft type as established in accordance with Part21, which will include some mandatory elements. Pilots already operating as ight crew members for the holder of an Air Operators Certicate who have completed training on type, in accordance with ORO.FC, that did not include the mandatory elements established in the relevant operational suitability data must undertake further training covering any such mandatory elements. This training shall be undertaken within 12months of the publication of the operational suitability data for the aircraft type(s) operated by the crew members concerned and may be incorporated into scheduled training and checking.
ORO.FC.005 Scope This Subpart establishes requirements to be met by the operator conducting commercial air transport operations related to ight crew training, experience and qualication. ORO.FC.100 Composition of ight crew (a) The composition of the ight crew and the number of ight crew members at designated crew stations shall be not less than the minimum specied in the aircraft ight manual or operating limitations prescribed for the aircraft. (b) The ight crew shall include additional ight crew members when required by the type of operation and shall not be reduced below the number specied in the operations manual. (c) All ight crew members shall hold a licence and ratings issued or accepted in accordance with Commission Regulation (EC) No 1178/2011 and appropriate to the duties assigned to them. (d) The ight crew member may be relieved in ight of his/her duties at the controls by another suitably qualied ight crew member. (e) When engaging the services of ight crew members who are working on a freelance or part-time basis, the operator shall verify that all applicable requirements of this Subpart and the relevant elements of Part-FCL, including the requirements on recent experience, are complied with, taking into account all services rendered by the ight crew member to other operator(s) to determine in particular: (1) the total number of aircraft types or variants operated; and (2) the applicable ight and duty time limitations and rest requirements. ORO.FC.105 Designation as pilot-in-command/commander (a) In accordance with 8.e of Annex IV to Regulation (EC) No 216/2008, one pilot amongst the ight crew, qualied as pilot-in-command in accordance with Part-FCL, shall be designated by the operator as pilot-in-command, or, for commercial air transport operations, as commander. (b) The operator shall only designate a ight crew member to act as pilot-in-command/ commander if he/she has: (1) the minimum level of experience specied in the operations manual; (2) adequate knowledge of the route or area to be own and of the aerodromes, including alternate aerodromes, facilities and procedures to be used; and (3) in the case of multi-crew operations, completed an operators command course if upgrading from co-pilot to pilot-in-command/commander.
30 January 2013
(c) The pilot-in-command/commander or the pilot to whom the conduct of the ight may be delegated, shall have had initial familiarisation training of the route or area to be own and of the aerodromes, facilities and procedures to be used. This route/area and aerodrome knowledge shall be maintained by operating at least once on the route or area or to the aerodrome within a 12 month period. (d) In the case of performance class B aeroplanes involved in commercial air transport operations under VFR by day, (c) shall not apply. ORO.FC.110 Flight engineer When a separate ight engineer station is incorporated in the design of an aeroplane, the ight crew shall include one crew member who is suitably qualied in accordance with applicable national rules. ORO.FC.115 Crew resource management (CRM) training (a) Before operating, the ight crew member shall have received CRM training, appropriate to his/her role, as specied in the operations manual. (b) Elements of CRM training shall be included in the aircraft type or class training and recurrent training as well as in the command course. ORO.FC.120 Operator conversion training (a) In the case of aeroplane or helicopter operations, the ight crew member shall complete the operator conversion training course before commencing unsupervised line ying: (1) when changing to an aircraft for which a new type or class rating is required; or (2) when joining an operator. (b) The operator conversion training course shall include training on the equipment installed on the aircraft as relevant to ight crew members roles. ORO.FC.125 Differences training and familiarisation training (a) Flight crew members shall complete differences or familiarisation training when required by Annex I (Part-FCL) to Regulation (EU) No 1178/2011 and when changing equipment or procedures requiring additional knowledge on types or variants currently operated. (b) The operations manual shall specify when such differences or familiarisation training is required. ORO.FC.130 Recurrent training and checking (a) Each ight crew member shall complete annual recurrent ight and ground training relevant to the type or variant of aircraft on which he/she operates, including training on the location and use of all emergency and safety equipment carried. (b) Each ight crew member shall be periodically checked to demonstrate competence in carrying out normal, abnormal and emergency procedures. ORO.FC.135 Pilot qualication to operate in either pilots seat Flight crew members who may be assigned to operate in either pilots seat shall complete appropriate training and checking as specied in the operations manual.
30 January 2013
ORO.FC.140 Operation on more than one type or variant (a) Flight crew members operating more than one type or variant of aircraft shall comply with the requirements prescribed in this Subpart for each type or variant, unless credits related to the training, checking, and recent experience requirements are dened in the data established in accordance with Commission Regulation (EC) No 1702/2003 for the relevant types or variants. (b) Appropriate procedures and/or operational restrictions shall be specied in the operations manual for any operation on more than one type or variant. ORO.FC.145 Provision of training (a) All the training required in this Subpart shall be conducted: (1) in accordance with the training programmes and syllabi established by the operator in the operations manual; (2) by appropriately qualied personnel. In the case of ight and ight simulation training and checking, the personnel providing the training and conducting the checks shall be qualied in accordance with Annex I (Part-FCL) to Regulation (EU) No 1178/2011. (b) When establishing the training programmes and syllabi, the operator shall include the mandatory elements for the relevant type as dened in the data established in accordance with Regulation (EC) No 1702/2003. (c) Training and checking programmes, including syllabi and use of individual ight simulation training devices (FSTDs), shall be approved by the competent authority. (d) The FSTD shall replicate the aircraft used by the operator, as far as practicable. Differences between the FSTD and the aircraft shall be described and addressed through a brieng or training, as appropriate. (e) The operator shall establish a system to adequately monitor changes to the FSTD and to ensure that those changes do not affect the adequacy of the training programmes. ORO.FC.200 Composition of ight crew (a) There shall not be more than one inexperienced ight crew member in any ight crew. (b) The commander may delegate the conduct of the ight to another pilot suitably qualied in accordance with Annex I (Part-FCL) to Regulation (EU) No 1178/2011 provided that the requirements of ORO.FC.105 (b)(1), (b)(2) and (c) are complied with. (c) Specic requirements for aeroplane operations under instrument ight rules (IFR) or at night. (1) The minimum ight crew shall be two pilots for all turbo-propeller aeroplanes with a maximum operational passenger seating conguration (MOPSC) of more than nine and all turbojet aeroplanes. (2) Aeroplanes other than those covered by (c)(1) shall be operated with a minimum crew of two pilots, unless the requirements of ORO.FC.202 are complied with, in which case they may be operated by a single pilot. (d) Specic requirements for helicopter operations. (1) For all operations of helicopters with an MOPSC of more than 19 and for operations under IFR of helicopters with an MOPSC of more than 9: (i) the minimum ight crew shall be two pilots; and
30 January 2013
(ii) the commander shall be the holder of an airline transport pilot licence (helicopter) (ATPL(H)) with an instrument rating issued in accordance with Annex I (Part-FCL) to Regulation (EU) No 1178/2011. (2) Operations not covered by (d)(1) may be operated by a single pilot under IFR or at night provided that the requirements of ORO.FC.202 are complied with. ORO.FC.A.201 In-ight relief of ight crew members (a) The commander may delegate the conduct of the ight to: (1) another qualied commander; or (2) or operations only above ight level (FL) 200, a pilot who complies with the following minimum qualications: (i) ATPL; (ii) conversion training and checking, including type rating training, in accordance with ORO.FC.220; (iii) all recurrent training and checking in accordance with ORO.FC.230 and ORO. FC.240; and (iv) route/area and aerodrome competence in accordance with ORO.FC.105. (b) The co-pilot may be relieved by: (1) another suitably qualied pilot; (2) for operations only above FL 200, a cruise relief co-pilot that complies with the following minimum qualications: (i) valid commercial pilot licence (CPL) with an instrument rating; (ii) conversion training and checking, including type rating training, in accordance with ORO.FC.220 except the requirement for take-off and landing training; and (iii) recurrent training and checking in accordance with ORO.FC.230 except the requirement for take-off and landing training. (c) A ight engineer may be relieved in ight by a crew member suitably qualied in accordance with applicable national rules. ORO.FC.202 Single-pilot operations under IFR or at night In order to be able to y under IFR or at night with a minimum ight crew of one pilot, as foreseen in ORO.FC.200 (c)(2) and (d)(2), the following shall be complied with: (a) The operator shall include in the operations manual a pilots conversion and recurrent training programme that includes the additional requirements for a single-pilot operation. The pilot shall have undertaken training on the operators procedures, in particular regarding: (1) engine management and emergency handling; (2) use of normal, abnormal and emergency checklist; (3) air trafc control (ATC) communication; (4) departure and approach procedures; (5) autopilot management, if applicable; (6) use of simplied in-ight documentation; and (7) single-pilot crew resource management. (b) The recurrent checks required by ORO.FC.230 shall be performed in the single-pilot role on the relevant type or class of aircraft in an environment representative of the operation.
30 January 2013
(c) The recurrent checks required by ORO.FC.230 shall be performed in the single-pilot role on the relevant type or class of aircraft in an environment representative of the operation. (d) For aeroplane operations under IFR the pilot shall have: (1) a minimum of 50 hours ight time under IFR on the relevant type or class of aeroplane, of which 10 hours are as commander; and (2) completed during the preceding 90 days on the relevant type or class of aeroplane: (i) ve IFR ights, including three instrument approaches, in a single-pilot role; or (ii) an IFR instrument approach check. (e) For aeroplane operations at night the pilot shall have: (1) a minimum of 15 hours ight time at night which may be included in the 50 hours ight time under IFR in (c)(1); and (2) completed during the preceding 90 days on the relevant type or class of aeroplane: (i) three take-offs and landings at night in the single pilot role; or (ii) a night take-off and landing check. (f) For helicopter operations under IFR the pilot shall have: (1) 25 hours total IFR ight experience in the relevant operating environment; and (2) 25 hours ight experience as a single pilot on the specic type of helicopter, approved for single-pilot IFR, of which 10 hours may be own under supervision, including ve sectors of IFR line ying under supervision using the single-pilot procedures; and (3) completed during the preceding 90 days: (i) ve IFR ights as a single pilot, including three instrument approaches, carried out on a helicopter approved for this purpose; or (ii) an IFR instrument approach check as a single pilot on the relevant type of helicopter, ight training device (FTD) or full ight simulator (FFS). ORO.FC.205 Command course (a) For aeroplane and helicopter operations, the command course shall include at least the following elements: (1) training in an FSTD, which includes line oriented ight training (LOFT) and/or ight training; (2) the operator prociency check, operating as commander; (3) command responsibilities training; (4) line training as commander under supervision, for a minimum of: (i) 10 ight sectors, in the case of aeroplanes; and (ii) 10 hours, including at least 10 ight sectors, in the case of helicopters; (5) completion of a line check as commander and demonstration of adequate knowledge of the route or area to be own and of the aerodromes, including alternate aerodromes, facilities and procedures to be used; and (6) crew resource management training. ORO.FC.215 Initial operators crew resource management (CRM) training (a) The ight crew member shall have completed an initial CRM training course before commencing unsupervised line ying.
30 January 2013
(b) Initial CRM training shall be conducted by at least one suitably qualied CRM trainer who may be assisted by experts in order to address specic areas. (c) If the ight crew member has not previously received theoretical training in human factors to the ATPL level, he/she shall complete, before or combined with the initial CRMtraining, a theoretical course provided by the operator and based on the human performance and limitations syllabus for the ATPL as established in Annex I (Part-FCL) to Regulation (EU) No 1178/2011. ORO.FC.220 Operator conversion training and checking (a) CRM training shall be integrated into the operator conversion training course. (b) Once an operator conversion course has been commenced, the ight crew member shall not be assigned to ying duties on another type or class of aircraft until the course is completed or terminated. Crew members operating only performance class B aeroplanes may be assigned to ights on other types of performance class B aeroplanes during conversion courses to the extent necessary to maintain the operation. (c) The amount of training required by the ight crew member for the operators conversion course shall be determined in accordance with the standards of qualication and experience specied in the operations manual, taking into account his/her previous training and experience. (d) The ight crew member shall complete: (1) the operator prociency check and the emergency and safety equipment training and checking before commencing line ying under supervision (LIFUS); and (2) the line check upon completion of line ying under supervision. For performance class B aeroplanes, LIFUS may be performed on any aeroplane within the applicable class. (e) In the case of aeroplanes, pilots that have been issued a type rating based on a zero ighttime training (ZFTT) course shall: (1) commence line ying under supervision not later than 21 days after the completion of the skill test or after appropriate training provided by the operator. The content of such training shall be described in the operations manual. (2) complete six take-offs and landings in a FSTD not later than 21 days after the completion of the skill test under the supervision of a type rating instructor for aeroplanes (TRI(A)) occupying the other pilot seat. The number of take-offs and landings may be reduced when credits are dened in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Commission Regulation (EC) 1702/2003. If these take-offs and landings have not been performed within 21 days, the operator shall provide refresher training. The content of such training shall be described in the operations manual. (3) conduct the rst four take-offs and landings of the LIFUS in the aeroplane under the supervision of a TRI(A) occupying the other pilot seat. The number of take-offs and landings may be reduced when credits are dened in the operational suitability data established in accordance with Commission Regulation (EC) 1702/2003. ORO.FC.230 Recurrent training and checking (a) Each ight crew member shall complete recurrent training and checking relevant to the type or variant of aircraft on which they operate.
30 January 2013
(b) Operator prociency check (1) Each ight crew member shall complete operator prociency checks as part of the normal crew complement to demonstrate competence in carrying out normal, abnormal and emergency procedures. (2) When the ight crew member will be required to operate under IFR, the operator prociency check shall be conducted without external visual reference, as appropriate. (3) The validity period of the operator prociency check shall be 6 calendar months. For operations under VFR by day of performance class B aeroplanes conducted during seasons not longer than 8 consecutive months, one operator prociency check shall be sufcient. The prociency check shall be undertaken before commencing commercial air transport operations. (4) The ight crew member involved in operations by day and over routes navigated by reference to visual landmarks with another-than-complex motor-powered helicopter may complete the operator prociency check in only one of the relevant types held. The operator prociency check shall be performed each time on the type least recently used for the prociency check. The relevant helicopter types that may be grouped for the purpose of the operator prociency check shall be contained in the operations manual. (5) Notwithstanding ORO.FC.145(a)(2), for operations of other-than-complex motorpowered helicopters by day and over routes navigated by reference to visual landmarks and performance class B aeroplanes, the check may be conducted by a suitably qualied commander nominated by the operator, trained in CRM concepts and the assessment of CRM skills. The operator shall inform the competent authority about the persons nominated. (c) Line check (1) Each ight crew member shall complete a line check on the aircraft to demonstrate competence in carrying out normal line operations described in the operations manual. The validity period of the line check shall be 12 calendar months. (2) Notwithstanding ORO.FC.145 (a)(2), line checks may be conducted by a suitably qualied commander nominated by the operator, trained in CRM concepts and the assessment of CRM skills. (d) Emergency and safety equipment training and checking Each ight crew member shall complete training and checking on the location and use of all emergency and safety equipment carried. The validity period of an emergency and safety equipment check shall be 12 calendar months. (e) CRM training (1) Elements of CRM shall be integrated into all appropriate phases of the recurrent training. (2) Each ight crew member shall undergo specic modular CRM training. All major topics of CRM training shall be covered by distributing modular training sessions as evenly as possible over each three year period. (f) Each ight crew member shall undergo ground training and ight training in an FSTD or an aircraft, or a combination of FSTD and aircraft training, at least every 12 calendar months. (g) The validity periods mentioned in (b)(3), (c) and (d) shall be counted from the end of the month when the check was taken.
30 January 2013
(h) When the training or checks required above are undertaken within the last 3 months of the validity period, the new validity period shall be counted from the original expiry date. ORO.FC.235 Pilot qualication to operate in either pilots seat (a) Commanders whose duties require them to operate in either pilot seat and carry out the duties of a co-pilot, or commanders required to conduct training or checking duties, shall complete additional training and checking as specied in the operations manual. The check may be conducted together with the operator prociency check prescribed in ORO.FC.230(b). (b) The additional training and checking shall include at least the following: (1) an engine failure during take-off; (2) a one-engine-inoperative approach and go-around; and (3) a one-engine-inoperative landing. (c) In the case of helicopters, commanders shall also complete their prociency checks from left- and right-hand seats, on alternate prociency checks, provided that when the type rating prociency check is combined with the operator prociency check the commander completes his/her training or checking from the normally occupied seat. (d) When engine-out manoeuvres are carried out in an aircraft, the engine failure shall be simulated. (e) When operating in the co-pilots seat, the checks required by ORO.FC.230 for operating in the commanders seat shall, in addition, be valid and current. (f) The pilot relieving the commander shall have demonstrated, concurrent with the operator prociency checks prescribed in ORO.FC.230 (b), practice of drills and procedures that would not, normally, be his/her responsibility. Where the differences between left- and right-hand seats are not signicant, practice may be conducted in either seat. (g) The pilot other than the commander occupying the commanders seat shall demonstrate practice of drills and procedures, concurrent with the operator prociency checks prescribed in ORO.FC.230 (b), which are the commanders responsibility acting as pilot monitoring. Where the differences between left- and right-hand seats are not signicant, practice may be conducted in either seat. ORO.FC.240 Operation on more than one type or variant (a) The procedures or operational restrictions for operation on more than one type or variant established in the operations manual and approved by the competent authority shall cover: (1) the ight crew members minimum experience level; (2) the minimum experience level on one type or variant before beginning training for and operation of another type or variant; (3) the process whereby ight crew qualied on one type or variant will be trained and qualied on another type or variant; and (4) all applicable recent experience requirements for each type or variant. (b) When a ight crew member operates both helicopters and aeroplanes, that ight crew member shall be limited to operations on only one type of aeroplane and one type of helicopter. (c) Point (a) shall not apply to operations of performance class B aeroplane if they are limited to single-pilot classes of reciprocating engine aeroplanes under VFR by day. Point (b) shall not apply to operations of performance class B aeroplane if they are limited to single-pilot classes of reciprocating engine aeroplanes.
30 January 2013
ORO.FC.A.245 Alternative training and qualication programme (a) The aeroplane operator having appropriate experience may substitute one or more of the following training and checking requirements for ight crew by an alternative training and qualication programme (ATQP), approved by the competent authority: (1) SPA.LVO.120 on ight crew training and qualications; (2) conversion training and checking; (3) differences training and familiarisation training; (4) command course; (5) recurrent training and checking; and (6) operation on more than one type or variant. (b) The ATQP shall contain training and checking that establishes and maintains at least an equivalent level of prociency achieved by complying with the provisions of ORO.FC.220 and ORO.FC.230. The level of ight crew training and qualication prociency shall be demonstrated prior to being granted the ATQP approval by the competent authority. (c) The operator applying for an ATQP approval shall provide the competent authority with an implementation plan, including a description of the level of ight crew training and qualication prociency to be achieved. (d) In addition to the checks required by ORO.FC.230 and FCL.060 of Annex I (Part-FCL) to Regulation (EU) No 1178/2011, each ight crew member shall complete a line oriented evaluation (LOE) conducted in an FSTD. The validity period of an LOE shall be 12 calendar months. The validity period shall be counted from the end of the month when the check was taken. When the LOE is undertaken within the last 3 months of the validity period, the new validity period shall be counted from the original expiry date. (e) After 2 years of operating with an approved ATQP, the operator may, with the approval of the competent authority, extend the validity periods of the checks in ORO.FC.230 as follows: (1) Operator prociency check to 12 calendar months. The validity period shall be counted from the end of the month when the check was taken. When the check is undertaken within the last 3 months of the validity period, the new validity period shall be counted from the original expiry date. (2) Line check to 24 calendar months. The validity period shall be counted from the end of the month when the check was taken. When the check is undertaken within the last 6 months of the validity period, the new validity period shall be counted from the original expiry date. (3) Emergency and safety equipment checking to 24 calendar months. The validity period shall be counted from the end of the month when the check was taken. When the check is undertaken within the last 6 months of the validity period, the new validity period shall be counted from the original expiry date. ORO.FC.A.250 Commanders holding a CPL(A) (a) The holder of a CPL(A) (aeroplane) shall only act as commander in commercial air transport on a single-pilot aeroplane if: (1) when carrying passengers under VFR outside a radius of 50 NM (90 km) from an aerodrome of departure, he/she has a minimum of 500 hours of ight time on aeroplanes or holds a valid instrument rating; or
30 January 2013
(2) when operating on a multi-engine type under IFR, he/she has a minimum of 700 hours of ight time on aeroplanes, including 400 hours as pilot-in-command. These hours shall include 100 hours under IFR and 40 hours in multi-engine operations. The 400 hours as pilot-in-command may be substituted by hours operating as co-pilot within an established multi-pilot crew system prescribed in the operations manual, on the basis of two hours of ight time as co-pilot for one hour of ight time as pilot-in command. (b) For operations under VFR by day of performance class B aeroplanes (a)(1) shall not apply. ORO.FC.H.250 Commanders holding a CPL(H) (a) The holder of a CPL(H) (helicopter) shall only act as commander in commercial air transport on a single-pilot helicopter if: (1) when operating under IFR, he/she has a minimum of 700 hours total ight time on helicopters, including 300 hours as pilot-in-command. These hours shall include 100 hours under IFR. The 300 hours as pilot-in-command may be substituted by hours operating as co-pilot within an established multi-pilot crew system prescribed in the operations manual on the basis of two hours of ight time as co-pilot for one hour ight time as pilot-in command; (2) when operating under visual meteorological conditions (VMC) at night, he/she has: (i) a valid instrument rating; or (ii) 300 hours of ight time on helicopters, including 100 hours as pilot-in-command and 10 hours as pilot ying at night.
Additional Information
None.
30 January 2013
Section 5
Part A
UK National Licences
UK National Private Pilot Licences (NPPL) for Aeroplanes, Microlights, Self Launching Motor Gliders and Helicopters Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 UK National Private Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes NPPL(A) (SSEA/SLMG) UK National Private Pilots Licence NPPL(A) with a Microlight Aeroplane Class Rating UK National Private Pilot Licence for Helicopters NPPL(H)
Part B
UK Private Pilot Licences (PPL) for Aeroplanes, Balloons and Airships, Gyroplanes, Helicopters and Unmanned Aircraft Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Subpart 4 Subpart 5 UK Private Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes UK PPL(A) UK Private Pilot Licence for Balloons and Airships UK PPL(BA) UK Private Pilot Licence for Gyroplanes UK PPL(G) UK Private Pilot Licence for Helicopters UK PPL(H) UK Private Pilot Licence for Unmanned Aircraft UK PPL(UA)
Part C
UK Commercial Pilot Licence (CPL) Aeroplanes, Balloons, Gyroplanes, Helicopters, Unmanned Aircraft and Airships Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Subpart 4 Subpart 5 UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes UK CPL(A) UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Balloons UK CPL(B) UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Gyroplanes UK CPL(G) UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Helicopters UK CPL(H) UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Unmanned Air craft UK CPL (UA)
11Page 1
Subpart 6 Part D
UK Airline Transport Pilot Licence (ATPL) Aeroplanes Subpart 1 Subpart 2 UK Airline Transport Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes UK ATPL(A) UK Airline Transport Pilot Licence for Helicopters UK ATPL(H)
Part E
The UK Instrument Meteorological Conditions Rating for Aeroplanes UK (IMC) (endorsed as IR(Restricted) on Part-FCL licences) UK Class and Type Ratings Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Aeroplanes Helicopters Airships
Part F
Part G Part H
UK Licence Additional Ratings UK Instructor Ratings Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Aeroplanes and Helicopters Microlights, SLMGs and Powered Parachutes Gyroplanes
Part I Part J
11Page 2
Part A
UK National Private Pilot Licences (NPPL) for Aeroplanes, Microlights, Self Launching Motor Gliders and Helicopters UK National Private Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes NPPL(A) (SSEA/SLMG)
Subpart 1
1 Applicability
The holder of a UK NPPL(A) with an SSEA/SLMG rating may exercise the privileges of the licence to y non-EASA SSEA or SLMGs, as applicable, registered in the UK in UK airspace. Use of the licence within the airspace of other countries is subject to the agreement of the relevant authorities in those countries. The licence is also valid for EASA SSEA and SLMGs until 8 April 2015.
2 Privileges
2.1 The privileges and conditions of the UK NPPL(A) are as dened in Part A of Schedule7 to the ANO (2009), refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B.
April 2012
2.2 2.3
Applicants should note that no other ratings or qualications other than SSEA, Microlight and SLMG may be added to the NPPL(A). At the time of writing an NPPL holder with SSEA ratings can y in France following an agreement with the French DGAC, provided the holder is in possession of an SSEA rating, Class 2 Medical Certicate and a certicate conrming specied experience. For further details of the experience requirements and obtaining a certicate contact NPLG Ltd. The holder of an NPPL with SLMG rating is entitled to ICAO Annex I privileges for international ight provided that they obtain a Part-MED Class 1 or 2 medical certicate and demonstrate compliance with the ICAO requirements of 40 hours training. Applications may then be made to L&TS for an appropriate licence endorsement. The NPPL(A) is not a valid licence for any EASA aircraft after 7 April 2015.
2.4
2.5
3 Requirements
3.1 Minimum Age 3.2 Licence Validity 3.3 Medical Requirements 3.4 Flying Training/Experience Requirements 3.5 Credits from Flying Training 3.6 Theoretical Knowledge Requirements 3.7 UK Flight Radiotelephony operators Licence (FRTOL) 3.8 Conversion to Part-FCL PPL(A) 3.9 Revalidation/Renewal 3.10 Issue of Class Rating and Differences Training 3.11 Issue of SSEA or SLMG Class Rating on the basis of a SEP(Land) Class Rating Minimum Age An applicant for an NPPL(A) SSEA/SLMG shall be at least 17 years of age. The minimum age for the rst solo ight is 16 years of age. 3.2 Licence Validity The NPPL(A) SSEA/SLMG is issued with a lifetime validity. Ratings included in an NPPL(A) are issued with a 24 month validity period. 3.3 Medical Requirements An applicant for an NPPL(A) shall hold a valid NPPL medical declaration or a Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate. 3.4 3.4.1 Flying Training/Experience Requirements An applicant for an NPPL(A) SSEA/SLMG shall have completed at least 32 hours ight time as pilot of aeroplanes (excluding Navigation Skill Test and General Skill Test). NPPL(A) SSEA training shall be completed at an organisation acceptable to the CAA, and training for the NPPL(A) SLMG at an approved BGA site. Training for the NPPL(A) SSEA or SLMG must include the following: a) 22 hours dual instruction (to include 1 hour instrument appreciation);
3.1
3.4.2
April 2012
b) 10 hours solo ight time which must include at least 4 hours of solo cross-country ight time, including one solo cross-country ight of at least 185km (100NM) in the course of which full stop landings at two aerodromes other than the aerodrome of departure shall be made; c) Navigation Skill Test (NST) (minimum of 1 hour duration and to be taken prior to undertaking the qualifying solo cross-country ight); d) General Skill Test (GST) (minimum of 1 hour duration). An applicant may not take the General Skill Test until all associated ying training has been completed and the associated theoretical knowledge examinations have been passed. Where the privilege of using radio telephony is required, applicants must also comply with FRTOL requirements. The General Skill Test shall be taken within 6 months of the completion of training. All sections of the test shall be completed within 6 months of the rst attempt. If the applicant does not pass all sections of the skill test at the rst attempt, the section(s) that have been failed may be attempted in a further test(s). There is no limit to the number of tests that may be taken. 3.5 Credits from Flying Training Allowances against training for the grant of an NPPL(A) SSEA/SLMG may be given for holders of other licences (UK/EASA/NPPL or Non-UK), military ying experience and other qualications. See Part II to CAP804, Section 5, Part A, Appendix1. 3.6 3.6.1 Theoretical Knowledge Requirements An applicant for an NPPL(A) SSEA/SLMG shall pass the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical knowledge examinations as detailed in Section 4,Part C, Subpart 1, to the same pass standards and validity periods. The NPPL(A) SSEA/SLMG syllabi of ying training and Skill Tests and theoretical knowledge requirements are detailed in Part II to CAP 804, Section 5, Part A. UK Flight Radiotelephony operators Licence (FRTOL) Pilots who intend to operate radiotelephony equipment will require an FRTOL. The FRTOL requirements are contained in CAP 804, Section 6. 3.8 Conversion to Part-FCL Licences The holder of an NPPL(A) rating seeking to obtain a Part-FCL LAPL(A) may do so by complying with the requirements as set out in Section 4, PartB, Subpart 1. 3.9 3.9.1 Revalidation/Renewal of NPPL(A) SSEA or SLMG Revalidation To revalidate an SSEA or SLMG class rating attached to an NPPL(A), the holder must complete the following during the 24 month validity of the current certicate of revalidation for the rating: a) Complete a General skill test; or b) At least 12 hours ight time to include: i) at least 8 hours as pilot in command; ii) at least 12 take-offs and 12 landings; iii) at least 1 hour of ying training with an instructor entitled to give instruction on aeroplanes of that class; iv) at least 6 hours ight time in the 12 months preceding the validity expiry date.
3.6.2 3.7
30 January 2013
3.9.1.1 Where the holder has not undertaken the skill test or the ying training specied in b)iii) above a certicate of revalidation may be issued but must be endorsed single seat only. 3.9.1.2 Where the holder wishes to revalidate more than one class rating they may carry out the requirements above in any of the relevant classes but must have at least 1 hour PIC or 1 hour dual instruction in each of the classes as part of the 12 hours ight time. 3.9.1.3 Refer to Part II to CAP 804, Section 5, Part A, Subpart 1 for supplemental information. 3.9.2 Renewal 3.9.2.1 To renew an SSEA or SLMG class rating that has expired by not more than 5 years, applicants must hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED medical certicate and pass the NPPL GST in the relevant class of aircraft which shall include an oral examination of theoretical knowledge. 3.9.2.2 Where an SSEA or SLMG class rating has expired by more than 5 years applicants shall undergo a course of refresher ying training in SSEA or SLMG (for the applicable class rating held) as specied by an instructor qualied to give instruction on SSEA or SLMG (for the applicable class rating held), hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1 or 2 medical certicate, and pass the NPPL GST in an SSEA or SLMG (for the applicable class rating held), to include an oral theoretical knowledge examination. 3.10 Issue of Class Rating and Differences Training Applicants wishing to add an SSEA or SLMG aircraft class rating to their current licence must undergo appropriate training and pass a General Skill Test in the class of aircraft for which the rating is to be used. 3.11 Issue of SSEA or SLMG Class Rating on the basis of an SEP(Land) Class Rating The holder of an ATPL(A)/CPL(A) or PPL(A) with an SEP rating may convert their Licence to an NPPL with SSEA/SLMG or Microlight rating by satisfying any difference training requirements set out in Part II CAP 804, Section 5, Part A.
Additional Information
None.
April 2012
Subpart 2 UK National Private Pilots Licence NPPL(A) with a Microlight Aeroplane Class Rating
1 Applicability
The holder of a UK NPPL(A) or UK issued licence endorsed with a microlight aeroplane class rating may exercise the privileges of the licence to y microlight aeroplanes registered in the UK within UK airspace. Entry of the airspace of other countries is subject to permission by the relevant authorities in those countries and exemption from the licence restriction by the CAA.
2 Privileges
The privileges and conditions of the UK NPPL(A) Microlight Aeroplanes are as dened in Part A of Schedule 7 to the ANO (2009), See Section 7, Part B.
3 Requirements
3.1 Classications 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 3.8 3.9 3.11 3.12 3.13 3.1 3.1.1 3.1.2 Minimum Age Medical Requirements Licence Validity Theoretical Knowledge Examination (Microlight) Powered Parachute Theoretical Knowledge Examination (Powered Parachute) Flight Test UK Flight Radiotelephony operators Licence (FRTOL) Issue of Class Rating and Differences Training Issue of Microlight aeroplane Class Rating on the basis of a SEP(Land) Class Rating Exercising the privileges on Microlight aeroplanes on the basis of a SEP(Land) Class Rating
3.10 Revalidation/Renewal
Classications Current microlight aeroplanes have 1 of 3 alternative forms of control: conventional 3-axis; weight shift (ex wing); or powered parachute. Pilots who undertake their training in a 3-axis or weight shift microlight will be granted an NPPL with Microlight rating. Holders of such licences may y 3-axis or weight shift microlights subject to satisfactory completion of appropriate differences training in each case. Pilots who undertake their training in a powered parachute microlight (as set out within paragraph 3.6) will be granted an NPPL(A) with a Microlight Powered Parachute only rating. Holders of such licences may have the rating replaced with a
3.1.3
27 July 2012
Microlight rating subject to satisfactory completion of any additional training and experience (including conversion training) in a 3-axis or weight shift microlight to show compliance with the requirements for the microlight rating. A Microlight aeroplane is dened in Article 255 of the Air Navigation Order as follows: Microlight aeroplane means an aeroplane designed to carry not more than two persons which has: (a) a maximum total weight authorised not exceeding: (i) 300kg for a single seat landplane, (or 390kg for a single seat landplane of which at least 51% was built by an amateur, or non-prot making association of amateurs, for their own purposes and without any commercial objective, in respect of which a permit to y issued by the CAA was in force prior to 1st January 2003); (ii) 450kg for a two-seat landplane; or (iii) 330kg for a single seat amphibian or oatplane; or (iv) 495kg for a two-seat amphibian or oatplane; or (v) 315kg for a single seat landplane equipped with an airframe mounted total recovery parachute system; or (vi) 472.5kg for a two-seat landplane equipped with an airframe mounted total recovery parachute system; and (b) a stalling speed, or minimum steady ight speed in the landing conguration, at the maximum total weight authorised not exceeding 35 knots calibrated airspeed. All aeroplanes falling within these parameters are Microlight aeroplanes for the purpose of UK legislation. 3.2 Minimum Age An applicant for an NPPL(A) Microlight (or MicrolightPowered Parachute) shall be at least 17 years of age. The minimum age for the rst solo ight is 16 years of age. 3.3 Medical Requirements An applicant for an NPPL(A) shall hold a valid NPPL medical declaration or a Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate. For information regarding the medical requirements for the NPPL Medical Declaration please refer to Section 4, Part N, or the CAA web site at www.caa.co.uk/medical. 3.4 Licence Validity The NPPL(A) is issued with lifetime validity. The microlight class rating added to an NPPL(A) or UK national licence shall remain valid for 24 months from the date of check or test. 3.5 Flying Training/Experience Requirements Applicants may obtain either an unrestricted licence or a restricted licence (which includes operational limitations). 3.5.1 NPPL(A) Microlight Restricted with Operational Limitations Applicants shall be required to complete a minimum of 15 hours training as pilot of microlight aeroplanes.
May 2012
This shall include not less than 7 hours as PIC, which shall be own in the 9 months prior to the date of application for licence issue. In addition, applicants will be required to pass an NPPL(A) Microlight General Skill Test. When an NPPL(A) Microlight is issued with operational limitations, it will impose the constraints as listed in Part II to CAP 804, Section 5, Part A, Subpart 2, 2.1, on the licence holder. 3.5.2 NPPL(A) Microlight without Operational Limitations An applicant shall complete a minimum of 25 hours training as pilot of a microlight aeroplane. The total must include not less than 10 hours as PIC in the 9 months prior to the date of application. A minimum total of 5 hours navigation ying training must be completed within the period of 9 months immediately prior to licence application or an application to remove operational limitations from an existing licence. The required navigation ying training includes a minimum of 3 hours of solo navigation ying training to be completed within the 9 month period. The navigation ight training must include two solo qualifying cross-country ights. Each solo qualifying cross country ight must have: a minimum total ight distance of 40 nautical miles; a landing at another site which is at least 15 nautical miles, measured in a straight line, from the take-off site at which the ight began The two solo qualifying cross-country ights must be own over different routes and to different sites. 3.5.3 Credits from Flying Training Allowances against training for the grant of an NPPL(A) Microlight may be given for holders of other licences (UK/Part-FCL/NPPL or Non-UK), military ying experience and other qualications. For full details, see Part II to CAP 804, Section 5, Part A, Appendix1. 3.5.4 Theoretical Knowledge Examination (Microlight) An applicant for an NPPL(A) Microlight shall pass theoretical knowledge examinations in the following subjects: 1. Aviation Law, Flight Rules and Procedures 2. Human Performance and Limitations 3. Navigation 4. Meteorology 5. Aircraft (General) 6. Aircraft (Type) (Oral as part of the NPPL(A) Microlight GFT). An applicant for an NPPL(A) Microlight shall pass all the examinations within 24 months prior to applying for the licence. Details of the NPPL(A) Microlight syllabi of ying training, ight tests and theoretical knowledge requirements can be found in Part II to CAP 804, Section 5, Part A, Appendix1.
27 July 2012
3.6 3.6.1
Powered Parachute Pilots who undertake their training in a powered parachute microlight will be granted an NPPL(A) with a Microlight Powered Parachute only rating. Holders of such licences may have the rating replaced with a Microlight rating subject to satisfactory completion of additional training and experience (including conversion training) in a 3-axis or weight shift microlight to show compliance with the requirements for the Microlight rating as set out in CAP 804 Part II, Subpart 2 for UK NPPL(A) Microlight. All ying training must be carried out under the supervision of a ying instructor holding a valid AFI rating or an FI rating on the type of powered parachute on which the training is conducted. Flight in any powered parachute is acceptable and must follow either the dual training system for a two seat aeroplane or the solo training system for a single seat aeroplane. Applicants may obtain either an unrestricted licence or a restricted licence (which includes operational limitations).
3.6.2
Restricted Licence with Operational Limitations Applicants must produce evidence of having satisfactorily completed a course of training to a syllabus recognised by the CAA and have passed a GFT with an authorised examiner. The syllabus of training must provide for a minimum of: a) 4 hours of ight time in a powered parachute including not less than: i) 1 hour as solo PIC; and ii) not less than 25 take-offs and full stop landings of which at least 6 must be as solo PIC in the 9 months prior to the date of application. The Flight Test time can be included in the minimum 4 hours of ight training, but cannot form part of the 1 hour required as PIC. The licence will impose the constraints listed in Part II to CAP 804, Section 5, Part A, Subpart 2, 2.1, on the licence holder.
3.6.3
Unrestricted Licence without Operational Limitations Applicants must produce evidence of having satisfactorily completed a course of training to a syllabus recognised by the CAA and pass a Flight Test. The syllabus of training must provide for a minimum of: a) 15 hours of ight time in a powered parachute supervised by a ying instructor. The total must include not less than: i) 6 hours as solo PIC; ii) 25 take-offs and full stop landings of which, at least 6 take-offs and full stop landings must be as solo PIC; iii) 5 hours training in navigation including at least 3 hours as solo PIC and must include 2 solo 25NM crosscountry ights during each of which the applicant landed at least at 1 other site not less than 10NM from the take-off site at which the ight began. The 2 solo cross-country ights must be own over different routes and to different sites. The solo hours must be own within the 9 months prior to the date of application. The Flight Test time can be included in the minimum 15 hours ight training, but cannot form part of the 6 hours required as PIC.
3.6.4
Credits from Flying Training Non-UK licence holders and military pilots who have previous experience on Powered Parachutes may be eligible for credits towards training. For details, see Part II to CAP804, Section 5, Part A, Appendix 1.
27 July 2012
3.7 3.7.1
Theoretical Knowledge Examination (Powered Parachute) An applicant for a Powered Parachute licence must pass theoretical knowledge examinations in the following subjects: 1. Aviation Law, Flight Rules and Procedures 2. Human Performance and Limitations 3. Navigation 4. Meteorology 5. Aircraft (General) 6. Aircraft (Type) (Oral as part of the GFT). Examinations 1, 2, 3 and 4 are common to Microlights and Powered Parachutes. The Aircraft (General) and Aircraft (Type) are specic to Powered Parachutes. An applicant for an NPPL(A) Powered Parachute shall successfully pass all the examinations within 24 months prior to applying for the licence.
3.7.2
Credits from Examinations a) The holder of a valid Non-UK Pilots licence (Aeroplanes) issued by another ICAO Contracting State may be credited the examinations in Navigation, Meteorology, Aircraft (General) and Aircraft (Type). b) A QMP in the UK Armed Forces may be credited the examinations in Navigation, Meteorology and Aircraft (General). c) A holder of a valid UK or another ICAO Contracting States Flight Navigators Licence and UK Military Navigators may be credited the examinations in Navigation and Meteorology. Holders of a current BMAA FLM or BHPA PPG or SPHG Pilot Rating should contact the BMAA for details of the allowable credits.
3.8
Flight Test Applicants shall pass the General Flight Test conducted by a CAA authorised Microlight Examiner in a Microlight. Applicants shall pass the General Flight Test conducted by a CAA authorised Powered Parachute Examiner in a Powered Parachute. Pilots who intend to operate Radio Telephony equipment must comply with FRTOL requirements.
3.9
UK Flight Radiotelephony operators Licence (FRTOL) Pilots who intend to operate radiotelephony equipment shall hold an FRTOL. Full details of the FRTOL requirements are contained in CAP 804, Section 6.
3.10
Revalidation/ Renewal To revalidate a Microlight rating attached to a UK PPL(A) (only if attached before 1February 2008) or UK PPL (Microlight), the holder may complete the following on the appropriate class of aircraft during the validity of the current certicate of revalidation for the rating: Complete an NPPL GST, or 5 hours ight time in the appropriate class in the preceding 13 months. Of the 5 hours experience required above, 3 hours must have been as PIC. The remaining time may be made up of:
3.10.1 Revalidation
27 July 2012
a) PICUS ight time gained with a ying instructor on a successful check ight or with an authorised Examiner on a successful Flight Test for the grant or revalidation of a rating in a PPL; or b) dual ying instruction own with a ying instructor but only if, at the end of the dual ight or ights, the instructor considered the pilot was t to y as PIC, and so certies in the log. Important Note 1: The holder may elect instead to revalidate his rating/s in accordance with the requirements of a NPPL licence holder as listed below. However, once such an election has been made, all future revalidations will be on the 12 hour, 24 month cycle rather than the 5 hour, 13 month cycle. To revalidate a Microlight aircraft class rating attached to an NPPL(A), the holder shall complete the following during the 24 month validity of the current certicate of revalidation for the rating: a) Complete a General skill test; or b) at least 12 hours ight time to include: i) at least 8 hours as pilot in command; ii) at least 12 take-offs and 12 landings; iii) at least 1 hour of ying training with an instructor entitled to give instruction on aeroplanes of that class; and iv) at least 6 hours in the 12 months preceding the validity expiry date. Where the holder has not undertaken the ying training specied above a certicate of revalidation may be issued but it shall be endorsed single seat only. Where the holder wishes to revalidate more than one class rating they may comply with the requirements above in any of the relevant classes but must carry out at least 1 hour PIC or 1 hour dual instruction in each of the classes as part of the 12 hours ight time. NOTE 1: Schedule 7 of the Air Navigation Order 2009 species that a Microlight rating on a UK PPL shall be revalidated by experience in accordance with the 5 hours in 13 months arrangements. However, the CAA has issued a general exemption to allow the holder of a UK PPL(A) to maintain such a rating in accordance with the NPPL requirements set out in this section (12 hours in 24 months) as if the rating were associated with an NPPL. NOTE 2: Schedule 7 of the Air Navigation Order 2009 species that a Microlight rating on a CPL(A) or ATPL(A) shall be revalidated by experience in accordance with the requirements set out in this section; (i.e. the 12 hours in 24 months cycle). However, the CAA has issued a general exemption to allow the holder of a UK CPL(A) or ATPL(A) who obtained their Microlight rating prior to 1 February 2008 to continue to re-validate that rating using the 5 in 13 months system as set out in Case A Section 1 of Part C of Schedule 7 i.e. in the same manner as for the microlight aeroplane class rating on a UK PPL(A). Refer to Part II to CAP804, Section 5, Part A, Subpart 2, 3.10.1 for supplemental information. 3.10.2 Renewal To renew a Microlight class rating that has expired for not more than 5 years, applicants shall hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate and pass the NPPL GST in the microlight to include an oral theoretical knowledge examination.
27 July 2012
Where a Microlight class rating has expired by more than 5 years applicants shall undergo a course of refresher ying training in microlights as specied by an instructor qualied to give instruction on microlights, hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate, and pass the NPPL GST in a microlight, to include an oral theoretical knowledge examination. 3.11 Issue of Class Rating and Differences Training 3.11.1 Applicants wishing to add a Microlight aircraft class rating to a UK licence must undergo appropriate training and pass a General Flight Test. 3.11.2 Microlight pilots wishing to convert between weightshift and 3-axis microlight control systems, or to a microlight with more than one engine, shall undertake differences training given by a ight instructor entitled to instruct on the microlight aeroplane on which instruction is being given. The training must be completed, recorded in the pilots personal ying log book and endorsed and signed by the instructor conducting the differences training. 3.12 Issue of Microlight Aeroplane Class Rating on the basis of an SEP(Land) Class Rating Provided that their SEP aeroplane class rating is valid, an Examiner may revalidate their SEP aircraft class rating as a Microlight aircraft class rating. The Examiner makes the relevant entry in the Certicate of Revalidation page in the holders licence, entering the revalidation date in the Date of Check or Test column and entering the Valid To date as 24 months later. The holder must then apply to L&TS for the inclusion of the Microlight Class Rating in their licence as the Examiner is not permitted to make entries in the ratings page of the licence. If the SEP rating or the licence has expired, application for an NPPL with the required ratings should be made to NPLG Ltd. 3.13 Exercising the privileges on Microlight aeroplanes on the basis of an SEP(Land) Class Rating The holder of a UK issued licence or any Part-FCL licence with an SEP rating, may, subject to differences training on the appropriate class with a suitably qualied instructor, exercise the privileges of their licence on microlight aircraft. However, any experience gained in microlight aircraft cannot be counted towards the ying experience necessary to maintain the full SEP or TMG privileges.
Additional Information
None.
27 July 2012
1 Applicability
The holder of a UK NPPL(H) may exercise the privileges of the licence to y non-EASA helicopters registered in the UK that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence.
2 Privileges
The privileges and conditions of the UK NPPL(H) are as dened in Part A of Schedule7 to the ANO (2009), refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B.
3 Requirements
An applicant for an NPPL(H) shall: a) hold the EASA (LAPL(H)) in accordance with Part-FCL and comply with the requirements for the rating; or b) comply with the requirements of Part-FCL for the LAPL(H), and comply with the requirements for the national rating. An applicant for the UK NPPL(H) shall comply with the Part-FCL requirements as listed in CAP 804, Section 4, Part B, Subpart 2: An applicant for an NPPL(H) shall hold a valid Part-MED medical certicate. For information regarding the medical requirements please refer to the CAA web site at www.caa.co.uk/medical.
NOTE: The NPPL Medical Declaration is not an acceptable alternative to the LAPL Medical Certicate for the NPPL(H).
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Part B
UK Private Pilot Licences (PPL) for Aeroplanes, Balloons and Airships, Gyroplanes, Helicopters and Unmanned Aircraft UK Private Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes UK PPL(A)
Subpart 1
1 Applicability
The holder of a UK PPL(A) may exercise the privileges of the licence to y non-EASA aeroplanes registered in the UK that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence. The same privileges of the licence may be exercised to y EASA aeroplanes registered in the UK until 8 April 2014; and until 8 April 2015 with the privileges restricted to those of the LAPL(A).
2 Privileges
The privileges and conditions of the UK PPL(A) are as dened in Part A of Schedule 7 to the ANO (2009), refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B.
3 Requirements
An applicant for the UK PPL(A) shall either comply with the Part-FCL requirements for PPL(A) as listed in CAP 804, Section 4, Part C, Subpart 1 or hold a Part-FCL PPL(A). Applicants for and holders of the PPL(A) shall hold a Part-MED Class 1 or Class 2 medical certicate.
NOTE: Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA PPL(A) to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA aeroplanes. Consequently a pilot who holds a Part-FCL PPL(A) does not require a UK PPL(A) unless they need to exercise the privileges of a rating that cannot be included in the Part-FCL licence; e.g. a type rating for a non-EASA aeroplane.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
2 Privileges
The privileges and conditions of the UK PPL(BA) are as dened in the Part A of Schedule 7 to the ANO, refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B. For this purpose, the types of balloon or airships are: a) Free Balloons Hot Air Filled b) Free Balloons Gas Filled Netless c) Free Balloons Gas Filled Netted d) Free Balloons Combination Gas/Hot Air Filled e) Hot Air Airships Pressurised (up to 160,000 CuFt/4550 CuM Volume) f) Hot Air Airships Un-pressurised (up to 160,000 CuFt/4550 CuM Volume) g) Gas Airships Pressurised (up to 160,000 CuFt/4550 CuM Volume) When a UK PPL(BA) is issued, it will be endorsed with a Day Flying Only restriction. (For removal of this restriction, please refer to the Night Flying section). Airship ratings can only be obtained and endorsed onto an existing PPL(BA) licence. (Please refer to paragraph 3.9 for full details).
3 Requirements
3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 3.8 3.9 3.10 Minimum Age Licence Validity Non-UK Licence Holders UK PPL(BA) Flying Training/Experience Requirements UK PPL(BA) Ground Examination Requirements UK PPL(BA) Flight Test Requirements UK PPL(BA) Medical Requirements UK PPL(BA) Re-validation Requirements Additional Balloon or Hot-Air Airship Rating UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence (FRTOL) Requirements
Applicants for and holders of the UK PPL(BA) shall hold a Part-MED Class 1, Class 2 or LAPL medical certicate or hold a Medical declaration.
May 2012
EASA Airships Licences Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA PPL(As) to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA airships. EASA Balloon Licences Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA LAPL(B) and BPL to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA balloons. 3.1 3.2 Minimum Age Applicants for the PPL(BA) for balloons and airships shall be at least 17 years of age; Licence Validity The UK PPL(BA) will be issued with a lifetime validity but for the privileges conferred by it to be exercised the pilot must have a current Part-MED Medical Certicate or a Medical Declaration and a valid Aircraft Rating. 3.3 Non-UK Licence Holders Any credits or exemptions against training for holders of a non-UK Pilots Licence or equivalent privileges for balloons are indicated at the relevant section. Applicants for conversion to a UK PPL(BA) must obtain a valid Part-MED Medical Certicate or UK National PPL Medical Declaration. 3.4 3.4.1 UK PPL(BA) Flying Training/Experience Requirements For PPL(BA) Issue with a Free Balloons Hot Air Filled Rating:
3.4.1.1 An applicant for a UK PPL(BA) shall produce evidence of having satisfactorily completed a course of training to a syllabus recognised by the Authority, within the 24 months preceding the date of application for the licence. 3.4.1.2 Flying hours by day under instruction in hot air lled balloons must include: a) Not less than 16 hours total ying time to cover the syllabus of training detailed in Part II, Section 5, Part B, Subpart 2; and b) 6 ascents by day under the instruction of a licensed balloon pilot of which 4 ascents must be made under the instruction of a BBAC instructor. 3.4.1.3 In addition to the above, applicants must complete: a) 1 solo ascent by day of not less than 30 minutes duration under the supervision of a CAA appointed examiner or delegated instructor (to be completed within the 6 months preceding licence application); and b) 1 tethered ight. 3.4.2 For PPL(BA) Issue with a Free Balloon Gas Filled Rating: An applicant for a UK PPL(BA) shall produce evidence of having satisfactorily completed a course of training to a syllabus recognised by the Authority, within the 24 months preceding the date of application for the licence. Flying hours by day under instruction in gas balloons must include: a) not less than 16 hours total ying time to cover the syllabus of training detailed in Part II, Section 5, Part B, Subpart 2; and b) 6 ascents by day under the instruction of a licensed Gas Balloon pilot of which 4 ascents must be made under the instruction of a BBAC Gas Balloon Instructor or CAA appointed Gas Balloon Examiner. NOTE: The PPL(BA) will be rated for netless or netted gas lled balloons according to the type in which the training and ight test is completed.
May 2012
3.4.3
Credits for Non-UK Licence Holders: Logbook evidence that the applicant has met the above minimum ying experience for a PPL(BA) issue with a Free Balloons Hot Air Filled Rating or a Free Balloons Gas Filled Rating as appropriate must be provided.
3.4.4
Night Flying Where an applicant wishes to exercise the licence privileges by night in hot air balloons, the following additional training must be completed: 2 night ights, each of which shall include a night take-off and subsequent night operation of not less than 1 hours duration under the supervision of a licensed hot air lled balloon pilot whose licence is not limited to day ying only.
3.4.4.2 Free Balloons Gas Filled: Where an applicant wishes to exercise the licence privileges by night in gas lled balloons, the following additional training must be completed: 2 periods of night operation of not less than 1 hours duration, which may be completed in 2 ights or a single ight spanning 2 nights under the supervision of a licensed gas lled balloon pilot whose licence is not limited to day ying only. 3.5 UK PPL(BA) Ground Examination Requirements An applicant for a UK PPL(BA) is required to pass written examinations in the following subjects: 1. Aviation Law, Flight Rules and Procedures 2. Human Performance and Limitations 3. Navigation 4. Meteorology 5. Airmanship and Balloon Systems (for Hot-air Balloons only) 6. Airmanship and Aerostatics (for Gas-lled Balloons only) The syllabus for subjects 1, 2, 3, and 4 is the same as for the CPL(B) (see Part II, Section 5, Part C). The syllabus for subjects 5 and 6 is maintained by the BBAC Senior Examiner, and a copy may be obtained from the club on request. The examinations are written multiple-choice papers and are normally conducted under the auspices of a Balloon or Airship Examiner. The above examinations are valid for licence issue for 24 months from the date of passing. Candidates must obtain not less than 70% in each subject to pass. 3.5.1 Credits from Ground Examinations The holder of a valid UK or Part-FCL Private or Professional Pilots Licence for any category of aircraft is credited the examinations in Aviation Law, Flight Rules and Procedures, Meteorology and, if already passed, Human Performance and Limitations. Holders of a valid non-UK ICAO Annex I compliant Private or Professional Pilots Licence (Balloons) issued by an ICAO Contracting State (an ICAO balloon pilots licence) are credited the examinations in Navigation, Meteorology, Airmanship and Balloon Systems.
May 2012
3.6
UK PPL(BA) Flight Test Requirements An applicant for a UK PPL(BA) shall pass a Flight Test in a hot air lled or gas lled balloon as appropriate with, or supervised by, a CAA Authorised Balloon Examiner. The Flight Test is valid for licence issue for 9 months from the date of passing. NOTE: Where the balloon used can carry only one person, the ight test is carried out under the supervision of the Examiner. There is no requirement for a further solo ight. The licence will be restricted to solo ying only, until a further test is passed in a balloon designed for multiple occupancy. It is not essential to complete the test in one ight, but the whole test must be passed in a 28 day period.
3.6.1
Credits from Flight Test: The holder of a non-UK balloon licence who has completed 5 ascents as pilot-incommand on a similar balloon type in the last 13 months will be credited with a pass for the ight test. DETAILS OF THE UK PPL(BA) FLIGHT TEST ARE GIVEN IN PART II, SECTION 5, PARTB, SUBPART 2.
3.7
UK PPL(BA) Medical Requirements An applicant for a UK PPL(BA) shall hold a valid Part-MED Medical Certicate or UK National PPL medical declaration. For full details please refer to Section 4, Part N. Applicants are strongly advised to ensure that they meet the appropriate medical standard before embarking on a course of training.
3.8
UK PPL(BA) Re-validation Requirements The minimum ying experience required to maintain balloon ratings in the licence is 5 ascents, each of at least 5 minutes duration, as PIC within the previous 13 months, or satisfactorily passing the Flight Test as detailed in Part II, Section 5, Part B, Subpart2. A pilot who has not met the requirement specied above to maintain the rating but wishes to qualify for a further 13 months ying must either, pass a balloon test, or undertake the balance of the required ascents as PIC with a BBAC instructor. If the period since the last ight own as Pilot-in-Command exceeds 4 years the pilot must apply to the CAA through the BBAC Senior Examiner for an assessment of the amount of dual and solo ying to be undertaken, and pass the skill test to revalidate a balloon rating in the licence.
3.9 3.9.1
Additional Balloon or Hot-Air Airship Rating Addition of a Free Balloons Hot Air Filled Rating: The holder of a PPL(BA) wishing to add a Hot Air Filled Balloon Rating to the licence shall comply with the following requirements: a) Undergo 5 hours ying training on hot air lled balloons to include 3 ascents with a person entitled to give such training to cover the syllabus of training detailed in Part II, Section 5, Part B, Subpart 2; b) Undertake a supervised solo ight. c) Pass a Flight Test as detailed in Part II, Section 5, Part B, Subpart 2 in a hot air lled balloon conducted by CAA Authorised Examiner. d) Pass the Airmanship and Balloon Systems Ground Examination.
May 2012
3.9.2
Addition of a Free Balloons Gas Filled Rating: Ratings are available for netted gas balloons and netless gas balloons. Conversion training may be on either type. The holder of a PPL(BA) wishing to add a Gas Filled Balloon Rating to the licence shall comply with the following requirements: a) Have achieved at least 50 hours experience as Pilot-in-Command of hot-air balloons. b) Undergo at least 10 hours ying training on gas lled balloons under the instruction of a BBAC Gas Balloon Instructor or CAA appointed Gas Balloon c) Examiner to cover the syllabus of training detailed in Part II, Section 5, Part B, Subpart 2 which must include not less than two ascents, one of which may be the ight test. d) Pass a Flight Test as detailed in Part II, Section 5, Part B, Subpart 2 in a gas balloon conducted by CAA Authorised Examiner. e) Pass the Airmanship and Aerostatics Ground Examination. The holder of a gas balloon rating of one type (netted or netless) may add the other type (netted or netless) by: f) Passing an oral examination on the technical knowledge and operation and differences between netted and netless gas balloons conducted by the authorised examiner. g) Having a practical demonstration of the envelope rigging and operation of the valve prior to take-off.
3.9.3
Addition of a Hot-Air Airship Rating (either Pressurised or Unpressurised): The holder of a PPL(BA) wishing to add a Hot-Air Airship Rating to the licence shall comply with the following requirements: a) Have achieved at least 5 hours experience as Pilot-in-Command of hot-air balloons. b) Undergo at least 5 hours ying training on a hot-air airship to include at least 3 hours dual instruction, and one supervised solo ight. c) Pass a Flight Test in a hot-air airship conducted by CAA Authorised Examiner, followed by a qualifying solo ight. d) Pass the Aircraft Technical examination conducted by the authorised examiner. This takes the form of an oral test on the technical differences between the hot-air balloon and the hot-air airship (either pressurised or unpressurised). NOTE: Where both the pressurised and unpressurised ratings are required the requirements shall be complied with separately for both pressurised and unpressurised hot-air airships.
3.9.4 3.10
Addition of a Gas Airship Rating: Requirements for the addition of a Gas Airship Rating have not yet been developed. UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence (FRTOL) Requirements Although an FRTOL is not a mandatory requirement for the issue of a UK PPL(BA), applicants who intend to operate radiotelephony equipment will require an FRTOL. FRTOL requirements are contained in Section 6.
May 2012
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
2 Privileges
There are no ICAO standards for gyroplanes. The PPL(G) does not benet from ICAO recognition. Details of licence privileges can be found in Schedule 7 of the Air Navigation Order, (please refer to Section 7, Part B). When a UK PPL(G) is issued, it will be endorsed with the following restriction: The holder of this licence is not permitted to y gyroplanes: a. out of sight of ground or water; b. by sole reference to instruments.
3 Requirements
3.1 Prerequisites for Training 3.2 Application for Training 3.3 Training content 3.4 Application for Licence issue 3.5 General Flying Test 3.6 Exemptions: 3.7 Application Procedure 3.8 Certicate of Validity Revalidation 3.9 Certicate of Validity Renewal 3.10 Radio Operators Licence 3.11 Flying Club Requirements 3.12 Carriage of Passengers 3.13 Gyroplane Differences Training 3.14 Allowable Credit For Time Spent On Wheel Balancing Exercises 3.1 Prerequisites for Training The prerequisites for training are: Minimum age there is no minimum age to start training however: a student cannot y solo until they are 16 years old; a student cannot apply for the PPL(G) until they are 17 years old. Medical Requirements: An applicant for a PPL(G) shall hold a valid NPPL medical declaration or a Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate. A student must hold a valid medical certicate or declaration when conducting solo ight training.
27 July 2012 Section 5 Part B, Subpart 3 Page 1
3.2
Application for Training Application for training is made directly with an AFI(G) or an FI(G). For a complete list of contact numbers please refer to the BRA website, as given in the contact section within the General Information section of this document. The acceptance of a person to start a schedule of training with an AFI(G) or an FI(G) is at the discretion of that AFI(G) or FI(G).
3.3
Training content The training syllabus for the PPL(G) is given in Appendix A of Standards Document 44. Initial training Except for training covered by any one of the exceptions set out in Notes 1, 2 or 3 below, all training given to a person prior to that person being granted a PPL(G) shall be undertaken in gyroplanes that are Type Approved by the CAA. For all parts of the PPL(G) syllabus other than solo ying, instruction shall be given in Type Approved gyroplanes with fully functional dual controls and the instructor seated at the second set of controls. The solo ying sections of the PPL(G) syllabus may be completed in gyroplanes having only one set of controls, which may be single seat Type Approved aircraft. Student pilots undertaking solo ying shall not carry passengers on such ights. Before ying a gyroplane of a different type, whether under training or after licence issue, a pilot shall complete differences training where applicable see paragraph 3.12. NOTE 1: Solo ying exercises contained in the PPL(G) syllabus may be carried out in a gyroplane (single or two seat) that is not Type Approved, subject to the following conditions: a) the gyroplane is wholly and solely owned by the student pilot and no valuable consideration is given or promised for its use for the ight or ights; and b) the gyroplane has a valid permit to y issued by the CAA that does not include any condition, limitation or condition that would prohibit its use for the ight or ights; and c) there is no other mandatory restriction notied by the CAA, such as a Mandatory Permit Directive, whether specic or general in its applicability that would prohibit the use of the gyroplane for the ight or ights. d) before authorising any solo ight the instructor shall verify, by ying the aircraft that is to be used through the manoeuvres required for the PPL(G) General Flying Test, that the ying characteristics of the aircraft are normal for the type and are within the capabilities of the student taking into account the level of skill and experience of the student. NOTE 2: Where an individual two seat, non-Type Approved gyroplane has a training permission that was issued by the CAA prior to 1 July 2012, the gyroplane may be used for dual instruction unless the permission is withdrawn, cancelled or revoked by the CAA. NOTE 3: Permissions were issued by the CAA prior to 1 July 2012 to named individuals ying specically identied single seat gyroplanes. These permissions allowed them to receive instruction that is not limited to the solo ying sections of the syllabus for the PPL(G). These permissions may be used until the named person is granted a PPL(G), unless the permission is withdrawn, cancelled or revoked by the CAA.
27 July 2012
Solo training Before solo ying begins, at least the following exercises shall have been satisfactorily completed to solo standard on a two seat gyroplane and signed in the personal ying log of the student annotated competent for solo by an FI(G): Upper Air Work Advanced Rotor Management including Wheel Balancing Low Hops and High Hops Circuits, Take offs and Landings Emergency Procedures including Emergency Field Landings Skill Test General Flying Tests for the grant of the PPL(G) shall be conducted using Type Approved gyroplanes with fully functional dual controls (or a gyroplane specied under Note 2 above), with the examiner occupying the seat that would be used by an instructor. 3.4 Application for Licence issue Requirements for Licence issue The requirements for the issue of a Licence are: The completion of a course of training dened by the syllabus in Appendix A of Standards Document 44. The course shall include theoretical knowledge and ight instruction appropriate to the privileges given. All training shall be suitably recorded by the instructing AFI(G) or FI(G). These records shall be held and retained by the AFI(G) or FI(G) as part of their training notes. Completion of a minimum of 40 hours of ight training (dual and solo) supervised by an authorised instructor in any ying machine. These ights must be recorded in a personal ying log detailing the syllabus and exercise numbers own. A log can be maintained electronically but it must be printed out and signed by the owner/holder. Completion of a minimum of 15 hours of dual ying training in gyroplanes. This time may include the General Flying Test. Completion of a minimum of 10 hours of solo ying in gyroplanes including: a minimum of 3 hours of cross country, dened as ight which takes the aircraft a straight line distance of more than 10 nautical miles from the departing aireld. Completion of a minimum of:
Two cross country return ights where a landing is made at an aireld different from the point of departure and the return ight is made to the departure aireld on the same day. The route taken to the destination aireld must be more than 25 nautical miles. Each cross country ight must follow a different route.
Alternatively a single cross country ight can consist of landings made at two different airelds and returning to the aireld of original departure, and the route taken to each aireld is more than 25 nautical miles. The cross country ight requirements must have been completed within the 9 months preceding the application. These ights must be recorded on a form based upon the sample given in Appendix P of Standards Document 44.
27 July 2012
Crediting of experience: The exercises Wheel Balancing and Rotor Management may only be counted up to a maximum of 2 hours for credit towards the ight time requirements for licence issue. Training in an authorised gyro-glider, under the supervision of an AFI(G) or FI(G) can only be counted up to a maximum of 2 hours. Pass in the examination Gyroplane (Type) relevant to the gyroplane that is to be used for the General Flying Test. This test must have been completed within the 9 months preceding the application. The schedule for this test is given in AppendixF of Standards Document 44. Applicants for a PPL(G) shall demonstrate through the completion of a skill test the ability to perform, as PIC on gyroplanes, the relevant procedures and manoeuvres with competency appropriate to the privileges granted. The General Flying Test, conducted by an FE(G) and according to the schedule given in Appendix G of Standards Document 44 and recorded in an appropriate manner. This test must have been completed within the 9 months preceding the application and within 6 months of the completion of the training. Passes in the theoretical elements within the 24 months preceding the application. The following exam should be passed prior to solo ight: Aviation Law, Flight Rules and Procedures. The following exams should be passed prior to qualifying cross country ight: Human Performance and Limitations; Navigation; Meteorology. The following exam should be passed prior to the General Flying Test: Gyroplane Technical. 3.5 General Flying Test An applicant for a skill test for the PPL(G) shall have received instruction on the same type of gyroplane to be used in the test. The General Flying Test is a ight conducted under the supervision of an FE(G). The General ying Test for the initial issue of a PPL(G) shall be conducted in a gyroplane with a minimum of two seats and with functioning dual controls tted with the examiner occupying the seat that would be used by an instructor. An applicant shall pass all the relevant sections of the skill test. If any item in a section is failed, that section is failed. Failure in more than one section will require the applicant to take the entire test again. An applicant failing only in one section shall only repeat the failed section. Failure in any section of the retest, including those sections that have been passed on a previous attempt, will require the applicant to take the entire test again. All relevant sections of the skill test shall be completed within 6months. Failure to achieve a pass in all relevant sections of the test in two attempts will require further training. Further training may be required following any failed skill test. There is no limit to the number of skill tests that may be attempted. The schedule for the General Flying Test is given in Appendix G of Standards Document44.
27 July 2012
Conduct of the Test Should the applicant choose to terminate a skill test for reasons considered inadequate by the Flight Examiner (FE(G)), the applicant shall retake the entire skill test. If the test is terminated for reasons considered adequate by the FE(G), only those sections not completed shall be tested in a further ight. At the discretion of the FE(G), any manoeuvre or procedure of the test may be repeated once by the applicant. The FE(G) may stop the test at any stage if it is considered that the applicants demonstration of ying skills requires a complete re-test. An applicant shall be required to y the aircraft from a position where the PIC functions can be performed and to carry out the test as if no other crew member is present. Responsibility for the ight shall be allocated in accordance with national regulations. An applicant shall indicate to the FE(G) the checks and duties carried out. Checks shall be completed in accordance with the checklist for the aircraft on which the test is being taken. During pre-ight preparation for the test, the applicant is required to determine power settings and speeds. Performance data for take-off, approach and landing shall be calculated by the applicant in compliance with the operations manual or ight manual for the aircraft used. The FE(G) shall take no part in the operation of the aircraft except where intervention is necessary in the interests of safety or to avoid unacceptable delay to other trafc. An applicant may not take the General Flying Test until: the applicant for a general ying test shall be recommended for the test by the person responsible for the training, once the training is completed. The training records shall be made available to the examiner. 3.6 Credits: Credits for non-UK gyroplane Licence holders Where a holder of a non-UK gyroplane Licence seeks to obtain a UK gyroplane Licence, application for credits for previous experience should be made to the BRA providing details of the current Licence, the syllabus or training used to obtain the Licence and the personal ying logs showing the ying experience in gyroplanes. The holder must ensure that they fulll the requirements above and they are advised to consult with an FI(G). A letter of recommendation from the FI(G) would be useful to support the application. Any additional training determined by the BRA must be completed prior to conducting the GFT for UK PPL(G) issue. Credits for existing pilots Licence (non gyroplane) holders Where an applicant holds an existing current and valid pilots Licence where ground examinations of the theoretical subjects were required to obtain that Licence and the standard of the ground examination was of an equivalent or higher level, the ground examination shall be credited. Holders of a UK issued pilots licence in a different category of aircraft may be credited with, up to a maximum of 15 hours ying experience towards the PPL(G) training requirements. Non UK pilot licence holders seeking credit for theoretical exams undertaken in another state must provide satisfactory evidence of exam equivalence. Instructional hours gained in other countries Where an applicant has completed instructional hours on gyroplanes in other countries they may be credited towards the grant of a PPL(G) provided:
27 July 2012
they are logged in a personal ying log, annotated with the syllabus and exercise numbers and signed by a qualied instructor in that country; the exercises can be cross referenced to corresponding exercises in the UK PPL(G) Syllabus given in Appendix A of Standards Document 44. For each exercise logged as completed in another country, the applicant must demonstrate that they have attained the level of skill for each Specic Flying Objective specied for that exercise in the full PPL(G) syllabus to a UK AFI(G) or FI(G) who will sign the personal ying log to this effect. 3.7 Application Procedure Application is made on form SRG 2101 which is included as Appendix L of Standards Document 44. Details of where to submit the form and supporting documentation are included on the form. Validity of Licence The UK PPL(G) is issued with a lifetime validity but for the privileges conferred by it to be exercised, the holder must have at all times: a current medical certicate or medical declaration (see below); a valid aircraft rating for the aircraft that the holder is going to y (see below); a valid seat rating for the aircraft that the holder is going to y (see below); a current certicate of validity (see below). The holder must not carry any passenger, except an AFI(G) or FI(G), unless within the preceding 90 days the holder has made 3 successful take offs and 3 successful landings as the sole manipulator of the controls in a gyroplane of the same type. Valid aircraft rating When granted a Licence, it is only valid for the particular type of gyroplane that was used for the General Flying Test and as recorded in the licence holders personal ying log. In order to exercise the privileges to y a different type of gyroplane an aircraft rating must be added to the personal ying log of the pilot. The requirements for this endorsement are: Before the aircraft is own a suitable brieng must be obtained from an AFI(G) or FI(G) who holds an aircraft rating for that type. A recommended scope of the brieng is given in Appendix N. Student must receive differences training as set out in 3.13. Where a pilot wishes to y a gyroplane of a different type and there is no instructor with experience on that type, the differences training should be provided by a pilot qualied on that type, under the supervision of an instructor. The log (see below) must be endorsed by the instructor. The aircraft must be own under the supervision of the instructor until the pilot can demonstrate the level of competence required to pass the General Flying Test. This is given in the schedule in Appendix G. The pilot must demonstrate satisfactory knowledge of the aircraft in terms of performance and daily inspection to the level required to pass the gyroplane (type) examination. This is given in Appendix F. The aircraft rating shall be recorded as Aircraft Rating <type> entered alongside the record of the qualifying ight in the personal ying log of the holder, signed by the instructor conducting the training annotated with their approval number.
27 July 2012
NOTE: MPD 2005-008 prohibits ight in single-seat gyroplanes that have a cockpit nacelle and a thrustline to centre of gravity offset of more than 2 inches by pilots who have less than 50 hours solo ying since obtaining their PPL(G). 3.8 Certicate of Validity After 17 September 2012, the initial issue of a gyroplane licence will have the rating valid for 24 months. The revalidation and renewal process for gyroplane ratings will be aligned with the current PPL(A) JAR/EASA procedures. Part of this process will involve the examiner signing the ratings validity page in the applicants licence and not a Certicate of experience entry in the logbook. 3.8.1 Revalidation The administrative action taken within the period of validity of a rating that allows the holder to continue to exercise the privileges for a further specied period consequent upon the fullment of specied requirements There are two methods of revalidating a rating: a) Revalidation by Prociency check The rating may be revalidated by passing an aircraft rating revalidation ight test with a UK gyroplane Flight Examiner (FE(G)). If completed within the three months preceding the expiry date of the current rating, no loss of rating validity will be incurred- the new rating expiry date will be calculated from the preceding expiry date, not from the date of the prociency check. If the test is completed more than three months in advance of the expiry date of the rating, a new rating expiry date will be calculated from the date of the test. b) Revalidation by ying experience A gyroplane class rating can be revalidated by ying experience by producing logbook evidence to a gyroplane examiner, before the rating expiry date has passed, of the following ying experience completed within the 12 months preceding the rating expiry date. 12 hours of ight time in a gyroplane to include: i) 6 hours as pilot in command; and ii) 12 take-offs and landings; and iii) a training ight of at least 1 hour duration with an FI(G) who must countersign the appropriate logbook entry. The Training Flight The FI should make the purpose of the training ight clear at the outset. His function is to ascertain the applicants knowledge and skills, interjecting if necessary to improve on these. If the primary purpose of the ight was for some other training then the FI must select suitable items of general handling and brief how these will t into the prole for the purpose of maintaining the applicants knowledge and skills. When the aims have been achieved the FI will sign the applicants logbook, append his/her licence number and identify the Training ight. Transitional Procedures Current licence holders, pre 17 September 2012, have been able to revalidate by experience, i.e. 5 hrs ying experience every 13 months with a revalidation signature being placed in the logbook.
27 July 2012
Such applicants who wish to revalidate by experience after the 17 September 2012 may do so once. The examiner will complete an entry into the ratings page of the licence and will annotate the validity period of 24 months not 13 months. The next time the rating is to be renewed or revalidated it is to be done in accordance with the process, listed in this document, which comes into effect on 17 September 2012. 3.8.2 Renewal Renewal means: The administrative action taken after a rating has lapsed that renews the privileges of the rating for a further specied period consequent upon the fullment of specied requirements Certicate of Validity Renewal THE RENEWAL REQUIREMENTS ARE DEPENDENT ON THE AMOUNT OF TIME WHICH HAS ELAPSED SINCE THE RATING LAPSED. Where a certicate of validity has expired for a period not exceeding 24 months: An applicant who wishes to renew his aircraft rating for a further 24 months shall pass the Aircraft rating revalidation ight test. The ight test will require the applicant to demonstrate that he/she is competent to y the gyroplane as PIC and includes the following items: all maneuvers used in normal ight, including take-off and landing and simulated forced landing. Where a certicate of validity has expired for a period exceeding 24 months but not more than 5 years since having own as PIC in a gyroplane: Complete the following training syllabus, which must be completed within the 9 month period preceding the date of issue of the rating: a) Ground Discussion of changes to regulations, procedures etc. introduced since the last ight as PIC and revision of the Aviation Law and ight rules and procedures syllabus for the PPL. Revision of the Human Performance and Limitations syllabus. b) Flight At least one hours training including circuits landings and ground handling to include a power-off approach and landing to touchdown to a selected area under the direction of the FI. On completion of the training syllabus the ight test with an FE(G) consisting of one ight in a gyroplane of the appropriate type to include: i) a general ight test to cover all items in the ight test for the initial issue of the aircraft rating; and ii) a cross-country ight to an aerodrome at least 30 minutes ying time from the aerodrome of departure, a circuit and landing at the destination, and a return ight to the aerodrome of departure, the preparation (ight planning) for each leg will form part of this test. Where a certicate of validity has expired for a period exceeding 5 years since having own as PIC in a gyroplane: The applicant must apply to the CAA, through the BRA, for an assessment of the training and subsequent testing required for the renewal of the aircraft rating.
27 July 2012
When the applicant has successfully renewed or revalidated his rating the FE(G) will then complete form SRG/1119 and complete the ratings page of the applicants licence. The SRG/1119 form is to be sent to Gatwick. The CAA will charge no fee provided that the examiner signs the certicate. 3.9 Radio Operators Licence All pilots are encouraged to have and use the radio telephony equipment in their gyroplane. In order to use the equipment it is necessary for the pilot to obtain a Flight Radio Telephony Operators Licence (FRTOL). Refer to Section 6 of CAP 804. 3.10 Flying Club Requirements The instructor and the student must be a member of the same ying club and the aircraft must be operated under arrangements entered into with the ying club. Use of aircraft for training Restrictions apply when an aircraft issued with a Permit to Fly (rather than a Certicate of Airworthiness) is used for ight training. The conditions that apply are set out in AIC 001/2011. The aircraft that may be used for training are set out in paragraph 3.3. Exceptions A gyroplane may have a restriction on its use for training, rendering it unsuitable for training unless a certain level of gyroplane experience has been attained by the pilot. Use of aireld for training Training can be undertaken at any Licensed or unlicensed aireld. Where training is operating from an unlicensed aireld, the guidelines given in CAP 793 Safe Operating Practices at Unlicensed Aerodromes should be adhered to. 3.11 Carriage of Passengers A passenger is any person other than the pilot or a pilot under instruction. The holder of a PPL(G) shall not act as PIC of a gyroplane carrying passengers unless within the preceding 90 days that person has made 3 take-offs and 3 landings as the sole manipulator of the controls in a gyroplane of the same type. 3.12 Gyroplane Differences Training Pilots who wish to y a gyroplane of a different type from that which they received training on, shall receive appropriate differences training from a gyroplane assistant ight instructor or ight instructor and have their log book endorsed by the instructor. In the case of single seat gyroplanes, arrangements shall be made with an instructor for the differences to be covered and where necessary a ight demonstration by the pilot to conrm his competency: a log endorsement shall be made. The formal requirement for differences training was introduced as a consequence of Safety Recommendations from the Air Accidents Investigation Branch following a number of gyroplane accidents. Presently there is only one gyroplane class single piston engine gyroplane. All UK registered gyroplanes are members of this class. Each type within this class is a variant of the class, but this does not reect the marked differences that are manifest between them. Certain gyroplanes have more demanding handling qualities and require a greater period of differences training. The minimum period of differences training (in hours) may be found from the table below. Time spent on wheel balancing exercises shall not be counted as differences training.
27 July 2012
NOTE: MPD 2005-008 prohibits ight in single-seat gyroplanes that have a cockpit nacelle and a thrustline to centre of gravity offset of more than 2 inches by pilots who have less than 50 hours solo ying since obtaining their PPL(G).
GYROPLANE MINIMUM DIFFERENCES TRAINING HOURS Converting to: Not Listed:
Tandem 2 Seat 1 1 1 1 1 1 Side-by-side Single Seat 2 Seat 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1
Listed:
Tandem 2 Seat 4 4 4 4 4 4 Side-by-side 2 Seat 4 4 4 4 4 4 Single Seat 4 4 4 4 4 4
Tandem 2 Seat Side-by-side 2 Seat Single Seat Tandem 2 seat Side-by-side 2 Seat Single Seat
LISTED GYROPLANES
Any single seat gyroplane with a cockpit nacelle and a thrust line / c.g. offset of more than 2 inches - refer to MPD 2005-008. RAF 2000
Converting from
Where a pilot wishes to y a single seat gyroplane of a different type and there is no instructor with experience on that type, the difference training should be provided by a pilot qualied on the type, under the supervision of an instructor. The log must be endorsed by the instructor. Where a student undertaking training for the PPL(G) converts from one gyroplane type to another during the training course, the differences training requirement must be added to the PPL(G) training requirement. 3.13 Allowable Credit For Time Spent On Wheel Balancing Exercises During wheel balancing a gyroplane is partially supported by the undercarriage and partially rotor borne. The Air Navigation Order denition of being in ight stipulates that, for piloted aircraft, a ight begins when, after the embarkation of its crew for the purpose of taking off, it rst moves under its own power..... When a student is carrying out wheel balancing there is no intent to take off, and therefore the aircraft is not considered to be in ight, even if it does become entirely supported by the rotor for any period during the wheel balancing activity. However, in recognition of the value of wheel balancing as a ying training exercise, up to 2 hours of such training may be counted towards the experience requirements for the PPL(G). Time spent on wheel balancing shall not be counted as differences training. This acceptance of wheel balancing as experience is subject to compliance with the following conditions: a) The wheel balancing will be the sole activity carried out during the period to be claimed as wheel balancing against the experience requirements. Short hops and other training activities for which becoming airborne is necessary, and therefore intended from the outset, may be logged as ight time; b) Entries in the log for wheel balancing must be annotated clearly as wheel balancing and not as ight time. Wherever possible the wheel balancing time should be recorded in a different column to that used to record ight time.
27 July 2012
Additional Information
None.
27 July 2012
2 Privileges
The privileges and conditions of the UK PPL(H) are as dened in Part A of Schedule7 to the ANO (2009), refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B:
3 Requirements
An applicant for the UK PPL(H) shall comply with the Part-FCL requirements for the PPL(H) as listed in CAP 804, Section 4, Part C, Subpart 2 or hold a Part-FCL PPL(H). Applicants for and holders of the UK PPL(H) shall hold a valid Part-MED Class 1 or Class 2 medical certicate. EASA helicopters Subject to the transition arrangements, the UK PPL(H) is not a valid licence for EASA Helicopters.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 5
1 Applicability
This licence is not yet available.
2 Privileges
To be advised.
3 Requirements
To be advised.
Additional Information
UK legislation does not yet make provision for this licence.
May 2012
Part C
UK Commercial Pilot Licence (CPL) Aeroplanes, Balloons, Gyroplanes, Helicopters, Unmanned Aircraft and Airships UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Aeroplanes UK CPL(A)
Subpart 1
1 Applicability
The holder of a UK CPL(A) may exercise the privileges of the licence to y non-EASA aeroplanes registered in the UK that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence. The same privileges of the licence may be exercised to y EASA aeroplanes registered in the UK until 8 April 2014; and until 8 April 2015 with the privileges restricted to those of the LAPL(A).
2 Privileges
The privileges and conditions of the UK CPL(A) are as dened in Part A of Schedule 7 to the ANO (2009), refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B.
3 Requirements
An applicant for the UK CPL(A) either shall comply with the Part-FCL requirements for CPL(A) as listed in CAP 804, Section 4, Part D, Subpart 1 or hold a Part-FCL CPL(A) or ATPL(A): Applicants for and holders of the UK CPL(A) shall hold a valid Part-MED Class 1 medical certicate.
NOTE: Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA CPL(A) to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA aeroplanes. Consequently a pilot who holds a Part-FCL CPL(A) does not require a UK CPL(A) unless they need to exercise the privileges of a rating that cannot be included in the Part-FCL licence; e.g. a type rating for a non-EASA aeroplane.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
2 Privileges
The privileges and conditions of the UK CPL(B) are as dened in Part A of Schedule 7 to the ANO (2009), refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B: NOTE: Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA BPL to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA Balloons. Consequently a pilot who holds a Part-FCL BPL without restriction as described in FCL.205.B(b) does not require a UK CPL(B) unless they need to exercise the privileges of a rating that cannot be included in the Part-FCL licence; e.g. a Class or Group rating for a non-EASA Balloon.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a CPL(B) shall hold a Part-FCL BPL without restriction, or comply with the following: 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 3.1 3.1.1 UK CPL(B) General Information UK CPL(B) Flying Experience Requirements UK CPL(B) General Flight Test Requirements UK CPL(B) Theoretical Knowledge Examination Requirements UK CPL(B) Aircraft Rating Requirements UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence (FRTOL) Requirements UK CPL(B) Medical Requirements
UK CPL(B) General Information Minimum age The minimum age for the grant of a UK CPL(B) is 18 years, but some of the required qualications for the grant of the licence may be gained earlier. Applicants should ensure that any qualications gained earlier will still be valid at the time they plan to apply for the grant of the licence. The validity periods of training, examinations and ight tests are covered in this subpart.
3.1.2
May 2012
3.1.3
Non-UK licence holders Any credits or exemptions against training for holders of a non-UK Pilots Licence or equivalent privileges issued in accordance with ICAO Annex 1 for Balloons are indicated at the relevant section. Where credit is to be claimed for a non-UK Pilots Licence or equivalent issued in accordance with ICAO Annex 1, a verication statement from the issuing authority of the ICAO State that issued it conrming the details of the licence must be included with the application submitted to the CAA. Applicants for conversion to a UK CPL(B) must hold a valid Medical Certicate or medical declaration (see 3.7).
3.2 3.2.1
UK CPL(B) Flying Experience Requirements CPL(B) (Restricted privileges) An applicant for a CPL(B) with privileges restricted to aerial work and private ying must have completed at least 35 hours ight time as pilot of balloons including the requirements of 3.2.1 a) and b) below. a) 15 hours of instruction in ying as pilot of balloons, including: i) 4 free ights, one of which must be an ascent to at least 5000 ft above the elevation of the place of departure; ii) 2 tethered ights. b) 20 hours as PIC, including: i) 16 free ights, including one cross-country ight with a landing made at a place not less than 20 km from the point of departure; ii) 2 tethered ights. NOTES: 1 The candidate must hold a PPL(B and As) licence before completing the PIC requirement. 2 A free ight means a ight in a free balloon of at least 5 minutes. 3 A tethered ight means a ight in a captive balloon of at least 5 minutes. 4 The instructional hours at 3.2.1 (a) must be to a syllabus recognised by the CAA and conducted by a person approved by the CAA for the purpose.
3.2.2
UK CPL(B) (Unrestricted Privileges) An applicant for a CPL(B) must have a minimum of: a) 75 hours as pilot of balloons, including the experience requirements of 3.2.1 a) and b); and; b) 60 hours as PIC of balloons.
3.3
UK CPL(B) General Flight Test Requirements Unless credited the skill test as detailed below, applicants for a CPL(B) shall pass a General Flight Test (GFT), conducted by an examiner authorised for the purpose by the CAA, in the rst type of balloon to be included in the Aircraft Rating of the licence. The details of the GFT are given in Part II to CAP 804, Section 5, Part C, Subpart 2, Appendix 1.
NOTE: Credit for GFT Holders of a professional balloon pilots licence issued by
another ICAO Contracting State who are in regular ying practice and meet the experience requirements given in 3.2, are credited the GFT for a period of 12 months from the date when they last exercised the professional pilot privileges of their non-UK licence as PIC.
Section 5 Part C, Subpart 2 Page 2
May 2012
However, candidates qualifying for such a credit must pass an appropriate aircraft rating ight test with a CAA Flight Examiner (3.2 and 5 Additional Information, Appendix 1). 3.4 3.4.1 UK CPL(B) Theoretical Knowledge Examination Requirements Unless qualifying for credits as detailed below, applicants for a UK CPL(B) shall to pass Theoretical Knowledge examinations in: 1. Aviation Law, Flight Rules and Procedures 2. Human Performance and Limitations 3. Navigation 4. Meteorology 5. Aircraft (General) Balloons The syllabus for the examinations is given in Part II to CAP 804, Section 5, Part C, Subpart 2, Appendix 2. 3.4.2 Credit for Theoretical Knowledge Examinations 3.4.2.1 The holder of a valid UK or Part-FCL professional pilots licence is credited with passes in the following subjects: 1. Aviation Law, Flight Rules and Procedures 2. Navigation 3. Meteorology 4. Human Performance and Limitations (if already passed). 3.4.2.2 The holder of a valid professional pilots licence (Balloons) issued by another ICAO Contracting State who can show that he was examined to CPL(A), CPL(H) or higher standard will be credited with passes in the following subjects: 1. Navigation 2. Meteorology NOTE: Failure to pass any of the required papers in a maximum of four attempts will lead to withdrawal of any ground examination credits that have been granted on the basis of a non-UK licence. 3.4.3 Examination Conditions A candidate shall pass all Theoretical Knowledge examination papers within a period of eighteen months from the end of the calendar month when an initial sitting took place. A maximum of 6 sittings is allowed to complete the group with a maximum of 4 attempts per paper. The candidate may attempt the papers in any order and may opt for a schedule to meet their own training requirements. 3.4.4 Examination arrangements Written examinations for the CPL(B) are conducted by the CAA at an examination centre. Details of examination dates and closing dates for applications to take the examinations are published in Aeronautical Information Circulars (AICs). The examination in Aircraft (Type) may take the form of an oral test conducted by the authorised examiner who carries out the Aircraft Rating ight test.
May 2012
3.4.5
Examination Validity The Theoretical Knowledge examinations are valid for licence issue for a period of 36 months from the nal pass.
3.5
UK CPL(B) Aircraft Rating Requirements The privileges of a professional pilots licence may be exercised only in aircraft specied in the Aircraft Rating included in the licence and in respect of which the licence contains a valid Certicate of Test (C of T) or Certicate of Experience (C of E). Details of the aircraft rating syllabi are contained in Part II to CAP804, Section 5, PartC, Subpart 2, Appendix 3.
3.6
UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence (FRTOL) Requirements Pilots who intend to operate Radio Telephony equipment will require an FRTOL (CAP804, Section 6 refers).
3.7
UK CPL(B) Medical Requirements An applicant for a UK CPL(B) restricted licence (aerial work) shall hold a valid National PPL medical declaration or Part-MED Class 1 or 2 or LAPL medical certicate. An applicant for a UK CPL(B) unrestricted licence shall hold a valid Part-MED Class 1 or 2 medical certicate. Applicants are strongly advised to ensure that they meet the appropriate medical standard before embarking on a course of training. For full details please refer to the CAA web site www.caa.co.uk/medical.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 3
Reserved To be developed.
May 2012
2 Privileges
The privileges and conditions of the UK CPL(H) are as dened in Part A of Schedule7 to the ANO (2009), refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B.
3 Requirements
An applicant for the UK CPL(H) shall comply with the Part-FCL requirements for a CPL(H) as listed in CAP 804, Section 4, Part D, Subpart 2 or hold a Part-FCL CPL(H) or ATPL(H). Applicants for and holders of the UK CPL(H) shall hold a valid Part-MED Class 1 medical certicate. EASA Helicopters Subject to the transition arrangements, the UK CPL(H) is not a valid licence for EASA Helicopters.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 5
1 Applicability
This licence is not yet available.
2 Privileges
To be advised.
3 Requirements
To be advised.
Additional Information
UK legislation does not yet make provision for this licence.
May 2012
2 Privileges
The privileges and conditions of the UK CPL (As) are as dened in Part A of Schedule7 to the ANO (2009), refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B.
3 Requirements
An applicant for the UK CPL(As) shall comply with the Part-FCL requirements for the CPL(As) as listed in CAP 804, Section 4, Part D, Subpart 1 or hold a Part-FCL CPL(As). Applicants for and holders of the CPL(As) shall hold a Part-MED Class 1 medical certicate. Non-EASA Airships Article 62 of the ANO renders the EASA CPL(As) to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA Airships. Consequently a pilot who holds a Part-FCL CPL(As) does not require a UK CPL(As) unless they need to exercise the privileges of a rating that cannot be included in the Part-FCL licence; e.g. a type rating for a non-EASA Airship.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Part D
2 Privileges
The privileges and conditions of the UK ATPL (A) are as dened in Part A of Schedule7 to the ANO (2009), refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B.
3 Requirements
An applicant for the UK ATPL(A) shall comply with the Part-FCL requirements as listed in CAP 804, Section 4, Part F, Subpart 1 or hold a valid Part-FCL ATPL(A). Applicants for and holders of the UK ATPL(A) shall hold a valid Part-MED Class 1 medical certicate. Non-EASA aeroplanes Article 62 of the ANO renders the EASA ATPL(A) to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA aeroplanes. Consequently a pilot who holds a Part-FCL ATPL(A) does not require a UK ATPL(A) unless they need to exercise the privileges of a rating that cannot be included in the Part-FCL licence; e.g. a type rating for a non-EASA aeroplane.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 2
1 Applicability
The holder of a UK ATPL(H) may exercise the privileges of the licence to y non-EASA helicopters registered in the UK that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence. The same privileges of the licence may be exercised to y EASA helicopters registered in the UK until 8 April 2014; and until 8 April 2015 with the privileges restricted to those of the LAPL(H).
2 Privileges
The privileges and conditions of the UK ATPL(H) are as dened in Part A of Schedule7 to the ANO (2009), refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B.
3 Requirements
An applicant for the UK ATPL(H) shall comply with the Part-FCL requirements as listed in CAP 804, Section 4, Part F, Subpart 2 or hold a Part-FCL ATPL(H). Applicants for and holders of the UK ATPL(H) shall hold a valid Part-MED Class 1 medical certicate. EASA helicopters Subject to the transition arrangements, the UK ATPL(H) is not a valid licence for EASA Helicopters.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Part E
The UK Instrument Meteorological Conditions Rating for Aeroplanes UK (IMC) (endorsed as IR(Restricted) on Part-FCL licences)
1 Applicability
The IMC Rating is a national rating and can only be endorsed onto a UK aeroplane licence. When training for the issue of a UK Instrument Meteorological Conditions (IMC) Rating a syllabus recognised by the Civil Aviation Authority must be followed. Training for the IMC rating is permitted outside the UK provided that the ying training is conducted by an organisation that is approved by the UK Civil Aviation Authority for such purposes. Instruction on the course may only be given by an IRI or by an FI who is qualied to teach applied instrument ying. In agreement with EASA, UK JAA and National licences which contained the UK IMC rating for Aeroplanes issued prior to 8 April 2014 that are converted to EASA licences will retain IMC privileges. On a Part-FCL licence the UK (IMC) appears as IR (Restricted). The revalidation/renewal requirements of the IMC Rating shall apply to all IR (Restricted) Ratings. An IMCR rst obtained prior to 8th April 2014 can be added in the form of an EASA Instrument Rating with restrictions (IR(R)) to a UK-issued Part-FCL licence at any time in the future, including after 8th April 2014. IMCRs rst obtained after 8th April 2014 cannot be added to Part-FCL licences. IMCRs obtained after 8th April 2014 may continue to be added to UK national (non-Part-FCL) licences only.
2 Privileges
The IMC rating privileges are dened in Schedule 7 of the Air Navigation Order (2009) (please also refer to Section 7, Part B). The privileges of the IMC Rating or IR (Restricted) on a Part-FCL licence may be exercised within the UK. The IMC Rating may not be used in the airspace of any other Country unless permission to do so has been given by the appropriate authority of that Country. A multi-pilot IR(A) rating does not include IMC rating privileges for single pilot aeroplanes.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a UK IMC rating shall comply with the following requirements: 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 Flying Training/Experience Requirements Theoretical Knowledge Examinations Flight Test Rating Approach Types Rating Revalidation and Renewal
30 January 2013
3.1
Flying Training/Experience Requirements When applying for an IMC Rating applicants must produce logbook evidence of having met the following ying experience requirements: a) Experience i) 25 hours total experience as pilot of aeroplanes following PPL issue and which may include the training for the IMC rating. ii) 10 hours as Pilot in Command of aeroplanes to including 5 hours as Pilot in Command of aeroplanes on cross-country ights. b) IMC Rating Training At least 15 hours as Pilot under Training in instrument ying with an instructor in a dual controlled aeroplane. Up to 5 hours of this training may be completed in an EASA-STD device qualied BITD, FNPT I, FNPT II, up to 2 hours of which may be in other FSTDs recognised by the Authority. This training in instrument ying shall include at least 10 hours of ying by sole reference to instruments (during the IMC course). Where an applicant wishes to be tested for the IMC Rating on a single-pilot multiengine aeroplane the ying training must ensure that when in simulated instrument ight conditions in a multi engine aeroplane the applicant can maintain stable ight after an engine failure at climb power, then climb at the recommended speed and then execute the normal range of ight manoeuvres under asymmetric power. c) Requirement for a Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence Applicants for the IMC Rating must hold a valid UK issued FRTOL. Details on how to obtain the FRTOL can be found in Section 6.
3.2
Theoretical Knowledge Examinations Unless credited as detailed below, applicants shall pass a written theoretical knowledge examination covering subjects drawn from the IMC Rating course syllabus and the PPL(A) syllabus including questions on the planning and execution of a typical ight under IFR outside controlled airspace. The syllabus may be found in Part II of CAP 804, Section 5, Part E, The pass mark for the IMC theoretical knowledge examination is 72%.
3.3
Flight Test Unless credited as detailed below, an applicant for the rating must complete the required training before taking a Flight Test conducted by an Examiner authorised by the CAA. The test includes full and limited panel instrument ying, use of radio navigation aids whilst ying by sole reference to instruments, instrument approach procedures, bad weather circuits and landings. In the case of a multi-engine aeroplane it includes ight with asymmetric power. Detailed contents of the test are in Part II of CAP 804, Section 5, Part E. Initial, revalidation and renewal Flight Tests may be completed in more than one ight but not more than three (including any extra ight required to test limited panel items) and must be completed in a period of 28 days. Failure in any part of the test will require the applicant to take the full test again. Where an applicant chooses not to continue with a test for reasons considered inadequate by the examiner, that test will be regarded as a failure.
30 January 2013
There is no limit on the number of cycles of attempts that can be made to pass the ighttest. If the skill test for issue of the rating is conducted in an aeroplane without a separate turn coordinator or turn needle then the limited panel items will be carried out using the standby AI. In this case, applicants must have satisfactorily completed the limited panel items of the test schedule, (i.e. without gyro attitude and heading instruments) in an appropriately equipped aeroplane or FNPT ii within the 6 months preceding the skill test, with an FIE, IRE, CRE with IRR privileges or FE PPL with IMC privileges, and have a signed certicate in their log book to this effect. Alternatively this ight may be conducted as part of one of the three allowable test ights. 3.3.1 Validities The Flight Test and Theoretical Knowledge Examination required for the inclusion of an IMC Rating in an aeroplane pilot licence must be completed (and application for the rating submitted) within the time period shown below: Theoretical Knowledge Examination: 12 months validity for the conduct of a Flight test and 21 months for the issue of the rating. Flight Test: 9 months validity for the issue of the rating. The IMC Rating is valid for a period of 25 months after the last day of the month in which the test was successfully passed. 3.3.2 Credits An applicant who has held an ICAO IR(A) or military green aeroplane Instrument Rating or a UK professional pilots licence aeroplanes within the 10 years before the date of application for the IMC Rating is not required to undergo a course of ight or ground training but must pass the Theoretical Knowledge examination and initial IMC Rating ight test. An applicant who has held a military amber or white aeroplane Instrument Rating is required to complete discretional IMC training to cover the IMC syllabus, and to pass the initial IMC ight test and Theoretical Knowledge examination. An applicant who has held an ICAO IR(A) or military green aeroplane Instrument Rating or a UK professional pilot licence aeroplanes or a valid Aircraft Owners and Pilots Association (AOPA) Ground Instructors Certicate within the 5 years before the date of application for the IMC Rating will be credited with a pass in the Theoretical Knowledge examination. An applicant who holds an ICAO IR(A) or military green Instrument Rating (Aeroplanes) and has passed a single-pilot IR test in the 24 months preceding the date of application for the IMC Rating will be credited with a pass in the initial IMC Flight Test and the written examination. The applicant must apply for the issue of the IMC rating within 24 months of the last IR test passed, The IMC rating will be valid for 25 months from the date the last IR test was passed. The holder of a Part-FCL helicopter Night Rating (but not a former UK helicopter Night Rating) will be credited up to 2 hours of ying instruction by sole reference to instruments. See Note 1 below. An applicant who has qualied for the AOPA Radio Navigation Certicate will be credited with up to 5 hours of the instrument training of the Applied Stage of the IMC course. See Note 1 below.
30 January 2013
The holder of a valid ICAO IR(H) or military IR(H) who wishes to add an IMC Rating to a pilot licence (aeroplanes) is required to: a) have not less than 50 hours as a pilot of aeroplanes, including 15 hours as PIC; b) have received dual instruction in instrument ying in aeroplanes including not less than 5 hours ight time by sole reference to instruments gained in aeroplanes since the grant of a PPL(A); c) pass the initial IMC Rating Flight Test in aeroplanes.
NOTE 1: The reductions in hours referred to here are not cumulative. The maximum reduction in ying training allowed is 5 hours.
The holder of a valid UK CAA issued Professional Pilots Licence (Helicopters) will be credited with the Theoretical Knowledge Examination. Experience gained as PIC in a SLMG/TMG while under power throughout the ight can be counted towards the 25 hours total experience required. An applicant with a valid pass in all subjects for the Part-FCL ATPL(A), ATPL(H), CPL(A), CPL(H), IR(A) or IR(H) theoretical knowledge examinations will be credited the IMC Rating Theoretical Knowledge Examination. A pass in these examinations will be accepted for the grant of the IMC rating for a period of 36 months from the end of the month in which a pass in all the required subjects was gained. The acceptance period of the pass for the grant of the Part-FCL professional licence or instrument rating is NOT extended upon issue of the IMC rating. 3.3.3 UK National Professional Aeroplane Licence Holders IMC Rating privileges are contained within UK CPL(A) and ATPL(A) licences; (this does not include JAR-FCL or Part-FCL licences). There is no requirement for a separate IMC Certicate of Test for these licences. 3.3.4 Part-FCL Restricted Instrument Rating Where a licence containing a valid IMC rating or IMC privileges is replaced with a PartFCL licence, the IMC rating privileges may be preserved as a restricted Instrument Rating. This will appear on the licence as IR (Restricted). The privileges are the same as for the IMC rating. The use of the Rating is restricted to UK airspace. The renewal and revalidation requirements for the restricted IR are the same as for the IMC Rating. IMC Ratings or privileges gained after 7 April 2014 are not convertible to restricted IR on Part-FCL licences. 3.3.5 Part FCL Basic Instrument Flight Module The holder of a course completion certicate for the Part-FCL Basic Instrument Flight Module may have the total amount of ight training required in paragraph 3.1 reduced by 10 hours. 3.4 Rating Approach Types The syllabus for the IMC Rating requires a minimum of training and testing in prociency in 2 approach types. IMC rating holders are strongly urged to undergo further training with an appropriately qualied ight instructor before attempting to y additional approach types. 3.5 Rating Revalidation and Renewal The privileges of an IMC Rating or IR (Restricted) must not be exercised unless the licence contains a valid Certicate of Test (C of T).
30 January 2013
The period of validity of the C of T is 25 months from the date of the last satisfactory ight test (recorded in the Certicate of Revalidation) of the licence.
NOTE: Holders of a UK national CPL(A) or ATPL(A) need only maintain a valid licence, medical certicate and aircraft rating.
3.5.1
Revalidation The IMC Rating or IR (Restricted) will be revalidated by revalidation Flight Test, the details of which can be found in Pt II of CAP 804, Section 5, Part E. The candidate must show logbook evidence that, in the period since the previous ight test, he has successfully completed a let-down and approach to DH/MDH, a go-around and a missed approach procedure, using an aid of a different type from that used during item (b) of the new revalidation test. This shall be accomplished to the satisfaction of an instructor qualied to give instrument ying instruction. Alternatively, the candidate may carry out two approach procedures using different aids during the re-validation ight test.
3.5.2
Renewal Where the IMC rating or IR (Restricted) has expired by not more than 5 years, the revalidation requirements of 3.5.1 apply for renewal. Where the IMC rating or IR(Restricted) has expired by more than 5 years, the candidate shall carry out dual instruction, at the discretion of the FI or IRI as appropriate covering the IMC rating course, and pass the Initial IMC Rating Test with an IMC rating examiner in a suitably equipped aircraft. If the rating has expired by more than 10 years, then the IMC Theoretical Knowledge Examination must be passed.
3.5.3
Holders of a ICAO or Military Green Single-Pilot IR(A) (Non-Part-FCL) An IMC rating or IR(restricted) rating may be revalidated/renewed for a further period by the CAA, on the basis of the most recent Part-FCL or UK National single-pilot IR(A) ight test or military Green single-pilot (IR(A)) ight test. Application for revalidation/ renewal should be made to L&TS together with the current fee as per the scheme of charges.
Additional Information
None.
30 January 2013
Part F Subpart 1
1 Applicability
The holder of a UK Aeroplane licence may extend the privileges of their licence by adding non-EASA Class or Type ratings.
2 Privileges
UK Class and Type Rating Aeroplanes The privileges and conditions of the UK Class or Type Rating are to act as pilot on the class or type of non-EASA aeroplanes specied in the rating.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a non-EASA Aeroplane Class or Type rating to be added to a UK Licence shall comply with the Part-FCL requirements as listed in CAP 804, Section 4, Part H, Subpart 1, for the applicable Rating. In the case of a Type Rating, the applicant shall complete a course approved by the CAA.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 2
Helicopters
1 Applicability
The holder of a UK Helicopter licence may extend the privileges of their licence by adding a non-EASA Type Rating.
2 Privileges
UK Type Rating Helicopters The privileges and conditions of the UK Helicopter Type Rating are to act as pilot on the non-EASA type of helicopter specied in the rating.
3 Requirements
An applicant for a non-EASA Type Rating to be added to a UK Licence shall comply with the Part-FCL requirements as listed in CAP 804, Section 4, Part H, Subpart 2, for the applicable Rating and complete a Type Rating course approved by the CAA.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 3
Airships
1 Applicability
The holder of a UK Airship licence may extend the privileges of their licence by adding a non-EASA Airship Type rating.
2 Privileges
UK Airship Type Rating The privileges and conditions of the UK Airship Type Rating are to act as pilot on the type of non-EASA airship specied in the rating.
3 Requirements
Wherever practical, an applicant for an non-EASA Airship Type rating to be added to a UK Licence shall comply with the Part-FCL requirements as listed in CAP 804, Section 4, Part H, Subpart 4, for the applicable Rating. In the case of a Type Rating the applicant shall complete a course approved by the CAA.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Part G
1 Applicability
The holder of a UK pilots licence other than an NPPL may extend the privileges of their licences with additional ratings listed below. The additional privileges will apply to nonEASA aircraft registered in the UK. The use of the licence and ratings to y aircraft registered in other countries depends upon the legislation of those countries.
2 Privileges
UK Additional Ratings/Qualications The privileges of a UK licence with additional ratings/qualications endorsed are dened in Part A of Schedule 7 to the ANO (2009), refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B.
3 Requirements
An applicant for an additional rating to be added to a UK Licence which has an equivalent Part-FCL rating/qualication shall comply with the Part-FCL requirements as listed in CAP 804, Section 4, for the applicable rating/qualication. Where the UK rating has no equivalent Part-FCL rating/qualication, the requirements are set out in CAP 804, Section 5. Instrument meteorological conditions rating (aeroplanes) UK IMC (comply with the requirements of Section 5, Part E) Flying instructors ratings Comply with the requirements of Section 5, Part H Instrument rating (aeroplane) UK IR(A) Comply with the requirements of Part-FCL Instrument rating (helicopter) UK IR(H) Comply with the requirements of Part-FCL Night rating (aeroplanes) Comply with the requirements of Part-FCL Night qualication (aeroplane) Comply with the requirements of Part-FCL Night rating (helicopters) Comply with the requirements of Part-FCL Night rating (balloons) Comply with the requirements of Part-FCL Night qualication (helicopter) Comply with the requirements of Part-FCL Towing rating (ying machines) Comply with the requirements of Part-FCL
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Part H Subpart 1
Flight Instructor Aeroplane FI(A) Flight Instructor Helicopter FI(H) Type Rating Instructor Rating (multi-pilot Aeroplane) TRI (A) Type Rating Instructor Rating (Helicopter) TRI (H) Class Rating Instructor Rating (single-pilot Aeroplane) CRI (A) Instrument Rating Instructor Rating (Aeroplane) IRI (A) Instrument Rating Instructor Rating (Helicopter) IRI (H)
1 Applicability
The holder of a UK Instructor Rating may exercise the privileges of the Rating to carry out instruction in non-EASA aircraft registered in the UK that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence.
2 Privileges
UK Instructor Ratings The privileges and conditions of the various UK Instructor Ratings are as dened in Part A of Schedule 7 to the ANO (2009), refer to CAP 804 Section7, Part B:
3 Requirements
An applicant for the UK Instructor Ratings shall comply with the Part-FCL requirements as listed in CAP 804, Section 4, Part J for the applicable Rating and satisfy any nonEASA Aircraft Type specic requirements, where applicable.
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Subpart 2
AFI (A) Microlights FI(A) Microlights FI (SLMG) AFI(A) Powered Parachute FI(A) Powered Parachute 1 Applicability
The holder of a UK Instructor Rating for Microlights, SLMG or Powered Parachute may exercise the privileges of the Rating to carry out instruction in non-EASA Microlights, SLMGs or Powered Parachutes registered in the UK that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence.
2 Privileges
UK Instructor Ratings for Microlights The privileges and conditions of the various UK Instructor Ratings are as dened in Part A of Schedule 7 to the ANO (2009), refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B.
3 Requirements
3.1 3.1.1 3.1.2 3.1.3 3.1.4 3.1.5 3.2 3.2.1 3.2.2 3.3 3.3.1 3.3.2 3.3.3 3.3.4 3.4 3.4.1 3.4.2 3.4.3 3.4.4 3.4.5 3.4.6 AFI Rating Aeroplane Microlight Pre-requisite Requirements Approved Course of Training Flight Test and Ground Examination Endorsement of Aeroplane Types Rating Limitations FI(A) Rating Aeroplane Microlight FI(A) (Land, Sea) Microlights Experience/Requirements Rating Limitations FI Rating (SLMG) General Information Qualifying requirements Rating Limitations Revalidation/Renewal of Rating AFI Rating Aeroplanes Powered Parachutes General Information Course pre-entry requirements Course minimum requirements Single Seat Aircraft Only Limitation Flight Test and Ground Examination Rating Limitations
May 2012
Extension to Other Powered Parachute Types FI Rating Aeroplanes Powered Parachutes General Information Flight Test and General Examination Rating Limitations Extension to Other Powered Parachute Types AFI Rating Aeroplane Microlight Pre-requisite Requirements Before starting the associated ying instructor course for Microlight Aeroplanes the applicant must produce satisfactory evidence of having: a) a licence that includes a valid microlight aeroplane class rating with no operational restrictions and of having held a valid SEP or microlight aeroplane rating for at least the eight months prior to the AFI course. b) 100 hours as PIC of aircraft of which at least 40 hours must be on microlights including 5 hours as PIC on the type to be used on the AFI course. The 100 hour requirement may be reduced to 70 hours in the case of holders of BHGA Full and Senior Flying Instructors Certicates. c) Passed a pre-entry written examination and a Flight Test conducted by a Microlight FIE or a Microlight FIC Instructor in the 6 months immediately preceding the date of commencement of the course.
3.1.2
Approved Course of Training The minimum course of approved training for the AFI Rating (Aeroplanes) Microlight comprises not less than 40 hours ground training and 15 hours ight training conducted by an instructor authorised by the CAA to conduct AFI Rating Courses (FIC Instructor) at ATOs approved for this purpose. Up to 2 hours of the course may be mutual ying with another AFIC student.
3.1.3
Flight Test and Theoretical Knowledge Examination The applicant shall pass an AFI Rating Flight Test and Theoretical Knowledge Examination conducted by a FIE (Microlight) authorised by the CAA to conduct such tests. The candidate is responsible for providing a suitable microlight aeroplane for the test.
3.1.4
Endorsement of Aeroplane Types An AFI Rating holder wishing to instruct on an additional microlight type (i.e. weight shift, three axis or powered parachute) must have completed at least 5 hours as PIC on the type concerned. He must also have passed a Flight Test and Ground Examination on the type conducted by either a FIE (Microlight) or an instructor authorised to conduct Microlight AFI Courses.
3.1.5
Rating Limitations The syllabus for the AFI Course for microlights includes those items that form part of the syllabus of the Flight Test and Ground Examination for the NPPL Microlight. It does not include instruction in night ying, instrument ying or aerobatics and a FI or AFI Rating for Microlights will be endorsed with limitations in respect of such instruction.
27 July 2012
A microlight ying instructor qualied on landplanes and wishing to instruct on seaplanes must complete Seaplane differences training as specied in Schedule 7 of the Air Navigation Order and carry out sufcient ground and ight training with an appropriately qualied FIC instructor; pass a test conducted by an appropriately qualied FIC instructor or FIE and pass the Professional Seamanship Examination. This examination is booked through L&TS and taken at Gatwick or a CAA Regional Test Centre. 3.2 3.2.1 FI(A) Rating Aeroplane Microlights FI(A) (Land, Sea) Microlights Experience/Requirements To qualify for the grant of an FI Rating Microlight, the applicant must: a) have gained not less than 250 hours experience as PIC of aeroplanes of which at least 200 hours must be on microlights (160 hours on microlights in the case of holders of the BHGA Full or Senior Flying Instructors Certicate); b) have held an AFI rating valid for microlights for at least 10 months and have at least 100 hours experience instructing on microlights; c) have then passed a Flight Test and Ground Examination conducted by an FIE (Microlight), arrangements for which are as described in Section 5, Part A, Subpart2. 3.2.2 3.3 3.3.1 Rating Limitations As per 3.1.5 FI Rating (SLMG) General Information Much of the instructing which is given in motor gliders is for the training of glider pilots and the instructor is not required to teach aeroplane exercises. The British Gliding Association (BGA) has its own scheme of motor glider instructor ratings for teaching gliding exercises only. Details are contained in the Associations publication Laws and Rules For Glider Pilots and on the BGA website at www.gliding.co.uk An instructor teaching students for the NPPL(A) SLMG must hold a Flying Instructors Rating (SLMG). This rating carries a restriction stating that the privileges may only be exercised under conditions laid down by the BGA. Alternatively, instruction for the NPPL SLMG licence or rating can be given by the holder of an FI(A) with TMG rating or an FI(A) who has undergone differences training onto SLMG aircraft. The fundamental difference between a Flying Instructors Rating (FI(SLMG)), and the equivalent EASA Instructor Rating is that there is no CAA approved course for the FI(SLMG). The rating is issued by the CAA on the recommendation of the BGA and is separate from all other CAA issued FIRs. This is managed by the Associations Senior Regional Examiner for Motor Gliders. 3.3.2 Qualifying requirements The qualifying requirements for the instructor rating issued by the CAA are that the applicant must: a) hold a Part-MED Class 1 or Class 2 Medical Certicate or, for NPPL holders only, a medical declaration valid for the NPPL or LAPL medical certicate; b) hold either a valid PPL(A) or a valid Professional Pilots Licence (A) with the SLMG endorsement, a valid NPPL(A) with SLMG endorsement or valid Part-FCL aeroplane licence with TMG rating;
May 2012
c) hold a current Full Gliding Instructors Rating issued by the BGA; d) pass a competency Flight Test with an approved Examiner. The approved Examiner must have CAA authorisation, i.e. hold a Flying Instructor Examiner Authorisation (SLMGs); e) have a minimum of 25 hours ying experience as PIC on SLMGs. There is no requirement to hold a Motor Glider Instructors Certication (gliding exercises only) before attaining the FI(SLMG). Furthermore, since all applicants must hold a Full Gliding Instructors Rating, with its associated instructional experience, there is only one grade of FI(SLMG) (i.e. there is no Assistant Instructor category). 3.3.3 Rating Limitations There is no requirement for FI(SLMG) Rating to hold IMC Ratings or have any experience in instrument ying. The FI(SLMG) Rating will be issued with the limitation that no night ying or instrument ying instruction will be given. The rating will also include a limitation precluding aerobatic instruction. 3.3.4 Revalidation/Renewal of Rating The FI(SLMG) Rating must be revalidated every 25 months by completing a Flight and Ground Test with a BGA Panel Examiner. 3.4 3.4.1 AFI Rating Aeroplanes Powered Parachutes General Information Before starting the associated ying instructor course for Powered Parachute, the applicant must produce satisfactory evidence of having: a) a licence that includes a valid microlight aeroplane powered parachute rating (or microlight rating with powered parachute differences training endorsement) with no operational restrictions and have held a valid SEP or microlight aeroplane or powered parachute rating for at least the eight months prior to the AFI course; b) 100 hours as PIC of aircraft of which at least 40 hours must be in a powered parachute microlight and must include at least 5 hours as PIC on the aircraft to be used on the course; c) passed a pre-entry examination and a ight test conducted by a Microlight Flying Instructor Examiner (FIE) or Flying Instructor Course instructor (FIC) in the 6months immediately preceding the date of commencement of the course. The minimum course of approved training for the AFI Rating Aeroplanes Powered Parachute comprises not less than 25 hours ground training and 4 hours ight training conducted by an instructor authorised by the CAA to conduct AFI Rating Courses (FIC Instructor) at ATOs approved for this purpose. 3.4.2 AFI Course pre-entry requirement for holders of BMAA FLM or BHPA PPG* Instructor Ratings Before starting the AFI course for Powered Parachute, the applicant must produce satisfactory evidence of having: a) held a valid NPPL(A) (PP) without Operational Limitations; b) held a BMAA FLM or BHPA PPG Instructor rating; c) 10 hours a PIC on Powered Parachute (PP) including 2 hours as PIC on the aircraft to be used for the AFI course;
27 July 2012
d) passed a pre-entry written examination and a Flight Test conducted by a Powered Parachute Flying Instructor Examiner (FIE) or a Powered Parachute Flying Instructor Course (FIC) Instructor in the 6 months immediately preceding the date of the commencement of the course. * British Microlight Aircraft Association (BMAA) Foot Launched Microlight (FLM), British Hang Gliding and Paragliding Association (BHPA) Powered Paraglider. 3.4.3 Course minimum requirements The AFI Course minimum requirements for holders of BMAA or BHPA SPHG or FLM Instructor Ratings are to: Complete ground and dual ight training as required conducted by an instructor authorised by the CAA to conduct AFI Rating Courses (FIC Instructor) approved for this purpose, to achieve a recommendation as suitable for test by a Powered Parachute FIE for the grant of a AFI (Aeroplanes) Powered Parachute. 3.4.4 Single Seat Aircraft Only Limitation With the single seat limitation the AFI Course minimum requirements for holders of BMAA or BHPA SPHG or FLM Instructor Ratings are to: Complete ground training and ight demonstrations as required conducted, by an instructor authorised by the CAA to conduct AFI Rating Courses (FIC Instructor) approved for this purpose, and to achieve a recommendation as suitable for test by an FIE Powered Parachute for the grant of an AFI (Aeroplanes) Powered Parachute. 3.4.5 Flight Test and Ground Examination On completion of the approved course of training, the applicant will be required to pass an AFI Rating Flight Test and Ground Examination conducted by a FIE (Powered Parachute) authorised by the CAA to conduct such tests. Arrangements have been made for the BMAA to process applications for instructor tests for the issue, revalidation or extension of ying instructors ratings valid only on Powered Parachutes. Applications should be made direct to BMAA, who will then forward the application to the CAA for nal action. 3.4.6 Rating Limitations An AFI who completes the single seat Rating Aeroplanes (Landplanes) Powered Parachute course will have his licence endorsed with the restriction Single Seat Aircraft Only. The limitation restricts the holder to conducting ight training in accordance with the Solo Training Syllabus for the issue of an NPPL with a Powered Parachute Class Rating or the addition of a Powered Parachute Class Rating to an existing licence. The Single Seat Aircraft Only restriction may be removed by completing an instructor test conducted by an FIE entitled to test on Powered Parachutes during which the candidate demonstrates adequate knowledge and skill to be able to teach for the grant or renewal of the powered parachute rating in a two seat aircraft.
27 July 2012
3.5 3.5.1
FI Rating Aeroplanes Powered Parachutes General Information To be eligible to attempt the ight test and examination to obtain an FI Rating Powered Parachute (PP) the applicant must have completed 60 hours of ying instruction on powered parachutes using the privileges of a valid AFI rating, under the supervision of an Instructor entitled to give instruction in a Powered Parachute. The training must have included instructing at least one student for the complete NPPL (Powered Parachute) syllabus.
3.5.2
Flight Test and General Examination Applicants for the FI(PP) Rating will be required to pass a Flight Test and oral Ground Examination conducted by an FIE authorised to conduct tests for Microlight or Powered Parachute instructor ratings (FIEM or FIEPP).
3.5.3
Rating Limitations Where the applicant for the FI(PP) rating holds an AFI rating that has the Single Seat Aircraft Only limitation, that limitation shall also be applied to the FI rating. The limitation restricts the holder to conducting ight training in accordance with the Solo Training Syllabus for the issue, or addition, of a NPPL Powered Parachute Class Rating to an existing pilots licence. The Single Seat Aircraft Only restriction may be removed by completing an instructor test conducted by an FIE entitled to test on Powered Parachutes during which the candidate demonstrates adequate knowledge and skill to be able to teach for the grant or renewal of the powered parachute rating in a two seat aircraft.
Additional Information
None.
27 July 2012
Subpart 3
AFI(A) Gyroplanes FI(A) Gyroplanes
Gyroplanes
1 Applicability
The holder of an UK Instructor Rating for Gyroplanes may exercise the privileges of the Rating to carry out instruction in non-EASA Gyroplanes registered in the UK that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence.
2 Privileges
UK Instructor Ratings for Gyroplanes The privileges and conditions of the various UK Instructor Ratings are as dened in the Part A of Schedule 7 to the ANO, refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B.
3 Requirements
3.1 3.2 3.1 AFI(G) Rating Gyroplanes FI(G) Rating
AFI(G) Rating Gyroplanes The privilege of an AFI(G) is to conduct ight instruction for the issue, revalidation or renewal of a PPL(G) in Gyroplanes.
3.1.1
Restrictions of the rating The holder of the AFI(G) rating is not permitted to give instruction unless supervised by an FI(G). The supervising FI(G) must be present at the aireld, or ying within the local area whenever ying instruction is given by the AFI(G) in the circuit. The FI(G) must be at the aireld, or available by radio or telephone when the AFI(G) is ying cross country and that ight must be authorised by the FI(G). While conducting training under supervision, the AFI(G) shall not have the privilege to authorise student pilots to conduct rst solo ights and rst solo cross country ights. Instruction can only be given on a type of gyroplane for which the instructor: has a valid aircraft type rating endorsement in his personal ying log; and, where a gyroplane has dual controls, is competent at ying that type of gyroplane using the instructors controls.
3.1.2
Prerequisites for training The pre-requisites to commence the AFI(G) training course are: PPL(G) holder with a current Certicate of Validity. 150 hrs own P1 on any ying machine of which 100 hrs must have been own on a gyroplane. These hours to have been attained since the issue of the appropriate pilots Licence. 30 hrs own P1 on cross-country ights i.e. a ight where a landing is made at an aerodrome at least 25NM away from the departure aerodrome.
27 July 2012
Demonstrated by personal log entries, landing entries, competency at landing at airelds with: Full ATC or FISO service; A radio service; Non radio. Demonstrate to an FIC(G) an excellent ying capability, knowledge of the handling characteristics of the aircraft, and the ability to land the aircraft in the event of an real or simulated emergency. 3.1.3 Application for training Application for training is made directly with an FIC(G). For a complete list of contact numbers please refer to the BRA website, as given in the contact section within the General Information section of this document. The acceptance of a person to start a schedule of training with an FIC(G) is at the discretion of that FIC(G). 3.1.4 Training content Applicants for an AFI(G) shall have completed a course of theoretical knowledge and ight instruction. In addition to the specic elements prescribed: All applicants shall be trained to achieve the following competences: Prepare resources, Create a climate conducive to learning, Present knowledge, Integrate Threat and Error Management (TEM) and crew resource management, Manage time to achieve training objectives, Facilitate learning, Assess trainee performance, Monitor and review progress, Evaluate training sessions, Report outcome. The syllabus for the training is given in Standards Document 44, Appendix B. 3.1.5 Application for rating issue The requirements for the issue of an AFI(G) rating are: The completion of a course of training dened by the syllabus in Appendix B, suitably recorded by the instructing FIC(G). These records are retained by the FIC(G) as part of their training notes; Completion of a minimum of 40 hours of classroom training. This includes: the ight briengs for the exercises dened in the PPL(G) syllabus; the theoretical subjects as dened in the PPL(G) syllabus; Completion of a minimum of 20 hours of ying training; Complete an assessment of competence conducted by an FIE(G) according to the schedule in Standards Document 44, Appendix H;
27 July 2012
This assessment shall include: the demonstration of the competencies during pre-ight, postight and theoretical knowledge instruction; oral theoretical examinations on the ground, pre-ight and post-ight briengs and in-ight demonstrations in the appropriate gyroplane type; exercises adequate to evaluate the instructors competencies; The assessment shall be performed on the same type of gyroplane used for the ight instruction; When an assessment of competence is required for revalidation of an instructor rating, an applicant who fails to achieve a pass in the assessment before the expiry date of an instructor rating shall not exercise the privileges of that certicate until the assessment has successfully been completed. 3.1.6 Credits for existing instructor rating holders (non gyroplane) Where the applicant holds or has held an instructor rating in another category of aircraft issued by the CAA, the subjects of Aviation Law, Flight Rules and Procedures; Human Performance and Limitations; Navigation and Meteorology may be credited towards the classroom training requirements. In these circumstances the FIC(G) must ensure that the applicant is competent in delivering these subjects to students. There are no credits for the ight briengs, Gyroplane technical or the ying elements of the course. 3.1.7 Application procedure Application is made on form SRG 2102 which is included as Appendix M. Details of where to submit the form and supporting documentation are included on the form. 3.1.8 Revalidation of rating The AFI(G) rating is issued with a 3 year validity. It is revalidated by passing an assessment of competence conducted by an FIE(G) according to the schedule in Standards Document 44, Appendix H. 3.1.9 Renewal of rating If an AFI(G) rating expires it can be renewed by: Appropriate refresher training by an FIC(G) Conduct of assessment of competence conducted by an FIE(G) according to the schedule in Appendix H. 3.2 FI(G) Rating The FI(G) rating grants the privilege to: conduct ight instruction for the issue, revalidation or renewal of a PPL(G) in gyroplanes; supervise an AFI(G). 3.2.1 Restrictions of the rating Instruction can only be given on a type of gyroplane that the instructor: is entitled to act as PIC on the aircraft during such ight instruction; has a valid aircraft rating endorsed in his personal ying log; and, if a gyroplane is tted with dual controls, is competent at ying that type of gyroplane using the instructors controls.
27 July 2012
Prerequisites for training There is no additional training required for the FI(G) rating. Application for training There is no additional training required for the FI(G) rating. Training content There is no additional training required for the FI(G) rating. Application for rating issue The requirements for the issue of an FI(G) rating are: PPL(G) holder with a current Certicate of Validity; AFI(G) rating; A minimum of 100 hrs of giving dual ying instruction. This training must include the briengs and associated ying training of every exercise in the syllabus given in Appendix A of Standards Document 44; Has supervised at least 25 student solo ights; A letter of recommendation from the supervising FI(G) that the applicant is suitable to instruct unsupervised; Pass of a test conducted by an FIE(G) according to the schedule in Standards Document 44, Appendix H. This performance of this test should be at a level of competence higher than when it was done as an AFI(G), the applicant should be able to relate to real life experiences.
3.2.6 3.2.7
Credits for existing instructor rating holders (non gyroplane) There are no credits for holders of existing instructor ratings (non gyroplane). Application procedure Application is made on form SRG 2102 which is included as Appendix M of Standards Document 44. Details of where to submit the form and supporting documentation are included on the form.
3.2.8
Revalidation of rating The FI(G) rating is issued with a 3 year validity. It is revalidated by passing an assessment of competence conducted by an FIE(G) according to the schedule in Appendix H Renewal of rating If an FI(G) rating expires it can be renewed by: Appropriate refresher training by an FIC(G) Conduct of assessment of competence conducted by an FIE(G) according to the schedule in Appendix H of Standards Document 44.
Additional Information
None.
27 July 2012
Part I
Flight Examiner FE Type Rating Examiner TRE Class Rating Examiner CRE Instrument Rating Examiner IRE Synthetic Flight Examiner SFE Flight Instructor Examiner FIE
1 Applicability
The holder of a UK Examiner Certicate may exercise the privileges of the certicate to conduct ight examinations or prociency checks in non-EASA aircraft registered in the UK that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence for the purpose of issue, revalidation or renewal of a licence or rating.
2 Privileges
The Examiner Authorisation/Certicate issued by the CAA shows both the Part-FCL and national privileges. Part-FCL examiner privileges that are type specic may be used to conduct examinations or checks for UK (non-Part-FCL) licences.
3 Requirements
An applicant for the UK examiner certicate shall comply with the Part-FCL requirements as listed in CAP 804, Section 4, Part K, Subparts 1-6 (as applicable).
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
Part J
Flight Engineers
1 Applicability
There are no requirements in Part-FCL for Flight Engineer licences. This part sets out the requirements for UK Flight Engineer licences.
2 Privileges
The holder of a United Kingdom Flight Engineers Licence (F/EL) is entitled to act as ight engineer in any type of aircraft specied in an aircraft rating included in the licence.
3 Requirements
3.1 Minimum Age 3.2 Licence Validity 3.3 Eligibility 3.4 UK F/EL Flying Training Requirements 3.5 UK F/EL Theoretical Knowledge Examination Requirements 3.6 UK F/EL Skill Test Requirements 3.7 Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence (FRTOL) Requirements 3.8 UK F/EL Medical Requirements 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.3.1 Minimum Age The minimum age for an applicant for a UK F/EL is 21 years. Licence Validity The UK F/EL is a non expiring licence. Eligibility The following persons may be eligible to qualify for the issue of a UK F/EL: a) Experienced Aeronautical Ground Engineers who: i) hold a valid Aircraft Maintenance Engineers Licence (can be a Licence without Type Rating); or ii) have at least three years general aeronautical engineering maintenance experience; b) Royal Air Force Air Engineers with at least 400 hours ying experience as an Air Engineer; c) Holders of a valid Non-UK Flight Engineers Licence (Aeroplanes); d) Holders of a valid Professional Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes). 3.3.2 3.3.3 A UK F/EL must contain a Type Rating that allows the holder to exercise the privileges of the licence. Type Ratings are issued for the following aircraft: Airbus A300
May 2012
Boeing 707 Boeing 727 Boeing 747-100/200/300/S.P DC-6 DC-8 DC-10 L382G (Hercules) L1011 Tri-Star L188 Electra Shorts Belfast 3.3.4 The Royal Air Force (RAF) uses Flight Engineers (known as Air Engineers) on the following aircraft: C130 Hercules L1011 Tri-Star Nimrod Sentry (B707) VC-10 3.3.5 Non-UK Licence Holders Any United Kingdom ight crew licences issued on conversion of foreign licences will contain a statement on the licence to that effect. 3.4 UK F/EL Flying Training Requirements An applicant for a UK F/EL must undertake 100 hours of supervised Flight Engineer training on the rst aircraft type to be included in the licence. This must include the particular requirements specied in a) below. All Flight Engineer training must be completed within the 12 months preceding the date of application for licence issue. a) 100 hours* Supervised Flight Engineer Training on Type, can include i); i) 50 hours* (Maximum) training in a CAA Approved Flight Simulator of the same type. * Royal Air Force Air Engineers are credited with 50 hours of the 100 hours supervised Flight Engineer training required in a). Of the remaining 50 hours required on type, up to 25 hours may be completed in a CAA Approved Flight Simulator of the same type. Air Engineers who have more than 100 hours experience in a Service aircraft for which a type rating is issued (e.g. L1011 Tri-Star), will only be required to complete the Aircraft Rating Flight Test on that type. b) Complete a CAA Approved Type Rating Conversion Course. 3.5 UK F/EL Theoretical Knowledge Examination Requirements An applicant for a UK F/EL is required to: a) pass the Part-FCL ATPL(A) Theoretical Knowledge Examinations in the following subjects: Principles of Flight Airframes/Systems Mass and Balance Instrumentation
May 2012
3.5.1
Credits from Ground Examinations The holder of a valid Non-UK Flight Engineers Licence with more than 3000 hours experience as a Flight Engineer will be credited the Principles of Flight, Airframes/ Systems, Mass and Balance and Instrumentation examinations. A current UK Military Air Engineer will be credited the Airframes/Systems and Instrumentation examinations. Full details of the Part-FCL-ATPL(A) Theoretical Knowledge Examinations, Pass Rules, Validity Periods etc. are given in Subpart A and Appendices 1 and 3 to Part-FCL and, Section 4, Part F, Subpart 1 and Part L, Appendices 1 and 3 to CAP 804.
3.5.2
Note for RAF Air Engineers It has been agreed that qualied Air Engineers having passed the theoretical knowledge examinations may retain this pass for as long as they remain in current ying practice as appropriately categorised Air Engineers in the RAF. Once they leave the RAF, the 36 month acceptance period for licence issue will be calculated from the date of their last ight as Air Engineer in a military aeroplane.
3.6
UK F/EL Skill Test Requirements An applicant for a UK F/EL is required to pass a Flight Engineer Skill Test on the aircraft type to be included in the licence with a CAA Authorised Flight Engineer Type Rating Examiner. For further details of Flight Engineer Type Rating Examiners, please contact the CAA, Flight Crew Standards, L&TS. E-mail: ightcrewstandards@caa.co.uk Fax: +44 (0)1293 573959. Holders of a valid Non-UK Flight Engineers Licence which includes a specic aeroplane type, may have that type endorsed in the UK Licence without having to take an Aircraft Rating Flight Test on the type, provided that: a) the applicant has more than 3000 hours experience as a Flight Engineer including at least 100 hours experience as Flight Engineer on the type; and b) the holder can produce logbook evidence of having acted as Flight Engineer on the type in the ve years preceding date of application for licence issue. Applicants who are eligible for this credit should note that a Flight Engineer Skill Test must be completed with a Flight Engineer Type Rating Examiner before the privileges of the licence are to be exercised.
3.7
Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence (FRTOL) Requirements Although a UK FRTOL is not a requirement for the issue of a Flight Engineers Licence, applicants who intend to operate radiotelephony equipment will require an FRTOL (CAP 804, Section 6 refers).
3.8
UK F/EL Medical Requirements An applicant for a UK F/EL must hold a valid UK Class 1 Medical Certicate.
May 2012
Additional Information
None.
May 2012
1 Applicability
The Flight Radio Telephony Operators Licence (FRTOL) is a licence that may be issued to ight crew and other persons who have a requirement to operate the Aircraft Radio Station in a UK registered aircraft. The FRTOL is a national licence that may be printed onto a UK-issued Flight Crew Licence, or separately. The requirement to have a licence for a radio station in an aircraft and to be licensed or otherwise permitted to operate that radio station is detailed in Article 112 of the Air Navigation Order (ANO). Articles 50 and 50A of the ANO specify that an FRTOL is required in order to act as a radiotelephony operator in UK registered EASA and nonEASA aircraft. There are exceptions for ight crew under training and for sailplane pilots when transmitting on frequencies specically allocated for glider operation. 1.1 No person may operate an aircraft radio station in the air, or on the ground, unless they are in possession of a valid FRTOL, or are operating directly under the supervision of the holder of a FRTOL. This applies equally to ground crew and other persons who wish to operate radio transmitting equipment licensed in accordance with, and operating on, frequencies listed in the Aircraft Radio Licence. The FRTOL provides no privileges for the installation or establishment of a Radio Station; it is an operators licence. The FRTOL does not entitle the holder to operate a radio station installed anywhere other than in an aircraft. All aeronautical and aircraft radio stations require a Radio Licence issued by the CAA in accordance with the Wireless Telegraphy Acts as amended. The holder of a FRTOL is responsible for ensuring that the aircraft radio station they operate has a valid radio licence. Failure to do so will render them liable to prosecution under the Wireless Telegraphy Acts. The FRTOL issued by the CAA complies with the applicable requirements of the General Radio Regulations to the International Telecommunications Union (ITU). Unless the holder of a FRTOL has passed the relevant examination in High Frequency (HF) radio theory, the privileges of the FRTOL are limited to VHF only (specically to frequencies above 60 MHz). Holders of UK or EASA professional pilot licences do not have this limitation. UK radiotelephony procedures are detailed in CAP 413 The Radiotelephony Manual. This document can be viewed on the CAA web site at www.caa.co.uk/CAP413. This document is edited in parallel with CAP 493 The Manual of Air Trafc Services Part 1.
1.2
1.3
2 Privileges
The holder of a United Kingdom Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence is entitled to operate radiotelephony apparatus in any aircraft if the stability of the frequency radiated by the transmitter is maintained automatically; but is not entitled to operate the transmitter, or to adjust its frequency, except by the use of external switching devices. The privileges of the UK FRTOL are detailed in Schedule 7 to the ANO (see Section 7, Part B).
17 September 2012 Section 6 Part A Page 1
Article 62 of the Air Navigation Order provides for the holder of a radiotelephony licence issued in accordance with ICAO Annex 1 under the law of an ICAO Contracting State to exercise the privileges of that radiotelephony licence in UK-registered aircraft and in the UK in aircraft registered in other States, as if it were a FRTOL issued by the CAA. Pilot Certicates issued by some States do not confer International privileges for the operation of an aircraft radio station. For example, a United States Pilot Certicate alone issued by the Federal Aviation Administration conveys no radiotelephony privileges outside the USA and must be accompanied by an appropriate Form 605-FRC issued by the Federal Communications Commission to be valid.
3 Requirements
3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.1 3.2 Minimum Age FRTOL Examination and Test Requirements FRTOL Syllabus FRTOL Examination Credits FRTOL Validity FRTOL Application
Minimum Age An applicant for an FRTOL shall be at least 16 years of age. FRTOL Examination and Test Requirements Subject to the credits detailed below in section 3.4, an applicant for the FRTOL shall pass a theoretical written PPL Communications examination and a practical RTF Communications test. Upon successfully passing the examination and test an FTROL limited to VHF operations only can be issued. An additional HF written examination is available for candidates who wish to remove the VHF only limitation. Authorised RTF Examiners conduct examinations for the FRTOL. An authorised ground examiner may conduct the theoretical written examination when it forms part of the qualication for a PPL, LAPL or NPPL. Details of examinations are published regularly by AIC (White). A list of RTF Examiners is located on the SRG web site at: www.caa.co.uk/standardsdocuments.
3.2.1 3.2.2
An applicant for an FRTOL shall pass the relevant PPL Communications examination prior to attempting the practical test. Validity of examinations and tests The PPL Communications examination is valid for issue of the FRTOL for a period of 24 months from the date of passing the examination. A pass in the practical RTF Communications test is valid for the grant of the FRTOL for 24 months. If any validity period is exceeded the examination or test as applicable must be passed again before the FRTOL is issued. A pass in the HF written examination is valid for 24 months for the removal of the VHF only limitation. Where the RTF Communications test is taken together with the theoretical knowledge examinations for the issue of a PPL, LAPL or NPPL and all examinations are passed within an 18 month period and application for the FRTOL is made as part of the pilot licence application. The RTF examination will be valid for 24 months following the nal theoretical knowledge examination.
3.2.3
Applicants for the FRTOL shall have demonstrated language prociency in English at Level 4, 5 or 6, which must be valid on the date that the FRTOL is issued.
15 October 2013
3.3
FRTOL Syllabus The syllabus of training for the UK theoretical written PPL Communications examination and practical Communications test, is based upon CAP 413 The Radiotelephony Manual, the UK AIP, the ANO and AMC 1 FCL.210 and FCL.215 to Part-FCL. FRTOL Examination Credits The International Telecommunications Union General Radio Regulations Article 37 details the requirements for the issue of a Flight Radiotelephone Operator Certicate. Individual States are responsible for the procedures that determine compliance with these requirements. The CAA requires that UK professional pilots are familiar with the procedures contained in CAP 413 The UK Radiotelephony Manual, which is closely aligned with the Air Trafc Controllers phraseology manual. Approved Training Organisations (ATOs) providing both modular and integrated training for any UK-issued CPL, MPL, ATPL or IR shall ensure that the applicant either holds a valid UK FRTOL or has qualied for the issue of a UK FRTOL prior to attempting the ATPL, MPL, CPL or IR Skill Tests. Candidates for the IR, CPL, MPL or ATPL who do not hold a valid FRTOL shall hold a completed Form SRG/1106 (FCL 508) prior to taking the Skill Test. Subject to Notes 1 and 2 below, the following credits apply: Holders of a valid pass in the JAR-FCL/Part-FCL Communications Examinations in VFR and IFR Communications (Subject 90) are credited with the written PPL Communications theoretical examination for the validity period of that examination as dened in Part-FCL. Holders of a valid ATCO licence issued in accordance with EU Directive 2006/23/ EC are credited with the PPL communications theoretical written examination and the 24 month examination validity period shall not apply. Applications shall be made using Form SRG\1162 which can be downloaded from the SRG web site: www.caa.co.uk/fcl/forms. Holders of a valid FISO licence issued in accordance with Article 203 of the Air Navigation Order 2009 are credited with the PPL communications theoretical written examination and the 24 month examination validity period shall not apply. Applications shall be made using Form SRG\1162 which can be downloaded from the SRG web site: www.caa.co.uk/fcl/forms. The holder of a valid CPL or ATPL Licence issued in accordance with ICAO Annex 1 by another ICAO contracting State (including any JAR-FCL/Part-FCL pilots licence) who also holds a valid radiotelephony licence issued in accordance with Article 37 of the ITU Radio Regulations and has in excess of 1500 hours ight time engaged on international public transport ights, will be credited with the practical RTF Communications test and PPL Communications theoretical written examination; provided that the licence is valid and the practical test was conducted using the English language and English Language Prociency is shown on the licence. The holders of a Private Pilots Licence issued in accordance with ICAO Annex 1 by another ICAO contracting State (including any JAR-FCL/Part-FCL pilots licence) who also holds a valid radiotelephony licence issued in accordance with Article37of the ITU Radio Regulations will be credited with the written PPL Communications theoretical examination provided that the licence is valid and training was conducted using the English language and English Language Prociency is shown on the licence. Military Pilots qualied as an EFTG, SERP or QMP in Section 4, Part O shall be credited the RTF Practical Test. The UK practical RTF Communications test must be passed in the 24 months prior to the grant of the FRTOL.
3.4
15 October 2013
For both private and professional licence holders the licence must state that it is issued in accordance with the requirements of Article 37 of the ITU Radio Regulations. Applicants who believe they full the criteria for examination credits and licence conversion must submit the valid licence and provide logbook evidence of ights during which the privileges have been exercised. Applicants who hold licences in languages other than English must provide an English translation. NOTE 1: Holders of Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licences and privileges issued by States in ITU Region 2 (North and South America) or where no tests or examinations have been required will not be granted any credits against the UK FRTOL written examinations and practical tests. NOTE 2: A number of States are known to issue radiotelephony licences with VFR only privileges for use in National languages holders of any such licence will not be granted any credits against the UK FRTOL written examinations and practical tests. 3.5 FRTOL Validity Stand alone UK FRTOL issued before 17 September 2012, had a ten year validity. When these licences expire, if the holder still requires to hold an FRTOL, they must complete form SRG 1106 and pay the appropriate fee. A UK FRTOL issued after 17 September 2012, does not expire, but it is not valid unless the holder has language prociency in English at Level 6, or at Level 4 or 5 that has not expired. FRTOL Application The FRTOL is not a prerequisite for the issue of a ight crew licence and is not automatically issued. If an FRTOL is being applied for with pilot or ight engineer licence this must be indicated on the application for the ight crew licence. When applying for an FRTOL only, applicants must use the following forms; SRG 1106 for the grant and renewal of an FRTOL. SRG 1106 for the renewal of an FRTOL for Glider pilots (Sailplane licence holders). SRG 1162 for the grant of an FRTOL to an ATCO or FISO licence holder. An ATO training record form (SRG 1171), for licence applicants who are conducting PPL training, is available on the SRG web site This record is designed to ensure applicants receive training in all aspects of communications that may be tested in both the written and practical examinations. The record may be used by the candidate to indicate to the ATO examiner that the recommended training for the FRTOL has been completed. The use of the Form SRG 1171 is not mandatory and should not be submitted to the CAA with the licence application. Applicants who wish to claim credits against the FRTOL examinations must provide evidence to support their claim. Where this takes the form of a FRTOL issued by another State, the original licence must be valid and be submitted with the licence application.
3.6
Additional Information
None.
27 July 2012
Section 7 Part A
1 Introduction
1.1 The European Regulation 216/2008 (often referred to as the Basic EASA Regulation) has transferred rulemaking powers in respect of Flight Crew Licensing from the Members States to the European Parliament and the European Commission (as advised by the European Aviation Safety Agency). The Basic EASA Regulation denes the scope of the legislation and denes the essential requirements for licensing, as well as other aspects of civil aviation. Specic requirements for each aspect are dened in the Implementing Rules. The Implementing Rules for Flight Crew Licensing are set out in Regulation (EC) 1178/2011 as amended by Regulation 290/2012 the EASA Aircrew Regulation. This comprises a cover regulation with 7 annexes. These are: Annex I Part-FCL Annex II Conversion of European national licences Annex III Validation and Conversion of non-EU licences Annex IV Part-MED Annex V Part-Cabin Crew Annex VI Part-ARA, Authority Requirements Aircrew Annex VII Part-ORA, Organisation Requirements Aircrew The contents of Annexes I, II, III and VII are reproduced in this CAP 804, and references have been made to the other Annexes where necessary. The complete documents may be accessed via the EASA website at www.easa.eu.int. For convenience a consolidated version of the EASA Aircrew Regulation is reproduced in section 3 below without the Annexes.
1.2
1.3
1.4
2
2.1
The use of derogations for transition to compliance with the Aircrew Regulation
In recognition that it is not possible for licence holders and organisations to become compliant with the new rules immediately when they come into force, the Aircrew Regulation includes provisions under Article 12 for Member States to delay the mandatory dates for certain rules by means of derogations. The UK has notied the Commission that it is applying these derogations as follows: a) compliance with the requirements of all 7 Annexes will not be mandatory until 17 September 2012; b) the requirements for the validation of 3rd country licences in respect of noncommercial ights (only) will not be applied until 8 April 2014; c) the replacement of a non-JAR compliant aeroplane or helicopter licence with an EASA licence will not be mandatory until 8 April 2014; d) compliance with the requirements of ORA.GEN.200(a)(3) in respect of FSTD certicate holders that are not approved training organisations or holders of Air Operators Certicates will not be mandatory until 8 April 2014; e) obtaining the following to carry out the related activity will not be mandatory until 8April 2015:
2.2
27 July 2012
i) pilot licences for balloons, airships, sailplanes and powered lift aircraft; ii) the Light Aircraft Pilots Licence; iii) the aerobatic rating; iv) the sailplane and banner towing ratings; v) the mountain and mountain instructor ratings; vi) the ight test and ight test instructor ratings; vii) the multi-crew co-operation instructor for helicopters; viii) Part-ORA approval for organisations providing training for the Private Pilots Licence, Balloon licences or sailplane licences; ix) Part-ORA approval for organisations providing examiner standardisation courses. The use of these derogations is consistent with the transition arrangements set out in CAP 804, Section 1 and Section 2 Part B.
3
3.1
(2)
May 2012
(3)
different medical certicates for pilots, the conditions for issuing, maintaining, amending, limiting, suspending or revoking medical certicates, the privileges and responsibilities of the holders of medical certicates as well as the conditions for the conversion of national medical certicates into commonly recognised medical certicates; (4) the certication of aero-medical examiners, as well as the conditions under which general medical practitioners may act as aero-medical examiners; (5) the periodical aero-medical assessment of cabin crew members, as well as the qualication of persons responsible for this assessment. (6) the conditions for issuing, maintaining, amending, limiting, suspending or revoking cabin crew attestations, as well as the privileges and responsibilities of the holders of cabin crew attestations; (7) the conditions for issuing, maintaining, amending, limiting, suspending or revoking certicates of pilot training organisations and of aero-medical centres involved in the qualication and aero-medical assessment of civil aviation aircrew; (8) the requirements for the certication of ight simulation training devices and for organisations operating and using those devices; (9) the requirements for the administration and management system to be fullled by the Member States, the Agency and the organisations in relation with the rules referred to in paragraphs 1 to 8. Article 2 Denitions For the purposes of this Regulation, the following denitions shall apply: (1) Part-FCL licence means a ight crew licence which complies with the requirements of Annex I; (2) JAR means joint aviation requirements adopted by the Joint Aviation Authorities as applicable on 30 June 2009; (3) Light aircraft pilot licence (LAPL) means the leisure pilot licence referred to in Article 7 of Regulation (EC) No 216/2008; (4) JAR-compliant licence means the pilot licence and attached ratings, certicates, authorisations and/or qualications, issued or recognised, in accordance with the national legislation reecting JAR and procedures, by a Member State having implemented the relevant JAR and having being recommended for mutual recognition within the Joint Aviation Authorities system in relation to such JAR; (5) Non JARcompliant licence means the pilot licence issued or recognised by a Member State in accordance with national legislation and not having been recommended for mutual recognition in relation to the relevant JAR; (6) Credit means the recognition of prior experience or qualications; (7) Credit report means a report on the basis of which prior experience or qualications may be recognised; (8) Conversion report means a report on the basis of which a licence may be converted into a Part FCL licence. (9) JAR-compliant pilots medical certicate and aero-medical examiners certicate means the certicate issued or recognised, in accordance with the national legislation reecting JAR and procedures, by a Member State having implemented the relevant JAR and having been recommended for mutual recognition within the Joint Aviation Authorities system in relation to such JAR.
May 2012
(10) Non JAR-compliant pilots medical certicate and aero-medical examiners certicate means the certicate issued or recognised by a Member State in accordance with national legislation and not having been recommended for mutual recognition in relation to the relevant JAR. (11) Cabin crew member means an appropriately qualied crew member, other than a ight crew or technical crew member, who is assigned by an operator to perform duties related to the safety of passengers and ight during operations; (12) Aircrew means ight crew and cabin crew; (13) JAR-compliant certicate, approval or organisation means the certicate or approval issued or recognised or the organisation certied, approved, registered or recognised, in accordance with the national legislation reecting JAR and procedures, by a Member State having implemented the relevant JAR and having been recommended for mutual recognition within the Joint Aviation Authorities system in relation to such JAR. Article 3 Pilot licensing and Medical Certication Without prejudice to Article 7, pilots of aircraft referred to in Article 4(1)(b) and (c) and Article 4(5) of Regulation (EC) No 216/2008 shall comply with the technical requirements and administrative procedures laid down in Annex I and Annex IV to this Regulation. Article 4 Existing National Pilots licences (1) JAR-compliant licences issued or recognised by a Member State before this Regulation applies shall be deemed to have been issued in accordance with this Regulation. Member States shall replace these licences with licences complying with the format laid down in Part-ARA by 8April2018 at the latest. (2) Non JAR-compliant licences including any associated ratings, certicates, authorisations and/or qualications issued or recognised by a Member State before the applicability of this Regulation shall be converted into Part-FCL licences by the Member State that issued the licence. (3) Non JAR-compliant licences shall be converted into Part-FCL licences and associated ratings or certicates in accordance with: (a) the provisions of Annex II, or (b) the elements laid down in a conversion report. (4) The conversion report shall: (a) be established; by the Member State that issued the pilot licence in consultation with the European Aviation Safety Agency (the Agency);
May 2012
(b) describe the national requirements on the basis of which the pilot licences were issued; (c) describe the scope of the privileges that were given to the pilots; (d) indicate for which requirements in Annex I credit is to be given; (e) indicate any limitations that need to be included on the Part-FCL licences and any requirements the pilot has to comply with in order to remove those limitations; (5) The conversion report shall include copies of all documents necessary to demonstrate the elements set out in points (a) to (e) of paragraph (4), including copies of the relevant national requirements and procedures. When developing the conversion report, Member States shall aim at allowing pilots to, as far as possible, maintain their current scope of activities. Notwithstanding paragraphs (1) and (3), holders of a class rating instructor certicate or an examiner certicate who have privileges for single-pilot high performance complex aircraft shall have those privileges converted into a type rating instructor certicate or an examiner certicate for single-pilot aeroplanes. A Member State may authorise a student pilot to exercise limited privileges without supervision before he/she meets all the requirements necessary for the issuance of an LAPL under the following conditions: (a) the privileges shall be limited to its national territory or a part of it; (b) the privileges shall be restricted to a limited geographical area and to singleengine piston aeroplanes with a maximum take-off mass not exceeding 2000kg and shall not include the carriage of passengers; (c) those authorisations shall be issued on the basis of an individual safety risk assessment carried out by an instructor following a concept safety risk assessment carried out by the Member State; (d) the Member State shall submit periodical reports to the Commission and the Agency every three years.
(6)
(7)
Article 5 Existing national pilots medical certicates and aero-medical examiners certicates 1. JAR-compliant pilots medical certicates and aero-medical examiners certicates issued or recognised by a Member State before this Regulation applies shall be deemed to have been issued in accordance with this Regulation. Member States shall replace pilots medical certicates and aero-medical examiners certicates with certicates complying with the format laid down in Part-ARA by 8 April 2017 at the latest. Non JAR-compliant pilot medical certicates and aero-medical examiners certicates issued by a Member State before this Regulation applies shall remain valid until the date of their next revalidation or until 8 April 2017, whichever is the earlier. The revalidation of the certicates referred to in paragraphs 1 and 2 shall comply with the provisions of Annex IV.
2.
3.
4.
May 2012
Article 6 Conversion of ight test qualications 1. Pilots who before this Regulation applies conducted category 1 and 2 ight tests as dened in the Annex to Commission Regulation (EC) No 1702/2003, or who provided instruction to ight test pilots, shall have their ight test qualications converted into ight test ratings in accordance with Annex I to this Regulation and, where applicable, ight test instructor certicates by the Member State that issued the ight test qualications. This conversion shall be carried out in accordance with the elements established in a conversion report that complies with the requirements set out in Article 4(4) and (5). In order to convert ight engineer licences, issued in accordance with Annex1 to the Chicago Convention, into Part-FCL licences, holders shall apply to the Member State that issued the licences. Flight engineer licences shall be converted into Part-FCL licences in accordance with a conversion report that complies with the requirements set out in Article 4(4) and (5). When applying for the airline transport pilot licence (ATPL) for aeroplanes, the provisions on credit in FCL.510.A(c)(2) of Annex I shall be complied with. Without prejudice to Article 12 of Regulation (EC) No 216/2008 and where there are no agreements concluded between the Union and a third country covering pilot licensing, Member States may accept third country licences, and associated medical certicates issued by or on behalf of third countries, in accordance with the provisions of Annex III to this Regulation. Applicants for PartFCL licences already holding at least an equivalent licence, rating or certicate issued in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention by a third country shall comply with all the requirements of Annex I to this Regulation, except that the requirements of course duration, number of lessons and specic training hours may be reduced. The credit given to the applicant shall be determined by the Member State to which the pilot applies on the basis of a recommendation from an approved training organisation. Holders of an ATPL issued by or on behalf of a third country in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention who have completed the experience requirements for the issue of an ATPL in the relevant aircraft category as set out in Subpart F of Annex I to this Regulation may be given full credit as regards the requirements to undergo a training course prior to undertaking the theoretical knowledge examinations and the skill test, provided that the third country licence contains a valid type rating for the aircraft to be used for the ATPL skill test. Aeroplane or helicopter type ratings may be issued to holders of Part-FCL licences that comply with the requirements for the issue of those ratings established by a third country. Such ratings will be restricted to aircraft registered in that third country. This restriction may be removed when the pilot complies with the requirements in paragraph C.1 of Annex III.
2.
2.
3.
2.
3.
4.
5.
May 2012
Article 9 Credit for training commenced prior to the application of this Regulation 1. In respect of issuing Part-FCL licences in accordance with Annex I, training commenced prior to the application of this Regulation in accordance with the Joint Aviation Authorities requirements and procedures, under the regulatory oversight of a Member State recommended for mutual recognition within the Joint Aviation Authorities system in relation to the relevant JAR, shall be given full credit provided that the training and testing were completed by 8April2016 at the latest. Training commenced prior to the application of this Regulation in accordance with Annex 1 to the Chicago Convention shall be given credit for the purposes of issuing Part-FCL licences on the basis of a credit report established by the Member State in consultation with the Agency. The credit report shall describe the scope of the training, indicate for which requirements of Part-FCL licences credit is given and, if applicable, which requirements applicants need to comply with in order to be issued with PartFCL licences. It shall include copies of all documents necessary to demonstrate the scope of the training and of the national regulations and procedures in accordance with which the training was commenced. In order for holders of military ight crew licences to obtain Part-FCL licences, they shall apply to the Member State where they served. The knowledge, experience and skill gained in military service shall be given credit for the purposes of the relevant requirements of Annex I in accordance with the elements of a credit report established by the Member State in consultation with the Agency. The credit report shall: (a) describe the national requirements on the basis of which the military licences, ratings, certicates, authorisations and/or qualications were issued; (b) describe the scope of the privileges that were given to the pilots; (c) indicate for which requirements of Annex I credit is to be given; (d) indicate any limitations that need to be included on the Part-FCL licences and indicate any requirements pilots have to comply with to remove those limitations; (e) include copies of all documents necessary to demonstrate the elements above, accompanied by copies of the relevant national requirements and procedures. Pilot training organisations shall comply with the technical requirements and administrative procedures laid down in Annexes VI and VII and shall be certied. Pilot training organisations holding JAR-compliant certicates issued or recognised by a Member State before this Regulation applies shall be deemed to hold a certicate issued in accordance with this Regulation. In such case the privileges of these organisations shall be limited to the privileges included in the approval issued by the Member State.
2.
3.
3.
3.
May 2012
4. 5. 6.
Pilot training organisations shall adapt their management system, training programmes, procedures and manuals to be compliant with Annex VII by 8 April 2014 at the latest. JAR-compliant training organisations registered in a Member State before this Regulation applies shall be allowed to provide training for a JAR-compliant private pilot licence (PPL). Member States shall replace the certicates referred to in the rst subparagraph of paragraph 2 with certicates complying with the format laid down in Annex VI by 8 April 2017 at the latest. Flight simulation training devices (FSTDs) used for pilot training, testing and checking, with the exception of developmental training devices used for ight test training, shall comply with the technical requirements and administrative procedures laid down in Annexes VI and VII and shall be qualied. JAR-compliant FSTD qualication certicates issued or recognised before this Regulation applies shall be deemed to have been issued in accordance with this Regulation. Member States shall replace the certicates referred to in paragraph 2 with qualication certicates complying with the format laid down in Annex VI by 8 April 2017 at the latest. Aero-medical centres shall comply with the technical requirements and administrative procedures laid down in Annexes VI and VII and shall be certied. JAR-compliant aero-medical centre approvals issued or recognised by a Member State before this Regulation applies shall be deemed to have been issued in accordance with this Regulation. Aero-medical centres shall adapt their management system, training programmes, procedures and manuals to be compliant with Annex VII by 8 April 2014 at the latest. Member States shall replace aero-medical centres approvals referred to in the rst subparagraph of paragraph 2 with certicates complying with the format laid down in Annex VI by 8 April 2017 at the latest. Cabin crew members involved in the operation of aircraft referred to in Article 4(1)(b) and (c) of Regulation (EC) No 216/2008 shall comply with the technical requirements and administrative procedures laid down in Annex IV. The medical examinations or assessments of cabin crew members that were conducted in accordance with Regulation (EEC) No 3922/91 and which are still valid at the date of application of this Regulation shall be deemed to be valid according to this Regulation until the earlier of the following: (a) the end of the validity period determined by the competent authority in accordance with Regulation (EEC) No 3922/91; or (b) the end of the validity period provided for in point MED.C.005 of AnnexIV. The validity period shall be counted from the date of the last medical examination or assessment. By the end of the validity period any subsequent aero-medical re-assessment shall be conducted in accordance with Annex IV.
2. 3.
3.
2.
May 2012
Article 11a Cabin crew qualications and related attestations 1. Cabin crew members involved in commercial operation of aircraft referred to in Article 4(1)(b) and (c) of Regulation (EC) No 216/2008 shall be qualied and hold the related attestation in accordance with the technical requirements and administrative procedures laid down in Annexes V and VI. Cabin crew members holding, before this Regulation applies, an attestation of safety training issued in accordance with Regulation (EEC) No 3922/91 (EUOPS): (a) shall be deemed to be compliant with this Regulation if they comply with the applicable training, checking and recency requirements of EU-OPS; or (b) if they do not comply with the applicable training, checking and recency requirements of EU-OPS, they shall complete all required training and checking before being deemed to be compliant with this Regulation; or (c) if they have not operated in commercial operations by aeroplanes for more than 5 years, they shall complete the initial training course and shall pass the related examination as required in Annex V before being deemed to be compliant with this Regulation. 3. The attestations of safety training issued in accordance with EU-OPS shall be replaced with cabin crew attestations complying with the format laid down in Annex VI by 8 April 2017 at the latest. Cabin crew members involved in commercial operations of helicopters on the date of application of this Regulation: (a) shall be deemed to be compliant with the initial training requirements of Annex V if they comply with the applicable training, checking and recency provisions of the JARs for commercial air transportation by helicopters; or (b) if they do not comply with the applicable training, checking and recency requirements of the JARs for commercial air transportation by helicopters, they shall complete all relevant training and checking required to operate on helicopter(s), except the initial training, before being deemed to be compliant with this Regulation; or (c) if they have not operated in commercial operations by helicopters for more than 5 years, they shall complete the initial training course and shall pass the related examination as required in Annex V before being deemed to be compliant with this Regulation. Cabin crew attestations complying with the format laid down in Annex VI shall be issued to all cabin crew members involved in commercial operations by helicopters by 8 April 2013 at the latest. Member States shall designate one or more entities as the competent authority within that Member State with the necessary powers and allocated responsibilities for the certication and oversight of persons and organisations subject to Regulation (EC) No 216/2008 and its implementing rules. If a Member State designates more than one entity as competent authority: (a) the areas of competence of each competent authority shall be clearly dened in terms of responsibilities and geographic limitation;
2.
4.
5.
2.
May 2012
3.
4.
5.
6.
(b) coordination shall be established between those entities to ensure effective oversight of all organisations and persons subject to Regulation (EC) No 216/2008 and its implementing rules within their respective remits. Member States shall ensure that the competent authority(ies) has(ve) the necessary capability to ensure the oversight of all persons and organisations covered by their oversight programme, including sufcient resources to full the requirements of this Regulation. Member States shall ensure that competent authority personnel do not perform oversight activities when there is evidence that this could result directly or indirectly in a conict of interest, in particular when relating to family or nancial interest. Personnel authorised by the competent authority to carry out certication and/ or oversight tasks shall be empowered to perform at least the following tasks: (a) examine the records, data, procedures and any other material relevant to the execution of the certication and/or oversight task; (b) take copies of or extracts from such records, data, procedures and other material; (c) ask for an oral explanation on site; (d) enter relevant premises, operating sites or means of transport; (e) perform audits, investigations, assessments, inspections, including ramp inspections and unannounced inspections; and (f) take or initiate enforcement measures as appropriate. The tasks under paragraph 5 shall be carried out in compliance with the legal provisions of the relevant Member State.
Article 11c Transitional measures As regards organisations for which the Agency is the competent authority in accordance with Article 21(1)(b) of Regulation (EC) No 216/2008: (a) Member States shall transfer to the Agency all records related to the oversight of such organisations by 8 April 2013 at the latest; (b) Certication processes initiated before 8 April 2012 by a Member State shall be nalised by that Member State in coordination with the Agency. The Agency shall assume all its responsibilities as competent authority concerning such organisation after the issuance of the certicate by that Member State. Article 12 Entry into force and application 1. (a) This Regulation shall enter into force on the twentieth day following that of its publication in the Ofcial Journal of the European Union. It shall apply as from 8April2012. (b) By way of derogation from paragraph 1, Member States may decide not to apply the provisions of Annexes I to VII until 8 April 2013. By way of derogation from paragraph 1, Member States may decide not to apply the following provisions of Annexes I to VII: (a) the provisions related to pilot licences of powered-lift aircraft, airships, balloons and sailplanes until 8 April 2015;
2.
May 2012
(b) the provisions of Subpart B until 8 April 2015; (c) the provisions of points FCL.800, FCL.805, FCL.815 and FCL.820 until 8 April 2015; (d) in the case of helicopters, the provisions of section 8 of Subpart J until 8 April 2015; (e) the provisions of sections 10 and 11 of Subpart J until 8 April 2015; (f) point CC.GEN.030 of Annex V until 8 April 2015; (g) Annexes VI and VII to training organisations providing training only for the light aircraft pilot licence, private pilot licence, balloon pilot licence or sailplane pilot licence until 8 April 2015; (h) Annexes VI and VII to training organisations providing training for ight test ratings in accordance with point FCL.820 of Annex I to Regulation (EU) No 1178/2011 until 8 April 2015; (i) Annex V to cabin crew members involved in commercial operations by helicopters until 8 April 2015; (j) point ORA.GEN.200(a)(3) of Annex VII to FSTD qualication certicate holders not being an approved training organisation and not holding an air operator certicate until 8 April 2014; (k) Annexes VI and VII to non JAR-compliant approved training organisations and aero-medical centres until 8 April 2014. 3. By way of derogation from paragraph 1, Member States may decide not to convert non JAR-compliant aeroplane and helicopter licences that they have issued until 8April2014. By way of derogation from paragraph 1, Member States may decide not to apply the provisions of this Regulation to pilots holding a licence issued by a third country involved in the non-commercial operation of aircraft specied in Article 4(1) (b) or (c) of Regulation (EC) No 216/2008 until 8 April 2014. By way of derogation from paragraph 1, Member States may decide not to apply the provisions of Section 3 of Subpart B of Annex IV until 8 April 2015. By way of derogation from paragraph 1, Member States may decide not to apply the provisions of Subpart C of Annex IV until 8 April 2014. When a Member State makes use of the provisions of paragraphs 2 to 6 it shall notify the Commission and the Agency. This notication shall describe the reasons for such derogation as well as the programme for implementation containing actions envisaged and related timing.
4.
5. 6. 7.
This Regulation shall be binding in its entirety and directly applicable in all Member States.
May 2012
Section 7 Part B
The UK national legislation pertaining to Flight Crew Licensing is set out in the Air Navigation Order (ANO) as amended. For the day-to-day performance of administration and regulatory activities a consolidated version of the text of the ANO is published by the CAA as CAP 393. This may be accessed via the CAA website, or obtained from TSO (The Stationery Ofce). The general provisions of the ANO apply to all civil aviation activities that are outside of the scope of the EU Legislation. The provisions that are specic to the licensing of ight crew are in Parts 6, 7 and 8 (Articles 50 through 82). Where necessary these Articles make reference to Schedule 7 of the ANO, which sets out the privileges and conditions of the licences issued by the UK CAA in accordance with national legislation; (accordingly EASA licences are not included). Pilots should ensure that they are aware of the provisions of the ANO in so far as they affect their ying activities. For convenience the text of Schedule 7 with effect from the 2012 amendment is reproduced below. SCHEDULE 7 of the Air Navigation Order with effect from the 2012 amendment SCHEDULE 7 Articles 64 to 71 and 78
Flight crew of aircraft licences, ratings, qualications and maintenance of licence privileges PART A FLIGHT CREW LICENCES SECTION 1 United Kingdom Licences Sub-Section 1 AEROPLANE PILOTS Private Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) Minimum age 17 years Privileges: (1) Subject to paragraph (2), the holder of a Private Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) is entitled to y as pilot in command or co-pilot of an aeroplane of any of the types or classes specied or otherwise falling within an aircraft rating included in the licence. The holder may not: (a) y such an aeroplane for the purpose of commercial air transport, public transport or aerial work except in accordance with paragraph (3); (b) receive any remuneration for services as a pilot on a ight except in accordance with paragraph (4); (c) unless the licence includes an instrument rating (aeroplane) or an instrument meteorological conditions rating (aeroplanes), y as pilot in command of such an aeroplane: (i) on a ight outside controlled airspace if the ight visibility is less than three km;
(2)
May 2012
(ii) on a special VFR ight in a control zone in a ight visibility of less than 10km except on a route or in an aerodrome trafc zone notied for the purpose of this subparagraph; or (iii) out of sight of the surface; (d) unless the licence includes a night rating (aeroplanes) or a night qualication (aeroplane) y as pilot in command of such an aeroplane at night; (e) unless the licence includes an instrument rating (aeroplane), y as pilot in command or co-pilot of such an aeroplane ying in Class A, B or C airspace in circumstances which require compliance with the Instrument Flight Rules; (f) unless the licence includes an instrument rating (aeroplane) or an instrument meteorological conditions rating (aeroplanes), y as pilot in command or copilot of such an aeroplane ying in Class D or E airspace in circumstances which require compliance with the Instrument Flight Rules; or (g) y as pilot in command of such an aeroplane carrying passengers unless: (i) within the preceding 90 days the holder has made at least three take-offs and three landings as the sole manipulator of the controls of an aeroplane of the same type or class; and (ii) if such a ight is to be carried out at night and the licence does not include an instrument rating (aeroplane), at least one of those take-offs and landings has been at night. (a) The holder may y such an aeroplane for the purpose of aerial work which consists of instruction or testing in a club environment provided that, in the case of instruction, the licence includes a ying instructors rating, class rating instructor rating, ight instructor rating or an assistant ying instructors rating. (b) The holder may y such an aeroplane for the purpose of aerial work which consists of: (i) towing a glider in ight; or (ii) a ight for the purpose of dropping of persons by parachute; in either case in an aeroplane owned, or operated under arrangements entered into, by a ying club of which the holder of the licence and any person carried in the aircraft or in any glider towed by the aircraft are members. (4) The holder may receive remuneration for services as a pilot on a ight if: (a) the licence includes a ying instructors rating, a ight instructor rating or an assistant ying instructors rating which entitles the holder to give instruction in ying aeroplanes, microlight aeroplanes or SLMGs; and (b) the remuneration is for the giving of such instruction or the conducting of such ying tests as are specied in sub-paragraph (3)(a) in an aeroplane, a microlight aeroplane or an SLMG. Explanatory Note The text relating to the Basic Commercial Pilots Licence has been deleted. These licences are no longer available. As set out in Article 82A, a Basic Commercial Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) that includes specic restrictions is now a Private Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) as detailed above (which now allows remuneration of instructors); and a Basic Commercial Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) that does not include those specic restrictions is now a Commercial Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) as detailed below.
(3)
May 2012
Commercial Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) Minimum age 18 years Privileges: (1) The holder of a Commercial Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) is entitled to exercise the privileges of a United Kingdom Private Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) which includes an instrument meteorological conditions rating (aeroplanes) and a night rating (aeroplanes) or night qualication (aeroplane). The holder is entitled to y as pilot in command of an aeroplane: (a) on a special VFR ight notwithstanding that the ight visibility is less than three km; (b) when the aeroplane is taking off from or landing at any place notwithstanding that the ight visibility below cloud is less than 1800metres. (3) Subject to paragraphs (4) and (8), the holder is entitled to y as pilot in command of an aeroplane of a type or class on which the holder is so qualied and which is specied in an aircraft rating included in the licence when the aeroplane is ying on a ight for any purpose whatsoever. The holder may not: (a) unless the licence includes an instrument rating (aeroplane), y such an aeroplane on any scheduled journey; (b) y as pilot in command of an aeroplane carrying passengers unless the holder has carried out at least three take-offs and three landings as pilot ying in an aeroplane of the same type or class or in a ight simulator, approved for the purpose, of the aeroplane type or class to be used, in the preceding 90 days; (c) as co-pilot serve at the ying controls in an aeroplane carrying passengers during take-off and landing unless the holder has served as a pilot at the controls during take-off and landing in an aeroplane of the same type or class or in a ight simulator, approved for the purpose, of the aeroplane type or class to be used, in the preceding 90 days; (d) if the licence does not include an instrument rating (aeroplane), y as pilot in command of an aeroplane carrying passengers at night unless during the previous 90 days at least one of the take-offs and landings required by subparagraph (b) has been at night; (e) unless the licence includes an instrument rating (aeroplane), y any such aeroplane which has a maximum total weight authorised exceeding 2300kg on any ight for the purpose of commercial air transport or public transport, except a ight beginning and ending at the same aerodrome and not extending beyond 25 nautical miles from that aerodrome; (f) y such an aeroplane on a ight for the purpose of commercial air transport or public transport unless it is certicated for single pilot operation; (g) y such an aeroplane on any ight for the purpose of commercial air transport or public transport after attaining the age of 60 years unless the aeroplane is tted with dual controls and carries a second pilot who has not attained the age of 60 years and who holds an appropriate licence under this Order entitling the second pilot to act as pilot in command or co-pilot of that aeroplane; or
(2)
(4)
May 2012
(h) unless the licence includes an instrument rating (aeroplane), y as pilot in command or co-pilot of such an aeroplane ying in Class A, B or C airspace in circumstances which require compliance with the Instrument Flight Rules. (5) Subject to paragraph (6), the holder is entitled to y as pilot in command of an aeroplane of a type or class specied in an instructors rating included in the licence on a ight for the purpose of aerial work which consists of instruction or testing in a club environment. (6) The holder may exercise the privileges specied in paragraph (5) only an aeroplane which the holder is entitled to y as pilot in command on a private ight, an aerial work ight, a public transport ight or a commercial air transport ight under the privileges set out in paragraph (1) or (2) of these privileges. (7) Subject to paragraph (8) the holder is entitled to y as co-pilot of any aeroplane of a type specied in an aircraft rating included in the licence when the aeroplane is ying on a ight for any purpose whatsoever. (8) The holder must not at any time after attaining the age of 65 years act as pilot in command or co-pilot of any aeroplane on a ight for the purpose of commercial air transport or public transport. Airline Transport Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) Minimum age 21 years Privileges: The holder of an Airline Transport Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) is entitled to exercise the privileges of a Commercial Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) except that the restriction at sub-paragraph (4)(f) of those privileges does not apply. Sub-Section 2 HELICOPTER AND GYROPLANE PILOTS Private Pilots Licence (Helicopters) Minimum age 17 years Privileges: (1) Subject to paragraph (2), the holder of a Private Pilots Licence (Helicopters) is entitled to y as pilot in command or co-pilot of any helicopter of a type specied in an aircraft rating included in the licence. The holder may not: (a) y such a helicopter for the purpose of public transport or aerial work except in accordance with paragraph (3); (b) receive any remuneration for services as a pilot on a ight other than remuneration for the giving of such instruction or the conducting of such ying tests as are specied in paragraph (3); (c) y as pilot in command of such a helicopter at night unless the licence includes a night rating (helicopters) or a night qualication (helicopter); (d) unless the licence includes an instrument rating (helicopter) y as pilot in command or co-pilot of such a helicopter in circumstances which require compliance with the Instrument Flight Rules:
(2)
May 2012
(i) in Class A, B or C airspace at any time; or (ii) in Class D, E, F or G airspace unless ying at night and remaining clear of cloud and with the surface in sight; or (e) y as pilot in command of such a helicopter carrying passengers unless: (i) within the preceding 90 days the holder has made at least three circuits, each to include take-offs and landings, as the sole manipulator of the controls of a helicopter of the same type; or (ii) if the privileges are to be exercised by night and the licence does not include an instrument rating, within the preceding 90 days the holder has made at least three circuits, each to include take-offs and landings by night as the sole manipulator of the controls of a helicopter of the same type. (3) The holder may y such a helicopter for the purpose of aerial work which consists of instruction or testing in a club environment provided that, in the case of instruction, the licence includes a ying instructors rating, a ight instructor rating or an assistant ying instructors rating. Private Pilots Licence (Gyroplanes) Minimum age 17 years Privileges: (1) Subject to paragraph (2), the holder of a Private Pilots Licence (Gyroplanes) is entitled to y as pilot in command or co-pilot of any gyroplane of a type specied in the aircraft rating included in the licence. The holder may not: (a) y such a gyroplane for the purpose of public transport or aerial work except in accordance with paragraph (3); (b) receive any remuneration for services as a pilot on a ight other than remuneration for the giving of such instruction or the conducting of such ying tests as are specied in paragraph (3); (c) y as pilot in command of such a gyroplane at night unless the licence includes a night rating (gyroplanes) and the holder has within the immediately preceding 13 months carried out as pilot in command not less than ve take-offs and ve landings at a time when the depression of the centre of the sun was not less than 12 below the horizon. The holder may y such a gyroplane for the purpose of aerial work which consists of instruction or testing in a club environment provided that, in the case of instruction, the licence includes a ying instructors rating, a ight instructor rating or an assistant ying instructors rating. Commercial Pilots Licence (Helicopters and Gyroplanes) Minimum age 18 years Privileges: (1) Subject to paragraphs (2) and (5), the holder of a Commercial Pilots Licence (Helicopters and Gyroplanes) is entitled: (a) to exercise the privileges of a Private Pilots Licence (Helicopters) or a Private Pilots Licence (Gyroplanes) which includes respectively either a night rating (helicopters) or night qualication (helicopter) or a night rating (gyroplanes); and (3)
(2)
May 2012
(b) to y as pilot in command of any helicopter or gyroplane on which the holder is so qualied and which is of a type specied in an aircraft rating included in the licence when the helicopter or gyroplane is ying on a ight for any purpose whatsoever. (2) The holder may not: (a) y such a helicopter on a public transport ight unless it is certicated for single pilot operation; (b) y such a helicopter on any public transport ight after attaining the age of 60 years unless the helicopter is tted with dual controls and carries a second pilot who has not attained the age of 60 years and who holds an appropriate licence under this Order entitling the second pilot to act as pilot in command or co-pilot of that helicopter; (c) unless the licence includes an instrument rating (helicopter) y as pilot in command of such a helicopter in circumstances which require compliance with the Instrument Flight Rules: (i) in Class A, B or C airspace at any time; or (ii) in Class D, E, F or G airspace unless remaining clear of cloud and with the surface in sight; (d) y as pilot in command of a helicopter carrying passengers unless the holder has carried out at least three circuits, each to include take-offs and landings, as pilot ying in a helicopter of the same type or a ight simulator of the helicopter type to be used, in the preceding 90 days; (e) unless the licence includes an instrument rating (helicopter) act as pilot in command of a helicopter carrying passengers at night unless during the previous 90 days at least one of the take-offs and landings required in subparagraph (d) has been at night; (f) y such a gyroplane on a public transport ight unless it is certicated for single pilot operation; (g) y such a gyroplane at night unless the holder has within the immediately preceding 13 months carried out as pilot in command not less than ve takeoffs and ve landings at a time when the depression of the centre of the sun was not less than 12 below the horizon; or (h) y such a gyroplane on a public transport ight after attaining the age of 60 years unless the gyroplane is tted with dual controls and carries a second pilot who has not attained the age of 60 years and who holds an appropriate licence under this Order entitling him to act as pilot in command or co-pilot of that gyroplane. (3) Subject to paragraphs (4) and (5) the holder is entitled to y as co-pilot of any helicopter or gyroplane of a type specied in an aircraft rating included in the licence when the helicopter or gyroplane is ying on a ight for any purpose whatsoever. The holder may not: (a) unless the licence includes an instrument rating (helicopter) y as co-pilot of a helicopter ying in circumstances which require compliance with the Instrument Flight Rules: (i) in Class A, B or C airspace at any time; or (ii) in Class D, E, F or G airspace unless remaining clear of cloud and with the surface in sight; or
(4)
May 2012
(b) as co-pilot serve at the ying controls in a helicopter carrying passengers during take-off and landing unless the holder has served as a pilot at the controls during take-off and landing in a helicopter of the same type or in a ight simulator of the helicopter type to be used, in the preceding 90 days. (5) The holder must not at any time after attaining the age of 65 years act as pilot in command or co-pilot of any helicopter or gyroplane on a public transport ight. Airline Transport Pilots Licence (Helicopters and Gyroplanes) Minimum age 21 years Privileges: The holder of an Airline Transport Pilots Licence (Helicopters and Gyroplanes) is entitled to exercise the privileges of a United Kingdom Commercial Pilots Licence (Helicopters and Gyroplanes) except that the restrictions at sub-paragraphs (2)(a) and (2)(f) of those privileges do not apply. United Kingdom Commercial Pilots Licence (Helicopters) Minimum age 18 years Privileges: (1) Subject to paragraphs (2) and (5), the holder of a United Kingdom Commercial Pilots Licence (Helicopters) is entitled: (a) to exercise the privileges of a United Kingdom Private Pilots Licence (Helicopters) which includes a night rating (helicopters); and (b) to y as pilot in command of any helicopter which is of a type specied in an aircraft rating included in the licence when the helicopter is ying on a ight for any purpose. (2) The holder may not: (a) y such a helicopter for the purpose of commercial air transport1 or public transport unless it is certicated for single-pilot operation; (b) y such a helicopter for the purpose of commercial air transport or public transport after attaining the age of 60 years unless the helicopter is tted with dual controls and carries a second pilot who has not attained the age of 60 years and who holds an appropriate licence under this Order entitling the second pilot to act as pilot in command or co-pilot of that helicopter; (c) unless the licence includes an instrument rating (helicopter) y as pilot in command of such a helicopter in circumstances which require compliance with the Instrument Flight Rules: (i) in Class A, B or C airspace at any time; or (ii) in Class D, E, F or G airspace unless remaining clear of cloud and with the surface in sight; (d) y as pilot in command of a helicopter carrying passengers unless the holder has carried out at least three circuits, each to include take-offs and landings, as pilot ying in a helicopter of the same type or a ight simulator of the helicopter type to be used, in the preceding 90 days;
1. A United Kingdom Commercial Pilots Licence is not valid to y as pilot in command of a non-EASA aircraft that is referred to in paragraphs (a)(ii), (d) or (h) of Annex II of the Basic EASA Regulation on a commercial air transport ight see article 50C(2) and footnote (a) to that article.
May 2012
(e) unless the licence includes an instrument rating (helicopter) act as pilot in command of a helicopter carrying passengers at night unless during the previous 90 days at least one of the take-offs and landings required in subparagraph (d) has been at night. (3) Subject to paragraphs (4) and (5), the holder is entitled to y as co-pilot of any helicopter of a type specied in an aircraft rating included in the licence when the helicopter is ying on a ight for any purpose whatsoever. The holder may not: (a) unless the licence includes an instrument rating (helicopter) y as co-pilot of such a helicopter ying in circumstances which require compliance with the Instrument Flight Rules: (i) in Class A, B or C airspace at any time; or (ii) in Class D, E, F or G airspace unless remaining clear of cloud and with the surface in sight; or (b) as co-pilot serve at the ying controls in a helicopter carrying passengers during take-off and landing unless the holder has served as a pilot at the controls during take-off and landing in a helicopter of the same type or in a ight simulator of the helicopter type to be used, in the preceding 90 days. (5) The holder must not at any time after attaining the age of 65 years act as pilot in command or co-pilot of any helicopter on a ight for the purpose of commercial air transport or public transport. United Kingdom Airline Transport Pilots Licence (Helicopters) Minimum age 21 years Privileges: The holder of a United Kingdom Airline Transport Pilots Licence (Helicopters) is entitled to exercise the privileges of a United Kingdom Commercial Pilots Licence (Helicopters) except that the restriction at sub-paragraph (2)(a) of those privileges does not apply. Sub-Section 3 BALLOON AND AIRSHIP PILOTS Private Pilots Licence (Balloons and Airships) Minimum age 17 years Privileges: (1) Subject to paragraph (2), the holder of a Private Pilots Licence (Balloons and Airships) is entitled to y as pilot in command of any type of balloon or airship on which the holder is so qualied and which is specied in an aircraft rating in the licence and as co-pilot of any type of balloon or airship specied in such a rating. The holder may not: (a) y such a balloon or airship for the purpose of public transport or aerial work, other than aerial work which consists of instruction or testing in a club environment; (b) receive any remuneration for services as a pilot on a ight other than remuneration for the giving of such instruction or the conducting of such ying tests as are specied in subparagraph (a); or (c) y such a balloon unless the holder has within the immediately preceding 13 months carried out as pilot in command in a free balloon at least ve ights each of not less than ve minutes duration.
(4)
(2)
May 2012
Commercial Pilots Licence (Balloons) Minimum age 18 years Privileges: The holder of a Commercial Pilots Licence (Balloons) is entitled to exercise the privileges of a United Kingdom Private Pilots Licence (Balloons and Airships). (2) Subject to paragraph (3), the holder is entitled to y as pilot in command or copilot of any type of balloon specied in the aircraft rating included in the licence when the balloon is ying for any purpose whatsoever. (3) The holder may not act as pilot in command on a ight for the purpose of the public transport of passengers unless the holder has within the immediately preceding 90 days carried out as pilot in command in a free balloon at least three ights each of not less than ve minutes duration. Commercial Pilots Licence (Airships) Minimum age 18 years Privileges: (1) (2) The holder of a Commercial Pilots Licence (Airships) is entitled to exercise the privileges of a United Kingdom Private Pilots Licence (Balloons and Airships). The holder is entitled to y as pilot in command of any type of airship on which the holder is so qualied and which is specied in an aircraft rating included in the licence and as co-pilot of any type of airship specied in such a rating, when the airship is ying for any purpose whatsoever. (1)
Sub-Section 4 GLIDER PILOTS Commercial Pilots Licence (Gliders) Minimum age 18 years Privileges: The holder of a Commercial Pilots Licence (Gliders) is entitled to y for any purpose as pilot in command or co-pilot of: (a) any glider which has a maximum total weight authorised of not more than 680kg; or (b) a type specied in the rating included in the licence. Sub-Section 5 OTHER FLIGHT CREW Flight Navigators Licence Minimum age 21 years Privileges: The holder of a Flight Navigators Licence is entitled to act as ight navigator in any aircraft. Flight Engineers Licence Minimum age 21 years Privileges: The holder of a Flight Engineers Licence is entitled to act as ight engineer in any type of aircraft specied in an aircraft rating included in the licence.
May 2012
Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence Minimum age 16 years Privileges: The holder of a Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence is entitled to operate radiotelephony apparatus in any aircraft if the stability of the frequency radiated by the transmitter is maintained automatically but is not entitled to operate the transmitter, or to adjust its frequency, except by the use of external switching devices. Explanatory Note (not part of Schedule 7) The text relating to all JAR-FCL licences has been deleted. With the exception of licences that are marked Valid for UK registered aircraft because they are not fully compliant with JAR-FCL, all JAA licences issued by the UK CAA are European Part-FCL licences with effect from 8 April 2012. This change is enacted by Regulation (EU) 1178/2011 and the privileges of Part-FCL licences are set out in Annex I (Part-FCL) to that Regulation. As set out in Article 82A, UK-issued JAA ATPLs and CPLs that are marked Valid for UK registered aircraft because they are not fully compliant with JAR-FCL are now United Kingdom (national) ATPLs and CPLs as set out above. Section 3 National Private Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) National Private Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) Minimum age 17 years Privileges and conditions: (1) Subject to paragraphs (2) to (8) the holder of the licence is entitled to y as pilot in command of any SSEA, microlight aeroplane or SLMG for which a class rating is included in the licence. Flight outside the United Kingdom (2) The holder may not y: (a) such an SSEA or a microlight aeroplane outside the United Kingdom except with the permission of the competent authority for the airspace in which the aircraft is being own; or (b) such an SLMG in or over the territory of a Contracting State other than the United Kingdom except in accordance with a permission granted by the competent authority of that State provided that the holder may y any SLMG outside the United Kingdom if the licence includes an SLMG rating and a medical certicate appropriate for such a ight. Flight for purpose of commercial air transport, public transport and aerial work (3) The holder may not y any such aeroplane for the purpose of commercial air transport, public transport or aerial work except in the circumstances specied in paragraph (4) or (5). (4) The circumstances rst referred to in paragraph (3) are that the holder ies such an aeroplane for the purpose of aerial work which consists of towing another aeroplane or glider in ight: (a) in an aeroplane owned, or operated under arrangements entered into, by a ying club of which the holder of the licence and any person carried in the towing aeroplane or in any aeroplane or glider being towed are members; or (b) in an aeroplane owned, or operated under arrangements entered into, by an organisation approved by the CAA for the purpose of this provision when: (i) the holder of the licence is a member of an organisation approved by the CAA for the purpose of this provision; and
May 2012 Section 7 Part B Page 10
(ii) any person carried in the towing aeroplane or in any aeroplane or glider being towed is a member of an organisation approved by the CAA for the purpose of this provision. (5) The circumstances secondly referred to in paragraph (3) are that the holder ies such an aeroplane for the purposes of aerial work which consists of instruction or testing in a club environment provided that, in the case of instruction, the licence includes a ying instructors rating or an assistant ying instructors rating. Receipt of remuneration (6) The holder may receive any remuneration for services as a pilot on a ight only if the licence includes a ying instructors rating or an assistant ying instructors rating entitling the holder to give instruction in ying microlight aeroplanes or SLMGs, and the holder gives such instruction or conducts such ying tests as are specied in paragraph (5) in a microlight aeroplane or a SLMG. Prohibitions on ight in specied conditions (7) The holder may not y: (a) as pilot in command of such an SSEA on a ight outside controlled airspace when the ight visibility is less than ve km; (b) as pilot in command of such an SLMG or microlight aeroplane on a ight outside controlled airspace when the ight visibility is less than three km; (c) as pilot in command of any such aeroplane (i) on a special VFR ight in a control zone in a ight visibility of less than 10km; (ii) out of sight of the surface; or (iii) at night; or (d) as pilot in command of any such aeroplane in circumstances which require compliance with the Instrument Flight Rules. Carriage of persons (8) The holder may not y as pilot in command of any such aeroplane: (a) if the total number of persons carried (including the pilot) exceeds four; or (b) when carrying passengers unless within the preceding 90 days the holder has made at least three take-offs and three landings as the sole manipulator of the controls of an aeroplane of the same class as that being own. National Private Pilots Licence (Helicopters) Minimum age 17 years Privileges and conditions: (1) Subject to paragraphs (2) to (4) the holder of the licence is entitled to y as pilot in command of a single engine helicopter with a maximum total weight authorised of 2000 kg or less, carrying a maximum of 3 passengers, such that there are never more than 4 persons on board. Flight outside the United Kingdom (2) The holder may not y such a helicopter outside the United Kingdom except with the permission of the competent authority for the airspace in which the aircraft is being own.
May 2012
Flight for purpose of commercial air transport, public transport and aerial work The holder may not y any such a helicopter for the purpose of commercial air transport, public transport or aerial work. Carriage of persons (4) The holder may not y as pilot in command of any such a helicopter when carrying passengers unless within the preceding 90 days the holder has made at least three take-offs and three landings as the sole manipulator of the controls of a helicopter of the same type as that being own. (3)
PART B RATINGS AND QUALIFICATIONS Section 1 Ratings and qualications which may be included in United Kingdom Licences but not in National Private Pilots Licences Sub-Section 1 AIRCRAFT RATINGS 1 An aircraft rating may be included in a United Kingdom licence granted under Part7, and, subject to the provisions of this Order and of the licence, the inclusion of a rating in a licence has the consequences specied as follows. When included in a pilot licence an aircraft rating entitles the holder of the licence to act as pilot of aircraft of the types and classes specied in the aircraft rating and different types and classes of aircraft may be specied in respect of different privileges of a licence. When included in a Flight Engineers Licence an aircraft rating entitles the holder of the licence to act as ight engineer only of aircraft of a type specied in the aircraft rating. Subject to article 82(2), the following ratings and qualications may be included in a United Kingdom pilot licence granted under Part 7 and, subject to the provisions of this Order and of the licence, the inclusion of a rating or qualication in a licence has the consequences respectively specied as follows. Instrument meteorological conditions rating (aeroplanes) (1) Subject to paragraph (2), within the United Kingdom an instrument meteorological conditions rating (aeroplanes) rating entitles the holder of a United Kingdom Private Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) to y as pilot in command of an aeroplane without being subject to the restrictions contained respectively in paragraph (2) (c) or (f) of the privileges of the United Kingdom Private Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes). The rating does not entitle the holder of the licence to y (a) on a special VFR ight in a control zone in a ight visibility of less than threekm; or (b) when the aeroplane is taking off or landing at any place if the ight visibility below cloud is less than 1800 metres. Instrument rating (aeroplane) An instrument rating (aeroplane) entitles the holder of the licence to act as pilot in command or co-pilot of an aeroplane ying in controlled airspace in circumstances which require compliance with the Instrument Flight Rules. Instrument rating (helicopter) An instrument rating (helicopter) entitles the holder of the licence to act as pilot in command or co-pilot of a helicopter ying in controlled airspace in circumstances which require compliance with the Instrument Flight Rules.
(2)
May 2012
Night rating (aeroplanes) A night rating (aeroplanes) entitles the holder of a United Kingdom Private Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) to act as pilot in command of an aeroplane at night. Night qualication (aeroplane) A night qualication (aeroplane) entitles the holder of a United Kingdom Private Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) to act as pilot in command of an aeroplane at night. Night rating (helicopters) A night rating (helicopters) entitles the holder of a United Kingdom Private Pilots Licence (Helicopters) to act as pilot in command of a helicopter at night. Night qualication (helicopter) A night qualication (helicopter) entitles the holder of a United Kingdom Private Pilots Licence (Helicopters) or a PartFCL Private Pilot Licence (Helicopter) to act as pilot in command of a helicopter at night. Night rating (gyroplanes) A night rating (gyroplanes) entitles the holder of a United Kingdom Private Pilots Licence (Gyroplanes) to act as pilot in command of a gyroplane at night. Towing rating (ying machines) A towing rating (ying machines) entitles the holder of the licence to act as pilot of a ying machine while towing a glider in ight for the purpose of public transport or aerial work. Flying instructors rating A ying instructors rating entitles the holder of the licence to give instruction in ying aircraft of such types and classes as may be specied in the rating for that purpose. Assistant ying instructors rating (1) Subject to paragraph (2), an assistant ying instructors rating entitles the holder of the licence to give instruction in ying aircraft of such types and classes as may be specied in the rating for that purpose. (a) Such instruction must only be given under the supervision of a person present during the take-off and landing at the aerodrome at which the instruction is to begin and end and who holds a pilots licence endorsed with a ying instructors rating entitling the holder to instruct on an aircraft of the same type or class as the aircraft on which instruction is being given. (b) An assistant ying instructors rating does not entitle the holder of the licence to give directions to a person undergoing instruction in respect of the performance of that persons: (i) rst solo ight; (ii) rst solo ight by night; (iii) rst solo cross-country ight otherwise than by night; or (iv) rst solo cross-country ight by night. Flight instructor rating (aeroplane) A ight instructor rating (aeroplane) entitles the holder of the licence to give instruction in ying aircraft of such types and classes as may be specied in the rating for that purpose subject to the restrictions specied below.
(2)
May 2012
Restrictions restricted period Until the holder of a ight instructor rating (aeroplane) has completed at least 100 hours ight instruction and, in addition, has supervised at least 25 solo ights by students, the privileges of the rating are restricted. (2) The restrictions will be removed from the rating when the requirements specied in paragraph (1) have been met and on the recommendation of the supervising ight instructor (aeroplane). Restrictions restricted privileges The privileges will be restricted to carrying out under the supervision of the holder of a ight instructor rating (aeroplane) approved for this purpose: (a) ight instruction for the issue of the National Private Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes), the United kingdom Private Pilot Licence (Aeroplane) or those parts of integrated courses at United Kingdom Private Pilot Licence (Aeroplane) level and class and type ratings for single-engine aeroplanes, excluding approval of rst solo ights by day or by night and rst solo cross country ights by day or by night; and (b) night ying instruction. Flight instructor rating (helicopter) A ight instructor rating (helicopter) entitles the holder of the licence to give instruction in ying helicopters of such types as may be specied in the rating for that purpose subject to the restrictions specied below. Restrictions restricted period (1) Until the holder of a ight instructor rating (helicopter) has completed at least 100 hours ight instruction and, in addition, has supervised at least 25 solo ights by students, the privileges of the rating are restricted. (2) The restrictions will be removed from the rating when the requirements specied in paragraph (1) have been met and on the recommendation of the supervising ight instructor (helicopter). Restrictions restricted privileges (3) The privileges are restricted to carrying out under the supervision of the holder of a ight instructor rating (helicopter) approved for this purpose: (a) ight instruction for the issue of the National Private Pilots Licence (Helicopters), the United Kingdom Private Pilot Licence (Helicopter) or those parts of integrated courses at United Kingdom Private Pilot Licence (Helicopter) level and type ratings for single engine helicopters, excluding approval of rst solo ights by day or by night and rst solo cross-country ights by day or by night; and (b) night ying instruction. Type rating instructor rating (multi-pilot aeroplane) A type rating instructor rating (multi-pilot aeroplane) entitles the holder to instruct licence holders for the issue of a multi-pilot aeroplane type rating, including the instruction required for multicrew co-operation. Type rating instructor rating (helicopter) A type rating instructor rating (helicopter) entitles the holder to instruct licence holders for the issue of a type rating, including the instruction required for multi-crew cooperation. (1)
May 2012
Class rating instructor rating (single-pilot aeroplane) A class rating instructor rating (single-pilot aeroplane) entitles the holder to instruct licence holders for the issue of a type or class rating for single-pilot aeroplanes. Instrument rating instructor rating (aeroplane) An instrument rating instructor rating (aeroplane) entitles the holder to conduct ight instruction for the issue of an instrument rating (aeroplane) or an instrument meteorological conditions rating (aeroplanes) for a United Kingdom Licence. Instrument rating instructor rating (helicopter) An instrument rating instructor rating (helicopter) entitles the holder to conduct ight instruction for the issue of an instrument rating (helicopter) for a United Kingdom Licence. 5 For the purposes of this Section: Day means the time from half an hour before sunrise until half an hour after sunset (both times exclusive), sunset and sunrise being determined at surface level; Solo ight means a ight on which the pilot of the aircraft is not accompanied by a person holding a pilots licence granted or rendered valid under this Order; Cross-country ight means any ight during the course of which the aircraft is more than three nautical miles from the aerodrome of departure. Section 2 Aircraft and instructor ratings which may be included in United Kingdom aeroplane pilots Licences and National Private Pilots Licences (Aeroplanes) 1 The following ratings may be included in a United Kingdom aeroplane pilot licence or a National Private Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes) granted under Part 7, and, subject to the provisions of this Order and of the licence, the inclusion of a rating in a licence has the consequences specied as follows. Microlight class rating (1) Subject to paragraph (2) and to the conditions of the licence in which it is included, a microlight class rating entitles the holder to act as pilot in command of any microlight aeroplane. (a) If the current certicate of revalidation for the rating is endorsed single seat only the holder is only entitled to act as pilot in command of any single seat microlight aeroplane. (b) (i) If the aeroplane has: (aa) three axis controls and the holders previous training and experience has only been in an aeroplane with exwing/weightshift controls; (bb) exwing/weightshift controls and the holders previous training and experience has only been in an aeroplane with three axis controls; or (cc) more than one engine, before exercising the privileges of the rating the holder must complete appropriate differences training. (ii) The differences training must be given by a ight instructor entitled to instruct on the aeroplane on which the training is being given, recorded in the holders personal ying logbook and endorsed and signed by the instructor conducting the training.
(2)
May 2012
(c) (i) Where the aeroplane is to be operated from water during take-off and landing, before exercising the privileges of the rating the holder must (aa) complete appropriate differences training; and (bb) attain a pass in the Private or Professional Seamanship examination. (ii) The differences training must be given by a ight instructor entitled to instruct on the aeroplane on which the training is being given, recorded in the holders personal ying logbook and endorsed and signed by the instructor conducting the training. SSEA class rating (1) Subject to paragraph (2) and to the conditions of the licence in which it is included, a SSEA class rating entitles the holder to act as pilot in command of any SSEA with a maximum takeoff weight authorised of not more than 2000kg excluding any such aeroplane which is a SLMG or a microlight aeroplane. (a) If the current certicate of revalidation for the rating is endorsed single seat only the holder is only entitled to act as pilot in command of a single seat SSEA. (b) (i) If the aeroplane: (aa) is tted with a tricycle undercarriage; (bb) is tted with a tailwheel; (cc) is tted with a supercharger or turbo-charger; (dd) is tted with a variable pitch propeller; (ee) is tted with retractable landing gear; (ff) is tted with a cabin pressurisation system; or (gg) has a maximum continuous cruising speed in excess of 140 knots indicated airspeed, before exercising the privileges of the rating, the holder must complete appropriate differences training. (ii) The differences training must be given by a ight instructor entitled to instruct on the aeroplane on which the training is being given, recorded in the holders personal ying logbook and endorsed and signed by the instructor conducting the training. (c) (i) If the aeroplane is to be operated from water during take-off and landing, before exercising the privileges of the rating the holder must: (aa) complete appropriate differences training; and (bb) attain a pass in the Private or Professional Seamanship examination. (ii) The differences training must be given by a ight instructor entitled to instruct on the aeroplane on which the training is being given, recorded in the holders personal ying logbook and endorsed and signed by the instructor conducting the training. SLMG class rating (1) Subject to paragraph (2) and to the conditions of the licence in which it is included, a SLMG class rating entitles the holder to act as pilot in command of any SLMG.
(2)
May 2012
If the current certicate of revalidation for the rating is endorsed single seat only the holder is only entitled to act as pilot in command of a single seat SLMG. Flying instructors rating (microlight) A ying instructors rating (microlight) entitles the holder of the licence to give instruction in ying microlight aeroplanes. Flying instructors rating (SLMG) A ying instructors rating (SLMG) entitles the holder of the licence to give instruction in ying SLMGs. Assistant ying instructors rating (microlight) Subject to paragraph (2), an assistant ying instructors rating (microlight) entitles the holder of the licence to give instruction in ying microlight aeroplanes. (2) (a) Such instruction must only be given under the supervision of a person present during the take-off and landing at the aerodrome at which the instruction is to begin and end and holding a pilots licence endorsed with a ying instructors rating entitling that person to instruct on a microlight aeroplane with the same type of control system as the microlight aeroplane on which instruction is being given. (b) An assistant ying instructors rating (microlight) does not entitle the holder of the licence to give directions to the person undergoing instruction in respect of the performance of that persons (i) rst solo ight; or (ii) rst solo cross-country ight. For the purposes of this Section, solo ight and cross-country ight have the same meaning as in Section 1. (1)
(2)
Section 3 Ratings which may be included in National Private Pilots Licences (Helicopters) A helicopter type rating for a single engine helicopter with a maximum total weight authorised of 2000kg or less may be included in a National Private Pilots Licence (Helicopters) granted under Part 7. PART C MAINTENANCE OF LICENCE PRIVILEGES Section 1 Requirement for Certicate of Test or Experience 1 Appropriateness of certicate (1) For the purposes of articles 66(2), 68(1), 69(2) or 71 the type of certicate specied in column 4 in the following table is appropriate for the ight or functions described in column 3 carried out by the holder of the type of licence specied in column 2.
May 2012
Case Class of Licence A Private Pilots Licence (Gyroplanes) Private Pilots Licence (Aeroplanes)
Description of Flight Any ight within the privileges of the licence Any ight within the privileges of a microlight aeroplane class rating included in the licence
Certicate Required Certicate of test or certicate of experience Certicate of test or certicate of experience
Commercial Pilots Licence (Balloons) Carriage of passengers on a Commercial Pilots Licence (Gliders) ight for which the holder of Commercial Pilots Licence (Airships) the licence receives remuneration Commercial Pilots Licence (Balloons) For public transport Commercial Pilots Licence (Gliders) Commercial Pilots Licence (Airships) Commercial Pilots Licence (Balloons) For aerial work Commercial Pilots Licence (Gliders) Commercial Pilots Licence (Airships) Commercial Pilots Licence (Balloons) Any ight within the Commercial Pilots Licence (Gliders) privileges of a Private Pilots Commercial Pilots Licence (Airships) Licence Flight Navigators Licence Flights to which article47 applies
Certicate of test
Certicate of test
Certicate of test or certicate of experience Certicate of test or certicate of experience Certicate of experience
For the purposes of this Part of this Schedule, references to Cases are references to the Cases indicated in the rst Column of the Table above. Certicate of test A certicate of test required by article 66(2), 68(1) or 69(2) must be signed by a person authorised by the CAA to sign certicates of this kind and certify the following: (a) the functions to which the certicate relates; (b) that the person signing the certicate is satised that on a date specied in the certicate the holder of the licence or personal ying logbook of which the certicate forms a part passed an appropriate test of the holders ability to perform the functions to which the certicate relates; (c) the type of aircraft or ight simulator in or by means of which the test was conducted; and (d) the date on which it was signed. Nature of test The appropriate test referred to in paragraph 2: (a) in the case of a test which entitles the holder of the licence of which the certicate forms part to act as pilot in command or co-pilot (or both) of aircraft of the type, types or class specied in the certicate: (i) is a test of the pilots competence to y the aircraft as pilot in command or co-pilot (or both); and (ii) must where the CAA so species for the whole or part of a test, be conducted in an aircraft in ight or by means of a ight simulator approved by the CAA.
(2)
May 2012
(b) in the case of a test which entitles the holder of the licence of which the certicate forms part to perform the functions to which a ying instructors rating (gyroplanes), an assistant ying instructors rating (gyroplanes) or an instrument meteorological conditions rating (aeroplanes) relate: (i) is a test of the holders ability to perform the functions to which the rating relates; and (ii) must where the CAA so species for the whole or part of the test, be conducted in an aircraft in ight. Period of validity of certicate of test 4 (1) Subject to sub-paragraph (3), a certicate of test required by article 66(2) for a Commercial Pilots Licence (Balloons) is not valid in relation to a ight made more than 13 months after the last day of the month in which the test was taken. Subject to sub-paragraph (3), a certicate of test required by article 66(2) or 69(3) for any other licence, is not valid in relation to a ight made more than 13 months in Cases A, B and E or more than six months in Cases C and D after the last day of the month in which the test was taken. (3) In the case of Cases C and D, two certicates of test are together deemed to constitute a valid certicate of test if they certify ying tests conducted on two occasions within the period of 13 months preceding the ight on which the functions are to be performed, such occasions being separated by an interval of not less than four months, and if both certicates are appropriate to those functions. (4) A certicate of test required by article 68(1) for an instrument meteorological conditions rating (aeroplanes) is not valid in relation to a ight made more than 25 months after the last day of the month in which the test was taken. (5) A certicate of test required by article 68(1) for an assistant ying instructors rating (gyroplanes) and a ying instructors rating (gyroplanes) is not valid in relation to a ight made more than three years after the last day of the month in which the test was taken. Certicate of experience (2) 5 A certicate of experience required by article 66(2), 69(2) or 71 must be signed by a person authorised by the CAA to sign such a certicate and certify: (a) the functions to which the certicate relates; (b) in the case of a pilot, that on the date on which the certicate was signed, the holder of the licence or personal ying log book of which it forms part: (i) produced the personal ying log book to the person signing the certicate; and (ii) satised the authorised person that the licence holder had appropriate experience in the capacity to which the licence relates within the appropriate period specied in paragraph 6 of this Part of this Schedule; (c) in the case of a ight navigator, that on the date on which the certicate was signed, the holder of the licence of which it forms part: (i) produced the licence holders navigation logs, charts and workings of astronomical observations to the authorised person; and (ii) satised the authorised person that the licence holder had appropriate experience in the capacity to which the licence relates within the appropriate period specied in paragraph 6 of this Part of this Schedule;
May 2012
(d) in the case of a pilot or ight engineer, the type or types of aircraft in which the experience was gained; (e) the date on which it was signed. Period of experience 6 A certicate of experience is not valid unless the experience was gained within the period of 13 months preceding the last day of the month in which the certicate was signed in the case of Cases A, E and F, or six months preceding the last day of the month in which the certicate was signed in the case of Case D. Period of validity of certicate of experience 7 A certicate of experience for a Commercial Pilots Licence (Balloons) is not valid for more than 13 months after the last day of the month in which it was signed and for any other licence is not valid for more than six months after the last day in the month in which it was signed for Case D nor for more than 13 months after it was signed for any other case. Section 2 Requirement for Certicate of Revalidation Appropriate certicate of revalidation A certicate of revalidation required by article 67(2), 68(2) or 70 is not appropriate to the 8 exercise of the privileges of a ight crew licence unless it is a certicate which accords with this Section. Type and class ratings 9 (1) Aeroplane type and class ratings (a) Type ratings and multi-engine class ratings, aeroplane (i) Validity Type ratings and multi-engine class ratings for aeroplanes are valid for one year beginning with the date of issue, revalidation or renewal or the last date of the month in which the rating expires if it is revalidated within the period of three months preceding that day. (ii) Revalidation For revalidation of type ratings and multi-engine class ratings, aeroplane, the applicant must satisfy the requirements for the ratings specied in paragraph FCL.740.A of Part-FCL. (b) Single-pilot single-engine class ratings (i) Validity Single-pilot single-engine class ratings are valid for two years beginning with the date of issue, revalidation or renewal or the last day of the month in which the rating expires if it is revalidated within the period of three months preceding that day. Revalidation of all single-engine piston aeroplane class ratings (land) and (ii) all touring motor glider ratings For revalidation of single-pilot single-engine piston aeroplane (land) class ratings or touring motor glider class ratings (or both) the applicant must on single engine piston aeroplanes (land) or touring motor gliders (as the case may be) satisfy the requirements for the ratings specied in paragraph FCL.740.A of Part-FCL. (iii) Revalidation of single-engine turbo-prop aeroplanes (land) single-pilot For revalidation of single-engine turbo-prop (land) class ratings the applicant must within the three months preceding the last day of the month in which the rating expires, pass a prociency check with an authorised examiner on an aeroplane in the relevant class.
May 2012
(iv) Revalidation of single-engine piston aeroplanes (SEA) For revalidation of single-pilot single-engine piston aeroplane (SEA) class ratings the applicant must: (aa) within the three months preceding the last day of the month inwhich the rating expires, pass a prociency check with an authorised examiner on a single-engine piston aeroplane (SEA); or (bb) within the 12 months preceding the last day of the month in which the rating expires, complete at least 12 hours of ight time including at least six hours of pilot in command time on either a single-engine piston aeroplane (SEA) or a single-engine piston aeroplane (land) and at least 12 water take-offs and 12 alightings on water; and either complete a training ight of at least one hour duration with a ight instructor or pass a prociency check or skill test for any other class or type rating. (c) Expired ratings (i) If a type rating or multi-engine class rating has expired, the applicant must meet the requirements in sub-paragraph (a)(ii) and meet any refresher training requirements as determined by the CAA and the rating will be valid from the date of completion of the renewal requirements. (ii) If a single-pilot single-engine class rating has expired, the applicant must complete the skill test in accordance with the requirements specied at Appendix 9 to PartFCL. (2) Helicopter type ratings (a) Type ratings, helicopter validity Type ratings for helicopters are valid for one year beginning with the date of issue, or the last day of the month in which the rating expired if revalidated within the period of three months preceding that day. (b) Type ratings, helicopter revalidation For revalidation of type ratings, helicopter, the applicant must complete the requirements specied in Paragraph FCL.740.H of Part-FCL. (c) Expired ratings If a type rating has expired, the applicant must meet the requirements in subparagraph (b) and meet any refresher training requirements as determined by the CAA and the rating is valid for a period beginning with the date of completion of the renewal requirements. (3) Flight engineer type ratings (a) Type ratings validity Flight engineer type ratings are valid for one year beginning with the date of issue, or the last day of the month in which the rating expired if revalidated within the period of three months preceding that day. (b) Type ratings revalidation For revalidation of ight engineer type ratings the applicant must, within the three months preceding the expiry date of the rating, pass a prociency check with an authorised examiner on the relevant type of aircraft.
May 2012
Instrument ratings 9A Instrument ratings Validity periods (a) Instrument ratings are valid from the date of issue, revalidation or renewal to the end of the month in which they were issued, revalidated or renewed, plus one year after that date in each case. (b) Revalidation and renewal of expired ratings (i) Instrument rating aeroplane For revalidation of instrument ratings aeroplane the applicant must complete the requirements specied in paragraph FCL.625.A of Part-FCL. (ii) Instrument rating helicopter For revalidation of instrument ratings helicopter the applicant must complete the requirements specied in paragraph FCL.625.H of PartFCL. (c) Expired Instrument Ratings If the instrument rating has expired the applicant must complete therenewal requirements specied in paragraphs FCL.625(c) and FCL.625(d) of Part FCL. Instructor ratings 9B Instructor Ratings (a) Validity periods Instructor ratings are valid from the date of issue, revalidation or renewal to the end of the month in which they were issued, revalidated or renewed, plus three years after that date in each case. (b) Revalidation and renewal of expired ratings In the following table, for an instructor rating listed in column 1 the requirements for revalidation are those set out in column 2 and for expired ratings the renewal requirements are those set out in column 3:
Revalidation Renewal requirement requirement (Part-FCL) (Part-FCL) FCL.940.FI(a) and (b) FCL.940.FI(c)
Rating Flight instructor (aeroplane) Flying instructors rating (aeroplanes) Assistant ying instructors rating (aeroplanes) Flight instructor (helicopter) Flying instructors rating (helicopters) Assistant ying instructors rating (helicopters) Type rating instructor rating (multi-pilot aeroplane) Type rating instructor rating (helicopter) Class rating instructor rating (single pilot aeroplane) Instrument rating instructor rating (aeroplane) Instrument rating instructor rating (helicopter)
FCL.940.FI(c)
May 2012
Forms of certicate of revalidation 10 (1) A certicate of revalidation required by article 65(2), 66(2) or 68 must be signed by a person authorised by the CAA to sign certicates of this kind and certify (a) the functions to which the certicate relates; (b) that the person signing the certicate is satised that on a date specied in the certicate, the holder of the licence of which the certicate forms a part met the appropriate requirements for revalidation specied for the rating, in the case of an aircraft rating in paragraph 9, in the case of an instrument rating in paragraph 9A and in the case of any other rating in the Table in paragraph 9B; (c) the type of aircraft or ight simulator in or by means of which the test was conducted; and (d) the date on which it was signed. rating specied in Sections 2 and 3 of Part B 11 (1)
(3)
Table 1 Requirements for issue of a certicate of revalidation for an aeroplane class rating included in Section 2 of Part B
Circumstances 1 On initial issue by the CAA Description of Flight The holder of the licence has passed a NPPL General Skill Test with the authorised examiner signing the licence application form in an aeroplane of the class for which the certicate of revalidation is sought
There is a current valid certicate of The holder of the licence has: revalidation for the rating (a) passed a NPPL General Skill Test with the authorised examiner signing the certicate in an aeroplane of the class for which the certicate of revalidation is sought; or (b) produced their personal ying log book to the authorised person signing the certicate and satised the authorised person that the holder satised the experience requirements specied in Table 2
May 2012
Circumstances 3 The last previous certicate of revalidation for the rating expired less than ve years before the date on which the new certicate is to be signed The last previous certicate of revalidation for the rating expired ve years or more before the date on which the new certicate is to be signed
Description of Flight The holder of the licence has passed a NPPL General Skill Test with the authorised examiner signing the certicate in an aeroplane of the class for which the certicate of revalidation is sought The holder of the licence has passed: (a) a NPPL General Skill Test with the authorised examiner signing the certicate in an aeroplane of the class for which the certicate of revalidation is sought; and (b) an oral theoretical knowledge examination conducted by the authorised examiner as part of the NPPL General Skill Test
Table 2 Experience requirements for issue of certicate of revalidation in accordance with paragraph 2(b) of Table 1
Circumstances 1 Experience Requirements
Where one aeroplane class rating is (a) The holder has, as a pilot, in an aeroplane specied in held the aeroplane class rating and within the period of validity of the current certicate of revalidation for the rating: (i) own at least 12 hours which includes at least 8 hours as pilot in command; (ii) completed at least 12 take-offs and 12 landings; (iii) subject to sub-paragraph (b), undertaken at least one hour of ying training with an instructor entitled to give instruction on aeroplanes of that class; and (iv) own at least six hours in the 12 months preceding the specied date (b) If the holder has not undertaken the ying training specied in paragraph 1(a)(iii) a certicate of revalidation may be issued but must be endorsed single seat only.
(a) The holder has, as a pilot, within the period of validity of the current certicate of revalidation for each rating: (i) own a total of at least 12 hours in an aeroplane coming within any of the aeroplane class ratings which are held which includes at least a total of eight hours as pilot in command; (ii) completed not less than 12 take-offs and 12 landings in an aeroplane coming within any of the aeroplane class ratings which are held; (iii) subject to sub-paragraph (b), in an aeroplane coming within each of the aeroplane class ratings which are to be revalidated, either: (aa) own at least one hour as pilot in command; or (bb)undertaken at least one hour of ying training with an instructor entitled to give instruction on aeroplanes of that class;
May 2012
Circumstances
Experience Requirements (iv) subject to sub-paragraph (b), undertaken at least one hour of ying training in aeroplanes coming within any of the aeroplane class ratings which are held, with instructors entitled to give instruction on aeroplanes of those classes; and (v) own at least six hours in the 12 months preceding the specied date in an aeroplane coming within any of the aeroplane class ratings which are held. (b) If the holder has own at least one hour as pilot in command as specied in paragraph 2(a)(iii)(aa) but has not undertaken the ying training specied in paragraph 2(a)(iv) a certicate of revalidation may be issued but must be endorsed single seat only.
Table 3Removed.
12
(1) A certicate of revalidation required by article 69(1) for a ying instructors rating (SLMG), a ying instructors rating (microlight), or an assistant ying instructors rating (microlight) must be signed by a person authorised by the CAA to sign certicates of this kind and certify: (a) the rating to which the certicate relates; (b) that on a specied date the holder has passed an appropriate test of the holders ability to exercise the privileges of the rating; (c) the specied date; and (d) the date on which the period of validity of the certicate expires in accordance with Table 4. (2) Such a certicate of revalidation remains valid in accordance with Table 4.
Table 4 Period of validity of certicate of revalidation for a ying instructors rating included in Section 2 of Part B
Circumstances Whether or not a previous certicate is valid on the specied date of the instructor ight and ground test Period of validity for a certicate of revalidation for a ying instructors rating (microlight and/or SLMG) The new certicate is valid for 25 months from the date of test Period of validity for a certicate of revalidation for an assistant ying instructors rating (microlight) The new certicate is valid for 13 months from the date of test
13
(1)
A certicate of revalidation required by article 69 for a helicopter type rating must be signed by a person authorised by the CAA to sign certicates of this kind and certify:
(2)
(a) the rating to which the certicate relates; (b) that on a specied date the holder has satised the requirements of FCL.740 and FCL.740.H of Part-FCL; (c) the specied date; and (d) the date on which the period of validity of the certicate expires in accordance with paragraph (2). The new certicate is valid for 12 months in addition to the remainder of the month in which the date of issue falls.
May 2012
2
2.1
Licensing action
Licences issued by the CAA under the Air Navigation Order The Air Navigation Order states that the CAA will issue a Flight Crew Licence when it is satised that the applicant is a t person to hold a licence and is qualied to do so by having the knowledge, experience, competence, skill and physical and mental tness to act in the capacity to which the licence relates. The CAA is obliged to remain satised in these respects on a continuing basis. If the CAA becomes aware of information that gives cause to doubt a licence holders tness and qualication to hold a licence it is obliged to consider this and where necessary to take action to restrict or prevent further ying by that pilot until it is again satised with respect to tness and qualication. As licensing action involves the use of discretionary powers, the CAA must consider each case according to the particular circumstances. However, licensing action will generally be considered by Licensing and Training Standards against the following criteria: Competence Any pilot whose ying ability is called into question is subject to consideration for licensing action. Qualication Any licence holder who acts outside of the privileges for which they are qualied is subject to consideration for licensing action. Fitness Fitness in this context means tness of character. The CAA will consider all relevant matters, including whether the holder has demonstrated a propensity not to obey the law or to act dishonestly or without integrity. Information that may call into question a licence holders tness includes, but is not limited to:
May 2012
Section 8 Page 1
a) Drug related offences/activities. If the licence holder is suspected of taking drugs that would cast doubt on their tness of character and medical tness. If a licence holder is convicted of dealing in illegal drugs or of drug trafcking, this would cast doubt on their tness to hold a position of responsibility such as instructor or examiner. There are international (ICAO and UN) obligations for authorities to take action against pilots who engage in drug trafcking. b) Alcohol. If there are credible reports of a licence holder performing an aviation function whilst intoxicated this will cast doubt on medical tness as well as on being a t person. c) Criminal convictions. Anyone convicted of serious violent, sexual, drug-related or nancial offences is unlikely to be regarded as a t and proper person to hold an instructor rating or examiner authorisation. d) Falsication of, or failure to keep, records. Where L&TS receives credible information alleging falsication of records relating to ying training, ying tests, examinations, log books etc, (or of failure to keep such records where this is a requirement) licensing action may be taken, particularly in the case of an instructor or examiner. e) Propensity not to comply with rules and regulations. Anyone displaying such a propensity in a manner detrimental to safety, particularly if it is likely to adversely inuence the behaviour of others, may be considered unt to hold a licence. f) Any other action that would impact on ight safety or the safety of persons on the ground. 2.2 Licences issued by the CAA under European regulations Under European regulations the CAA must comply with Part-ARA (Annex VI of the Aircrew Regulation), which includes the following: ARA.FCL.250 Limitation, suspension or revocation of licences, ratings and certicates (a) The competent authority shall limit, suspend or revoke as applicable a pilot licence and associated ratings or certicates in accordance with ARA.GEN.355 in, but not limited to, the following circumstances: (1) obtaining the pilot licence, rating or certicate by falsication of submitted documentary evidence; (2) falsication of the logbook and licence or certicate records; (3) the licence holder no longer complies with the applicable requirements of Part-FCL; (4) exercising the privileges of a licence, rating or certicate when adversely affected by alcohol or drugs; (5) non-compliance with the applicable operational requirements; (6) evidence of malpractice or fraudulent use of the certicate; or (7) unacceptable performance in any phase of the ight examiners duties or responsibilities. (b) The competent authority may also limit, suspend or revoke a licence, rating or certicate upon the written request of the licence or certicate holder. (c) All skill tests, prociency checks or assessments of competence conducted during suspension or after the revocation of an examiners certicate will be invalid.
May 2012
Section 8 Page 2
It can be seen that these specic circumstances are similar to many of those that the CAA includes when considering licensing action in respect of national licences. However, Part-ARA states that licensing action is not limited to these particular circumstances. For cases that do not come within the specic wording of ARA. FCL.250(a) paragraphs (1) to (7), the CAA will act in the same manner as for a licence issued under the Air Navigation Order.
May 2012
Section 8 Page 3
Section 9 Exemptions
Part A
1 Introduction
Articles 14(4) and 14(5) Regulation (EC) 216/2008 provide certain exibility provisions which Member States may exercise. Article 14(4) Member States may grant exemptions from the substantive requirements laid down in this Regulation and its implementing rules in the event of unforeseen urgent operational circumstances or operational needs of a limited duration, provided the level of safety is not adversely affected. The Agency, the Commission and the other Member States shall be notied of any such exemptions as soon as they become repetitive or where they are granted for periods of more than two months. Article 14(5) The Agency shall assess whether the exemptions notied by a Member State are less restrictive than the applicable Community provisions and, within one month of being notied thereof, shall issue a recommendation in accordance with Article 18(b) on whether these exemptions comply with the general safety objectives of this Regulation or any other rule of Community law. If an exemption does not comply with the general safety objectives of this Regulation or any other rule of Community law, the Commission shall take a decision not to permit the exemption in accordance with the procedure referred to in Article 65(7). In such a case, the Member State concerned shall revoke the exemption.
2 Application
2.1 Exemptions issued under Article 14(4) can be used to exempt from any EASA rule or requirement. Applicants for exemptions shall provide written justication to the CAA as to: a) why the circumstances were not foreseen and are urgent; or b) why there is an urgent operational need; and c) why the level of safety will not be adversely affected, (including compensatory measures). Applicants shall also identify the requirements against which the exemption is requested, the requested start and end dates of the exemption, and whether the exemption is a repeat of a previous exemption.
May 2012
3 Authorisation
3.1 Exemptions will be issued to the proposer only when the CAA is satised that: a) the applicable criteria have been met and that all applicable procedures have been completed; and b) the level of safety is not affected.
4 Duration/Repetition
Where any exemption becomes repetitive or has a duration greater than 2 months, its existence must be notied by the Member State to the Commission, EASA and the other Member States. EASA will review the circumstances and advise the Commission. The Commission will then decide whether the exemption can remain in force or must be revoked.
May 2012
Part B
1 Introduction
Article 242 of the Air Navigation Order provides for the CAA to exercise discretion to issue exemptions to certain provisions of the Order. Article 242 states: The CAA may exempt from any of the provisions of this Order (other than articles 120, 149, 151, 223, 224, 225, 230, and 243) or any regulation made under this Order, any aircraft or persons or classes of aircraft or persons, subject to such conditions as it thinks t.
2 Application
2.1 Applicants for exemptions shall provide written justication to the CAA as to: a) why the exemption is requested; b) why the need for the exemption could not have been avoided; and c) why the level of safety will not be adversely affected, (including compensatory measures). Applicants shall identify the requirements against which the exemption is requested and the requested start and end dates of the exemption.
3 Authorisation
3.1 Exemptions may be issued to the proposer only when the CAA is satised that: a) the exemption is justiable; and b) the level of safety is not adversely affected.
May 2012
Part II Contents
Section 5
Part A
UK National Licences
UK NPPL for Aeroplanes, Microlights, Self Launching Motor Gliders and Helicopters
Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Simple Single-engine Aeroplane (SSEA)/Self Launching Motor Gliders (SLMG) UK National Pilot Licence for Microlights UK NPPL(A) Microlight/Powered Parachute Allowances Against Training for an NPPL(A)
Part B
UK Private Pilot Licences (PPL) for Aeroplanes, Balloons and Airships, Gyroplanes, Helicopters and Unmanned Aircraft
Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Subpart 4 Subpart 5 UK PPL(A) Aeroplanes UK Private Pilot Licence for Balloons and Airships UK PPL(BA) UK PPL(G) Gyroplanes UK PPL(H) Helicopters UK PPL(Unmanned) Unmanned Aircraft
Part C
UK Commercial Pilot Licence (CPL) for Aeroplanes, Balloons and Airships, Gyroplanes, Helicopters and Unmanned Aircraft
Subpart 1 Subpart 2 Subpart 3 Subpart 4 Subpart 5 Subpart 6 UK CPL(A) Aeroplanes UK Commercial Pilot Licence for Balloons UK CPL(B) UK CPL(G) Gyroplanes UK CPL(H) Helicopters UK CPL(Unmanned) Unmanned Aircraft UK CPL(As) Airships
Part D
Part E
27 July 2012
Contents Page 1
UK National Licences UK NPPL for Aeroplanes, Microlights, Self Launching Motor Gliders and Helicopters Simple Single-engine Aeroplane (SSEA)/Self Launching Motor Gliders (SLMG)
(A)
SSEA Syllabus
Foreword
This syllabus, for the National Private Pilot Licence Simple Single-engine Aeroplane (NPPL(SSEA)) conforms to the agreed requirements of the United Kingdom Civil Aviation Authority (CAA) for the training of pilots for the grant of a UK National Private Pilot Licence (SSEA). This syllabus is acceptable to the Authority.
May 2012
SECTION 1
INTRODUCTION The purpose of this syllabus is to give guidance to instructors who are involved in the task of training pilots and to student pilots for the United Kingdom National Private Pilot Licence Simple Single-engine Aeroplane. (NPPL (SSEA)). TRAINING OBJECTIVES Each course is to be designed so that the students or the pilots under training are given the experience, the competence in ying, and the knowledge of aviation technical matters demanded by the ground and ight tests as laid down in this syllabus for the initial issue of a National Private Pilot Licence. To enable them to use the aeroplanes and facilities of the private ying environment within the privileges of the licence, in a safe and responsible manner within their own limitations. CO-ORDINATION OF TRAINING The co-ordination of ground and ight training is a necessary and important part of any pilot course. Care should be exercised when conducting the course to ensure that ying training exercises are compatible with the students ground training progress. SUMMARY OF MINIMUM TRAINING HOURS DUAL: SOLO: TOTAL: 22.00 hours to include: 1 hour instrument appreciation. 10.00 hours. 32.00 hours -(Excluding Navigation Skill Test and General Skill Test).
GROUND TRAINING This consists of all the theoretical knowledge required for the course. No mandatory lecture periods are laid down and training may consist of directed self study. DEFINITIONS The following denitions provide a general guide to the briengs given, but may vary in length and content dependent on the individual students needs. Long Brieng A detailed explanation and discussion conducted by the ight instructor of the major considerations of an air exercise. The normal length should be approximately 30 minutes and may be given to an individual student, or as an informal lecture to two or more students. Pre-ight Brieng A practical exposition by the ight instructor and lasting 10-15 minutes, on the contents of a specic ight lesson. This normally includes a statement of the aims, a brief revision of the practical aspects of any Principles of Flight involved, a statement of exactly what air exercises are to be taught by the instructor and practised by the student, and how, when and by whom the aeroplane is to be operated within the limits imposed by airmanship, weather and ight safety. These limits may vary with a particular ight and will be appropriate to the students stage of training. The order in which the content is given may vary according to the instructors judgement and the students experience. Post-ight Discussion A few minutes devoted by the instructor immediately after a specic lesson to consolidate the major points made during the ight, clarify any queries the student may have and review progress made by the student, using fault analysis or praise as necessary, and nally to indicate the nature of the next lesson. Theoretical Subjects The essential knowledge needed by students to comprehend the constraints of their intended operating environment and its inter-relationship with the operation of an aeroplane within their personal limitations. The subject material may be covered by classroom lectures or by directed self study.
May 2012
Explanatory Note It should be appreciated that the wide coverage of theoretical subjects in the syllabus is due to the need for a student to develop a broad appreciation of the many factors concerned with the safe operation of aircraft, an appreciation which must be inculcated during training rather than afterwards. However, the need to have an in depth knowledge of the specied subject material will be conned to a limited number of items. AIR EXERCISES The numbering of the air exercises is to be used primarily as a reference list and instructional sequencing guide only. Demonstrations and practices need not necessarily be given in the order listed. The actual order and content will depend upon the following interrelated factors: The students progress and ability Instructional technique considerations The weather conditions affecting the ight The local operating environment The ight time available PRIMARY REFERENCE MATERIAL National AIP and NOTAMS Aeronautical Information Circulars The Air Navigation Order CAP 804 CAP 413 - Radio Telephony Manual (latest edition) Aeronautical Charts 1:500,000 Aircraft Owners/Flight Manual/Pilots Operating Handbook Safety Equipment - Manufacturers Recommendations and Instruction Leaets Accident Information Bulletins General Aviation Safety Sense Leaets ICAO Documents: Convention; Annexes 2, 7, 8, 11, 14; and Doc. 4444
SECTION 2
NATIONAL PRIVATE PILOT LICENCE Simple Single-engine Aeroplane (SSEA) Course COURSE OBJECTIVES The course shall be designed so that student pilots are given adequate theoretical knowledge and ight training in order to ensure they are capable of safely operating an aeroplane whilst ying in weather conditions appropriate to the visual ight rules. COURSE DESCRIPTION The course shall be undertaken at an Air Training Organisation within the UK or Isle of Man and the required theoretical knowledge and ying training for the course is as follows: Theoretical Knowledge Subjects: The theoretical knowledge syllabus of the NPPL(SSEA) course shall cover the following: Air Law Aeroplane General Knowledge Flight Performance and Planning Human Performance and Limitations Meteorology
27 July 2012
Navigation Operational Procedures Principles of Flight Communications These subjects shall be covered by the use of lectures or by a course of directed study including self study at home. Full details of the theoretical knowledge subjects are shown in Section 3 of this syllabus. Privileges of the NPPL, in addition to the Theoretical knowledge syllabus, the course shall include an explanation of the privileges and limitations of the NPPL and the requirement for revalidation and renewal of Ratings. Flight Training Flight instruction shall be given by ight instructors qualied in accordance with UK National Licensing requirements or Part-FCL and shall be sufcient to cover the following ight procedures and manoeuvres: pre-ight operations, including mass and balance determination, aeroplane inspection and servicing; aerodrome and trafc pattern operations, collision avoidance precautions and procedures; control of the aeroplane by external visual reference; ight at critically slow airspeeds; recognition of, and recovery from, incipient and full stalls; ight at critically high airspeeds; recognition of, and recovery from spiral dives; normal and cross wind take-offs and landings, landing at unlicensed strips, shorteld/grass eld operation; maximum performance (short eld and obstacle clearance) take-offs; short eld landings; instrument appreciation; cross-country ying using visual reference and dead reckoning; emergency operations, including simulated aeroplane equipment malfunctions; and operations to, from and transitting controlled aerodromes, compliance with air trafc services, procedures, radiotelephony procedures and phraseology. Full details of the air exercises to cover the above items are shown in Section 4 of this syllabus. An applicant for an NPPL must complete at least 32 hours ight time as pilot of aeroplanes. Of the 32 hours, a minimum of 22 hours dual including 1 hour of instrument appreciation and 10 hours solo must be completed. The Navigation Skill Test and General Skill Test are not included in the course hours. Of the minimum 10 hours solo, a student must complete at least four hours of solo cross country ight, including one cross country of at least 185km (100 nm) in the course of which full stop landings at two aerodromes other than the aerodrome of departure shall be made. Entry to training: Before being accepted for training, an applicant should be informed of the medical requirements laid down prior to rst solo and application for an NPPL. Minimum age for rst solo: 16 years. Minimum medical requirement to y solo and for the issue of the NPPL (SSEA) restricted to no passengers: Driver and Vehicle Licensing Agency (DVLA) Group 1 car driving medical standards. Minimum age for issue of NPPL (SSEA): 17 years
27 July 2012
Minimum medical requirements to carry passengers on issue of NPPL (SSEA): A medical declaration from the pilots GP, equivalent to the DVLA Group 2 professional driving medical standard; or a Part-FCL medical certicate. Training Aeroplanes An adequate eet of training aeroplane(s) equipped and maintained to the relevant BCAR/EASA standards shall be provided by the ying club or training organisation. Training conducted on aeroplanes having a certicate of airworthiness will enable an applicant to obtain a Simple Singleengine Aeroplane class rating for National Private Pilot Licence issue. Each aeroplane shall be tted with duplicated primary ight controls for use by the ight instructor and the student: swing-over ight controls shall not be acceptable. The eet should include, as appropriate to the courses of training, aeroplane(s) suitable for demonstrating stalling and spin avoidance. Types of aeroplane used for training shall be approved by the Authority for training purposes. Training Aerodromes Training for the NPPL may be conducted at any UK training aerodrome. Theoretical Knowledge Examination Applicants for a National Private Pilot Licence shall pass a written examination to demonstrate that they hold a level of aeronautical knowledge appropriate to the holder of a Part-FCL Private Pilot Licence. NPPL holders who obtain their licences before 8 April 2015 may, if they so wish, up-grade to a full Part-FCL PPL at some future time and therefore, in view of this possibility, the theoretical knowledge examinations undertaken by NPPL applicants will be the same as those set for the Part-FCL PPL(A) examinations. Navigation Skill Test Applicants for the NPPL shall pass a Navigation Skill Test with an examiner prior to undertaking the qualifying solo cross-country ight. General Skill Test Applicants for the NPPL shall demonstrate their ability to perform procedures and manoeuvres in an aeroplane for an examiner to assess their competency to hold an NPPL. Validity periods of examinations for applicants for the National Private Pilot Licence (SSEA): All the theoretical knowledge examinations must be passed within a period of 18 months counted from the end of the month when the applicant rst attempted an examination. Passes will remain valid for licence issue for a period of 24 months from the date of successful completion of the nal examination. All theoretical knowledge examinations must be completed before taking the General Skill Test. The General Skill Test must be undertaken within 6 months of completing the ying training, and all sections of the test must be completed within a period of 6 months.
SECTION 3
THEORETICAL KNOWLEDGE SUBJECTS AIR LAW LEGISLATION The Convention on International Civil Aviation The International Civil Aviation Organisation (ICAO) Articles of the Convention relevant to pilots:
May 2012
1 Sovereignty 2 Territory 5 Flight over territory of Contracting States 10 Landing at customs airports 11 Applicability of air regulations 12 Rules of the air 13 Entry and clearance regulations of Contracting States 16 Search of aircraft 22 Facilitation of formalities 23 Customs and immigration procedures 24 Customs duty 29 Documents to be carried in aircraft 30 Use of aircraft radio equipment 31 Certicate of airworthiness 32 Licences of personnel 33 Recognition of certicates and licences 34 Journey log books 35 Cargo restrictions 36 Restrictions on use of photographic equipment 37 Adoption of international standards and procedures 39 Endorsements of certicates and licences 40 Validity of endorsed certicates and licences Annexes to the Convention (ICAO Annexes) Annex 7 Aircraft nationality and registration marks - denitions - aircraft registration marks - certicate of registration - identication plate Annex 8 Airworthiness of aircraft - denitions - certicate of airworthiness - continuing airworthiness - validity of certicate of airworthiness - instruments and equipment - aircraft limitations and information Rules of the air Annex 2 Rules of the air - denitions - applicability - general rules - visual ight rules - signals (Appendix 1) - interception of civil aircraft (Appendix 2) Air trafc regulations and air trafc services Annex 11 Air trafc regulations and air trafc services
May 2012
- denitions - objectives of air trafc services - classication of airspace - ight information regions, control areas and control zones - air trafc control services - ight information services - alerting service - visual meteorological conditions - instrument meteorological conditions - in-ight contingencies Annex 14 Aerodrome data - denitions - conditions of the movement area and related facilities Visual aids for navigation - indicators and signalling devices - markings - lights - signs - markers - signal area Visual aids for denoting obstacles - marking of objects - lighting of objects Visual aids for denoting restricted use of areas Emergency and other services - re and rescue service - apron management service - aerodrome ground lights and surface marking colours - colours for aeronautical ground lights - colours for surface markings ICAO Doc. 4444 Air Trafc Management Procedures for air trafc services General provisions - denitions - ATS operating practices - ight plan clearance and information - control of air trafc ow - altimeter setting procedures - wake turbulence information - meteorological information - air reports (AIREP) Area control service - separation of controlled trafc in the various classes of airspace - pilots, responsibility to maintain separation in visual meteorological conditions (VMC) - emergency and communication failure, procedures by the pilot - interception of civil aircraft
May 2012 Section 5 Part A Subpart 1 Page 7
Approach control service - departing and arriving aircraft procedures in VMC Aerodrome control service - function of aerodrome control towers - visual ight rules (VFR) operations - trafc and circuit procedures - information to aircraft - control of aerodrome trafc Flight information and alerting service - air trafc advisory service - objectives and basic principles National operating rules and procedures - reference to the ANO The Order and Regulations - reference to the UK AIP - airspace restrictions and hazards - reference to specic national Aeronautical Information Publications (AIPs) European Aviation Safety Agency (EASA) Part-FCL Requirements Part-FCL Subpart A - General requirements - FCL.015 Application and issue of licences, ratings and certicates - Part-MED Medical tness - FCL.035 Crediting of ight time and theoretical knowledge - FCL.050 Recording of ight time Part-FCL Subpart A - Student Pilot - FCL.020 Requirements - FCL.020 Minimum age - Part-MED Medical tness Part-FCL Subpart C - Private pilot licence Minimum age - FCL.200 - Part-MED Medical tness - FCL.205/205A Privileges and conditions - FCL.210A Experience and crediting - FCL.210 Training course - FCL.215 Theoretical knowledge examination - FCL.235 Skill test Part-FCL Subpart G -Instrument rating - FCL.605 IR-Privileges Part-FCL Subpart H -Type and class ratings - FCL.710 Type and class ratings - variants - FCL.700 Circumstances in which type or class ratings are required - FCL.740 Validity, revalidation and renewal Part-FCL Subpart J -Instructor ratings - FCL.900 Instructor certicates - general Reference to EU-OPS 1 Recommended reference material to cover this aspect is as follows:
May 2012 Section 5 Part A Subpart 1 Page 8
CAP 393 Air Navigation: the Order and Regulations (as amended). The UK AIP: General (GEN) and En-route (ENR) (as amended). Aeroplane General Knowledge AIRFRAME Airframe structure - components - fuselage, wings, tailplane, n - primary ying controls - trim and ap/slat systems - landing gear - nose wheel, including steering - tyres, condition - braking systems and precautions in use - retraction systems Airframe loads - static strength - safety factor - control locks and use - ground/ight precautions POWERPLANT Engines general - principles of the four stroke internal combustion engine - basic construction - causes of pre-ignition and detonation - power output as a function of RPM Engine cooling - air cooling - cowling design and cylinder bafes - design and use of cowl aps - cylinder head temperature gauge Engine lubrication - function and methods of lubrication - lubrication systems - methods of oil circulation - oil pump and lter requirements - qualities and grades of oil - oil temperature and pressure control - oil cooling methods - recognition of oil system malfunction Ignition systems - principles of magneto ignition - construction and function - purpose and principle of impulse coupling - serviceability checks, recognition of malfunctions
May 2012
- operational procedures to avoid spark plug fouling Carburation - principles of oat type carburettor - construction and function - methods to maintain correct mixture ratio - operation of metering jets and accelerator pump - effect of altitude - manual mixture control - maintenance of correct mixture ratio - limitations on use at high power - avoidance of detonation - idle cut-off valve - operation and use of primary controls - air induction system - alternate induction systems - carburettor icing, use of hot air - injection systems, principles and operation Aero engine fuel - classication of fuels - grades and identication by colour - quality requirements - inspection for contamination - use of fuel strainers and drains Fuel systems - fuel tanks and supply lines - venting system - mechanical and electrical pumps - gravity feed - tank selection - system management Propellers - propeller nomenclature - conversion of engine power to thrust - design and construction of xed pitch propeller - forces acting on propeller blade - variation of RPM with change of airspeed - thrust efciency with change of speed - design and construction of variable pitch propeller - constant speed unit operation - effect of blade pitch changes - windmilling effect Engine handling - starting procedures and precautions - recognition of malfunctions - warming up, power and system checks
May 2012
- - - - - -
oil temperature and pressure limitations cylinder head temperature limitations ignition and other system checks power limitations avoidance of rapid power changes use of mixture control
SYSTEMS Electrical system - installation and operation of alternators / generators - direct current supply - batteries, capacity and charging - voltmeters and ammeters - circuit breakers and fuses - electrically operated services and instruments - recognition of malfunctions - procedures in event of malfunctions Vacuum system - components - pumps - regulator and gauge - lter system - recognition of malfunction - procedure in event of malfunctions INSTRUMENTS Pitot/static system - pitot tube, function - pitot tube, principles and construction - static source - alternate static source - position error - system drains - heating element - errors caused by blockage or leakage Airspeed indicator - principles of operation and construction - relationship between pitot and static pressure - denition of indicated, calibrated and true airspeed - instrument errors - airspeed indications, colour coding - pilots serviceability checks Altimeter - principles of operation and construction - function of the sub-scale - effects of atmospheric density - pressure altitude
May 2012
- - - - - -
true altitude international standard atmosphere ight level presentation (three needle) instrument errors pilots serviceability checks
Vertical speed indicator - principles of operation and construction - function - inherent lag - instantaneous VSI - presentation - pilots serviceability checks Gyroscopes - principles - rigidity - precession Turn indicator - rate gyro - purpose and function - effect of speed - presentation - turn co-ordinator - limited rate of turn indications - power source - balance indicator - principle - presentation - pilots serviceability checks Attitude indicator - earth gyro - purpose and function - presentation - interpretation - operating limitations - power source - pilots serviceability checks Heading indicator - directional gyro - purpose and function - presentation - use with magnetic compass - setting mechanism - apparent drift - operating limitations - power source
May 2012 Section 5 Part A Subpart 1 Page 12
- pilots serviceability checks Magnetic compass - construction and function - earths magnetic eld - variation and deviation - turning, acceleration errors - precautions when carrying magnetic items - pilots serviceability checks Engine instruments - principles, presentation and operational use of: - oil temperature gauge - oil pressure gauge - cylinder head temperature gauge - exhaust gas meter - manifold pressure gauge - fuel pressure gauge - fuel ow gauge - fuel quantity gauge(s) - tachometer Other instruments - principles, presentation and operational use of: - vacuum gauge - voltmeter and ammeter - warning indicators - others relevant to aeroplane type AIRWORTHINESS Airworthiness - certicate to be in force - compliance with requirements - periodic maintenance inspections - compliance with ight manual (or equivalent), instructions, limitations, placards - ight manual supplements - provision and maintenance of documents - aeroplane, engine and propeller log books - recording of defects - permitted maintenance by pilots FLIGHT PERFORMANCE AND PLANNING MASS AND BALANCE Mass and balance - limitations on maximum mass - forward and aft limitations of centre of gravity, normal and utility operation - mass and centre of gravity calculations, aeroplane manual, mass and balance sheet PERFORMANCE Take-off - take-off run and distance available
May 2012
- take-off and initial climb - effects of mass, wind and density altitude - effects of ground surface and gradient - use of aps Landing - effects of mass, wind, density altitude and approach speed - use of aps - ground surface and gradient In ight - relationship between power required and power available - performance diagram - maximum rate and maximum angle of climb - range and endurance - effects of conguration, mass, temperature and altitude - reduction of performance during climbing turns - gliding - adverse effects - icing, rain - condition of the airframe - effect of ap HUMAN PERFORMANCE BASIC PHYSIOLOGY Concepts - composition of the atmosphere - the gas laws - respiration and blood circulation Effects of partial pressure - effect of increasing altitude - gas transfer - hypoxia - symptoms - prevention - cabin pressurisation - effects of rapid decompression - time of useful consciousness - the use of oxygen masks and rapid descent - hyperventilation - symptoms - avoidance - effects of accelerations Vision - physiology of vision - limitations of the visual system - vision defects - optical illusions - spatial disorientation
May 2012
- avoidance of disorientation Hearing - physiology of hearing - inner ear sensations - effects of altitude change - noise and hearing loss - protection of hearing - spatial disorientation - conicts between ears and eyes - prevention of disorientation Motion sickness - causes - symptoms - prevention Flying and health - medical requirements - effects of common ailments and cures - colds - stomach upsets - drugs, medicines and side effects - alcohol - fatigue - personal tness - passenger care - scuba diving - precautions before ying Toxic hazards - dangerous goods - carbon monoxide from heaters BASIC PSYCHOLOGY The information process - concepts of sensation - cognitive perception - expectancy - anticipation - habits The central decision channel - mental workload, limitations - information sources - stimuli and attention - verbal communication - memory and its limitations - causes of misinterpretation Stress - causes and effects - concepts of arousal
May 2012
- effects on performance - identifying and reducing stress Judgement and decision making - concepts of pilots judgement - psychological attitudes - behavioural aspects - risk assessment - development of situational awareness METEOROLOGY The atmosphere - composition and structure - vertical divisions Pressure, density and temperature - barometric pressure, isobars - changes of pressure, density and temperature with altitude - altimetry terminology - solar and terrestial energy radiation, temperature - diurnal variation of temperature - adiabatic process - temperature lapse rate - stability and instability - effects of radiation, advection, subsidence and convergence Humidity and precipitation - water vapour in the atmosphere - vapour pressure - dew point and relative humidity - condensation and vaporisation - precipitation Pressure and wind - high and low pressure areas - motion of the atmosphere, pressure gradient - vertical and horizontal motion, convergence, divergence - surface and geostrophic wind - effect of wind gradient and wind shear on take-off and landing - relationship between isobars and wind, Buys Ballots law - turbulence and gustiness - local winds, fhn, land and sea breezes Cloud formation - cooling by advection, radiation and adiabatic expansion - cloud types - convection clouds - orographic clouds - stratiform and cumulus clouds - ying conditions in each cloud type Fog, mist and haze - radiation, advection, frontal, freezing fog
May 2012
- formation and dispersal - reduction of visibility due to mist, snow, smoke, dust and sand - assessment of probability of reduced visibility - hazards in ight due to low visibility, horizontal and vertical Airmasses - description of and factors affecting the properties of airmasses - classication of airmasses, region of origin - modication of airmasses during their movement - development of low and high pressure systems - weather associated with pressure systems Frontology - formation of cold and warm fronts - boundaries between airmasses - development of a warm front - associated clouds and weather - weather in the warm sector - development of a cold front - associated clouds and weather - occlusions - associated clouds and weather - stationary fronts - associated clouds and weather Ice accretion - conditions conducive to ice formation - effects of hoar frost, rime ice, clear ice - effects of icing on aeroplane performance - precautions and avoidance of icing conditions - powerplant icing - precautions, prevention and clearance of induction and carburettor icing Thunderstorms - formation - airmass, frontal, orographic - conditions required - development process - recognition of favourable conditions for formation - hazards for aeroplanes - effects of lightning and severe turbulence - avoidance of ight in the vicinity of thunderstorms Flight over mountainous areas - hazards - inuence of terrain on atmospheric processes - mountain waves, windshear, turbulence, vertical movement, rotor effects,valley winds Climatology - general seasonable circulation in the troposphere over Europe - local seasonal weather and winds Altimetry
May 2012
- operational aspects of pressure settings - pressure altitude, density altitude - height, altitude, ight level - ICAO standard atmosphere - QNH, QFE, standard setting - transition altitude, layer and level The meteorological organisation - aerodrome meteorological ofces - aeronautical meteorological stations - forecasting service - meteorological services at aerodromes - availability of periodic weather forecasts Weather analysis and forecasting - weather charts, symbols, signs - signicant weather charts - prognostic charts for general aviation Weather information for ight planning - reports and forecasts for departure, en-route, destination and alternate(s) - interpretation of coded information, METAR, TAF - availability of ground reports for surface wind, windshear and visibility Meteorological broadcasts for aviation - VOLMET, ATIS, SIGMET NAVIGATION Form of the earth - axis, poles - meridians of longitude - parallels of latitude - great circles, small circle rhumb lines - hemispheres north/south, east/west Mapping - aeronautical maps and charts (topographical) - projections and their properties - conformity - equivalence - scale - great circles and rhumb lines Conformal orthomorphic projection (ICAO 1:500,000 chart) - main properties - construction - convergence of meridians - presentation of meridians, parallels, great circles and rhumb lines - scale, standard parallels -depiction of height Direction - true north - earths magnetic eld, variation - annual change - magnetic north
May 2012
- vertical and horizontal components - isogonals, agonic lines Aeroplane magnetism - magnetic inuences within the aeroplane - compass deviation - turning, acceleration errors - avoiding magnetic interference with the compass Distances - units - measurement of distance in relation to map projection Charts in practical navigation - plotting positions - latitude and longitude - bearing and distance - use of navigation protractor - measurement of tracks and distances Chart reference material / map reading - map analysis - topography - relief - cultural features - permanent features e.g.line features, spot features, unique or special features - features subject to change e.g. water - preparation - folding the map for use - methods of map reading - map orientation - checkpoint features - anticipation of checkpoints - with continuous visual contact - without continuous visual contact - when uncertain of position - aeronautical symbols - aeronautical information - conversion of units Principles of navigation - IAS, RAS, (CAS) and TAS - track, true and magnetic - wind velocity, heading and groundspeed - triangles of velocities - calculation of heading and groundspeed - drift, wind correction angle - ETA - dead reckoning, position, x The navigation computer - the use of the circular slide rule to determine:
May 2012
relationship between universal co-ordinated (standard) (UTC) time and local mean time (LMT) - denition of sunrise and sunset times Flight planning - selection of charts - route and aerodrome weather forecasts and reports - assessing the weather situation - plotting the route - considerations of controlled/regulated airspace, airspace restrictions, danger areas, etc. - use of AIP and NOTAMS - ATC liaison procedures in controlled/regulated airspace - fuel considerations - en-route safety altitude(s) - alternate aerodromes - communications and radio/navaid frequencies - compilation of ight log - compilation of ATC ight plan - selection of check points, time and distance marks - mass and balance calculations - mass and performance calculations Practical navigation - compass headings, use of deviation card - organisation of in-ight workload - departure procedure, log entries, altimeter setting and establishing IAS - maintenance of heading and altitude - use of visual observations - establishing position, checkpoints - revisions to heading and ETA - arrival procedures, ATC Liaison - completion of ight log and aeroplane log entries RADIO NAVIGATION Ground D/F - application - principles - presentation and interpretation - coverage
- - - - - - - - - Time -
TAS, time and distance conversion of units fuel required pressure, density and true altitude time on route and ETA use of computer to solve triangles of velocities application of TAS and wind velocity to track determination of heading and groundspeed drift and wind correction angle
May 2012
- errors and accuracy - factors affecting range and accuracy ADF, including associated beacons (NDBs) and use of RMI - application - principles - presentation and interpretation - coverage - errors and accuracy - factors affecting range and accuracy VOR/DME - application - principles - presentation and interpretation - coverage - errors and accuracy - factors affecting range and accuracy GPS - application - principles - presentation and interpretation - coverage - errors and accuracy - factors affecting reliability and accuracy Ground radar - application - principles - presentation and interpretation - coverage - errors and accuracy - factors affecting reliability and accuracy Secondary surveillance radar - principles (transponders) - application - presentation and interpretation - modes and codes OPERATIONAL PROCEDURES ICAO Annex 6, Part II - Operation of Aircraft - foreword - denitions - general statement - ight preparation and in-ight procedures - performance and operating limitations - instruments and equipment - communications and navigation equipment - maintenance - ight crew
May 2012
- lights to be displayed ICAO Annex 12 - Search and rescue - denitions - operating procedures - procedures for pilot-in-command (para 5.7) - search and rescue signals ICAO Annex 13 - Aircraft accident investigation - denitions - national procedures ICAO Annex 16 Environmental Protection Noise abatement - general procedures - application to take-off and landing Contravention of aviation regulations - offences - penalties PRINCIPLES OF FLIGHT The atmosphere - composition and structure - ICAO standard atmosphere - atmospheric pressure Airow around a body, subsonic - air resistance and air density - boundary layer - friction forces - laminar and turbulent ow - Bernoullis principle - venturi effect Airow about a two dimensional aerofoil - airow around a at plate - airow around a curved plate (aerofoil) - description of aerofoil cross section - lift and drag - CL and CD and their relationship to angle of attack Three dimensional ow about an aerofoil - aerofoil shapes and wing planforms - induced drag - downwash angle, vortex drag, ground effect - aspect ratio - parasite (prole) drag - form, skin friction and interference drag - lift/drag ratio Distribution of the four forces - balance and couples - lift and mass - thrust and drag - methods of achieving balance
May 2012
Flying controls - the three planes - pitching about the lateral axis - rolling about the longitudinal axis - yawing about the normal axis - effects of the elevators (stabilators), ailerons and rudder - control in pitch, roll and yaw - cross coupling, roll and yaw - mass and aerodynamic balance of control surfaces Trimming controls - basic trim tab, balance tab and anti-balance tab - purpose and function - method of operation Flaps and slats - simple, split, slotted and Fowler aps - purpose and function - operational use - slats, leading edge - purpose and function - normal/automatic operation The stall - stalling angle of attack - disruption of smooth airow - reduction of lift, increase of drag - movement of centre of pressure - symptoms of development - aeroplane characteristics at the stall - factors affecting stall speed and aeroplane behaviour at the stall - stalling from level, climbing, descending and turning ight - inherent and articial stall warnings - recovery from the stall Avoidance of spins - wing tip stall - the development of roll - recognition at the incipient stage - immediate and positive stall recovery Stability - denition of static and dynamic stability - longitudinal stability - centre of gravity effect on control in pitch - lateral and directional stability - interrelationship, lateral and directional stability Load factor and manoeuvres - structural considerations - manoeuvring and gust envelope - limiting load factors, with and without aps
May 2012
- changes in load factor in turns and pull-ups - manoeuvring speed limitations - in-ight precautions Stress loads on the ground - side loads on the landing gear - landing - taxiing, precautions during turns COMMUNICATION Radio telephony and communications - use of AIP and frequency selection - microphone technique - phonetic alphabet - station/aeroplane/callsigns/abbreviations - transmission technique - use of standard words and phrases - listening out - required readback instructions Departure procedures - radio checks - taxi instructions - holding on ground - departure clearance En-route procedures - frequency changing - position, altitude/ight level reporting - ight information service - weather information - weather reporting - procedure to obtain bearings, headings, position - procedural phraseology - height/range coverage Arrival and trafc pattern procedures - arrival clearance - calls and ATC instructions during the: - circuit - approach and landing - vacating the runway Communications failure - action to be taken - alternate frequency - serviceability check including microphone and headphones - in-ight procedures according to type of airspace Distress and urgency procedures - distress (Mayday), denition and when to use - frequencies to use - contents of Mayday message
May 2012
- - - - -
urgency (PAN), denition and when to use frequencies to use relay of messages maintenance of silence when distress/urgency calls heard cancellation of distress/urgency
GENERAL FLIGHT SAFETY Aeroplane - seat adjustment and security - harness and seat belts - emergency equipment and its use - re extinguisher - engine/cabin res - de-icing systems - survival equipment, life jackets, life rafts - carbon monoxide poisoning - refuelling precautions - ammable goods/pressurised containers Operational - wake turbulence - aquaplaning - wind shear, take-off, approach and landing - passenger briengs - emergency exits - evacuation from the aeroplane - forced landings - gear-up landing - ditching THEORETICAL KNOWLEDGE EXAMINATION 1 The examination shall be in written form and may be taken on one or more days and shall comprise seven examinations in accordance with the Part-FCL PPL theoretical knowledge syllabus in current sets provided by the UK Civil Aviation Authority as indicated below: Subject Air Law and Operational Procedures Navigation and Radio Aids Meteorology Aircraft General and Principles of Flight Human Performance Flight Performance and Planning Communications PPL 2 3 4 The majority of the questions shall be multiple choice. A pass in a subject will be awarded to an applicant achieving at least 75% of the marks allocated to that subject. Marks shall only be awarded for correct answers. A pass in The Communications examination for the Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence (FRTOL) as shown in the list of subjects above, shall be obtained together with all the other theoretical knowledge examinations in the 18 month period counted
May 2012
from the end of the calendar month when the applicant rst attempted an examination. Thereafter it will remain valid for a period of 24 months for the issue of a FRTOL when combined with a course of PPL training. The examination shall be completed prior to the NPPL General Skill Test. 5 FRTOL Practical Test: All applicants for a FRTOL are required to demonstrate that they have achieved the required standard for licence issue.
SECTION 4 FLIGHT TRAINING SYLLABUS The ying training section of the NPPL (SSEA) course will include exercises as shown below. The exercise numbering corresponds to the exercises conducted for the Part-FCL PPL, but the depth of coverage and time spent on the different exercises will be less than in the full 45 hour Part-FCL PPL course. The exercises, particularly those following rst solo and consolidation on the circuit, will not necessarily be given in the order as shown. 1. Familiarisation with the aeroplane 1E. Emergency drills 2. Preparation for and action after ight 3. Air experience Effects of controls 4. 5. Taxiing Straight and level ight 6. 7. Climbing 8. Descending Medium turns 9. 10A. Slow ight 10B. Stalling Spin avoidance 11. 12. Take-off and climb Approach and landing 13. 12/13E. Emergency procedures (as appropriate) 14. First solo Consolidation of take-offs and landings including: Crosswind take-off and landing Short eld take-off and landing, soft eld procedures Glide approaches, powered approaches Flapless landings 14B. Circuit departure procedures, local area orientation, RTF procedures, use of magnetic compass, map reading, circuit rejoining. 15. Advanced turning 16 Forced landings without power 17. Precautionary landings 18A. Pilot navigation 18B. Navigation at lower levels 19. Instrument appreciation Revision for the NPPL (SSEA) qualifying Navigation Skill Test and General Skill Test.
May 2012
SYLLABUS OF FLIGHT BRIEFINGS AND AIR INSTRUCTION FOR THE NATIONAL PRIVATE PILOT LICENCE SIMPLE SINGLE-ENGINE AEROPLANE (SSEA) Exercise 1 Familiarisation with the aeroplane - characteristics of the aeroplane - cockpit layout - systems - check lists, drills, controls - passenger care Exercise 1E Emergency drills - action in event of re on the ground and in the air - engine, cabin and electrical system re - systems failure - escape drills, location and use of emergency equipment and exits Exercise 2 Preparation for and action after ight - ight authorisation and aeroplane acceptance - serviceability documents - equipment required, maps, etc - external checks - internal checks - harness, seat or rudder pedal adjustments - starting and warm up checks - power checks - running down system checks and switching off the engine - parking, security and picketing (e.g. tie down) - completion of authorisation sheet and serviceability documents Exercise 3 Air experience - ight exercise Exercise 4 Effects of controls - primary effects when laterally level and when banked - further effects of aileron and rudder - effects of: - airspeed - slipstream - power - trimming controls - aps - other controls as applicable - operation of: - mixture control - carburettor heat - cabin heating/ventilation - airmanship Exercise 5 Taxiing - pre-taxi checks - starting, control of speed and stopping - engine handling - control of direction and turning
May 2012 Section 5 Part A Subpart 1 Page 27
- turning in conned spaces - parking area procedures and precautions - effects of wind and use of ying controls - effects of ground surface - freedom of rudder movement - marshalling signals - instrument checks - air trafc control procedures - airmanship Exercise 5E Emergencies - brakes and steering failure Exercise 6 Straight and level - at normal cruising power, attaining and maintaining straight & level ight - ight at critically high airspeeds - demonstration of inherent stability - control in pitch, including use of trim - lateral level, direction and balance, trim: - at selected airspeeds (use of power) - during speed and conguration changes - use of instruments for precision ight - airmanship Exercise 7 Climbing - entry, maintaining the normal and maximum rate climb, levelling off - levelling off at selected altitudes - en-route climb (cruise climb) - climbing with ap down - recovery to normal climb - maximum angle of climb - airmanship Exercise 8 Descending - entry, maintaining and levelling off - levelling off at selected altitudes - glide, powered and cruise descent (including effect of power and airspeed) - descending with aps down - side slipping (on suitable types) - airmanship Exercise 9 Turning - entry and maintaining medium level turns - resuming straight ight - faults in the turn (incorrect pitch, bank, balance) - climbing turns - descending turns - slipping turns (on suitable types) - turns on to selected headings, use of gyro heading indicator and compass - use of instruments for precision ight - airmanship
May 2012
Exercise 10A Slow ight NOTE: The objective is to improve the students ability to recognise inadvertent ight at critically low speeds and provide practice in maintaining the aeroplane in balance while returning to normal airspeed. - safety checks - introduction to slow ight - controlled ight down to critically slow airspeed - application of full power with correct attitude and balance to achieve normal climb speed - airmanship Exercise 10B Stalling - airmanship - safety checks - symptoms - recognition - clean stall and recovery without power and with power - recovery when a wing drops - approach to stall in the approach and in the landing conguration with and without power, recovery at the incipient stage of the stall Exercise 11 Spin avoidance - airmanship - safety checks - stalling and recovery at the incipient spin stage (stall with excessive wing drop, about 45) - instructor induced distractions during the stall NOTE 1: At least two hours of stall awareness and spin avoidance ight training shall be completed during the course. NOTE 2: Consideration of manoeuvre limitations and the need to refer to the aeroplane manual and mass and balance calculations. Exercise 12 Take-off and climb to downwind position - pre-take-off checks - into wind take-off - safeguarding the nosewheel - crosswind take-off - drills during and after take-off - short take-off and soft eld procedure/techniques including performance calculations - noise abatement procedures - airmanship Exercise 13 Circuit, approach and landing - circuit procedures, downwind, base leg - powered approach and landing - safeguarding the nosewheel - effect of wind on approach and touchdown speeds, use of aps - crosswind approach and landing - glide approach and landing - short landing and soft eld procedures/techniques - apless approach and landing - 3 point landing (tailwheel aeroplane, if applicable)
May 2012
- missed approach/go-around - noise abatement procedures - airmanship Exercise 12/13E Emergencies - abandoned take-off - engine failure after take-off - mislanding/go-around - missed approach In the interests of safety it will be necessary for pilots trained on nose-wheel aeroplanes to undergo differencies training before ying tailwheel aeroplanes and vice versa Exercise 14 First solo - instructors brieng, observation of ight and de-brieng NOTE: During ights immediately following the solo circuit consolidation the following should be revised: - procedures for leaving and rejoining the circuit - the local area, restrictions, map reading - turns using the magnetic compass - compass errors - airmanship Exercise 15 Advanced turning - steep turns (45), level, descending - stalling in the turn and recovery - recoveries from unusual attitudes, including spiral dives - airmanship Exercise 16 Forced landing without power - forced landing procedure - choice of landing area, provision for change of plan - gliding distance - descent plan - key positions - engine warming procedure - engine failure checks - use of radio - base leg - nal approach - landing - actions after landing - airmanship Exercise 17 Precautionary landing - full procedure away from the aerodrome to break-off height - occasions necessitating - in-ight conditions - landing area selection - normal aerodrome - disused aerodrome - ordinary eld - circuit and approach
May 2012 Section 5 Part A Subpart 1 Page 30
- actions after landing - airmanship Exercise 18A Navigation Flight planning - weather forecast and actuals - map selection and preparation - choice of route - controlled airspace - danger, prohibited and restricted areas - safety altitude(s) - calculations - magnetic heading(s) and time(s) en-route - fuel consumption - mass and balance - mass and performance - ight information - NOTAMS etc. - radio frequencies - selection of alternate aerodromes - aeroplane documentation - notication of the ight - pre-ight administrative procedures - ight plan form Departure - organisation of cockpit workload - departure procedures - altimeter settings - ATC liaison in controlled/regulated airspace - setting heading procedure - noting of ETAs - maintenance of altitude and heading - revision of ETAs & heading - log keeping - use of radio - minimum weather conditions for continuation of ight - in-ight decisions - transitting controlled/regulated airspace - diversion procedures - uncertainty of position procedure - lost procedure Arrival, aerodrome joining procedure - ATC liaison in controlled/regulated airspace - altimeter setting - entering the trafc pattern - circuit procedure - parking
May 2012
- security of aeroplane - refuelling - booking in/closing of ight plan, if appropriate - post-ight administrative procedure Exercise 18B Navigation problems at lower levels and in reduced visibility - actions prior to descending - hazards (e.g. obstacles & terrain) - difculties of map reading - effects of wind and turbulence - avoidance of noise sensitive areas - joining the circuit - bad weather circuit and landing Exercise 19 Instrument appreciation - physiological sensations - instrument appreciation - demonstration to show need for proper training before ying by sole reference to instruments and being able to make a 180 turn on instruments on inadvertent encounter with cloud Solo Navigation Brieng Certicate NOTES: 1 T he Solo Navigation Brieng Certicate is to be left at the base aerodrome, when completed. 2 T he student should carry the NPPL (SSEA) Qualifying Cross Country Certicate on the nal qualifying cross country ight and return it duly completed to the authorising instructor. I certify that student pilot ..has been briefed for a solo navigation exercise as follows: From ................................................................. To..................................................................... From ................................................................. To..................................................................... For an ETD of.....................................................hrs UTC/local on .......................................20 The navigation ight plan has been checked and the following items discussed and, where applicable, the required facts noted on the ight plan. ITEM 1. WEATHER - altitude to y and terrain clearance (safety altitude) - destination(s) actual 2. ROUTE - - - - - - need and method for maintaining VFR ight military zones, and procedures for crossing (if applicable) danger areas (if applicable) altimeter setting regions applicable NOTAMS, regulated airspace & entry/exit lane procedures current navigation warnings including royal ights
May 2012
3. DESTINATION - PPR (if applicable), joining procedure/position reports/knowledge of landing runways - land away procedure (including refuelling instructions and booking in/out) 4. ABNORMAL AND EMERGENCY PROCEDURES - - - - - - - - - - knowledge of controlled/regulated airspace and related minimum altitudes/levels action in event on intrusion into controlled airspace action in event of weather deterioration and/or fuel shortage action on becoming lost use of R/T including position reports use of D/F RTF PAN procedure action in event of an unscheduled landing full fuel and oil aeroplane serviceability mass and balance mass and performance
5. AEROPLANE
6. RADIO - use of radio (when applicable) if lost - RTF MAYDAY procedure - Selection and noting of communications frequencies for normal and emergency operation
Instructors signature ............................................................................. Licence number .................................................................. I certify that I have been briefed for the navigation exercise detailed above and understand that in the event of an unscheduled landing I will contact the CFI or his/her deputy by the quickest possible means and act according to their instructions. Student pilots signature ........................................................................ Date ...................................... Time (UTC/local) ............................
May 2012
THE NAVIGATION SKILL TEST The Navigation Skill Test (NST) is a qualifying requirement for the grant of a NPPL (SLMG) or NPPL (SSEA). The aim of the test is to provide an independent check of the student pilots ability to apply visual navigation techniques, to prepare for an in-ight diversion, to liaise with ATC and, in the case of the SLMG NST only, to navigate safely following change to the planned route resulting from an unsuccessful soaring opportunity. Before attempting this test, the student must have satisfactorily completed all the dual navigation training in the NPPL syllabus, except as dened for applicants claiming cross-crediting allowances against training as outlined in the NPPL Licence Allowance document. The student must have passed the Navigation Skill Test before undertaking the qualifying solo cross-country. The test comprises the following: 1. Flight planning and self brieng (including assessment of weather suitability) for a route of not less than 60 minutes ying time. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. In-ight recording of the progress of the ight. Notes made on the map are acceptable for this requirement. ATC liaison and compliance; observance of ATC Regulations and Rules of the Air. DR navigation (correction of track error, revision of ETA, heading-setting technique including, where tted, synchronising directional gyro with magnetic compass in ight). Map reading. Track crawling through continuous map reading will not be considered an acceptable visual navigation technique. Maintenance of heading, height and airspeed at normal cruising levels. (SLMG only) Re-establishment of position by visual methods following deliberate disruption of the original ight plan, simulating an unsuccessful attempt to take advantage of an off-track soaring opportunity. Diversion procedure following simulated adverse weather conditions en-route.
8.
Pre-Flight Planning Requirements Weather - obtaining appropriate information - interpreting the information - assessing weather suitability Airspace - obtaining appropriate information including relevant NOTAMs - interpreting the information - assessing any threats Navigation ight plan & map preparation Fuel plan & aircraft loading Booking out/ local procedures Flight Test Procedure 1. The route should not be made available to the applicant earlier than 2 hours before walking out to the aircraft. 2. 3. 4. The applicant must not have practised (either dual or solo) ying the route to be used. The ight is to be non-stop; i.e. without an intermediate landing. Radio navigation aids or GPS may not be used, except during the practice diversion once the applicant has made an initial assessment of the required heading to the diversion and the ETA at the diversion. If such navigation aids are used, their correct use will be assessed. Radar navigational assistance may not be used at any time. The planned route is normally to be A - B - C, subject to the following provisos:
5.
May 2012
6.
- leg A - B should require at least 20 mins ight time; - track change at B should be between 60 and 120 and the distance B - C should require at least 20 mins ight time. During leg B-C: - (SLMG only) between about 10-15 min after B the examiner will direct the applicant, simulating changed soaring opportunities, to a position about 5 nm off track. - (SLMG only) when directed, the applicant must make and implement an appropriate decision either to regain the planned track or to plan a revised track direct to the next turning point. - between 10-15 min after B (or, SLMG only, once the applicants revised tracking and timing have been assessed), the applicant will be told to assume weather deterioration and to prepare for a practice diversion to a point not less than 20 nm off track. - The test may be terminated when the applicant has demonstrated the ability to track towards the diversion for not less than 10 minutes, has told the examiner the location of the aeroplane and has given an acceptable ETA at the diversion. Appropriate systems management, including fuel use and carburettor heat operation is to be assessed throughout the test. The record of the ight in the applicants logbook is to include the examiners signature and examiner number, stating that the ight was a NST and whether a successful pass was achieved. The planned route is to be shown in the remarks column, together with details of the diversion point. Successful applicants should log the ight time as PIC U/S.
7. 8.
May 2012
REPORT FORM FOR THE NAVIGATION SKILL TEST FOR THE NPPL SLMG/(SSEA)*
It is an offence to make, with intent to deceive, any false representations for the purpose of procuring the grant, issue, renewal, or variation of any certicate, licence approval, permission or other document. Persons so doing render themselves liable, on summary conviction to a ne not exceeding the statutory maximum (currently 5,000, or in Northern Ireland 2,000) and on conviction on indictment to an unlimited ne or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2years or both. Date of Test:.................................. Place of Test:.................................................................... Aircraft Type and Registration Block Times Route Result Re-test: (Details as required) Retraining requirement if required: Remarks: This test was conducted in accordance with NPPL Syllabus......................(SLMG/SSEA)* Examiners Name: Examiners Signature: Examiners CAA Authorisation Number: * Delete as applicable Departure Arrival Duration
May 2012
NPPL (SSEA) Cross Country Certicate NOTICE TO PILOTS In the event of a landing being made at a place other than an aerodrome named hereon, the authorisation for the ight is automatically terminated. The CFI is then immediately to be notied by telephone (number: ..............) and the ight MUST NOT be continued without his/her specic authorisation. This is to certify that . Holder of student pilots privileges and pilot of . Aircraft, G-... was authorised to leave ...... at hours, on ..... 20... for .................... for the purpose of .................. Signed ... Authorising instructor This is to certify that the above named pilot landed at ........ at .. Hours on .. 20 The nature of the landing was ... As far as can be ascertained the pilot was alone in the aircraft and unaccompanied by any other aircraft. Signed ... Chief Flying Instructor/Deputy or Air Trafc Controller/FISO This is to certify that the above named pilot landed at at . Hours on .. 20 The nature of the landing was .......... The standard of airmanship displayed was ........ As far as can be ascertained the pilot was alone in the aircraft and unaccompanied by any other aircraft. Signed ... Chief Flying Instructor/Deputy or Air Trafc Controller/FISO The above cross country ight was carried out to my satisfaction. Signed ... Chief Flying Instructor
May 2012
THE GENERAL SKILL TEST 1. An applicant for an NPPL(SSEA) shall have demonstrated the ability to perform as pilot-incommand of an aeroplane the procedures and ight manoeuvres described in the foregoing pages of this syllabus with a degree of competency appropriate to the privileges granted to the holder of an NPPL(SSEA). 2. An applicant for an NPPL(SSEA) General Skill Test shall have satisfactorily completed all of the required ight training, including instruction on the same class/type of aeroplane to be used during the Navigation Skill Test (NST) and the General Skill Test (GST). 3. The General Skill Test shall be taken within 6 months of the completion of training and all sections of the test must be completed within 6 months of the rst attempt. If the applicant does not pass all sections of the skill test at the rst attempt, the section(s) which have been failed may be attempted in a further test. There is no limit to the number of tests that may be taken. 4. A pass will be achieved when all sections of the General Skill Test have been passed. 5. The General Skill Test shall be conducted by an authorised Flight Examiner. 6. An applicant for a General Skill Test shall have successfully completed all theoretical knowledge examinations including examinations in Communications with a practical Radio Telephony (R/T) examination. 7. Provision of aeroplanes for the General Skill Test - The aeroplane used for the test shall meet the requirements for training aeroplanes. 8. SECTIONS OF THE FLIGHT TEST Section 1: Pre-ight operations and departure Section 2: General Airwork Section 3: Approach and landing procedures Section 4: Abnormal and emergency operations 9. FLIGHT TEST TOLERANCES The applicant shall demonstrate the ability to: - operate the aeroplane within its limitations; - complete all manoeuvres with smoothness and accuracy; - exercise good judgement and airmanship; - apply aeronautical knowledge; and - maintain control of the aeroplane at all times in such a manner that the successful outcome of the procedure or manoeuvre is never seriously in doubt. The following limits are for general guidance. The examiner will make allowances for turbulent conditions and for the handling qualities and performance of the aeroplane used. Height 150ft. Heading 10. Speed 15kt CONTENTS OF THE GENERAL SKILL TEST The General Skill Test contents for the issue of an NPPL (SSEA) are shown below: Use of checklists, control of the aeroplane by external visual reference, anti/de-icing procedures, etc. apply in all sections. SECTION 1 PRE-FLIGHT OPERATIONS AND DEPARTURE a. Pre-ight documentation and weather brief b. Mass and balance and performance calculation c. Aeroplane inspection and servicing
May 2012
d. Passenger care and considerations e. Engine starting and after starting procedures f. Taxiing and aerodrome procedures, pre take-off procedures g. Take-off and after take-off checks h. Aerodrome departure procedures i. ATC liaison - compliance, R/T procedures, Airmanship SECTION 2 - GENERAL AIRWORK a ATC liaison and compliance, R/T procedure, Airmanship b Straight and level ight, with speed changes c Climbing: i best rate of climb ii climbing turns iii levelling off d Medium (30 bank) turns e Steep turns (360 left and right - 45 bank) including recognition and recovery from a spiral dive f Flight at critically low airspeed with and without aps. Best angle of climb g Stalling: i Clean stall and recovery with power ii Approach to stall descending turn with bank angle 20, approach conguration iii Approach to stall in landing conguration
h Descending i With and without power ii Descending turns (steep gliding turns) iii Levelling off SECTION 3 - APPROACH AND LANDING PROCEDURES a Aerodrome arrival procedures b *Precision landing (short eld landing), cross wind, (if suitable conditions available) c *Flapless landing d Approach to landing with idle power e Touch and go f Go-around from low height g ATC liaison -compliance, R/T procedures, Airmanship h Actions after ight including documentation SECTION 4 - ABNORMAL AND EMERGENCY PROCEDURES This section may be combined with Sections 1 through 3 a Simulated engine failure after take-off b *Simulated forced landing c Simulated precautionary landing d *Simulated emergencies *some of these items may be combined at the discretion of the Flight Examiner.
May 2012
APPLICATION AND REPORT FORM NPPL (SSEA) GENERAL SKILL TEST Applicants Name Applicants Signature For Ofcial use CAA Reference U K N P
It is an offence to make, with intent to deceive, any false representations for the purpose of procuring the grant, issue, renewal, or variation of any certicate, licence approval, permission or other document. Persons so doing render themselves liable, on summary conviction to a ne not exceeding the statutory maximum (currently 5,000, or in Northern Ireland 2,000) and on conviction on indictment to an unlimited ne or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2years or both. Date of Test:.................................. Place of Test:....................................................................
Aircraft Type and Reg. Block Times Dep Arrival Duration Examiners name and Licence Number
Test Sections: Sections To Be Taken: RESULT a b c d e f g h i Re-test: Test Sections incomplete: Items not completed: Retraining requirements of any failed sections/items: Examiners Name Examiners Signature
May 2012
SUMMARY OF AIR EXERCISES CONTAINED IN PHASES 1 TO 4 OF THE FLIGHT CURRICULUM PHASE 1 1. Familiarisation with the aeroplane 1E. Emergency drills 2. Preparation for and action after ight 3. Air experience 4. Effects of controls 5. Taxiing 6. Straight and level ight 7. Climbing 8. Descending 9. Medium turns 10A. Slow ight 12. Take-off and climb 13. Approach and landing PHASE 2 Consolidation of previously taught air exercises (as required) 10B. Stalling 11. Spin avoidance 14. First solo PHASE 3 Consolidation of take-offs and landings including: Crosswind take-off and landing 12/13. Short eld take-off and landing, soft eld procedures Landing at unlicensed strips, shorteld/grass operation Glide approaches, powered approaches Flapless landings 12/13E. Emergency procedures (as appropriate) 14B. Circuit departure procedures, local area orientation, RTF procedures, use of magnetic compass, map reading, circuit rejoining. PHASE 4 Consolidation of previously taught air exercises (as required) 15. Advanced turning 16. Forced landings without power 17. Precautionary landings 18A. Pilot navigation 18B. Navigation at lower levels 19. Instrument appreciation Revision for the NPPL(SSEA) qualifying General Skill Test.
May 2012
The following breakdown of ying hours is only an example, it does not take into account any additional training which may be necessary for a student to reach an acceptable standard of performance. Phase 1.
Exercise No. 1. 1E. 2. 3. 4. 5. 5E. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10A. 10B. 11. Dual ) ) ) )1.30 ) ) ) 1.00 0.45 0.45 0.45 0.30 1.00 0.30 Solo Total Dual Total Solo Total Dual/Solo Detail of Exercise Familiarisation with the a/c Emergency Drills Pre. For/after ight Air Experience Effect of controls Taxiing Taxiing emergencies Straight & level ight Climbing Descending Turning Slow ight Stalling Spin avoidance
1.30
1.30
Phase 3
12/13 14B. 1.00 0.45 2.15 1.00 10.45 11.30 2.30 3.30 13.15 15.00 Consolidation on circuit dual/solo Leaving circuit, local area, compass turns, circuit rejoining
Phase 4
15. 16. 17. 18A/B 19. Revision 1.00 2.00 1.00 4.30 1.00 1.00 0.45 0.45 4.00 1.00 12.30 14.30 15.30 20.00 21.00 22.00 4.15 5.00 5.00 9.00 9.00 10.00 16.45 19.30 20.30 29.00 30.00 32.00 Advance turning Forced landing without power Precautionary landing and operations at minimum level Compass turns, map reading, dual,solo,x-country Instrument appreciation Revision as required
Navigation Skill Test to be conducted prior to the qualifying solo cross-country 1.00 (or as required) General Skill Test to be undertaken on completion of all the training 1.00 (or as required)
May 2012
TRAINING RECORD STATEMENTS PHASE 1 I certify that the student has received the ying and ground training in this section. Chief Flying Instructor Name ........................................................... Signature ...................................................... Student name .............................................. Signature ...................................................... PHASE 3 I certify that the student has received the ying and ground training in this section. Chief Flying Instructor Name ........................................................... Signature ...................................................... Student name .............................................. Signature ...................................................... PHASE 2 I certify that the student has received the ying and ground training in this section. Chief Flying Instructor Name ......................................................... Signature .................................................... Student name ............................................ Signature .................................................... PHASE 4 I certify that the student has received all the training required in this syllabus. Chief Flying Instructor Name ......................................................... Signature .................................................... Student name ............................................ Signature ....................................................
May 2012
(B)
SLMG Syllabus
Syllabus for the UNITED KINGDOM National Private Pilot Licence (Self Launching Motor Glider) Section 1 Introduction Section 2 The NPPL (SLMG) Course Section 3 Theoretical Knowledge Syllabus Section 4 Flight Training Syllabus Section 5 SLMG Specic Exercises Section 6 Advice to Instructors Section 7 Record of Flight Training Section 8 Examining Record Designed and produced by the NPPL (SLMG) Instructing and Examining Panel with reference to the AOPA NPPL (SEP) syllabus.
May 2012
Section 1 Introduction
This syllabus is designed for use during a training course for the NPPL (SLMG). Training Objectives The NPPL (SLMG) syllabus is designed so that the pilots under training are: provided with the experience, the competence in ying and the theoretical knowledge demanded by the ground and ight tests for the initial issue of an NPPL; able to use the motor gliders and facilities of the private ying environment within the privileges of the licence, ratings and qualications; made aware of how to operate in a safe and responsible manner, and with an awareness of their own limitations. Denitions The following denitions apply to this document: General Skills Test Applicants for the NPPL have to demonstrate their ability to perform procedures and manoeuvres in an aircraft for an examiner to assess their competency to hold an NPPL. Navigation Skills Test Applicants for the NPPL will be required to successfully execute a planned navigation test ight with an examiner prior to undertaking the qualifying solo cross country ight. Qualifying Solo Cross Country Flight Ab-initio applicants for the NPPL must consolidate the NPPL training course by planning and conducting a solo cross country ight of a dened minimum distance that involves landing at other airelds. Reference Material Flying Manual for the NPPL1 Aircraft Owners and Pilots Association (AOPA) Flying Instructors Manual Ground Training Manuals (eg. the AFE PPL series) The Training Aircraft Flight Manual/Pilots Operating Handbook Safety Equipment Manufacturers Recommendations and Instruction Leaets Aeronautical Charts 1:500 000 The ANO (Air Navigation Order) CAP 804 Part-FCL (EASA Flight Crew Licensing) National AIP (Aeronautical Information Publication) AICs (Aeronautical Information Circulars) CAP 85 A guide to aviation Law, Flight Rules and Procedures CAP 413 Radio Telephony Manual CAA GA Safety Sense Leaets Accident Information Bulletins
1. Currently unavailable
May 2012
Section 2 The NPPL (SLMG) Course The objectives of the NPPL (SLMG) course are that student pilots are given adequate theoretical knowledge and ying training to ensure that they are capable of safely operating an aircraft whilst ying in weather conditions appropriate to the visual ight rules. Acceptance for Training Before being accepted for training, the student should be informed of the medical requirements for solo and for the application for the NPPL. Minimum Age First solo 16 yrs. Issue of NPPL 17 yrs. Medical Requirements Declaration of medical tness signed by the pilots GP, equivalent to the DVLA Group 2 professional driving medical standards, is required for solo ying or for passenger carrying. Alternatively any Part-MED Medical Certicate (including the LAPL Medical Certicate) may be accepted. It may be possible for individuals who cannot meet the DVLA Group 2 standards to operate as a solo pilot only with a certicate of tness equivalent to the DVLA Group 1 standards. Training Aircraft An adequate training aircraft must be provided by the ying or gliding club and maintained to the appropriate BCAR standards. The types of self launching motor glider accepted as appropriate for training for the NPPL (SLMG) shall be approved by the NPPL (SLMG) Instructing and Examining Panel. Training Airelds Training for the NPPL (SLMG) shall be conducted at appropriately approved airelds. Instruction Instruction for the NPPL (SLMG) must be carried out by a holder of either the UK SLMG PPL ying instructor rating or the holder of a Part-FCL ying instructor rating with TMG privileges. Course of Training Ab-initio students shall complete a minimum course of ying training totalling 32 hours, excluding the General Skill test and the Navigation Skill test. Record of Training An individual record of training for the NPPL (SLMG) must be maintained for each student and retained by the ying training organisation for 5 years. Particular emphasis should be placed on recording emergency procedure training. The student should sign the record of training at the end of each phase to acknowledge that all the items in the syllabus for that phase have been taught. On completion of training, the students logbook should be signed by the students CFI or his representative as a true record of the completed training. NPPL Enquiries In the rst instance, please view the NPLG website at www.nationalprivatepilotslicence.co.uk
May 2012
Aviation Law & Operational Procedures Human Performance and Limitations Navigation Meteorology Aircraft (General) Principles of Flight Flight Performance Communications These subjects should be covered by use of lectures and by a course of directed study. Privileges of the NPPL In addition to the Theoretical Knowledge syllabus, the course shall include an explanation of the privileges and limitations of the NPPL, and the requirements for the revalidation and renewal of ratings.
May 2012
To assist students who may wish to complete a Part-FCL PPL in the future, the exercise numbering corresponds to the exercises conducted for the Part-FCL PPL. However, the depth of coverage and time spent on each exercise will be appropriate to the NPPL course. A summary of the NPPL minimum ight training time is tabulated below. Minimum Flight Training Time for the NPPL (SLMG) Flight Training Syllabus Phase 1.
Exercise No. 1. 1E. 2. 3. 4. 5. 5E. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10A. 10B. 11. Dual ) ) ) )1.30 ) ) ) 1.00 0.45 0.45 0.45 0.30 1.00 0.30 Solo Total Dual Total Solo Total Dual/Solo Detail of Exercise Familiarisation with the a/c Emergency Drills Pre. For/after ight Air Experience Effect of controls Taxiing Taxiing emergencies Straight & level ight Climbing Descending Turning Slow ight Stalling Spin avoidance
1.30
1.30
Phase 2
12. 13. 13E. 14. 1.15 1.15 0.30 0.15 8.00 9.15 9.45 9.45 0.15 8.00 9.15 9.45 10.00 Take-off/climb to down-wind position Circuit approach & landing Emergencies during take-off and landing First solo
Phase 3
12/13. 14B. 1.00 0.45 2.15 1.00 10.45 11.30 2.30 3.30 13.15 15.00 Consolidation on circuit dual/solo Leaving circuit, local area, compass turns, circuit rejoining
Phase 4
15. 16. 17. 18A/B. 19. Revision 1.00 2.00 1.00 4.30 1.00 1.00 0.45 0.45 4.00 1.00 12.30 14.30 15.30 20.00 21.00 22.00 4.15 5.00 5.00 9.00 9.00 10.00 16.45 19.30 20.30 29.00 30.00 32.00 Advance turning Forced landing without power Precautionary landing and operations at minimum level Compass turns, map reading, dual, solo, x-country Instrument appreciation Revision as required 1.00 (or as required) 1.00 (or as required)
to be conducted prior to the qualifying solo cross-country to be undertaken on completion of all the training
SLMG with ap may require additional dual training time during this exercise May 2012 Section 5 Part A Subpart 1 Page 48
NPPL SLMG Solo Navigation Brieng Certicate NOTE: The completed certicate should remain at the base aerodrome. I certify that student pilot.has been briefed for a solo navigation ight as follows: From.. To From.. To From.. To for an estimated ETD ofhrs local on (date) The navigation plan has been checked and the following items discussed. Where applicable, the required facts have been noted on the ight plan.
Weather Altitude to y and terrain clearance. Minimum safety altitude Destination actual weather Requirement and method of maintaining VFR ight Procedures for crossing zones, civil and military Regulated airspace entry/exit lane procedures Danger areas ASRs NOTAMs TNWs including Royal Flights PPR? Knowledge of runways, noise abatement, joining procedures, frequencies Landaway procedure, including refuel and booking in/out Knowledge of controlled/regulated airspace and related min altitudes/levels Action in the event of an airspace intrusion Action in the event of weather deterioration and/or fuel shortage Action on becoming lost Use of RT including use of DF and PAN procedure Action in the event of an unscheduled landing Full fuel and oil level Serviceability Mass and Balance Mass and Performance Use of radio if lost MAYDAY procedure Noting frequencies for normal and emergency use
Route
Destination
Aircraft
Radio
Certifying instructors signature... Licence No. I certify that I have been briefed for the navigation exercise detailed above and understand that in the event of an unscheduled landing I will contact the CFI or his deputy by the quickest possible means and act according to their instructions. Student pilots signature Date.. Time...
May 2012
This is to certify that.......................................................................is the student pilot of G-................... and was authorised to leave .................................................................................................................. at (time)............................ (date) .......................... for the purpose of ..................................................... .............................................................................................................................................................. .............................................................................................................................................................. Signed ........................................................................................... Authorising CAA SLMG FI
This is to certify that student pilot .................................................landed at.......................................... .............................................................................................................................................................. The landing was normal and the standard of airmanship displayed was/was not acceptable. As far as can be ascertained, the pilot was alone in the aircraft. I have briefed the pilot for a departure from this aireld. Signed ............................................................ CFI/Deputy CFI/Rated Instructor/Air Trafc Control
This is to certify that student pilot .................................................landed at.......................................... .............................................................................................................................................................. The landing was normal and the standard of airmanship displayed was/was not acceptable. As far as can be ascertained, the pilot was alone in the aircraft. I have briefed the pilot for a departure from this aireld. Signed ............................................................ CFI/Deputy CFI/Rated Instructor/Air Trafc Control
The above cross-country ight was carried out to my satisfaction. Signed ................................................................. CAA SLMG FI at student pilots operating base
May 2012
May 2012
Exercise 16 Stopping and Starting the Engine in Flight Instructors Note: This exercise has signicant airmanship implications! It is, of course, important that the instructor ensures that the student is fully aware of the requirement to remain within gliding range of an aireld with the engine stopped, and to ensure that he or she understands the concept of a height envelope, including a height oor. For example: 3000 Stop the engine 1500 Restart the engine 1000 Exercise height oor. Abandon engine start attempt. Get established in the glide circuit This exercise demonstrates the procedure for stopping and starting the engine in ight using normal engine starting for the aircraft type. Demonstration Stopping. Having carefully addressed the airmanship considerations, at an appropriate height and position (ideally close to an aireld) reduce the power to allow the engine to cool to the recommended temperature. Having achieved the recommended temperature, stop the engine as recommended in the ight manual or pilots notes. Note any post engine stop requirements, for example electrical power conservation, propeller adjustment, engine cooling ap closure, etc. If the type has no recommended engine stopping procedure, the following guidelines may be appropriate. After the engine cooling down period: Carb Heat Check Fully Hot Ancillary electrics Off Radio Off Ignition Off Fuel Off Check airspeed Apply the propeller brake, or feather the propeller, or reduce the airspeed until the propeller stops Adopt the normal gliding attitude Radio On Demonstration Starting. Having addressed the appropriate airmanship considerations and any pre starting requirements, for example un-feathering the propeller or opening cooling aps, etc, start the engine as recommended in the ight manual or pilots notes. If the type has no recommended engine starting procedure, the following guideline may be appropriate. If above the minimum height to attempt a start: Fuel On Choke As required Throttle Set Ignition On Radio Off Starter Operate, and when engine starts, Choke Off Starter Warning Check Oil Pressure and Temperature Check Carb Heat Cold Radio On
May 2012
Summary: Stopping and starting the engine in ight is a relatively complex procedure and in some types may require the use of ight reference cards. The priority must always be to FLY the aircraft, and to remain in gliding range of a safe landing area. Switching off the ignition and fuel will prevent the engine running under its own power but the gliding speed will continue to make the propeller rotate due to the windmilling action of the slipstream. Exercise 16 Windmill Starting the Engine in Flight Instructors Note: This exercise uses a considerable amount of height, and therefore the airmanship considerations previously described in exercise 16 should again be addressed. This exercise should be carried out close to an aireld. Consideration should also be given to some older aircraft types with a low VNE the speed required to windmill the propeller may be too close to VNE for safe windmill starting. It is important that the student is made aware that electrical failure could occur while attempting to start the engine in ight - for example a discharged battery or failed starter motor. This exercise demonstrates the procedure for windmill starting the engine in ight. Demonstration. Having addressed the airmanship considerations, including an agreed start attempt height oor, y the aircraft at best glide speed and close to the aireld. Having noted any pre-starting requirements, carry out a windmill start as recommended in the ight manual or pilots notes. If the type has no recommended procedure for a windmill start but the type is approved for a windmill start, the following procedure may be appropriate: Fuel On Throttle Set as for a ground start Choke As Required Ignition On Radio Off Propeller Unfeather Accelerate to windmill the propeller (speed is type specic) When engine starts, reduce the airspeed Adjust the power setting as required Choke Off Radio On
Summary: The windmilling action of the slipstream can be utilised to start the engine in the event of a failure of the aircraft normal engine starting system. Care must be taken to avoid overspeeding the engine and propeller during the post start recovery. A windmill start attempt will inevitably use a signicant amount of height.
May 2012
Airbrakes or Spoilers. In many SLMG aircraft types, in the event of a go around or baulked landing it is necessary to move the left hand from the airbrake (or spoiler) lever to the stick and the right hand from the stick to the throttle. All instructors and their students should be fully briefed on the required procedure to change from the approach or landing with airbrake (or spoiler) to the take-off or climb under power. For example: Close and lock the airbrake (or spoiler) and adopt the appropriate attitude; Move the left hand to the control column and then the right hand to the throttle; Apply power. Carburettor Icing. All pilots should be made aware of carburettor icing during the course of their theoretical and ight training. However, some SLMG aircraft types are less prone to carburettor icing because of design features such as carburettor position and/or air inlet position. It is likely that this has inuenced some instructors and students to become complacent about use of carburettor hot air in ight. Instructors should ensure that their students use carburettor hot air on all occasions appropriate to the engine and aircraft type, and are reminded of the primacy aspects of the student noting the use of carburettor heat during the rst and every subsequent ight. Self Launching Sailplanes. It is unlikely that any retractable engine self-launching sailplane will be appropriate for training for the NPPL (SLMG). Advice on operating this type of SLMG and on appropriate differences training can be obtained from the NPPL (SLMG) Instructing and Examining Panel. The Navigation Skills Test The Navigation Skill Test (NST) is a qualifying requirement for the grant of a NPPL (SLMG) or NPPL (SSEA). The aim of the test is to provide an independent check of the student pilots ability to apply visual navigation techniques, to prepare for an in-ight diversion, to liaise with ATC and, in the case of the SLMG NST only, to navigate safely following change to the planned route resulting from an unsuccessful soaring opportunity. Before attempting this test, the student must have satisfactorily completed all the dual navigation training in the NPPL syllabus, except as dened for applicants claiming cross-crediting allowances against training as outlined in the NPPL Licence Allowance document. The student must have passed the Navigation Skill Test before undertaking the qualifying solo cross-country. The test comprises the following: 1. Flight planning and self brieng (including assessment of weather suitability) for a route of not less than 60 minutes ying time. 2. In-ight recording of the progress of the ight. Notes made on the map are acceptable for this requirement. 3. ATC liaison and compliance; observance of ATC Regulations and Rules of the Air. 4. DR navigation (correction of track error, revision of ETA, heading-setting technique including, where tted, synchronising directional gyro with magnetic compass in ight). 5. Map reading. Track crawling through continuous map reading will not be considered an acceptable visual navigation technique. 6. Maintenance of heading, height and airspeed at normal cruising levels. 7. (SLMG only) Re-establishment of position by visual methods following deliberate disruption of the original ight plan, simulating an unsuccessful attempt to take advantage of an off-track soaring opportunity. 8. Diversion procedure following simulated adverse weather conditions en-route.
May 2012
Pre-Flight Planning Requirements Weather obtaining appropriate information interpreting the information assessing weather suitability Airspace obtaining appropriate information including relevant NOTAMs interpreting the information assessing any threats Navigation ight plan and map preparation Fuel plan and aircraft loading Booking out/ local procedures Flight Test Procedure 1. The route should not be made available to the applicant earlier than 2 hours before walking out to the aircraft. 2. The applicant must not have practised (either dual or solo) ying the route to be used. 3. The ight is to be non-stop; i.e. without an intermediate landing. 4. Radio navigation aids or GPS may not be used, except during the practice diversion once the applicant has made an initial assessment of the required heading to the diversion and the ETA at the diversion. If such navigation aids are used, their correct use will be assessed. Radar navigational assistance may not be used at any time. 5. The planned route is normally to be A - B - C, subject to the following provisos: leg A - B should require at least 20 mins ight time; track change at B should be between 60 and 120 and the distance B - C should require at least 20 mins ight time. 6. During leg B-C: (SLMG only) between about 10-15 min after B the examiner will direct the applicant, simulating changed soaring opportunities, to a position about 5 NM off track. (SLMG only) when directed, the applicant must make and implement an appropriate decision either to regain the planned track or to plan a revised track direct to the next turning point. between 10-15 min after B (or, SLMG only, once the applicants revised tracking and timing have been assessed), the applicant will be told to assume weather deterioration and to prepare for a practice diversion to a point not less than 20 NM off track. The test may be terminated when the applicant has demonstrated the ability to track towards the diversion for not less than 10 minutes, has told the examiner the location of the aeroplane and has given an acceptable ETA at the diversion. 7. Appropriate systems management, including fuel use and carburettor heat operation is to be assessed throughout the test. 8. The record of the ight in the applicants logbook is to include the examiners signature and examiner number, stating that the ight was a NST and whether a successful pass was achieved. The planned route is to be shown in the remarks column, together with details of the diversion point. Successful applicants should log the ight time as PIC U/S.
May 2012
May 2012
Phase 2
Phase 2 Exercise 12 13 12E/13E 14 Description Takeoff and Climb The Circuit, Approach and Landing Emergency Procedures First Solo Date Completed Instructors Signature
Phase 3
Phase 3 Exercise 12/13 14B Description Consolidation of Exercises 12 and 13 Consolidation of Exercise 14 Date Completed Instructors Signature
Phase 4
Phase 4 Exercise 15 16 17 18A 18E 19 Description Advanced Turning Forced Landing without Power Precautionary Landing Pilot Navigation Navigation Emergencies Instrument Appreciation Date Completed Instructors Signature
Phase 4 Flying Exercises Taught - Student Signature: ........................................................................... Date Flight Training Syllabus Completed
Examiner Signature
Student Signature
May 2012
Section 8 Examining Record The NPPL SLMG ight tests comprise of the Navigational Skills Test (NST) and the General Skills Test (GST). The following documents are designed for use by the examiner during the testing process. The completed forms must be forwarded with the licence application. NPPL SLMG NST Examining Record NPPL SLMG GST Examining Record NPPL NAVIGATION SKILL TEST REPORT
Applicants Name: ................................................................................ Applicants Signature: ......................................................................... U K N For Ofcial use CAA Reference P
It is an offence to make, with intent to deceive, any false representations for the purpose of procuring the grant, issue, renewal, or variation of any certicate, licence approval, permission or other document. Persons so doing render themselves liable, on summary conviction to a ne not exceeding the statutory maximum (currently 5,000, or in Northern Ireland 2,000) and on conviction on indictment to an unlimited ne or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2years or both. Date of Test:.......................... Place of Test: ...........................................................................
Aircraft Type and Registration Block Times Route: Result: Re-test: (Details as required) Retraining requirement if required: Remarks: Departure Arrival Duration
This test was conducted in accordance with NPPL Syllabus SLMG* / SSEA*
Examiners Name: Examiners Signature: Examiners CAA Authorisation Number:
* Delete as applicable.
May 2012 Section 5 Part A Subpart 1 Page 58
NPPL SLMG GENERAL SKILLS TEST EXAMINING RECORD NOTE: It is not essential that the whole test be completed in one ight provided the date on which the candidate was found procient is inserted against each item of the test. The whole test must be completed within 28 days.
Applicants name: ................................................. Aircraft type: Registration
Preparation For Flight Weather suitability Aeroplane documents check Personal equipment check Weight, balance and performance calculate Pre-ight inspection Booking out Passenger brieng
STARTING, TAXYING AND POWER CHECKS:
Straight and level Descending and descending turning Turns onto specied headings Recovery to straight and level ight from climbing/descending turns
NAVIGATION AND ORIENTATION:
Pre-take-off checks (vital actions) Assessment of crosswind component Checks during & after take-off Normal take-off Crosswind take-off
AERODROME DEPARTURE PROCEDURES
Pre-landing checks (vital actions) Powered approach Glide approach Flapless approach Shorteld landing Crosswind landing Assessment of crosswind component Missed approach procedure Checks after landing
STARTING/STOPPING THE ENGINE IN FLIGHT SIMULATED EMERGENCIES
CLIMBING STRAIGHT & LEVEL DESCENDING WITH POWER TURNING: Level Climbing Descending At steep angle of bank
STALLING/UNUSUAL ATTITUDES:
Knowledge of aircraft manoeuvre limitations and speed limitations Checks before stalling Flight at 1g clean stall speed + 5 kt and ight at 1g airbrake/spoiler deployed stall speed + 5 kt level, climbing, descending and turning Recognition of incipient stall Recovery from incipient stall Recovery from a developed stall: Straight Turning In approach conguration
Engine re in the air/on the ground Cabin re in the air/on the ground
Engine failure after take-off ENGINE & SYSTEMS HANDLING USE OF CARBURETTOR HEAT
AIRMANSHIP AWARENESS:
May 2012
Recognition of incipient spin Recovery from an incipient spin: Gliding At climb power In approach conguration
I certify that: a) I have examined the applicants training record and logbook. b) I am satised that the applicant has reached the standards of ying required to pass the NPPL SLMG GST. c) I have retained a copy of this completed document.
Examiners Signature: ........................................ Examiners Name: ........................................ CAA Authority No: ................................... Date: .......................
May 2012
Subpart 2
1 Privileges
The privileges of the NPPL(A) Microlight and Powered Parachute are dened in Schedule 7 of the Air Navigation Order. The NPPL(A) is a sub-ICAO licence* and therefore is restricted for use in G-registered aircraft within UK airspace. For ights outside of the UK please refer to Schedule 7, Part A, Section 3 of the Air Navigation Order, see CAP 804 Section 7, Part B.
2 Requirements
2.1 Limitations 2.2 National Private Pilots Licence Microlight Training Syllabus 2.3 Revalidation 2.1 Limitations This licence is valid only for ights in the UK. Flights using the privileges of this licence within the territories of the Channel Islands, the Isle of Man, and other Contracting States to the International Convention on Civil Aviation require the written permission of the appropriate authority of that State. When issued with operational Limitation, the following shall also apply. When an NPPL(A) (Microlight) is issued with operational limitations, it will impose the following constraints on the licence holder: Limitation 1: No person in addition to the pilot shall be carried in the aeroplane other than a qualied ying instructor in an aeroplane equipped with dual controls, provided that where the pilot has gained not less than 25 hours experience on microlight aeroplanes, including not less than 10 hours as PIC and such experience has been entered in his/her personal ying logbook and has been certied by a person holding a Flight Examiner authorisation, then this Limitation (numbered 2) shall cease to apply. Limitation 2: No ight shall commence or continue unless: a) there is no cloud below 1000 feet above ground level over the take-off site and over the planned route including the landing site; and b) the ight can be conducted in a ight visibility of not less than 10 kilometers. Limitation 3: The aeroplane shall not y further than 8 nautical miles from the take-off site. Limitation Nos. 2 and 3 will be removed from the licence, upon recommendation to the CAA by the BMAA upon completion of at least 25 hours experience in microlights, including: a) A minimum total of 5 hours navigation ying training must be completed within the period of 9 months immediately prior to licence application or an application to remove operational limitations from an existing licence. b) The required navigation ying training includes a minimum of 3 hours of solo navigation ying training to be completed within the 9 month period.
27 July 2012
c) The navigation ight training must include two solo qualifying cross-country ights. Each solo qualifying cross country ight must have: a minimum total ight distance of 40 nautical miles; a landing at another site which is at least 15 nautical miles, measured in a straight line, from the take-off site at which the ight began. The two solo qualifying cross-country ights must be own over different routes and to different sites. In addition, applicants are required to complete the NPPL (Microlight) General Skills Test. The ight time of the test may be included in the minimum 15 hours of ight training, but cannot form part of the minimum 7 hours required as PIC. 2.2 National Private Pilots Licence Microlight Training Syllabus Introduction After many years experience and consultation with experienced microlight instructors and examiners, this syllabus has been formulated by the Microlight Panel of Examiners on behalf of the British Microlight Aircraft Association (BMAA), and approved by the Civil Aviation Authority (CAA). All microlight instruction must be conducted in accordance to this, and no other syllabus - unless any alternative syllabus has been submitted to and approved by the CAA. The syllabus is in two main parts - 1 Flying, 2 Ground - subjects. The ying syllabus is broken down into phases and exercises. Individual exercises are further sub-divided into different elements, each of which must be fully understood by the student. Within each phase, each exercise has a specic stated aim. To ensure that these aims are achieved each phase has a specic stated standard of skill which must be achieved. Elements pertinent to both weightshift and 3-axis types of aircraft are included in the syllabus. Where an aspect is not relevant to a type it should be ignored. For example, in exercise 6 - Use of yaw control to maintain balanced ight is not pertinent to a weightshift aircraft, as no primary control for yaw is provided in current designs. Use of the syllabus Every student should be in possession of a copy of the syllabus. As an aid to ensuring that no element is omitted each element can be ticked off as it is completed. An exercise or group of exercises of the ying syllabus is taken as a session, and the pattern of each ying session should be run as follows: (1) Pre-ight brieng (2) Flight training session (3) Post ight de-brieng The ight exercises as listed reect a progression through the basic handling skills to more complex manoeuvring and procedural ying. It is not however mandatory for a student to complete the exercises in strict number order if an instructor feels that the student would benet from an earlier introduction to a later exercise, for example First Solo immediately after satisfactory completion of Phase 3, Exercise 13. All ight exercises should be completed to a satisfactory standard prior to course completion.
27 July 2012
There is no laid down format for the ground subjects training, but it should be closely aligned to the knowledge required for the ight training exercises in order to produce an integrated course of training. Every school is required to keep an up to date progress report for each student pilot on a student record sheet. Student records must be kept for at least two years after the last entry and should be available to the student to view. Summary of the Syllabus for the Microlight NPPL Course Flight Training
Phase 1 Ex No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9a 9b 2 10a 10b 11 3 12 13 4 14 15 5 16a 16b 6 17a 17b 17c 7 18 Exercise Description Aircraft familiarisation Preparation for ight and action after Air Experience Effects of Controls Taxiing Straight & Level ight Climbing Descending Medium Level-turns (up to 30 bank angle) Climbing and descending turns Slow ight Stalling Spin Awareness Takeoff and climb to down wind The circuit, approach, and landing/overshoot Advanced turning (up to 60 bank angle) Unusual and dangerous attitudes/conditions Forced landings, with/without power Operation at minimum level First solo Solo circuit, local area, and general ying consolidation to GST for microlight NPPL Dual revision for GST Pilot navigation
27 July 2012
MICROLIGHT NPPL COURSE FLIGHT TRAINING SYLLABUS Ex 1. Aircraft Familiarisation Aim: To become familiar with the component parts, controls, and systems of the aircraft. Explanation of the aircraft: Component parts of the aircraft Main ight controls Engine controls Explanation of the cockpit layout and systems: Operation of ying controls Operation of engine controls Flight instruments/Engine instruments Electrical system Fuel system Operation of safety equipment Check lists and drills: Use of check lists and drills suitable for aircraft type Instinctive knowledge of position of controls Emergency drills: Action in the event of re; in the air and on the ground Failure of equipment or systems Escape drills Ex 2. Preparation for ight and Action after ight Aim: To understand how to prepare the aircraft and pilot for ight, and to leave the aircraft after ight. Aireld Rules/Procedure/Safety: Standing orders Booking out/in Windsock Signals square Fuel storage Fire extinguisher/s Smoking Student Comfort: Seating position Suitable clothing for conditions expected Flight Authorisation and aircraft acceptance: Pre-ight planning Aircraft documentation Air trafc control information Personal equipment
27 July 2012
Pre-ight checks: Use of manufacturers check list or mnemonic Explanation of extra items to check if aircraft just rigged External checks: Position of aircraft suitable for starting Fire extinguisher is available Taxi path is unobstructed Starting and warming up engine: Pre-start checks Stages and controls involved Signals that may be used Pre-Takeoff checks: Use of manufacturers checklist or suitable mnemonic Importance of this check (vital actions) Running down and switching off: Stages and controls involved Leaving the aircraft: Suitably parked/picketed Controls locked or restrained Brief external check Completion of post-ight documentation: Booking in Reporting of defects Entries in personal ight log Entries in Airframe/Engine log Ex 3. Air Experience Aim: To introduce and become accustomed to the aircraft, the sensation of ying and to sample the aspect of the ground from the air. Detailed instruction is not normally undertaken on this ight. It can, however, be a valuable lesson. It is an opportunity for the instructor to become acquainted with the student and decide upon the most suitable approach for subsequent instruction. During the ight all actions performed by the instructor should be accompanied by an explanation. Any sudden manoeuvring or expected turbulence should be discussed before it is encountered. The student should inform the instructor of any discomfort, in order to allow a rapid return to the aireld. During the latter part of the ight, the student should have the opportunity to handle the controls to provide a foundation for the next exercise. If the student has some previous ying experience, then this exercise can be combined with Ex 4 Effects of Controls. Ex 4. Effects of Controls Aim: To understand how each control affects the aircraft in ight.
27 July 2012
Airmanship The importance of maintaining a good lookout Methods of assessing aircraft attitude: The horizon Hands-off trim Feel of wind on face Primary effects of controls: Further effects of controls: Effects of airspeed, slipstream, and torque on control response: Effects of trim: Hands-off trim In ight adjustable trim (where applicable) Effects of Flap; (where applicable): Effect at different positions Change in pitch attitude with ap Remaining within ap operational limiting speed Use of other controls for increasing Rate of Descent (where applicable): Airbrakes Spoilers Tip draggers Use of other controls as applicable to type: Mixture control Carburettor heat Cabin heat and ventilation Ex 5. Taxiing Aim: To safely control the aircraft while manoeuvring on the ground, in different wind conditions, and on different surfaces. Airmanship: Lookout Suitable taxi speed Serviceability checks of instruments (compass, ASI, etc) Use of controls during taxiing: Headwind Tailwind Crosswind Tailwheel considerations, (where applicable) Emergencies: Ex 6. Straight and Level ight Aim: To attain and maintain ight in a straight line, and at a constant altitude. Airmanship: Lookout Regular checks - Fuel state/consumption rate/engine instruments/etc
27 July 2012
Straight ight: Visual reference point Regaining and maintaining visual reference point Use of yaw control to maintain balanced ight Level ight, (Normal cruise power): Power required dependant on load carried Attitude appreciation and control Use of in-ight trim control (if applicable) Hands-off trim Inherent stability Use of altimeter to check level Level ight, (Varying power settings and IAS): Power provides height Angle of attack provides speed Power and angle of attack combine to give performance Attitude control: Use of pitch control to maintain constant attitude to achieve constant I.A.S. Difference between 3-axis aircraft and weightshift aircraft: Pitch inputs change attitude on both weight shift & 3-axis aircraft, but with a weight shift aircraft the nose attitude in relation to the horizon remains nearly constant with different airspeeds, in a 3-axis aircraft the nose attitude in relation to the horizon changes with different airspeeds Ex 7. Climbing Aim: To enter and maintain a steady full-power-climb, and then return to level ight at a predetermined altitude. Also to enter and maintain a steady cruise-climb. Airmanship: Lookout Altimeter setting procedure Position of aircraft in relation to Airways etc Awareness of any blind spots Monitoring engine temperature Entry to climb: Power rst, then attitude adjustment (PAHT Power-Attitude-Hold-Trim) Combining power and attitude for performance Establishing and holding correct speed for climb Levelling off: Attitude rst, then power adjustment (AHPT Attitude-Hold-Power-Trim) Maintenance of selected altitude Effect of aps on climb, (if applicable): Effect on attitude and airspeed
27 July 2012
Maximum Angle of climb: Speed to achieve performance required Practical uses Maximum Rate of climb Speed to achieve performance required Practical uses Cruise climb Practical uses Ex 8. Descending Aim: To enter and maintain a steady glide-descent, then at a predetermined altitude, to return to level ight or climb. Also to enter and maintain a steady cruise-descent. Airmanship: Lookout Selection of clear airspace Altimeter setting procedure Regular application of power to ensure warm engine and clear plugs Awareness of blind spots Glide descent: Control of airspeed Speed for maximum glide range Speed for minimum sink Rate of descent/Angle of descent Use of aps (if applicable) Use of airbrakes (if applicable) Use of spoilers (if applicable) Use of tip draggers (if applicable) Entry to the descent: Coordination of power and attitude control. AHPT/ PAHT (depending on type) Levelling off Power and attitude together Effect of ap (where applicable): Effect on attitude and airspeed Control of angle of descent with constant airspeed Descent-to-climb-on-full-ap procedure Powered descent: Relationship between power and airspeed Control of rate of descent Control of angle of descent using visual reference point (as on nal approach) Cruise descent: Uses
27 July 2012
Sideslipping: Method of losing height Ex 9a. Medium level-turns up to 30 bank angles Aim: To enter and maintain a medium (up to approx 30 bank) turn whilst maintaining level ight, then to return to straight and level on a new heading. Airmanship: Instinctive lookout before turns Allowance for wind and maintaining knowledge of position Use of controls: Co-ordination and interaction during turns Use of pitch to control attitude for height Use of power to control airspeed Use of power Slipstream and torque effect relative to direction of turn Maintenance of attitude and balance: Co-ordination and balance through the turn Using structure of aircraft to provide datum during the turn Awareness of heading during the turn Use of visual reference points to ensure accurate rolling out of turns Ex 9b. Climbing and descending turns Aim: To enter and maintain a climb or descent whilst turning, or to enter and maintain a turn from a straight climb or a descent. Airmanship: Instinctive lookout before turns including above or below Allowance for wind and maintaining knowledge of position Use of controls: Co-ordination and interaction during turns Accurate speed and power control to control rate of climb or descent Slipstream and torque effect relative to direction of turn Maintenance of attitude and balance: Co-ordination and balance through the turn Using structure of aircraft to provide datum during the turn Awareness of heading during the turn Use of visual reference points to ensure accurate rolling out of turns Use of low bank angles during climbing turns, to maintain rate of climb ************************************************************************** Standard required at end of Phase 1. A reasonable level of competence in all general-ying skills **************************************************************************
27 July 2012
PHASE 2 Ex 10a. Slow ight. (Vs + 2mph and Vs + 5mph) Aim: To become familiar with the feel of the aircraft in slow ight just above the stall-speed, and to recognise the symptoms of the incipient stall, and to restore aircraft to safe ight before the stall occurs. Airmanship Lookout Checks to ensure safe operation through exercise ie: height/location etc Characteristics of slow speed ight: Control response Effect of slipstream and torque (where applicable) Angle of attack (high nose attitude for 3-Axis aircraft) Angle of attack (control bar well forward of hands-off position for weightshift aircraft) Wing dropping tendencies and difculty in maintaining wings level Extra emphasis on need to keep 3-axis aircraft in balance with use of rudder Extra emphasis on need for careful use of roll control Need for extra care when turning i.e. shallow angles of bank Ex 10b. Stalling Aim: To recognise and enter a fully-developed stall from various modes of ight both straight and turning, and then to recover with minimum height-loss to a safe ight mode. Also to recover to a safe ight mode at the incipient stall stage. Airmanship: Special attention to lookout - clearing turn to check rear Checks to ensure safe operation through exercise i.e.: height/location etc Principles and characteristics at the stall: Effectiveness of controls Inherent stability of aircraft at stall e.g. Washout Buffet and other indications e.g. Severe rearward bar pressure on weightshift aircraft Wing dropping tendencies and correct handling of controls i.e. dangers of using roll control to level wings at the point of stall. Factors affecting the stalling speed: Flaps (if applicable) Power Weight Load factor i.e. centrifugal force in steep turns Full Stall and recovery; (from straight ight level, climbing and descending) Use of controls Use of power (Recovery with and without the use of power) Full Stall and recovery; (from turning ight - 30 angle of bank - level, climbing and descending) Use of controls Use of power (recovery with and without the use of power)
27 July 2012 Section 5 Part A Subpart 2 Page 10
Stall and recovery at the incipient stage: Recovery during various attitudes and congurations Recovery during changing congurations Stalling at higher speed: Secondary stall g stall Ex 11. Spin awareness (if applicable) Aim: To understand and recognise the onset of situations which may lead to an inadvertent spin, and to learn how to instinctively take the necessary control actions to effect a recovery back to normal ight condition before a spin occurs, i.e. to recover the incipient stage. Airmanship: Special attention to lookout - clearing turn to check rear Checks to ensure safe operation through exercise ie: height/location etc. Causes of spin: Recognition of Incipient spin: Recovery from the incipient spin: Use of controls Danger of using ailerons at the incipient stage Effect of power and ap (ap restriction as applicable to type) Effect of centre of gravity on spin Recovery at the incipient stage from various attitudes and congurations ************************************************************************** Standard required at end of phase 2 Prior to circuit training, ability to control aircraft safely in slow ight just above the stall (Vs + 2mph) and able to recover to normal ight at incipient stall stage. Prior to solo ight, a very high standard of competence at recovering safely from fully developed stall and demonstrable ability to prevent aircraft getting into dangerous attitudes from all stall/spin-and-recovery manoeuvres. ************************************************************************** PHASE 3 Ex 12. Takeoff and climb to downwind position Aim: To safely take off and climb the aircraft to position on the downwind leg at circuit height. Also to land safely in the event of an engine failure after take off or at any time in the circuit, and to decide against and take appropriate action, if for some reason, continuation of the take off would be unsafe. Airmanship Pre take-off checks Planning for power failure on every take off Planning takeoff with regard to wake turbulence from other aircraft Planning takeoff with regard to areas of low level rotor/turbulence Drills during and after take off i.e. constant planning for an aborted takeoff, or a forced landing due to power failure on take off or in the circuit, and monitoring engine temperature during the climb
27 July 2012
Factors affecting the length of the takeoff roll and the initial climb: Use of power Correct lift-off speed Use of ight controls and techniques Wind: Nil-wind, Head-wind, Cross-wind Ground surface: Concrete, Grass (long/short/soft/hard/dry/wet) Ground gradient Weight - Altitude - Temperature - Humidity Maximum Angle of climb: Maximum Rate of climb: Undulating (rough eld) Premature lift-off and subsequent control Short and soft eld considerations: Tailwheel considerations (if applicable): Effect of aps (if applicable): Decision to use Effects of use Emergencies: Abandoned takeoff Engine failure after takeoff Engine failure in the circuit Ex 13. The circuit, nal approach and landing Aim: To y an accurate circuit and carry out a safe approach and landing. Airmanship Importance of constant lookout during circuit, and prior to turning to leg Downwind checks Planning approach and landing with regard to wake turbulence from aircraft landing ahead The downwind leg, base leg, nal approach positioning and drills: Factors affecting the nal approach (and landing run): Nil-wind, Head-wind, Cross-wind Correct approach speed Use of power Weight Flaps/spoilers (if applicable) Types of approach (and landing): Powered approach and landing Glide approach and landing Crosswind approach and landing Short eld approach and landing Soft eld approach and landing
27 July 2012
Flapless approach and landing (if applicable) Use of airbrakes and spoilers (if applicable) Missed approach and go-around: Correct positioning Missed landing and go-around: Effect of ground surface and gradient on the landing run: Tailwheel considerations (if applicable): Use of elevator: Safeguarding the nosewheel Use of brakes (if applicable): The Complete Take-off, Circuit and Landing: Circuit joining and leaving procedures The Hold-off period, and Touchdown: Ability to control height with pitch control, and airspeed with power Ability to control direction Ability to control and correct ballooning Ability to cope with crosswind Ground manoeuvring after landing ************************************************************************** Standard required at end of phase 3 Ability to take off safely and maintain the climb out safely given a variety of different circumstances. Ability to cope with emergencies at any point in the take-off, circuit, or landing phases of ight. Ability to approach and land safely given a variety of different circumstances. Demonstration of a high degree of airmanship and knowledge of aireld and circuit procedures and disciplines. ************************************************************************** PHASE 4 Ex 14. Advanced turning (up to 60 bank angles) Aim: To carry out a coordinated level turn at steep angles of bank and to recognise and recover from a spiral dive. Also entry and recovery from, and uses of a sideslipping turn (if applicable to type). Airmanship: Importance of lookout Importance of maintaining orientation Cockpit checks 360 turns: (up to 45 bank angle) Level / Climbing / Descending Wake turbulence Steep level-turns (up to 60 bank angle): Co-ordination Use of power
27 July 2012
Weightshift aircraft 270 turns only, to avoid own wake turbulence and possible student disorientation due to being forced into an unusual or dangerous attitude The spiral dive: If power applied reduce Recovery by use of roll and then pitch The sideslipping turn: Uses of Ex 15. Recognition of unusual attitudes; Prevention of dangerous conditions. Aim: To recognise and recover from unusual attitudes in order to prevent the aircraft entering dangerous conditions. Note: This exercise must not be practised solo by the student. Airmanship: HASELL checks Aircraft limits: (Refer to POH) Denition of Flight Envelope; Vne, Va, Vno, Vfe, Max bank, Max pitch, Max+ve and -ve G Dangers associated with exceeding aircrafts limits Weight shift aircraft the Tumble Need for inspection following ight outside envelope. Aircraft Stability Characteristics: Weightshift need to maintain +ve G Pitch-positive tendencies Roll Inertia. Possible causes of unusual attitudes: From inadvertent mishandling of controls at high speeds From inadvertent mishandling of controls in stall recovery in various congurations From inadvertent mishandling of controls in a steep turn From inadvertent mishandling controls following hitting own wake turbulence in a steep turn Severe meteorological turbulence. Loss of control following spatial disorientation. Deliberate manoeuvres outside the pilots ability. Recognition of Unusual Attitudes: Attitude in relation to horizon. Speed and Energy State. Instrument lag Recovery Techniques from: Nose high, wings level Nose high, wingsbanked Nose low, wings level, Nose low, wings banked
27 July 2012
Management of Controls during Simulation/Practice Need for smooth positive inputs, control of G Instructor to set up unusual attitude Handover/passing of control Motion Sickness Exercise to be terminated at onset. ************************************************************************** Standard required at end of phase 4 Ability to control aircraft safely at steep angles of bank, with correctly coordinated roll, pitch, and power. Ability to avoid the spiral dive and understand wake turbulence. Ability to use sideslipping usefully and safely. An understanding of unusual attitudes and dangerous conditions. The ability to recognise the onset of unusual attitudes and take instinctive recovery action to prevent a dangerous condition developing. ************************************************************************** PHASE 5 Ex 16a. Forced landings without and with power Aim: To carry out a safe descent, approach, and landing, in the event of the engine failing during ight, and to carry out a safe unplanned precautionary landing in an unfamiliar eld. Airmanship: Use of correct drills Correct handling and highly accurate speed control Forced landing procedure: Choice of landing area: Provision for change of plan Gliding distance considerations: The descent plan: Key position Engine failure checks The base leg: The nal approach: Methods of controlling glide angle S turns, beats, constant aspect, use of aps/spoilers and airspeed Precautionary landing with power: Inspection procedures Actions after landing: Aircraft security Ex 16b. Operation at minimum level. Aim: To safely operate the aircraft at heights lower than those normally used. Airmanship: Assessment of weather conditions/turbulence
27 July 2012
Assessment of height above terrain Compliance with low ying rules High level of awareness Low level of military aircraft Low level familiarisation: Actions prior to descending Visual impressions and height control at low altitudes Effects of wind, speed, and inertia during turns Effects of wind and turbulence Low level operation: Weather considerations Avoidance of precipitation Obstacle considerations Effects of precipitation: As applicable to type Joining circuit in poor weather, and bad-weather circuit ************************************************************************** Standard required at end of phase 5 Ability to choose a suitable safe area, and to set up a good approach to land following any unexpected power loss simulation. Ability to choose a suitable safe landing area, and to carry out a low pass to check suitability of surface prior to a simulated precautionary landing. Ability to y safely at minimum operational level, demonstrating a high degree of understanding of low-level turbulence and awareness of obstacles, together with ability to coordinate turns correctly with regard to wind direction. Acute awareness of dangers and rules associated with low ying, and consideration for noise, animals, etc. ************************************************************************** PHASE 6 Ex 17a. First solo Aim: To carry out a safe and accurate solo circuit, approach, and landing. Airmanship: Constant look out Faultless checks Ability to deal with all emergency drills First solo, short brieng required: Pilot should not hesitate to overshoot if in any doubt Differences in handling and performance when own solo Use of ballast
27 July 2012
Ex 17b. Solo circuit, local area, general ying consolidation. Aim: To practise and rene all the skills learned during the dual training , and to prepare for the General Skills Test. Airmanship: Review and application of all different aspects of airmanship General ying consolidation: Review and application of all different aspects of the general handling skills Circuit consolidation: Review and application of all different aspects of the take-off, circuit, approach and landing Local area consolidation: Aireld departure procedure Map reading and identication of local features Turning onto and maintaining heading by use of compass Circuit rejoining procedure Ex 17c. Dual revision for GST. Aim: To correct any errors or bad habits which may have developed during 17b and to check that no aspect of the training has been overlooked. Review of: All aspects of required standards of airmanship, general ying skills, knowledge of and practical application of ground subjects/procedures etc. prior to application for General Skills Test ************************************************************************** Standard required at end of phase 6 All general ying skills and airmanship to be up to GST standard. Also an adequate knowledge of aviation law, general meteorology, local weather, and ability to predict if conditions will remain suitable for continued ight. Also reasonable standard of map reading ability. ************************************************************************** MICROLIGHT NPPL COURSE FLIGHT TRAINING SYLLABUS PHASE 7 Ex 18. Pilot navigation Aim: To y accurately and safely in VMC and under VFR, a predetermined route, without infringing the rules governing regulated airspace. Airmanship: Pre-ight planning Planned cockpit management Adequate security of loose items Flight planning: NOTAMs Weather forecast and actual(s) for planned route Map selection and preparation Choice of route Tie-down equipment
27 July 2012 Section 5 Part A Subpart 2 Page 17
Calculations: Magnetic heading and times on route Fuel consumption Weight, balance and performance Aireld procedure on departure: Organisation of cockpit Altimeter setting Setting of heading Setting of time and noting of ETAs En-Route: Maintenance of altitudes and headings Revisions to ETA and heading Minimum weather conditions for ight to continue at any point In-ight decisions Navigation at minimum level Uncertain of position procedure Lost procedure Arrival at Destination procedure: Altimeter setting (QNH to aireld QFE) Aireld circuit and circuit joining procedure Parking procedure Security of aircraft: Note: A minimum total of 5 hours navigation ying training must be completed within the period of 9months immediately prior to licence application or an application to remove operational limitations from an existing licence. The required navigation ying training includesa minimum of 3 hours of solo navigation ying training to be completed within the 9 month period. The navigation ight training must include two solo qualifying cross-country ights. Eachsolo qualifying cross country ight must have a: minimum total ight distance of 40 nautical miles a landing at another site which is at least 15 nautical miles, measured in a straight line, from the take-off site at which the ight began The two solo qualifying cross-country ights must be own over different routes and to different sites. The navigation exercises would typically be spread over the following sessions, although it is not mandatory for any dual tuition for this part of the syllabus: 1 Dual cross country. (inc away landing) 2 Dual cross country. (inc navigation at minimum level, and lost procedure) 3 Solo cross country. (1st qualifying cross country) 4 Solo cross country. (2nd qualifying cross country) **************************************************************************
27 July 2012
Standard required at end of phase 7 Good navigational ability. Good ability to predict weather. High standard of airmanship. ************************************************************************** SUMMARY OF THE SYLLABUS FOR THE MICROLIGHT NPPL COURSE GROUND-SCHOOL TRAINING Principles of Flight Aviation Law Aviation Navigation Aviation Meteorology Airframes and Engines Aircraft Instruments Fire, First Aid, and Safety Equipment Human Performance Limitations MICROLIGHT NPPL COURSE GROUND-SCHOOL TRAINING SYLLABUS PRINCIPLES OF FLIGHT Physics and Mechanics: Speed, Velocity, Force Pressure - Bernoullis Principle Motion of a body along a curved path Aerofoils, Lift and Drag: Air Resistance and Air Density Aerofoil shapes Lift and Drag - Angle of Attack and Airspeed Distribution of lift, Centre of pressure Drag - Induced, Parasite - Form, Skin, Interference Lift/Drag Ratio and Aspect Ratio Flying Controls: The Three Axes - Vertical, Lateral, Longitudinal Yaw, Pitch, Roll Operation and Function of Elevators, Ailerons, Rudder Principles and Purpose of Mass, and Aerodynamic Balance Operation and Function of Trimming Controls Operation and Function of Flaps Operation and Function of Spoilers, Spoilerons, Tip Rudders Principles and Function of Canard conguration Principles and operation weightshift control systems Operation and function of billow shift Equilibrium: The Four Forces - Lift, Weight, Thrust, Drag Moments and Couples
27 July 2012
The Balance of the Four Forces Straight, Turning, Level, Climbing, Descending Stability: Positive, Neutral, Negative Lateral and Directional Stability 3Axis/Weightshift Longitudinal Stability 3Axis/Weightshift Relationship of C of G to Control in Pitch 3Axis/Weightshift Luff Lines on Weightshift aircraft Washout The Stall: Airow Separation Stalling Angle - Relationship to Airspeed Wing Loading Wing Loading increase with bank angle increase High Speed Stall The Spin: Causes of a spin Autorotation Effect of the C of G on spinning characteristics Turning Flight: The Forces in the Turn Load Factor and Manoeuvres: Denition of Load Factor - VN envelope Effect on Stalling Speed In-Flight Precautions Aircraft Performance: Power Curves Effect of Temperature and Density Range and Endurance Climbing Performance Rate of Climb Angle of Climb Take-off and Landing Performance Take-off Run Available Take-off Distance Available Landing Distance Available The Take-off and Initial Climb Performance Effect of: Wind Wind Gradient Wind Shear Weight
27 July 2012
Pressure, Altitude, Temperature and Density Ground Surface and Gradient Use of Flaps The Approach and Landing Performance Effect of: Wind Wind Gradient Wind Shear Use of Flaps Ground Effect Weight and Balance Limitations on Aircraft Weight Limitations in Relation to Aircraft Balance Weight and Centre of Gravity Calculations The Propeller Construction and Shape Maintenance and checks Balancing AVIATION LAW The Air Navigation Order: Classication of Aircraft Aircraft Documentation: Certicate of Registration Permit to Fly/Exemption Certicate Noise Certicate Flight Manual/Maintenance Schedules/Pilots Operating Handbook Airframe and Engine Logbook and Pilots responsibility to maintain and Record: Aircraft hours, inspections, defects, repairs, maintenance, and modications (mandatory and otherwise) Permits To Fly: BMAA Guide to Airworthiness Document Non-expiring Permit to Fly and Certicate of Validity Conditions applying to Permit to Fly Failure to Comply with the Requirements or Conditions of the Permit to Fly or Exemption Certicate Application of Flight/Owners Manual and Pilots Operating Handbooks to the Permit to Fly Requirements for Maintenance and Inspections Overhaul, Repair, Replacement and Modications to Aircraft or Equipment Aircraft Equipment: ANO As detailed in applicable Schedule Equipment Required in Relation to the Circumstances of Flight
27 July 2012
Aircraft Radio Equipment: ANO As detailed in applicable Schedule Certicate of Approval of Aircraft Radio Installation Flight Radio Operators Licence Aircraft Weight Schedule: Legal Requirements in Relation to the Permit to Fly Grant and Renewal of Licences to Members of Flight Crew: Conditions of issue Privileges of the National Private Pilots Licence: Student Pilot Privileges Medical Certication Ground Examinations and Flight Test Medical Certicate - Renewal Private Pilot Privileges (With and Without Operational Limitations) Minimum Weather Provisions Ratings Conditions of Issue: Privileges of the Aircraft Rating Additional Ratings Licences and Ratings Renewal: Certicate of Revalidation achieved by Test or Experience Period of Validity Flying Hour Requirements Personal Flying Log: Requirements to Maintain Personal Details Particulars of Flight Recording of Dual, Solo, Cross Country Flight Times Recording of Flight Tests Instructors Endorsements of Flight Times Instruction in Flying: Denition of Flying Instruction Requirement for Flying Instruction to be given Pre-ight Action by Commander of Aircraft: Dropping of Persons or Articles: Carriage of Munitions: Carriage of Dangerous Goods: Endangering Safety of Aircraft: Endangering Safety of Persons or Property: By intent By Neglect
27 July 2012
Drunkenness in Aircraft: Application to Passengers Application to Flight Crew. Legal maximum alcohol levels Smoking in Aircraft: Notices in Aircraft Authority of Commander of Aircraft: Legal requirements to Obey all Lawful Commands Exhibitions of Flying: Public Displays Private Events Documents to be Carried: On Domestic Flights On International Flights Production of Documents and Records: Requirements of Commander Requirements of Operator Requirements of Flight Crew Personal Flying Log Books Revocation, Suspension or Variation of Certicates, Licences, or other Documents: Whilst Pending Enquiry or After Enquiry Surrender of Documents Invalidation of Documents Due to Breach of Conditions Offences in Relation to Documents and Records: Unauthorised use of Documents Alteration, Mutilation, or Destruction of Documents or Records Entries in Log Books or Records Incorrect Entries - Wilfully or Negligently Unauthorised Issue of Certicates Aerodromes Instruction in Flying: The Recommendations for Basic minima as proposed by the BMAA Permission and Purpose of Use Power to Prevent Aircraft Flying: Air Trafc Rules and Services: Division of Airspace in the UK: Controlled Airspace Control Zones Control Areas Terminal Control Areas Airways Advisory Airspace
27 July 2012
Military Aerodrome Trafc Zones Civil Aerodrome Trafc Zones Classication of Airspace: The seven classes of airspace VMC, IMC and Notication: Conditions for VFR Flight (VMC) Conditions for IFR Flight (IMC) Quadrantal Rule Semi-Circular Rule Special VFR Flight Types of Air Trafc Service Units: NOTAMs The UK Air Pilot Air Trafc Centres Zone Control Units Aerodrome Control Units Radar Facilities Altimeter Setting Procedures: Terrain Clearance Flight Separation Flight Levels Transition Level Transition Layer Transition Altitude Flight at Aerodromes: Aerodrome Trafc Zone Lights and Pyrotechnic Signals Ground Signals Used at Civil Aerodromes Marshalling Signals Flight Plans: Flight Information Regions and Services: Flight in Control Zones, Control Areas and Terminal Control Areas: Flight on Airways: Flight on Advisory Routes/Service Areas: AIRPROX Reporting Procedures: Airspace Restrictions and Hazards: Danger Areas Prohibited and Restricted Areas Military Flight Training Areas Bird Sanctuaries
27 July 2012
High Intensity Radio Transmission Areas Additional Hazards to Aircraft in Flight Gliding Sites/Hang Gliding Sites Free Fall Parachute Areas Military Air Exercises Flying Displays, Air Races, Etc. Navigational Obstructions Royal Flights: Aerodromes AIS Information: Civil Aerodromes Military Aerodromes Aerodrome Ground Lights Identication Beacons Aerodrome Beacons Times of Operation Meteorology: Source of Information Requests for Route Forecasts Facilitation Customs and Public Health: Arrival, Departure, and Transit of Civil Aircraft on International Flights Customs Aerodromes Private Flights - Documentary Requirements Customs Requirements Public Health Requirements Search and Rescue: Responsibility and Organisation Aircraft not Equipped with Radio Visual Distress and Urgency Signals Procedures and Signals Employed by Rescue Aircraft Search and Rescue Regions and Facilities Warning Signals to Aircraft in Flight: Extracts from the Rules of the Air Trafc Control Regulations: Interpretation Application of Rules to Aircraft Reporting Hazardous Conditions Low Flying Simulated Instrument Flight Lights or Other Signals to be shown or made by Aircraft Display of Lights by Aircraft Failure of Navigation Lights
27 July 2012
General Flight Rules: Weather Reports and Forecasts Rules for Avoiding Aerial Collisions Aerobatic Manoeuvres Right Hand Trafc Rule Notication of Arrival Flight in Notied Airspace Choice of VFR or IFR Aerodrome Trafc Rules: Application Visual Signals Access to and Movement on the Manoeuvring Area Right of Way on the Ground Dropping of Tow Ropes Aerodromes not having ATC Units Special Rules for Certain Aerodromes Wake Turbulence Separation Flight Safety and Accident/incident Reporting: Extracts from: The Civil Aviation (Investigation of Air Accidents) Regulations: The Civil Navigation (Investigation of Air Accidents Involving Civil and Military or Installations) Regulations: Authorities requiring immediate notication by telephone Conrmation in writing and use of correct written form only BMAA Safety and Accident Investigation Handbook Flight Safety Issued Quarterly by the General Aviation Safety Council (GASCo) AAIB Bulletins Pink Aeronautical Information Circulars NAVIGATION Form of the Earth: Meridians of Longitude Parallels of Latitude Rhumb Lines Magnetic Variation: Compass Deviation: Principles of Navigation: IAS, Wind, Heading, Groundspeed The Triangle of Velocities Flight computers
27 July 2012
Maps and Charts: Practical Use of 1:500,000 and 1:250,000 Series Importance of using Current Charts Chart Scale Measurement of Distance and Heights Units of Distance Units of Height Conversion of Units (Distance and Height) Measurement of Angles, Tracks and Bearings Relationship to True, Magnetic and Compass North Map Reference Information: Latitude and Longitude Isogonals Topography Relief Hydrographical Features Cultural Features Aeronautical Symbols Aeronautical Information Map Reading: Map Analysis Permanent Features Relief Line Features Spot Features Unique or Special Features Features Subject to Change Water Other Effects of Seasons Preparation: Checkpoint Features and Selection Folding the Map for use Methods of Map Reading: Map Orientation Anticipation of Checkpoints With Continuous Visual Contact With Restricted Visual Contact When Uncertain of Position
27 July 2012
Flight Planning: Selection of Charts Plotting the Route Selection of Altitude/s and Safety Altitude Use of the Chart of UK Airspace Restrictions Danger Areas Prohibited/Restricted Areas Military Flight Training Areas Bird Sanctuaries High Intensity Radio Transmission Areas Additional Hazards to Aircraft in Flight NOTAMs and Aeronautical Information Bulletins Civil Aeronautical information circulars Local Time / Greenwich Mean Time / UTC Weather Forecasts and Reports: Minimum Weather Conditions Acceptable to Safety General Aviation Visual Flight Forecast Service Aerodrome Forecasts and Reports Local Telephone General Weather Forecast Local Radio/TV General Weather Forecast Practical Navigation: Compilation of the Flight Log Measurement of Tracks Determining Safety Altitude Calculating Heading, True and Magnetic, Groundspeed, Distance, Time, Fuel Consumption, Fuel Required Departure Procedures Booking Out Estimated Time of Arrival Setting heading Procedures Altimeter Setting Procedures Maintenance of Altitude and Heading Establishing Position Revisions to Heading The 1:60 and Closing Angle Methods of Heading Correction The use of Drift Lines En Route Checks Uncertainty of Position Procedure Lost Procedures Arrival Procedures Altimeter Setting Procedures Booking in
27 July 2012
AVIATION METEOROLOGY The Atmosphere: Composition and Structure Air density Pressure: Air has weight Effect of altitude Effect on density Measurement Barometers. Aneroid and Mercurial Mean Seal Level (MSL)-Conversion for height Isobars Pressure systems - Depression - Trough - Col - Anticyclone - Ridge The Altimeter: Principle Pressure settings (QNH, QFE, Regional PS, Standard) Wind: Horizontal motion of the atmosphere Effect of Earths rotation Relation of wind to isobars. Surface friction. Geostrophic Local winds. Sea breeze, off shore Thermal winds Katabatic/Anabatic Effect of terrain. Surface geography, Surface objects, Rotor Standing waves Wind gradient Wind shear Temperature: Source of Earths heat Effect on density Adiabatic cooling/heating Lapse rates. Environmental ELR Adiabatic - dry and wet (saturated) Effect of height on saturated adiabatic lapse rate Humidity: Water vapour Moisture content Relative Humidity Effect of temperature
27 July 2012
Dew point temperature Effect on density Air Masses: Source and types Transformation Fronts Warm Cold Occlusion Clouds: Classication of Clouds. High/Medium/Low Types of Clouds. Stratiform, Cumiliform Names of Clouds Formation of Cloud: Air cooling to Dew Point Mixing vertical motion of atmosphere Convection stability and instability Orographic Frontal Precipitation: Rain/drizzle/hail/sleet/snow Depressions: Origin Development Frontal depression Visibility: Measurement Haze Mist Fog - Radiation/Advection Ice Accretion on Aircraft: Conditions required for ice formation Types of airframe icing Hoar frost Rime ice Clear ice Effects of icing on aircraft performance Carburettor icing Effects of Weather on Flight: Effect on an altimeter en route in proximity to a depression
27 July 2012
Effect of turbulence low level under cumulus Hazards of ight through depressions and fronts Hazards of ight in reduced visibility haze precipitation Effect on visibility related to the suns position ahead or behind Flight in proximity of large Cu and Cb Cloud line squalls Effect on surface wind direction of large Cu and Cb cloud Potential hazard of a snow/ice coating on a parked aeroplane Potential hazard of a clear evening sky in autumn/winter fog, frost AIRFRAMES AND ENGINES Aircraft Structure: Airframe Wing The Controls The Trimming System Tuning Aircraft Tyres. Wear, Bulges, Cuts, Scores Aircraft Seats Baggage Stowage Position Maximum Weights allowed Engine: Principles of two stroke cycle Principles of four stroke cycle Engine Ignition System: Principles The Ignition Switch/es Use of Correct Spark Plugs Spark Gap Replacement Intervals Spark Plug Security Carburettors: Principles Setting for the Correct Mixture Recognising the Wrong Mixture Exhaust Systems: Difference between Two-stroke and Four-stroke systems Checks for security, cracks, and internal integrity Servicing: Intervals
27 July 2012
Oil System: Correct mixing of Two-stroke Oil/Petrol Four stroke oil system Fuel System: Fuel Pump Fuel Filters Fuel Grade Water in Fuel Electrical System: Generators Batteries Propeller: Defects Balancing Reduction Drive: Belt Tension Alignment Defects Maintenance procedures Aircraft Instruments: Airspeed Indicator: Position Errors Altimeter: Magnetic Compass: Precautions when carrying Ferrous Objects Turning, acceleration, Deceleration errors Engine Instruments: Temperature Gauges - CHT - EGT - Water RPM Counter FIRE, FIRST AID, AND SAFETY EQUIPMENT Fire, Dangers and Precautions: Fire Extinguishers Fire in Flight Fire on the Ground Fuel Storage, Fuel Mixing, Refuelling Smoking First Aid: Procedures following an accident Fractured or Broken Limbs Severe Bleeding
27 July 2012
Head Injuries Severe Shock Burns First Aid Kits - Stowage HUMAN PERFORMANCE LIMITATIONS Introduction: Reasons for Knowledge of HPL Oxygen: Relation to the atmosphere, to altitude Effects of reduced intake Hypoxia: Location Timing Effects and acceleration of same Hyperventilation: Causes and effects Avoidance Barotrauma: Causes and effects Avoidance Common Ailments: Effects Medication Decompression: Underwater effects Relationship to ying Air Sickness: Causes Medication Environment Hearing: Noise limits Effects Precautions Sight: Correction of defects Toxic Hazards: Sources Effects Smoking
27 July 2012
Blood Pressure: Control Alcohol/Drugs: Problems Effects Control Legal Limits Knowledge and the Senses: Knowledge Perception Action Environment Disorientation: Causes Effect Result Avoiding the AIRPROX: Assessment Relative speeds Look-out Actions Problems Stress: Forms The individual Outside inuences Management of Stress: Danger of drugs Mutual discussion Experience Social Psychology: The Ego factor Potential reactions Control Hypothermia: Causes Recognition Preparation for eventuality
27 July 2012
2.3
Revalidation
NOTE 1: Schedule 7 of the Air Navigation Order 2009 species that a Microlight rating on a UK PPL shall be revalidated by experience in accordance with the 5 hours in 13 months arrangements. However, the CAA has issued a general exemption to allow the holder of a UK PPL(A) to maintain such a rating in accordance with the NPPL requirements set out in this section (12 hours in 24 months) as if the rating were associated with an NPPL. It is intended that this exemption will remain in place until at least April 2012. NOTE 2: Schedule 7 of the Air Navigation Order 2009 species that a Microlight rating on a UK BCPL(A), CPL(A) or ATPL(A) shall be revalidated by experience in accordance with the requirements set out in this section; (i.e. the 12 hours in 24 months cycle). However, the CAA has issued a general exemption to allow the holder of a UK BCPL(A), CPL(A) or ATPL(A) who obtained their Microlight rating prior to 1st February 2008 to continue to re-validate that rating using the 5 in 13 months system as set out in Case A Section1 of Part C of Schedule 7 i.e. in the same manner as for the microlight aeroplane class rating on a UK PPL(A). It is intended that this exemption will remain in place until at least April 2012.
27 July 2012
Appendix 1
SECTION 1 GENERAL
Introduction Holders of a National Private Pilots Licence (NPPL(A)) with either a Simple Single Engine Aeroplane (SSEA), Self Launching Motor Glider (SLMG), or Microlight Aeroplane Class Rating who are in current ying practice may count ying experience towards the minimum requirements for other Class Ratings, as described in Sections 2, 3 and 4 below. Holders of other current or lapsed pilot licences may also apply for an NPPL(A) with appropriate Class Rating(s) in accordance with the accreditation specied in the section relevant to the Class Rating sought. Credit may also be given for other ying training experience. Each section refers to the requirements for obtaining a particular Class Rating, and also includes relevant credits for previous ying training. In order to keep each section specic to the Rating, a certain amount of repetition is allowed for the sake of clarity. The sections are as follows: This information is consistent with NPLG website cross credit document Revision 10. Section 2. Cross-crediting licences and ratings to NPPL(A) with SSEA Class Rating. Section 3. Cross-crediting licences and ratings to NPPL(A) with SLMG Class Rating. Section 4. Cross-crediting licences and ratings to NPPL(A) with Microlight Class Rating. Skill tests GST and NST refer to the General Skill Test and Navigation Skill Test applicable to NPPL(A) Class Ratings. Under each list of requirements, the GST must be the nal requirement to be met before application for an NPPL is made; the GST must have been completed in the 6 months before the date of application. Theoretical knowledge examinations The theoretical knowledge examinations (ground examinations) referred to in Sections 2, 3 and 4 are those specically applicable to the aircraft rating in question. In the case of the NPPL(A) (SSEA) or NPPL(A)(SLMG) the Part-FCL PPL (A) theoretical knowledge examinations shall be used. For the NPPL(A) (Microlight) the existing UK Microlight examinations shall be used pending the possible future introduction of alternative theoretical knowledge examinations specic to each aircraft rating. Medical certicates Either an NPPL Medical Declaration or a Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate is acceptable, but it should be noted that the periods of validity for each are different.
Validity periods
All theoretical knowledge examinations required under specic cross-crediting terms must have been passed in the 24 months before application is made for the new licence or rating.
Where accreditation is granted to holders of existing licences or ratings, such licences or ratings must have been valid in the 12 months before application is made for the new licence or rating.
30 January 2013
May 2012
a) The minimum requirement of 10 hours solo must be own in a single-engine piston aeroplane for the grant of an NPPL(A) with SSEA Class Rating; b) The minimum requirement of 32 hours of ying instruction required for the NPPL(A) may consist of a combination of Microlight and SSEA training; c) The whole of the navigation training required for the NPPL(A) with SSEA Class Rating must be completed. 2.1.3 UK PPL (Gyroplane) to NPPL(A) (SSEA) The holder of a valid UK PPL(G) who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) with SSEA Class Rating shall: a) produce the PPL(G); b) produce logbook evidence of currency on Gyroplane aircraft; c) carry out such SSEA conversion training as is judged necessary by the FI(A) or CRI(SPA) conducting the training to achieve the required standard for the applicant to take the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SSEA. This training must include: i) not less than 1 hour of dual instrument appreciation; ii) 2 hours stall awareness/spin avoidance training. d) pass the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examination in Aircraft (General) and Principles of Flight; e) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; f) pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SSEA. 2.1.4 CAA-issued Helicopter Licence to NPPL(A) (SSEA) The holder of a valid CAA-issued Helicopter licence who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) with SSEA Class Rating shall: a) produce the CAA-issued Part-FCL Pilot Licence (Helicopters) or UK PPL(H); b) produce logbook evidence of currency on helicopter aircraft; c) carry out such SSEA conversion training as is judged necessary by the FI(A) or CRI(SPA) conducting the training to achieve the required standard for the applicant to take the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SSEA. This training must include: i) not less than 1 hour of dual instrument appreciation; ii) 2 hours stall awareness/spin avoidance training. d) pass the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examinations in Aircraft (General) and Principles of Flight; e) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; f) pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SSEA. 2.1.5 BGA Glider Pilots Licence to NPPL(A) (SSEA) The holder of a valid BGA Glider Pilots Licence who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) with SSEA Class Rating shall: a) produce the BGA Glider Pilots Licence;
May 2012
b) produce log book evidence of having satisfactorily completed not less than 10hours ying training on single-engine piston aeroplanes under the supervision of an FI(A), which must include: i) not less than 1 hour dual instruction in stall/spin awareness and avoidance; ii) not less than 1 hour dual instrument appreciation; iii) not less than 1 hour supervised solo ight. c) pass the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examinations; d) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; e) pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SSEA. 2.1.6 Holder of ATC Instructors Qualication to NPPL(A) (SSEA) 2.1.6.1 The holder of the ATC Instructors Qualication valid for the Viking Glider who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) with SSEA Class Rating shall: a) produce log book evidence of having satisfactorily completed ying training on single-engine piston aeroplanes under the supervision of a FI(A), which must include: i) not less than 1 hour dual instruction in instrument appreciation; ii) not less than 4 hours dual instruction for a Category A or B Instructor, or not less than 10 hours dual instruction for a Category C Instructor, to include 2 hours stall awareness/spin avoidance training, practice forced landings without power and practice engine failure after take-off; iii) not less than 6 hours ying as PIC for a Category A or B Instructor, or not less than 10 hours for a Category C Instructor, which must include 4 hours cross-country ying. b) pass the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examinations; c) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or JAA Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; d) pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SSEA. 2.1.6.2 The holder of the ATC Instructors Qualication valid for the Vigilant Motor Glider who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) with SSEA Class Rating shall: a) produce log book evidence of having satisfactorily completed ying training on single-engine piston aeroplanes under the supervision of a FI(A), which must include: i) not less than 1 hour dual instruction in stall/spin awareness and avoidance; ii) not less than 1 hour dual instrument appreciation; iii) not less than 1 hour supervised solo ight; iv) not less than 4 hours navigation training or successful completion of the Air Cadet Vigilant Transit Qualication training syllabus, including at least one solo cross-country navigation exercise; b) pass the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examinations; c) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; d) pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SSEA.
30 January 2013
2.1.7
2.1.7.1 An applicant for the NPPL(A) with SSEA Class Rating shall be given appropriate accreditation for any theoretical and ying training and ying experience gained during military service. A Medical Ofcer in HM Forces who is included in the register of GPs maintained by the GMC may, in certain circumstances, countersign an NPPL Medical Declaration. Flying Training. Any previous ying training on Single Engine Piston (Land) aeroplanes conducted by an FI(A) or current Qualied Flying Instructor (QFI) may be counted towards the 32 hour minima of ying training and consolidation required before the applicant may take the NST and GST required for the grant of an NPPL(A) with SSEA Class Rating. This may include: a) Service Flying Scholarship ying. b) Elementary Flying Training (EFT) ying. c) University Air Squadron (UAS) ying. d) Service Pilots under training. e) Service Pilots withdrawn from ying training. 2.1.7.2 All hours must be properly logged and certied by the Chief Flying Instructor or Commanding Ofcer as appropriate. Applicants must ensure that each individual exercise requirement is fully met. Military or ex-military pilots shall receive the following specic accreditation: a) A Qualied Military Pilot (QMP) who has, in the 24 month period preceding the date of application for licence issue, own a minimum of 12 hours as Pilot of Single Engine Piston aeroplanes, including not less than 8 hours as Pilot in Command and not less than 1 hour of ying training with a current QFI or FI(A) and who has own a minimum of 6 hours as Pilot of Single Engine Piston aeroplanes in the 12 months before the date of application for licence issue shall be credited the requirement to pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST. b) A QMP who has not been current on any military aircraft in the 24 month period preceding the date of application for licence issue shall be credited the requirement to pass the NPPL(A) NST. c) A QMP who has not been current on any military aircraft in the 5 year period preceding the date of application for licence issue shall be credited the requirement to pass the NPPL(A) NST. The applicant shall undergo a course of training on single-engine piston aeroplanes as specied by an FI(A) before passing the NPPL(A) GST in an SSEA. 2.1.7.3 Theoretical Knowledge Qualied Military Aircrew in current ying practice, dened as a minimum of 12 hours ying experience as a pilot in military or civil aeroplanes (or combination of both) in the 24 months preceding the date of application for licence issue, shall receive the following specic accreditation: a) A current QMP who holds or has held any Operational Category or CFS QFI / QHI Category, shall be credited all theoretical examination requirements with the exception of the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examination in Aviation Law and Operational Procedures. b) A current QMP(A) shall be credited the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examinations in Navigation and Radio Aids, Meteorology, Aircraft (General) and Principles of Flight and Flight Performance and Planning.
30 January 2013
c) A current QMP(H), current Qualied Military Navigator or Observer shall be credited the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examinations in Navigation and Radio Aids, Meteorology and Flight Performance and Planning. d) A current Qualied Military Air Engineer shall be credited the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examination in Aircraft (General) and Principles of Flight. e) All current Military Service Pilots, Navigators, Observers and Air Engineers who have completed the appropriate single-service Aviation Medicine and Crew Resource Management courses shall be credited the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examination in Human Performance. f) All current Qualied Military Pilots and those current Qualied Military Navigators or Observers who are qualied as normal ight crew members of single pilot aircraft shall be credited the RTF Practical Test. In order to add FRTOL privileges to an NPPL, unless they hold or have held any Operational Category or CFS QFI / QHI Category, they will be required to pass the Part-FCL Communications (PPL) theoretical examination. 2.1.7.4 Elementary Flying Training School Graduates Pilots who have graduated from Service EFTS courses shall receive the following accreditation towards the issue of an NPPL(A) with SSEA Class Rating: a) EFTS Graduates presented with a full accreditation course completion certicate (annotated with a Green Border) shall be credited all the NPPL(A)ying training and theoretical knowledge requirements. b) EFTS Graduates presented with a partial course completion certicate (annotated with a Yellow Border) shall be credited only the elements completed during EFT training and will be required to complete the remaining elements to qualify for licence issue. c) An EFTS Graduate who has passed the EFTS Final Handling Test and who has, in the 24 month period preceding the date of application for licence issue, own a minimum of 12 hours as Pilot of Single Engine Piston aeroplanes, including not less than 8 hours as Pilot in Command and not less than 1 hour of ying training with a current QFI or FI(A) and who has own a minimum of 6 hours as Pilot of Single Engine Piston aeroplanes in the 12 months before the date of application for licence issue shall be credited the requirement to pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST. d) All EFTS Graduates wishing to add FRTOL privileges to an NPPL shall pass the PartFCL Communications (PPL) theoretical examination and the RTF Practical Test. 2.1.7.5 University Air Squadron Flying Training Pilots who have received formal ying training at a UAS shall receive full accreditation for such ying training. No accreditation will be given for air experience ying conducted by pilots who are neither current QFIs nor holders of civil pilot licences containing valid FI(A) Ratings. 2.1.7.6 CAA-issued Aeroplane licences with a valid SEP rating to NPPL (SSEA) The holder of a valid CAA-issued Part-FCL Pilot Licence (Aeroplanes) or UK PPL (A) with SEP class rating who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) (SSEA) shall: a) produce the CAA-issued Pilot Licence (Aeroplanes) or UK PPL(A); b) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate.
30 January 2013
It should be noted that any additional ratings attached to the CAA-issued Part-FCL Pilot Licence (Aeroplanes) or UK PPL(A), such as the Night Qualication or Rating, IMC or FI(A) Rating are not transferable to an NPPL(A) (SSEA) and the holders privileges will be restricted accordingly. 2.2 Pilots with expired licences or ratings Credit shall be given for holders of expired CAA-issued Pilot Licences for Aeroplanes or ratings as follows: a) Where an SEP class rating included in such licences has expired by not more than 5 years, the licence holder shall hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate and pass the NPPL(A) GST in an SSEA. b) Where an SEP class rating included in such licences has expired by more than 5years, the licence holder shall undergo a course of SSEA refresher ying training as specied by an FI(A) or CRI(SPA), hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or PartMED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate and pass the NPPL(A) GST in an SSEA. The licence holder shall also pass an oral theoretical knowledge examination conducted by the authorised examiner as part of the GST. 2.3 Non-UK licences a) The holder of any licence issued by an ICAO Contracting State who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) with SSEA Class Rating should contact the NPPL(A) (SSEA) assistance advisers for advice on the specic requirements for licence conversion. These requirements will be determined by the holders current experience and will be assessed individually. The applicant shall also pass the Part-FCL PPL(A) Air Law and Operational Procedures and Human Performance examinations prior to passing the NPPL NST and GST in an SSEA. However, holders of such licences which are current and valid in all respects who have own a minimum of 100 hours as pilot of aeroplanes shall be credited the NPPL(A) NST if they have also own a minimum of 5 hours PIC cross-country ight time in UK airspace in the 12 months prior to the date of licence application. b) Credit may be given for training on SSEA aircraft conducted in an ICAO Contracting State which has not been fully completed; applicants seeking credit for such training should contact the NPPL(A) (SSEA) assistance advisers. Applicants will be required to produce a certicated statement from the non-UK training provider in order for such previous training to be credited. 2.4 Incomplete SLMG, Microlight and/or ATC/CCF training Credit may be given for training on SLMG and/or Microlight aircraft which has not been fully completed; applicants seeking credit for such training should contact the NPPL(A) (SSEA) assistance advisers. Credit may also be given for ATC/CCF ying training conducted on the Vigilant TMG. All accreditation requirements will be determined by the applicants current experience and will be assessed individually. The applicant will be required to complete the minimum instructional training hours for the NPPL(A) (SSEA), to pass the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical knowledge examinations and to pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SSEA.
May 2012
May 2012
a) The minimum of 10 hours solo must be own in a self-launching motor glider for the grant of an NPPL(A) with SLMG Class Rating; b) The minimum requirement of 32 hours of ying instruction required for the NPPL(A) may consist of a combination of Microlight and SLMG training; c) The whole of the navigation training required for the NPPL(A) with SLMG Class Rating must be completed. 3.1.3 UK PPL (Gyroplane) to NPPL(A) (SLMG) The holder of a valid UK PPL(G) who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) with SLMG Class Rating shall: a) produce the PPL(G); b) produce logbook evidence of currency on Gyroplane aircraft; c) carry out such SLMG conversion training as is judged necessary by the SLMG Instructor conducting the training to achieve the required standard for the applicant to take the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SLMG. This training must include: i) not less than 1 hour of dual instrument appreciation; ii) 2 hours stall awareness/spin avoidance training. d) pass the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examination in Aircraft (General) and Principles of Flight; e) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; f) pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SLMG. 3.1.4 CAA-issued Helicopter licence to NPPL(A) (SLMG) The holder of a valid CAA-issued Helicopter licence who wishes to obtain an NPPL with SLMG Class Rating shall: a) produce the CAA-issued Helicopter licence; b) produce logbook evidence of currency on helicopters; c) carry out such SLMG conversion training as is judged necessary by the SLMG Instructor conducting the training to achieve the required standard for the applicant to take the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SLMG. This training must include: i) not less than 1 hour of dual instrument appreciation; ii) 2 hours stall awareness/spin avoidance training; d) pass the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examination in Aircraft (General) and Principles of Flight; e) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; f) pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SLMG. 3.1.5 BGA Glider Pilots Licence to NPPL(A) (SLMG) The holder of a valid BGA Glider Pilots Licence who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) with SLMG Class Rating shall: a) produce the BGA Glider Pilots Licence;
30 January 2013
b) produce log book evidence of having satisfactorily completed not less than 10 hours ying training in a self-launching motor glider under the supervision of an SLMG Instructor, which must include: i) not less than 1 hour dual instruction in stall/spin awareness and avoidance; ii) not less than 1 hour dual instrument appreciation; iii) not less than 1 hour supervised solo ight. c) pass the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examinations; d) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; e) pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SLMG. 3.1.6 Holder of ATC Instructors Qualication to NPPL(SLMG) 3.1.6.1 The holder of the ATC Instructors Qualication valid for the Viking Glider who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) with SLMG Class Rating shall: a) produce log book evidence of having satisfactorily completed ying training in a selflaunching motor glider under the supervision of an SLMG Instructor, which must include: i) not less than 1 hour dual instruction in instrument appreciation; ii) not less than 4 hours dual instruction for a Category A or B Instructor, or 10hours for a Category C Instructor, to include 2 hours stall awareness/spin avoidance training, practice forced landings without power and practice engine failure after take-off; iii) not less than 6 hours ying as PIC for a Category A or B Instructor, or 10 hours for a Category C Instructor, which must include 4 hours cross-country ying; b) pass the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examinations; c) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; d) pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SLMG. 3.1.6.2 The holder of the ATC Instructors Qualication valid for the Vigilant Motor Glider who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) with SLMG Class Rating shall: a) produce log book evidence of having satisfactorily completed ying training in a selflaunching motor glider under the supervision of an SLMG Instructor, which must include: i) not less than 1 hour dual instruction in stall/spin awareness and avoidance; ii) not less than 1 hour dual instrument appreciation; iii) not less than 1 hour supervised solo ight; iv) not less than 4 hours navigation training or successful completion of the Air Cadet Vigilant Transit Qualication training syllabus, including at least one solo cross-country navigation exercise; b) pass the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examinations; c) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; d) pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SLMG.
May 2012
3.1.7
Military training towards NPPL(A) (SLMG) An applicant for the NPPL(A) with SLMG Class Rating shall be given appropriate accreditation for any theoretical and ying training and ying experience gained during military service. A Medical Ofcer in HM Forces who is included in the register of GPs maintained by the GMC may, in certain circumstances, countersign an NPPL Medical Declaration.
3.1.7.1 Flying Training Any previous ying training on self-launching motor gliders conducted by an SLMG Instructor may be counted towards the 32 hour minima of ying training and consolidation required before the applicant may take the NST and GST required for the grant of an NPPL(A) with SLMG Class Rating. All hours must be properly logged and certied by the Chief Flying Instructor or Commanding Ofcer as appropriate. Applicants must ensure that each individual exercise requirement is fully met. Military or ex-military pilots shall receive the following specic accreditation: a) A Qualied Military Pilot (QMP) who has, in the 24 month period preceding the date of application for licence issue, own a minimum of 12 hours as Pilot of Single Engine Piston aeroplanes, including not less than 8 hours as Pilot in Command and not less than 1 hour of ying training with a current QFI or FI(A) and who has own a minimum of 6 hours as Pilot of Single Engine Piston aeroplanes in the 12 months before the date of application for licence issue shall be credited the requirement to pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST, but shall produce log book evidence of having satisfactorily completed conversion training with an SLMG Instructor on selflaunching motor gliders. b) A QMP who has not been current on any military aircraft in the 24 month period preceding the date of application for licence issue shall be credited the requirement to pass the NPPL(A) NST but shall produce log book evidence of having satisfactorily completed conversion training with an SLMG Instructor on self-launching motor gliders. c) A QMP who has not been current on any military aircraft in the 5 year period preceding the date of application for licence issue shall be credited the requirement to pass the NPPL(A) NST. The applicant shall undergo a course of training on self-launching motor gliders as specied by an SLMG Instructor before passing the NPPL(A) GST in an SLMG. 3.1.7.2 Theoretical Knowledge Qualied Military Aircrew in current ying practice, dened as a minimum of 12 hours ying experience as a pilot in military or civil aeroplanes (or combination of both) in the 24 months preceding the date of application for licence issue, shall receive the following specic accreditation: a) A current QMP, who holds or has held any Operational Category or CFS QFI / QHI Category, shall be credited all theoretical examination requirements with the exception of the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examination in Aviation Law and Operational Procedures. b) A current QMP(A) shall be credited the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examinations in Navigation and Radio Aids, Meteorology, Aircraft (General) and Principles of Flight and Flight Performance and Planning. c) A current QMP(H), current Qualied Service Navigator or Observer shall be credited the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examinations in Navigation and Radio Aids, Meteorology and Flight Performance and Planning.
30 January 2013
d) A current Qualied Military Air Engineer shall be credited the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examination in Aircraft (General) and Principles of Flight. e) All current Qualied Military Pilots, Navigators, Observers and Air Engineers who have completed the appropriate single-service Aviation Medicine and Crew Resource Management courses shall be credited the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examination in Human Performance. f) All current Qualied Military Pilots and those current Qualied Military Navigators or Observers who are qualied as normal ight crew members of single pilot aircraft shall be credited the RTF Practical Test. In order to add FRTOL privileges to an NPPL(A), unless they hold or have held any Operational Category or CFS QFI / QHI Category, they will be required to pass the Part-FCL Communications (PPL) theoretical examination. 3.1.7.3 Elementary Flying Training School Graduates Pilots who have graduated from Service EFTS courses shall receive the following accreditation towards the issue of an NPPL with SLMG Class Rating: a) EFTS Graduates presented with a full accreditation course completion certicate (annotated with a Green Border) shall be credited all the NPPL(A) ying training and theoretical knowledge requirements but shall produce logbook evidence of having satisfactorily completed conversion training with an SLMG Instructor on selflaunching motor gliders. b) EFTS Graduates presented with a partial course completion certicate (annotated with a Yellow Border) shall be credited only the elements completed during EFT training and will be required to complete the remaining elements to qualify for licence issue including conversion training with an SLMG Instructor on self-launching motor gliders. c) An EFTS Graduate who has passed the EFTS Final Handling Test and who has, in the 24 month period preceding the date of application for licence issue, own a minimum of 12 hours as Pilot of Single Engine Piston aeroplanes, including not less than 8 hours as Pilot in Command and not less than 1 hour of ying training with a current QFI or FI(A) and who has own a minimum of 6 hours as Pilot of Single Engine Piston aeroplanes in the 12 months before the date of application for licence issue, shall be credited the requirement to pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST. d) All EFTS Graduates wishing to add FRTOL privileges to an NPPL shall pass the PartFCL Communications (PPL) Examination and the RTF Practical Test. 3.1.7.4 University Air Squadron Flying Training Pilots who have received formal ying training at a UAS shall receive full accreditation for such ying training. No accreditation will be given for air experience ying conducted by pilots who are neither current QFIs nor holders of civil pilot licences containing valid FI(A) Ratings. 3.1.8 CAA-issued Part-FCL Pilot Licence (Aeroplanes) with TMG Class Rating or UK PPL(A) SLMG to NPPL(A) (SLMG) The holder of a valid CAA-issued Part-FCL Pilot Licence (Aeroplanes) with TMG Class Rating or UK PPL(A) SLMG who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) (SLMG) shall: a) produce the CAA-issued Part-FCL Pilot Licence (Aeroplanes) or UK PPL(A); b) hold a valid NPPL medical declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate. It should be noted that the holders privileges will be restricted to NPPL(A) privileges only.
30 January 2013 Section 5 Part A Appendix 1 Page 12
3.2
Pilots with expired licences or ratings Credit shall be given for holders of expired CAA-issued Part-FCL Pilot Licence (Aeroplanes) and UK PPL(A) licences or ratings as follows: a) Where a TMG class rating or SLMG privileges included in such licences has expired by not more than 5 years, the licence holder shall hold a valid NPPL medical declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate and pass the NPPL GST in an SLMG. b) Where a TMG class rating or SLMG privileges included in such licences has expired by more than 5 years, the licence holder shall undergo a course of training in a selflaunching motor glider as specied by an SLMG Instructor, hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate and pass the NPPL GST in an SLMG. The licence holder shall also pass an oral theoretical knowledge examination conducted by the authorised examiner as part of the GST.
3.3
Non-UK licences a) The holder of any licence issued by an ICAO Contracting State who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) with SLMG Class Rating should contact the NPPL(A) (SLMG) assistance advisers for advice on the specic requirements for licence conversion. These requirements will be determined by the holders current experience and will be assessed individually. The applicant shall also pass the Part-FCL PPL(A) theoretical examinations in Air Law and Operational Procedures and Human Performance prior to passing the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SLMG. However, holders of such licences which are current and valid in all respects who have own a minimum of 100 hours as pilot of aeroplanes shall be credited the NPPL(A) NST if they have also own a minimum of 5 hours PIC cross-country ight time in UK airspace in the 12 months prior to the date of licence application. b) Credit may be given for training on SLMG or TMG aircraft conducted in an ICAO Contracting State which has not been fully completed; applicants seeking credit for such training should contact the NPPL(A) (SLMG) assistance advisers. Applicants will be required to produce a certicated statement from the non-UK training provider in order for such previous training to be credited.
3.4
Incomplete SEP, SSEA, Microlight and/or ATC/CCF training Credit may be given for training on SEP, SSEA and/or Microlight aircraft which has not been fully completed; applicants seeking credit for such training should contact the NPPL(A) (SLMG) assistance advisers. Credit may also be given for ATC/CCF ying training conducted on the Vigilant TMG. All accreditation requirements will be determined by the applicants current experience and will be assessed individually. The applicant will be required to complete the minimum instructional training hours for the NPPL(A) (SLMG), to pass the Part--FCL PPL(A) theoretical examinations and to pass the NPPL(A) NST and GST in an SLMG.
May 2012
May 2012
c) pass the Microlight Aeroplanes Type (Part 2) oral examination conducted by a Microlight ight examiner. The examination shall include pilot maintenance requirements and conditions of the Permit to Fly; d) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; e) pass the NPPL(A) GST in a Microlight. 4.1.5 BGA Glider Pilots Licence to NPPL(A) (Microlight) The holder of a valid BGA Glider Pilots Licence who wishes to obtain a NPPL(A) with Microlight Class Rating shall: a) produce the BGA Glider Pilots Licence; b) produce log book evidence of 5 ights as PIC of gliders within the 9 months prior to licence application; c) produce log book evidence of having satisfactorily completed not less than 15hours conversion training in Microlight aircraft under the supervision of a Microlight FI, which must include: i) not less than 6 hours supervised solo ight; ii) not less than 5 hours navigation training, to include not less than 3 hours solo navigation including one qualifying cross-country ight as dened in the NPPL(A) (Microlight) syllabus d) pass the Microlight theoretical knowledge examinations; e) pass the Microlight Aeroplanes Type (Part 2) oral examination conducted by a Microlight ight examiner. The examination shall include pilot maintenance requirements and conditions of the Permit to Fly; f) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; g) pass the NPPL(A) GST in a Microlight. 4.1.6 ATC Instructors Qualication to NPPL(A) (Microlight) The holder of the ATC Instructors qualication wishing to obtain an NPPL(A) with Microlight Class Rating shall: a) produce log book evidence of having satisfactorily completed not less than 15hours conversion training in Microlight aircraft under the supervision of a Microlight FI, which must include: i) not less than 6 hours supervised solo ight; ii) not less than 5 hours navigation training, to include not less than 3 hours solo navigation including one qualifying cross-country ight as dened in the NPPL(A) (Microlight) syllabus; b) pass the Microlight theoretical knowledge examinations; c) pass the Microlight Aeroplanes Type (Part 2) oral examination conducted by a Microlight ight examiner. The examination shall include pilot maintenance requirements and conditions of the Permit to Fly; d) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; e) pass the NPPL(A) GST in a Microlight.
May 2012
4.1.7
4.1.7.1 An applicant for the NPPL(A) with Microlight Class Rating shall be given appropriate accreditation for any theoretical and ying training and ying experience gained during military service. A Medical Ofcer in HM Forces who is included in the register of GPs maintained by the GMC may, in certain circumstances, countersign an NPPL Medical Declaration. 4.1.7.2 Flying Training. Any previous ying training on Single Engine Piston (Land) aeroplanes conducted by an FI(A) or current Qualied Flying Instructor (QFI) may be counted towards the 25 hour minima of ying training and consolidation required before the applicant may take the GST required for the grant of an NPPL(A) with Microlight Class Rating. This may include: a) Service Flying Scholarship ying. b) Elementary Flying Training (EFT) ying. c) University Air Squadron (UAS) ying. d) Service Pilots under training. e) Service Pilots withdrawn from ying training. 4.1.7.3 All hours must be properly logged and certied by the Chief Flying Instructor or Commanding Ofcer as appropriate. Applicants must ensure that each individual exercise requirement is fully met. Military or ex-military pilots shall receive the following specic accreditation: a) A Qualied Military Pilot (QMP) who has been current on any military aircraft in the 5 year period preceding the date of application for licence issue shall pass the NPPL(A) GST in a Microlight. The applicant shall also pass the Microlight Aeroplanes Type (Part 2) oral examination conducted by the authorised examiner as part of the GST; this examination shall include pilot maintenance requirements and conditions of the Permit to Fly. b) A QMP who has not been current on any military aircraft in the 5 year period preceding the date of application for licence issue shall undergo a course of training on Microlight aircraft as specied by a Microlight FI before passing the NPPL(A) GST in a Microlight. The applicant shall also pass the Microlight Aeroplanes Type (Part 2) oral examination conducted by the authorised examiner as part of the GST; this examination shall include pilot maintenance requirements and conditions of the Permit to Fly. 4.1.7.4 Theoretical Knowledge Qualied Service Aircrew in current ying practice, dened as a minimum of 12 hours ying experience as a pilot in military or civil aeroplanes (or combination of both) in the 24 months preceding the date of application for licence issue, shall receive the following specic accreditation: a) A current QMP, who holds or has held any Operational Category or CFS QFI / QHI Category, shall be credited all theoretical examination requirements with the exception of the Microlight theoretical knowledge examination in Aviation Law, Flight Rules and Procedures and the Microlight Aeroplanes Type (Part 2) oral examination. b) A current QMP(A) shall be credited the Microlight theoretical examinations in Navigation, Meteorology and Aircraft General (Part 1).
30 January 2013
c) A current QMP(H), current Qualied Military Navigator or Observer shall be credited the Microlight theoretical examinations in Navigation and Meteorology. d) A current Qualied Military Air Engineer shall be credited the Microlight theoretical examination in Aircraft General (Part 1). e) All current Qualied Military Pilots, Navigators, Observers and Air Engineers who have completed the appropriate single-service Aviation Medicine and Crew Resource Management courses will be credited the Microlight theoretical examination in Human Performance and Limitations. f) All current Qualied Military Pilots and those current Qualied Military Navigators or Observers who are qualied as normal ight crew members of single pilot aircraft shall be credited the RTF Practical Test. In order to add FRTOL privileges to an NPPL, unless they hold or have held any Operational Category or CFS QFI / QHI Category, they will be required to pass the Part-FCL Communications (PPL) theoretical examination. 4.1.7.5 Elementary Flying Training School Graduates Pilots who have graduated from Service EFTS courses shall receive the following accreditation towards the issue of a NPPL(A) with Microlight Class Rating: a) EFTS Graduates presented with a full accreditation course completion certicate (annotated with a Green Border) will be credited all the NPPL(A) ying training and theoretical knowledge requirements but shall produce logbook evidence of having satisfactorily completed conversion training with a Microlight FI on Microlight aircraft before passing the NPPL(A) GST in a Microlight. The applicant shall also pass the Microlight Aeroplanes Type (Part 2) oral examination conducted by the authorised examiner as part of the GST; this examination shall include pilot maintenance requirements and conditions of the Permit to Fly. b) EFTS Graduates presented with a partial course completion certicate (annotated with a Yellow Border) will be credited only the elements completed during EFT training and will be required to complete the remaining elements to qualify for licence issue including conversion training with a Microlight FI on Microlight aircraft before passing the NPPL(A) GST in a Microlight. The applicant shall also pass the Microlight Aeroplanes Type (Part 2) oral examination conducted by the authorised examiner as part of the GST; this examination shall include pilot maintenance requirements and conditions of the Permit to Fly. c) All EFTS Graduates wishing to add FRTOL privileges to an NPPL(A) shall pass the Part-FCL Communications (PPL) Examination and the RTF Practical Test. 4.1.7.6 University Air Squadron Flying Training Pilots who have received formal ying training at a UAS shall receive full accreditation for such ying training. No accreditation will be given for air experience ying conducted by pilots who are neither current QFIs nor holders of civil pilot licences containing valid FI(A) Ratings. 4.1.8 Powered Parachute, Powered Hang Glider, Hang Glider or Paraglider experience to NPPL(A) (Microlight) The holder of a PPL (Powered Parachute), a British Hang Gliding and Paragliding Association Pilot Rating (or higher), BMAA or BHPA Powered Hang Glider FLM Rating who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) (Microlight) shall: a) produce log book evidence of having completed 5 ights as PIC of a powered parachute, powered hang glider, hang glider or paraglider in the 9 months prior to licence application;
30 January 2013 Section 5 Part A Appendix 1 Page 17
b) for applicants for the NPPL(A) (Microlight) with operational limits, produce log book evidence of having satisfactorily completed ying training in Microlight aircraft under the supervision of a Microlight FI including training exercises as dened in the NPPL(A) (Microlight) syllabus, which must include: i) not less than 5 hours training, including: ii) not less than 3 hours supervised solo ight in the 9 months prior to licence application; c) for applicants for the NPPL(A) (Microlight) without operational limits, produce log book evidence of having satisfactorily completed ying training in Microlight aircraft under the supervision of a Microlight FI including training exercises as dened in the NPPL (Microlight) syllabus, which must include: i) not less than 15 hours training, including: (1) not less than 6 hours supervised solo ight in the 9 months prior to licence application; (2) not less than 3 hours solo navigation in the 9 months prior to licence application including the qualifying cross-country ight as dened in the NPPL(A) (Microlight) syllabus; d) pass the following Microlight theoretical knowledge examinations: i) Holders of UK PPL (Powered Parachute) shall pass the Microlight theoretical examination in Aircraft General (Part 1); ii) Holders of British Hang Gliding and Paraglider Association or BMAA Powered Hang Glider FLM Pilot ratings shall pass all Microlight theoretical examinations; e) pass the Microlight Aeroplanes Type (Part 2) oral examination conducted by a Microlight ight examiner. The examination shall include pilot maintenance requirements and conditions of the Permit to Fly; f) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; g) pass the NPPL(A) (Microlight) GST. 4.1.9 Self Propelled Hang Glider or Foot Launched Microlight experience to NPPL(A) (Microlight) (Powered Parachute) The holder of a BMAA or BHPA Self Propelled Hang Glider or Foot Launched Microlight Pilot Rating who wishes to obtain an NPPL(A) (Microlight) (Powered Parachute) shall: a) produce log book or log sheet evidence of having completed at least 5 hours experience on foot launched SPHG or FLM aircraft in the 12 months prior to licence application; b) hold a current BMAA or BHPA SPHG/FLM Pilot Rating; c) complete the following ight training: i) For applicants for the NPPL(A) (Microlight) (Powered Parachute) with Operational Limitations, complete ight training of not less than 2 hours on Powered Parachutes under the supervision of an instructor authorised to conduct training for the NPPL(A) (Microlight) (Powered Parachute), to include: (1) not less than 1 hour solo PIC within the 9 months before licence application;
May 2012
(2) not less than 15 take-offs and full stop landings, of which 6 must be solo PIC own within the 9 months before licence application; ii) For applicants for the NPPL(A) (Microlight) (Powered Parachute) without Operational Limitations, complete ight training of not less than 5 hours on Powered Parachutes under the supervision of an instructor authorised to conduct training for the NPPL(A) (Microlight) (Powered Parachute), to include: (1) not less than 5 hours solo PIC within the 9 months before licence application; (2) not less than 15 take-offs and full stop landings, of which 6 must be solo PIC own within the 9 months before licence application. (3) Navigation training, to include: (aa) not less than 2 hours solo PIC within the 9 months before licence application, including one cross-country ight of at least 25 nautical miles during which the applicant landed at least one other site not less than 10 nautical miles from the site of departure; d) within the 12 months before licence application, pass the Microlight theoretical knowledge examinations in Aviation Law (Microlight), Human Performance and Limitations, Navigation, Meteorology and Aircraft General (Powered Parachutes); e) within the 9 months before licence application, pass the oral examination in Aircraft Type (Powered Parachutes); f) hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate; g) pass a Powered Parachute Flight Test with an Examiner authorised to conduct tests on Powered Parachutes. 4.2 Pilots with expired licences or ratings Credit shall be given for holders of expired CAA-issued Part-FCL Pilot Licence (Aeroplanes) and UK PPL(A) licences or ratings as follows: a) Where a Microlight class rating or Microlight privileges included in such licences has expired by not more than 5 years, the licence holder shall hold a valid NPPL medical declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate and pass the NPPL(A) GST in a Microlight. b) Where a Microlight class rating or Microlight privileges included in such licences has expired by more than 5 years, the licence holder shall undergo a course of training in a Microlight aircraft as specied by a Microlight FI, hold a valid NPPL Medical Declaration or Part-MED Class 1, 2 or LAPL medical certicate and pass the NPPL(A) GST in a Microlight. The licence holder shall also pass an oral theoretical knowledge examination conducted by the authorised examiner as part of the GST. 4.3 Non-UK licences The holder of any licence issued by an ICAO Contracting State who wishes to obtain a NPPL(A) (Microlight) should write to the BMAA for advice on the specic requirements for licence conversion. These requirements will be determined by the holders current experience and will be assessed individually. The applicant shall also pass the Microlight theoretical examinations in Aviation Law, Flight Rules and Procedures and Human Performance and Limitations before passing the NPPL(A) GST in a Microlight. The applicant shall also pass the Microlight Aeroplanes Type (Part2) oral examination conducted by the authorised examiner as part of the GST; this examination shall include pilot maintenance requirements and conditions of the Permit to Fly.
30 January 2013
4.4 4.4.1
Incomplete SEP, SSEA, SLMG and/or ATC/CCF training Credit towards the grant of an NPPL with Microlight Class Rating may be given for ight training on other classes of aircraft. A maximum of 10 hrs credit will be given for any such training conducted with an authorised UK ight instructor; applicants seeking credit for other ight training should contact the BMAA for advice. a) Applicants for a Microlight Class Rating without Operational Limitations shall pass the Microlight theoretical knowledge examinations, including the Microlight Aeroplanes Type (Part 2) oral examination conducted by a Microlight ight examiner and complete not less than 25 hours total ight training, to include the following ight training on Microlight aircraft: i) not less than 5 hours of navigation training with an authorised Microlight instructor in the 9 months before licence application; ii) not less than 10 hours solo under the supervision of an authorised Microlight instructor in the 9 months before licence application, to include: (1) 3 hours navigation; (2) 2 qualifying cross-country ights as dened in the NPPL Microlight Syllabus; iii) Pass the NPPL GST. b) Applicants for a Microlight Class Rating with Operational Limitations shall pass the Microlight theoretical knowledge examinations, including the Microlight Aeroplanes Type (Part 2) oral examination conducted by a Microlight ight examiner and complete not less than 15 hours total ight training, to include the following ight training on Microlight aircraft: i) Not less than 7 hours solo under the supervision of an authorised Microlight instructor in the 9 months before licence application; ii) Pass the NPPL GST.
4.4.2
Credit towards the Microlight theoretical knowledge examinations may be given for NPPL(A) or PPL theoretical knowledge examinations in the following subjects which the applicant has passed in the 24 months before licence application: a) Human Performance and Limitations. b) Navigation and Radio Aids. c) Meteorology.
May 2012
Part B
UK Private Pilot Licences (PPL) for Aeroplanes, Balloons and Airships, Gyroplanes, Helicopters and Unmanned Aircraft
UK PPL(A) Aeroplanes
Subpart 1
No Supplementary information.
May 2012
Subpart 2
1 Applicability
The holder of a UK PPL(BA) may exercise the privileges of the licence to y non-EASA balloons or airships, as applicable, registered in the UK, that come within the privileges of the licence and the valid ratings included in the licence.
2 Privileges
The privileges and conditions of the UK PPL (BA) are as dened in Part A of Schedule7 to the ANO, refer to CAP 804 Section 7, Part B: For this purpose, the types of balloon or airships are: a) Free Balloons Hot Air Filled b) Free Balloons Gas Filled Netless c) Free Balloons Gas Filled Netted d) Free Balloons Combination Gas/Hot Air Filled e) Hot Air Airships Pressurised (up to 160,000 CuFt/4550 CuM Volume) f) Hot Air Airships Un-pressurised (up to 160,000 CuFt/4550 CuM Volume) g) Gas Airships Pressurised (up to 160,000 CuFt/4550 CuM Volume) When a UK PPL(BA) is issued, it will be endorsed with a Day Flying Only restriction. (For removal of this restriction, please refer to the Night Flying section). Airship ratings can only be obtained and endorsed onto an existing PPL(BA) licence. (Please refer to paragraph 3.9 for full details).
3 Requirements
3.1 Minimum Age 3.2 Licence Validity 3.3 Non-UK Licence Holders 3.4 UK PPL(BA) Flying Training/Experience Requirements 3.5 UK PPL(BA) Ground Examination Requirements 3.6 UK PPL(BA) Flight Test Requirements 3.7 UK PPL(BA) Medical Requirements 3.8 UK PPL(BA) Re-validation Requirements 3.9 Additional Balloon or Hot-Air Airship Rating 3.10 UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence (FRTOL) Requirements Applicants for and holders of the UK PPL(BA) shall hold a Part-MED Class 1, Class 2 or LAPL medical certicate or hold a Medical declaration. EASA Airship Licences Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA PPL(As) to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA airships.
May 2012
EASA Balloon Licences Article 62(5) of the ANO renders the EASA LAPL(B) and BPL to be a valid licence with the same privileges for non-EASA balloons. 3.1 3.2 Minimum Age Applicants for the PPL(BA) for balloons and airships shall be at least 17 years of age; Licence Validity The UK PPL(BA) will be issued with a lifetime validity but for the privileges conferred by it to be exercised the pilot must have a current Part-MED Medical Certicate or a Medical Declaration and a valid Aircraft Rating. 3.3 Non-UK Licence Holders Any credits or exemptions against training for holders of a non-UK Pilots Licence or equivalent privileges for balloons are indicated at the relevant section. Applicants for conversion to a UK PPL(BA) must obtain a valid Part-MED Medical Certicate or UK National PPL Medical Declaration. 3.4 3.4.1 UK PPL(BA) Flying Training/Experience Requirements For PPL(BA) Issue with a Free Balloons Hot Air Filled Rating: An applicant for a UK PPL(BA) shall produce evidence of having satisfactorily completed a course of training to a syllabus recognised by the Authority, within the 24 months preceding the date of application for the licence. Flying hours by day under instruction in hot air lled balloons must include: a) not less than 16 hours total ying time to cover the syllabus of training detailed in Part II, Section 5, Part B, Subpart 2; and b) 6 ascents by day under the instruction of a licensed balloon pilot of which 4 ascents must be made under the instruction of a BBAC instructor. In addition to the above, applicants must complete: c) 1 solo ascent by day of not less than 30 minutes duration under the supervision of a CAA appointed examiner or delegated instructor (to be completed within the 6 months preceding licence application); and d) 1 tethered ight. 3.4.2 For PPL(BA) Issue with a Free Balloon Gas Filled Rating: An applicant for a UK PPL(BA) shall produce evidence of having satisfactorily completed a course of training to a syllabus recognised by the Authority, within the 24 months preceding the date of application for the licence. Flying hours by day under instruction in gas balloons must include: a) not less than 16 hours total ying time to cover the syllabus of training detailed in Part II, Section 5, Part B, Subpart 2; 6 ascents by day under the instruction of a licensed Gas Balloon pilot of which 4 ascents must be made under the instruction of a BBAC Gas Balloon Instructor or CAA appointed Gas Balloon Examiner. NOTE: The PPL(BA) will be rated for netless or netted gas lled balloons according to the type in which the training and ight test is completed.
May 2012
3.4.3
Credits for Non-UK Licence Holders: Logbook evidence that the applicant has met the above minimum ying experience for a PPL(BA) issue with a Free Balloons Hot Air Filled Rating or a Free Balloons Gas Filled Rating as appropriate must be provided.
3.4.4
Night Flying: Free Balloons Hot Air Filled: Where an applicant wishes to exercise the licence privileges by night in hot air balloons, the following additional training must be completed: 2 night ights, each of which shall include a night take-off and subsequent night operation of not less than 1 hours duration under the supervision of a licensed hot air lled balloon pilot whose licence is not limited to day ying only. Free Balloons Gas Filled: Where an applicant wishes to exercise the licence privileges by night in gas lled balloons, the following additional training must be completed: 2 periods of night operation of not less than 1 hours duration, which may be completed in 2 ights or a single ight spanning 2 nights under the supervision of a licensed gas lled balloon pilot whose licence is not limited to day ying only.
3.5
UK PPL(BA) Ground Examination Requirements An applicant for a UK PPL(BA) is required to pass written examinations in the following subjects: 1. Aviation Law, Flight Rules and Procedures 2. Human Performance and Limitations 3. Navigation 4. Meteorology 5. Airmanship and Balloon Systems (for Hot-air Balloons only) 6. Airmanship and Aerostatics (for Gas-lled Balloons only) The syllabus for subjects 1, 2, 3, and 4 is the same as for the CPL(B) (see Part II, Section 5, Part C). The syllabus for subjects 5 and 6 is maintained by the BBAC Senior Examiner, and a copy may be obtained from the club on request. The examinations are written multiple-choice papers and are normally conducted under the auspices of a Balloon or Airship Examiner. The above examinations are valid for licence issue for 24 months from the date of passing. Candidates must obtain not less than 70% in each subject to pass. Credits from Ground Examinations The holder of a valid UK or Part-FCL Private or Professional Pilots Licence for any category of aircraft is credited the examinations in Aviation Law, Flight Rules and Procedures, Meteorology and, if already passed, Human Performance and Limitations. Holders of a valid non-UK ICAO Annex I compliant Private or Professional Pilots Licence (Balloons) issued by an ICAO Contracting State (an ICAO balloon pilots licence) are credited the examinations in Navigation, Meteorology, Airmanship and Balloon Systems.
May 2012
3.6
UK PPL(BA) Flight Test Requirements An applicant for a UK PPL(BA) shall pass a Flight Test in a hot air lled or gas lled balloon as appropriate with, or supervised by, a CAA Authorised Balloon Examiner. The Flight Test is valid for licence issue for 9 months from the date of passing. NOTE: Where the balloon used can carry only one person, the ight test is carried out under the supervision of the Examiner. There is no requirement for a further solo ight. The licence will be restricted to solo ying only, until a further test is passed in a balloon designed for multiple occupancy. It is not essential to complete the test in one ight, but the whole test must be passed in a 28 day period. Credits from Flight Test: The holder of a non-UK balloon licence who has completed 5 ascents as pilot-incommand on a similar balloon type in the last 13 months will be credited with a pass for the ight test. DETAILS OF THE UK PPL(BA) FLIGHT TEST ARE GIVEN IN PART II, SECTION 5, PART B, SUBPART 2.
3.7
UK PPL(BA) Medical Requirements An applicant for a UK PPL(BA) shall hold a valid Part-MED Medical Certicate or UK National PPL medical declaration. For full details please refer to Section 4, Part N. Applicants are strongly advised to ensure that they meet the appropriate medical standard before embarking on a course of training.
3.8
UK PPL(BA) Re-validation Requirements The minimum ying experience required to maintain balloon ratings in the licence is 5 ascents, each of at least 5 minutes duration, as PIC within the previous 13 months, or satisfactorily passing the Flight Test as detailed in Part II, Section 5, Part B, Subpart2. A pilot who has not met the requirement specied above to maintain the rating but wishes to qualify for a further 13 months ying must either, pass a balloon test, or undertake the balance of the required ascents as PIC with a BBAC instructor. If the period since the last ight own as Pilot-in-Command exceeds 4 years the pilot must apply to the CAA through the BBAC Senior Examiner for an assessment of the amount of dual and solo ying to be undertaken, and pass the skill test to revalidate a balloon rating in the licence.
3.9 3.9.1
Additional Balloon or Hot-Air Airship Rating Addition of a Free Balloons Hot Air Filled Rating: The holder of a PPL(BA) wishing to add a Hot Air Filled Balloon Rating to the licence shall comply with the following requirements: a) Undergo 5 hours ying training on hot air lled balloons to include 3 ascents with a person entitled to give such training to cover the syllabus of training detailed in Part II, Section 5, Part B, Subpart 2; b) Undertake a supervised solo ight; c) Pass a Flight Test as detailed in Part II, Section 5, Part B, Subpart 2 in a hot air lled balloon conducted by CAA Authorised Examiner; and d) Pass the Airmanship and Balloon Systems Ground Examination.
May 2012
3.9.2
Addition of a Free Balloons Gas Filled Rating: Ratings are available for netted gas balloons and netless gas balloons. Conversion training may be on either type. The holder of a PPL(BA) wishing to add a Gas Filled Balloon Rating to the licence shall comply with the following requirements: a) Have achieved at least 50 hours experience as Pilot-in-Command of hot-air balloons; b) Undergo at least 10 hours ying training on gas lled balloons under the instruction of a BBAC Gas Balloon Instructor or CAA appointed Gas Balloon Examiner to cover the syllabus of training detailed in Part II, Section 5, Part B, Subpart 2 which must include not less than two ascents, one of which may be the ight test; c) Pass a Flight Test as detailed in Part II, Section 5, Part B, Subpart 2 in a gas balloon conducted by CAA Authorised Examiner; and d) Pass the Airmanship and Aerostatics Ground Examination. The holder of a gas balloon rating of one type (netted or netless) may add the other type (netted or netless) by: e) Passing an oral examination on the technical knowledge and operation and differences between netted and netless gas balloons conducted by the authorised examiner; and f) Having a practical demonstration of the envelope rigging and operation of the valve prior to take-off.
3.9.3
Addition of a Hot-Air Airship Rating (either Pressurised or Unpressurised): The holder of a PPL(BA) wishing to add a Hot-Air Airship Rating to the licence shall comply with the following requirements: a) Have achieved at least 5 hours experience as Pilot-in-Command of hot-air balloons; b) Undergo at least 5 hours ying training on a hot-air airship to include at least 3 hours dual instruction, and one supervised solo ight; c) Pass a Flight Test in a hot-air airship conducted by a CAA Authorised Examiner, followed by a qualifying solo ight; and d) Pass the Aircraft Technical examination conducted by the authorised examiner. This takes the form of an oral test on the technical differences between the hot-air balloon and the hot-air airship (either pressurised or unpressurised). NOTE: Where both the pressurised and unpressurised ratings are required the requirements shall be complied with separately for both pressurised and unpressurised hot-air airships.
3.9.4 3.10
Addition of a Gas Airship Rating: Requirements for the addition of a Gas Airship Rating have not yet been developed. UK Flight Radiotelephony Operators Licence (FRTOL) Requirements Although an FRTOL is not a mandatory requirement for the issue of a UK PPL(BA), applicants who intend to operate radiotelephony equipment will require an FRTOL. FRTOL requirements are contained in Section 6.
May 2012
Subpart 3
UK PPL(G) Gyroplanes
May 2012
Subpart 4
UK PPL(H) Helicopters
No supplementary information
May 2012
Subpart 5
May 2012
Part C
UK Commercial Pilot Licence (CPL) for Aeroplanes, Balloons and Airships, Gyroplanes, Helicopters and Unmanned Aircraft
UK CPL(A) Aeroplanes
Subpart 1
No supplementary information.
May 2012
Subpart 2
1
1.1
General Flight Test (Day) Content The content of the GFT has been expanded in detail to give applicants guidance as to the skills and knowledge they will be expected to demonstrate during the test. In addition to the specic items detailed, applicants will be required to demonstrate their knowledge of, and adherence to the guidelines for balloon ying agreed with the National Farmers Union (NFU). Whilst these guidelines do not form part of the test, the examiner, as pilot-in-command of the balloon during the test, has overall responsibility for the conduct of the ight and may curtail the test at his discretion unless the NFU guidelines are being followed without just cause, i.e. in an emergency. Flight Test Pass Conditions A fail in any one section of Sections 1, 2, 3 and 4 will require a re-test of that section except that in all re-tests Section 1 will be re-assessed whether or not it was a re-test item. Also, in the event of a failure in Section 3 or Section 4 then both sections will be re-assessed. A failure in Section 2 and in Section 3 or Section 4 will require a re-test of all four sections. A failure to obtain a pass in all four sections within a series of 3 attempts will invalidate that series and all four sections will have to be taken at the next attempt as for the initial test. General Flight Test Results. Period of Validity A pass in all four sections of the GFT within a series must be obtained within the 6months immediately preceding the date of receipt by CAA of the licence application.
1.3 1.3.1
1.3.2
1.4
Flight Test Arrangements The ight test will be conducted by a Flight Examiner employed by the CAA or by an examiner who has been authorised for the purpose by the CAA. Applicants will be required to make their own arrangements for the ight test. The applicant will be required to provide a suitable balloon for the ight test. Where the ight test is conducted by an examiner employed by the CAA, the statutory charge published in the CAA Personnel Licensing Scheme of Charges available on the CAA web site www.caa.co.uk/ors5 must be paid in advance by post or in person to the CAA, PLD at Aviation House, Gatwick or, by agreement at the time of making the arrangements for the test, to the examiner. Where the ight test is conducted by an examiner approved for the purpose by the CAA, the payment and scale of charges must be agreed between the examiner and the applicant.
1.5.4
May 2012
1.6
General Flying Test (Day) Section 1 1.0 Pre-ight 1.1 Preparation for ight 1.2 Pre-ination 1.3 Ination Section 2 2.0 Tethered Flight 2.1 Pre-ination 2.2 Ination 2.3 Tethered ight 2.4 Emergencies 2.5 Fuel Management Section 3 3.0 General Handling 3.1 Take off 3.2 Level Flight 3.3 Climb 3.4 Descent 3.5 Approaches 3.6 Emergencies 3.7 Landing 3.8 Action after ight 3.9 Fuel Management 3.10 ATC liaison Section 4 4.0 Navigation 4.1 Weather assessment 4.2 Use of maps, charts etc. 4.3 ATC Liaison 4.4 Position Fixing 4.5 Fuel Planning 4.6 Airmanship
1.7
Expanded Syllabus Section 1 Pre-Flight 1.1 Preparation For Flight a) Documentation i) Aircraft logbook ii) C of A iii) C of R iv) ARC and C of M Review v) Medical Certicate
May 2012
vi) Crew Licence vii) Radio Licence (where applicable) viii) Aircraft Flight Manual ix) Load Sheet b) Weather i) Weather Limitations ii) Meteorological actual and forecast conditions for proposed ight iii) Weather Suitability c) Selection of Launch Site i) Hazards to ination ii) Field conditions iii) Downwind obstructions d) Equipment Check i) Maps, charts ii) Pencil, scale, etc. iii) Timepiece iv) Means to assess track angles v) Gloves vi) Sources of Ignition (Matches, Striker etc.) e) Load Calculations i) Load calculations as specied in Aircraft Flight Manual ii) Load Sheet f) Flight Planning i) Pre-Flight Planning and Map Preparation ii) Airspace information (Danger, Prohibited, Restricted areas, ATZ, SRZ etc.) iii) Endurance iv) Altimeter settings (Actual and Forecast QNH) v) ATS frequencies (where applicable) vi) Retrieve information vii) Fuel Calculations 1.2 Pre-Ination a) Layout Considerations i) Position of balloon ii) Position of vehicle iii) Launch Tether b) Basket Preparation and Inspection i) Assembly of burner frame, basket wires, fuel hoses and karabiners ii) Assembly of burner frame support rods and covers (where tted) iii) Location and securing of fuel cylinders c) Burner Preparation and Inspection i) Inspection and connection of vapour and liquid hoses ii) Leak Test
May 2012
iii) Operation of pilot light and valves iv) Operation of main burner and valves d) Envelope Preparation & Inspection i) Connection of ying wires to burner frame ii) Attachment of Quick Release/ Restraint (where tted) iii) Layout e) Equipment Preparation, Inspection and Checks i) Altimeter ii) Variometer, thermistor (if tted) iii) Radio (if tted) iv) Navigation equipment stowed v) Handling line stowed vi) Fire Extinguisher f) Crew and Passenger Brieng i) Commanders supervision and direction of crew and passengers g) Airmanship 1.3 Ination a) Operation of Fan i) Position of fan ii) Precautions b) Deation System (IAW Flight Manual) i) Parachute type (as tted) ii) Velcro type (as tted) iii) Combination (as tted) type iv) Rapid Deation type (as tted) v) Turn Vents (where tted) c) Control of Crew during Ination of Envelope (IAW Flight Manual) i) Envelope and fan ii) Crown Line iii) Basket d) Operation of Burner i) Control ii) Safety precautions e) Pre-take off Checks i) In accordance with Flight Manual f) Airmanship g) Emergencies i) Action in event of re ii) Action in event of equipment failure iii) Action in event of gusting conditions
May 2012
Section 2 Tethered Flight 2.1 Pre-Ination a) Layout Consideration i) Position of tether points (vehicles, trees etc.) ii) Position of balloon iii) Position of tether lines iv) Tether height calculations v) Safety requirements vi) Compliance with the Air Navigation Order and Rules of the Air b) Basket Preparation and Inspection In accordance with 7.1.2 (b) (Pre-ination) c) Burner Preparation and Inspection In accordance with 7.1.2 (c) (Pre-ination) d) Envelope Preparation and Inspection In accordance with 7.1.2 (d) (Pre-ination) e) Equipment Preparation, Inspection and Checks i) Attachment of tether lines to tether points in accordance with Flight Manual ii) Attachment of tether lines to balloon a) i) and ii) in accordance with Flight Manual iii) Thermistor (if tted) iv) Fire Extinguisher f) Crew and Passenger Brieng i) Supervision and direction of crew ii) Procedure for supervision of passenger transfer iii) Directions to advise pilot of any changes in conditions iv) Actions in event of emergency g) Crowd Control h) Airmanship 2.2 Ination a) In accordance with 7.1.3 (Ination) 2.3 Tethered Flight a) Application of and reaction to changes in weather conditions b) Climb to achieve level ight at a height nominated by the examiner c) Maintenance of level ight for a minimum of ve minutes at a height of between 10 feet and 50 feet agl. d) Descent to land e) Procedures for transfer of passengers (Discussion) 2.4 Emergencies a) Action in event of Fire b) Actions in event of equipment failure c) Actions in event of gusting conditions 2.5 Fuel Management a) Fuel calculations b) Fuel transfer precautions
May 2012
Section 3 General Handling 3.1 Take-off a) Obtaining equilibrium b) Operation of quick release (where tted c) Awareness of false lift d) Awareness of downwind obstructions e) Establish climb rate to clear downwind obstructions f) Climb to achieve level ight 3.2 Level ight a) Maintain level ight for a minimum of 5 minutes to within 50 ft of required altitude 3.3 Climb and transition to level ight a) Maintain steady rate of climb to a briefed height (minimum height of 500 ft agl ROC not to exceed Flight Manual limits) b) Round out for level ight 3.4 Descent and transition to level ight a) Achieve a steady rate of descent to a new briefed minimum height of 500 ft agl (ROD not to exceed Flight Manual Limits) b) Round out for level ight 3.5 Approach and overshoot a) Airspace considerations b) Site selection and assessment of wind c) Pre-landing checks d) Use of controls e) Airmanship i) High level aa) An approach to land procedure starting at a minimum height of 1000 ft agl bb)Stabilised descent at 400 fpm 100 fpm to a point from which a landing could be made cc)Round out at 75 ft agl 25 ft dd) Initiate and establish a normal climb ii) b. Low level aa) An approach to land procedure starting at a maximum height of 500 ft agl bb)Stabilised descent at a ROD not exceeding 200 fpm to a point from which a landing could be made cc) Round out at 50 ft agl 25 ft dd) Initiate and establish a normal climb 3.6 Emergencies a) Envelope overheat
May 2012
b) Fire in the Air c) Contact with power lines d) Contact with obstacles e) Loss of main burner f) Loss of pilot light g) Emergency Landing h) Parachute/Velcro Malfunction i) Approach with simulated failure of one burner j) Ill or incapacitated passenger 3.7 Landing a) Site selection b) Pre-landing checks in accordance with Flight Manual c) Passenger brieng d) Use of controls to achieve desired ROD (touchdown nal velocity not to exceed 50 feet per minute) e) Deation f) Burner shutdown g) Passenger transfer (where applicable) 3.8 Action after ight a) Safety actions b) Passenger off-load c) Re-seal velcro (if appropriate) d) Pack away envelope e) De-rig burner f) Landowner consultation g) Recording of ight details in appropriate logbooks 3.9 Fuel management a) Minimum requirements in accordance with Flight Manual b) Checks c) Calculations d) Transfer of hoses e) Refuelling procedures and appropriate safety precautions 3.10 ATC liaison a) Communications with the appropriate Air Trafc Services by radiotelephony, telephone etc. as appropriate (the use of cellular telephones in ight is not permitted).
May 2012
Section 4 Navigation 4.1 Weather a) Awareness and usage of variations in wind direction and speed at different altitudes b) Prediction of potential hazards curlover, turbulence, thermals etc. c) Anticipation of conditions in landing area d) Assessment of low level and surface wind speed, and direction using smoke, trees, water, crops etc. 4.2 Use of maps and charts a) Scales and units. Conversion between units b) Computation of safety altitudes and selection of altitudes for ight c) Transfer of information from various types and projections of maps and charts d) Amendments to ight plan, and ight log (map) e) Position of balloon in relation to potential hazards and restrictions 4.3 ATC Liaison a) Recognition of and compliance with visual signals b) RT communications (where applicable) c) Trafc avoidance d) SAR requirements and signals e) Airmiss procedure f) Urgency and distress signals, and procedures g) Altimeter setting requirements h) Observance of air trafc control regulations and Rules of the Air 4.4 Position Fixing a) Fixing position within 500 metres of actual position (minimum of three xes at intervals of not less than 5 minutes) b) Determine track made good and ground speed c) Projection of track and calculation of ETA, to within 3 minutes, to overhead a position nominated by the examiner d) Calculation of a forecast ground position. Position to be 30 minutes ahead and based upon TMG and G/S 4.5 Fuel management a) Calculations of fuel used b) Revision of endurance based upon variations in fuel consumption c) Calculation of point from which a landing could be made aiming to land with 20% usable fuel remaining
May 2012
2.1
Aviation Law, Flight Rules and Procedures Publications may NOT be consulted during the examinations. Candidates will not be required to memorise details of geographical positions, or of special procedures applicable to any particular aerodrome, Flight Information Region, Control Zone or Airway.
2.1.1
The UK Aeronautical Information Publication, NOTAM and Aeronautical Information Circulars. A general knowledge of the operational provisions with a more detailed knowledge of the following: Denitions; conditions of availability; customs and health airports; use of military aerodromes; aeronautical ground lights.
2.1.1.1 Aerodromes
2.1.1.2 Communications The aeronautical mobile service; the aeronautical radio navigation service. 2.1.1.3 Meteorology Types of service provided; observing systems and operating procedures; application of METAR, TAF, TREND and AIREP codes; runway visual range; aircraft meteorological observations and reports. 2.1.1.4 Air Trafc Rules and Services Denitions. Visual ight rules, instrument ight rules and general air trafc control procedures. Types of airspace and air trafc service units. Separation standards. Carriage of radio equipment and communication failure procedures. Airprox reporting procedures. Altimeter setting procedures. Use of radar in air trafc services. Control areas. Advisory airspace. Flight information service. Airspace restrictions. Signals for aerodrome trafc. 2.1.1.5 Search and Rescue Responsible authority. Communications. Distress frequencies. Aircraft not equipped with radio. Procedure for pilot-in-command requiring SAR escort facilities. Procedure for pilot-in-command observing an accident or intercepting a distress call (or message) and for guiding surface craft to the scene of a ditching. Flight in areas where search and rescue operations are in progress. Action by survivors. Ground/air visual signal code for use by survivors. 2.1.1.6 Additional matters Any information of an operational nature that may, from time to time, be added to the UK AIP, NOTAM and Aeronautical Information Circulars. (It should be noted that questions based on the contents of current pink (Safety) Aeronautical Information Circulars may also be asked under an appropriate subject heading).
May 2012
2.1.2
The Air Navigation Order A general knowledge of the provisions, with particular reference to the following: Aircraft to be registered Registration of aircraft in the United Kingdom Certicate of airworthiness to be in force Issue, renewal, etc. of certicates of airworthiness Certicate of maintenance review Technical log Inspection, overhaul, repair, replacement and modication. Equipment of aircraft Radio equipment of aircraft Composition of crew of aircraft Members of ight crew requirements of licences Grant, renewal and effect of ight crew licences Validation of licences Personal ying logbook Instruction in ying Operations Manual Training Manual Public transport - operators responsibilities Public transport - operating conditions Pre-ight action by commander of aircraft Public transport of passengers additional duties of commander Operation of radio in aircraft Towing, picking up and raising of persons and articles Dropping of articles and animals Dropping of persons Carriage of weapons and munitions of war Carriage of dangerous goods Method of carriage of persons Exits and break-in marking Endangering safety of any person or property Drunkenness in aircraft Authority of commander and members of the crew of aircraft Application and interpretation of Part 20 Fatigue of crew - operators responsibilities Flight times: responsibilities of ight crew Documents to be carried Production of documents and records Offences in relation to documents and records Rules of the air Power to prohibit or restrict ying Balloons, kites, airships, gliders and parascending parachutes Mandatory reporting Penalties Interpretation Meaning of ight Meaning of operator Meaning of aerodrome trafc zone
May 2012
Schedule 2 Part A: A & B Conditions and Part B: Categories of Certicate of Airworthiness. Schedule 3 Schedule 5 Schedule 7 Schedule 9 Part A: Table of Classication of Aircraft. Radio equipment to be carried in aircraft. Flight Crew of Aircraft: Licences and Ratings. Documents to be carried by Aircraft Registered in the United Kingdom
Questions will not be asked on the details of the Schedules except where specically indicated above. 2.1.3 The Air Navigation (General) Regulations 2006 (as amended) Load sheets Regulation 4 Mandatory reporting Regulations 14 & 15 2.1.4 The Rules of the Air Regulations 2007 (as amended) Interpretation Section 1 General Section 2 Low Flying Rules Section 3 General Flight Rules Section 4 Visual Flight Rules Section 5 Instrument Flight Rules Section 6 Aerodrome Trafc Rules Section 7 Lights and other signals to be shown by aircraft Section 8 Aerodrome signals and Markings Section 9 2.1.5 The Civil Aviation (Investigation of Air Accidents and Incidents) Regulations 1996 (as amended) Duty to furnish information relating to accidents and incidents Regulation 5-6 2.1.6 2.2 2.2.1 The Air Navigation (Dangerous Goods) Regulations 2002 (as amended) Navigation Maps
2.2.1.1 The interpretation and use of the ICAO 1:500,000 chart and the Ordnance Survey 1:50,000 map; methods of indicating scale and relief; interpretation of chart symbols. 2.2.1.2 Position on the earth in latitude and longitude, grid reference and in bearing and distance from a prominent point. 2.2.1.3 Measurement of distance and bearings. 2.2.1.4 Determination of spot elevation from the Ordnance Survey 1:50,000 map. 2.2.1.5 Transfer of data from the ICAO 1:500,000 chart to the O/S 1:50,000 map and vice versa, especially the boundaries of controlled and special rules airspace and prohibited, danger and restricted areas. 2.2.2 Instruments 2.2.2.1 The principles of operation and the errors of the pressure altimeter; the meaning and uses of QNH, QFE, standard pressure setting, altitude, transition altitude, transition level, elevation, height, pressure altitude.
May 2012
2.2.2.2 The principles of operation and the errors of the magnetic compass. 2.2.2.3 The principles of operation of the vertical speed indicator. 2.2.3 Practical navigation 2.2.3.1 Track (true, magnetic, compass), wind velocity, groundspeed/distance/time/gas consumption calculations. 2.2.3.2 Conversion of units: nautical miles, statute miles, feet, inches, kilometres, metres, centimetres. 2.2.3.3 Determination of distance by scale calculation. 2.2.3.4 Given the relevant ight information and charts, predict a probable ight path with elapsed times/ ETAs for prominent points, and extract signicant features from the charts including topographical and aeronautical data. 2.2.3.5 Given the relevant information, determine position by the use of topographical pinpoints and bearings, including simple VOR bearings. 2.3 2.3.1 Meteorology Properties of the atmosphere
2.3.1.1 Temperature: radiation, conduction and convection; variation of temperature near the earths surface; variation of temperature with height; lapse rates, temperature inversions, troposphere, tropopause. 2.3.1.2 Pressure: denition; variation horizontally and vertically. 2.3.1.3 Air density: variation at surface and with height. 2.3.1.4 Humidity: dew point; latent heat and change of state; evaporation, condensation, sublimation. 2.3.1.5 Relationship between density, pressure, temperature and humidity; the International Standard Atmosphere. 2.3.2 Wind 2.3.2.1 Relationship between wind and isobars; geostrophic wind, gradient wind. 2.3.2.2 Variation of wind with height; elementary knowledge of thermal winds. 2.3.2.3 Local variation of wind with topography; diurnal; anabatic and katabatic effects, Fohn effect; land and sea breezes. 2.3.2.4 Airow over mountains; standing waves. 2.3.2.5 Gusts, squalls, turbulence; low-level wind shear. 2.3.3 Clouds and precipitation 2.3.3.1 Stability and instability in the atmosphere. 2.3.3.2 Types of cloud; methods of formation; height of base and vertical extent. 2.3.3.3 Turbulence cloud; orographic cloud; convection cloud. 2.3.3.4 Thunderstorms. 2.3.3.5 Precipitation associated with different types of cloud: drizzle, rain, snow, hail. 2.3.3.6 Operating hazards associated with various types of cloud and precipitation. 2.3.4 Visibility 2.3.4.1 Fog, mist, haze and their differences.
May 2012
2.3.4.2 Formation of radiation fog and advection fog, diurnal and seasonal variation. 2.3.4.3 Vertical and oblique visibility; runway visual range. 2.3.5 2.3.6 Ice Accretion Air masses and fronts 2.3.5.1 Flight procedure in icing conditions. 2.3.6.1 Classication and characteristics of air masses. 2.3.6.2 Characteristics of warm and cold fronts and occlusions. 2.3.6.3 Depressions, anticyclones, cols: associated weather. 2.3.7 The Weather Map 2.3.7.1 Interpretation of symbols and gures used on weather charts. 2.3.7.2 The development and movement of simple pressure systems and fronts. 2.3.7.3 Elementary forecasting. 2.3.8 Observations 2.3.8.1 Knowledge of standard methods of measuring pressure, temperature, humidity, cloud height, visibility, surface wind, upper wind. 2.3.9 Sources of meteorological information and its presentation 2.3.9.1 Weathercall and special arrangements for balloon operators. 2.3.9.2 Volmet. 2.3.9.3 Decoding of TAF and METAR. 2.3.9.4 Comprehension and interpretation of ight forecast documents (signicant weather and low level wind charts in particular). 2.4 2.4.1 Aircraft (General) (Balloons) This written examination is based on the knowledge areas specied in this section. Systems a) Main components, the purpose of each component and the safety features of the system; b) The principles of operation of the system; c) The care and maintenance of the system; d) Burner rating; e) The symptoms of fuel exhaustion and the use of an emergency (or back-up) system, if tted; f) Icing; g) Leaks; h) Cylinder position. 2.4.1.2 Propane a) Properties: i) specic gravity in liquid gaseous form; 2.4.1.1 Fuel systems and burners
May 2012
ii) effect of altitude on burner pressure; iii) effect of temperature on tank pressure and burner pressure; b) Fuel quantity measurement with reference to a percentage fuel gauge; c) The reasons for, and the method of, heating tanks; d) The precautions to be observed: i) for the prevention of re; ii) during refuelling; e) The action required in the event of a propane re. 2.4.1.3 Deation a) The operation of the deation system, the function of the main components. b) Main advantages and disadvantages of the system. c) Safety checks. d) Routine checks and limitations. 2.4.1.4 Equipment and instruments - altimeter, vertical speed indicator (vario), thermistor, their construction, principles of operation, limitations, presentation, adjustments and serviceability checks. 2.4.2 Balloon performance 2.4.2.1 Factors that may affect fuel consumption, burner output (pressure and ambient temperature). Use of nitrogen pressure systems. 2.4.2.2 Knowledge of the terms: equilibrium, inertia, momentum, false lift, terminal velocity, curlover, lift, weighing off. 2.4.2.3 Operational limitations, loading and limitations and the reasons for imposing those limits (to include normal and maximum rates of climb and descent, envelope temperature maximum and continuous). 2.4.2.4 The factors to be considered in preparation for, and the execution of: a) high wind landing; b) high vertical speed landing; c) landing in thermic conditions; d) landing in gusty/turbulent conditions; e) tethering for display purposes; f) tethering for passenger rides; g) take-off in varying conditions. 2.4.2.5 Factors that may affect performance: altitude, wind, terrain. 2.4.3 2.4.4 2.4.5 2.4.7 Balloon maintenance: qualications, C of A requirements, routine maintenance, minor repairs, inspection schedules, fabric overheating, deation system, re extinguisher. Flight characteristics. Accidents and incidents. Aero medical.
2.4.6 Documents.
May 2012
2.4.7.1 Basic knowledge of rst aid and use of generally available kits. 2.4.7.2 Physiological factors: the senses, spatial disorientation and sensory illusions. 2.4.7.3 Effects of colds, alcohol and drugs. 2.4.7.4 Recognition of the effects of hypoxia and carbon monoxide, and knowledge of their dangers. 2.5 2.5.1 2.5.2 Aircraft (Type) (Balloons) This is an examination, conducted by an authorised examiner and conned to the type of balloon upon which the candidate is being ight-tested. Flight Manual a) Emergency procedure: re on the ground and in the air. b) In-ight system failures. c) Limitations. d) Use of the load system specied in the Flight Manual, and determination of the maximum payload for a given pressure height and outside air temperature. 2.5.3 2.6 2.6.1 Balloon systems specic to type used during ight test. Human Performance and Limitations Syllabus (Balloons) This syllabus is divided into four main topic areas: a) Basic Aviation Physiology and Health Maintenance. b) Basic Aviation Psychology. c) Stress, Fatigue and their Management. d) Social Psychology. 2.6.2 Basic Aviation Physiology and Health Maintenance 2.6.2.1 Basic Physiology and the Effects of Flight Anatomy and physiology of the eye, ear, vestibular, circulatory and respiratory systems. Composition of the atmosphere, gas laws and the nature of the human requirement for oxygen. Effects of reduced ambient pressure. Recognising and coping with hypoxia and hyperventilation. Entrapped gases and barotrauma. Motion sickness. Diving and ying. 2.6.2.2 Flying and Health Noise and age-induced hearing loss. Visual defects and their correction. Arterial disease and coronary risk factors, ECG, blood pressure, stroke. Diet, exercise, obesity. Fits, faints and the EEG. Psychiatric diseases; drug dependence and alcoholism. Common ailments and tness to y; Gastro-enteritis, colds, use of common drugs and their side effects.
May 2012
2.6.3
Basic Aviation Psychology Basic plan of human information processing, including the concepts of sensation, attention, memory, central decision-making and the creation of mental models. Limitation of central decision channel and mental workload. Function of attention in selecting information sources, attention getting stimuli. Effects of experience and expectation on perception. Erroneous mental models; visual, vestibular and other illusions. Use of visual cues in landing. Eye movements, visual search techniques, mid-air collisions. Skill-, rule- and knowledge-based behaviour. The nature of skill acquisition, the exercise of skill, conscious and automatic behaviour errors of skill. Rule-based behaviour, procedures, failures of rule-based behaviour. Knowledge-based behaviour, problem solving and decision-making, inference formation, failures in knowledge-based behaviour. Maintaining accurate mental models, situational awareness, conrmation bias.
2.6.4 Stress and Stress Management 2.6.4.1 Models and Effects of Stress Denitions, concepts and models of stress. Arousal; concepts of over- and under-arousal. Environmental stresses and their effects; heat, noise. Domestic stress, home relationships, bereavement, nancial and time commitments. Work stress, relationship with colleagues. Effects of stress on attention, motivation and performance. Life stress and health, other clinical effects of stress. Defence mechanisms, identifying stress and stress management. 2.6.4.2 Sleep and Fatigue Work-induced fatigue. Shift work. Rostering problems, sleep management and naps. Sleep hygiene. 2.6.5 Social Psychology 2.6.5.1 Individual Differences, Social Psychology and Interaction with Others Individual differences, denitions of intelligence and personality. Assessing personality. Main dimensions of personality: extroversion and anxiety. Other important traits; warmth and sociability, impulsivity, tough-mindedness, dominance, stability and boldness. Goal-directed, person-directed types of behaviour. Individual personality related problems of ying, especially risk-taking. Communication, verbal and non-verbal communication, one and two-way communication, different communication styles. Interacting with crew, air trafc services, ground handling personnel and passengers. 2.6.5.2 Judgement Making decisions. Assessing risk.
May 2012 Section 5 Part C Subpart 2 Page 16
3.1
Flight tests Aircraft Rating ight tests are conducted by Type Rating Examiners (TRE) authorised by the CAA to conduct such tests and to sign a C of T or C of E in respect of the Aircraft Rating. Information concerning the availability of such examiners is obtainable from the CAA (Personnel Licensing). The arrangements and payment for conduct of an Aircraft Rating ight test are a matter between the applicant and the TRE concerned. Where the TRE is an employee of the Authority the charge will be in accordance with the current statutory list of charges. The test requires that the applicant demonstrates to the examiner his competence in carrying out normal and emergency manoeuvres and drills appropriate to the aircraft type in question. The detailed content of the test is specied in the application form for the inclusion of an aircraft type in the rating (Form SRG 1319). On application for grant of the CPL(B) the applicant should forward the completed SRG 1319 in which the examiner has certied the completion of the required test items. Provided that it is satisfactory, and that the other licensing requirements have been met, the CAA will issue the licence with the appropriate class and group entered in the Aircraft Rating. The Aircraft Rating ight test for the issue of a CPL(B) must be satisfactorily completed within the 12-month period immediately preceding the date of receipt by the CAA of the licence application.
3.2
Additional class/group An additional Class/Group of balloon will be included in the Aircraft Rating following a successful ight test and Aircraft (Type) examination in a balloon representative of the Class/Group, conducted by an examiner authorised for the purpose by the CAA.
May 2012
3.3
Credits for the Aircraft Rating ight test The holder of a professional balloon pilots licence issued by another ICAO Contracting State, and which includes a specic balloon type, may have the appropriate Class/Group entered in the Aircraft Rating of the UK licence without having to take the Aircraft Rating ight test, provided that he has not less than 100 hours experience as PIC of such a balloon and the non-UK licence and rating are current.
3.4
Certicates of test and experience An Aircraft Rating C of T is valid for a period of 13 months from the date of the initial successful ight test. Thereafter the validity of the Aircraft Rating must be maintained by either a C of T or a C of E as follows:
3.4.1
Flight for the purpose of public transport A C of T is required for public transport ights. The Certicate is valid for 13 months. The test must have been carried out in a balloon of the Class and Group in which the public transport ight is to be conducted, except that a test in a Group B balloon will also be valid for Group A balloons of the same Class, or a test in a Group C balloon will also be valid for Group A and Group B balloons of the same Class. The individual type used for the test must be within a Class and Group included in the Aircraft Rating. In addition, the pilot is required to have carried out in the 90 days preceding the public transport ight not less than 3 free ights, each of at least 5 minutes duration, for any purpose, as PIC of a free balloon.
3.4.2
Flight for the purpose of aerial work A C of E or a C of T is required for aerial work ights. The C of E is valid for 13 months, and will be entered in the licence by an examiner appointed or employed by the CAA on production of logbook evidence that the pilot has, within the preceding 13 months, carried out as pilot at least 3 hours free ight in a class and group entered in the Aircraft Rating of the licence, including at least 5 ights. At least one tethered ight must also have been made in the period. Of the 3 hours free ight experience required, at least 2hours and 3 ights must have been as PIC. The remainder of the time may be made up of: a) free ight as PICUS gained with an authorised examiner on a successful ight test for the grant or revalidation of a licence or Aircraft Rating; b) dual ying instruction own with a person authorised by the CAA provided that, at the completion of the free ight or ights, the authorised person considered the pilot t to y as PIC, and so certied in the pilots personal ying logbook. A pilot with more than one balloon class/group included in the Aircraft Rating of his licence, wishing to revalidate each Aircraft Rating, must include at least one free ight as PIC in a balloon in the class or group as part of the overall minimum 3 hours. Expiry of Cs of T and Cs of E by more than ve years If a period of more than 5 years has elapsed since the validity of the most recent CofT and the most recent C of E for the type of balloon on which the licence holder wishes to exercise the licence privileges, then before the C of T may be revalidated in respect of that type an assessment of training and testing requirements must be obtained from the CAA (Licensing and Training Standards).
May 2012
Subpart 3
UK CPL(G) Gyroplanes
May 2012
Subpart 4
UK CPL(H) Helicopters
No supplementary information.
May 2012
Subpart 5
No supplementary information.
May 2012
Subpart 6
UK CPL(As) Airships
No supplementary information.
May 2012
Part D
Subpart 1
No supplementary information.
May 2012
Subpart 2
UK ATPL(H) Helicopters
No supplementary information.
May 2012
Part E
1
1.0
1.1 1.2
Physiological Factors The senses, spatial disorientation, sensory illusions. Flight Instruments Principles of operation, pre-ight and in-ight checks, errors and limitations, system failures associated with the pressure altimeter, airspeed indicator, direct reading magnetic compass, directional gyro indicator, turn and slip indicator, articial horizon and vertical speed indicator.
Aeronautical Information Service NOTAMS UKAIP a) Rules of the Air and Air Trafc Services Visual ight rules and instrument ight rules, ight plans and ATS messages, use of radar in air trafc services, radio failure procedures, special VFR, Class D airspace, control zones and terminal control areas, control areas, advisory airspace, radar advisory service, airspace restrictions and hazards, royal ights, holding and approach to land procedures. The last item listed includes: recommended aerodrome operating minima for nonpublic transport ights, pilot-interpreted approach procedures, radar approach procedures, VDF procedures, missed approach procedures, and visual manoeuvring after an instrument approach. b) Communications Types of service, extracting data for radio aids from UKAIP.
May 2012
c) Aeronautical Charts General description of chart series available, symbols used, topographical charts, instrument approach and landing charts, system for chart amendment and revision. d) Supplements 1.3.3 1.4 1.4.1 AICs Contents of current circulars of an operational nature. Flight Planning General Objectives of ight planning, preparation of ight plan/log, choice of routes and levels, factors affecting aircraft and engine performance, selection of alternate aerodromes. 1.4.2 Meteorology Contents of terms and symbols used in aviation forecasts, documents (including TAFS), in other forms of present service (including pre-recorded voice), and weather reports (including METARs), available to the private pilot and SIGMET messages, the route forecast, operational signicance of information given (including icing, turbulence and visibility). 1.4.3 Altimetry Denitions (transition altitude, transition level, ight level, standard pressure setting, QFE, QNH, regional pressure setting), setting procedures (pre-ight check, take-off and climb, en-route, approach and landing, missed approach). 1.4.4 Terrain Clearance Minimum safe en-route altitude, aerodrome minimum sector altitudes, visual manoeuvring heights, obstacle clearance limits, decision height and minimum descent height. 1.4.5 Radio Aids Selection and use of Radio aids including VDF, VOR, ADF, DME, ILS, marker receiver, transponder: Principles of operation, pre-ight checks, range and accuracy, identication (Morse Code). 1.4.6 1.5 Radar Approach Procedures Accuracy, limitations of equipment and operational use. Privileges of IMC Rating A detailed knowledge of the privileges of the IMC Rating, its period of validity and revalidation procedure.
2
2.1 2.1.1
May 2012
2.1.2 2.1.3
Instruction on the course may only be given by an IRI or a ying instructor who is qualied to teach applied instrument ying. When the applicant wishes to be trained and tested for an IMC Rating on a multi-engine aeroplane, the training must include sufcient instruction to enable the pilot to maintain stable ight following the failure of one engine at climbing power, to climb at the recommended speed, and to carry out normal ight manoeuvres during asymmetric ight in simulated instrument ight conditions. A students ability and experience may be taken into account in deciding how much time should be allotted to each of the following items but the course must cover all of them. Basic Stage Full Panel a) Instrument Attitude Flight Pitch indications, bank and direction indications, effect of power variations and aircraft conguration, instrument limitations, selective radial scan. b) Basic Flight Manoeuvres Straight and level in various congurations, climbing, descending, standard rate turns (level, climbing and descending, compass/ timed). c) Intermediate Flight Manoeuvres Turns at various rates, transfer to instruments after take-off (full panel only), recovery from unusual attitudes (incipient stall, steep bank, spiral dive).
2.1.4
2.2 2.2.1
2.2.2
Limited Panel Simulated loss of gyroscopic pitch and bank indicator and gyroscopic direction indicator. a) Basic Flight Manoeuvres Straight and level, climbing, descending, standard rate level turns. b) Unusual Attitude Recoveries
2.2.3
Partial Panel Simulated loss of pitot/static pressure: recognition of loss of pitot/static pressure, maintenance of attitude and safe airspeed, straight and level and turning ight.
Applied Stage Pre-Flight Planning Published procedures, operating minima applicable to IMC Rating holders. Departure and En Route Aircraft equipment checks, radio aid selection and identication appropriate to the planned departure, ATC liaison and compliance with RT procedures, use of lower airspace radar services, operation of radio aids for the establishment of planned track, track keeping by interception and maintenance of pre-selected bearings/radials to and from a facility, use of bearing information from off-track radio aids for position nding, en route holding procedures. The applicant to be trained in the use of at least 2 from VOR, VDF, ADF or GPS (VOR or ADF must be included) to carry out these procedures.
May 2012
2.3.3
Approach and Let-Down Use of approach charts, Decision Height/Minimum Descent Height calculations using the recommended minima for the IMC Rated pilot given in the UK AIP forming a mental picture of the approach, initial homing, achieving the overhead/approach x, holding procedures, achieving the horizontal and vertical patterns, calculation of rate of descent, go-around, missed approach procedure. Applicants are to be trained in at least 2 instrument approach procedures using VOR, ADF, ILS, GPS, radar or VDF of which at least one must be pilot interpreted. Completion of a notied recognised civil or military instrument approach procedure during training, is to be certied in the applicants ying book. Note that GPS approaches are dened as those notied by the Authority in the AIP and own using equipment certied for the conduct of such approaches in the aeroplanes Pilots Operating Handbook or Flight Manual; overlay approaches or privately designed approaches are not acceptable.
2.3.4 2.4
Bad Weather Circuits and Landings Low cloud with good visibility, low cloud with poor visibility. Flight Test Syllabus The Flight Test for the initial issue of the IMC Rating will take approximately 1.5 hours chock to chock time and a candidate must demonstrate satisfactory manual instrument ying capability in the following: a) Full Panel Instrument Flying Straight and level ight at given speeds, turns at a given rate, turns onto given headings, climbing and descending including turns, recovery from unusual attitudes. b) Limited Panel Instrument Flying Assuming failure of the gyroscopic pitch and bank indicator and gyroscopic direction indicator): Straight and level ight, climbing and descending, turns onto given headings, recovery from unusual attitudes. c) Radio Navigation Aids Use of Radio Navigation Aids for positionnding using one or more aids (to include VOR or ADF), maintenance of a given track based on a pilot-interpreted aid for 10 minutes. d) Let-down and Approach Procedures Let-down and approach to Decision Height, Minimum Descent Height and missed approach procedure using a pilot-interpreted aid, carry out a recognised instrument approach procedure to Decision Height, Minimum Descent Height hence the appropriate go-around and missed approach procedure. e) Bad Weather Circuits Bad weather circuit and landing following item (d), position the aircraft in the circuit at the direction of the Examiner, to carry out a visual bad weather circuit and landing under specied simulated weather conditions. f) Flight with Asymmetric Power Control of the aeroplane and maintenance of a given heading and asymmetric climb speed, following the failure of one engine in the climbing conguration at normal climb power.
May 2012
Identication of the failed engine and the completion of all essential drills and checks. Climbing and level turns in asymmetric ight as directed by the Examiner. Throughout item f) of the test, the Examiner will be responsible for navigation and ATC liaison. On resumption of normal ight the applicant will be told the position of the aeroplane. Feathering will be simulated by the Examiner on completion of the correct touch drills by the candidate. 2.5 Tolerances To qualify for a pass, a candidate must demonstrate his ability to y safely in smooth air to the limits specied in the following table: these limits should not be achieved at the expense of smoothness and good co-ordination due allowance will be made for turbulent conditions.
TOLERANCES Flight Condition Height in Level Flight Height for initiating missed Approach Procedure from Decision Height or Minimum Descent Height Tracking (on Radio Aids) Heading Speed ILS Procedure - Final Approach GPS Approach Normal Flight 100 ft 0 ft +50 ft 5 (VOR) 10 (ADF) 10 10 kt N/A 15 20 kt N/A 10 10 kt Limited Panel Flight 200 ft N/A Flight (Full Panel) Asymmetric Power 200 ft N/A
(but not below threshold speed) scale deection on Localiser and Glidepath scale deection from Initial Approach Fix to MAP
2.6 2.6.1
Revalidation Flight Test The Flight Test required after initial qualication for the purpose of revalidating the Rating will comprise items b), d) and e) of the initial Flight Test (see paragraph 2.4). The type of approach aid used must be entered in the log book. A revalidation Flight Test that is a rst multi-engine test must include (f) at paragraph 2.4. The applicant is also to show log book evidence that, in the period between initial and/ or re-validation ight tests, he has successfully completed a let-down and notied approach to DH/MDH, a go-around and a missed approach procedure using an aid of a different type from that used during item d) of the test. This shall be accomplished to the satisfaction of an instructor qualied to give instrument ying instruction. Alternatively the candidate may carry out two approach procedures using different aids during the re-validation ight test. Item f) at paragraph 2.4 is required in multi-engine aeroplanes only. The Examiner will be responsible for navigation and ATC liaison. On resumption of normal ight, the candidate will be told the position of the aeroplane. Feathering will be simulated by the Examiner on completion of the correct touch drills by the candidate.
2.6.2
2.6.3
May 2012